B.tech (CSBS) Syllabus

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 397

ANNA UNIVERSITY, CHENNAI

NON- AUTONOMOUS AFFILIATED COLLEGES


REGULATIONS 2021
CHOICE BASED CREDIT SYSTEM
B.TECH. COMPUTER SCIENCE AND BUSINESS SYSTEMS

I. PROGRAM EDUCATIONAL OBJECTIVES (PEOs)

I. To ensure graduates will be proficient in utilizing the fundamental knowledge of basic


sciences, mathematics, Computer Science and Business systems for the applications
relevant to various streams of Engineering and Technology.
II. To enrich graduates with the core competencies necessary for applying knowledge of
computer science and Data analytics tools to store, retrieve, implement and analyze
data in the context of business enterprise
III. To enable graduates to gain employment in organizations and establish themselves as
professionals by applying their technical skills and leadership qualities to solve real
world problems and meet the diversified needs of industry, academia and research
IV. To equip the graduates with entrepreneurial skills and qualities which help them to
perceive the functioning of business, diagnose business problems, explore the
entrepreneurial opportunities and prepare them to manage business efficiently.

II. PROGRAM OUTCOMES (POs)

1 Engineering knowledge: Apply the knowledge of mathematics, science, engineering


fundamentals, and an engineering specialization to the solution of complex engineering
problems.
2 Problem analysis: Identify, formulate, review research literature, and analyze complex
engineering problems reaching substantiated conclusions using first principles of
mathematics, natural sciences, and engineering sciences.
3 Design/development of solutions: Design solutions for complex engineering problems and
design system components or processes that meet the specified needs with appropriate
consideration for the public health and safety, and the cultural, societal, and environmental
considerations.
4 Conduct investigations of complex problems: Use research-based knowledge
and research methods including design of experiments, analysis and interpretation of data,
and synthesis of the information to provide valid conclusions.
5 Modern tool usage: Create, select, and apply appropriate techniques, resources, and
modern engineering and IT tools including prediction and modeling to complex engineering
activities with an understanding of the limitations.
6 The engineer and society: Apply reasoning informed by the contextual knowledge to
assess societal, health, safety, legal and cultural issues and the consequent
responsibilities relevant to the professional engineering practice.
7 Environment and sustainability: Understand the impact of the professional engineering
solutions in societal and environmental contexts, and demonstrate the knowledge of, and need
for sustainable development.
1
8 Ethics: Apply ethical principles and commit to professional ethics and responsibilities and
norms of the engineering practice.
9 Individual and team work: Function effectively as an individual, and as a member or
leader in diverse teams, and in multidisciplinary settings.
10 Communication: Communicate effectively on complex engineering activities with the
engineering community and with society at large, such as, being able to comprehend and write
effective reports and design documentation, make effective presentations, and give and
receive clear instructions.
11 Project management and finance: Demonstrate knowledge and understanding of the
engineering and management principles and apply these to one’s own work, as a member and
leader in a team, to manage projects and in multidisciplinary environments.

12 Life-long learning: Recognize the need for, and have the preparation and ability to
engage in independent and life-long learning in the broadest context of technological
change.

III. PROGRAM SPECIFIC OUTCOMES (PSOs)

PSO1: To create, select, and apply appropriate techniques, resources, modern engineering and
business tools including prediction and data analytics to complex engineering activities and
business solutions

PSO2: To evolve computer science domain specific methodologies for effective decision making in
several critical problem domains of the real world.

PSO3: To be able to apply entrepreneurial skills and management tools for identifying, analyzing
and creating business opportunities with smart business ideas.

PSO4: To manage complex IT projects with consideration of the human, financial, ethical and
environmental factors and an understanding of risk management processes, and operational and
policy implications

2
Mapping of Course Outcome and Programme Outcome

Year Sem Course name PO PSO

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
Induction Programme
I
I Professional English - I 1.6 2.2 1.8 2.2 1.5 3 3 3 1.6 3 3 3 - - - -
Matrices and Calculus 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - - -
Engineering Physics 3 3 1.6 1.2 1.8 1 - - - - - 1 - - - -
Engineering Chemistry 2.8 1.3 1.6 1 - 1.5 1.8 - - - 1.5 - - - -
Problem Solving and
2 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 3 - -
Python Programming
தமிழர் மரபு
/Heritage of Tamils
Problem Solving and
Python Programming 2 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 3 - -
Laboratory
Physics and Chemistry 3 2.4 2.6 1 1
Laboratory
2.6 1.3 1.6 1 1 1.4 1.8 - - - - 1.3 - - - -
$
English Laboratory 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - - -

II Professional English - II 3 3 3 3 2.75 3 3 3 2.2 3 3 3 - - - -


Statistics and
3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - - -
Numerical Methods
Physics for Information
3 1.3 2 1.3 2.3 1 1.3 - - - - 2 - - - -
Science
Basic Electrical and 2 1.8 1 - - - - 1 - - - 2 - - 1 -
Electronics Engineering
Engineering Graphics 3 1 2 - 2 - - - - 3 - 2 2 2 - -

Data Structures Design

தமிழரும்
ததொழில் நுட்பமும்
/Tamils and
Technology
Engineering Practices 3 2 - - 1 1 1 - - - - 2 2 1 1 -
Laboratory
Data Structures Design
Laboratory
Communication
2.4 2.8 3 3 1.8 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - - -
Laboratory / Foreign
$
Language
1 3 2 1 - - - - - 1 - - - - - -
II Iii Discrete Mathematics
Digital Principles and
3 3 3 3 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 2 1 3
Computer Organization
Fundamentals of 3 3 1 - - 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 - 2 -
Economics
Object Oriented
3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 - 3 2 1.2 2
Programming

3
Design and Analysis of
Algorithms 3 3 3 2 - - 1 - - - - - 3 3 - 2

Fundamentals of Data
3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 1 1
Science and Analytics
Business
Communication 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 2 - 1 2 1 1 -
Laboratory I
Object Oriented
Programming 2 2 2 2 2 - - - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Laboratory
Professional
$
Development
Probability and - - - -
IV 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
Statistics
Database Management 3 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 3 3 3 -
Systems
Operating Systems 3 3 3 2 - 2 - - 2 - - 2 3 3 - -
Introduction to
3 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 3 2 2 1
Business Systems
Machine Learning 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 2 -
Environmental
Sciences and 2.8 1.8 1 1 - 2.2 2.4 - - - - 1.8 - - - -
Sustainability
Database Management
3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 - 2 3 3 2 2
Systems Laboratory
Machine Learning 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - 2 2 1 2 3 3 2 2
Laboratory
Business
Communication 3 2 - - 2 3 2 - 2 2 - 2 3 - 2 -
Laboratory II
Embedded Systems
III V 3 3 2.6 - 2 2 2 - - - 2 - 3 3 3 3
and IoT
Fundamentals of 3 3 2.2 2 - 2 2 2 2 2 - - 3 3 3 3
Management
Data and Information 3 2.2 1.6 1 1 - 2 3 1 - - - 3 3 2 1
Security
Summer internship

VI Business Analytics 3 3 2.4 2.2 2 1.6 1.6 1.8 1.8 2.6 2.2 2 3 2 2.2 2.6
Object Oriented 2 3 1 2 2 1 3 2
- - - - - -
Software Engineering
Business Analytics
3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3
Laboratory
Human Values and
IV VII Ethics
Project Work /
VIII Internship
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

4
ANNA UNIVERSITY, CHENNAI
NON- AUTONOMOUS AFFILIATED COLLEGES
REGULATIONS 2021
B.TECH. COMPUTER SCIENCE AND BUSINESS SYSTEMS
CHOICE BASED CREDIT SYSTEM
CURRICULUM AND SYLLABI FOR SEMESTERS I TO VIII
SEMESTER I
PERIODS PER TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE-
COURSE TITLE WEEK CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. IP3151 Induction Programme - - - - - 0
THEORY
2. HS3152 Professional English - I HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
3. MA3151 Matrices and Calculus BSC 3 1 0 4 4
4. PH3151 Engineering Physics BSC 3 0 0 3 3
5. CY3151 Engineering Chemistry BSC 3 0 0 3 3
Problem Solving and Python
6. GE3151 ESC 3 0 0 3 3
Programming
7. GE3152 தமிழர் மரபு /Heritage of Tamils HSMC 1 0 0 1 1
PRACTICALS
8. Problem Solving and Python
GE3171 ESC 0 0 4 4 2
Programming Laboratory
9. BS3171 Physics and Chemistry Laboratory BSC 0 0 4 4 2
$
10. GE3172 English Laboratory EEC 0 0 2 2 1
TOTAL 16 1 10 27 22
$
Skill Based Course
SEMESTER II
PERIODS PER TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE-
COURSE TITLE WEEK CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. HS3252 Professional English - II HSMC 2 0 0 2 2
2. MA3251 Statistics and Numerical Methods BSC 3 1 0 4 4
3. PH3256 Physics for Information Science BSC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Basic Electrical and Electronics
BE3251 ESC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
5. GE3251 Engineering Graphics ESC 2 0 4 6 4
6. AD3251 Data Structures Design PCC 3 0 0 3 3
7. GE3252 தமிழரும் ததொழில் நுட்பமும் HSMC 1 0 0 1 1
/Tamils and Technology
# *
8. NCC Credit Course Level 1 - 2 0 0 2 2
PRACTICALS
9. GE3271 Engineering Practices Laboratory ESC 0 0 4 4 2
10. AD3271 Data Structures Design Laboratory PCC 0 0 4 4 2
11. Communication Laboratory / Foreign
GE3272 $ EEC 0 0 4 4 2
Language
TOTAL 17 1 16 34 26
#
NCC Credit Course level 1 is offered for NCC students only. The grades earned by the students will
be recorded in the Mark Sheet, however the same shall not be considered for the computation of
CGPA.
$
Skill Based Course

5
SEMESTER III
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. MA3354 Discrete Mathematics BSC 3 1 0 4 4
2. CS3351 Digital Principles and
ESC 3 0 2 5 4
Computer Organization
3. CW3301 Fundamentals of Economics PCC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Object Oriented
CS3391 PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Programming
5. Design and Analysis of
AD3351 PCC 3 0 2 5 4
Algorithms
6. Fundamentals of Data
AD3491 PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Science and Analytics
PRACTICALS
7. Business Communication
CW3311 PCC 0 0 3 3 1.5
Laboratory I
8. Object Oriented
CS3381 PCC 0 0 3 3 1.5
Programming Laboratory
9. GE3361 Professional Development$ EEC 0 0 2 2 1
TOTAL 18 1 12 31 25
$
Skill Based Course
SEMESTER IV
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. MA3391 Probability and Statistics BSC 3 1 0 4 4
2. Database Management PCC 3
CS3492 3 0 0 3
Systems
3. AL3452 Operating Systems PCC 3 0 2 5 4
4. Introduction to Business PCC 3
CW3401 3 0 0 3
Systems
5. AL3451 Machine Learning PCC 3 0 0 3 3
6. Environmental Sciences and
GE3451 BSC 2 0 0 2 2
Sustainability
7. NCC Credit Course Level 2# 3 0 0 3 3#
PRACTICALS
8. Database Management 0 0 3 3
CS3481 PCC 1.5
Systems Laboratory
9. AD3461 Machine Learning Laboratory PCC 0 0 4 4 2
10. Business Communication 0 0 3 3
CW3411 PCC 1.5
Laboratory II
TOTAL 17 1 12 30 24
#
NCC Credit Course level 2 is offered for NCC students only. The grades earned by the students will
be recorded in the Mark Sheet, however the same shall not be considered for the computation of
CGPA.

6
SEMESTER V
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. CS3691 Embedded Systems and IoT PCC 3 0 2 5 4
2. Fundamentals of
CW3501 PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Management
3. Data and Information
CW3551 PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Security
4. Professional Elective I PEC - - - - 3
5. Professional Elective II PEC - - - - 3
6. Mandatory Course-I& MC 3 0 0 3 0
PRACTICALS
7. CW3511 Summer Internship EEC 0 0 0 0 2
TOTAL - - - - 18
&
Mandatory Course-I is a Non-credit Course (Student shall select one course from the list given
under Mandatory Course-I)
SEMESTER VI
PERIODS PER TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. CCW331 Business Analytics PCC 2 0 2 4 3
2. Object Oriented Software
CCS356 PCC 3 0 2 5 4
Engineering
3. Open Elective – I* OEC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Professional Elective III PEC - - - - 3
5. Professional Elective IV PEC - - - - 3
6. Professional Elective V PEC - - - - 3
7. Professional Elective VI PEC - - - - 3
8. Mandatory Course-II & MC 3 0 0 3 0
9. NCC Credit Course Level 3# 3 0 0 3 3#
PRACTICALS
10. Business Analytics PCC 0 0 4 4
CW3611 2
Laboratory
TOTAL - - - - 24
*Open Elective – I Shall be chosen from the list of open electives offered by other Programmes
&
Mandatory Course-II is a Non-credit Course (Student shall select one course from the list given
under Mandatory Course-II)
#
NCC Credit Course level 3 is offered for NCC students only. The grades earned by the students will
be recorded in the Mark Sheet, however the same shall not be considered for the computation of
CGPA

7
SEMESTER VII / VIII*
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. GE3791 Human Values and
HSMC 2 0 0 2 2
Ethics
2. Elective - Management# HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
3. Open Elective – II** OEC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Open Elective – III** OEC 3 0 0 3 3
5. Open Elective – IV** OEC 3 0 0 3 3
TOTAL 14 0 0 14 14
*If students undergo internship in Semester VII, then the courses offered during semester VII will be
offered during semester VIII.
** Open Elective II - IV (Shall be chosen from the list of open electives offered by other Programmes).
#
Elective - Management shall be chosen from the Elective Management courses.

SEMESTER VIII /VII*

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
PRACTICALS
1. Project Work /
CW3811 EEC 0 0 20 20 10
Internship
TOTAL 0 0 20 20 10
*If students undergo internship in Semester VII, then the courses offered during semester VII will be
offered during semester VIII.

TOTAL CREDITS :163

ELECTIVE – MANAGEMENT COURSES

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PERWEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. GE3751 Principles of Management HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
2. GE3752 Total Quality Management HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
3. Engineering Economics and
GE3753 HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
Financial Accounting
4. Human Resource
GE3754 HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
Management
5. GE3755 Knowledge Management HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
6. GE3792 Industrial Management HSMC 3 0 0 3 3

8
MANDATORY COURSES I

PERIODS TOTAL
S. CATE
COURSE COURSE TITLE PER WEEK CONTACT CREDITS
NO. GORY
CODE L T P PERIODS
1. Introduction to Women
MX3081 MC 3 0 0 3 0
and Gender Studies
2. MX3082 Elements of Literature MC 3 0 0 3 0
3. MX3083 Film Appreciation MC 3 0 0 3 0
4. Disaster Risk Reduction
MX3084 MC 3 0 0 3 0
and Management

MANDATORY COURSES II
PERIODS TOTAL
S. CATE
COURSE COURSE TITLE PER WEEK CONTACT CREDITS
NO. GORY
CODE L T P PERIODS
1. Well Being with
Traditional Practices -
MX3085 MC 3 0 0 3 0
Yoga, Ayurveda and
Siddha
2. History of Science and
MX3086 MC 3 0 0 3 0
Technology in India
3. Political and Economic
MX3087 Thought for a Humane MC 3 0 0 3 0
Society
4. State, Nation Building
MX3088 MC 3 0 0 3 0
and Politics in India
5. MX3089 Industrial Safety MC 3 0 0 3 0

9
PROFESSIONAL ELECTIVE COURSES: VERTICALS
Vertical II Vertical III Vertical IV
Vertical I Vertical V
Cloud Computing and Data Emerging Artificial Intelligence Vertical VI
Data Science Management
Center Technologies Technologies and Machine Learning Marketing
Exploratory Data Cloud Computing Augmented Knowledge Customer Relation Financial Analytics
Analysis Reality/Virtual Reality Engineering Management
Recommender Virtualization Robotic Process Soft Computing Human Resource Recommender Systems
Systems Automation Management for
Entrepreneurs
Neural Networks Cloud Services Management Neural Networks and Neural Networks and Financial Management Digital Marketing
and Deep Learning Deep Learning Deep Learning
Text and Data Warehousing Cyber security Text and Supply Chain Management Conversational Systems
Speech Analysis Speech Analysis
Business Analytics Storage Technologies Quantum Computing Optimization IT Project Management Social Text and Media
Techniques Analytics
Image and Video Software Defined Networks Cryptocurrency and Game Theory Entrepreneurship Marketing Research and
Analytics Blockchain Technologies Development Marketing Management
Computer Vision Stream Processing Game Development Cognitive Science Introduction to Innovation,
IP Management and Risk Analytics
Entrepreneurship
Big Data Analytics Security and Privacy in Cloud 3D Printing and Design Ethics and AI
Behavioral Economics Enterprise Security

Registration of Professional Elective Courses from Verticals:

Professional Elective Courses will be registered in Semesters V and VI. These courses are listed in groups called verticals that represent a particular area of specialisation / diversified
group. Students are permitted to choose all the Professional Electives from a particular vertical or from different verticals. Further, only one Professional Elective course shall be
chosen in a semester horizontally (row-wise). However, two courses are permitted from the same row, provided one course is enrolled in Semester V and another in semester VI.

The registration of courses for B.E./B.Tech (Honours) or Minor degree shall be done from Semester V to VIII. The procedure for registration of courses explained above shall be
followed for the courses of B.E/B.Tech (Honours) or Minor degree also. For more details on B.E./B.Tech (Honours) or Minor degree refer to the Regulations 2021, Clause 4.10
(Amendments).

1
PROFESSIONAL ELECTIVE COURSES: VERTICALS

VERTICAL 1: DATA SCIENCE

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. Exploratory Data
CCS346 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Analysis
2. Recommender
CCS360 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Systems
3. Neural Networks and
CCS355 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Deep Learning
4. Text and
CCS369 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Speech Analysis
5. CCW331 Business Analytics PEC 2 0 2 4 3
6. Image and Video
CCS349 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Analytics
7. CCS338 Computer Vision PEC 2 0 2 4 3
8. CCS334 Big Data Analytics PEC 2 0 2 4 3

VERTICAL 2: CLOUD COMPUTING AND DATA CENTER TECHNOLOGIES

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. CCS335 Cloud Computing PEC 2 0 2 4 3
2. CCS372 Virtualization PEC 2 0 2 4 3
3. Cloud Services
CCS336 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Management
4. CCS341 Data Warehousing PEC 2 0 2 4 3
5. CCS367 Storage Technologies PEC 3 0 0 3 3
6. Software Defined
CCS365 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Networks
7. CCS368 Stream Processing PEC 2 0 2 4 3
8. Security and Privacy in
CCS362 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Cloud

2
VERTICAL 3: EMERGING TECHNOLOGIES

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. Augmented
CCS333 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Reality/Virtual Reality
2. Robotic Process
CCS361 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Automation
3. Neural Networks and
CCS355 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Deep Learning
4. CCS340 Cyber Security PEC 2 0 2 4 3
5. CCS359 Quantum Computing PEC 2 0 2 4 3
6. Cryptocurrency and
CCS339 Blockchain PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Technologies
7. CCS347 Game Development PEC 2 0 2 4 3
8. CCS331 3D Printing and Design PEC 2 0 2 4 3

VERTICAL 4: ARTIFICIAL INTELLIGENCE AND MACHINE LEARNING

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. CCS350 Knowledge Engineering PEC 2 0 2 4 3
2. CCS364 Soft Computing PEC 2 0 2 4 3
3. Neural Networks and
CCS355 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Deep Learning
4. Text and
CCS369 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Speech Analysis
5. CCS357 Optimization Techniques PEC 2 0 2 4 3
6. CCS348 Game Theory PEC 2 0 2 4 3
7. CCS337 Cognitive Science PEC 2 0 2 4 3
8. CCS345 Ethics and AI PEC 2 0 2 4 3

3
VERTICAL 5: MANAGEMENT

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. Customer Relation
CW3003 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management
2. Human Resource
CMG341 Management for PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Entrepreneurs
3. CCD332 Financial Management PEC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Supply Chain
CCD334 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management
5. CW3007 IT Project Management PEC 3 0 0 3 3
6. Entrepreneurship
CW3005 PEC 2 0 2 4 3
Development
7. Introduction to
Innovation, IP
CW3006 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management and
Entrepreneurship
8.
CW3001 Behavioral Economics PEC 3 0 0 3 3

VERTICAL 6: MARKETING

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. CMG354 Financial Analytics PEC 3 0 0 3 3
2. CCS360 Recommender Systems PEC 2 0 2 4 3
3. CCW332 Digital Marketing PEC 2 0 2 4 3
4. CW3002 Conversational Systems PEC 3 0 0 3 3
5. Social Text and Media
CW3009 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Analytics
6. Marketing Research and
CCB331 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Marketing Management
7. CW3008 Risk Analytics PEC 3 0 0 3 3
8. CW3004 Enterprise Security PEC 3 0 0 3 3

4
OPEN ELECTIVES
(Students shall choose the open elective courses, such that the course contents are not
similar to any other course contents/title under other course categories).

OPEN ELECTIVES – I

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. ODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. OAS351 Space Science OEC 3 0 0 3 3
2. Introduction to Industrial
OIE351 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
3. OBT351 Food, Nutrition and Health OEC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Environment and Social
OCE351 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Impact Assessment
5. OEE351 Renewable Energy System OEC 3 0 0 3 3
6. Introduction to Industrial
OEI351 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Instrumentation and Control
7. OMA351 Graph Theory OEC 3 0 0 3 3

OPEN ELECTIVES – II

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. Resource Management
OIE352 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Techniques
2. OMG351 Fintech Regulation OEC 3 0 0 3 3
3. OFD351 Holistic Nutrition OEC 3 0 0 3 3
4. AI3021 IT in Agricultural System OEC 3 0 0 3 3
5. Introduction to Control
OEI352 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
6. Pharmaceutical
OPY351 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Nanotechnology
7. OAE351 Aviation Management OEC 3 0 0 3 3

OPEN ELECTIVES – III

COURSE PERIODS TOTAL


SL. CATE
CODE COURSE TITLE PER WEEK CONTACT CREDITS
NO. GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. English for Competitive
OHS351 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Examinations
2. NGOs and Sustainable
OMG352 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Development
3. OMG353 Democracy and Good OEC 3 0 0 3 3

5
Governance
4. Renewable Energy
CME365 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Technologies
5. OME354 Applied Design Thinking OEC 3 0 0 3 3
6. MF3003 Reverse Engineering OEC 3 0 0 3 3
7. OPR351 Sustainable Manufacturing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
8. AU3791 Electric and Hybrid Vehicles OEC 3 0 0 3 3
9. OAS352 Space Engineering OEC 3 0 0 3 3
10. OIM351 Industrial Management OEC 3 0 0 3 3
11. OIE354 Quality Engineering OEC 3 0 0 3 3
12. OSF351 Fire Safety Engineering OEC 3 0 0 3 3
13. Introduction to Non-destructive
OML351 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Testing
14. OMR351 Mechatronics OEC 3 0 0 3 3
15. ORA351 Foundation of Robotics OEC 3 0 0 3 3
16. Fundamentals of Aeronautical
OAE352 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
17. OGI351 Remote Sensing Concepts OEC 3 0 0 3 3
18. OAI351 Urban Agriculture OEC 3 0 0 3 3
19. Drinking Water Supply and
OEN351 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Treatment
20. OEE352 Electric Vehicle Technology OEC 3 0 0 3 3
21. Introduction to PLC
OEI353 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Programming
22. OCH351 Nano Technology OEC 3 0 0 3 3
23. OCH352 Functional Materials OEC 3 0 0 3 3
24. OFD352 Traditional Indian Foods OEC 3 0 0 3 3
25. OFD353 Introduction to food processing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
26. OPY352 IPR for Pharma Industry OEC 3 0 0 3 3
27. OTT351 Basics of Textile Finishing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
28. Industrial Engineering for
OTT352 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Garment Industry
29. OTT353 Basics of Textile Manufacture OEC 3 0 0 3 3
30. Introduction to Petroleum
OPE351 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Refining and Petrochemicals
31. Energy Conservation and
CPE334 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management
32. OPT351 Basics of Plastics Processing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
33. OEC351 Signals and Systems OEC 3 0 0 3 3
34. Fundamentals of Electronic
OEC352 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Devices and Circuits
35. Foundation Skills in Integrated
CBM348 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Product Development
6
36. CBM333 Assistive Technology OEC 3 0 0 3 3
37. OMA352 Operations Research OEC 3 0 0 3 3
38. OMA353 Algebra and Number Theory OEC 3 0 0 3 3
39. OMA354 Linear Algebra OEC 3 0 0 3 3
40. Lean Concepts, Tools and
OCE353 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Practices
41. Basics of Microbial
OBT352 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Technology
42. OBT353 Basics of Biomolecules OEC 3 0 0 3 3
43. Fundamentals of Cell and
OBT354 OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Molecular Biology

OPEN ELECTIVES – IV

COURSE PERIODS TOTAL


SL. CATE
CODE COURSE TITLE PER WEEK CONTACT CREDITS
NO. GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. OHS352 Project Report Writing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
2. Advanced Numerical OEC
OMA355 3 0 0 3 3
Methods
3. OMA356 Random Processes OEC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Queuing and Reliability OEC
OMA357 3 0 0 3 3
Modelling
5. Production and Operations OEC
OMG354 Management for 3 0 0 3 3
Entrepreneurs
6. OMG355 Multivariate Data Analysis OEC 3 0 0 3 3
7. OME352 Additive Manufacturing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
8. CME343 New Product Development OEC 3 0 0 3 3
9. Industrial Design & Rapid OEC
OME355 3 0 0 3 3
Prototyping Techniques
10. Micro and Precision OEC
MF3010 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
11. Cost Management of OEC
OMF354 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering Projects
12. Batteries and Management OEC
AU3002 3 0 0 3 3
system
13. AU3008 Sensors and Actuators OEC 3 0 0 3 3
14. OAS353 Space Vehicles OEC 3 0 0 3 3
15. OIM352 Management Science OEC 3 0 0 3 3
16. Production Planning and OEC
OIM353 3 0 0 3 3
Control
17. OIE353 Operations Management OEC 3 0 0 3 3

7
18. OSF352 Industrial Hygiene OEC 3 0 0 3 3
19. OSF353 Chemical Process Safety OEC 3 0 0 3 3
20. Electrical, Electronic and OEC
OML352 3 0 0 3 3
Magnetic materials
21. Nanomaterials and OEC
OML353 3 0 0 3 3
Applications
22. OMR352 Hydraulics and Pneumatics OEC 3 0 0 3 3
23. OMR353 Sensors OEC 3 0 0 3 3
24. ORA352 Concepts in Mobile Robots OEC 3 0 0 3 3
25. MV3501 Marine Propulsion OEC 3 0 0 3 3
26. OMV351 Marine Merchant Vessels OEC 3 0 0 3 3
27. Elements of Marine OEC
OMV352 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
28. CRA332 Drone Technologies OEC 3 0 0 3 3
29. Geographical Information OEC
OGI352 3 0 0 3 3
System
30. Agriculture Entrepreneurship OEC
OAI352 3 0 0 3 3
Development
31. OEN352 Biodiversity Conservation OEC 3 0 0 3 3
32. Introduction to control OEC
OEE353 3 0 0 3 3
systems
33. Introduction to Industrial OEC
OEI354 3 0 0 3 3
Automation Systems
34. OCH353 Energy Technology OEC 3 0 0 3 3
35. OCH354 Surface Science OEC 3 0 0 3 3
36. Fundamentals of Food OEC
OFD354 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
37. Food safety and Quality OEC
OFD355 3 0 0 3 3
Regulations
38. OPY353 Nutraceuticals OEC 3 0 0 3 3
39. OTT354 Basics of Dyeing and Printing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
40. FT3201 Fibre Science OEC 3 0 0 3 3
41. Garment Manufacturing OEC
OTT355 3 0 0 3 3
Technology
42. OPE353 Industrial safety OEC 3 0 0 3 3
43. Unit Operations in Petro OEC
OPE354 3 0 0 3 3
Chemical Industries
44. Plastic Materials for OEC
OPT352 3 0 0 3 3
Engineers
45. Properties and Testing of OEC
OPT353 3 0 0 3 3
Plastics
46. OEC353 VLSI Design OEC 3 0 0 3 3
47. CBM370 Wearable Devices OEC 3 0 0 3 3

8
48. CBM356 Medical Informatics OEC 3 0 0 3 3
49. Basics of Integrated Water OEC
OCE354 3 0 0 3 3
Resources Management
50. Biotechnology for Waste OEC
OBT355 3 0 0 3 3
Management
51. OBT356 Lifestyle Diseases OEC 3 0 0 3 3
52. OBT357 Biotechnology in Health Care OEC 3 0 0 3 3

9
SUMMARY

Name of the Programme: B.Tech. Computer Science and Business Systems

Subject Area Credits per Semester Total


S.No
Credits
I II III IV V VI VII/VIII VIII/VII
1 HSMC 4 3 5 12
2 BSC 12 7 4 6 29
3 ESC 5 9 4 18
4 PCC 5 16 18 10 9 58
5 PEC 6 12 18
6 OEC 3 9 12
7 EEC 1 2 1 2 10 16

Non-Credit
8 √ √
/(Mandatory)

Total 22 26 25 24 18 24 14 10 163

ENROLLMENT FOR B.E. / B. TECH. (HONOURS) / MINOR DEGREE (OPTIONAL)

A student can also optionally register for additional courses (18 credits) and become eligible for the
award of B.E. / B. Tech. (Honours) or Minor Degree.
For B.E. / B. Tech. (Honours), a student shall register for the additional courses (18 credits) from
semester V onwards. These courses shall be from the same vertical or a combination of different
verticals of the same programme of study only.
For minor degree, a student shall register for the additional courses (18 credits) from semester V
onwards. All these courses have to be in a particular vertical from any one of the other programmes,
Moreover, for minor degree the student can register for courses from any one of the following verticals
also.
Complete details are available in clause 4.10 (Amendments) of Regulations 2021.

10
VERTICALS FOR MINOR DEGREE
(In addition to all the verticals of other programmes)

Vertical IV
Vertical I Vertical III Vertical V
Vertical II Business Data
Fintech and Public Environment and
Entrepreneurship Analytics
Block Chain Administration Sustainability
Financial Foundations of Principles of Public Statistics for Sustainable
Management Entrepreneurship Administration Management Infrastructure
Development
Fundamentals of Team Building & Constitution of India Datamining for Sustainable
Investment Leadership Management Business Agriculture and
for Business Intelligence Environmental
Management
Banking, Creativity & Innovation Public Personnel Human Resource Sustainable Bio
Financial in Entrepreneurship Administration Analytics Materials
Services and
Insurance
Introduction to Principles of Marketing Administrative Marketing and Materials for Energy
Blockchain and Management For Theories Social Media Sustainability
its Applications Business Web Analytics
Fintech Personal Human Resource Indian Operation and Green Technology
Finance and Management for Administrative Supply Chain
Payments Entrepreneurs System Analytics

Introduction to Financing New Public Policy Financial Environmental


Fintech Business Ventures Administration Analytics Quality Monitoring
and Analysis
Integrated Energy
Planning for
- - - -
Sustainable
Development
Energy Efficiency for
- - - - Sustainable
Development

11
(choice of courses for Minor degree is to be made from any one vertical of other
programmes or from anyone of the following verticals)
VERTICAL 1: FINTECH AND BLOCK CHAIN
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. CMG331 Financial Management PEC 3 0 0 3 3
2. Fundamentals of
CMG332 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Investment
3. Banking, Financial Services
CMG333 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
and Insurance
4. Introduction to Blockchain
CMG334 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
and its Applications
5. Fintech Personal Finance
CMG335 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
and Payments
6. CMG336 Introduction to Fintech PEC 3 0 0 3 3

VERTICAL 2: ENTREPRENEURSHIP
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. Foundations of
CMG337 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Entrepreneurship
2. Team Building &
CMG338 Leadership Management PEC 3 0 0 3 3
for Business
3. Creativity & Innovation in
CMG339 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Entrepreneurship
4. Principles of Marketing
CMG340 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management for Business
5. Human Resource
CMG341 Management for PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Entrepreneurs
6. Financing New Business
CMG342 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Ventures

VERTICAL 3: PUBLIC ADMINISTRATION


PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. Principles of Public
CMG343 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Administration
2. CMG344 Constitution of India PEC 3 0 0 3 3
3. Public Personnel
CMG345 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Administration
4. CMG346 Administrative Theories PEC 3 0 0 3 3
5. Indian Administrative
CMG347 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
System
6. CMG348 Public Policy Administration PEC 3 0 0 3 3

12
VERTICAL 4: BUSINESS DATA ANALYTICS

PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. Statistics for
CMG349 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management
2. Datamining for Business
CMG350 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Intelligence
3. Human Resource
CMG351 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Analytics
4. Marketing and Social
CMG352 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Media Web Analytics
5. Operation and Supply
CMG353 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Chain Analytics
6. CMG354 Financial Analytics PEC 3 0 0 3 3

VERTICAL 5: ENVIRONMENT AND SUSTAINABILITY


PERIODS
PER TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE
COURSE TITLE WEEK CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
PERIODS
L T P
1. Sustainable Infrastructure
CES331 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Development
2. Sustainable Agriculture
CES332 and Environmental PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management
3. Sustainable Bio Materials
CES333 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Materials for Energy
CES334 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Sustainability
5. Green Technology
CES335 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
6. Environmental Quality
CES336 PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Monitoring and Analysis
7. Integrated Energy
CES337 Planning for Sustainable PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Development
8. Energy Efficiency for
CES338 Sustainable PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Development

13
IP3151 INDUCTION PROGRAMME

This is a mandatory 2 week programme to be conducted as soon as the students enter the
institution. Normal classes start only after the induction program is over.

The induction programme has been introduced by AICTE with the following objective:

“Engineering colleges were established to train graduates well in the branch/department of


admission, have a holistic outlook, and have a desire to work for national needs and beyond. The
graduating student must have knowledge and skills in the area of his/her study. However, he/she
must also have a broad understanding of society and relationships. Character needs to be
nurtured as an essential quality by which he/she would understand and fulfill his/her responsibility
as an engineer, a citizen and a human being. Besides the above, several meta-skills and
underlying values are needed.”

“One will have to work closely with the newly joined students in making them feel comfortable,
allow them to explore their academic interests and activities, reduce competition and make them
work for excellence, promote bonding within them, build relations between teachers and students,
give a broader view of life, and build character. “

Hence, the purpose of this programme is to make the students feel comfortable in their new
environment, open them up, set a healthy daily routine, create bonding in the batch as well as
between faculty and students, develop awareness, sensitivity and understanding of the self,
people around them, society at large, and nature.

The following are the activities under the induction program in which the student would be fully
engaged throughout the day for the entire duration of the program.

(i) Physical Activity

This would involve a daily routine of physical activity with games and sports, yoga, gardening, etc.

(ii) Creative Arts

Every student would choose one skill related to the arts whether visual arts or performing arts.
Examples are painting, sculpture, pottery, music, dance etc. The student would pursue it everyday
for the duration of the program. These would allow for creative expression. It would develop a
sense of aesthetics and
also enhance creativity which would, hopefully, grow into engineering design later.

(iii) Universal Human Values

This is the anchoring activity of the Induction Programme. It gets the student to explore oneself
and allows one to experience the joy of learning, stand up to peer pressure, make decisions with
courage, be aware of relationships with colleagues and supporting stay in the hostel and
department, be sensitive to others, etc. A module in Universal Human Values provides the base.
Methodology of teaching this content is extremely important. It must not be through do's and
don'ts, but get students to explore and think by engaging them in a dialogue. It is best taught
through group discussions and real life activities rather than lecturing.
Discussions would be conducted in small groups of about 20 students with a faculty
14
mentor each. It would be effective that the faculty mentor assigned is also the faculty advisor for
the student for the full duration of the UG programme.
(iv) Literary Activity

Literary activity would encompass reading, writing and possibly, debating, enacting a play etc.

(v) Proficiency Modules

This would address some lacunas that students might have, for example, English, computer
familiarity etc.

(vi) Lectures by Eminent People

Motivational lectures by eminent people from all walks of life should be arranged to give the
students exposure to people who are socially active or in public life.

(vii) Visits to Local Area

A couple of visits to the landmarks of the city, or a hospital or orphanage could be organized. This
would familiarize them with the area as well as expose them to the underprivileged.

(viii) Familiarization to Dept./Branch & Innovations

They should be told about what getting into a branch or department means what role it plays in
society, through its technology. They should also be shown the laboratories, workshops & other
facilities.

(ix) Department Specific Activities

About a week can be spent in introducing activities (games, quizzes, social interactions, small
experiments, design thinking etc.) that are relevant to the particular branch of Engineering /
Technology / Architecture that can serve as a motivation and kindle interest in building things
(become a maker) in that particular field. This can be conducted in the form of a workshop. For
example, CSE and IT students may be introduced to activities that kindle computational thinking,
and get them to build simple games. ECE students may be introduced to building simple circuits
as an extension of their knowledge in Science, and so on. Students may be asked to build stuff
using their knowledge of science.

Induction Programme is totally an activity based programme and therefore there shall be
no tests / assessments during this programme.

References:
Guide to Induction program from AICTE

15
HS3152 PROFESSIONAL ENGLISH I L T PC
3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES :
 To improve the communicative competence of learners
 To learn to use basic grammatic structures in suitable contexts
 To acquire lexical competence and use them appropriately in a sentence and understand
their meaning in a text
 To help learners use language effectively in professional contexts
 To develop learners’ ability to read and write complex texts, summaries, articles, blogs,
definitions, essays and user manuals.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO EFFECTIVE COMMUNICATION 1


What is effective communication? (Explain using activities) Why is communication critical for
excellence during study, research and work? What are the seven C’s of effective communication?
What are key language skills? What is effective listening? What does it involve? What is effective
speaking? What does it mean to be an excellent reader? What should you be able to do? What is
effective writing? How does one develop language and communication skills? What does the
course focus on? How are communication and language skills going to be enhanced during this
course? What do you as a learner need to do to enhance your English language and
communication skills to get the best out of this course?

INTRODUCTION TO FUNDAMENTALS OF COMMUNICATION 8

Reading - Reading brochures (technical context), telephone messages / social media messages
relevant to technical contexts and emails. Writing - Writing emails / letters introducing oneself.
Grammar - Present Tense ( simple and progressive); Question types: Wh/ Yes or No/ and Tags.
Vocabulary - Synonyms; One word substitution; Abbreviations & Acronyms (as used in technical
contexts).

UNIT II NARRATION AND SUMMATION 9


Reading - Reading biographies, travelogues, newspaper reports, Excerpts from literature, and
travel & technical blogs. Writing - Guided writing-- Paragraph writing Short Report on an event
(field trip etc.) Grammar –Past tense (simple); Subject-Verb Agreement; and Prepositions.
Vocabulary - Word forms (prefixes& suffixes); Synonyms and Antonyms. Phrasal verbs.

UNIT III DESCRIPTION OF A PROCESS / PRODUCT 9


Reading – Reading advertisements, gadget reviews; user manuals. Writing - Writing definitions;
instructions; and Product /Process description. Grammar - Imperatives; Adjectives; Degrees of
comparison; Present & Past Perfect Tenses. Vocabulary - Compound Nouns, Homonyms; and
Homophones, discourse markers (connectives & sequence words).

UNIT IV CLASSIFICATION AND RECOMMENDATIONS 9


Reading – Newspaper articles; Journal reports –and Non Verbal Communcation ( tables, pie
charts etc,. ). Writing – Note-making / Note-taking (*Study skills to be taught, not tested); Writing
recommendations; Transferring information from non verbal ( chart , graph etc, to verbal mode)
Grammar – Articles; Pronouns - Possessive & Relative pronouns. Vocabulary - Collocations; Fixed
/ Semi fixed expressions.

16
UNIT V EXPRESSION 9
Reading – Reading editorials; and Opinion Blogs; Writing – Essay Writing (Descriptive or
narrative). Grammar – Future Tenses, Punctuation; Negation (Statements & Questions); and
Simple, Compound & Complex Sentences. Vocabulary - Cause & Effect Expressions – Content vs
Function words.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES :
At the end of the course, learners will be able
CO1:To use appropriate words in a professional context
CO2:To gain understanding of basic grammatic structures and use them in right context.
CO3:To read and infer the denotative and connotative meanings of technical texts
CO4:To write definitions, descriptions, narrations and essays on various topics

TEXT BOOKS :
1. English for Engineers & Technologists Orient Blackswan Private Ltd. Department of
English, Anna University, (2020 edition)
2. English for Science & Technology Cambridge University Press, 2021.
Authored by Dr. Veena Selvam, Dr. Sujatha Priyadarshini, Dr. Deepa Mary Francis, Dr.
KN. Shoba, and Dr. Lourdes Joevani, Department of English, Anna University.

REFERENCES:

1. Technical Communication – Principles And Practices By Meenakshi Raman & Sangeeta


Sharma, Oxford Univ. Press, 2016, New Delhi.
2. A Course Book On Technical English By Lakshminarayanan, Scitech Publications (India) Pvt.
Ltd.
3. English For Technical Communication (With CD) By Aysha Viswamohan, Mcgraw Hill
Education, ISBN : 0070264244.
4. Effective Communication Skill, Kulbhusan Kumar, RS Salaria, Khanna Publishing House.
5. Learning to Communicate – Dr. V. Chellammal, Allied Publishing House, New Delhi,2003.

ASSESSMENT PATTERN
Two internal assessments and an end semester examination to test students’ reading and writing
skills along with their grammatical and lexical competence.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 1 1 1 1 1 3 3 3 1 3 - 3 - - -
2 1 1 1 1 1 3 3 3 1 3 - 3 - - -
3 2 3 2 3 2 3 3 3 2 3 3 3 - - -
4 2 3 2 3 2 3 3 3 2 3 3 3 - - -
5 2 3 3 3 - 3 3 3 2 3 - 3 - - -
AVg. 1.6 2.2 1.8 2.2 1.5 3 3 3 1.6 3 3 3 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

17
MA3151 MATRICES AND CALCULUS L T P C
3 1 0 4
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To develop the use of matrix algebra techniques that are needed by engineers for practical
applications.
 To familiarize the students with differential calculus.
 To familiarize the student with functions of several variables. This is needed in many
branches of engineering.
 To make the students understand various techniques of integration.
 To acquaint the student with mathematical tools needed in evaluating multiple integrals and
their applications.

UNIT I MATRICES 9+3


Eigenvalues and Eigenvectors of a real matrix – Characteristic equation – Properties of
Eigenvalues and Eigenvectors – Cayley - Hamilton theorem – Diagonalization of matrices by
orthogonal transformation – Reduction of a quadratic form to canonical form by orthogonal
transformation – Nature of quadratic forms – Applications : Stretching of an elastic membrane.

UNIT II DIFFERENTIAL CALCULUS 9+3


Representation of functions - Limit of a function - Continuity - Derivatives - Differentiation rules
(sum, product, quotient, chain rules) - Implicit differentiation - Logarithmic differentiation -
Applications : Maxima and Minima of functions of one variable.

UNIT III FUNCTIONS OF SEVERAL VARIABLES 9+3


Partial differentiation – Homogeneous functions and Euler’s theorem – Total derivative – Change
of variables – Jacobians – Partial differentiation of implicit functions – Taylor’s series for functions
of two variables – Applications : Maxima and minima of functions of two variables and
Lagrange’s method of undetermined multipliers.

UNIT IV INTEGRAL CALCULUS 9+3


Definite and Indefinite integrals - Substitution rule - Techniques of Integration : Integration by parts,
Trigonometric integrals, Trigonometric substitutions, Integration of rational functions by partial
fraction, Integration of irrational functions - Improper integrals - Applications : Hydrostatic force
and pressure, moments and centres of mass.

UNIT V MULTIPLE INTEGRALS 9+3


Double integrals – Change of order of integration – Double integrals in polar coordinates – Area
enclosed by plane curves – Triple integrals – Volume of solids – Change of variables in double
and triple integrals – Applications : Moments and centres of mass, moment of inertia.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course the students will be able to
CO1:Use the matrix algebra methods for solving practical problems.
CO2:Apply differential calculus tools in solving various application problems.
CO3:Able to use differential calculus ideas on several variable functions.
CO4:Apply different methods of integration in solving practical problems.
CO5:Apply multiple integral ideas in solving areas, volumes and other practical problems.

18
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Kreyszig.E, "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", John Wiley and Sons,
10th Edition, New Delhi, 2016.
2. Grewal.B.S., “Higher Engineering Mathematics”, Khanna Publishers, New Delhi,
44th Edition , 2018.
3. James Stewart, " Calculus : Early Transcendentals ", Cengage Learning, 8th Edition, New
Delhi, 2015. [For Units II & IV - Sections 1.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.5, 2.7 (Tangents problems only),
2.8, 3.1 to 3.6, 3.11, 4.1, 4.3, 5.1 (Area problems only), 5.2, 5.3, 5.4 (excluding net
change theorem), 5.5, 7.1 - 7.4 and 7.8 ].

REFERENCES:
1. Anton. H, Bivens. I and Davis. S, "Calculus", Wiley, 10th Edition, 2016
2. Bali. N., Goyal. M. and Watkins. C., “Advanced Engineering Mathematics”, Firewall
Media (An imprint of Lakshmi Publications Pvt., Ltd.,), New Delhi, 7th Edition, 2009.
3. Jain. R.K. and Iyengar. S.R.K., “Advanced Engineering Mathematics”, Narosa
Publications, New Delhi, 5th Edition, 2016.
4. Narayanan. S. and Manicavachagom Pillai. T. K., “Calculus" Volume I and II,
S. Viswanathan Publishers Pvt. Ltd., Chennai, 2009.
5. Ramana. B.V., "Higher Engineering Mathematics", McGraw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd,
New Delhi, 2016.
6. Srimantha Pal and Bhunia. S.C, "Engineering Mathematics" Oxford University Press, 2015.
7. Thomas. G. B., Hass. J, and Weir. M.D, " Thomas Calculus ", 14th Edition, Pearson India,
2018.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
CO1 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO2 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO3 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO5 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
Avg 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

PH3151 ENGINEERING PHYSICS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To make the students effectively achieve an understanding of mechanics.
 To enable the students to gain knowledge of electromagnetic waves and its applications.
 To introduce the basics of oscillations, optics and lasers.
 Equipping the students to successfully understand the importance of quantum physics.
 To motivate the students towards the applications of quantum mechanics.

UNIT I MECHANICS 9
Multi-particle dynamics: Center of mass (CM) – CM of continuous bodies – motion of the CM –
kinetic energy of the system of particles. Rotation of rigid bodies: Rotational kinematics – rotational
kinetic energy and moment of inertia - theorems of M .I –moment of inertia of continuous bodies –
19
M.I of a diatomic molecule - torque – rotational dynamics of rigid bodies – conservation of angular
momentum – rotational energy state of a rigid diatomic molecule - gyroscope - torsional pendulum
– double pendulum –Introduction to nonlinear oscillations.

UNIT II ELECTROMAGNETIC WAVES 9


The Maxwell’s equations - wave equation; Plane electromagnetic waves in vacuum, Conditions on
the wave field - properties of electromagnetic waves: speed, amplitude, phase, orientation and
waves in matter - polarization - Producing electromagnetic waves - Energy and momentum in EM
waves: Intensity, waves from localized sources, momentum and radiation pressure - Cell-phone
reception. Reflection and transmission of electromagnetic waves from a non-conducting medium-
vacuum interface for normal incidence.

UNIT III OSCILLATIONS, OPTICS AND LASERS 9


Simple harmonic motion - resonance –analogy between electrical and mechanical oscillating
systems - waves on a string - standing waves - traveling waves - Energy transfer of a wave -
sound waves - Doppler effect. Reflection and refraction of light waves - total internal reflection -
interference –Michelson interferometer –Theory of air wedge and experiment.
Theory of laser -
characteristics - Spontaneous and stimulated emission - Einstein’s coefficients - population
inversion - Nd-YAG laser, CO2 laser, semiconductor laser –Basic applications of lasers in industry.

UNIT IV BASIC QUANTUM MECHANICS 9


Photons and light waves - Electrons and matter waves –Compton effect - The Schrodinger
equation (Time dependent and time independent forms) - meaning of wave function -
Normalization –Free particle - particle in a infinite potential well: 1D,2D and 3D Boxes-
Normalization, probabilities and the correspondence principle.

UNIT V APPLIED QUANTUM MECHANICS 9


The harmonic oscillator(qualitative)- Barrier penetration and quantum tunneling(qualitative)-
Tunneling microscope - Resonant diode - Finite potential wells (qualitative)- Bloch’s theorem for
particles in a periodic potential –Basics of Kronig-Penney model and origin of energy bands.

TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completion of this course, the students should be able to
CO1:Understand the importance of mechanics.
CO2:Express their knowledge in electromagnetic waves.
CO3:Demonstrate a strong foundational knowledge in oscillations, optics and lasers.
CO4:Understand the importance of quantum physics.
CO5:Comprehend and apply quantum mechanical principles towards the formation of energy
bands.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. D.Kleppner and R.Kolenkow. An Introduction to Mechanics. McGraw Hill Education (Indian
Edition), 2017.
2. E.M.Purcell and D.J.Morin, Electricity and Magnetism, Cambridge Univ.Press, 2013.
3. Arthur Beiser, Shobhit Mahajan, S. Rai Choudhury, Concepts of Modern Physics, McGraw-
Hill (Indian Edition), 2017.

20
REFERENCES:
1. R.Wolfson. Essential University Physics. Volume 1 & 2. Pearson Education (Indian
Edition), 2009.
2. Paul A. Tipler, Physic – Volume 1 & 2, CBS, (Indian Edition), 2004.
3. K.Thyagarajan and A.Ghatak. Lasers: Fundamentals and Applications, Laxmi Publications,
(Indian Edition), 2019.
4. D.Halliday, R.Resnick and J.Walker. Principles of Physics, Wiley (Indian Edition), 2015.
5. N.Garcia, A.Damask and S.Schwarz. Physics for Computer Science Students. Springer-
Verlag, 2012.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3
1 3 2 1 1 1 - - - - - - - - -
2 3 3 2 1 2 1 - - - - - - - - -
3 3 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - 1 - - -
4 3 3 1 1 2 1 - - - - - - - -
5 3 3 1 1 2 1 - - - - - - - - -
AV 3 3 1.6 1.2 1.8 1 - - - - - 1 - - -
G 1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CY3151 ENGINEERING CHEMISTRY LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To inculcate sound understanding of water quality parameters and water treatment
techniques.
 To impart knowledge on the basic principles and preparatory methods of nanomaterials.
 To introduce the basic concepts and applications of phase rule and composites.
 To facilitate the understanding of different types of fuels, their preparation, properties and
combustion characteristics.
 To familiarize the students with the operating principles, working processes and
applications of energy conversion and storage devices.

UNIT I WATER AND ITS TREATMENT 9


Water: Sources and impurities, Water quality parameters: Definition and significance of-color,
odour, turbidity, pH, hardness, alkalinity, TDS, COD and BOD, fluoride and arsenic. Municipal
water treatment: primary treatment and disinfection (UV, Ozonation, break-point chlorination).
Desalination of brackish water: Reverse Osmosis. Boiler troubles: Scale and sludge, Boiler
corrosion, Caustic embrittlement, Priming & foaming. Treatment of boiler feed water: Internal
treatment (phosphate, colloidal, sodium aluminate and calgon conditioning) and External treatment
– Ion exchange demineralization and zeolite process.

UNIT II NANOCHEMISTRY 9
Basics: Distinction between molecules, nanomaterials and bulk materials; Size-dependent
properties (optical, electrical, mechanical and magnetic); Types of nanomaterials: Definition,
properties and uses of – nanoparticle, nanocluster, nanorod, nanowire and nanotube. Preparation
of nanomaterials: sol-gel, solvothermal, laser ablation, chemical vapour deposition,
electrochemical deposition and electro spinning. Applications of nanomaterials in medicine,
21
agriculture, energy, electronics and catalysis.
UNIT III PHASE RULE AND COMPOSITES 9
Phase rule: Introduction, definition of terms with examples. One component system - water
system; Reduced phase rule; Construction of a simple eutectic phase diagram - Thermal analysis;
Two component system: lead-silver system - Pattinson process.
Composites: Introduction: Definition & Need for composites; Constitution: Matrix materials
(Polymer matrix, metal matrix and ceramic matrix) and Reinforcement (fiber, particulates, flakes
and whiskers). Properties and applications of: Metal matrix composites (MMC), Ceramic matrix
composites and Polymer matrix composites. Hybrid composites - definition and examples.

UNIT IV FUELS AND COMBUSTION 9


Fuels: Introduction: Classification of fuels; Coal and coke: Analysis of coal (proximate and
ultimate), Carbonization, Manufacture of metallurgical coke (Otto Hoffmann method). Petroleum
and Diesel: Manufacture of synthetic petrol (Bergius process), Knocking - octane number, diesel
oil - cetane number; Power alcohol and biodiesel.
Combustion of fuels: Introduction: Calorific value - higher and lower calorific values, Theoretical
calculation of calorific value; Ignition temperature: spontaneous ignition temperature, Explosive
range; Flue gas analysis - ORSAT Method. CO2 emission and carbon footprint.

UNIT V ENERGY SOURCES AND STORAGE DEVICES 9


Stability of nucleus: mass defect (problems), binding energy; Nuclear energy: light water nuclear
power plant, breeder reactor. Solar energy conversion: Principle, working and applications of solar
cells; Recent developments in solar cell materials. Wind energy; Geothermal energy; Batteries:
Types of batteries, Primary battery - dry cell, Secondary battery - lead acid battery and lithium-ion-
battery; Electric vehicles - working principles; Fuel cells: H2-O2 fuel cell, microbial fuel cell;
Supercapacitors: Storage principle, types and examples.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, the students will be able:
CO1:To infer the quality of water from quality parameter data and propose suitable treatment
methodologies to treat water.
CO2:To identify and apply basic concepts of nanoscience and nanotechnology in designing the
synthesis of nanomaterials for engineering and technology applications.
CO3:To apply the knowledge of phase rule and composites for material selection requirements.
CO4:To recommend suitable fuels for engineering processes and applications.
CO5:To recognize different forms of energy resources and apply them for suitable applications in
energy sectors.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. P. C. Jain and Monica Jain, “Engineering Chemistry”, 17th Edition, Dhanpat Rai Publishing
Company (P) Ltd, New Delhi, 2018.
2. Sivasankar B., “Engineering Chemistry”, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Company Ltd, New
Delhi, 2008.
3. S.S. Dara, “A Text book of Engineering Chemistry”, S. Chand Publishing, 12th Edition,
2018

22
REFERENCES:
1. B. S. Murty, P. Shankar, Baldev Raj, B. B. Rath and James Murday, “Text book of
nanoscience and nanotechnology”, Universities Press-IIM Series in Metallurgy and
Materials Science, 2018.
2. O.G. Palanna, “Engineering Chemistry” McGraw Hill Education (India) Private Limited, 2nd
Edition, 2017.
3. Friedrich Emich, “Engineering Chemistry”, Scientific International PVT, LTD, New Delhi,
2014.
4. ShikhaAgarwal, “Engineering Chemistry-Fundamentals and Applications”, Cambridge
University Press, Delhi, Second Edition, 2019.
5. O.V. Roussak and H.D. Gesser, Applied Chemistry-A Text Book for Engineers and
Technologists, Springer Science Business Media, New York, 2nd Edition, 2013.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3 2 2 1 - 1 1 - - - - 1 - - -
2 2 - - 1 - 2 2 - - - - - - - -
3 3 1 - - - - - - - - - - - - -
4 3 1 1 - - 1 2 - - - - - - - -
5 3 1 2 1 - 2 2 - - - - 2 - - -
CO 2.8 1.3 1.6 1 - 1.5 1.8 - - - 1.5 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

GE3151 PROBLEM SOLVING AND PYTHON PROGRAMMING L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
● To understand the basics of algorithmic problem solving.
● To learn to solve problems using Python conditionals and loops.
● To define Python functions and use function calls to solve problems.
● To use Python data structures - lists, tuples, dictionaries to represent complex data.
● To do input/output with files in Python.

UNIT I COMPUTATIONAL THINKING AND PROBLEM SOLVING 9


Fundamentals of Computing – Identification of Computational Problems -Algorithms, building
blocks of algorithms (statements, state, control flow, functions), notation (pseudo
code, flow chart, programming language), algorithmic problem solving, simple strategies for
developing algorithms (iteration, recursion). Illustrative problems: find minimum in a list, insert a
card in a list of sorted cards, guess an integer number in a range, Towers of Hanoi.

UNIT II DATA TYPES, EXPRESSIONS, STATEMENTS 9


Python interpreter and interactive mode,debugging; values and types: int, float, boolean, string
, and list; variables, expressions, statements, tuple assignment, precedence of operators,
comments; Illustrative programs: exchange the values of two variables, circulate the values of n
variables, distance between two points.

23
UNIT III CONTROL FLOW, FUNCTIONS, STRINGS 9
Conditionals:Boolean values and operators, conditional (if), alternative (if-else),chained conditional
(if-elif-else);Iteration: state, while, for, break, continue, pass; Fruitful functions: return
values,parameters, local and global scope, function composition, recursion; Strings:
string slices,immutability, string functions and methods, string module; Lists as arrays.
Illustrative programs: square root, gcd, exponentiation, sum an array of numbers, linear search,
binary search.

UNIT IV LISTS, TUPLES, DICTIONARIES 9


Lists: list operations, list slices, list methods, list loop, mutability, aliasing, cloning lists, list
parameters; Tuples: tuple assignment, tuple as return value; Dictionaries: operations and
methods; advanced list processing - list comprehension; Illustrative programs: simple sorting,
histogram, Students marks statement, Retail bill preparation.

UNIT V FILES, MODULES, PACKAGES 9


Files and exceptions: text files, reading and writing files, format operator; command line
arguments, errors and exceptions, handling exceptions, modules, packages; Illustrative programs:
word count, copy file, Voter’s age validation, Marks range validation (0-100).
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, students will be able to
CO1: Develop algorithmic solutions to simple computational problems.
CO2: Develop and execute simple Python programs.
CO3: Write simple Python programs using conditionals and loops for solving problems.
CO4: Decompose a Python program into functions.
CO5: Represent compound data using Python lists, tuples, dictionaries etc.
CO6: Read and write data from/to files in Python programs.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Allen B. Downey, “Think Python: How to Think like a Computer Scientist”, 2nd Edition,
O’Reilly Publishers, 2016.
2. Karl Beecher, “Computational Thinking: A Beginner's Guide to Problem Solving and
Programming”, 1st Edition, BCS Learning & Development Limited, 2017.

REFERENCES:
1. Paul Deitel and Harvey Deitel, “Python for Programmers”, Pearson Education, 1st Edition,
2021.
2. G Venkatesh and Madhavan Mukund, “Computational Thinking: A Primer for Programmers
and Data Scientists”, 1st Edition, Notion Press, 2021.
3. John V Guttag, "Introduction to Computation and Programming Using Python: With
Applications to Computational Modeling and Understanding Data‘‘, Third Edition, MIT
Press , 2021
4. Eric Matthes, “Python Crash Course, A Hands - on Project Based Introduction to
Programming”, 2nd Edition, No Starch Press, 2019.
5. https://www.python.org/
6. Martin C. Brown, “Python: The Complete Reference”, 4th Edition, Mc-Graw Hill, 2018.

24
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 3 -
2 3 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 - -
3 3 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 - 3 - -
4 2 2 - 2 2 - - - - - 1 - 3 - -
5 1 2 - - 1 - - - - - 1 - 2 - -
6 2 2 - - 2 - - - - - 1 - 2 -
AVg. 2 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 3 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

GE3152 HERITAGE OF TAMILS L T PC


1 0 0 1

UNIT I LANGUAGE AND LITERATURE 3


Language Families in India - Dravidian Languages – Tamil as a Classical Language - Classical
Literature in Tamil – Secular Nature of Sangam Literature – Distributive Justice in Sangam
Literature - Management Principles in Thirukural - Tamil Epics and Impact of Buddhism & Jainism
in Tamil Land - Bakthi Literature Azhwars and Nayanmars - Forms of minor Poetry - Development
of Modern literature in Tamil - Contribution of Bharathiyar and Bharathidhasan.

UNIT II HERITAGE - ROCK ART PAINTINGS TO MODERN ART – SCULPTURE 3


Hero stone to modern sculpture - Bronze icons - Tribes and their handicrafts - Art of temple car
making - - Massive Terracotta sculptures, Village deities, Thiruvalluvar Statue at Kanyakumari,
Making of musical instruments - Mridhangam, Parai, Veenai, Yazh and Nadhaswaram - Role of
Temples in Social and Economic Life of Tamils.

UNIT III FOLK AND MARTIAL ARTS 3


Therukoothu, Karagattam, Villu Pattu, Kaniyan Koothu, Oyillattam, Leather puppetry, Silambattam,
Valari, Tiger dance - Sports and Games of Tamils.

UNIT IV THINAI CONCEPT OF TAMILS 3


Flora and Fauna of Tamils & Aham and Puram Concept from Tholkappiyam and Sangam
Literature - Aram Concept of Tamils - Education and Literacy during Sangam Age - Ancient Cities
and Ports of Sangam Age - Export and Import during Sangam Age - Overseas Conquest of
Cholas.

UNIT V CONTRIBUTION OF TAMILS TO INDIAN NATIONAL MOVEMENT AND INDIAN


CULTURE 3
Contribution of Tamils to Indian Freedom Struggle - The Cultural Influence of Tamils over the
other parts of India – Self-Respect Movement - Role of Siddha Medicine in Indigenous Systems
of Medicine – Inscriptions & Manuscripts – Print History of Tamil Books.

TOTAL : 15 PERIODS
TEXT-CUM-REFERENCE BOOKS
1. தமிழக வரலொறு – மக்களும் பண்பொடும் – கக.கக. பிள் ளள (தவளியீடு:

25
தமிழ் நொடு பொடநூல் மற் றும்
கல் வியியல் பணிகள் கழகம் ).
2. கணினித் தமிழ் – முளனவர் இல. சுந்தரம் . (விகடன் பிரசுரம் ).
3. கீழடி – ளவளக நதிக்களரயில் சங் ககொல நகர நொகரிகம் (ததொல் லியல்
துளற தவளியீடு)
4. தபொருளந – ஆற் றங் களர நொகரிகம் . (ததொல் லியல் துளற தவளியீடு)
5. Social Life of Tamils (Dr.K.K.Pillay) A joint publication of TNTB & ESC and RMRL – (in
print)
6. Social Life of the Tamils - The Classical Period (Dr.S.Singaravelu) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.
7. Historical Heritage of the Tamils (Dr.S.V.Subatamanian, Dr.K.D. Thirunavukkarasu)
(Published by: International Institute of Tamil Studies).
8. The Contributions of the Tamils to Indian Culture (Dr.M.Valarmathi) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.)
9. Keeladi - ‘Sangam City C ivilization on the banks of river Vaigai’ (Jointly Published by:
Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text Book and Educational Services
Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
10. Studies in the History of India with Special Reference to Tamil Nadu (Dr.K.K.Pillay)
(Published by: The Author)
11. Porunai Civilization (Jointly Published by: Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text
Book and Educational Services Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
12. Journey of Civilization Indus to Vaigai (R.Balakrishnan) (Published by: RMRL) – Reference
Book.

GE3152 தமிழர் மரபு LTPC


1 001
அலகு I மமொழி மற் றும் இலக்கியம் : 3
இந்திய தமொழிக் குடும் பங் கள் – திரொவிட தமொழிகள் – தமிழ் ஒரு தசம் தமொழி –
தமிழ் தசவ் விலக்கியங் கள் - சங் க இலக்கியத்தின் சமயச் சொர்பற் ற தன்ளம –
சங் க இலக்கியத்தில் பகிர்தல் அறம் – திருக்குறளில் கமலொண்ளமக் கருத்துக்கள்
– தமிழ் க் கொப் பியங் கள் , தமிழகத்தில் சமண தபௌத்த சமயங் களின் தொக்கம் -
பக்தி இலக்கியம் , ஆழ் வொர்கள் மற் றும் நொயன்மொர்கள் – சிற் றிலக்கியங் கள் –
தமிழில் நவீன இலக்கியத்தின் வளர்ச்சி – தமிழ் இலக்கிய வளர்ச்சியில்
பொரதியொர் மற் றும் பொரதிதொசன் ஆகிகயொரின் பங் களிப் பு.

அலகு II மரபு – பொறற ஓவியங் கள் முதல் நவீன ஓவியங் கள் வறர –
சிற் பக் கறல: 3
நடுகல் முதல் நவீன சிற் பங் கள் வளர – ஐம் தபொன் சிளலகள் – பழங் குடியினர்
மற் றும் அவர்கள் தயொரிக்கும் ளகவிளனப் தபொருட்கள் , தபொம் ளமகள் – கதர்
தசய் யும் களல – சுடுமண் சிற் பங் கள் – நொட்டுப் புறத் ததய் வங் கள் –
குமரிமுளனயில் திருவள் ளுவர் சிளல – இளசக் கருவிகள் – மிருதங் கம் , பளற,
வீளண, யொழ் , நொதஸ்வரம் – தமிழர்களின் சமூக தபொருளொதொர வொழ் வில்
ககொவில் களின் பங் கு.

26
அலகு III நொட்டுப் புறக் கறலகள் மற் றும் வீர விறளயொட்டுகள் : 3
ததருக்கூத்து, கரகொட்டம் , வில் லுப் பொட்டு, கணியொன் கூத்து, ஒயிலொட்டம் ,
கதொல் பொளவக் கூத்து, சிலம் பொட்டம் , வளரி, புலியொட்டம் , தமிழர்களின்
விளளயொட்டுகள் .

அலகு IV தமிழர்களின் திறைக் ககொட்பொடுகள் : 3


தமிழகத்தின் தொவரங் களும் , விலங் குகளும் – ததொல் கொப் பியம் மற் றும் சங் க
இலக்கியத்தில் அகம் மற் றும் புறக் ககொட்பொடுகள் – தமிழர்கள் கபொற் றிய
அறக்ககொட்பொடு – சங் ககொலத்தில் தமிழகத்தில் எழுத்தறிவும் , கல் வியும் –
சங் ககொல நகரங் களும் துளற முகங் களும் – சங் ககொலத்தில் ஏற் றுமதி மற் றும்
இறக்குமதி – கடல் கடந்த நொடுகளில் கசொழர்களின் தவற் றி.

அலகு V இந் திய கதசிய இயக்கம் மற் றும் இந் திய பை்பொட்டிற் குத்
தமிழர்களின் பங் களிப் பு: 3
இந்திய விடுதளலப்கபொரில் தமிழர்களின் பங் கு – இந்தியொவின் பிறப் பகுதிகளில்
தமிழ் ப் பண்பொட்டின் தொக்கம் – சுயமரியொளத இயக்கம் – இந்திய மருத்துவத்தில் ,
சித்த மருத்துவத்தின் பங் கு – கல் தவட்டுகள் , ளகதயழுத்துப் படிகள் - தமிழ் ப்
புத்தகங் களின் அச்சு வரலொறு.
TOTAL : 15 PERIODS
TEXT-CUM-REFERENCE BOOKS
1. தமிழக வரலொறு – மக்களும் பண்பொடும் – கக.கக. பிள் ளள (தவளியீடு:
தமிழ் நொடு பொடநூல் மற் றும்
கல் வியியல் பணிகள் கழகம் ).
2. கணினித் தமிழ் – முளனவர் இல. சுந்தரம் . (விகடன் பிரசுரம் ).
3. கீழடி – ளவளக நதிக்களரயில் சங் ககொல நகர நொகரிகம் (ததொல் லியல்
துளற தவளியீடு)
4. தபொருளந – ஆற் றங் களர நொகரிகம் . (ததொல் லியல் துளற தவளியீடு)
5. Social Life of Tamils (Dr.K.K.Pillay) A joint publication of TNTB & ESC and RMRL – (in
print)
6. Social Life of the Tamils - The Classical Period (Dr.S.Singaravelu) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.
7. Historical Heritage of the Tamils (Dr.S.V.Subatamanian, Dr.K.D. Thirunavukkarasu)
(Published by: International Institute of Tamil Studies).
8. The Contributions of the Tamils to Indian Culture (Dr.M.Valarmathi) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.)
9. Keeladi - ‘Sangam City C ivilization on the banks of river Vaigai’ (Jointly Published by:
Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text Book and Educational Services
Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
10. Studies in the History of India with Special Reference to Tamil Nadu (Dr.K.K.Pillay)
(Published by: The Author)
11. Porunai Civilization (Jointly Published by: Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text
Book and Educational Services Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
12. Journey of Civilization Indus to Vaigai (R.Balakrishnan) (Published by: RMRL) – Reference
Book.

27
GE3171 PROBLEM SOLVING AND PYTHON PROGRAMMING LABORATORY L TPC
0 04 2
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the problem solving approaches.
 To learn the basic programming constructs in Python.
 To practice various computing strategies for Python-based solutions to real world
problems.
 To use Python data structures - lists, tuples, dictionaries.
 To do input/output with files in Python.

EXPERIMENTS:
Note: The examples suggested in each experiment are only indicative. The lab instructor is
expected to design other problems on similar lines. The Examination shall not be restricted
to the sample experiments listed here.

1. Identification and solving of simple real life or scientific or technical problems, and
developing flow charts for the same. (Electricity Billing, Retail shop billing, Sin series, weight
of a motorbike, Weight of a steel bar, compute Electrical Current in Three Phase AC Circuit,
etc.)
2. Python programming using simple statements and expressions (exchange the values of two
variables, circulate the values of n variables, distance between two points).
3. Scientific problems using Conditionals and Iterative loops. (Number series, Number Patterns,
pyramid pattern)
4. Implementing real-time/technical applications using Lists, Tuples. (Items present in a
library/Components of a car/ Materials required for construction of a building –operations of
list & tuples)
5. Implementing real-time/technical applications using Sets, Dictionaries. (Language,
components of an automobile, Elements of a civil structure, etc.- operations of Sets &
Dictionaries)
6. Implementing programs using Functions. (Factorial, largest number in a list, area of shape)
7. Implementing programs using Strings. (reverse, palindrome, character count, replacing
characters)
8. Implementing programs using written modules and Python Standard Libraries (pandas,
numpy. Matplotlib, scipy)
9. Implementing real-time/technical applications using File handling. (copy from one file to
another, word count, longest word)
10. Implementing real-time/technical applications using Exception handling. (divide by zero error,
voter’s age validity, student mark range validation)
11. Exploring Pygame tool.
12. Developing a game activity using Pygame like bouncing ball, car race etc.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, students will be able to:
CO1: Develop algorithmic solutions to simple computational problems
CO2: Develop and execute simple Python programs.
CO3: Implement programs in Python using conditionals and loops for solving problems..
28
CO4: Deploy functions to decompose a Python program.
CO5: Process compound data using Python data structures.
CO6: Utilize Python packages in developing software applications.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Allen B. Downey, “Think Python : How to Think like a Computer Scientist”, 2nd Edition,
O’Reilly Publishers, 2016.
2. Karl Beecher, “Computational Thinking: A Beginner's Guide to Problem Solving and
Programming”, 1st Edition, BCS Learning & Development Limited, 2017.
REFERENCES:
1. Paul Deitel and Harvey Deitel, “Python for Programmers”, Pearson Education, 1st Edition,
2021.
2. G Venkatesh and Madhavan Mukund, “Computational Thinking: A Primer for Programmers
and Data Scientists”, 1st Edition, Notion Press, 2021.
3. John V Guttag, "Introduction to Computation and Programming Using Python: With
Applications to Computational Modeling and Understanding Data‘‘, Third Edition, MIT
Press , 2021
4. Eric Matthes, “Python Crash Course, A Hands - on Project Based Introduction to
Programming”, 2nd Edition, No Starch Press, 2019.
5. https://www.python.org/
6. Martin C. Brown, “Python: The Complete Reference”, 4th Edition, Mc-Graw Hill, 2018.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 3 -
2 3 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 - -
3 3 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 - 3 - -
4 2 2 - 2 2 - - - - - 1 - 3 - -
5 1 2 - - 1 - - - - - 1 - 2 - -
6 2 2 - - 2 - - - - - 1 - 2 -
AVg. 2 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 3 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

BS3171 PHYSICS AND CHEMISTRY LABORATORY L T P C


0 0 4 2

PHYSICS LABORATORY : (Any Seven Experiments)

COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn the proper use of various kinds of physics laboratory equipment.
 To learn how data can be collected, presented and interpreted in a clear and concise
manner.
 To learn problem solving skills related to physics principles and interpretation of
experimental data.
 To determine error in experimental measurements and techniques used to minimize such
error.
 To make the student an active participant in each part of all lab exercises.
29
1. Torsional pendulum - Determination of rigidity modulus of wire and moment of inertia
of regular and irregular objects.
2. Simple harmonic oscillations of cantilever.
3. Non-uniform bending - Determination of Young’s modulus
4. Uniform bending – Determination of Young’s modulus
5. Laser- Determination of the wavelength of the laser using grating
6. Air wedge - Determination of thickness of a thin sheet/wire
7. a) Optical fibre -Determination of Numerical Aperture and acceptance angle
b) Compact disc- Determination of width of the groove using laser.
8. Acoustic grating- Determination of velocity of ultrasonic waves in liquids.
9. Ultrasonic interferometer – determination of the velocity of sound and compressibility
of liquids
10. Post office box -Determination of Band gap of a semiconductor.
11. Photoelectric effect
12. Michelson Interferometer.
13. Melde’s string experiment
14. Experiment with lattice dynamics kit.
TOTAL: 30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, the students should be able to
CO1:Understand the functioning of various physics laboratory equipment.
CO2:Use graphical models to analyze laboratory data.
CO3:Use mathematical models as a medium for quantitative reasoning and describing physical
reality.
CO4:Access, process and analyze scientific information.
CO5:Solve problems individually and collaboratively.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3 2 3 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
2 3 3 2 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
3 3 2 3 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
4 3 3 2 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
5 3 2 3 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
AVG 3 2.4 2.6 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CHEMISTRY LABORATORY: (Any seven experiments to be conducted)


COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To inculcate experimental skills to test basic understanding of water quality parameters,
such as, acidity, alkalinity, hardness, DO, chloride and copper.
 To induce the students to familiarize with electroanalytical techniques such as, pH metry,
potentiometry and conductometry in the determination of impurities in aqueous solutions.
 To demonstrate the analysis of metals and alloys.
 To demonstrate the synthesis of nanoparticles

30
1. Preparation of Na2CO3 as a primary standard and estimation of acidity of a water
sample using the primary standard
2. Determination of types and amount of alkalinity in a water sample.
- Split the first experiment into two
3. Determination of total, temporary & permanent hardness of water by EDTA method.
4. Determination of DO content of water sample by Winkler’s method.
5. Determination of chloride content of water sample by Argentometric method.
6. Estimation of copper content of the given solution by Iodometry.
7. Estimation of TDS of a water sample by gravimetry.
8. Determination of strength of given hydrochloric acid using pH meter.
9. Determination of strength of acids in a mixture of acids using conductivity meter.
10. Conductometric titration of barium chloride against sodium sulphate (precipitation
titration)
11. Estimation of iron content of the given solution using potentiometer.
12. Estimation of sodium /potassium present in water using a flame photometer.
13. Preparation of nanoparticles (TiO2/ZnO/CuO) by Sol-Gel method.
14. Estimation of Nickel in steel
15. Proximate analysis of Coal
TOTAL : 30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES :
CO1:To analyse the quality of water samples with respect to their acidity, alkalinity, hardness and
DO.
CO2:To determine the amount of metal ions through volumetric and spectroscopic techniques
CO3:To analyse and determine the composition of alloys.
CO4:To learn simple method of synthesis of nanoparticles
CO5:To quantitatively analyse the impurities in solution by electroanalytical techniques

TEXT BOOKS :
1. J. Mendham, R. C. Denney, J.D. Barnes, M. Thomas and B. Sivasankar, Vogel’s Textbook
of Quantitative Chemical Analysis (2009).
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1
CO 3 - 1 - - 2 2 - - - - 2 - - -
2 3 1 2 - - 1 2 - - - - 1 - - -
3 3 2 1 1 - - 1 - - - - - - - -
4 2 1 2 - - 2 2 - - - - - - - -
5 2 1 2 - 1 2 2 - - - - 1 - - -
Avg. 2.6 1.3 1.6 1 1 1.4 1.8 - - - - 1.3 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

GE3172 ENGLISH LABORATORY L T P C


0 0 2 1
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To improve the communicative competence of learners
 To help learners use language effectively in academic /work contexts

31
 To develop various listening strategies to comprehend various types of audio materials
like lectures, discussions, videos etc.
 To build on students’ English language skills by engaging them in listening, speaking
and grammar learning activities that are relevant to authentic contexts.
 To use language efficiently in expressing their opinions via various media.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO FUNDAMENTALS OF COMMUNICATION 6


Listening for general information-specific details- conversation: Introduction to classmates - Audio /
video (formal & informal); Telephone conversation; Listening to voicemail & messages; Listening
and filling a form. Speaking - making telephone calls-Self Introduction; Introducing a friend; -
politeness strategies- making polite requests, making polite offers, replying to polite requests and
offers- understanding basic instructions( filling out a bank application for example).

UNIT II NARRATION AND SUMMATION 6


Listening - Listening to podcasts, anecdotes / stories / event narration; documentaries and
interviews with celebrities. Speaking - Narrating personal experiences / events-Talking about
current and temporary situations & permanent and regular situations* - describing experiences and
feelings- engaging in small talk- describing requirements and abilities.

UNIT III DESCRIPTION OF A PROCESS / PRODUCT 6


Listening - Listen to product and process descriptions; a classroom lecture; and advertisements
about products. Speaking – Picture description- describing locations in workplaces- Giving
instruction to use the product- explaining uses and purposes- Presenting a product- describing
shapes and sizes and weights- talking about quantities(large & small)-talking about precautions.

UNIT IV CLASSIFICATION AND RECOMMENDATIONS 6


Listening – Listening to TED Talks; Listening to lectures - and educational videos. Speaking –
Small Talk; discussing and making plans-talking about tasks-talking about progress- talking about
positions and directions of movement-talking about travel preparations- talking about
transportation-

UNIT V EXPRESSION 6
Listening – Listening to debates/ discussions; different viewpoints on an issue; and panel
discussions. Speaking –making predictions- talking about a given topic-giving opinions-
understanding a website-describing processes

TOTAL : 30 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, learners will be able
CO1:To listen to and comprehend general as w as complex academic information
CO2:To listen to and understand different points of view in a discussion
CO3:To speak fluently and accurately in formal and informal communicative contexts
CO4:To describe products and processes and explain their uses and purposes clearly and
accurately
CO5:To express their opinions effectively in both formal and informal discussions

32
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
2 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
3 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
4 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
5 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
AVg. 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
1-low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation
Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

ASSESSMENT PATTERN
 One online / app based assessment to test listening /speaking
 End Semester ONLY listening and speaking will be conducted online.
 Proficiency certification is given on successful completion of listening and speaking internal
test and end semester exam.

HS3252 PROFESSIONAL ENGLISH -II L T P C


2 00 2

COURSE OBJECTIVES :
 To engage learners in meaningful language activities to improve their reading and writing
skills
 To learn various reading strategies and apply in comprehending documents in professional
context.
 To help learners understand the purpose, audience, contexts of different types of writing
 To develop analytical thinking skills for problem solving in communicative contexts
 To demonstrate an understanding of job applications and interviews for internship and
placements

UNIT I MAKING COMPARISONS 6


Reading - Reading advertisements, user manuals, brochures; Writing – Professional emails, Email
etiquette - Compare and Contrast Essay; Grammar – Mixed Tenses, Prepositional phrases

UNIT II EXPRESSING CAUSAL RELATIONS IN SPEAKING AND WRITING 6


Reading - Reading longer technical texts– Cause and Effect Essays, and Letters / emails of
complaint, Writing - Writing responses to complaints. Grammar - Active Passive Voice
transformations, Infinitive and Gerunds

UNIT III PROBLEM SOLVING 6


Reading - Case Studies, excerpts from literary texts, news reports etc. Writing – Letter to the
Editor, Checklists, Problem solution essay / Argumentative Essay. Grammar – Error correction; If
conditional sentences

33
UNIT IV REPORTING OF EVENTS AND RESEARCH 6
Reading –Newspaper articles; Writing – Recommendations, Transcoding, Accident Report, Survey
Report Grammar – Reported Speech, Modals Vocabulary – Conjunctions- use of prepositions

UNIT V THE ABILITY TO PUT IDEAS OR INFORMATION COGENTLY 6


Reading – Company profiles, Statement of Purpose, (SOP), an excerpt of interview with
professionals; Writing – Job / Internship application – Cover letter & Resume; Grammar –
Numerical adjectives, Relative Clauses.
TOTAL : 30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, learners will be able
CO1: To compare and contrast products and ideas in technical texts.
CO2: To identify and report cause and effects in events, industrial processes through technical
texts
CO3: To analyse problems in order to arrive at feasible solutions and communicate them in the
written format.
CO4: To present their ideas and opinions in a planned and logical manner
CO5: To draft effective resumes in the context of job search.

TEXT BOOKS :
1. English for Engineers & Technologists (2020 edition) Orient Blackswan Private Ltd.
Department of English, Anna University.
2. English for Science & Technology Cambridge University Press 2021.
3. Authored by Dr. Veena Selvam, Dr. Sujatha Priyadarshini, Dr. Deepa Mary Francis, Dr. KN.
Shoba, and Dr. Lourdes Joevani, Department of English, Anna University.

REFERENCE BOOKS:
1. Raman. Meenakshi, Sharma. Sangeeta (2019). Professional English. Oxford university press.
New Delhi.
2. Improve Your Writing ed. V.N. Arora and Laxmi Chandra, Oxford Univ. Press, 2001,
NewDelhi.
3. Learning to Communicate – Dr. V. Chellammal. Allied Publishers, New Delhi, 2003
4. Business Correspondence and Report Writing by Prof. R.C. Sharma & Krishna Mohan, Tata
McGraw Hill & Co. Ltd., 2001, New Delhi.
5. Developing Communication Skills by Krishna Mohan, Meera Bannerji- Macmillan India Ltd.
1990, Delhi.

ASSESSMENT PATTERN
Two internal assessments and an end semester examination to test students’ reading and writing
skills along with their grammatical and lexical competence.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 3 3 3 - - -
2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 3 3 3 - - -
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 3 3 3 - - -
4 3 3 3 3 2 3 3 3 2 3 3 3 - - -
5 - - - - - - - - 3 3 3 3 - - -
AVg. 3 3 3 3 2.75 3 3 3 2.2 3 3 3 - - -

34
1-low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation
Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

MA3251 STATISTICS AND NUMERICAL METHODS L T P C


3 1 0 4
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
● This course aims at providing the necessary basic concepts of a few statistical and
numerical methods and give procedures for solving numerically different kinds of
problems occurring in engineering and technology.
● To acquaint the knowledge of testing of hypothesis for small and large samples which
plays an important role in real life problems.
● To introduce the basic concepts of solving algebraic and transcendental equations.
● To introduce the numerical techniques of interpolation in various intervals and numerical
techniques of differentiation and integration which plays an important role in engineering
and technology disciplines.
● To acquaint the knowledge of various techniques and methods of solving ordinary
differential equations.

UNIT I TESTING OF HYPOTHESIS 9+3


Sampling distributions - Tests for single mean, proportion and difference of means (Large and
small samples) – Tests for single variance and equality of variances – Chi square test for
goodness of fit – Independence of attributes.

UNIT II DESIGN OF EXPERIMENTS 9+3


One way and two way classifications - Completely randomized design – Randomized block design
– Latin square design - 22 factorial design.

UNIT III SOLUTION OF EQUATIONS AND EIGENVALUE PROBLEMS 9+3


Solution of algebraic and transcendental equations - Fixed point iteration method – Newton
Raphson method- Solution of linear system of equations - Gauss elimination method – Pivoting -
Gauss Jordan method – Iterative methods of Gauss Jacobi and Gauss Seidel - Eigenvalues of a
matrix by Power method and Jacobi’s method for symmetric matrices.

UNIT IV INTERPOLATION, NUMERICAL DIFFERENTIATION AND NUMERICAL


INTEGRATION 9 +3
Lagrange’s and Newton’s divided difference interpolations – Newton’s forward and backward
difference interpolation – Approximation of derivates using interpolation polynomials – Numerical
single and double integrations using Trapezoidal and Simpson’s 1/3 rules.

UNIT V NUMERICAL SOLUTION OF ORDINARY DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS 9 +3


Single step methods: Taylor’s series method - Euler’s method - Modified Euler’s method - Fourth
order Runge-Kutta method for solving first order differential equations - Multi step methods:
Milne’s and Adams - Bash forth predictor corrector methods for solving first order differential
equations.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS

35
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon successful completion of the course, students will be able to:
CO1: Apply the concept of testing of hypothesis for small and large samples in real life problems.
CO2: Apply the basic concepts of classifications of design of experiments in the field of
agriculture.
CO3: Appreciate the numerical techniques of interpolation in various intervals and apply the
numerical techniques of differentiation and integration for engineering problems.
CO4: Understandthe knowledge of various techniques and methods for solving first and second
order ordinary differential equations.
CO5: Solve the partial and ordinary differential equations with initial and boundary conditions by
using certain techniques with engineering applications.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Grewal, B.S., and Grewal, J.S., "Numerical Methods in Engineering and Science", Khanna
Publishers, 10th Edition, New Delhi, 2015.
2. Johnson, R.A., Miller, I and Freund J., “Miller and Freund’s Probability and Statistics for
Engineers", Pearson Education, Asia, 8th Edition, 2015.

REFERENCES:
1. Burden, R.L and Faires, J.D, "Numerical Analysis”, 9th Edition, Cengage Learning, 2016.
2. Devore. J.L., "Probability and Statistics for Engineering and the Sciences”, Cengage
Learning, New Delhi, 8th Edition, 2014.
3. Gerald. C.F. and Wheatley. P.O. "Applied Numerical Analysis” Pearson Education, Asia,
New Delhi, 7th Edition, 2007.
4. Gupta S.C. and Kapoor V. K., “Fundamentals of Mathematical Statistics”, Sultan Chand &
Sons, New Delhi, 12th Edition, 2020.
5. Spiegel. M.R., Schiller. J. and Srinivasan. R.A., "Schaum’s Outlines on Probability and
Statistics ", Tata McGraw Hill Edition, 4th Edition, 2012.
6. Walpole. R.E., Myers. R.H., Myers. S.L. and Ye. K., “Probability and Statistics for
Engineers and Scientists", 9th Edition, Pearson Education, Asia, 2010.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
CO1 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO2 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO3 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO5 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
Avg 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

PH3256 PHYSICS FOR INFORMATION SCIENCE L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To make the students understand the importance in studying electrical properties of
materials.
 To enable the students to gain knowledge in semiconductor physics
 To instill knowledge on magnetic properties of materials.
 To establish a sound grasp of knowledge on different optical properties of materials, optical
displays and applications

36
 To inculcate an idea of significance of nano structures, quantum confinement, ensuing
nano device applications and quantum computing.

UNIT I ELECTRICAL PROPERTIES OF MATERIALS 9


Classical free electron theory - Expression for electrical conductivity – Thermal conductivity,
expression - Wiedemann-Franz law – Success and failures - electrons in metals – Particle in a
three dimensional box – degenerate states – Fermi- Dirac statistics – Density of energy states –
Electron in periodic potential – Energy bands in solids – tight binding approximation - Electron
effective mass – concept of hole.

UNIT II SEMICONDUCTOR PHYSICS 9


Intrinsic Semiconductors – Energy band diagram – direct and indirect band gap semiconductors
– Carrier concentration in intrinsic semiconductors – extrinsic semiconductors - Carrier
concentration in N-type & P-type semiconductors – Variation of carrier concentration with
temperature – variation of Fermi level with temperature and impurity concentration – Carrier
transport in Semiconductor: random motion, drift, mobility and diffusion – Hall effect and devices –
Ohmic contacts – Schottky diode.

UNIT III MAGNETIC PROPERTIES OF MATERIALS 9


Magnetic dipole moment – atomic magnetic moments- magnetic permeability and susceptibility -
Magnetic material classification: diamagnetism – paramagnetism – ferromagnetism –
antiferromagnetism – ferrimagnetism – Ferromagnetism: origin and exchange interaction-
saturation magnetization and Curie temperature – Domain Theory- M versus H behaviour – Hard
and soft magnetic materials – examples and uses-– Magnetic principle in computer data storage –
Magnetic hard disc (GMR sensor).

UNIT IV OPTICAL PROPERTIES OF MATERIALS 9


Classification of optical materials – carrier generation and recombination processes - Absorption
emission and scattering of light in metals, insulators and semiconductors (concepts only) - photo
current in a P-N diode – solar cell - LED – Organic LED – Laser diodes – Optical data storage
techniques.

UNIT V NANODEVICES AND QUANTUM COMPUTING 9


Introduction - quantum confinement – quantum structures: quantum wells, wires and dots ––
band gap of nanomaterials. Tunneling – Single electron phenomena: Coulomb blockade -
resonant-tunneling diode – single electron transistor – quantum cellular automata - Quantum
system for information processing - quantum states – classical bits – quantum bits or qubits –
CNOT gate - multiple qubits – Bloch sphere – quantum gates – advantage of quantum computing
over classical computing.
TOTAL :45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, the students should be able to
CO1: gain knowledge on classical and quantum electron theories, and energy band structures
CO2: acquire knowledge on basics of semiconductor physics and its applications in various
devices
CO3: get knowledge on magnetic properties of materials and their applications in data storage,
CO4: have the necessary understanding on the functioning of optical materials for optoelectronics

37
CO5: understand the basics of quantum structures and their applications and basics of quantum
computing
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Jasprit Singh, “Semiconductor Devices: Basic Principles”, Wiley (Indian Edition), 2007.
2. S.O. Kasap. Principles of Electronic Materials and Devices, McGraw-Hill Education (Indian
Edition), 2020.
3. Parag K. Lala, Quantum Computing: A Beginner's Introduction, McGraw-Hill Education
(Indian Edition), 2020.
REFERENCES:
1. Charles Kittel, Introduction to Solid State Physics, Wiley India Edition, 2019.
2. Y.B.Band and Y.Avishai, Quantum Mechanics with Applications to Nanotechnology and
3. Information Science, Academic Press, 2013.
4. V.V.Mitin, V.A. Kochelap and M.A.Stroscio, Introduction to Nanoelectronics, Cambridge
Univ.Press, 2008.
5. G.W. Hanson, Fundamentals of Nanoelectronics, Pearson Education (Indian Edition) 2009.
6. B.Rogers, J.Adams and S.Pennathur, Nanotechnology: Understanding Small Systems,
CRC Press, 2014.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 1 - - - - - - - - - - - - -
2 3 1 2 - - - - - - - - - - - -
3 3 - - 1 2 1 1 - - - - - - - -
4 3 - 2 1 3 - 1 - - - - - - - -
5 3 2 2 2 2 1 2 - - - - 2 - - -
AVG 3 1.3 2 1.3 2.3 1 1.3 - - - - 2 - - -
1-Low,2-Medium,3-High,”-“-no correlation
Note: the average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

BE3251 BASIC ELECTRICAL AND ELECTRONICS ENGINEERING L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the basics of electric circuits and analysis
 To impart knowledge in the basics of working principles and application of electrical
machines
 To introduce analog devices and their characteristics
 To educate on the fundamental concepts of digital electronics
 To introduce the functional elements and working of measuring instruments

UNIT I ELECTRICAL CIRCUITS 9


DC Circuits: Circuit Components: Conductor, Resistor, Inductor, Capacitor – Ohm’s Law -
Kirchhoff’s Laws –Independent and Dependent Sources – Simple problems- Nodal Analysis,
Mesh analysis with Independent sources only (Steady state)
38
Introduction to AC Circuits and Parameters: Waveforms, Average value, RMS Value,
Instantaneous power, real power, reactive power and apparent power, power factor – Steady state
analysis of RLC circuits (Simple problems only)

UNIT II ELECTRICAL MACHINES 9


Construction and Working principle- DC Separately and Self excited Generators, EMF equation,
Types and Applications. Working Principle of DC motors, Torque Equation, Types and
Applications. Construction, Working principle and Applications of Transformer, Three phase
Alternator, Synchronous motor and Three Phase Induction Motor.

UNIT III ANALOG ELECTRONICS 9


Resistor, Inductor and Capacitor in Electronic Circuits- Semiconductor Materials: Silicon
&Germanium – PN Junction Diodes, Zener Diode –Characteristics Applications – Bipolar Junction
Transistor-Biasing, JFET, SCR, MOSFET,IGBT – Types, I-V Characteristics and Applications,
Rectifier and Inverters

UNIT IV DIGITAL ELECTRONICS 9


Review of number systems, binary codes, error detection and correction codes, Combinational
logic - representation of logic functions-SOP and POS forms, K-map representations -
minimization using K maps (Simple Problems only).

UNIT V MEASUREMENTS AND INSTRUMENTATION 9


Functional elements of an instrument, Standards and calibration, Operating Principle, types -
Moving Coil and Moving Iron meters, Measurement of three phase power, Energy Meter,
Instrument Transformers-CT and PT, DSO- Block diagram- Data acquisition.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completing this course, the students will be able to
CO1: Compute the electric circuit parameters for simple problems
CO2: Explain the working principle and applications of electrical machines
CO3: Analyze the characteristics of analog electronic devices
CO4: Explain the basic concepts of digital electronics
CO5: Explain the operating principles of measuring instruments

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Kothari DP and I.J Nagrath, “Basic Electrical and Electronics Engineering”, Second Edition,
McGraw Hill Education, 2020
2. S.K.Bhattacharya “Basic Electrical and Electronics Engineering”, Pearson Education, Second
Edition, 2017.
3. Sedha R.S., “A textbook book of Applied Electronics”, S. Chand & Co., 2008
4. James A .Svoboda, Richard C. Dorf, “Dorf’s Introduction to Electric Circuits”, Wiley, 2018.
5. A.K. Sawhney, Puneet Sawhney ‘A Course in Electrical & Electronic Measurements &
Instrumentation’, Dhanpat Rai and Co, 2015.

REFERENCES:
1. Kothari DP and I.J Nagrath, “Basic Electrical Engineering”, Fourth Edition, McGraw Hill
2. Education, 2019.
3. Thomas L. Floyd, ‘Digital Fundamentals’, 11th Edition, Pearson Education, 2017.
39
4. 4. Albert Malvino, David Bates, ‘Electronic Principles, McGraw Hill Education; 7th edition,
2017.
5. Mahmood Nahvi and Joseph A. Edminister, “Electric Circuits”, Schaum’ Outline Series,
McGraw Hill, 2002.
6. H.S. Kalsi, ‘Electronic Instrumentation’, Tata McGraw-Hill, New Delhi, 2010
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 2 2 1 - - - - 1 - - - 2 - - 1
2 2 2 1 - - - - 1 - - - 2 - - 1
3 2 1 1 - - - - 1 - - - 2 - - 1
4 2 2 1 - - - - 1 - - - 2 - - 1
5 2 2 1 - - - - 1 - - - 2 - - 1
CO 2 1.8 1 - - - - 1 - - - 2 - - 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

GE3251 ENGINEERING GRAPHICS L T P C


2 0 4 4
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The main learning objective of this course is to prepare the students for:
 Drawing engineering curves.
 Drawing a freehand sketch of simple objects.
 Drawing orthographic projection of solids and section of solids.
 Drawing development of solids
 Drawing isometric and perspective projections of simple solids.

CONCEPTS AND CONVENTIONS (Not for Examination)


Importance of graphics in engineering applications — Use of drafting instruments — BIS
conventions and specifications — Size, layout and folding of drawing sheets — Lettering and
dimensioning.

UNIT I PLANE CURVES 6+12


Basic Geometrical constructions, Curves used in engineering practices: Conics — Construction of
ellipse, parabola and hyperbola by eccentricity method — Construction of cycloid — construction
of involutes of square and circle — Drawing of tangents and normal to the above curves.

UNIT II PROJECTION OF POINTS, LINES AND PLANE SURFACE 6+12


Orthographic projection- principles-Principal planes-First angle projection-projection of points.
Projection of straight lines (only First angle projections) inclined to both the principal planes -
Determination of true lengths and true inclinations by rotating line method and traces. Projection of
planes (polygonal and circular surfaces) inclined to both the principal planes by rotating object
method.

UNIT III PROJECTION OF SOLIDS AND FREEHAND SKETCHING 6+12


Projection of simple solids like prisms, pyramids, cylinder, cone and truncated solids when the axis
is inclined to one of the principal planes and parallel to the other by rotating object method.
Visualization concepts and Free Hand sketching: Visualization principles —Representation of

40
Three Dimensional objects — Layout of views- Freehand sketching of multiple views from pictorial
views of objects.
Practicing three dimensional modeling of simple objects by CAD Software (Not for examination)

UNIT IV PROJECTION OF SECTIONED SOLIDS AND DEVELOPMENT OF


SURFACES 6 +12
Sectioning of above solids in simple vertical position when the cutting plane is inclined to one of
the principal planes and perpendicular to the other — obtaining true shape of section.
Development of lateral surfaces of simple and sectioned solids — Prisms, pyramids cylinders and
cones.
Practicing three dimensional modeling of simple objects by CAD Software (Not for examination)

UNIT V ISOMETRIC AND PERSPECTIVE PROJECTIONS 6+12


Principles of isometric projection — isometric scale — isometric projections of simple solids and
truncated solids - Prisms, pyramids, cylinders, cones- combination of two solid objects in simple
vertical positions - Perspective projection of simple solids - Prisms, pyramids and cylinders by
visual ray method.
Practicing three dimensional modeling of isometric projection of simple objects by CAD Software
(Not for examination)
TOTAL: (L=30+P=60) 90 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion of this course, the student will be able to
CO1: Use BIS conventions and specifications for engineering drawing.
CO2: Construct the conic curves, involutes and cycloid.
CO3: Solve practical problems involving projection of lines.
CO4: Draw the orthographic, isometric and perspective projections of simple solids.
CO5: Draw the development of simple solids.
TEXT BOOK:
1. Bhatt N.D. and Panchal V.M., “Engineering Drawing”, Charotar Publishing House, 53rd
Edition, 2019.
2. Natarajan K.V., “A Text Book of Engineering Graphics”, Dhanalakshmi Publishers,
Chennai, 2018.
3. Parthasarathy, N. S. and Vela Murali, “Engineering Drawing”, Oxford University Press,
2015
REFERENCES:
1. Basant Agarwal and Agarwal C.M., “Engineering Drawing”, McGraw Hill, 2nd Edition, 2019.
2. Gopalakrishna K.R., “Engineering Drawing” (Vol. I&II combined), Subhas Publications,
Bangalore, 27th Edition, 2017.
3. Luzzader, Warren.J. and Duff,John M., “Fundamentals of Engineering Drawing with an
introduction to Interactive Computer Graphics for Design and Production, Eastern
Economy Edition, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd, New Delhi, 2005.
4. Parthasarathy N. S. and Vela Murali, “Engineering Graphics”, Oxford University, Press,
New Delhi, 2015.
5. Shah M.B., and Rana B.C., “Engineering Drawing”, Pearson Education India, 2nd Edition,
2009.
6. Venugopal K. and Prabhu Raja V., “Engineering Graphics", New Age International (P)
Limited, 2008.
41
Publication of Bureau of Indian Standards:
1. IS 10711 — 2001: Technical products Documentation — Size and layout of drawing
sheets.
2. IS 9609 (Parts 0 & 1) — 2001: Technical products Documentation — Lettering.
3. IS 10714 (Part 20) — 2001 & SP 46 — 2003: Lines for technical drawings.
4. IS 11669 — 1986 & SP 46 —2003: Dimensioning of Technical Drawings.
5. IS 15021 (Parts 1 to 4) — 2001: Technical drawings — Projection Methods.

Special points applicable to University Examinations on Engineering Graphics:


1. There will be five questions, each of either or type covering all units of the syllabus.
2. All questions will carry equal marks of 20 each making a total of 100.
3. The answer paper shall consist of drawing sheets of A3 size only. The students will be
permitted to use appropriate scale to fit a solution within A3 size.
4. The examination will be conducted in appropriate sessions on the same day
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3 1 2 - 2 - - - - 3 - 2 2 2 -
2 3 1 2 - 2 - - - - 3 - 2 2 2 -
3 3 1 2 - 2 - - - - 3 - 2 2 2 -
4 3 1 2 - 2 - - - - 3 - 2 2 2 -
5 3 1 2 - 2 - - - - 3 - 2 2 2 -
CO 3 1 2 - 2 - - - - 3 - 2 2 2 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

AD3251 DATA STRUCTURES DESIGN L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
● To understand the concepts of ADTs
● To design linear data structures – lists, stacks, and queues
● To understand sorting, searching and hashing algorithms
● To apply Tree and Graph structures

UNIT I ABSTRACT DATA TYPES 9


Abstract Data Types (ADTs) – ADTs and classes – introduction to OOP – classes in Python –
inheritance – namespaces – shallow and deep copying
Introduction to analysis of algorithms – asymptotic notations – recursion – analyzing recursive
algorithms

UNIT II LINEAR STRUCTURES 9


List ADT – array-based implementations – linked list implementations – singly linked lists –
circularly linked lists – doubly linked lists – applications of lists – Stack ADT – Queue ADT –
double ended queues

UNIT III SORTING AND SEARCHING 9


Bubble sort – selection sort – insertion sort – merge sort – quick sort – linear search – binary

42
search – hashing – hash functions – collision handling – load factors, rehashing, and efficiency

UNIT IV TREE STRUCTURES 9


Tree ADT – Binary Tree ADT – tree traversals – binary search trees – AVL trees – heaps – multi-
way search trees

UNIT V GRAPH STRUCTURES 9


Graph ADT – representations of graph – graph traversals – DAG – topological ordering – shortest
paths – minimum spanning trees
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, the student should be able to:
CO1: explain abstract data types
CO2: design, implement, and analyse linear data structures, such as lists, queues, and stacks,
according to the needs of different applications
CO3: design, implement, and analyse efficient tree structures to meet requirements such as
searching, indexing, and sorting
CO4: model problems as graph problems and implement efficient graph algorithms to solve them

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Michael T. Goodrich, Roberto Tamassia, and Michael H. Goldwasser, “Data Structures and
Algorithms in Python” (An Indian Adaptation), Wiley, 2021.
2. Lee, Kent D., Hubbard, Steve, “Data Structures and Algorithms with Python” Springer
Edition 2015.
3. Narasimha Karumanchi, “Data Structures and Algorithmic Thinking with Python”
Careermonk, 2015.
REFERENCES:
1. Rance D. Necaise, “Data Structures and Algorithms Using Python”, John Wiley & Sons,
2011.
2. Thomas H. Cormen, Charles E. Leiserson, Ronald L. Rivest, and Clifford Stein,
“Introduction to Algorithms", Third Edition, PHI Learning, 2010.
3. Mark Allen Weiss, “Data Structures and Algorithm Analysis in C++”, Fourth Edition,
Pearson Education, 2014
4. Aho, Hopcroft, and Ullman, “Data Structures and Algorithms”, Pearson Education India,
2002.

GE3252 TAMILS AND TECHNOLOGY LTPC


1 001
UNIT I WEAVING AND CERAMIC TECHNOLOGY 3
Weaving Industry during Sangam Age – Ceramic technology – Black and Red Ware Potteries
(BRW) – Graffiti on Potteries.

UNIT II DESIGN AND CONSTRUCTION TECHNOLOGY 3


Designing and Structural construction House & Designs in household materials during Sangam
Age - Building materials and Hero stones of Sangam age – Details of Stage Constructions in

43
Silappathikaram - Sculptures and Temples of Mamallapuram - Great Temples of Cholas and
other worship places - Temples of Nayaka Period - Type study (Madurai Meenakshi Temple)-
Thirumalai Nayakar Mahal - Chetti Nadu Houses, Indo - Saracenic architecture at Madras during
British Period.

UNIT III MANUFACTURING TECHNOLOGY 3


Art of Ship Building - Metallurgical studies - Iron industry - Iron smelting, steel -Copper and gold-
Coins as source of history - Minting of Coins – Beads making-industries Stone beads -Glass
beads - Terracotta beads -Shell beads/ bone beats - Archeological evidences - Gem stone types
described in Silappathikaram.

UNIT IV AGRICULTURE AND IRRIGATION TECHNOLOGY 3


Dam, Tank, ponds, Sluice, Significance of Kumizhi Thoompu of Chola Period, Animal Husbandry
- Wells designed for cattle use - Agriculture and Agro Processing - Knowledge of Sea - Fisheries
– Pearl - Conche diving - Ancient Knowledge of Ocean - Knowledge Specific Society.

UNIT V SCIENTIFIC TAMIL & TAMIL COMPUTING 3


Development of Scientific Tamil - Tamil computing – Digitalization of Tamil Books – Development
of Tamil Software – Tamil Virtual Academy – Tamil Digital Library – Online Tamil Dictionaries –
Sorkuvai Project.
TOTAL : 15 PERIODS
TEXT-CUM-REFERENCE BOOKS
1. தமிழக வரலொறு – மக்களும் பண்பொடும் – கக.கக. பிள் ளள (தவளியீடு:
தமிழ் நொடு பொடநூல் மற் றும்
கல் வியியல் பணிகள் கழகம் ).
2. கணினித் தமிழ் – முளனவர் இல. சுந்தரம் . (விகடன் பிரசுரம் ).
3. கீழடி – ளவளக நதிக்களரயில் சங் ககொல நகர நொகரிகம் (ததொல் லியல் துளற
தவளியீடு)
4. தபொருளந – ஆற் றங் களர நொகரிகம் . (ததொல் லியல் துளற தவளியீடு)
5. Social Life of Tamils (Dr.K.K.Pillay) A joint publication of TNTB & ESC and RMRL – (in print)
6. Social Life of the Tamils - The Classical Period (Dr.S.Singaravelu) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.
7. Historical Heritage of the Tamils (Dr.S.V.Subatamanian, Dr.K.D. Thirunavukkarasu)
(Published by: International Institute of Tamil Studies).
8. The Contributions of the Tamils to Indian Culture (Dr.M.Valarmathi) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.)
9. Keeladi - ‘Sangam City C ivilization on the banks of river Vaigai’ (Jointly Published by:
Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text Book and Educational Services Corporation,
Tamil Nadu)
10. Studies in the History of India with Special Reference to Tamil Nadu (Dr.K.K.Pillay)
(Published by: The Author)
11. Porunai Civilization (Jointly Published by: Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text
Book and Educational Services Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
12. Journey of Civilization Indus to Vaigai (R.Balakrishnan) (Published by: RMRL) – Reference
Book.

44
GE3252 தமிழரும் மதொழில் நுட்பமும் L TPC
1 0 01
அலகு I மநசவு மற் றும் பொறனத் மதொழில் நுட்பம் : 3
சங் க கொலத்தில் தநசவுத் ததொழில் – பொளனத் ததொழில் நுட்பம் - கருப் பு சிவப்பு
பொண்டங் கள் – பொண்டங் களில் கீறல் குறியீடுகள் .

அலகு II வடிவறமப் பு மற் றும் கட்டிடத் மதொழில் நுட்பம் : 3


சங் க கொலத்தில் வடிவளமப் பு மற் றும் கட்டுமொனங் கள் & சங் க கொலத்தில் வீட்டுப்
தபொருட்களில் வடிவளமப் பு- சங் க கொலத்தில் கட்டுமொன தபொருட்களும்
நடுகல் லும் – சிலப் பதிகொரத்தில் கமளட அளமப் பு பற் றிய விவரங் கள் -
மொமல் லபுரச் சிற் பங் களும் , ககொவில் களும் – கசொழர் கொலத்துப்
தபருங் ககொயில் கள் மற் றும் பிற வழிபொட்டுத் தலங் கள் – நொயக்கர் கொலக்
ககொயில் கள் - மொதிரி கட்டளமப் புகள் பற் றி அறிதல் , மதுளர மீனொட்சி அம் மன்
ஆலயம் மற் றும் திருமளல நொயக்கர் மஹொல் – தசட்டிநொட்டு வீடுகள் – பிரிட்டிஷ்
கொலத்தில் தசன்ளனயில் இந்கதொ-சொகரொதசனிக் கட்டிடக் களல.
அலகு III உற் பத்தித் மதொழில் நுட்பம் : 3
கப் பல் கட்டும் களல – உகலொகவியல் – இரும் புத் ததொழிற் சொளல – இரும் ளப
உருக்குதல் , எஃகு – வரலொற் றுச் சொன்றுகளொக தசம் பு மற் றும் தங் க நொணயங் கள் –
நொணயங் கள் அச்சடித்தல் – மணி உருவொக்கும் ததொழிற் சொளலகள் – கல் மணிகள் ,
கண்ணொடி மணிகள் – சுடுமண் மணிகள் – சங் கு மணிகள் – எலும் புத்துண்டுகள் –
ததொல் லியல் சொன்றுகள் – சிலப் பதிகொரத்தில் மணிகளின் வளககள் .

அலகு IV கவளொை்றம மற் றும் நீ ர்ப்பொசனத் மதொழில் நுட்பம் : 3


அளண, ஏரி, குளங் கள் , மதகு – கசொழர்கொலக் குமுழித் தூம் பின் முக்கியத்துவம் –
கொல் நளட பரொமரிப் பு – கொல் நளடகளுக்கொக வடிவளமக்கப் பட்ட கிணறுகள் –
கவளொண்ளம மற் றும் கவளொண்ளமச் சொர்ந்த தசயல் பொடுகள் – கடல் சொர் அறிவு –
மீன்வளம் – முத்து மற் றும் முத்துக்குளித்தல் – தபருங் கடல் குறித்த பண்ளடய
அறிவு – அறிவுசொர் சமூகம் .

அலகு V அறிவியல் தமிழ் மற் றும் கைித்தமிழ் : 3


அறிவியல் தமிழின் வளர்ச்சி –கணித்தமிழ் வளர்ச்சி - தமிழ் நூல் களள
மின்பதிப் பு தசய் தல் – தமிழ் தமன்தபொருட்கள் உருவொக்கம் – தமிழ் இளணயக்
கல் விக்கழகம் – தமிழ் மின் நூலகம் – இளணயத்தில் தமிழ் அகரொதிகள் –
தசொற் குளவத் திட்டம் .
TOTAL : 15 PERIODS
TEXT-CUM-REFERENCE BOOKS
1. தமிழக வரலொறு – மக்களும் பண்பொடும் – கக.கக. பிள் ளள (தவளியீடு:
தமிழ் நொடு பொடநூல் மற் றும்
கல் வியியல் பணிகள் கழகம் ).
2. கணினித் தமிழ் – முளனவர் இல. சுந்தரம் . (விகடன் பிரசுரம் ).
3. கீழடி – ளவளக நதிக்களரயில் சங் ககொல நகர நொகரிகம் (ததொல் லியல்
துளற தவளியீடு)

45
4. தபொருளந – ஆற் றங் களர நொகரிகம் . (ததொல் லியல் துளற தவளியீடு)
5. Social Life of Tamils (Dr.K.K.Pillay) A joint publication of TNTB & ESC and RMRL – (in
print)
6. Social Life of the Tamils - The Classical Period (Dr.S.Singaravelu) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.
7. Historical Heritage of the Tamils (Dr.S.V.Subatamanian, Dr.K.D. Thirunavukkarasu)
(Published by: International Institute of Tamil Studies).
8. The Contributions of the Tamils to Indian Culture (Dr.M.Valarmathi) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.)
9. Keeladi - ‘Sangam City C ivilization on the banks of river Vaigai’ (Jointly Published by:
Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text Book and Educational Services
Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
10. Studies in the History of India with Special Reference to Tamil Nadu (Dr.K.K.Pillay)
(Published by: The Author)
11. Porunai Civilization (Jointly Published by: Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text
Book and Educational Services Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
12. Journey of Civilization Indus to Vaigai (R.Balakrishnan) (Published by: RMRL) – Reference
Book.

46
NX3251 NCC Credit Course Level 1*
(ARMY WING)
NCC Credit Course Level - I L T P C
2 0 0 2

NCC GENERAL 6
NCC 1 Aims, Objectives & Organization of NCC 1
NCC 2 Incentives 2
NCC 3 Duties of NCC Cadet 1
NCC 4 NCC Camps: Types & Conduct 2

NATIONAL INTEGRATION AND AWARENESS 4


NI 1 National Integration: Importance & Necessity 1
NI 2 Factors Affecting National Integration 1
NI 3 Unity in Diversity & Role of NCC in Nation Building 1
NI 4 Threats to National Security 1

PERSONALITY DEVELOPMENT 7
Self-Awareness, Empathy, Critical & Creative Thinking,
PD 1 2
Decision Making and Problem Solving
PD 2 Communication Skills 3
PD 3 Group Discussion: Stress & Emotions 2

LEADERSHIP 5
Leadership Capsule: Traits, Indicators, Motivation, Moral
L1 3
Values, Honour Code
L2 Case Studies: Shivaji, Jhasi Ki Rani 2

SOCIAL SERVICE AND COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT 8


Basics, Rural Development Programmes, NGOs, Contribution
SS 1 3
of Youth
SS 4 Protection of Children and Women Safety 1
SS 5 Road / Rail Travel Safety 1
SS 6 New Initiatives 2
SS 7 Cyber and Mobile Security Awareness 1

TOTAL: 30 PERIODS

47
NX3252 NCC Credit Course Level 1*
(NAVAL WING)
NCC Credit Course Level - I L T P C
2 0 0 2
NCC GENERAL 6
NCC 1 Aims, Objectives & Organization of NCC 1
NCC 2 Incentives 2
NCC 3 Duties of NCC Cadet 1
NCC 4 NCC Camps: Types & Conduct 2

NATIONAL INTEGRATION AND AWARENESS 4


NI 1 National Integration: Importance & Necessity 1
NI 2 Factors Affecting National Integration 1
NI 3 Unity in Diversity & Role of NCC in Nation Building 1
NI 4 Threats to National Security 1

PERSONALITY DEVELOPMENT 7
Self-Awareness, Empathy, Critical & Creative Thinking, Decision
PD 1 2
Making and Problem Solving
PD 2 Communication Skills 3
PD 3 Group Discussion: Stress & Emotions 2

LEADERSHIP 5
Leadership Capsule: Traits, Indicators, Motivation, Moral Values,
L1 3
Honour Code
L2 Case Studies: Shivaji, Jhasi Ki Rani 2

SOCIAL SERVICE AND COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT 8


Basics, Rural Development Programmes, NGOs, Contribution of
SS 1 3
Youth
SS 4 Protection of Children and Women Safety 1
SS 5 Road / Rail Travel Safety 1
SS 6 New Initiatives 2
SS 7 Cyber and Mobile Security Awareness 1

TOTAL : 30 PERIODS

48
NX3253 NCC Credit Course Level 1*
(AIR FORCE WING)
NCC Credit Course Level - I L T P C
2 0 0 2
NCC GENERAL 6
NCC 1 Aims, Objectives & Organization of NCC 1
NCC 2 Incentives 2
NCC 3 Duties of NCC Cadet 1
NCC 4 NCC Camps: Types & Conduct 2

NATIONAL INTEGRATION AND AWARENESS 4


NI 1 National Integration: Importance & Necessity 1
NI 2 Factors Affecting National Integration 1
NI 3 Unity in Diversity & Role of NCC in Nation Building 1
NI 4 Threats to National Security 1

PERSONALITY DEVELOPMENT 7
PD 1 Self-Awareness, Empathy, Critical & Creative Thinking, Decision
2
Making and Problem Solving
PD 2 Communication Skills 3
PD 3 Group Discussion: Stress & Emotions 2

LEADERSHIP 5
Leadership Capsule: Traits, Indicators, Motivation, Moral Values,
L1 3
Honour Code
L2 Case Studies: Shivaji, Jhasi Ki Rani 2

SOCIAL SERVICE AND COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT 8


Basics, Rural Development Programmes, NGOs, Contribution of
SS 1 3
Youth
SS 4 Protection of Children and Women Safety 1
SS 5 Road / Rail Travel Safety 1
SS 6 New Initiatives 2
SS 7 Cyber and Mobile Security Awareness 1

TOTAL : 30 PERIODS

49
GE3271 ENGINEERING PRACTICES LABORATORY LT PC
0 0 42
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The main learning objective of this course is to provide hands on training to the
students in:
1. Drawing pipe line plan; laying and connecting various pipe fittings used in common
household plumbing work; Sawing; planing; making joints in wood materials used in
commonhousehold wood work.

2. Wiring various electrical joints in common household electrical wire work.

3. Welding various joints in steel plates using arc welding work; Machining various
simple processes like turning, drilling, tapping in parts; Assembling simple
mechanical assembly of common household equipments; Making a tray out of metal
sheet using sheet metal work.

4. Soldering and testing simple electronic circuits; Assembling and testing simple
electronic components on PCB.

GROUP – A (CIVIL & ELECTRICAL)

PART I CIVIL ENGINEERING PRACTICES 15

PLUMBING WORK:
a) Connecting various basic pipe fittings like valves, taps, coupling, unions,
reducers,elbows and other components which are commonly used in
household.
b) Preparing plumbing line sketches.
c) Laying pipe connection to the suction side of a pump
d) Laying pipe connection to the delivery side of a pump.
e) Connecting pipes of different materials: Metal, plastic and flexible pipes
used inhousehold appliances.
WOOD WORK:
a) Sawing,
b) Planing and
c) Making joints like T-Joint, Mortise joint and Tenon joint and Dovetail joint.
Wood Work Study:

a) Studying joints in door panels and wooden furniture


b) Studying common industrial trusses using models.

PART II ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING PRACTICES 15

a) Introduction to switches, fuses, indicators and lamps - Basic switch board


wiring with lamp, fan and three pin socket
b) Staircase wiring
c) Fluorescent Lamp wiring with introduction to CFL and LED types.
d) Energy meter wiring and related calculations/ calibration
e) Study of Iron Box wiring and assembly

50
f) Study of Fan Regulator (Resistor type and Electronic type using
Diac/Triac/quadrac)
g) Study of emergency lamp wiring/Water heater

GROUP – B (MECHANICAL AND ELECTRONICS)

PART III MECHANICAL ENGINEERING PRACTICES 15

WELDING WORK:

a) Welding of Butt Joints, Lap Joints, and Tee Joints using arc welding.
b) Practicing gas welding.

BASIC MACHINING WORK:

a) (simple)Turning.
b) (simple)Drilling.
c) (simple)Tapping.

ASSEMBLY WORK:

a) Assembling a centrifugal pump.


b) Assembling a household mixer.
c) Assembling an airconditioner.

SHEET METAL WORK:


a) Making of a square tray

FOUNDRY WORK:
a) Demonstrating basic foundry operations.

PART IV ELECTRONIC ENGINEERING PRACTICES 15

SOLDERING WORK:
a) Soldering simple electronic circuits and checking continuity.
ELECTRONIC ASSEMBLY AND TESTING WORK:
a) Assembling and testing electronic components on a small PCB.

ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT STUDY:


a) Study an elements of smart phone..
b) Assembly and dismantle of LED TV.
c) Assembly and dismantle of computer/ laptop
TOTAL : 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Draw pipe line plan; lay and connect various pipe fittings used in common household
plumbing work; Saw; plan; make joints in wood materials used in common household wood work.

51
CO2: Wire various electrical joints in common household electrical wire work.
CO3: Weld various joints in steel plates using arc welding work; Machine various simple processes
like turning, drilling, tapping in parts; Assemble simple mechanical assembly of common
household equipments; Make a tray out of metal sheet using sheet metal work.
CO4: Solder and test simple electronic circuits; Assemble and test simple electronic components
on PCB.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3 2 - - 1 1 1 - - - - 2 2 1 1
2 3 2 - - 1 1 1 - - - - 2 2 1 1
3 3 2 - - 1 1 1 - - - - 2 2 1 1
CO 3 2 - - 1 1 1 - - - - 2 2 1 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

AD3271 DATA STRUCTURES DESIGN LABORATORY L T PC


0 0 4 2
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
● To implement ADTs in Python
● To design and implement linear data structures – lists, stacks, and queues
● To implement sorting, searching and hashing algorithms
● To solve problems using tree and graph structures

LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
Note: The lab instructor is expected to design problems based on the topics listed. The
Examination shall not be restricted to the sample experiments designed.
1. Implement simple ADTs as Python classes
2. Implement recursive algorithms in Python
3. Implement List ADT using Python arrays
4. Linked list implementations of List
5. Implementation of Stack and Queue ADTs
6. Applications of List, Stack and Queue ADTs
7. Implementation of sorting and searching algorithms
8. Implementation of Hash tables
9. Tree representation and traversal algorithms
10. Implementation of Binary Search Trees
11. Implementation of Heaps
12. Graph representation and Traversal algorithms
13. Implementation of single source shortest path algorithm
14. Implementation of minimum spanning tree algorithms

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, the student should be able to:
CO1: implement ADTs as Python classes
CO2: design, implement, and analyse linear data structures, such as lists, queues, and stacks,
according to the needs of different applications
52
CO3: design, implement, and analyse efficient tree structures to meet requirements such as
searching, indexing, and sorting
CO4: model problems as graph problems and implement efficient graph algorithms to solve them
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Michael T. Goodrich, Roberto Tamassia, and Michael H. Goldwasser, “Data Structures and
Algorithms in Python” (An Indian Adaptation), Wiley, 2021.
2. Lee, Kent D., Hubbard, Steve, “Data Structures and Algorithms with Python” Springer
Edition 2015.
3. Narasimha Karumanchi, “Data Structures and Algorithmic Thinking with Python”
Careermonk, 2015.

REFERENCES:
1. Rance D. Necaise, “Data Structures and Algorithms Using Python”, John Wiley & Sons,
2011.
2. Thomas H. Cormen, Charles E. Leiserson, Ronald L. Rivest, and Clifford Stein,
“Introduction to Algorithms", Third Edition, PHI Learning, 2010.
3. Mark Allen Weiss, “Data Structures and Algorithm Analysis in C++”, Fourth Edition,
Pearson Education, 2014
4. Aho, Hopcroft, and Ullman, “Data Structures and Algorithms”, Pearson Education India,
2002.

GE3272 COMMUNICATION LABORATORY LT P C


0 0 4 2
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To identify varied group discussion skills and apply them to take part in effective
discussions in a professional context.
 To analyse concepts and problems and make effective presentations explaining them
clearly and precisely.
 To be able to communicate effectively through formal and informal writing.
 To be able to use appropriate language structures to write emails, reports and essays
 To give instructions and recommendations that are clear and relevant to the context

UNIT I 12
Speaking-Role Play Exercises Based on Workplace Contexts, - talking about competition-
discussing progress toward goals-talking about experiences- talking about events in life-
discussing past events-Writing: writing emails ( formal & semi-formal).

UNIT II 12
Speaking: discussing news stories-talking about frequency-talking about travel problems-
discussing travel procedures- talking about travel problems- making arrangements-describing
arrangements-discussing plans and decisions- discussing purposes and reasons- understanding
common technology terms-Writing: - writing different types of emails.

UNIT III 12
Speaking: discussing predictions-describing the climate-discussing forecasts and scenarios-
talking about purchasing-discussing advantages and disadvantages- making comparisons-
53
discussing likes and dislikes- discussing feelings about experiences-discussing imaginary
scenarios Writing: short essays and reports-formal/semi-formal letters.

UNIT IV 12
Speaking: discussing the natural environment-describing systems-describing position and
movement- explaining rules-( example- discussing rental arrangements)- understanding technical
instructions-Writing: writing instructions-writing a short article.

UNIT V 12
Speaking: describing things relatively-describing clothing-discussing safety issues (making
recommendations) talking about electrical devices-describing controlling actions- Writing:
job application( Cover letter + Curriculum vitae)-writing recommendations.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
LEARNING OUTCOMES
CO1: Speak effectively in group discussions held in a formal/semi formal contexts.
CO2: Discuss, analyse and present concepts and problems from various perspectives to arrive at
suitable solutions
CO3: Write emails, letters and effective job applications.
CO4: Write critical reports to convey data and information with clarity and precision
CO5: Give appropriate instructions and recommendations for safe execution of tasks
Assessment Pattern
 One online / app based assessment to test speaking and writing skills
 Proficiency certification is given on successful completion of speaking and writing.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 2 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
2 2 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
3 2 2 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
4 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
5 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
AVg. 2.4 2.8 3 3 1.8 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
1-low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation
Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

MA3354 DISCRETE MATHEMATICS L T P C


3 1 0 4
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To extend student’s logical and mathematical maturity and ability to deal with abstraction.
 To introduce most of the basic terminologies used in computer science courses and
application of ideas to solve practical problems.
 To understand the basic concepts of combinatorics and graph theory.
 To familiarize the applications of algebraic structures.
 To understand the concepts and significance of lattices and boolean algebra which are
widely used in computer science and engineering.

54
UNIT I LOGIC AND PROOFS 9+3
Propositional logic – Propositional equivalences - Predicates and quantifiers – Nested quantifiers –
Rules of inference - Introduction to proofs – Proof methods and strategy.

UNIT II COMBINATORICS 9+3


Mathematical induction – Strong induction and well ordering – The basics of counting – The
pigeonhole principle – Permutations and combinations – Recurrence relations – Solving linear
recurrence relations – Generating functions – Inclusion and exclusion principle and its
applications.

UNIT III GRAPHS 9+3


Graphs and graph models – Graph terminology and special types of graphs – Matrix
representation of graphs and graph isomorphism – Connectivity – Euler and Hamilton paths.

UNIT IV ALGEBRAIC STRUCTURES 9+3


Algebraic systems – Semi groups and monoids - Groups – Subgroups – Homomorphism’s –
Normal subgroup and cosets – Lagrange’s theorem – Definitions and examples of Rings and
Fields.

UNIT V LATTICES AND BOOLEAN ALGEBRA 9+3


Partial ordering – Posets – Lattices as posets – Properties of lattices - Lattices as algebraic
systems – Sub lattices – Direct product and homomorphism – Some special lattices – Boolean
algebra – Sub Boolean Algebra – Boolean Homomorphism.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, students would :
CO1:Have knowledge of the concepts needed to test the logic of a program.
CO2:Have an understanding in identifying structures on many levels.
CO3:Be aware of a class of functions which transform a finite set into another finite set which
relates to input and output functions in computer science.
CO4:Be aware of the counting principles.
CO5:Be exposed to concepts and properties of algebraic structures such as groups, rings and
fields.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Rosen. K.H., "Discrete Mathematics and its Applications", 7th Edition, Tata McGraw
Hill Pub. Co. Ltd., New Delhi, Special Indian Edition, 2017.
2. Tremblay. J.P. and Manohar. R, "Discrete Mathematical Structures with Applications to
Computer Science", Tata McGraw Hill Pub. Co. Ltd, New Delhi, 30th Reprint, 2011.

REFERENCES:
1. Grimaldi. R.P. "Discrete and Combinatorial Mathematics: An Applied Introduction",
5thEdition, Pearson Education Asia, Delhi, 2013.
2. Koshy. T. "Discrete Mathematics with Applications", Elsevier Publications, 2006.
3. Lipschutz. S. and Mark Lipson., "Discrete Mathematics", Schaum’s Outlines, Tata McGraw
Hill Pub. Co. Ltd., New Delhi, 3rd Edition, 2010.

55
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 3 3 2 - - - - - - - - 2 - - -
2 3 3 - - - - - - - - - - - - -
3 - 3 2 - - 2 - - - 3 - - - - -
4 - 2 2 2 - - - - - - - - - - -
5 - 2 2 2 - - - - - 2 - - - - -
AVg. 1 3 2 1 - - - - - 1 - - - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CS3351 DIGITAL PRINCIPLES AND COMPUTER ORGANIZATION L T P C


3 0 2 4
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To analyze and design combinational circuits.
 To analyze and design sequential circuits
 To understand the basic structure and operation of a digital computer.
 To study the design of data path unit, control unit for processor and to familiarize with the
hazards.
 To understand the concept of various memories and I/O interfacing.

UNIT I COMBINATIONAL LOGIC 9


Combinational Circuits – Karnaugh Map - Analysis and Design Procedures – Binary Adder –
Subtractor – Decimal Adder - Magnitude Comparator – Decoder – Encoder – Multiplexers -
Demultiplexers

UNIT II SYNCHRONOUS SEQUENTIAL LOGIC 9


Introduction to Sequential Circuits – Flip-Flops – operation and excitation tables, Triggering of FF,
Analysis and design of clocked sequential circuits – Design – Moore/Mealy models, state
minimization, state assignment, circuit implementation - Registers – Counters.

UNIT III COMPUTER FUNDAMENTALS 9


Functional Units of a Digital Computer: Von Neumann Architecture – Operation and Operands of
Computer Hardware Instruction – Instruction Set Architecture (ISA): Memory Location, Address
and Operation – Instruction and Instruction Sequencing – Addressing Modes, Encoding of
Machine Instruction – Interaction between Assembly and High Level Language.

UNIT IV PROCESSOR 9
Instruction Execution – Building a Data Path – Designing a Control Unit – Hardwired Control,
Microprogrammed Control – Pipelining – Data Hazard – Control Hazards.

UNIT V MEMORY AND I/O 9


Memory Concepts and Hierarchy – Memory Management – Cache Memories: Mapping and
Replacement Techniques – Virtual Memory – DMA – I/O – Accessing I/O: Parallel and Serial
Interface – Interrupt I/O – Interconnection Standards: USB, SATA
45 PERIODS

56
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Verification of Boolean theorems using logic gates.
2. Design and implementation of combinational circuits using gates for arbitrary functions.
3. Implementation of 4-bit binary adder/subtractor circuits.
4. Implementation of code converters.
5. Implementation of BCD adder, encoder and decoder circuits
6. Implementation of functions using Multiplexers.
7. Implementation of the synchronous counters
8. Implementation of a Universal Shift register.
9. Simulator based study of Computer Architecture

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1 : Design various combinational digital circuits using logic gates
CO2 : Design sequential circuits and analyze the design procedures
CO3 : State the fundamentals of computer systems and analyze the execution of an instruction
CO4 : Analyze different types of control design and identify hazards
CO5 : Identify the characteristics of various memory systems and I/O communication
TOTAL:75 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. M. Morris Mano, Michael D. Ciletti, “Digital Design : With an Introduction to the Verilog HDL,
VHDL, and System Verilog”, Sixth Edition, Pearson Education, 2018.
2. David A. Patterson, John L. Hennessy, “Computer Organization and Design, The
Hardware/Software Interface”, Sixth Edition, Morgan Kaufmann/Elsevier, 2020.

REFERENCES
1. Carl Hamacher, Zvonko Vranesic, Safwat Zaky, Naraig Manjikian, “Computer Organization
and Embedded Systems”, Sixth Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2012.
2. William Stallings, “Computer Organization and Architecture – Designing for Performance”,
Tenth Edition, Pearson Education, 2016.
3. M. Morris Mano, “Digital Logic and Computer Design”, Pearson Education, 2016.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 1 2 3 2 3 3 2
2 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 1 2 2 1
3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 2 3 2 3 1 1
4 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 3 1 1
5 3 3 3 3 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 2 1 1
AVg. 3 3 3 3 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 2 1 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

57
CW3301 FUNDAMENTALS OF ECONOMICS L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To exemplify the demand curves of households and supply curves of firms with the
principles.
 To differentiate Price ceilings, Price floors and compare income effects, substitute effects
 To Analyze the Keynesian's process of multiplier theory in macro economics

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MICRO ECONOMICS 9


Introduction to Economics – Themes of Economics – Micro Vs Macro Economics- Demand curves
and supply curves- Elasticity of Demand - Elasticity of Supply- Demand Curves of Households and
firms

UNIT II WELFARE ANALYSIS 9


Consumers and Producers Surplus- Price Ceilings and Price Floors; Consumer Behavior - Axioms
of Choice-Budget Constraints and Indifference Curves; Consumers Equilibrium Effects of a Price
Change, Income and Substitution Effects Derivation of a Demand Curve

UNIT III PRODUCTION AND COST FUNCTION 9


Theory of Production - Production Function and Isoquants - Cost Minimization; Cost Curves -
Total, Average and Marginal Costs - Long Run and Short Run Costs; Equilibrium of a Firm under
Perfect Competition; Monopoly and Monopolistic Competition

UNIT IV MACRO ECONOMICS 9


National Income and its Components - GNP, NNP, GDP, NDP Consumption Function; Investment;
Simple Keynesian Model of Income Determination and the Keynesian Multiplier; Government
Sector -Taxes and Subsidies; External Sector - Exports and Imports; Money -Definitions; Demand
for Money Transaction and Speculative Demand; Supply of Money - Banks Credit Creation
Multiplier; Integrating Money and Commodity Markets - IS, LM Model

UNIT V BUSINESS CYCLES AND STABILIZATION 9


Monetary and Fiscal Policy - Central Bank and the Government; the Classical Paradigm - Price
and Wage Rigidities - Voluntary and Involuntary Unemployment.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: To analyze the supporting of price, income and substitution effects in the consumers and
producers surplus.
CO2: To compare the equilibrium of a firm under perfect competition, monopoly and monopolistic
competition.
CO3 : To study the concepts of demand for money and supply of money with appropriate model in
macro economic analysis.
CO4: To examine and evaluate the problems of voluntary and involuntary unemployment

TOTAL:45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Paul Anthony Samuelson, William D. Nordhaus, Economics, Nineteenth Edition, McGraw-
Hill Education, 2010.
2. N. Gregory Mankiw, Principles of Macroeconomics, Seventh Edition, Cengage Learning,
2018.
58
3. Pindyck, Robert S and Daniel L. Rubinfeld , Micro Economics, Eighth Edition, 2013.

REFERENCES
1. Dornbusch, Fischer and Startz, Macroeconomics, Tenth Edition, Tata Mcgraw Hill, 2012.
2. Hal R, Varia, Intermediate Microeconomics: A Modern Approach, Eighth Edition Affiliated
East-West Press, 2006

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 1 - - 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 - 2 -
2 3 3 1 - - 1 1 2 - - 2 - 3 - 2 -
3 3 3 1 - - 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 - 2 -
4 3 2 1 - - 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 - 2 -
5 3 3 1 - - 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 - 2 -
AVg. 3 3 1 - - 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 - 2 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CS3391 OBJECT ORIENTED PROGRAMMING L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand Object Oriented Programming concepts and basics of Java programming
language
 To know the principles of packages, inheritance and interfaces
 To develop a java application with threads and generics classes
 To define exceptions and use I/O streams
 To design and build Graphical User Interface Application using JAVAFX

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO OOP AND JAVA 9


Overview of OOP – Object oriented programming paradigms – Features of Object Oriented
Programming – Java Buzzwords – Overview of Java – Data Types, Variables and Arrays –
Operators – Control Statements – Programming Structures in Java – Defining classes in Java –
Constructors-Methods -Access specifiers - Static members- JavaDoc comments

UNIT II INHERITANCE, PACKAGES AND INTERFACES 9


Overloading Methods – Objects as Parameters – Returning Objects –Static, Nested and Inner
Classes. Inheritance: Basics– Types of Inheritance -Super keyword -Method Overriding – Dynamic
Method Dispatch –Abstract Classes – final with Inheritance. Packages and Interfaces: Packages –
Packages and Member Access –Importing Packages – Interfaces.

UNIT III EXCEPTION HANDLING AND MULTITHREADING 9


Exception Handling basics – Multiple catch Clauses – Nested try Statements – Java’s Built-in
Exceptions – User defined Exception. Multithreaded Programming: Java Thread Model–Creating a
Thread and Multiple Threads – Priorities – Synchronization – Inter Thread Communication-
Suspending –Resuming, and Stopping Threads –Multithreading. Wrappers – Auto boxing.

59
UNIT IV I/O, GENERICS, STRING HANDLING 9
I/O Basics – Reading and Writing Console I/O – Reading and Writing Files. Generics: Generic
Programming – Generic classes – Generic Methods – Bounded Types – Restrictions and
Limitations. Strings: Basic String class, methods and String Buffer Class..

UNIT V JAVAFX EVENT HANDLING, CONTROLS AND COMPONENTS 9


JAVAFX Events and Controls: Event Basics – Handling Key and Mouse Events. Controls:
Checkbox, ToggleButton – RadioButtons – ListView – ComboBox – ChoiceBox – Text Controls –
ScrollPane. Layouts – FlowPane – HBox and VBox – BorderPane – StackPane – GridPane.
Menus – Basics – Menu – Menu bars – MenuItem.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1:Apply the concepts of classes and objects to solve simple problems
CO2:Develop programs using inheritance, packages and interfaces
CO3:Make use of exception handling mechanisms and multithreaded model to solve real world
problems
CO4:Build Java applications with I/O packages, string classes, Collections and generics concepts
CO5:Integrate the concepts of event handling and JavaFX components and controls for
developing GUI based applications
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Herbert Schildt, “Java: The Complete Reference”, 11 th Edition, McGraw Hill Education, New
Delhi, 2019
2. Herbert Schildt, “Introducing JavaFX 8 Programming”, 1 st Edition, McGraw Hill Education, New
Delhi, 2015

REFERENCES:
1. Cay S. Horstmann, “Core Java Fundamentals”, Volume 1, 11 th Edition, Prentice Hall, 2018.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 1 - 3 2 1 2
2 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 - 3 2 2 2
3 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 1 - 3 1 1 2
4 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 3 - 3 2 1 2
5 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 - 3 2 1 2
AVg. 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 - 3 2 1.2 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

60
AD3351 DESIGN AND ANALYSIS OF ALGORITHMS L T P C
3 0 2 4
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To critically analyze the efficiency of alternative algorithmic solutions for the same problem
 To illustrate brute force and divide and conquer design techniques.
 To explain dynamic programming and greedy techniques for solving various problems.
 To apply iterative improvement technique to solve optimization problems
 To examine the limitations of algorithmic power and handling it in different problems.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 8
Notion of an Algorithm – Fundamentals of Algorithmic Problem Solving – Important Problem Types
–Fundamentals of the Analysis of Algorithm Efficiency – Analysis Framework - Asymptotic
Notations and their properties – Empirical analysis - Mathematical analysis of Recursive and Non-
recursive algorithms – Visualization.

UNIT II BRUTE FORCE AND DIVIDE AND CONQUER 10


Brute Force – String Matching - Exhaustive Search - Traveling Salesman Problem - Knapsack
Problem - Assignment problem. Divide and Conquer Methodology – Multiplication of Large
Integers and Strassen’s Matrix Multiplication – Closest-Pair and Convex - Hull Problems.
Decrease and Conquer: - Topological Sorting – Transform and Conquer: Presorting – Heaps and
Heap Sort.

UNIT III DYNAMIC PROGRAMMING AND GREEDY TECHNIQUE 10


Dynamic programming – Principle of optimality - Coin changing problem – Warshall’s and Floyd‘s
algorithms – Optimal Binary Search Trees - Multi stage graph - Knapsack Problem and Memory
functions. Greedy Technique – Dijkstra’s algorithm - Huffman Trees and codes - 0/1 Knapsack
problem.

UNIT IV ITERATIVE IMPROVEMENT 8


The Simplex Method-The Maximum-Flow Problem – Maximum Matching in Bipartite Graphs- The
Stable marriage Problem.

UNIT V LIMITATIONS OF ALGORITHM POWER 9


Lower - Bound Arguments - P, NP, NP- Complete and NP Hard Problems. Backtracking – N-
Queen problem - Hamiltonian Circuit Problem – Subset Sum Problem. Branch and Bound – LIFO
Search and FIFO search - Assignment problem – Knapsack Problem – Traveling Salesman
Problem - Approximation Algorithms for NP-Hard Problems – Traveling Salesman problem –
Knapsack problem.
45 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Implement recursive and non-recursive algorithms and study the order of growth from log2n
to n!.
2. Divide and Conquer - Strassen’s Matrix Multiplication
3. Decrease and Conquer - Topological Sorting
4. Transform and Conquer - Heap Sort

61
5. Dynamic programming - Coin change Problem, Warshall’s and Floyd‘s algorithms,
Knapsack Problem
6. Greedy Technique – Dijkstra’s algorithm, Huffman Trees and codes
7. Iterative improvement - Simplex Method
8. Backtracking – N-Queen problem, Subset Sum Problem
9. Branch and Bound - Assignment problem, Traveling Salesman Problem

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Analyze the efficiency of recursive and non-recursive algorithms mathematically
CO2: Analyze the efficiency of brute force, divide and conquer, decrease and conquer, Transform
and conquer algorithmic techniques
CO3: Implement and analyze the problems using dynamic programming and greedy algorithmic
techniques.
CO4: Solve the problems using iterative improvement techniques for optimization.
CO5: Compute the limitations of algorithmic power and solve the problems using backtracking and
branch and bound techniques.
TOTAL: 75 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Anany Levitin, Introduction to the Design and Analysis of Algorithms, Third Edition,
Pearson Education, 2012.
REFERENCES:
1. Ellis Horowitz, Sartaj Sahni and Sanguthevar Rajasekaran, Computer Algorithms/ C++,
Second Edition, Universities Press, 2019.
2. Thomas H.Cormen, Charles E.Leiserson, Ronald L. Rivest and Clifford Stein, Introduction
to Algorithms, Third Edition, PHI Learning Private Limited, 2012.
3. S. Sridhar, Design and Analysis of Algorithms, Oxford university press, 2014.
4. Alfred V. Aho, John E. Hopcroft and Jeffrey D. Ullman, Data Structures and Algorithms,
Pearson Education, Reprint 2006.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 2 - - 1 - - - - - 3 3 - 2
2 3 3 3 2 - - 1 - - - - - 3 2 - 2
3 3 3 3 2 - - 1 - - - - - 3 3 - 2
4 3 3 3 2 - - 1 - - - - - 2 3 - 2
5 3 3 3 2 - - 1 - - - - - 3 3 - 2
AVg. 3 3 3 2 - - 1 - - - - - 3 3 - 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

AD3491 FUNDAMENTALS OF DATA SCIENCE AND ANALYTICS LT PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the techniques and processes of data science
 To apply descriptive data analytics
62
 To visualize data for various applications
 To understand inferential data analytics
 To analysis and build predictive models from data

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO DATA SCIENCE 08


Need for data science – benefits and uses – facets of data – data science process – setting the
research goal – retrieving data – cleansing, integrating, and transforming data – exploratory data
analysis – build the models – presenting and building applications.

UNIT II DESCRIPTIVE ANALYTICS 10


Frequency distributions – Outliers –interpreting distributions – graphs – averages - describing
variability – interquartile range – variability for qualitative and ranked data - Normal distributions –
z scores –correlation – scatter plots – regression – regression line – least squares regression line
– standard error of estimate – interpretation of r2 – multiple regression equations – regression
toward the mean.

UNIT III INFERENTIAL STATISTICS 09


Populations – samples – random sampling – Sampling distribution- standard error of the mean -
Hypothesis testing – z-test – z-test procedure –decision rule – calculations – decisions –
interpretations - one-tailed and two-tailed tests – Estimation – point estimate – confidence interval
– level of confidence – effect of sample size.

UNIT IV ANALYSIS OF VARIANCE 09


t-test for one sample – sampling distribution of t – t-test procedure – t-test for two independent
samples – p-value – statistical significance – t-test for two related samples. F-test – ANOVA –
Two-factor experiments – three f-tests – two-factor ANOVA –Introduction to chi-square tests.

UNIT V PREDICTIVE ANALYTICS 09


Linear least squares – implementation – goodness of fit – testing a linear model – weighted
resampling. Regression using StatsModels – multiple regression – nonlinear relationships –
logistic regression – estimating parameters – Time series analysis – moving averages – missing
values – serial correlation – autocorrelation. Introduction to survival analysis.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon successful completion of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Explain the data analytics pipeline
CO2: Describe and visualize data
CO3 : Perform statistical inferences from data
CO4 : Analyze the variance in the data
CO5 : Build models for predictive analytics

TEXT BOOKS
1. David Cielen, Arno D. B. Meysman, and Mohamed Ali, “Introducing Data Science”, Manning
Publications, 2016. (first two chapters for Unit I).
2. Robert S. Witte and John S. Witte, “Statistics”, Eleventh Edition, Wiley Publications, 2017.
3. Jake VanderPlas, “Python Data Science Handbook”, O’Reilly, 2016.

REFERENCES
1. Allen B. Downey, “Think Stats: Exploratory Data Analysis in Python”, Green Tea Press,
2014.
63
2. Sanjeev J. Wagh, Manisha S. Bhende, Anuradha D. Thakare, “Fundamentals of Data
Science”, CRC Press, 2022.
3. Chirag Shah, “A Hands-On Introduction to Data Science”, Cambridge University Press,
2020.
4. Vineet Raina, Srinath Krishnamurthy, “Building an Effective Data Science Practice: A
Framework to Bootstrap and Manage a Successful Data Science Practice”, Apress, 2021.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 1 1
2 3 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 1 1
3 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 1 1
4 3 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 1 1
5 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 1 1
AVg. 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 1 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3311 BUSINESS COMMUNICATION LABORATORY I L T P C


0 0 3 1.5

COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To enhance students’ overall communication and their interpersonal skills by engaging
them in group activities so that they could excel in their career pursuits.
 To improve the students’ fluency level in the English language by enriching their diction
and articulation so that they could effectively present themselves in their workplaces.

LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
1. Business terminology
2. Interpersonal Skills: Dialogue & Conversation
3. Job Application
4. Letters & Reports
5. SWOT analysis
6. Team vs Group
7. Conflict management
8. Acquiring Leadership traits
9. Women in all spheres
10. Human values and Corporate culture
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:Speak fluently in English without errors and present themselves as effective
communicators.
CO2:Use business vocabulary and take part comfortably in business conversations in English.
CO3:Draft letters and reports with appropriate formats and choice of words.
CO4:Perform well in team and group, resolve conflicts in workplaces and acquire leadership skills.

64
CO5:Understand women in all spheres and cultural behaviours of the people and approach them
with positive human values.

List of Equipments:(30 Students per Batch)


1: Systems with Rosetta stone and Globarena

REFERENCES:
1. Business Communication, Dr. Saroj Hire math
2. English vocabulary in use , Alan McCarthy and O’Dell
3. Strategic Writing by Charles Marsh
4. he Seven Basic Plots by Christopher Booker

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 2 - 1 2 1 1 -
2 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 2 - 1 2 1 1 -
3 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 2 - 1 2 1 1 -
4 3 2 2 - - - - - 3 3 - 1 2 1 1 -
5 3 2 2 - - - - - 3 3 - 1 2 1 1 -
AVg. 3 2 2 - - - - - 2 2 - 1 2 1 1 -

CS3381 OBJECT ORIENTED PROGRAMMING LABORATORY L T P C


0 0 3 1.5
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To build software development skills using java programming for real-world applications.
 To understand and apply the concepts of classes, packages, interfaces, inheritance,
exception handling and file processing.
 To develop applications using generic programming and event handling

LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Solve problems by using sequential search, binary search, and quadratic sorting algorithms
(selection, insertion)
2. Develop stack and queue data structures using classes and objects.
3. Develop a java application with an Employee class with Emp_name, Emp_id, Address,
Mail_id, Mobile_no as members. Inherit the classes, Programmer, Assistant Professor,
Associate Professor and Professor from employee class. Add Basic Pay (BP) as the
member of all the inherited classes with 97% of BP as DA, 10 % of BP as HRA, 12% of
BP as PF, 0.1% of BP for staff club funds. Generate pay slips for the employees with their
gross and net salary.
4. Write a Java Program to create an abstract class named Shape that contains two integers
and an empty method named printArea(). Provide three classes named Rectangle,
Triangle and Circle such that each one of the classes extends the class Shape. Each one
of the classes contains only the method printArea( ) that prints the area of the given shape.
5. Solve the above problem using an interface.
6. Implement exception handling and creation of user defined exceptions.

65
7. Write a java program that implements a multi-threaded application that has three
threads. First thread generates a random integer every 1 second and if the value is
even, the second thread computes the square of the number and prints. If the value is odd,
the third thread will print the value of the cube of the number.
8. Write a program to perform file operations.
9. Develop applications to demonstrate the features of generics classes.
10. Develop applications using JavaFX controls, layouts and menus.
11. Develop a mini project for any application using Java concepts.
Lab Requirements: for a batch of 30 students
Operating Systems: Linux / Windows
Front End Tools: Eclipse IDE / Netbeans IDE
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1 : Design and develop java programs using object oriented programming concepts
CO2 : Develop simple applications using object oriented concepts such as package, exceptions
CO4 : Create GUIs and event driven programming applications for real world problems
CO3: Implement multithreading, and generics concepts
CO5: Implement and deploy web applications using Java

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 2 1 2 1 - - - - 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 2
2 2 1 3 1 - - - - 2 3 3 2 1 3 1 2
3 2 2 1 2 1 - - - 1 2 1 3 2 3 2 2
4 2 2 1 3 - - - - 3 1 1 1 2 1 2 2
5 1 3 3 1 3 - - - 1 1 1 1 2 1 2 2
AVg. 2 2 2 2 2 - - - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2

GE3361 PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT LTPC


0 021

COURSE OBJECTIVES:

To be proficient in important Microsoft Office tools: MS WORD, EXCEL, POWERPOINT.

 To be proficient in using MS WORD to create quality technical documents, by using


standard templates, widely acceptable styles and formats, variety of features to enhance
the presentability and overall utility value of content.
 To be proficient in using MS EXCEL for all data manipulation tasks including the common
statistical, logical, mathematical etc., operations, conversion, analytics, search and explore,
visualize,interlink, and utilizing many more critical features offered

 To be able to create and share quality presentations by using the features of MS


PowerPoint, including: organization of content, presentability, aesthetics, using media
elements and enhance the overall quality of presentations.
66
MS WORD: 10 Hours
Create and format a document
Working with tables
Working with Bullets and Lists
Working with styles, shapes, smart art, charts
Inserting objects, charts and importing objects from other office tools
Creating and Using document templates
Inserting equations, symbols and special characters
Working with Table of contents and References, citations
Insert and review comments
Create bookmarks, hyperlinks, endnotes footnote
Viewing document in different modes
Working with document protection and security
Inspect document for accessibility

MS EXCEL: 10 Hours

Create worksheets, insert and format data

Work with different types of data: text, currency, date, numeric etc.

Split, validate, consolidate, Convert data

Sort and filter data

Perform calculations and use functions: (Statistical, Logical, Mathematical, date, Time etc.,)

Work with Lookup and reference formulae

Create and Work with different types of charts

Use pivot tables to summarize and analyse data

Perform data analysis using own formulae and functions

Combine data from multiple worksheets using own formulae and built-in functions to generate
results

Export data and sheets to other file formats

Working with macros

Protecting data and Securing the workbook

MS POWERPOINT: 10 Hours

Select slide templates, layout and themes

67
Formatting slide content and using bullets and numbering

Insert and format images, smart art, tables, charts

Using Slide master, notes and handout master

Working with animation and transitions

Organize and Group slides

Import or create and use media objects: audio, video, animation

Perform slideshow recording and Record narration and create presentable videos

TOTAL: 30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion the students will be able to
CO1:Use MS Word to create quality documents, by structuring and organizing content for their day
to day technical and academic requirements
CO2:Use MS EXCEL to perform data operations and analytics, record, retrieve data as per
requirements and visualize data for ease of understanding
CO3:Use MS PowerPoint to create high quality academic presentations by including common
tables, charts, graphs, interlinking other elements, and using media objects.

MA3391 PROBABILITY AND STATISTICS L T P C


3 1 0 4

COURSE OBJECTIVES
 This course aims at providing the required skill to apply the statistical tools in engineering
problems.
 To introduce the basic concepts of probability and random variables.
 To introduce the basic concepts of two dimensional random variables.
 To acquaint the knowledge of testing of hypothesis for small and large samples which
plays an important role in real life problems.
 To introduce the basic concepts of classifications of design of experiments which plays
very important roles in the field of agriculture and statistical quality control.

UNIT I PROBABILITY AND RANDOM VARIABLES 9+3
Axioms of probability – Conditional probability – Baye’s theorem - Discrete and continuous random
variables – Moments – Moment generating functions – Binomial, Poisson, Geometric, Uniform,
Exponential and Normal distributions – Functions of a random variable.

UNIT II TWO- DIMENSIONAL RANDOM VARIABLES 9+3


Joint distributions – Marginal and conditional distributions – Covariance – Correlation and linear
regression – Transformation of random variables – Central limit theorem (for independent and
identically distributed random variables).

UNIT III ESTIMATION THEORY 9+3


Unbiased estimators - Efficiency - Consistency - Sufficiency - Robustness - Method of moments -
Method of maximum Likelihood - Interval estimation of Means - Differences between means,
68
variations and ratio of two variances

UNIT IV NON- PARAMETRIC TESTS 9+3


Introduction - The Sign test - The Signed - Rank test - Rank - sum tests - The U test - The H test
- Tests based on Runs - Test of randomness - The Kolmogorov Tests .

UNIT V STATISTICAL QUALITY CONTROL 9+3


Control charts for measurements ( 𝑋̅ and R charts ) – Control charts for attributes ( p, c and np
charts) – Tolerance limits - Acceptance sampling.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon successful completion of the course, students will be able to:
CO1:Understand the fundamental knowledge of the concepts of probability and have knowledge of
standard distributions which can describe real life phenomenon.
CO2:Understand the basic concepts of one and two dimensional random variables and apply in
engineering applications.
CO3:Apply the concept of testing of hypothesis for small and large samples in real life problems.
CO4:Apply the basic concepts of classifications of design of experiments in the field of agriculture
and statistical quality control.
CO5:Have the notion of sampling distributions and statistical techniques used in engineering and
management problems.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Johnson. R.A., Miller. I.R and Freund . J.E, " Miller and Freund’s Probability and Statistics
for Engineers", Pearson Education, Asia, 9th Edition, 2016.
2. Milton. J. S. and Arnold. J.C., "Introduction to Probability and Statistics", Tata McGraw Hill,
4th Edition, 2007.
3. John E. Freund, "Mathematical Statistics", Prentice Hall, 5th Edition, 1992.
REFERENCES:
1. Gupta. S.C. and Kapoor. V. K., “Fundamentals of Mathematical Statistics”, Sultan Chand
& Sons, New Delhi, 12th Edition, 2020.
2. Devore. J.L., "Probability and Statistics for Engineering and the Sciences”, Cengage
Learning, New Delhi, 8th Edition, 2014.
3. Ross. S.M., "Introduction to Probability and Statistics for Engineers and Scientists",
5thEdition, Elsevier, 2014.
4. Spiegel. M.R., Schiller. J. and Srinivasan. R.A., "Schaum’s Outline of Theory and Problems
of Probability and Statistics", Tata McGraw Hill Edition, 4th Edition, 2012.
5. Walpole. R.E., Myers. R.H., Myers. S.L. and Ye. K., "Probability and Statistics for
Engineers and Scientists", Pearson Education, Asia, 9th Edition, 2010.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
CO2 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
CO3 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
CO4 3 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
CO5 3 3 2 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
AVG 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation
69
CS3492 DATABASE MANAGEMENT SYSTEMS L T P C
3 0 0 3
COUSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn the fundamentals of data models, relational algebra and SQL
 To represent a database system using ER diagrams and to learn normalization techniques
 To understand the fundamental concepts of transaction, concurrency and recovery
processing
 To understand the internal storage structures using different file and indexing techniques
which will help in physical DB design
 To have an introductory knowledge about the Distributed databases, NOSQL and database
security

UNIT I RELATIONAL DATABASES 10


Purpose of Database System – Views of data – Data Models – Database System Architecture –
Introduction to relational databases – Relational Model – Keys – Relational Algebra – SQL
fundamentals – Advanced SQL features – Embedded SQL– Dynamic SQL

UNIT II DATABASE DESIGN 8


Entity-Relationship model – E-R Diagrams – Enhanced-ER Model – ER-to-Relational Mapping –
Functional Dependencies – Non-loss Decomposition – First, Second, Third Normal Forms,
Dependency Preservation – Boyce/Codd Normal Form – Multi-valued Dependencies and Fourth
Normal Form – Join Dependencies and Fifth Normal Form

UNIT III TRANSACTIONS 9


Transaction Concepts – ACID Properties – Schedules – Serializability – Transaction support in
SQL – Need for Concurrency – Concurrency control –Two Phase Locking- Timestamp –
Multiversion – Validation and Snapshot isolation– Multiple Granularity locking – Deadlock Handling
– Recovery Concepts – Recovery based on deferred and immediate update – Shadow paging –
ARIES Algorithm
UNIT IV IMPLEMENTATION TECHNIQUES 9
RAID – File Organization – Organization of Records in Files – Data dictionary Storage – Column
Oriented Storage– Indexing and Hashing –Ordered Indices – B+ tree Index Files – B tree Index
Files – Static Hashing – Dynamic Hashing – Query Processing Overview – Algorithms for
Selection, Sorting and join operations – Query optimization using Heuristics - Cost Estimation.

UNIT V ADVANCED TOPICS 9


Distributed Databases: Architecture, Data Storage, Transaction Processing, Query processing and
optimization – NOSQL Databases: Introduction – CAP Theorem – Document Based systems –
Key value Stores – Column Based Systems – Graph Databases. Database Security: Security
issues – Access control based on privileges – Role Based access control – SQL Injection –
Statistical Database security – Flow control – Encryption and Public Key infrastructures –
Challenges

COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1:Construct SQL Queries using relational algebra
CO2:Design database using ER model and normalize the database

70
CO3: Construct queries to handle transaction processing and maintain consistency of the
database
CO4: Compare and contrast various indexing strategies and apply the knowledge to tune the
performance of the database
CO5: Appraise how advanced databases differ from Relational Databases and find a suitable
database for the given requirement.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Abraham Silberschatz, Henry F. Korth, S. Sudharshan, “Database System Concepts”,
Seventh Edition, McGraw Hill, 2020.
2. Ramez Elmasri, Shamkant B. Navathe, “Fundamentals of Database Systems”, Seventh
Edition, Pearson Education, 2017

REFERENCES:
1. C.J.Date, A.Kannan, S.Swamynathan, “An Introduction to Database Systems”, Eighth
Edition, Pearson Education, 2006.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 3 3 3 -
2 3 2 1 1 2 - - - - - - - 3 3 3 -
3 3 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 3 3 3 -
4 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - - 3 3 3 -
5 3 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 3 3 3 -
AVg. 3 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 3 3 3 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

AL3452 OPERATING SYSTEMS L T PC


3 0 2 4
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basics and functions of operating systems.
 To understand Processes and Threads
 To analyze Scheduling algorithms and process synchronization.
 To understand the concept of Deadlocks.
 To analyze various memory management schemes.
 To be familiar with I/O management and File systems.
 To be familiar with the basics of virtual machines and Mobile OS like iOS and Android.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 7
Computer System - Elements and organization; Operating System Overview - Objectives and
Functions - Evolution of Operating System; Operating System Structures – Operating System
Services - User Operating System Interface - System Calls – System Programs - Design and
Implementation - Structuring methods.

71
UNIT II PROCESS MANAGEMENT 11
Processes - Process Concept - Process Scheduling - Operations on Processes - Inter-process
Communication; CPU Scheduling - Scheduling criteria - Scheduling algorithms: Threads -
Multithread Models – Threading issues; Process Synchronization - The critical-section problem -
Synchronization hardware – Semaphores – Mutex - Classical problems of synchronization -
Monitors; Deadlock - Methods for handling deadlocks, Deadlock prevention, Deadlock avoidance,
Deadlock detection, Recovery from deadlock.

UNIT III MEMORY MANAGEMENT 10


Main Memory - Swapping - Contiguous Memory Allocation – Paging - Structure of the Page Table
- Segmentation, Segmentation with paging; Virtual Memory - Demand Paging – Copy on Write -
Page Replacement - Allocation of Frames –Thrashing.

UNIT IV STORAGE MANAGEMENT 10


Mass Storage system – Disk Structure - Disk Scheduling and Management; File-System Interface
- File concept - Access methods - Directory Structure - Directory organization - File system
mounting - File Sharing and Protection; File System Implementation - File System Structure -
Directory implementation - Allocation Methods - Free Space Management; I/O Systems – I/O
Hardware, Application I/O interface, Kernel I/O subsystem.

UNIT V VIRTUAL MACHINES AND MOBILE OS 7


Virtual Machines – History, Benefits and Features, Building Blocks, Types of Virtual Machines and
their Implementations, Virtualization and Operating-System Components; Mobile OS - iOS and
Android.

45 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Installation of Operating system : Windows/ Linux
2. Illustrate UNIX commands and Shell Programming
3. Process Management using System Calls : Fork, Exec, Getpid, Exit, Wait, Close
4. Write C programs to implement the various CPU Scheduling Algorithms
5. Illustrate the inter process communication strategy
6. Implement mutual exclusion by Semaphores
7. Write a C program to avoid Deadlock using Banker's Algorithm
8. Write a C program to Implement Deadlock Detection Algorithm
9. Write C program to implement Threading
10. Implement the paging Technique using C program
11. Write C programs to implement the following Memory Allocation Methods
a. First Fit b. Worst Fit c. Best Fit
12. Write C programs to implement the various Page Replacement Algorithms
13. Write C programs to Implement the various File Organization Techniques
14. Implement the following File Allocation Strategies using C programs
a. Sequential b. Indexed c. Linked
15. Write C programs for the implementation of various disk scheduling algorithms

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Analyze various scheduling algorithms and process synchronization.
CO2 : Explain deadlock, prevention and avoidance algorithms.
72
CO3 : Compare and contrast various memory management schemes.
CO4 : Explain the functionality of file systems I/O systems, and Virtualization
CO5 : Compare iOS and Android Operating Systems.
TOTAL:75 PERIODS
TEXTBOOKS
1. Abraham Silberschatz, Peter Baer Galvin and Greg Gagne, “Operating System
Concepts”, 9th Edition, John Wiley and Sons Inc., 2018.
2. Andrew S Tanenbaum, "Modern Operating Systems", Pearson, 4th Edition, New Delhi,
2016.

REFERENCES
1. Ramaz Elmasri, A. Gil Carrick, David Levine, “Operating Systems – A Spiral Approach”,
Tata McGraw Hill Edition, 2010.
2. William Stallings, "Operating Systems: Internals and Design Principles", 7th Edition, Prentice
Hall, 2018.
3. Achyut S.Godbole, Atul Kahate, “Operating Systems”, McGraw Hill Education, 2016.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 1 - 2 - - 2 - - 2 3 3 - -
2 3 3 3 3 - 2 - - 2 - - 2 3 3 - -
3 3 3 3 3 - 2 - - 2 - - 2 3 3 - -
4 3 3 3 2 - 2 - - 2 - - 2 3 3 - -
5 3 3 3 3 - 2 - - 2 - - 2 3 3 - -
AVg. 3 3 3 2 - 2 - - 2 - - 2 3 3 - -

CW3401 INTRODUCTION TO BUSINESS SYSTEMS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To develop and strengthen business quality and motivation in students
 To impart basic business skills
 To understanding to run a business efficiently and effectively.

UNIT I OVERVIEW OF BUSINESS SYSTEM 9


Business environmental factors - Internal and External. System approach of management Process
- Input for the business, Transformational process and output. Objectives of the business system.
System model of business management. Management functions – Planning, Organising, Staffing,
Directing and Controlling.

UNIT II OUTLINE OF BUSINESS ORGANIZATION 9


Types of Business organization - Sole proprietorship, partnership, company-public and private
sector enterprises, Multinational and Global companies. Managing Global environment.
Management levels and types.

UNIT III FUNCTIONS OF BUSINESS 9


Functions and Objectives – Production, Marketing, Finance, Human Resource, quality control and
Research & development.

73
UNIT IV MEASURING BUSINESS PERFORMANCE AND CONTROL PROCESS 9
Key performance indicators. Financial statement analysis- Cash flow analysis, ROI, working
capital, cost volume profit analysis. Customer - satisfaction Retention and acquisition. Employee
Performance - Benchmarking, employee retention. Controlling Techniques - Budgetary and Non-
Budgetary control measures

UNIT V COMPUTER APPLICATIONS IN BUSINESS 9


Introduction to business Software- Enterprise application and Business application. Overview on
types of Business software. ERP. Business Intelligence, e-business and e-governance.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: To demonstrate and strengthen business quality and motivation in students
CO2: Examine basic business skills and measuring business performance
CO3: To demonstrate business Applications using business software
CO4: Apply Enterprise application and Business application
CO5: Use Business Intelligence in e-business for marketing and sales.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOK
1. Harold Koontz, Heinz Weihrich, Mark V. Cannice, “Essentials of Management”, Tata
McGraw-Hill, 11th Edition, 2020
2. Stephen P. Robbins and David A. Decenzo, “Fundamentals of Management”, Pearson
Education,8th Edition, 2012.

REFERENCES
1. James A. O’Brien, “Management Information Systems: Managing Information Technology
in the Business Enterprise”, Tata McGraw Hill, 2004.
2. Corey Schou and Dan Shoemaker, “Information Assurance for the Enterprise: A Roadmap
to Information Security”, Tata McGraw Hill, 2007.
3. Bateman Snell, “Management: Competing in the new era”, McGraw-Hill Irwin, 5th
Edition,2002.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 3 2 2 1
2 3 3 3 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 3 2 2 1
3 3 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 3 2 2 1
4 3 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 3 2 2 1
5 3 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 3 2 2 1
AVg. 3 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 3 2 2 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

74
AL3451 MACHINE LEARNING L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basic concepts of machine learning.
 To understand and build supervised learning models.
 To understand and build unsupervised learning models.
 To evaluate the algorithms based on corresponding metrics identified

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MACHINE LEARNING 8


Review of Linear Algebra for machine learning; Introduction and motivation for machine learning;
Examples of machine learning applications, Vapnik-Chervonenkis (VC) dimension, Probably
Approximately Correct (PAC) learning, Hypothesis spaces, Inductive bias, Generalization, Bias
variance trade-off.

UNIT II SUPERVISED LEARNING 11


Linear Regression Models: Least squares, single & multiple variables, Bayesian linear regression,
gradient descent, Linear Classification Models: Discriminant function – Perceptron algorithm,
Probabilistic discriminative model - Logistic regression, Probabilistic generative model – Naive
Bayes, Maximum margin classifier – Support vector machine, Decision Tree, Random Forests

UNIT III ENSEMBLE TECHNIQUES AND UNSUPERVISED LEARNING 9


Combining multiple learners: Model combination schemes, Voting, Ensemble Learning - bagging,
boosting, stacking, Unsupervised learning: K-means, Instance Based Learning: KNN, Gaussian
mixture models and Expectation maximization.

UNIT IV NEURAL NETWORKS 9


Multilayer perceptron, activation functions, network training – gradient descent optimization –
stochastic gradient descent, error backpropagation, from shallow networks to deep networks –Unit
saturation (aka the vanishing gradient problem) – ReLU, hyperparameter tuning, batch
normalization, regularization, dropout.

UNIT V DESIGN AND ANALYSIS OF MACHINE LEARNING EXPERIMENTS 8


Guidelines for machine learning experiments, Cross Validation (CV) and resampling – K-fold CV,
bootstrapping, measuring classifier performance, assessing a single classification algorithm and
comparing two classification algorithms – t test, McNemar’s test, K-fold CV paired t test

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Explain the basic concepts of machine learning.
CO2 : Construct supervised learning models.
CO3 : Construct unsupervised learning algorithms.
CO4: Evaluate and compare different models
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
TEXTBOOKS:
1. Ethem Alpaydin, “Introduction to Machine Learning”, MIT Press, Fourth Edition, 2020.
2. Stephen Marsland, “Machine Learning: An Algorithmic Perspective, “Second Edition”,
CRC Press, 2014.

75
REFERENCES
1. Christopher M. Bishop, “Pattern Recognition and Machine Learning”, Springer, 2006.
2. Tom Mitchell, “Machine Learning”, McGraw Hill, 3rd Edition, 1997.
3. Mehryar Mohri, Afshin Rostamizadeh, Ameet Talwalkar, “Foundations of Machine
Learning”, Second Edition, MIT Press, 2012, 2018.
4. Ian Goodfellow, Yoshua Bengio, Aaron Courville, “Deep Learning”, MIT Press, 2016
5. Sebastain Raschka, Vahid Mirjalili , “Python Machine Learning”, Packt publishing 3rd
Edition, 2019.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 2 -
2 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 2 -
3 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 2 -
4 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 2 -
5 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 2 -
AVg. 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 3 3 2 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

GE3451 ENVIRONMENTAL SCIENCES AND SUSTAINABILITY L T PC


2 0 0 2

COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the basic concepts of environment, ecosystems and biodiversity and
emphasize on the biodiversity of India and its conservation.
 To impart knowledge on the causes, effects and control or prevention measures of
environmental pollution and natural disasters.
 To facilitate the understanding of global and Indian scenario of renewable and
nonrenewable resources, causes of their degradation and measures to preserve them.
 To familiarize the concept of sustainable development goals and appreciate the
interdependence of economic and social aspects of sustainability, recognize and analyze
climate changes, concept of carbon credit and the challenges of environmental
management.
 To inculcate and embrace sustainability practices and develop a broader understanding on
green materials, energy cycles and analyze the role of sustainable urbanization.

UNIT I ENVIRONMENT AND BIODIVERSITY 6


Definition, scope and importance of environment – need for public awareness. Eco-system and
Energy flow– ecological succession. Types of biodiversity: genetic, species and ecosystem
diversity– values of biodiversity, India as a mega-diversity nation – hot-spots of biodiversity –
threats to biodiversity: habitat loss, poaching of wildlife, man-wildlife conflicts – endangered and
endemic species of India – conservation of biodiversity: In-situ and ex-situ.

76
UNIT II ENVIRONMENTAL POLLUTION 9
Causes, Effects and Preventive measures of Water, Soil, Air and Noise Pollutions.
Solid, Hazardous and E-Waste management. Case studies on Occupational Health and Safety
Management system (OHASMS). Environmental protection, Environmental protection acts .

UNIT III RENEWABLE SOURCES OF ENERGY 6


Energy management and conservation, New Energy Sources: Need of new sources. Different
types new energy sources. Applications of- Hydrogen energy, Ocean energy resources, Tidal
energy conversion. Concept, origin and power plants of geothermal energy.

UNIT IV SUSTAINABILITY AND MANAGEMENT 6


Development , GDP ,Sustainability- concept, needs and challenges-economic, social and aspects
of sustainability-from unsustainability to sustainability-millennium development goals, and
protocols-Sustainable Development Goals-targets, indicators and intervention areas Climate
change- Global, Regional and local environmental issues and possible solutions-case studies.
Concept of Carbon Credit, Carbon Footprint. Environmental management in industry-A case study.

UNIT V SUSTAINABILITY PRACTICES 6


Zero waste and R concept, Circular economy, ISO 14000 Series, Material Life cycle assessment,
Environmental Impact Assessment. Sustainable habitat: Green buildings, Green materials, Energy
efficiency, Sustainable transports. Sustainable energy: Non-conventional Sources, Energy Cycles-
carbon cycle, emission and sequestration, Green Engineering: Sustainable urbanization- Socio-
economical and technological change.
TOTAL: 30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:To recognize and understand the functions of environment, ecosystems and biodiversity and
their conservation.
CO2:To identify the causes, effects of environmental pollution and natural disasters and contribute
to the preventive measures in the society.
CO3:To identify and apply the understanding of renewable and non-renewable resources and
contribute to the sustainable measures to preserve them for future generations.
CO4:To recognize the different goals of sustainable development and apply them for suitable
technological advancement and societal development.
CO5:To demonstrate the knowledge of sustainability practices and identify green materials, energy
cycles and the role of sustainable urbanization.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Anubha Kaushik and C. P. Kaushik’s “Perspectives in Environmental Studies”, 6th Edition,
New Age International Publishers ,2018.
2. Benny Joseph, ‘Environmental Science and Engineering’, Tata McGraw-Hill, New Delhi,
2016.
3. Gilbert M.Masters, ‘Introduction to Environmental Engineering and Science’, 2nd edition,
Pearson Education, 2004.
4. Allen, D. T. and Shonnard, D. R., Sustainability Engineering: Concepts, Design and Case
Studies, Prentice Hall.
5. Bradley. A.S; Adebayo, A.O., Maria, P. Engineering applications in sustainable design and
development, Cengage learning.
77
6. Environment Impact Assessment Guidelines, Notification of Government of India, 2006.
7. Mackenthun, K.M., Basic Concepts in Environmental Management, Lewis Publication,
London, 1998.
REFERENCES :
1. R.K. Trivedi, ‘Handbook of Environmental Laws, Rules, Guidelines, Compliances and
Standards’, Vol. I and II, Enviro Media. 38 . edition 2010.
2. Cunningham, W.P. Cooper, T.H. Gorhani, ‘Environmental Encyclopedia’, Jaico Publ.,
House, Mumbai, 2001.
3. Dharmendra S. Sengar, ‘Environmental law’, Prentice hall of India PVT. LTD, New Delhi,
2007.
4. Rajagopalan, R, ‘Environmental Studies-From Crisis to Cure’, Oxford University Press,
Third Edition, 2015.
5. Erach Bharucha “Textbook of Environmental Studies for Undergraduate Courses” Orient
Blackswan Pvt. Ltd. 2013.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO PSO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 1 - - - 2 3 - - - - 2 - - -
2 3 2 - - - 3 3 - - - - 2 - - -
3 3 - 1 - - 2 2 - - - - 2 - - -
4 3 2 1 1 - 2 2 - - - - 2 - - -
5 3 2 1 - - 2 2 - - - - 1 - - -
Avg. 2.8 1.8 1 1 - 2.2 2.4 - - - - 1.8 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CS3481 DATABASE MANAGEMENT SYSTEMS LABORATORY L T P C


0 0 3 1.5
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn and implement important commands in SQL.
 To learn the usage of nested and joint queries.
 To understand functions, procedures and procedural extensions of databases.
 To understand design and implementation of typical database applications.
 To be familiar with the use of a front end tool for GUI based application development.

LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
1. Create a database table, add constraints (primary key, unique, check, Not null), insert
rows, update and delete rows using SQL DDL and DML commands.
2. Create a set of tables, add foreign key constraints and incorporate referential integrity.
3. Query the database tables using different ‘where’ clause conditions and also implement
aggregate functions.
4. Query the database tables and explore sub queries and simple join operations.
5. Query the database tables and explore natural, equi and outer joins.
6. Write user defined functions and stored procedures in SQL.
7. Execute complex transactions and realize DCL and TCL commands.
8. Write SQL Triggers for insert, delete, and update operations in a database table.
9. Create View and index for database tables with a large number of records.
10. Create an XML database and validate it using XML schema.
78
11. Create Document, column and graph based data using NOSQL database tools.
12. Develop a simple GUI based database application and incorporate all the above-
mentioned features
13. Case Study using any of the real life database applications from the following list
a) Inventory Management for a EMart Grocery Shop
b) Society Financial Management
c) Cop Friendly App – Eseva
d) Property Management – eMall
e) Star Small and Medium Banking and Finance
 Build Entity Model diagram. The diagram should align with the business and
functional goals stated in the application.
 Apply Normalization rules in designing the tables in scope.
 Prepared applicable views, triggers (for auditing purposes), functions for
enabling enterprise grade features.
 Build PL SQL / Stored Procedures for Complex Functionalities, ex EOD Batch
Processing for calculating the EMI for Gold Loan for each eligible Customer.
● Ability to showcase ACID Properties with sample queries with appropriate
settings

List of Equipments:(30 Students per Batch)


MYSQL / SQL : 30 Users
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Create databases with different types of key constraints.
CO2: Construct simple and complex SQL queries using DML and DCL commands.
CO3: Use advanced features such as stored procedures and triggers and incorporate in
GUI based application development.
CO4: Create an XML database and validate with meta-data (XML schema).
CO5: Create and manipulate data using NOSQL database.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 - 2 3 3 2 2
2 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 - 2 3 3 2 2
3 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 - 2 3 3 2 2
4 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 - 2 3 3 2 2
5 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 - 2 3 3 2 2
AVg. 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 - 2 3 3 2 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

79
AD3461 MACHINE LEARNING LABORATORY L T PC
0 0 4 2
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the data sets and apply suitable algorithms for selecting the appropriate
features for analysis.
 To learn to implement supervised machine learning algorithms on standard datasets and
evaluate the performance.
 To experiment the unsupervised machine learning algorithms on standard datasets and
evaluate the performance.
 To build the graph based learning models for standard data sets.
 To compare the performance of different ML algorithms and select the suitable one based
on the application.

LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
1. For a given set of training data examples stored in a .CSV file, implement and demonstrate
the Candidate-Elimination algorithm to output a description of the set of all hypotheses
consistent with the training examples.
2. Write a program to demonstrate the working of the decision tree based ID3 algorithm. Use
an appropriate data set for building the decision tree and apply this knowledge to classify a
new sample.
3. Build an Artificial Neural Network by implementing the Backpropagation algorithm and
test the same using appropriate data sets.
4. Write a program to implement the naïve Bayesian classifier for a sample training data set
stored as a .CSV file and compute the accuracy with a few test data sets.
5. Implement naïve Bayesian Classifier model to classify a set of documents and
measure the accuracy, precision, and recall.
6. Write a program to construct a Bayesian network to diagnose CORONA infection using
standard WHO Data Set.
7. Apply EM algorithm to cluster a set of data stored in a .CSV file. Use the same data set for
clustering using the k-Means algorithm. Compare the results of these two algorithms.
8. Write a program to implement k-Nearest Neighbour algorithm to classify the iris data set.
Print both correct and wrong predictions.
9. Implement the non-parametric Locally Weighted Regression algorithm in order to fit
data points. Select an appropriate data set for your experiment and draw graphs.

List of Equipments:(30 Students per Batch)


The programs can be implemented in either Python or R.
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1:Apply suitable algorithms for selecting the appropriate features for analysis.
CO2:Implement supervised machine learning algorithms on standard datasets and evaluate the
performance.
CO3:Apply unsupervised machine learning algorithms on standard datasets and evaluate the
performance.
CO4:Build the graph based learning models for standard data sets.
CO5:Assess and compare the performance of different ML algorithms and select the suitable one
based on the application.
80
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - 2 2 1 2 3 3 2 2
2 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - 2 2 1 2 3 3 2 2
3 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - 2 2 1 2 3 3 2 2
4 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - 2 2 1 2 3 3 2 2
5 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - 2 2 1 2 3 3 2 2
Avg. 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - 2 2 1 2 3 3 2 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3411 BUSINESS COMMUNICATION LABORATORY II L T P C


0 0 3 1.5
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To augment students overall communication and thus aid in helping them
 To improve their interpersonal skills by engaging them in group activities
 To emerge as professionals.

LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:

1: Writing letters and creating mails


2: Construction of paragraphs and essays
3. Speaking skills and methods of speech
4. Leadership, Communication and Interpersonal skills
5. Being a motivator and role model
6. Corporate Etiquettes
7. Professionalism in the workplace
8. Engineering ethics, rights and responsibilities
9. Managing cultural diversities and global diversities
10. Right use of social media
11.Maintaining the image and pride of the organization
12.Winning formula for a successful manager/leader

List of Equipments:(30 Students per Batch)

1: Systems with Rosetta stone and Globarena

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Speak fluently in English without errors in the sentence construction and hence present
themselves as effective English communicators.
CO2: Differentiate between vocabularies used as adjectives, verbs.
CO3 Deliver a public speech according to the need of the audience and also be aware of
positive body language to be manifested during a speech.
CO4: Deal with the deeper parameters of working in teams like team motivation, multicultural
team activity and team conflict resolution.
CO5: Set realistic goals in terms of personal and professional growth.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
81
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Bovee, Thill and Raina, “Business Communication Today” , Pearson Education, 2017.
2. APAART: Speak Well 1 (English Language and Communication)
3. APAART: Speak Well 2 (Soft Skills)

REFERENCES:
1. Charles Marsh , “Strategic Communication”, New International Edition, 2013.
2. Alan Mc’carthy and O’dell, “ English Vocabulary in Use, Cambridge University Press, 4 th
edition, 2017.
3. Dr. Saroj Hiremath , “Business Communication”, Nirali Prakashan, 2018.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 - - 2 1 2 - 1 2 - 2 3 - 2 -
2 3 2 - - 2 1 2 - 1 2 - 2 3 - 2 -
3 3 2 - - 2 3 3 - 3 3 - 2 3 - 2 -
4 3 2 - - 2 3 2 - 3 3 - 2 3 - 2 -
5 3 2 - - 2 3 2 - 2 2 - 2 3 - 2 -
AVg. 3 2 - - 2 3 2 - 2 2 - 2 3 - 2 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CS3691 EMBEDDED SYSTEMS AND IOT LTPC


3 024
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn the internal architecture and programming of an embedded processor.
 To introduce interfacing I/O devices to the processor.
 To introduce the evolution of the Internet of Things (IoT).
 To build a small low-cost embedded and IoT system using Arduino/Raspberry Pi/ open
platform.
 To apply the concept of Internet of Things in real world scenario.

UNIT I 8-BIT EMBEDDED PROCESSOR 9


8-Bit Microcontroller – Architecture – Instruction Set and Programming – Programming Parallel
Ports – Timers and Serial Port – Interrupt Handling.

UNIT II EMBEDDED C PROGRAMMING 9


Memory And I/O Devices Interfacing – Programming Embedded Systems in C – Need For RTOS –
Multiple Tasks and Processes – Context Switching – Priority Based Scheduling Policies.

UNIT III IOT AND ARDUINO PROGRAMMING 9


Introduction to the Concept of IoT Devices – IoT Devices Versus
Computers – IoT Configurations – Basic Components – Introduction to Arduino – Types of Arduino
– Arduino Toolchain – Arduino Programming Structure – Sketches – Pins – Input/Output From

82
Pins Using Sketches – Introduction to Arduino Shields – Integration of Sensors and Actuators with
Arduino.

UNIT IV IOT COMMUNICATION AND OPEN PLATFORMS 9


IoT Communication Models and APIs – IoT Communication Protocols – Bluetooth – WiFi – ZigBee
– GPS – GSM modules – Open Platform (like Raspberry Pi) – Architecture – Programming –
Interfacing – Accessing GPIO Pins – Sending and Receiving Signals Using GPIO Pins –
Connecting to the Cloud.

UNIT V APPLICATIONS DEVELOPMENT 9


Complete Design of Embedded Systems – Development of IoT Applications – Home Automation –
Smart Agriculture – Smart Cities – Smart Healthcare.
45 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Write 8051 Assembly Language experiments using simulator.
2. Test data transfer between registers and memory.
3. Perform ALU operations.
4. Write Basic and arithmetic Programs Using Embedded C.
5. Introduction to Arduino platform and programming
6. Explore different communication methods with IoT devices (Zigbee, GSM,
Bluetooth)
7. Introduction to Raspberry PI platform and python programming
8. Interfacing sensors with Raspberry PI
9. Communicate between Arduino and Raspberry PI using any wireless medium
10. Setup a cloud platform to log the data
11. Log Data using Raspberry PI and upload to the cloud platform
12. Design an IOT based system
TOTAL:75 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Explain the architecture of embedded processors.
CO2: Write embedded C programs.
CO3: Design simple embedded applications.
CO4: Compare the communication models in IOT
CO5: Design IoT applications using Arduino/Raspberry Pi /open platform.

TEXTBOOKS
1. Muhammed Ali Mazidi, Janice Gillispie Mazidi, Rolin D. McKinlay, “The 8051 Microcontroller and
Embedded Systems”, Pearson Education, Second Edition, 2014
2. Robert Barton, Patrick Grossetete, David Hanes, Jerome Henry, Gonzalo Salgueiro, “IoT
Fundamentals: Networking Technologies, Protocols, and Use Cases for the Internet of Things”,
CISCO Press, 2017.

REFERENCES
1. Michael J. Pont, “Embedded C”, Pearson Education, 2007.
2. Wayne Wolf, “Computers as Components: Principles of Embedded Computer System Design”,
Elsevier, 2006.
3. Andrew N Sloss, D. Symes, C. Wright, “Arm System Developer's Guide”, Morgan Kauffman/
Elsevier, 2006.

83
4. Arshdeep Bahga, Vijay Madisetti, “Internet of Things – A hands-on approach”, Universities Press,
2015
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 1 - 2 2 2 - - - 2 - 3 3 3 3
2 3 3 1 - 2 2 2 - - - 2 - 3 3 3 3
3 3 3 3 - 2 2 2 - - - 2 - 3 3 3 3
4 3 3 3 - 2 2 2 - - - 2 - 3 3 3 3
5 3 3 3 - 2 2 2 - - - 2 - 3 3 3 3
AVg. 3 3 2.6 - 2 2 2 - - - 2 - 3 3 3 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3501 FUNDAMENTALS OF MANAGEMENT LT PC


30 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To familiarize the students the basic concepts of Management
 To understand the history, evolution and growth of management concepts
 To learn the applications of different functions of Management
 To study the different issues handled by modern managers
 To understand the different challenges faced by modern managers

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT 9


Definition, Nature and Scope, Functions, Managerial Roles, Levels of Management, Managerial
Skills, Challenges of Management; Evolution of Management-Classical Approach-Scientific and
Administrative Management; The Behavioral approach; The Quantitative approach; The Systems
Approach; Contingency Approach, IT Approach.

UNIT II PLANNING AND DECISION MAKING 9


General Framework for Planning -Planning Process, Types of Plans, Management by Objectives;
Development of Business Strategy. Decision making and Problem Solving -Programmed and Non-
Programmed Decisions, Steps in Problem Solving and Decision Making; Bounded Rationality and
Influences on Decision Making; Group Problem Solving and Decision Making, Creativity and
Innovation in Managerial Work.

UNIT III ORGANIZATION AND HRM 9


Principles of Organization: Organizational Design & Organizational Structures;
Departmentalization, Delegation; Empowerment, Centralization, Decentralization, Recentralization;
Organizational Culture; Organizational Climate and Organizational Change. Human Resource
Management & Business Strategy: Talent Management, Talent Management Models and
Strategic Human Resource Planning; Recruitment and Selection; Training and Development;
Performance Appraisal.

UNIT IV LEADERSHIP AND MOTIVATION 9


Leadership, Power and Authority, Leadership Styles; Behavioral Leadership, Situational
Leadership, Leadership Skills, Leader as Mentor and Coach, Leadership during adversity and
Crisis; Handling Employee and Customer Complaints, Team Motivation -Types of Motivation;

84
Relationship between Motivation, Performance and Engagement, Content Motivational Theories -
Needs Hierarchy Theory, Two Factor Theory, Theory X and Theory Y.

UNIT V CONTROLLING 9
Control, Types and Strategies for Control, Steps in Control Process, Budgetary and Non-
Budgetary Controls. Characteristics of Effective Controls, Establishing control systems, Control
frequency, and Methods.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the different elements of effective management
CO2: Apply the concepts of planning and decision making in organizations
CO3: Describe the concepts of organization and need for staffing process
CO4: Adopt the concept of directing through motivation and leadership
CO5: Demonstrate the use of control methods in changing business environment

TEXT BOOK:
1. Management Fundamentals, Robert N Lussier, 5e, Cengage Learning, 2013.
2. Fundamentals of Management, Stephen P. Robbins, Pearson Education, 2009.

REFERENCES :
1. Essentials of Management, Koontz Kleihrich, Tata McGraw Hill.
2. Management Essentials, Andrew DuBrin, 9e, Cengage Learning, 2012
3. Management: Principles, Processes and Practices, Anil Bhat, Arya Kumar –Oxford University
Press-, 2008

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 3 2 - 1 1 1 2 2 - - 3 3 3 3
2 3 3 3 3 - 2 2 2 2 3 - - 3 3 3 3
3 3 3 3 2 - 2 2 2 2 2 - - 3 3 3 3
4 3 3 2 2 - 2 2 2 2 2 - - 3 3 3 3
5 3 3 2 3 - 2 2 2 2 2 - - 3 3 3 3
AVg. 3 3 2.2 2 - 2 2 2 2 2 - - 3 3 3 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3551 DATA AND INFORMATION SECURITY L T PC


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basics of Information Security
 To know the legal, ethical and professional issues in Information Security
 To equip the students’ knowledge on digital signature, email security and web security

85
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
History, What is Information Security?, Critical Characteristics of Information, NSTISSC Security
Model, Components of an Information System, Securing the Components, Balancing Security and
Access, The SDLC, The Security SDLC

UNIT II SECURITY INVESTIGATION 9


Need for Security, Business Needs, Threats, Attacks, Legal, Ethical and Professional Issues - An
Overview of Computer Security - Access Control Matrix, Policy-Security policies, Confidentiality
policies, Integrity policies and Hybrid policies

UNIT III DIGITAL SIGNATURE AND AUTHENTICATION 9


Digital Signature and Authentication Schemes: Digital signature-Digital Signature Schemes and
their Variants- Digital Signature Standards-Authentication: Overview- Requirements Protocols -
Applications - Kerberos -X.509 Directory Services

UNIT IV E-MAIL AND IP SECURITY 9


E-mail and IP Security: Electronic mail security: Email Architecture -PGP – Operational
Descriptions- Key management- Trust Model- S/MIME.IP Security: Overview- Architecture - ESP,
AH Protocols IPSec Modes – Security association - Key management.
UNIT V WEB SECURITY 9
Web Security: Requirements- Secure Sockets Layer- Objectives-Layers -SSL secure
communication-Protocols - Transport Level Security. Secure Electronic Transaction- Entities DS
Verification-SET processing.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon successful completion of this course, students will be able to:
CO1: Understand the basics of data and information security
CO2:Understand the legal, ethical and professional issues in information security
CO3: Understand the various authentication schemes to simulate different applications.
CO4:Understand various security practices and system security standards
CO5:Understand the Web security protocols for E-Commerce applications
TOTAL :45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Michael E Whitman and Herbert J Mattord, “Principles of Information Security, Course
Technology, 6th Edition, 2017.
2. Stallings William. Cryptography and Network Security: Principles and Practice, Seventh
Edition, Pearson Education, 2017.
REFERENCES
1. Harold F. Tipton, Micki Krause Nozaki,, “Information Security Management Handbook, Volume
6, 6th Edition, 2016.
2. Stuart McClure, Joel Scrambray, George Kurtz, “Hacking Exposed”, McGraw- Hill, Seventh
Edition, 2012.
3. Matt Bishop, “Computer Security Art and Science, Addison Wesley Reprint Edition, 2015.
4. Behrouz A Forouzan, Debdeep Mukhopadhyay, Cryptography And network security, 3rd
Edition, . McGraw-Hill Education, 2015.

86
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 1 1 1 - 1 2 1 - - - 3 3 2 1
2 3 3 2 1 1 - 2 3 1 - - - 3 3 2 1
3 3 2 2 1 1 - 2 3 1 - - - 3 3 2 1
4 3 2 2 1 1 - 2 3 1 - - - 3 3 2 1
5 3 2 1 1 1 - 2 3 1 - - - 3 3 2 1
AVg. 3 2.2 1.6 1 1 - 2 3 1 - - - 3 3 2 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCW331 BUSINESS ANALYTICS LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the Analytics Life Cycle.
 To comprehend the process of acquiring Business Intelligence
 To understand various types of analytics for Business Forecasting
 To model the supply chain management for Analytics.
 To apply analytics for different functions of a business

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO BUSINESS ANALYTICS 9


Analytics and Data Science – Analytics Life Cycle – Types of Analytics – Business Problem
Definition – Data Collection – Data Preparation – Hypothesis Generation – Modeling – Validation
and Evaluation – Interpretation – Deployment and Iteration

UNIT II BUSINESS INTELLIGENCE 9


Data Warehouses and Data Mart - Knowledge Management –Types of Decisions - Decision
Making Process - Decision Support Systems – Business Intelligence –OLAP – Analytic functions

UNIT III BUSINESS FORECASTING 9


Introduction to Business Forecasting and Predictive analytics - Logic and Data Driven Models –
Data Mining and Predictive Analysis Modeling –Machine Learning for Predictive analytics.

UNIT IV HR & SUPPLY CHAIN ANALYTICS 9


Human Resources – Planning and Recruitment – Training and Development - Supply chain
network - Planning Demand, Inventory and Supply – Logistics – Analytics applications in HR &
Supply Chain. Apply HR Analytics to make a prediction of the demand for hourly employees for a
year.

UNIT V MARKETING & SALES ANALYTICS 9


Marketing Strategy, Marketing Mix, Customer Behaviour –selling Process – Sales Planning –
Analytics applications in Marketing and Sales. Do predictive analytics for customers' behaviour in
marketing and sales.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Explain the real world business problems and model with analytical solutions.
CO2: Identify the business processes for extracting Business Intelligence
CO3 : Apply predictive analytics for business fore-casting
87
CO4: Apply analytics for supply chain and logistics management
CO5: Use analytics for marketing and sales.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
REFERENCES
1. R. Evans James, Business Analytics, 2017
2. R N Prasad, Seema Acharya, Fundamentals of Business Analytics, 2016
3. Philip Kotler and Kevin Keller, Marketing Management, 15th edition, PHI, 2016
4. VSP RAO, Human Resource Management, 3rd Edition, Excel Books, 2010.
5. Mahadevan B, “Operations Management -Theory and Practice”,3rd Edition,
Pearson Education,2018.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 1 2 1 1 1 1 2 1 2 3 2 1 2
2 3 3 1 2 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 2 1 2
3 3 3 2 3 2 2 2 2 2 3 3 2 3 2 3 3
4 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 3 2 3 2 3 3
5 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 3 3 2 3 2 3 3
AVg. 3 3 2.4 2.2 2 1.6 1.6 1.8 1.8 2.6 2.2 2 3 2 2.2 2.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS356 OBJECT ORIENTED SOFTWARE ENGINEERING LTPC


3 024
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
• To understand Software Engineering Lifecycle Models
• To Perform software requirements analysis
• To gain knowledge of the System Analysis and Design concepts using UML.
• To understand software testing and maintenance approaches
• To work on project management scheduling using DevOps

UNIT I SOFTWARE PROCESS AND AGILE DEVELOPMENT 9


Introduction to Software Engineering, Software Process, Perspective and Specialized Process
Models –Introduction to Agility-Agile process-Extreme programming-XP Process-Case Study.

UNIT II REQUIREMENTS ANALYSIS AND SPECIFICATION 9


Requirement analysis and specification – Requirements gathering and analysis – Software
Requirement Specification – Formal system specification – Finite State Machines – Petrinets –
Object modelling using UML – Use case Model – Class diagrams – Interaction diagrams – Activity
diagrams – State chart diagrams – Functional modelling – Data Flow Diagram- CASE TOOLS.

UNIT III SOFTWARE DESIGN 9


Software design – Design process – Design concepts – Coupling – Cohesion – Functional
independence – Design patterns – Model-view-controller – Publish-subscribe – Adapter –

88
Command – Strategy – Observer – Proxy – Facade – Architectural styles – Layered - Client
Server - Tiered - Pipe and filter- User interface design-Case Study.

UNIT IV SOFTWARE TESTING AND MAINTENANCE 9


Testing – Unit testing – Black box testing– White box testing – Integration and System testing–
Regression testing – Debugging - Program analysis – Symbolic execution – Model Checking-
Case Study

UNIT V PROJECT MANAGEMENT 9


Software Project Management- Software Configuration Management - Project Scheduling-
DevOps: Motivation-Cloud as a platform-Operations- Deployment Pipeline:Overall Architecture
Building and Testing-Deployment- Tools- Case Study

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Compare various Software Development Lifecycle Models
CO2: Evaluate project management approaches as well as cost and schedule estimation
strategies.
CO3: Perform formal analysis on specifications.
CO4: Use UML diagrams for analysis and design.
CO5: Architect and design using architectural styles and design patterns, and test the system

45 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
1. Identify a software system that needs to be developed.
2. Document the Software Requirements Specification (SRS) for the identified system.
3. Identify use cases and develop the Use Case model.
4. Identify the conceptual classes and develop a Domain Model and also derive a Class Diagram
from that.
5. Using the identified scenarios, find the interaction between objects and represent them using
UML Sequence and Collaboration Diagrams
6. Draw relevant State Chart and Activity Diagrams for the same system.
7. Implement the system as per the detailed design
8. Test the software system for all the scenarios identified as per the usecase diagram
9. Improve the reusability and maintainability of the software system by applying appropriate
design patterns.
10. Implement the modified system and test it for various scenarios.

SUGGESTED DOMAINS FOR MINI-PROJECT:


1. Passport automation system.
2. Book bank
3. Exam registration
4. Stock maintenance system.
5. Online course reservation system
6. Airline/Railway reservation system
7. Software personnel management system
8. Credit card processing
9. e-book management system

89
10. Recruitment system
11. Foreign trading system
12. Conference management system
13. BPO management system
14. Library management system
15. Student information system
TOTAL:75 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Bernd Bruegge and Allen H. Dutoit, “Object-Oriented Software Engineering: Using UML,
Patterns and Java”, Third Edition, Pearson Education, 2009.
2. Roger S. Pressman, Object-Oriented Software Engineering: An Agile Unified Methodology,
First Edition, Mc Graw-Hill International Edition, 2014.
REFERENCES
1. Carlo Ghezzi, Mehdi Jazayeri, Dino Mandrioli, Fundamentals of Software Engineering, 2nd
edition, PHI Learning Pvt. Ltd., 2010.
2. Craig Larman, Applying UML and Patterns, 3rd ed, Pearson Education, 2005.
3. Len Bass, Ingo Weber and Liming Zhu, ―DevOps: A Software Architect‘s Perspective‖,
Pearson Education, 2016
4. Rajib Mall, Fundamentals of Software Engineering, 3rd edition, PHI Learning Pvt. Ltd.,
2009.
5. Stephen Schach, Object-Oriented and Classical Software Engineering, 8th ed, McGraw-
Hill, 2010.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2
1 2 2 1 2 2 - - - - 1 1 2 2 2
2 2 3 2 3 2 - - - 2 2 3 2 3 2
3 2 3 2 1 1 - - - 2 2 3 2 2 3
4 2 3 2 2 3 - - - 2 2 3 2 2 3
5 2 3 1 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3611 BUSINESS ANALYTICS LABORATORY LT PC


0 04 2
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Implement various machine learning techniques for predictive analysis
 Learn the various software development methodologies
 Learn predictive analysis in HR, supply chain
 Learn predictive analysis in marketing and sales

LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:

1. Implement Machine learning techniques for Predictive analytics.


2. Predict the Customer Credit Risk for Credit card data-set using Linear Regression
3. Apply HR Analytics to make a prediction of the demand for hourly-employees for the
following month or for the next few years

90
4. Apply analytics for forecasting and inventory planning for a large retailer.
5. Perform predictive analytics for customers' behaviour in marketing and sales

List of Equipments:(30 Students per Batch)

1: Systems with R, R Studio (Additional libraries required)

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Implement Machine learning techniques for Predictive analytics.
CO2: Analyse prediction using Linear Regression
CO3: Perform analytics for forecasting and inventory planning for a large retailer.
CO4: Apply predictive analysis in HR, supply chain
CO5: Apply predictive analysis in marketing and sales
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3
2 3 3 3 2 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3
3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3
4 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3
5 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3
AVg. 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3511 SUMMER INTERNSHIP LTPC


000 2
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to
 Get connected with reputed industry/ laboratory/academia / research institute
 Get practical knowledge on Product Development / Services and operations / Software
Design and Development / Testing / Analytics/ research/ startups/ professionalism /
business processes and insights / domain knowledge/ Industry Practices/ and other related
aspects and develop skills to solve related problems
 Develop technical, soft, team skills to cater to the needs of the industry / academia /
businesses / research / organizations in the core aspects of Automation, Digitalization
The students individually undergo training in reputed firms/ research institutes / laboratories for the
specified duration. After the completion of training, a detailed report should be submitted within ten
days from the commencement of next semester. The students will be evaluated as per the
Regulations.

No. of Weeks: 04
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the student will know about
CO1: Industry Practices, Processes,Techniques, technology, automation and other core aspects
of software industry
CO2: Analyze, Design solutions to complex business problems
CO3: Build and deploy solutions for target platform
CO4: Preparation of Technical reports and presentation
91
CW3811 PROJECT WORK/ INTERNSHIP LT P C
0 0 20 10
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To train the students
 For gaining domain knowledge, and technical skills to solve potential business / research
problems
 Gather requirements and Design suitable software solutions and evaluate
 alternatives
 To work in small teams and understand the processes and practices in the ‘industry.
 Implement, Test and deploy solutions for target platforms
 Preparing project reports and presentation

The students shall individually / or as group work on business/research domains and related
problems approved by the Department / organization that offered the internship / project.

The student can select any topic which is relevant to his/her specialization of the programme. The
student should continue the work on the selected topic as per the formulated methodology. At the
end of the semester, after completing the work to the satisfaction of the supervisor and review
committee, a detailed report which contains clear definition of the identified problem, detailed
literature review related to the area of work and methodology for carrying out the work, results
and discussion, conclusion and references should be prepared as per the format prescribed by
the University and submitted to the Head of the department. The students will be evaluated
based on the report and viva-voce examination by a panel of examiners as per the Regulations.
TOTAL: 300 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the project, the student will be able to
CO1: Gain Domain knowledge and technical skill set required for solving industry /
research problems
CO2: Provide solution architecture, module level designs, algorithms
CO3: Implement, test and deploy the solution for the target platform
CO4: Prepare detailed technical report, demonstrate and present the work

92
VERTICALS

CCS346 EXPLORATORY DATA ANALYSIS LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To outline an overview of exploratory data analysis.
 To implement data visualization using Matplotlib.
 To perform univariate data exploration and analysis.
 To apply bivariate data exploration and analysis.
 To use Data exploration and visualization techniques for multivariate and time series data.

UNIT I EXPLORATORY DATA ANALYSIS 6


EDA fundamentals – Understanding data science – Significance of EDA – Making sense of data –
Comparing EDA with classical and Bayesian analysis – Software tools for EDA - Visual Aids for
EDA- Data transformation techniques-merging database, reshaping and pivoting, Transformation
techniques.

UNIT II EDA USING PYTHON 6


Data Manipulation using Pandas – Pandas Objects – Data Indexing and Selection – Operating on
Data – Handling Missing Data – Hierarchical Indexing – Combining datasets – Concat, Append,
Merge and Join – Aggregation and grouping – Pivot Tables – Vectorized String Operations.

UNIT III UNIVARIATE ANALYSIS 6


Introduction to Single variable: Distribution Variables - Numerical Summaries of Level and Spread
- Scaling and Standardizing – Inequality.

UNIT IV BIVARIATE ANALYSIS 6


Relationships between Two Variables - Percentage Tables - Analysing Contingency Tables -
Handling Several Batches - Scatterplots and Resistant Lines.

UNIT V MULTIVARIATE AND TIME SERIES ANALYSIS 6


Introducing a Third Variable - Causal Explanations - Three-Variable Contingency Tables and
Beyond – Fundamentals of TSA – Characteristics of time series data – Data Cleaning – Time-
based indexing – Visualizing – Grouping – Resampling.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Install the data Analysis and Visualization tool: R/ Python /Tableau Public/ Power BI.
2. Perform exploratory data analysis (EDA) with datasets like email data set. Export all your
emails as a dataset, import them inside a pandas data frame, visualize them and get
different insights from the data.
3. Working with Numpy arrays, Pandas data frames , Basic plots using Matplotlib.
4. Explore various variable and row filters in R for cleaning data. Apply various plot features in
R on sample data sets and visualize.
5. Perform Time Series Analysis and apply the various visualization techniques.
6. Perform Data Analysis and representation on a Map using various Map data sets with
Mouse Rollover effect, user interaction, etc..
7. Build cartographic visualization for multiple datasets involving various countries of the
world; states and districts in India etc.
93
8. Perform EDA on Wine Quality Data Set.
9. Use a case study on a data set and apply the various EDA and visualization techniques
and present an analysis report.
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Understand the fundamentals of exploratory data analysis.
CO2: Implement the data visualization using Matplotlib.
CO3: Perform univariate data exploration and analysis.
CO4: Apply bivariate data exploration and analysis.
CO5: Use Data exploration and visualization techniques for multivariate and time series data.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Suresh Kumar Mukhiya, Usman Ahmed, “Hands-On Exploratory Data Analysis with
Python”, Packt Publishing, 2020. (Unit 1)
2. Jake Vander Plas, "Python Data Science Handbook: Essential Tools for Working with
Data", First Edition, O Reilly, 2017. (Unit 2)
3. Catherine Marsh, Jane Elliott, “Exploring Data: An Introduction to Data Analysis for Social
Scientists”, Wiley Publications, 2nd Edition, 2008. (Unit 3,4,5)
REFERENCES:
1. Eric Pimpler, Data Visualization and Exploration with R, GeoSpatial Training service, 2017.
2. Claus O. Wilke, “Fundamentals of Data Visualization”, O’reilly publications, 2019.
3. Matthew O. Ward, Georges Grinstein, Daniel Keim, “Interactive Data Visualization:
Foundations, Techniques, and Applications”, 2nd Edition, CRC press, 2015.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 3 2 3 3 2 3
2 2 2 2 3 3 - - - 3 2 2 2 1 2 3 2
3 2 3 2 2 3 - - - 2 2 2 1 2 3 1 2
4 2 2 2 2 3 - - - 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2
5 2 2 3 2 1 - - - 1 2 2 1 2 2 3 2
AVg. 2.2 2.2 2.4 2.4 2.6 - - - 2.2 2 2.2 1.4 2 2.4 2.2 2.2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS360 RECOMMENDER SYSTEMS LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the foundations of the recommender system.
 To learn the significance of machine learning and data mining algorithms for
Recommender systems
 To learn about collaborative filtering
 To make students design and implement a recommender system.
 To learn collaborative filtering.

94
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 6
Introduction and basic taxonomy of recommender systems - Traditional and non-personalized
Recommender Systems - Overview of data mining methods for recommender systems- similarity
measures- Dimensionality reduction – Singular Value Decomposition (SVD)

Suggested Activities:

 Practical learning – Implement Data similarity measures.


 External Learning – Singular Value Decomposition (SVD) applications

Suggested Evaluation Methods:

 Quiz on Recommender systems.


 Quiz of python tools available for implementing Recommender systems

UNIT II CONTENT-BASED RECOMMENDATION SYSTEMS 6

High-level architecture of content-based systems - Item profiles, Representing item profiles,


Methods for learning user profiles, Similarity-based retrieval, and Classification algorithms.

Suggested Activities:
 Assignment on content-based recommendation systems
 Assignment of learning user profiles

Suggested Evaluation Methods:


 Quiz on similarity-based retrieval.
 Quiz of content-based filtering

UNIT III COLLABORATIVE FILTERING 6


A systematic approach, Nearest-neighbor collaborative filtering (CF), user-based and item-based
CF, components of neighborhood methods (rating normalization, similarity weight computation,
and neighborhood selection

Suggested Activities:
● Practical learning – Implement collaborative filtering concepts
● Assignment of security aspects of recommender systems

Suggested Evaluation Methods:


● Quiz on collaborative filtering
● Seminar on security measures of recommender systems

UNIT IV ATTACK-RESISTANT RECOMMENDER SYSTEMS 6


Introduction – Types of Attacks – Detecting attacks on recommender systems – Individual attack
– Group attack – Strategies for robust recommender design - Robust recommendation algorithms.

Suggested Activities:
● Group Discussion on attacks and their mitigation
● Study of the impact of group attacks
● External Learning – Use of CAPTCHAs
95
Suggested Evaluation Methods:

● Quiz on attacks on recommender systems


● Seminar on preventing attacks using the CAPTCHAs

UNIT V EVALUATING RECOMMENDER SYSTEMS 6


Evaluating Paradigms – User Studies – Online and Offline evaluation – Goals of evaluation design
– Design Issues – Accuracy metrics – Limitations of Evaluation measures

Suggested Activities:
● Group Discussion on goals of evaluation design
● Study of accuracy metrics

Suggested Evaluation Methods:


● Quiz on evaluation design
● Problems on accuracy measures 30 PERIODS

PRACTICAL EXERCISES 30 PERIODS


1. Implement Data similarity measures using Python
2. Implement dimension reduction techniques for recommender systems
3. Implement user profile learning
4. Implement content-based recommendation systems
5. Implement collaborative filter techniques
6. Create an attack for tampering with recommender systems
7. Implement accuracy metrics like Receiver Operated Characteristic curves
TOTAL 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the students will be able to:
CO1:Understand the basic concepts of recommender systems.
CO2:Implement machine-learning and data-mining algorithms in recommender systems
data sets.
CO3:Implementation of Collaborative Filtering in carrying out performance evaluation of
recommender systems based on various metrics.
CO4:Design and implement a simple recommender system.
CO5:Learn about advanced topics of recommender systems.
CO6:Learn about advanced topics of recommender systems applications

TEXTBOOKS:
1. Charu C. Aggarwal, Recommender Systems: The Textbook, Springer, 2016.
2. Dietmar Jannach , Markus Zanker , Alexander Felfernig and Gerhard Friedrich ,
Recommender Systems: An Introduction, Cambridge University Press (2011), 1st ed.
3. Francesco Ricci , Lior Rokach , Bracha Shapira , Recommender Sytems Handbook, 1st
ed, Springer (2011),
rd
4. Jure Leskovec, Anand Rajaraman, Jeffrey David Ullman, Mining of massive datasets, 3
edition, Cambridge University Press, 2020.

96
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 2 1 2 1 _ _ _ 1 _ _ 1 _ _ _
2 1 2 _ _ 1 _ _ _ _ _ _ 1 _ _ _
3 2 3 1 _ 1 _ _ _ 2 _ _ _ _ _ _
4 3 2 2 2 1 _ _ _ 2 _ _ 2 _ _ _
5 1 1 _ 2 1 _ _ _ _ _ _ 1 _ _ _
6 2 2 1 1 1 _ _ _ _ _ _ 1 _ _ _
AVg 1.83 2 0.83 1.16 1 _ _ _ 0.83 _ _ 1 _ _ _
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS355 NEURAL NETWORKS AND DEEP LEARNING LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basics in deep neural networks
 To understand the basics of associative memory and unsupervised learning networks
 To apply CNN architectures of deep neural networks
 To analyze the key computations underlying deep learning, then use them to build and train
deep neural networks for various tasks.
 To apply autoencoders and generative models for suitable applications.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 6
Neural Networks-Application Scope of Neural Networks-Artificial Neural Network: An Introduction-
Evolution of Neural Networks-Basic Models of Artificial Neural Network- Important Terminologies of
ANNs-Supervised Learning Network.

UNIT II ASSOCIATIVE MEMORY AND UNSUPERVISED LEARNING NETWORKS 6


Training Algorithms for Pattern Association-Autoassociative Memory Network-Heteroassociative
Memory Network-Bidirectional Associative Memory (BAM)-Hopfield Networks-Iterative
Autoassociative Memory Networks-Temporal Associative Memory Network-Fixed Weight
Competitive Nets-Kohonen Self-Organizing Feature Maps-Learning Vector Quantization-Counter
propagation Networks-Adaptive Resonance Theory Network.

UNIT III THIRD-GENERATION NEURAL NETWORKS 6


Spiking Neural Networks-Convolutional Neural Networks-Deep Learning Neural Networks-Extreme
Learning Machine Model-Convolutional Neural Networks: The Convolution Operation – Motivation –
Pooling – Variants of the basic Convolution Function – Structured Outputs – Data Types – Efficient
Convolution Algorithms – Neuroscientific Basis – Applications: Computer Vision, Image Generation,
Image Compression.

UNIT IV DEEP FEEDFORWARD NETWORKS 6


History of Deep Learning- A Probabilistic Theory of Deep Learning- Gradient Learning – Chain Rule
and Backpropagation - Regularization: Dataset Augmentation – Noise Robustness -Early Stopping,
Bagging and Dropout - batch normalization- VC Dimension and Neural Nets.

97
UNIT V RECURRENT NEURAL NETWORKS 6
Recurrent Neural Networks: Introduction – Recursive Neural Networks – Bidirectional RNNs – Deep
Recurrent Networks – Applications: Image Generation, Image Compression, Natural Language
Processing. Complete Auto encoder, Regularized Autoencoder, Stochastic Encoders and
Decoders, Contractive Encoders.

30 PERIODS
LAB EXPERIMENTS: 30 PERIODS
1. Implement simple vector addition in TensorFlow.
2. Implement a regression model in Keras.
3. Implement a perceptron in TensorFlow/Keras Environment.
4. Implement a Feed-Forward Network in TensorFlow/Keras.
5. Implement an Image Classifier using CNN in TensorFlow/Keras.
6. Improve the Deep learning model by fine tuning hyper parameters.
7. Implement a Transfer Learning concept in Image Classification.
8. Using a pre trained model on Keras for Transfer Learning
9. Perform Sentiment Analysis using RNN
10. Implement an LSTM based Autoencoder in TensorFlow/Keras.
11. Image generation using GAN
Additional Experiments:
12. Train a Deep learning model to classify a given image using pre trained model
13. Recommendation system from sales data using Deep Learning
14. Implement Object Detection using CNN
15. Implement any simple Reinforcement Algorithm for an NLP problem
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Apply Convolution Neural Network for image processing.
CO2: Understand the basics of associative memory and unsupervised learning networks.
CO3: Apply CNN and its variants for suitable applications.
CO4: Analyze the key computations underlying deep learning and use them to build and train deep
neural networks for various tasks.
CO5: Apply autoencoders and generative models for suitable applications.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Ian Goodfellow, Yoshua Bengio, Aaron Courville, “Deep Learning”, MIT Press, 2016.
2. Francois Chollet, “Deep Learning with Python”, Second Edition, Manning Publications,
2021.
REFERENCES:
1. Aurélien Géron, “Hands-On Machine Learning with Scikit-Learn and TensorFlow”, Oreilly,
2018.
2. Josh Patterson, Adam Gibson, “Deep Learning: A Practitioner’s Approach”, O’Reilly
Media, 2017.
3. Charu C. Aggarwal, “Neural Networks and Deep Learning: A Textbook”, Springer
International Publishing, 1st Edition, 2018.
98
4. Learn Keras for Deep Neural Networks, Jojo Moolayil, Apress,2018
5. Deep Learning Projects Using TensorFlow 2, Vinita Silaparasetty, Apress, 2020
6. Deep Learning with Python, FRANÇOIS CHOLLET, MANNING SHELTER ISLAND,2017.
7. S Rajasekaran, G A Vijayalakshmi Pai, “Neural Networks, FuzzyLogic and Genetic
Algorithm, Synthesis and Applications”, PHI Learning, 2017.
8. Pro Deep Learning with TensorFlow, Santanu Pattanayak, Apress,2017
9. James A Freeman, David M S Kapura, “Neural Networks Algorithms, Applications, and
Programming Techniques”, Addison Wesley, 2003.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 3 2 3 1 - - 2 1 - - 2 2 1 2
2 3 1 2 1 - - - - - 1 2 2 - 1 - 1
3 3 3 3 3 3 1 - - 2 1 - - 2 2 1 3
4 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 - 2 3 2 2 2 3
5 1 1 3 2 3 - - - 2 - - - 1 1 - 1
AVg. 2.6 2 2.8 2.2 2.4 0.4 0 0 1.6 0.6 0.8 1 1.4 1.6 0.8 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS369 TEXT AND SPEECH ANALYSIS L T PC


2 0 2 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Understand natural language processing basics
 Apply classification algorithms to text documents
 Build question-answering and dialogue systems
 Develop a speech recognition system
 Develop a speech synthesizer

UNIT I NATURAL LANGUAGE BASICS 6


Foundations of natural language processing – Language Syntax and Structure- Text
Preprocessing and Wrangling – Text tokenization – Stemming – Lemmatization – Removing stop-
words – Feature Engineering for Text representation – Bag of Words model- Bag of N-Grams
model – TF-IDF model

Suggested Activities
● Flipped classroom on NLP
● Implementation of Text Preprocessing using NLTK
● Implementation of TF-IDF models

Suggested Evaluation Methods


 Quiz on NLP Basics
 Demonstration of Programs

99
UNIT II TEXT CLASSIFICATION 6
Vector Semantics and Embeddings -Word Embeddings - Word2Vec model – Glove model –
FastText model – Overview of Deep Learning models – RNN – Transformers – Overview of Text
summarization and Topic Models

Suggested Activities
 Flipped classroom on Feature extraction of documents
 Implementation of SVM models for text classification
 External learning: Text summarization and Topic models

Suggested Evaluation Methods


 Assignment on above topics
 Quiz on RNN, Transformers
 Implementing NLP with RNN and Transformers

UNIT III QUESTION ANSWERING AND DIALOGUE SYSTEMS 9


Information retrieval – IR-based question answering – knowledge-based question answering –
language models for QA – classic QA models – chatbots – Design of dialogue systems -–
evaluating dialogue systems

Suggested Activities:
 Flipped classroom on language models for QA
 Developing a knowledge-based question-answering system
 Classic QA model development

Suggested Evaluation Methods


 Assignment on the above topics
 Quiz on knowledge-based question answering system
 Development of simple chatbots

UNIT IV TEXT-TO-SPEECH SYNTHESIS 6


Overview. Text normalization. Letter-to-sound. Prosody, Evaluation. Signal processing -
Concatenative and parametric approaches, WaveNet and other deep learning-based TTS
systems

Suggested Activities:
 Flipped classroom on Speech signal processing
 Exploring Text normalization
 Data collection
 Implementation of TTS systems
Suggested Evaluation Methods

 Assignment on the above topics


 Quiz on wavenet, deep learning-based TTS systems
 Finding accuracy with different TTS systems

100
UNIT V AUTOMATIC SPEECH RECOGNITION 6
Speech recognition: Acoustic modelling – Feature Extraction - HMM, HMM-DNN systems

Suggested Activities:
 Flipped classroom on Speech recognition.
 Exploring Feature extraction

Suggested Evaluation Methods


 Assignment on the above topics
 Quiz on acoustic modelling
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES 30 PERIODS
1. Create Regular expressions in Python for detecting word patterns and tokenizing text
2. Getting started with Python and NLTK - Searching Text, Counting Vocabulary, Frequency
Distribution, Collocations, Bigrams
3. Accessing Text Corpora using NLTK in Python
4. Write a function that finds the 50 most frequently occurring words of a text that are not stop
words.
5. Implement the Word2Vec model
6. Use a transformer for implementing classification
7. Design a chatbot with a simple dialog system
8. Convert text to speech and find accuracy
9. Design a speech recognition system and find the error rate
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the students will be able to
CO1: Explain existing and emerging deep learning architectures for text and speech processing
CO2: Apply deep learning techniques for NLP tasks, language modelling and machine translation
CO3: Explain coreference and coherence for text processing
CO4: Build question-answering systems, chatbots and dialogue systems
CO5: Apply deep learning models for building speech recognition and text-to-speech systems

TEXTBOOK
1. Daniel Jurafsky and James H. Martin, “Speech and Language Processing: An Introduction
to Natural Language Processing, Computational Linguistics, and Speech Recognition”,
Third Edition, 2022.
REFERENCES:
1. Dipanjan Sarkar, “Text Analytics with Python: A Practical Real-World approach to Gaining
Actionable insights from your data”, APress,2018.
2. Tanveer Siddiqui, Tiwary U S, “Natural Language Processing and Information Retrieval”,
Oxford University Press, 2008.
3. Lawrence Rabiner, Biing-Hwang Juang, B. Yegnanarayana, “Fundamentals of Speech
Recognition” 1st Edition, Pearson, 2009.
4. Steven Bird, Ewan Klein, and Edward Loper, “Natural language processing with Python”,
O’REILLY.

101
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 3 1 3 - - - 1 2 1 2 1 1 1 -
2 3 1 2 1 3 - - - 2 2 1 3 3 2 1 -
3 2 2 1 3 1 - - - 3 3 1 2 3 3 1 -
4 2 1 1 1 2 - - - 2 1 2 2 3 1 1 -
5 1 3 2 2 1 - - - 3 2 1 1 2 3 1 -
AVg. 2.2 1.8 1.8 1.6 2 - - - 2.2 2 1.2 2 2.4 2 1 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCW331 BUSINESS ANALYTICS LTPC


20 23
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the Analytics Life Cycle.
 To comprehend the process of acquiring Business Intelligence
 To understand various types of analytics for Business Forecasting
 To model the supply chain management for Analytics.
 To apply analytics for different functions of a business

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO BUSINESS ANALYTICS 6


Analytics and Data Science – Analytics Life Cycle – Types of Analytics – Business Problem
Definition – Data Collection – Data Preparation – Hypothesis Generation – Modeling – Validation
and Evaluation – Interpretation – Deployment and Iteration

UNIT II BUSINESS INTELLIGENCE 6


Data Warehouses and Data Mart - Knowledge Management –Types of Decisions - Decision
Making Process - Decision Support Systems – Business Intelligence –OLAP – Analytic functions

UNIT III BUSINESS FORECASTING 6


Introduction to Business Forecasting and Predictive analytics - Logic and Data Driven Models –
Data Mining and Predictive Analysis Modelling –Machine Learning for Predictive analytics.

UNIT IV HR & SUPPLY CHAIN ANALYTICS 6


Human Resources – Planning and Recruitment – Training and Development - Supply chain
network - Planning Demand, Inventory and Supply – Logistics – Analytics applications in HR &
Supply Chain - Applying HR Analytics to make a prediction of the demand for hourly employees
for a year.

UNIT V MARKETING & SALES ANALYTICS 6


Marketing Strategy, Marketing Mix, Customer Behaviour –selling Process – Sales Planning –
Analytics applications in Marketing and Sales - predictive analytics for customers' behaviour in
marketing and sales.

30 PERIODS
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS: 30 PERIODS

102
Use MS-Excel and Power-BI to perform the following experiments using a Business data set, and
make presentations.
Students may be encouraged to bring their own real-time socially relevant data set.
I Cycle – MS Excel
1. Explore the features of Ms-Excel.
2. (i) Get the input from user and perform numerical operations (MAX, MIN, AVG, SUM,
SQRT, ROUND)
ii) Perform data import/export operations for different file formats.
3. Perform statistical operations - Mean, Median, Mode and Standard deviation, Variance,
Skewness, Kurtosis
4. Perform Z-test, T-test & ANOVA
5. Perform data pre-processing operations i) Handling Missing data ii) Normalization
6. Perform dimensionality reduction operation using PCA, KPCA & SVD
7. Perform bivariate and multivariate analysis on the dataset.
8. Apply and explore various plotting functions on the data set.
II Cycle – Power BI Desktop
9. Explore the features of Power BI Desktop
10. Prepare & Load data
11. Develop the data model
12. Perform DAX calculations
13. Design a report
14. Create a dashboard and perform data analysis
15. Presentation of a case study

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Explain the real world business problems and model with analytical solutions.
CO2: Identify the business processes for extracting Business Intelligence
CO3 : Apply predictive analytics for business fore-casting
CO4: Apply analytics for supply chain and logistics management
CO5: Use analytics for marketing and sales.
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. R. Evans James, Business Analytics, 2nd Edition, Pearson, 2017
2. R N Prasad, Seema Acharya, Fundamentals of Business Analytics, 2nd Edition, Wiley,
2016
3. Philip Kotler and Kevin Keller, Marketing Management, 15th edition, PHI, 2016
4. VSP RAO, Human Resource Management, 3rd Edition, Excel Books, 2010.
5. Mahadevan B, “Operations Management -Theory and Practice”,3rd Edition,
Pearson Education,2018.

103
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 2 2 3 1 1 - - - 1 2 1 1
2 3 3 3 2 3 - - - 1 2 2 2
3 2 2 3 3 2 - - - 3 1 1 3
4 2 1 1 2 2 - - - 3 3 2 1
5 2 3 2 3 2 - - - 3 3 1 3
AVg. 2.2 2.2 2.4 2.2 2 - - - 2.2 2.2 1.4 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS349 IMAGE AND VIDEO ANALYTICS LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basics of image processing techniques for computer vision.
 To learn the techniques used for image pre-processing.
 To discuss the various object detection techniques.
 To understand the various Object recognition mechanisms.
 To elaborate on the video analytics techniques.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 6
Computer Vision – Image representation and image analysis tasks - Image representations –
digitization – properties – color images – Data structures for Image Analysis - Levels of image data
representation - Traditional and Hierarchical image data structures.

UNIT II IMAGE PRE-PROCESSING 6


Local pre-processing - Image smoothing - Edge detectors - Zero-crossings of the second
derivative - Scale in image processing - Canny edge detection - Parametric edge models - Edges
in multi-speralct images - Local pre-processing in the frequency domain - Line detection by local
pre-processing operators - Image restoration.

UNIT III OBJECT DETECTION USING MACHINE LEARNING 6


Object detection– Object detection methods – Deep Learning framework for Object detection–
bounding box approach-Intersection over Union (IoU) –Deep Learning Architectures-R-CNN-Faster
R-CNN-You Only Look Once(YOLO)-Salient features-Loss Functions-YOLO architectures

UNIT IV FACE RECOGNITION AND GESTURE RECOGNITION 6


Face Recognition-Introduction-Applications of Face Recognition-Process of Face Recognition-
DeepFace solution by Facebook-FaceNet for Face Recognition- Implementation using FaceNet-
Gesture Recognition.

UNIT V VIDEO ANALYTICS 6


Video Processing – use cases of video analytics-Vanishing Gradient and exploding gradient
problem-RestNet architecture-RestNet and skip connections-Inception Network-GoogleNet
architecture-Improvement in Inception v2-Video analytics-RestNet and Inception v3.

30 PERIODS

104
LIST OF EXERCISES 30 PERIODS

1. Write a program that computes the T-pyramid of an image.


2. Write a program that derives the quad tree representation of an image using the homogeneity
criterion of equal intensity
3. Develop programs for the following geometric transforms: (a) Rotation (b) Change of scale (c)
Skewing (d) Affine transform calculated from three pairs of corresponding points (e) Bilinear
transform calculated from four pairs of corresponding points.
4. Develop a program to implement Object Detection and Recognition
5. Develop a program for motion analysis using moving edges, and apply it to your image
sequences.
6. Develop a program for Facial Detection and Recognition
7. Write a program for event detection in video surveillance system

TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Understand the basics of image processing techniques for computer vision and video
analysis.
CO2: Explain the techniques used for image pre-processing.
CO3: Develop various object detection techniques.
CO4: Understand the various face recognition mechanisms.
CO5: Elaborate on deep learning-based video analytics.

TEXT BOOK:
1. Milan Sonka, Vaclav Hlavac, Roger Boyle, “Image Processing, Analysis, and Machine
Vision”, 4nd edition, Thomson Learning, 2013.
2. Vaibhav Verdhan,(2021, Computer Vision Using Deep Learning Neural Network
Architectures with Python and Keras,Apress 2021(UNIT-III,IV and V)
REFERENCES
1. Richard Szeliski, “Computer Vision: Algorithms and Applications”, Springer Verlag
London
2. Limited,2011.
3. Caifeng Shan, FatihPorikli, Tao Xiang, Shaogang Gong, “Video Analytics for Business
Intelligence”, Springer, 2012.
4. D. A. Forsyth, J. Ponce, “Computer Vision: A Modern Approach”, Pearson Education,
2003.
5. E. R. Davies, (2012), “Computer & Machine Vision”, Fourth Edition, Academic Press.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 1 2 2 2 - - - 3 3 2 1 2 1 3
2 2 2 3 3 3 - - - 3 2 1 1 2 2 1
3 1 2 2 2 3 - - - 1 2 1 2 1 1 3
4 1 2 3 2 3 - - - 2 2 2 3 2 2 2
5 3 2 1 3 2 - - - 2 1 1 3 3 2 1
AVg. 2 1.8 2.2 2.4 2.6 - - - 2.2 2 1.4 2 2 1.6 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation
105
CCS338 COMPUTER VISION L T PC
2 0 23
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the fundamental concepts related to Image formation and processing.
 To learn feature detection, matching and detection
 To become familiar with feature based alignment and motion estimation
 To develop skills on 3D reconstruction
 To understand image based rendering and recognition

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO IMAGE FORMATION AND PROCESSING 6


Computer Vision - Geometric primitives and transformations - Photometric image formation - The
digital camera - Point operators - Linear filtering - More neighborhood operators - Fourier
transforms - Pyramids and wavelets - Geometric transformations - Global optimization.

UNIT II FEATURE DETECTION, MATCHING AND SEGMENTATION 6


Points and patches - Edges - Lines - Segmentation - Active contours - Split and merge - Mean
shift and mode finding - Normalized cuts - Graph cuts and energy-based methods.

UNIT III FEATURE-BASED ALIGNMENT & MOTION ESTIMATION 6


2D and 3D feature-based alignment - Pose estimation - Geometric intrinsic calibration -
Triangulation - Two-frame structure from motion - Factorization - Bundle adjustment - Constrained
structure and motion - Translational alignment - Parametric motion - Spline-based motion - Optical
flow - Layered motion.

UNIT IV 3D RECONSTRUCTION 6
Shape from X - Active rangefinding - Surface representations - Point-based representations-
Volumetric representations - Model-based reconstruction - Recovering texture maps and
albedosos.

UNIT V IMAGE-BASED RENDERING AND RECOGNITION 6


View interpolation Layered depth images - Light fields and Lumigraphs - Environment mattes -
Video-based rendering-Object detection - Face recognition - Instance recognition - Category
recognition - Context and scene understanding- Recognition databases and test sets.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
LABORATORY EXPERIMENTS:

Software needed:

OpenCV computer vision Library for OpenCV in Python / PyCharm or C++ / Visual Studio or or
equivalent

● OpenCV Installation and working with Python

106
● Basic Image Processing - loading images, Cropping, Resizing, Thresholding, Contour
analysis, Bolb detection
● Image Annotation – Drawing lines, text circle, rectangle, ellipse on images
● Image Enhancement - Understanding Color spaces, color space conversion, Histogram
equialization, Convolution, Image smoothing, Gradients, Edge Detection
● Image Features and Image Alignment – Image transforms – Fourier, Hough, Extract ORB
Image features, Feature matching, cloning, Feature matching based image alignment
● Image segmentation using Graphcut / Grabcut
● Camera Calibration with circular grid
● Pose Estimation
● 3D Reconstruction – Creating Depth map from stereo images
● Object Detection and Tracking using Kalman Filter, Camshift
1. docs.opencv.org
2. https://opencv.org/opencv-free-course/
TOTAL : 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1:To understand basic knowledge, theories and methods in image processing and computer
vision.
CO2:To implement basic and some advanced image processing techniques in OpenCV.
CO3:To apply 2D a feature-based based image alignment, segmentation and motion estimations.
CO4:To apply 3D image reconstruction techniques
CO5:To design and develop innovative image processing and computer vision applications.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Richard Szeliski, “Computer Vision: Algorithms and Applications”, Springer- Texts in
Computer Science, Second Edition, 2022.
2. Computer Vision: A Modern Approach, D. A. Forsyth, J. Ponce, Pearson Education,
Second Edition, 2015.
REFERENCES:
1. Richard Hartley and Andrew Zisserman, Multiple View Geometry in Computer Vision,
Second Edition, Cambridge University Press, March 2004.
2. Christopher M. Bishop; Pattern Recognition and Machine Learning, Springer, 2006
3. E. R. Davies, Computer and Machine Vision, Fourth Edition, Academic Press, 2012.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 1 1 1 1 - - - 2 1 3 2 2 1 1 1
2 3 3 3 2 3 - 1 - 2 1 2 2 3 1 2 1
3 3 3 2 2 3 - - - 1 1 2 2 3 2 2 1
4 2 3 3 2 3 - - - 2 1 2 3 2 2 3 2
5 2 3 3 2 2 2 - - 3 1 2 3 3 3 3 2
AVg. 2.6 2.6 2.4 1.8 2.4 0.4 0.25 0 2 1 2.2 2.4 2.6 1.8 2.2 1.4
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

107
CCS334 BIG DATA ANALYTICS L T PC
2 0 23
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand big data.
 To learn and use NoSQL big data management.
 To learn mapreduce analytics using Hadoop and related tools.
 To work with map reduce applications
 To understand the usage of Hadoop related tools for Big Data Analytics

UNIT I UNDERSTANDING BIG DATA 5


Introduction to big data – convergence of key trends – unstructured data – industry examples of
big data – web analytics – big data applications– big data technologies – introduction to Hadoop –
open source technologies – cloud and big data – mobile business intelligence – Crowd sourcing
analytics – inter and trans firewall analytics.

UNIT II NOSQL DATA MANAGEMENT 7


Introduction to NoSQL – aggregate data models – key-value and document data models –
relationships – graph databases – schemaless databases – materialized views – distribution
models – master-slave replication – consistency - Cassandra – Cassandra data model –
Cassandra examples – Cassandra clients

UNIT III MAP REDUCE APPLICATIONS 6


MapReduce workflows – unit tests with MRUnit – test data and local tests – anatomy of
MapReduce job run – classic Map-reduce – YARN – failures in classic Map-reduce and YARN –
job scheduling – shuffle and sort – task execution – MapReduce types – input formats – output
formats.

UNIT IV BASICS OF HADOOP 6


Data format – analyzing data with Hadoop – scaling out – Hadoop streaming – Hadoop pipes –
design of Hadoop distributed file system (HDFS) – HDFS concepts – Java interface – data flow –
Hadoop I/O – data integrity – compression – serialization – Avro – file-based data structures -
Cassandra – Hadoop integration.

UNIT V HADOOP RELATED TOOLS 6


Hbase – data model and implementations – Hbase clients – Hbase examples – praxis.
Pig – Grunt – pig data model – Pig Latin – developing and testing Pig Latin scripts.
Hive – data types and file formats – HiveQL data definition – HiveQL data manipulation – HiveQL
queries.
30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After the completion of this course, students will be able to:
CO1: Describe big data and use cases from selected business domains.
CO2: Explain NoSQL big data management.
CO3: Install, configure, and run Hadoop and HDFS.
CO4: Perform map-reduce analytics using Hadoop.
CO5: Use Hadoop-related tools such as HBase, Cassandra, Pig, and Hive for big data analytics.

108
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS: 30 PERIODS
1. Downloading and installing Hadoop; Understanding different Hadoop modes. Startup scripts,
Configuration files.
2. Hadoop Implementation of file management tasks, such as Adding files and directories,
retrieving files and Deleting files
3. Implement of Matrix Multiplication with Hadoop Map Reduce
4. Run a basic Word Count Map Reduce program to understand Map Reduce Paradigm.
5. Installation of Hive along with practice examples.
7. Installation of HBase, Installing thrift along with Practice examples
8. Practice importing and exporting data from various databases.

Software Requirements:
Cassandra, Hadoop, Java, Pig, Hive and HBase.

TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Michael Minelli, Michelle Chambers, and AmbigaDhiraj, "Big Data, Big Analytics: Emerging
Business Intelligence and Analytic Trends for Today's Businesses", Wiley, 2013.
2. Eric Sammer, "Hadoop Operations", O'Reilley, 2012.
3. Sadalage, Pramod J. “NoSQL distilled”, 2013

REFERENCES:
1. E. Capriolo, D. Wampler, and J. Rutherglen, "Programming Hive", O'Reilley, 2012.
2. Lars George, "HBase: The Definitive Guide", O'Reilley, 2011.
3. Eben Hewitt, "Cassandra: The Definitive Guide", O'Reilley, 2010.
4. Alan Gates, "Programming Pig", O'Reilley, 2011.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 3 1 1 3 3
2 3 3 2 3 2 - - - 2 2 3 3 2 3 2
3 3 3 3 2 3 - - - 2 2 1 2 2 3 3
4 2 3 3 3 3 - - - 2 2 3 2 3 3 2
5 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 3 1 3 2 3 2 3
AVg. 2.8 3 2.8 2.8 2.8 - - - 2.2 1.8 2.6 2 2.2 2.8 2.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS335 CLOUD COMPUTING LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the principles of cloud architecture, models and infrastructure.
 To understand the concepts of virtualization and virtual machines.
 To gain knowledge about virtualization Infrastructure.
 To explore and experiment with various Cloud deployment environments.
 To learn about the security issues in the cloud environment.

109
UNIT I CLOUD ARCHITECTURE MODELS AND INFRASTRUCTURE 6
Cloud Architecture: System Models for Distributed and Cloud Computing – NIST Cloud Computing
Reference Architecture – Cloud deployment models – Cloud service models; Cloud Infrastructure:
Architectural Design of Compute and Storage Clouds – Design Challenges

UNIT II VIRTUALIZATION BASICS 6


Virtual Machine Basics – Taxonomy of Virtual Machines – Hypervisor – Key Concepts –
Virtualization structure – Implementation levels of virtualization – Virtualization Types: Full
Virtualization – Para Virtualization – Hardware Virtualization – Virtualization of CPU, Memory and
I/O devices.

UNIT III VIRTUALIZATION INFRASTRUCTURE AND DOCKER 7


Desktop Virtualization – Network Virtualization – Storage Virtualization – System-level of
Operating Virtualization – Application Virtualization – Virtual clusters and Resource Management –
Containers vs. Virtual Machines – Introduction to Docker – Docker Components – Docker
Container – Docker Images and Repositories.

UNIT IV CLOUD DEPLOYMENT ENVIRONMENT 6


Google App Engine – Amazon AWS – Microsoft Azure; Cloud Software Environments –
Eucalyptus – OpenStack.

UNIT V CLOUD SECURITY 5


Virtualization System-Specific Attacks: Guest hopping – VM migration attack – hyperjacking. Data
Security and Storage; Identity and Access Management (IAM) - IAM Challenges - IAM Architecture
and Practice.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Install Virtualbox/VMware/ Equivalent open source cloud Workstation with different
flavours of Linux or Windows OS on top of windows 8 and above.
2. Install a C compiler in the virtual machine created using a virtual box and execute Simple
Programs
3. Install Google App Engine. Create a hello world app and other simple web applications
using python/java.
4. Use the GAE launcher to launch the web applications.
5. Simulate a cloud scenario using CloudSim and run a scheduling algorithm that is not
present in CloudSim.
6. Find a procedure to transfer the files from one virtual machine to another virtual machine.
7. Install Hadoop single node cluster and run simple applications like wordcount.
8. Creating and Executing Your First Container Using Docker.
9. Run a Container from Docker Hub

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the design challenges in the cloud.
CO2: Apply the concept of virtualization and its types.
CO3: Experiment with virtualization of hardware resources and Docker.
CO4: Develop and deploy services on the cloud and set up a cloud environment.
CO5: Explain security challenges in the cloud environment.
110
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Kai Hwang, Geoffrey C Fox, Jack G Dongarra, “Distributed and Cloud Computing, From
Parallel Processing to the Internet of Things”, Morgan Kaufmann Publishers, 2012.
2. James Turnbull, “The Docker Book”, O’Reilly Publishers, 2014.
3. Krutz, R. L., Vines, R. D, “Cloud security. A Comprehensive Guide to Secure Cloud
Computing”, Wiley Publishing, 2010.
REFERENCES
1. James E. Smith, Ravi Nair, “Virtual Machines: Versatile Platforms for Systems and
Processes”, Elsevier/Morgan Kaufmann, 2005.
2. Tim Mather, Subra Kumaraswamy, and Shahed Latif, “Cloud Security and Privacy: an
enterprise perspective on risks and compliance”, O’Reilly Media, Inc., 2009.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 1 3 2 1 3
2 3 1 2 2 1 - - - 1 2 1 3 2 2 1
3 2 3 2 3 1 - - - 3 1 1 3 1 1 1
4 1 2 3 3 3 - - - 3 3 1 2 1 3 3
5 2 3 3 1 3 - - - 2 2 1 2 2 2 3
AVg. 2.2 2.2 2.2 2 1.8 - - - 2.2 2.2 1 2.6 1.6 1.8 2.2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS372 VIRTUALIZATION LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To Learn the basics and types of Virtualization
 To understand the Hypervisors and its types
 To Explore the Virtualization Solutions
 To Experiment the virtualization platforms
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO VIRTUALIZATION 7
Virtualization and cloud computing - Need of virtualization – cost, administration, fast deployment,
reduce infrastructure cost – limitations- Types of hardware virtualization: Full virtualization - partial
virtualization - Paravirtualization-Types of Hypervisors

UNIT II SERVER AND DESKTOP VIRTUALIZATION 6


Virtual machine basics- Types of virtual machines- Understanding Server Virtualization- types of
server virtualization- Business Cases for Server Virtualization – Uses of Virtual Server
Consolidation – Selecting Server Virtualization Platform-Desktop Virtualization-Types of Desktop
Virtualization

UNIT III NETWORK VIRTUALIZATION 6


Introduction to Network Virtualization-Advantages- Functions-Tools for Network Virtualization-
VLAN-WAN Architecture-WAN Virtualization

UNIT IV STORAGE VIRTUALIZATION 5


Memory Virtualization-Types of Storage Virtualization-Block, File-Address space Remapping-Risks
of Storage Virtualization-SAN-NAS-RAID
111
UNIT V VIRTUALIZATION TOOLS 6
VMWare-Amazon AWS-Microsoft HyperV- Oracle VM Virtual Box - IBM PowerVM- Google
Virtualization- Case study.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1.Create type 2 virtualization in VMWARE or any equivalent Open Source Tool. Allocate memory
and storage space as per requirement. Install Guest OS on that VMWARE.
2. a.Shrink and extend virtual disk
b. Create, Manage, Configure and schedule snapshots
c. Create Spanned, Mirrored and Striped volume
d. Create RAID 5 volume
3. a.Desktop Virtualization using VNC
b.Desktop Virtualization using Chrome Remote Desktop
4.Create type 2 virtualization on ESXI 6.5 server
5.Create a VLAN in CISCO packet tracer
6.Install KVM in Linux
7.Create Nested Virtual Machine(VM under another VM)

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Analyse the virtualization concepts and Hypervisor
CO2: Apply the Virtualization for real-world applications
CO3: Install & Configure the different VM platforms
CO4: Experiment with the VM with various software
TOTAL :60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Cloud computing a practical approach - Anthony T.Velte , Toby J. Velte Robert Elsenpeter,
TATA McGraw- Hill , New Delhi – 2010
2. Cloud Computing (Principles and Paradigms), Edited by Rajkumar Buyya, James Broberg,
Andrzej Goscinski, John Wiley & Sons, Inc. 2011
3. David Marshall, Wade A. Reynolds, Advanced Server Virtualization: VMware and Microsoft
Platform in the Virtual Data Center, Auerbach
4. Chris Wolf, Erick M. Halter, “Virtualization: From the Desktop to the Enterprise”, APress,
2005.
5. James E. Smith, Ravi Nair, “Virtual Machines: Versatile Platforms for Systems and
Processes”, Elsevier/Morgan Kaufmann, 2005.
6. David Marshall, Wade A. Reynolds, “Advanced Server Virtualization: VMware and
Microsoft Platform in the Virtual Data Center”, Auerbach Publications, 2006.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1 3 1 3 2 - - - 1 1 3 1 2 3 2
2 3 2 2 1 2 - - - 1 2 2 3 3 2 1
3 3 2 1 3 1 - - - 2 2 1 3 3 3 2
4 1 1 2 3 3 - - - 3 3 1 1 3 2 2
5 1 3 2 3 1 - - - 2 1 3 3 1 1 2
AVg. 1.8 2.2 1.6 2.6 1.8 - - - 1.8 1.8 2 2.2 2.4 2.2 1.8
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation
112
CCS336 CLOUD SERVICES MANAGEMENT LTPC
2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Introduce Cloud Service Management terminology, definition & concepts
 Compare and contrast cloud service management with traditional IT service management
 Identify strategies to reduce risk and eliminate issues associated with adoption of cloud
services
 Select appropriate structures for designing, deploying and running cloud-based services in
a business environment
 Illustrate the benefits and drive the adoption of cloud-based services to solve real world
problems

UNIT I CLOUD SERVICE MANAGEMENT FUNDAMENTALS 6


Cloud Ecosystem, The Essential Characteristics, Basics of Information Technology Service
Management and Cloud Service Management, Service Perspectives, Cloud Service Models,
Cloud Service Deployment Models

UNIT II CLOUD SERVICES STRATEGY 6


Cloud Strategy Fundamentals, Cloud Strategy Management Framework, Cloud Policy, Key Driver
for Adoption, Risk Management, IT Capacity and Utilization, Demand and Capacity matching,
Demand Queueing, Change Management, Cloud Service Architecture

UNIT III CLOUD SERVICE MANAGEMENT 6


Cloud Service Reference Model, Cloud Service LifeCycle, Basics of Cloud Service Design,
Dealing with Legacy Systems and Services, Benchmarking of Cloud Services, Cloud Service
Capacity Planning, Cloud Service Deployment and Migration, Cloud Marketplace, Cloud Service
Operations Management

UNIT IV CLOUD SERVICE ECONOMICS 6


Pricing models for Cloud Services, Freemium, Pay Per Reservation, Pay per User, Subscription
based Charging, Procurement of Cloud-based Services, Capex vs Opex Shift, Cloud service
Charging, Cloud Cost Models

UNIT V CLOUD SERVICE GOVERNANCE & VALUE 6


IT Governance Definition, Cloud Governance Definition, Cloud Governance Framework, Cloud
Governance Structure, Cloud Governance Considerations, Cloud Service Model Risk Matrix,
Understanding Value of Cloud Services, Measuring the value of Cloud Services, Balanced
Scorecard, Total Cost of Ownership

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:Exhibit cloud-design skills to build and automate business solutions using cloud technologies.
CO2:Possess Strong theoretical foundation leading to excellence and excitement towards
adoption of cloud-based services
CO3: Solve the real world problems using Cloud services and technologies
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Create a Cloud Organization in AWS/Google Cloud/or any equivalent Open Source cloud
softwares like Openstack, Eucalyptus, OpenNebula with Role-based access control

113
2. Create a Cost-model for a web application using various services and do Cost-benefit
analysis
3. Create alerts for usage of Cloud resources
4. Create Billing alerts for your Cloud Organization
5. Compare Cloud cost for a simple web application across AWS, Azure and GCP and
suggest the best one
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Cloud Service Management and Governance: Smart Service Management in Cloud Era by
Enamul Haque, Enel Publications
2. Cloud Computing: Concepts, Technology & Architecture by Thomas Erl, Ricardo Puttini,
Zaigham Mohammad 2013
3. Cloud Computing Design Patterns by Thomas Erl, Robert Cope, Amin Naserpour

REFERENCES
1. Economics of Cloud Computing by Praveen Ayyappa, LAP Lambert Academic Publishing
2. Mastering Cloud Computing Foundations and Applications Programming Rajkumar Buyya,
Christian Vechhiola, S. Thamarai Selvi

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 1 1 1 - - - 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
2 3 1 2 3 2 - - - 1 2 3 1 2 2 2
3 1 1 3 1 3 - - - 3 3 1 1 3 2 1
4 1 1 1 2 3 - - - 2 3 3 1 1 1 1
5 1 3 3 2 2 - - - 1 3 1 2 1 3 2
AVg. 1.8 1.8 2 1.8 2.2 - - - 1.8 2.4 2.2 1.4 1.8 1.8 1.8
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS341 DATA WAREHOUSING LT PC


2 0 23
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To know the details of data warehouse Architecture
 To understand the OLAP Technology
 To understand the partitioning strategy
 To differentiate various schema
 To understand the roles of process manager & system manager

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO DATA WAREHOUSE 5


Data warehouse Introduction - Data warehouse components- operational database Vs data
warehouse – Data warehouse Architecture – Three-tier Data Warehouse Architecture -
Autonomous Data Warehouse- Autonomous Data Warehouse Vs Snowflake - Modern Data
Warehouse

114
UNIT II ETL AND OLAP TECHNOLOGY 6
What is ETL – ETL Vs ELT – Types of Data warehouses - Data warehouse Design and Modeling -
Delivery Process - Online Analytical Processing (OLAP) - Characteristics of OLAP - Online
Transaction Processing (OLTP) Vs OLAP - OLAP operations- Types of OLAP- ROLAP Vs
MOLAP Vs HOLAP.

UNIT III META DATA, DATA MART AND PARTITION STRATEGY 7


Meta Data – Categories of Metadata – Role of Metadata – Metadata Repository – Challenges for
Meta Management - Data Mart – Need of Data Mart- Cost Effective Data Mart- Designing Data
Marts- Cost of Data Marts- Partitioning Strategy – Vertical partition – Normalization – Row Splitting
– Horizontal Partition

UNIT IV DIMENSIONAL MODELING AND SCHEMA 6


Dimensional Modeling- Multi-Dimensional Data Modeling – Data Cube- Star Schema- Snowflake
schema- Star Vs Snowflake schema- Fact constellation Schema- Schema Definition - Process
Architecture- Types of Data Base Parallelism – Datawarehouse Tools

UNIT V SYSTEM & PROCESS MANAGERS 6


Data Warehousing System Managers: System Configuration Manager- System Scheduling
Manager - System Event Manager - System Database Manager - System Backup Recovery
Manager - Data Warehousing Process Managers: Load Manager – Warehouse Manager- Query
Manager – Tuning – Testing
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Data exploration and integration with WEKA
2. Apply weka tool for data validation
3. Plan the architecture for real time application
4. Write the query for schema definition
5. Design data ware house for real time applications
6. Analyse the dimensional Modeling
7. Case study using OLAP
8. Case study using OTLP
9. Implementation of warehouse testing.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course the students should be able to
CO1: Design data warehouse architecture for various Problems
CO2: Apply the OLAP Technology
CO3: Analyse the partitioning strategy
CO4: Critically analyze the differentiation of various schema for given problem
CO5: Frame roles of process manager & system manager
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Alex Berson and Stephen J. Smith “Data Warehousing, Data Mining & OLAP”, Tata
McGraw – Hill Edition, Thirteenth Reprint 2008.
2. Ralph Kimball, “The Data Warehouse Toolkit: The Complete Guide to Dimensional
Modeling”, Third edition, 2013.

115
REFERENCES
1. Paul Raj Ponniah, “Data warehousing fundamentals for IT Professionals”, 2012.
2. K.P. Soman, ShyamDiwakar and V. Ajay “Insight into Data mining Theory and Practice”,
Easter Economy Edition, Prentice Hall of India, 2006.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 3 3 3 2 2 - - - 3 - - 3
2 3 2 2 2 3 - - - 2 - 2 2
3 3 3 3 3 - - - - - - - 3
4 3 3 3 3 - - - - - - - 3
5 3 2 2 2 - 2 - - - - 2 2
AVg. 3 2.6 2.6 1.2 2.5 1 - - 2.5 - 2 2.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS367 STORAGE TECHNOLOGIES LTPC


3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:

 Characterize the functionalities of logical and physical components of storage


 Describe various storage networking technologies
 Identify different storage virtualization technologies
 Discuss the different backup and recovery strategies
 Understand common storage management activities and solutions

UNIT I STORAGE SYSTEMS 9


Introduction to Information Storage: Digital data and its types, Information storage, Key
characteristics of data center and Evolution of computing platforms. Information Lifecycle
Management. Third Platform Technologies: Cloud computing and its essential characteristics,
Cloud services and cloud deployment models, Big data analytics, Social networking and mobile
computing, Characteristics of third platform infrastructure and Imperatives for third platform
transformation. Data Center Environment: Building blocks of a data center, Compute systems and
compute virtualization and Software-defined data center.
UNIT II INTELLIGENT STORAGE SYSTEMS AND RAID 5
Components of an intelligent storage system, Components, addressing, and performance of hard
disk drives and solid-state drives, RAID, Types of intelligent storage systems, Scale-up and scale-
out storage
Architecture.

UNIT III STORAGE NETWORKING TECHNOLOGIES AND VIRTUALIZATION 13


Block-Based Storage System, File-Based Storage System, Object-Based and Unified Storage.
Fibre Channel SAN: Software-defined networking, FC SAN components and architecture, FC SAN
topologies, link aggregation, and zoning, Virtualization in FC SAN environment. Internet Protocol
SAN: iSCSI protocol, network components, and connectivity, Link aggregation, switch aggregation,
and VLAN, FCIP protocol,

116
connectivity, and configuration. Fibre Channel over Ethernet SAN: Components of FCoE SAN,
FCoE SAN connectivity, Converged Enhanced Ethernet, FCoE architecture.

UNIT IV BACKUP, ARCHIVE AND REPLICATION 12


Introduction to Business Continuity, Backup architecture, Backup targets and methods, Data
deduplication, Cloud-based and mobile device backup, Data archive, Uses of replication and its
characteristics, Compute based, storage-based, and network-based replication, Data migration,
Disaster Recovery as a Service
(DRaaS).

UNIT V SECURING STORAGE INFRASTRUCTURE 6


Information security goals, Storage security domains, Threats to a storage infrastructure, Security
controls to protect a storage infrastructure, Governance, risk, and compliance, Storage
infrastructure management functions, Storage infrastructure management processes.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Demonstrate the fundamentals of information storage management and various models of
Cloud infrastructure services and deployment
CO2: Illustrate the usage of advanced intelligent storage systems and RAID
CO3: Interpret various storage networking architectures - SAN, including storage subsystems and
virtualization
CO4: Examine the different role in providing disaster recovery and remote replication technologies
CO5: Infer the security needs and security measures to be employed in information storage
management
TOTAL:45 PERIODS

TEXTBOOKS

1. EMC Corporation, Information Storage and Management, Wiley, India


2. Jon Tate, Pall Beck, Hector Hugo Ibarra, Shanmuganathan Kumaravel and Libor Miklas,
Introduction to Storage Area Networks, Ninth Edition, IBM - Redbooks, December 2017
3. Ulf Troppens, Rainer Erkens, Wolfgang Mueller-Friedt, Rainer Wolafka, Nils Haustein
,Storage Networks Explained, Second Edition, Wiley, 2009
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 1 2 1 3 3 - - - 1 1 1 3 1 2 1
2 3 1 2 3 3 - - - 3 2 3 2 2 3 1
3 1 1 3 2 2 - - - 3 1 1 2 2 3 3
4 3 2 1 2 2 - - - 1 1 3 1 3 2 1
5 1 3 2 1 2 - - - 1 2 3 1 3 2 1
AVg. 1.8 1.8 1.8 2.2 2.4 - - - 1.8 1.4 2.2 1.8 2.2 2.4 1.4
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

117
CCS365 SOFTWARE DEFINED NETWORKS LTPC
2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the need for SDN and its data plane operations
 To understand the functions of control plane
 To comprehend the migration of networking functions to SDN environment
 To explore various techniques of network function virtualization
 To comprehend the concepts behind network virtualization

UNIT I SDN: INTRODUCTION 6


Evolving Network Requirements – The SDN Approach – SDN architecture - SDN Data Plane ,
Control plane and Application Plane

UNIT II SDN DATA PLANE AND CONTROL PLANE 6


Data Plane functions and protocols - OpenFLow Protocol - Flow Table - Control Plane Functions -
Southbound Interface, Northbound Interface – SDN Controllers - Ryu, OpenDaylight, ONOS -
Distributed Controllers

UNIT III SDN APPLICATIONS 6


SDN Application Plane Architecture – Network Services Abstraction Layer – Traffic Engineering –
Measurement and Monitoring – Security – Data Center Networking

UNIT IV NETWORK FUNCTION VIRTUALIZATION 6


Network Virtualization - Virtual LANs – OpenFlow VLAN Support - NFV Concepts – Benefits and
Requirements – Reference Architecture

UNIT V NFV FUNCTIONALITY 6


NFV Infrastructure – Virtualized Network Functions – NFV Management and Orchestration – NFV
Use cases – SDN and NFV
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1) Setup your own virtual SDN lab
i) Virtualbox/Mininet Environment for SDN - http://mininet.org
ii) https://www.kathara.org
iii) GNS3
2) Create a simple mininet topology with SDN controller and use Wireshark to capture and
visualize the OpenFlow messages such as OpenFlow FLOW MOD, PACKET IN, PACKET OUT
etc.
3) Create a SDN application that uses the Northbound API to program flow table rules on the
switch for various use cases like L2 learning switch, Traffic Engineering, Firewall etc.
4) Create a simple end-to-end network service with two VNFs using vim-emu
https://github.com/containernet/vim-emu
5) Install OSM and onboard and orchestrate network service.
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After the successful completion of this course, the student will be able to
CO1: Describe the motivation behind SDN
CO2: Identify the functions of the data plane and control plane
CO3: Design and develop network applications using SDN
118
CO4: Orchestrate network services using NFV
CO5: Explain various use cases of SDN and NFV
TOTAL :60 PERIODS
TEXTBOOKS:
1. William Stallings, “Foundations of Modern Networking: SDN, NFV, QoE, IoT and Cloud”,
Pearson Education, 1st Edition, 2015.

REFERENCES:
1. Ken Gray, Thomas D. Nadeau, “Network Function Virtualization”, Morgan Kauffman, 2016.
2. Thomas D Nadeau, Ken Gray, “SDN: Software Defined Networks”, O’Reilly Media, 2013.
3. Fei Hu, “Network Innovation through OpenFlow and SDN: Principles and Design”, 1st
Edition, CRC Press, 2014.
4. Paul Goransson, Chuck Black Timothy Culver, “Software Defined Networks: A
Comprehensive Approach”, 2nd Edition, Morgan Kaufmann Press, 2016.
5. Oswald Coker, Siamak Azodolmolky, “Software-Defined Networking with OpenFlow”, 2nd
Edition, O’Reilly Media, 2017.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 1 2 3 1 3 - - - 2 3 1 3 1 2 1
2 2 1 2 2 3 - - - 2 2 2 2 1 3 2
3 2 2 2 3 3 - - - 3 1 1 2 1 3 3
4 2 2 2 3 1 - - - 1 3 1 2 2 2 2
5 3 3 1 1 3 - - - 1 2 1 2 2 1 3
AVg. 2 2 2 2 2.6 - - - 1.8 2.2 1.2 2.2 1.4 2.2 2.2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS368 STREAM PROCESSING LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Introduce Data Processing terminology, definition & concepts
 Define different types of Data Processing
 Explain the concepts of Real-time Data processing
 Select appropriate structures for designing and running real-time data services in a
business environment
 Illustrate the benefits and drive the adoption of real-time data services to solve real world
problems

UNIT I FOUNDATIONS OF DATA SYSTEMS 6


Introduction to Data Processing, Stages of Data processing, Data Analytics, Batch Processing,
Stream processing, Data Migration, Transactional Data processing, Data Mining, Data
Management Strategy, Storage, Processing, Integration, Analytics, Benefits of Data as a Service,
Challenges

119
UNIT II REAL-TIME DATA PROCESSING 6
Introduction to Big data, Big data infrastructure, Real-time Analytics, Near real-time solution,
Lambda architecture, Kappa Architecture, Stream Processing,Understanding Data Streams,
Message Broker, Stream Processor, Batch & Real-time ETL tools, Streaming Data Storage

UNIT III DATA MODELS AND QUERY LANGUAGES 6


Relational Model, Document Model, Key-Value Pairs, NoSQL, Object-Relational Mismatch, Many-
to-One and Many-to-Many Relationships, Network data models, Schema Flexibility, Structured
Query Language, Data Locality for Queries, Declarative Queries, Graph Data models, Cypher
Query Language, Graph Queries in SQL, The Semantic Web, CODASYL, SPARQL

UNIT IV EVENT PROCESSING WITH APACHE KAFKA 6


Apache Kafka, Kafka as Event Streaming platform, Events, Producers, Consumers, Topics,
Partitions, Brokers, Kafka APIs, Admin API, Producer API, Consumer API, Kafka Streams API,
Kafka Connect API

UNIT V REAL-TIME PROCESSING USING SPARK STREAMING 6


Structured Streaming, Basic Concepts, Handling Event-time and Late Data, Fault-tolerant
Semantics, Exactly-once Semantics, Creating Streaming Datasets, Schema Inference, Partitioning
of Streaming datasets, Operations on Streaming Data, Selection, Aggregation, Projection,
Watermarking, Window operations, Types of Time windows, Join Operations, Deduplication
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Install MongoDB
2. Design and Implement Simple application using MongoDB
3. Query the designed system using MongoDB
4. Create a Event Stream with Apache Kafka
5. Create a Real-time Stream processing application using Spark Streaming
6. Build a Micro-batch application
7. Real-time Fraud and Anomaly Detection,
8. Real-time personalization, Marketing, Advertising

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the applicability and utility of different streaming algorithms.
CO2: Describe and apply current research trends in data-stream processing.
CO3: Analyze the suitability of stream mining algorithms for data stream systems.
CO4: Program and build stream processing systems, services and applications.
CO5: Solve problems in real-world applications that process data streams.
TOTAL :60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Streaming Systems: The What, Where, When and How of Large-Scale Data Processing by
Tyler Akidau, Slava Chemyak, Reuven Lax, O’Reilly publication
2. Designing Data-Intensive Applications by Martin Kleppmann, O’Reilly Media
3. Practical Real-time Data Processing and Analytics : Distributed Computing and Event
Processing using Apache Spark, Flink, Storm and Kafka, Packt Publishing

REFERENCES
1. https://spark.apache.org/docs/latest/streaming-programming-guide.html
2. Kafka.apache.org

120
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 2 3 1 - - - 2 3 1 2 1 3 3
2 2 1 1 2 2 - - - 3 2 2 3 1 2 1
3 3 1 2 3 3 - - - 2 2 1 1 2 2 1
4 2 1 3 3 3 - - - 3 3 1 1 1 2 1
5 3 3 1 2 2 - - - 3 3 2 3 2 3 2
AVg. 2.6 1.8 1.8 2.6 2.2 - - - 2.6 2.6 1.4 2 1.4 2.4 1.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS362 SECURITY AND PRIVACY IN CLOUD L T PC


2 0 23
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To Introduce Cloud Computing terminology, definition & concepts
 To understand the security design and architectural considerations for Cloud
 To understand the Identity, Access control in Cloud
 To follow best practices for Cloud security using various design patterns
 To be able to monitor and audit cloud applications for security

UNIT I FUNDAMENTALS OF CLOUD SECURITY CONCEPTS 7


Overview of cloud security- Security Services - Confidentiality, Integrity, Authentication, Non-
repudiation, Access Control - Basic of cryptography - Conventional and public-key cryptography,
hash functions, authentication, and digital signatures.

UNIT II SECURITY DESIGN AND ARCHITECTURE FOR CLOUD 6


Security design principles for Cloud Computing - Comprehensive data protection - End-to-end
access control - Common attack vectors and threats - Network and Storage - Secure Isolation
Strategies - Virtualization strategies - Inter-tenant network segmentation strategies - Data
Protection strategies: Data retention, deletion and archiving procedures for tenant data,
Encryption, Data Redaction, Tokenization, Obfuscation, PKI and Key

UNIT III ACCESS CONTROL AND IDENTITY MANAGEMENT 6


Access control requirements for Cloud infrastructure - User Identification - Authentication and
Authorization - Roles-based Access Control - Multi-factor authentication - Single Sign-on, Identity
Federation - Identity providers and service consumers - Storage and network access control
options - OS Hardening and minimization - Verified and measured boot - Intruder Detection and
prevention

UNIT IV CLOUD SECURITY DESIGN PATTERNS 6


Introduction to Design Patterns, Cloud bursting, Geo-tagging, Secure Cloud Interfaces, Cloud
Resource Access Control, Secure On-Premise Internet Access, Secure External Cloud

UNIT V MONITORING, AUDITING AND MANAGEMENT 5


Proactive activity monitoring - Incident Response, Monitoring for unauthorized access, malicious
traffic, abuse of system privileges - Events and alerts - Auditing – Record generation, Reporting
and Management, Tamper-proofing audit logs, Quality of Services, Secure Management, User
management, Identity management, Security Information and Event Management
121
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Simulate a cloud scenario using Cloud Sim and run a scheduling algorithm not present in Cloud
Sim
2. simulate resource management using cloud sim
3. simulate log forensics using cloud sim
4. simulate a secure file sharing using a cloud sim
5. Implement data anonymization techniques over the simple dataset (masking, k-anonymization,
etc)
6. Implement any encryption algorithm to protect the images
7. Implement any image obfuscation mechanism
8. Implement a role-based access control mechanism in a specific scenario
9. implement an attribute-based access control mechanism based on a particular scenario
10. Develop a log monitoring system with incident management in the cloud

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the cloud concepts and fundamentals.
CO2: Explain the security challenges in the cloud.
CO3: Define cloud policy and Identity and Access Management.
CO4: Understand various risks and audit and monitoring mechanisms in the cloud.
CO5: Define the various architectural and design considerations for security in the cloud.
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXTBOOKS
1. Raj Kumar Buyya , James Broberg, andrzejGoscinski, ―Cloud Computing:‖, Wiley 2013
2. Dave shackleford, ―Virtualization Security‖, SYBEX a wiley Brand 2013.
3. Mather, Kumaraswamy and Latif, ―Cloud Security and Privacy‖, OREILLY 2011
REFERENCES
1. Mark C. Chu-Carroll ―Code in the Cloud‖,CRC Press, 2011
2. Mastering Cloud Computing Foundations and Applications Programming RajkumarBuyya,
Christian Vechhiola, S. ThamaraiSelvi

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 1 2 - - - 1 1 1 3 3 1 2
2 1 3 2 3 1 - - - 2 2 3 2 3 1 2
3 3 2 2 3 2 - - - 3 1 1 2 2 3 1
4 2 1 2 3 3 - - - 3 2 3 3 1 1 2
5 1 3 3 1 1 - - - 2 3 3 2 2 3 2
AVg. 2 2.4 2.4 2.2 1.8 - - - 2.2 1.8 2.2 2.4 2.2 1.8 1.8
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

122
CCS333 AUGMENTED REALITY/VIRTUAL REALITY L T P C
2 0 2 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To impart the fundamental aspects and principles of AR/VR technologies.
 To know the internals of the hardware and software components involved in the
development of AR/VR enabled applications.
 To learn about the graphical processing units and their architectures.
 To gain knowledge about AR/VR application development.
 To know the technologies involved in the development of AR/VR based applications.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 7
Introduction to Virtual Reality and Augmented Reality – Definition – Introduction to Trajectories and
Hybrid Space-Three I’s of Virtual Reality – Virtual Reality Vs 3D Computer Graphics – Benefits of
Virtual Reality – Components of VR System – Introduction to AR-AR Technologies-Input Devices –
3D Position Trackers – Types of Trackers – Navigation and Manipulation Interfaces – Gesture
Interfaces – Types of Gesture Input Devices – Output Devices – Graphics Display – Human Visual
System – Personal Graphics Displays – Large Volume Displays – Sound Displays – Human
Auditory System.

UNIT II VR MODELING 6
Modeling – Geometric Modeling – Virtual Object Shape – Object Visual Appearance – Kinematics
Modeling – Transformation Matrices – Object Position – Transformation Invariants –Object
Hierarchies – Viewing the 3D World – Physical Modeling – Collision Detection – Surface
Deformation – Force Computation – Force Smoothing and Mapping – Behavior Modeling – Model
Management.

UNIT III VR PROGRAMMING 6


VR Programming – Toolkits and Scene Graphs – World ToolKit – Java 3D – Comparison of World
ToolKit and Java 3D

UNIT IV APPLICATIONS 6
Human Factors in VR – Methodology and Terminology – VR Health and Safety Issues – VR and
Society-Medical Applications of VR – Education, Arts and Entertainment – Military VR Applications
– Emerging Applications of VR – VR Applications in Manufacturing – Applications of VR in
Robotics – Information Visualization – VR in Business – VR in Entertainment – VR in Education.

UNIT V AUGMENTED REALITY 5


Introduction to Augmented Reality-Computer vision for AR-Interaction-Modelling and Annotation-
Navigation-Wearable devices
30 PERIODS

PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS

1. Study of tools like Unity, Maya, 3DS MAX, AR toolkit, Vuforia and Blender.
2. Use the primitive objects and apply various projection types by handling camera.
3. Download objects from asset store and apply various lighting and shading effects.
4. Model three dimensional objects using various modelling techniques and apply textures
over them.
123
5. Create three dimensional realistic scenes and develop simple virtual reality enabled mobile
applications which have limited interactivity.
6. Add audio and text special effects to the developed application.
7. Develop VR enabled applications using motion trackers and sensors incorporating full
haptic interactivity.
8. Develop AR enabled applications with interactivity like E learning environment, Virtual
walkthroughs and visualization of historic places.
9. Develop AR enabled simple applications like human anatomy visualization, DNA/RNA
structure visualization and surgery simulation.
10. Develop simple MR enabled gaming applications.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Understand the basic concepts of AR and VR
CO2: Understand the tools and technologies related to AR/VR
CO3: Know the working principle of AR/VR related Sensor devices
CO4: Design of various models using modeling techniques
CO5: Develop AR/VR applications in different domains

TEXTBOOKS:

1. Charles Palmer, John Williamson, “Virtual Reality Blueprints: Create compelling VR


experiences for mobile”, Packt Publisher, 2018
2. Dieter Schmalstieg, Tobias Hollerer, “Augmented Reality: Principles & Practice”, Addison
Wesley, 2016
3. John Vince, “Introduction to Virtual Reality”, Springer-Verlag, 2004.
4. William R. Sherman, Alan B. Craig: Understanding Virtual Reality – Interface, Application,
Design”, Morgan Kaufmann, 2003
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2 2 - 3 - - - 2 2 1 2 2 1 2
2 3 2 2 1 3 - - - 3 2 2 3 3 1 2
3 3 3 2 2 3 - - - 3 2 1 2 3 2 2
4 3 3 3 2 3 - - - 3 2 2 3 3 2 2
5 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
AVg. 3.00 2.60 2.40 2.00 3.00 - - - 2.80 2.20 1.80 2.60 2.80 1.80 2.20
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS361 ROBOTIC PROCESS AUTOMATION LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basic concepts of Robotic Process Automation.
 To expose to the key RPA design and development strategies and methodologies.
 To learn the fundamental RPA logic and structure.
 To explore the Exception Handling, Debugging and Logging operations in RPA.
 To learn to deploy and Maintain the software bot.
124
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO ROBOTIC PROCESS AUTOMATION 6
Emergence of Robotic Process Automation (RPA), Evolution of RPA, Differentiating RPA from
Automation - Benefits of RPA - Application areas of RPA, Components of RPA, RPA Platforms.
Robotic Process Automation Tools - Templates, User Interface, Domains in Activities, Workflow
Files.

UNIT II AUTOMATION PROCESS ACTIVITIES 6


Sequence, Flowchart & Control Flow: Sequencing the Workflow, Activities, Flowchart, Control Flow
for Decision making. Data Manipulation: Variables, Collection, Arguments, Data Table, Clipboard
management, File operations Controls: Finding the control, waiting for a control, Act on a control,
UiExplorer, Handling Events

UNIT III APP INTEGRATION, RECORDING AND SCRAPING 6


App Integration, Recording, Scraping, Selector, Workflow Activities. Recording mouse and
keyboard actions to perform operation, Scraping data from website and writing to CSV.
Process Mining.

UNIT IV EXCEPTION HANDLING AND CODE MANAGEMENT 6


Exception handling, Common exceptions, Logging- Debugging techniques, Collecting crash
dumps, Error reporting. Code management and maintenance: Project organization, Nesting
workflows, Reusability, Templates, Commenting techniques, State Machine.

UNIT V DEPLOYMENT AND MAINTENANCE 6


Publishing using publish utility, Orchestration Server, Control bots, Orchestration Server to deploy
bots, License management, Publishing and managing updates. RPA Vendors – Open
Source RPA, Future of RPA
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
Setup and Configure a RPA tool and understand the user interface of the tool:
1. Create a Sequence to obtain user inputs display them using a message box;
2. Create a Flowchart to navigate to a desired page based on a condition;
3. Create a State Machine workflow to compare user input with a random number.
4. Build a process in the RPA platform using UI Automation Activities.
5. Create an automation process using key System Activities, Variables and Arguments
6. Also implement Automation using System Trigger
7. Automate login to (web)Email account
8. Recording mouse and keyboard actions.
9. Scraping data from website and writing to CSV
10. Implement Error Handling in RPA platform
11. Web Scraping
12. Email Query Processing

TOTAL:60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
By the end of this course, the students will be able to:
 Enunciate the key distinctions between RPA and existing automation techniques and
platforms.
 Use UiPath to design control flows and work flows for the target process
125
 Implement recording, web scraping andprocess mining by automation
 Use UIPath Studio to detect, and handle exceptions in automation processes
 Implement and use Orchestrator for creation, monitoring, scheduling, and controlling of
automated bots and processes.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Learning Robotic Process Automation: Create Software robots and automate business
processes with the leading RPA tool - UiPath by Alok Mani Tripathi, Packt
Publishing, 2018.
2. Tom Taulli , “The Robotic Process Automation Handbook: A Guide to Implementing RPA
Systems”, Apress publications, 2020.

REFERENCES:
1. Frank Casale (Author), Rebecca Dilla (Author), Heidi Jaynes (Author), Lauren Livingston
(Author), Introduction to Robotic Process Automation: a Primer, Institute of Robotic
Process Automation, Amazon Asia-Pacific Holdings Private Limited, 2018
2. Richard Murdoch, Robotic Process Automation: Guide To Building Software Robots,
Automate Repetitive Tasks & Become An RPA Consultant, Amazon Asia-Pacific Holdings
Private Limited, 2018
3. A Gerardus Blokdyk, “Robotic Process Automation Rpa A Complete Guide “, 2020

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 1 3 - - - 1 3 3 2 2 2 1
2 1 1 2 3 3 - - - 1 2 3 1 3 2 1
3 2 3 2 3 3 - - - 2 3 1 1 3 3 3
4 1 2 1 2 2 - - - 1 2 1 3 3 3 2
5 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 3 1 1 1 3 2 1
AVg. 2 2.2 2 2.4 2.8 - - - 1.6 2.2 1.8 1.6 2.8 2.4 1.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS340 CYBER SECURITY LTPC


2 023

COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn cybercrime and cyberlaw.
 To understand the cyber attacks and tools for mitigating them.
 To understand information gathering.
 To learn how to detect a cyber attack.
 To learn how to prevent a cyber attack.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 6
Cyber Security – History of Internet – Impact of Internet – CIA Triad; Reason for Cyber Crime –
Need for Cyber Security – History of Cyber Crime; Cybercriminals – Classification of Cybercrimes

126
– A Global Perspective on Cyber Crimes; Cyber Laws – The Indian IT Act – Cybercrime and
Punishment.

UNIT II ATTACKS AND COUNTERMEASURES 6


OSWAP; Malicious Attack Threats and Vulnerabilities: Scope of Cyber-Attacks – Security Breach
– Types of Malicious Attacks – Malicious Software – Common Attack Vectors – Social engineering
Attack – Wireless Network Attack – Web Application Attack – Attack Tools – Countermeasures.

UNIT III RECONNAISSANCE 5


Harvester – Whois – Netcraft – Host – Extracting Information from DNS – Extracting Information
from E-mail Servers – Social Engineering Reconnaissance; Scanning – Port Scanning – Network
Scanning and Vulnerability Scanning – Scanning Methodology – Ping Sweer Techniques – Nmap
Command Switches – SYN – Stealth – XMAS – NULL – IDLE – FIN Scans – Banner Grabbing
and OS Finger printing Techniques.

UNIT IV INTRUSION DETECTION 5


Host -Based Intrusion Detection – Network -Based Intrusion Detection – Distributed or Hybrid
Intrusion Detection – Intrusion Detection Exchange Format – Honeypots – Example System Snort.

UNIT V INTRUSION PREVENTION 5


Firewalls and Intrusion Prevention Systems: Need for Firewalls – Firewall Characteristics and
Access Policy – Types of Firewalls – Firewall Basing – Firewall Location and Configurations –
Intrusion Prevention Systems – Example Unified Threat Management Products.

30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Install Kali Linux on Virtual box
2. Explore Kali Linux and bash scripting
3. Perform open source intelligence gathering using Netcraft, Whois Lookups, DNS
Reconnaissance, Harvester and Maltego
4. Understand the nmap command d and scan a target using nmap
5. Install metasploitable2 on the virtual box and search for unpatched vulnerabilities
6. Use Metasploit to exploit an unpatched vulnerability
7. Install Linus server on the virtual box and install ssh
8. Use Fail2banto scan log files and ban Ips that show the malicious signs
9. Launch brute-force attacks on the Linux server using Hydra.
10. Perform real-time network traffic analysis and data pocket logging using Snort

COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion of this course, the student will be able to
CO1: Explain the basics of cyber security, cyber crime and cyber law (K2)
CO2: Classify various types of attacks and learn the tools to launch the attacks (K2)
CO3 Apply various tools to perform information gathering (K3)
CO4: Apply intrusion techniques to detect intrusion (K3)
CO5: Apply intrusion prevention techniques to prevent intrusion (K3)
TOTAL:60 PERIODS

127
TEXTBOOKS
1. Anand Shinde, “Introduction to Cyber Security Guide to the World of Cyber Security”,
Notion Press, 2021 (Unit 1)
2. Nina Godbole, Sunit Belapure, “Cyber Security: Understanding Cyber Crimes, Computer
Forensics and Legal Perspectives”, Wiley Publishers, 2011 (Unit 1)
3. https://owasp.org/www-project-top-ten/

REFERENCES
1. David Kim, Michael G. Solomon, “Fundamentals of Information Systems Security”, Jones &
Bartlett Learning Publishers, 2013 (Unit 2)
2. Patrick Engebretson, “The Basics of Hacking and Penetration Testing: Ethical Hacking and
Penetration Testing Made easy”, Elsevier, 2011 (Unit 3)
3. Kimberly Graves, “CEH Official Certified Ethical hacker Review Guide”, Wiley Publishers,
2007 (Unit 3)
4. William Stallings, Lawrie Brown, “Computer Security Principles and Practice”, Third Edition,
Pearson Education, 2015 (Units 4 and 5)
5. Georgia Weidman, “Penetration Testing: A Hands-On Introduction to Hacking”, No Starch
Press, 2014 (Lab)

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 1 1 1 1 - 1 - - - - 1 - 2 2 2
2 1 3 1 3 2 1 - - - - - - 2 2 1
3 2 1 1 1 - 1 - - - - 1 - 2 2 2
4 3 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 2 3
5 3 2 1 1 1 1 - 1 - - 1 - 2 2 2
AVg. 2 2 1.2 1.6 1 1 0 0.2 0 0 0.6 0 2 2 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS359 QUANTUM COMPUTING LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To know the background of classical computing and quantum computing.
 To learn the fundamental concepts behind quantum computation.
 To study the details of quantum mechanics and its relation to Computer Science.
 To gain knowledge about the basic hardware and mathematical models of quantum
computation.
 To learn the basics of quantum information and the theory behind it.

UNIT I QUANTUM COMPUTING BASIC CONCEPTS 6


Complex Numbers - Linear Algebra - Matrices and Operators - Global Perspectives Postulates of
Quantum Mechanics – Quantum Bits - Representations of Qubits - Superpositions

128
UNIT II QUANTUM GATES AND CIRCUITS 5
Universal logic gates - Basic single qubit gates - Multiple qubit gates - Circuit development -
Quantum error correction

UNIT III QUANTUM ALGORITHMS 7


Quantum parallelism - Deutsch’s algorithm - The Deutsch–Jozsa algorithm - Quantum Fourier
transform and its applications - Quantum Search Algorithms: Grover’s Algorithm

UNIT IV QUANTUM INFORMATION THEORY 6


Data compression - Shannon’s noiseless channel coding theorem - Schumacher’s quantum
noiseless channel coding theorem - Classical information over noisy quantum channels

UNIT V QUANTUM CRYPTOGRAPHY 6


Classical cryptography basic concepts - Private key cryptography - Shor’s Factoring Algorithm -
Quantum Key Distribution - BB84 - Ekart 91
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES 30 PERIODS
1. Single qubit gate simulation - Quantum Composer
2. Multiple qubit gate simulation - Quantum Composer
3. Composing simple quantum circuits with q-gates and measuring the output into classical
bits.
4. IBM Qiskit Platform Introduction
5. Implementation of Shor’s Algorithms
6. Implementation of Grover’s Algorithm
7. Implementation of Deutsch’s Algorithm
8. Implementation of Deutsch-Jozsa’s Algorithm
9. Integer factorization using Shor’s Algorithm
10. QKD Simulation
11. Mini Project such as implementing an API for efficient search using Grover’s Algorithms or

COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Understand the basics of quantum computing.
CO2: Understand the background of Quantum Mechanics.
CO3: Analyze the computation models.
CO4: Model the circuits using quantum computation.
environments and frameworks.
CO5: Understand the quantum operations such as noise and error–correction.
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXTBOOKS:
1. Parag K Lala, Mc Graw Hill Education, “Quantum Computing, A Beginners Introduction”, First
edition (1 November 2020).
2. Michael A. Nielsen, Issac L. Chuang, “Quantum Computation and Quantum Information”,
Tenth Edition, Cambridge University Press, 2010.
3. Chris Bernhardt, The MIT Press; Reprint edition (8 September 2020), “Quantum Computing
for Everyone”.

129
REFERENCES
1. Scott Aaronson, “Quantum Computing Since Democritus”, Cambridge University Press, 2013.
2. N. David Mermin, “Quantum Computer Science: An Introduction”, Cambridge University
Press, 2007.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 2 - - - - 2 - - - 2 3 2
2 3 2 2 2 - - - - 2 - - - 2 3 1
3 3 3 3 3 2 - - - 3 - - - 3 2 2
4 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 3 - - - 1 3 2
5 3 3 2 3 - - - - 2 - - - 1 3 3
AVg. 3 2.6 2.4 2.6 1 - - - 2.4 - - - 1.8 2.8 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS339 CRYPTOCURRENCY AND BLOCKCHAIN TECHNOLOGIES LTPC


2023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basics of Blockchain
 To learn Different protocols and consensus algorithms in Blockchain
 To learn the Blockchain implementation frameworks
 To understand the Blockchain Applications
 To experiment the Hyperledger Fabric, Ethereum networks

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO BLOCKCHAIN 7


Blockchain- Public Ledgers, Blockchain as Public Ledgers - Block in a Blockchain, Transactions-
The Chain and the Longest Chain - Permissioned Model of Blockchain, Cryptographic -Hash
Function, Properties of a hash function-Hash pointer and Merkle tree

UNIT II BITCOIN AND CRYPTOCURRENCY 6


A basic crypto currency, Creation of coins, Payments and double spending, FORTH – the
precursor for Bitcoin scripting, Bitcoin Scripts , Bitcoin P2P Network, Transaction in Bitcoin
Network, Block Mining, Block propagation and block relay

UNIT III BITCOIN CONSENSUS 6


Bitcoin Consensus, Proof of Work (PoW)- Hashcash PoW , Bitcoin PoW, Attacks on PoW
,monopoly problem- Proof of Stake- Proof of Burn - Proof of Elapsed Time - Bitcoin Miner, Mining
Difficulty, Mining Pool-Permissioned model and use cases.

UNIT IV HYPERLEDGER FABRIC & ETHEREUM 5


Architecture of Hyperledger fabric v1.1- chain code- Ethereum: Ethereum network, EVM,
Transaction fee, Mist Browser, Ether, Gas, Solidity.

UNIT V BLOCKCHAIN APPLICATIONS 6


Smart contracts, Truffle Design and issue- DApps- NFT. Blockchain Applications in Supply Chain
Management, Logistics, Smart Cities, Finance and Banking, Insurance,etc- Case Study.
130
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand emerging abstract models for Blockchain Technology
CO2: Identify major research challenges and technical gaps existing between theory and practice
in the crypto currency domain.
CO3: It provides conceptual understanding of the function of Blockchain as a method of securing
distributed ledgers, how consensus on their contents is achieved, and the new applications that
they enable.
CO4: Apply hyperledger Fabric and Ethereum platform to implement the Block chain Application.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL 30 PERIODS
1. Install and understand Docker container, Node.js, Java and Hyperledger Fabric, Ethereum
and perform necessary software installation on local machine/create instance on cloud to
run.
2. Create and deploy a blockchain network using Hyperledger Fabric SDK for Java Set up
and initialize the channel, install and instantiate chain code, and perform invoke and query
on your blockchain network.
3. Interact with a blockchain network. Execute transactions and requests against a blockchain
network by creating an app to test the network and its rules.
4. Deploy an asset-transfer app using blockchain. Learn app development within a
Hyperledger Fabric network.
5. Use blockchain to track fitness club rewards. Build a web app that uses Hyperledger Fabric
to track and trace member rewards.
6. Car auction network: A Hello World example with Hyperledger Fabric Node SDK and IBM
Blockchain Starter Plan. Use Hyperledger Fabric to invoke chain code while storing results
and data in the starter plan
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Bashir and Imran, Mastering Blockchain: Deeper insights into decentralization,
cryptography, Bitcoin, and popular Blockchain frameworks, 2017.
2. 2.Andreas Antonopoulos, “Mastering Bitcoin: Unlocking Digital Cryptocurrencies”, O’Reilly,
2014.

REFERENCES:
1. Daniel Drescher, “Blockchain Basics”, First Edition, Apress, 2017.
2. Arvind Narayanan, Joseph Bonneau, Edward Felten, Andrew Miller, and Steven Goldfeder.
Bitcoin and cryptocurrency technologies: a comprehensive introduction. Princeton
University Press, 2016.
3. Melanie Swan, “Blockchain: Blueprint for a New Economy”, O’Reilly, 2015
4. Ritesh Modi, “Solidity Programming Essentials: A Beginner’s Guide to Build Smart
Contracts for Ethereum and Blockchain”, Packt Publishing
5. Handbook of Research on Blockchain Technology, published by Elsevier Inc. ISBN:
9780128198162, 2020.

131
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 2 2 1 - - - 1 - - 2 3 3
2 3 3 3 3 1 - - - 2 - - 2 3 3
3 3 3 3 3 2 - - - 3 - - 2 3 3
4 3 2 3 2 3 - - - 3 - - 2 3 2
AVg. 3 2.75 2.75 2.5 1.75 - - - 2.25 - - 2 3 2.75
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS347 GAME DEVELOPMENT LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To know the basics of 2D and 3D graphics for game development.
 To know the stages of game development.
 To understand the basics of a game engine.
 To survey the gaming development environment and tool kits.
 To learn and develop simple games using Pygame environment

UNIT I 3D GRAPHICS FOR GAME DESIGN 6


Genres of Games, Basics of 2D and 3D Graphics for Game Avatar, Game Components – 2D and
3D Transformations – Projections – Color Models – Illumination and Shader Models – Animation –
Controller Based Animation.

UNIT II GAME DESIGN PRINCIPLES 6


Character Development, Storyboard Development for Gaming – Script Design – Script Narration,
Game Balancing, Core Mechanics, Principles of Level Design – Proposals – Writing for
Preproduction, Production and Post – Production.

UNIT III GAME ENGINE DESIGN 6


Rendering Concept – Software Rendering – Hardware Rendering – Spatial Sorting Algorithms –
Algorithms for Game Engine– Collision Detection – Game Logic – Game AI – Pathfinding.

UNIT IV OVERVIEW OF GAMING PLATFORMS AND FRAMEWORKS 6


Pygame Game development – Unity – Unity Scripts –Mobile Gaming, Game Studio, Unity
Single player and Multi-Player games.

UNIT V GAME DEVELOPMENT USING PYGAME 6


Developing 2D and 3D interactive games using Pygame – Avatar Creation – 2D and 3D Graphics
Programming – Incorporating music and sound – Asset Creations – Game Physics algorithms
Development – Device Handling in Pygame – Overview of Isometric and Tile Based arcade
Games – Puzzle Games.
30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Explain the concepts of 2D and 3d Graphics

132
CO2: Design game design documents.
CO3: Implementation of gaming engines.
CO4: Survey gaming environments and frameworks.
CO5: Implement a simple game in Pygame.
EXPERIMENTS: 30 PERIODS
1. Installation of a game engine, e.g., Unity, Unreal Engine, familiarization of the GUI.
Conceptualize the theme for a 2D game.
2. Character design, sprites, movement and character control
3. Level design: design of the world in the form of tiles along with interactive and collectible
objects.
4. Design of interaction between the player and the world, optionally using the physics
engine.
5. Developing a 2D interactive using Pygame
6. Developing a Puzzle game
7. Design of menus and user interaction in mobile platforms.
8. Developing a 3D Game using Unreal
9. Developing a Multiplayer game using unity
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
REFERENCES
1. Sanjay Madhav, “Game Programming Algorithms and Techniques: A Platform Agnostic
Approach”, Addison Wesley,2013.
2. Will McGugan, “Beginning Game Development with Python and Pygame: From Novice to
Professional”, Apress,2007.
3. Paul Craven, “Python Arcade games”, Apress Publishers,2016.
4. David H. Eberly, “3D Game Engine Design: A Practical Approach to Real-Time Computer
Graphics”, Second Edition, CRC Press,2006.
5. Jung Hyun Han, “3D Graphics for Game Programming”, Chapman and Hall/CRC, 2011.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 1 2 - - - - - - - 2 2 2
2 1 2 2 1 2 - - - - - - - 2 2 1
3 1 1 1 2 1 - - - - - - - 2 2 2
4 3 3 1 3 3 - - - - - - - 2 2 3
5 3 3 2 1 3 - - - - - - - 2 2 3
AVg. 2.2 2.2 1.6 1.6 2.2 - - - - - - - 2 2 2.2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS331 3D PRINTING AND DESIGN LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To discuss on basics of 3D printing
To explain the principles of 3D printing technique
 To explain and illustrate inkjet technology
 To explain and illustrate laser technology
133
 To discuss the applications of 3D printing
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 6
Introduction; Design considerations – Material, Size, Resolution, Process; Modelling and
viewing - 3D; Scanning; Model preparation – Digital; Slicing; Software; File formats

UNIT II PRINCIPLE 6
Processes – Extrusion, Wire, Granular, Lamination, Photopolymerisation; Materials - Paper,
Plastics, Metals, Ceramics, Glass, Wood, Fiber, Sand, Biological Tissues, Hydrogels, Graphene;
Material Selection - Processes, applications, limitations;

UNIT III INKJET TECHNOLOGY 6


Printer - Working Principle, Positioning System, Print head, Print bed, Frames, Motion control;
Print head Considerations – Continuous Inkjet, Thermal Inkjet, Piezoelectric Drop-On-Demand;
Material Formulation for jetting; Liquid based fabrication – Continous jet, Mulitjet; Powder based
fabrication – Colourjet.

UNIT IV LASER TECHNOLOGY 6


Light Sources – Types, Characteristics; Optics – Deflection, Modulation; Material feeding and flow
– Liquid, powder; Printing machines – Types, Working Principle, Build Platform, Print bed
Movement, Support structures;

UNIT V INDUSTRIAL APPLICATIONS 6


Product Models, manufacturing – Printed electronics, Biopolymers, Packaging, Healthcare, Food,
Medical, Biotechnology, Displays; Future trends;
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Study the interface and basic tools in the CAD software.
2. Study 3D printer(s) including print heads, build envelope, materials used and related support
removal system(s).
3. Review of geometry terms of a 3D mesh.
4. Commands for moving from 2D to 3D.
5. Advanced CAD commands to navigate models in 3D space
6. Design any four everyday objects
Refer to web sites like Thingiverse, Shapeways and GitFab to design four everyday objects that
utilize the advantages of 3D printing
. Choose four models from a sharing site like Thingiverse, Shapeways or Gitfab.
a. Improve upon a file and make it your own. Some ideas include:
• Redesign it with a specific user in mind
• Redesign it for a slightly different purpose
• Improve the look of the product
7. Use the CAM software to prepare files for 3D printing.
8. Manipulate machine movement and material layering.
9. Repair a 3D mesh using
a) Freeware utilities: Autodesk MeshMixer (http://goo.gl/x5nhYc), MeshLab (http://goo.gl/fgztLl) or
Netfabb Basic or Cloud Service (http://goo.gl/Q1P47a)
b) Freeware tool tutorials: Netfabb Basic or Cloud Service (http://goo.gl/Q1P47a), Netfabb and
MeshLab (http://goo.gl/WPOVec)
134
c) Professional tools: Magics or Netfabb

Equipment : one 3D printer for every 10-15 students


COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Outline and examine the basic concepts of 3D printing technology
CO2: Outline 3D printing workflow`
CO3 Explain and categorise the concepts and working principles of 3D printing using inkjet
technique
CO4: Explain and categorise the working principles of 3D printing using laser technique
CO5: Explain various method for designing and modeling for industrial applications
TOTAL :60PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Christopher Barnatt, 3D Printing: The Next Industrial Revolution, CreateSpace Independent
Publishing Platform, 2013.
2. Ian M. Hutchings, Graham D. Martin, Inkjet Technology for Digital Fabrication, John Wiley &
Sons, 2013.
REFERENCES:
1. Chua, C.K., Leong K.F. and Lim C.S., Rapid prototyping: Principles and applications, second
edition, World Scientific Publishers, 2010
2. Ibrahim Zeid, Mastering CAD CAM Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Co., 2007
3. Joan Horvath, Mastering 3D Printing, APress, 2014

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 1 1 2 2 3 1 - - 2 - 2 2 3 2
2 3 2 3 3 3 2 - - 3 - 3 2 3 2
3 2 2 2 2 2 2 - - 2 - 2 2 3 2
4 2 2 2 2 3 2 - - 2 - 2 2 3 3
5 1 3 3 3 3 3 - - 3 - 3 3 3 3
AVg. 1.8 2 2.4 2.4 2.8 2 - - 2.4 - 2.4 2.2 3 2.4
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS350 KNOWLEDGE ENGINEERING LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
● To understand the basics of Knowledge Engineering.
● To discuss methodologies and modeling for Agent Design and Development.
● To design and develop ontologies.
● To apply reasoning with ontologies and rules.
● To understand learning and rule learning.

UNIT I REASONING UNDER UNCERTAINTY 6


Introduction – Abductive reasoning – Probabilistic reasoning: Enumerative Probabilities –
Subjective Bayesian view – Belief Functions – Baconian Probability – Fuzzy Probability –
135
Uncertainty methods - Evidence-based reasoning – Intelligent Agent – Mixed-Initiative Reasoning
– Knowledge Engineering.

UNIT II METHODOLOGY AND MODELING 6


Conventional Design and Development – Development tools and Reusable Ontologies – Agent
Design and Development using Learning Technology – Problem Solving through Analysis and
Synthesis – Inquiry-driven Analysis and Synthesis – Evidence-based Assessment – Believability
Assessment – Drill-Down Analysis, Assumption-based Reasoning, and What-If Scenarios.

UNIT III ONTOLOGIES – DESIGN AND DEVELOPMENT 6


Concepts and Instances – Generalization Hierarchies – Object Features – Defining Features –
Representation – Transitivity – Inheritance – Concepts as Feature Values – Ontology Matching.
Design and Development Methodologies – Steps in Ontology Development – Domain
Understanding and Concept Elicitation – Modelling-based Ontology Specification.

UNIT IV REASONIING WITH ONTOLOGIES AND RULES 6


Production System Architecture – Complex Ontology-based Concepts – Reduction and Synthesis
rules and the Inference Engine – Evidence-based hypothesis analysis – Rule and Ontology
Matching – Partially Learned Knowledge – Reasoning with Partially Learned Knowledge.

UNIT V LEARNING AND RULE LEARNING 6


Machine Learning – Concepts – Generalization and Specialization Rules – Types – Formal
definition of Generalization. Modelling, Learning and Problem Solving – Rule learning and
Refinement – Overview – Rule Generation and Analysis – Hypothesis Learning.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Perform operations with Evidence Based Reasoning.
2. Perform Evidence based Analysis.
3. Perform operations on Probability Based Reasoning.
4. Perform Believability Analysis.
5. Implement Rule Learning and refinement.
6. Perform analysis based on learned patterns.
7. Construction of Ontology for a given domain.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Understand the basics of Knowledge Engineering.
CO2: Apply methodologies and modelling for Agent Design and Development.
CO3: Design and develop ontologies.
CO4: Apply reasoning with ontologies and rules.
CO5: Understand learning and rule learning.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Gheorghe Tecuci, Dorin Marcu, Mihai Boicu, David A. Schum, Knowledge Engineering Building
Cognitive Assistants for Evidence-based Reasoning, Cambridge University Press, First Edition,
2016. (Unit 1 – Chapter 1 / Unit 2 – Chapter 3,4 / Unit 3 – Chapter 5, 6 / Unit 4 - 7 , Unit 5 –
Chapter 8, 9 )

136
REFERENCES:
1. Ronald J. Brachman, Hector J. Levesque: Knowledge Representation and Reasoning, Morgan
Kaufmann, 2004.
2. Ela Kumar, Knowledge Engineering, I K International Publisher House, 2018.
3. John F. Sowa: Knowledge Representation: Logical, Philosophical, and Computational
Foundations, Brooks/Cole, Thomson Learning, 2000.
4. King , Knowledge Management and Organizational Learning , Springer, 2009.
5. Jay Liebowitz, Knowledge Management Learning from Knowledge Engineering, 1st
Edition,2001.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 1 1 1 1 1 - - 1 2 1 2 1 1 1 1
2 3 2 3 2 2 - - - 2 1 2 1 3 3 1 2
3 2 2 3 2 2 - - - 3 2 2 2 3 2 3 3
4 2 2 3 1 1 - - - 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2
5 2 2 2 1 1 - - - 2 1 1 1 2 1 1 1
AVg. 2.4 1.8 2.4 1.4 1.4 0.2 0 0 2 1.6 1.6 1.6 2.2 1.6 1.4 1.8
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS364 SOFT COMPUTING LTPC


20 23
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the ideas of fuzzy sets, fuzzy logic and use of heuristics based on human
experience.
 To provide the mathematical background for carrying out the optimization associated with
neural network learning
 To learn various evolutionary Algorithms.
 To become familiar with neural networks that can learn from available examples and
generalize to form appropriate rules for inference systems.
 To introduce case studies utilizing the above and illustrate the Intelligent behavior of
programs based on soft computing

UNIT 1 INTRODUCTION TO SOFT COMPUTING AND FUZZY LOGIC 6


Introduction - Fuzzy Logic - Fuzzy Sets, Fuzzy Membership Functions, Operations on Fuzzy Sets,
Fuzzy Relations, Operations on Fuzzy Relations, Fuzzy Rules and Fuzzy Reasoning, Fuzzy
Inference Systems

UNIT II NEURAL NETWORKS 6


Supervised Learning Neural Networks – Perceptrons - Backpropagation -Multilayer Perceptrons –
Unsupervised Learning Neural Networks – Kohonen Self-Organizing Networks

UNIT III GENETIC ALGORITHMS 6


Chromosome Encoding Schemes -Population initialization and selection methods - Evaluation
function - Genetic operators- Cross over – Mutation - Fitness Function – Maximizing function

137
UNIT IV NEURO FUZZY MODELING 6
ANFIS architecture – hybrid learning – ANFIS as universal approximator – Coactive Neuro fuzzy
modeling – Framework – Neuron functions for adaptive networks – Neuro fuzzy spectrum -
Analysis of Adaptive Learning Capability

UNIT V APPLICATIONS 6
Modeling a two input sine function - Printed Character Recognition – Fuzzy filtered neural
networks – Plasma Spectrum Analysis – Hand written neural recognition - Soft Computing for
Color Recipe Prediction.
30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the fundamentals of fuzzy logic operators and inference mechanisms
CO2: Understand neural network architecture for AI applications such as classification and
clustering
CO3: Learn the functionality of Genetic Algorithms in Optimization problems
CO4: Use hybrid techniques involving Neural networks and Fuzzy logic
CO5: Apply soft computing techniques in real world applications

PRACTICAL EXERCISES 30 PERIODS


1. Implementation of fuzzy control/ inference system
2. Programming exercise on classification with a discrete perceptron
3. Implementation of XOR with backpropagation algorithm
4. Implementation of self organizing maps for a specific application
5. Programming exercises on maximizing a function using Genetic algorithm
6. Implementation of two input sine function
7. Implementation of three input non linear function
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. SaJANG, J.-S. R., SUN, C.-T., & MIZUTANI, E. (1997). Neuro-fuzzy and soft computing: A
computational approach to learning and machine intelligence. Upper Saddle River, NJ,
Prentice Hall,1997
2. Himanshu Singh, Yunis Ahmad Lone, Deep Neuro-Fuzzy Systems with Python
3. With Case Studies and Applications from the Industry, Apress, 2020
REFERENCES
1. roj Kaushik and Sunita Tiwari, Soft Computing-Fundamentals Techniques and
Applications, 1st Edition, McGraw Hill, 2018.
2. S. Rajasekaran and G.A.V.Pai, “Neural Networks, Fuzzy Logic and Genetic Algorithms”,
PHI, 2003.
3. Samir Roy, Udit Chakraborthy, Introduction to Soft Computing, Neuro Fuzzy and Genetic
Algorithms, Pearson Education, 2013.
4. S.N. Sivanandam, S.N. Deepa, Principles of Soft Computing, Third Edition, Wiley India Pvt
Ltd, 2019.
5. R.Eberhart, P.Simpson and R.Dobbins, “Computational Intelligence - PC Tools”, AP
Professional, Boston, 1996

138
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 3 3 3 - - - 3 1 3 2 3 1 2
2 2 3 3 2 3 - - - 3 2 3 2 2 1 3
3 1 3 2 2 1 - - - 3 1 1 2 1 3 2
4 1 2 1 3 2 - - - 3 3 1 1 2 1 1
5 2 3 1 2 1 - - - 3 3 3 2 1 2 3
AVg. 1.8 2.6 2 2.4 2 - - - 3 2 2.2 1.8 1.8 1.6 2.2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCS357 OPTIMIZATION TECHNIQUES LTPC


2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The objective of this course is to enable the student to
 Formulate and solve linear programming problems (LPP)
 Evaluate Integer Programming Problems, Transportation and Assignment
Problems.
 Obtain a solution to network problems using CPM and PERT techniques.
 Able to optimize the function subject to the constraints.
 Identify and solve problems under Markovian queuing models.

UNIT I LINEAR MODELS 6


Introduction of Operations Research - mathematical formulation of LPP- Graphical Methods to
solve LPP- Simplex Method- Two-Phase method

UNIT II INTEGER PROGRAMMING AND TRANSPORTATION PROBLEMS 6


Integer programming: Branch and bound method- Transportation and Assignment problems -
Traveling salesman problem.

UNIT III PROJECT SCHEDULING 6


Project network -Diagram representation – Floats - Critical path method (CPM) – PERT- Cost
considerations in PERT and CPM

UNIT IV CLASSICAL OPTIMIZATION THEORY 6


Unconstrained problems – necessary and sufficient conditions - Newton-Raphson method,
Constrained problems – equality constraints – inequality constraints - Kuhn-Tucker conditions.

UNIT V QUEUING MODELS 6


Introduction, Queuing Theory, Operating characteristics of a Queuing system, Constituents of a
Queuing system, Service facility, Queue discipline, Single channel models, multiple service
channels.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICALS 30 PERIODS
1.Solving simplex maximization problems using R programming.
2. Solving simplex minimization problems using R programming.
139
3. Solving mixed constraints problems – Big M & Two phase method using TORA.
4. Solving transportation problems using R.
5. Solving assignment problems using R.
6. Solving optimization problems using LINGO.
7. Studying Primal-Dual relationships in LP using TORA.
8. Solving LP problems using dual simplex method using TORA.
9. Sensitivity & post optimality analysis using LINGO.
10. Solving shortest route problems using optimization software
11. Solving Project Management problems using optimization software
12. Testing random numbers and random variates for their uniformity.
13. Testing random numbers and random variates for their independence
14. Solve single server queuing model using simulation software package.
15. Solve multi server queuing model using simulation software package.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion of this course, the student will able to
CO1: Formulate and solve linear programming problems (LPP)
CO2: Evaluate Integer Programming Problems, Transportation and Assignment Problems.
CO3: Obtain a solution to network problems using CPM and PERT techniques.
CO4: Able to optimize the function subject to the constraints.
CO5: Identify and solve problems under Markovian queuing models

TEXT BOOK:
1. Hamdy A Taha, Operations Research: An Introduction, Pearson, 10th Edition, 2017.

REFERENCES:
1. ND Vohra, Quantitative Techniques in Management, Tata McGraw Hill, 4th Edition, 2011.
2. J. K. Sharma, Operations Research Theory and Applications, Macmillan, 5th Edition, 2012.
3. Hiller F.S, Liberman G.J, Introduction to Operations Research, 10th Edition McGraw Hill,
2017.
4. Jit. S. Chandran, Mahendran P. Kawatra, KiHoKim, Essentials of Linear Programming,
Vikas Publishing House Pvt.Ltd. New Delhi, 1994.
5. Ravindran A., Philip D.T., and Solberg J.J., Operations Research, John Wiley, 2nd Edition,
2007.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 2 1 1 - - - 2 1 1 2 3 3 3
2 3 1 2 2 3 - - - 3 2 3 1 2 1 1
3 2 3 3 2 2 - - - 3 3 1 3 1 3 1
4 2 2 1 1 3 - - - 2 1 3 1 2 1 2
5 2 1 1 3 2 - - - 3 3 1 3 3 2 1
AVg. 2.4 2 1.8 1.8 2.2 - - - 2.6 2 1.8 2 2.2 2 1.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

140
CCS348 GAME THEORY L T PC
2 0 23
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
• To introduce the student to the notion of a game, its solutions concepts, and other basic
notions and tools of game theory, and the main applications for which they are appropriate,
including electronic trading markets.
• To formalize the notion of strategic thinking and rational choice by using the tools of game
theory, and to provide insights into using game theory in 41odeIIing applications.
• To draw the connections between game theory, computer science, and economics,
especially emphasizing the computational issues.
• To introduce contemporary topics in the intersection of game theory, computer science, and
economics.
• To apply game theory in searching, auctioning and trading.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 6
Introduction — Making rational choices: basics of Games — strategy — preferences — payoffs
— Mathematical basics — Game theory — Rational Choice — Basic solution concepts-non-
cooperative versus cooperative games — Basic computational issues — finding equilibria and
learning in games- Typical application areas for game theory (e.g. Google's sponsored search,
eBay auctions, electricity trading markets).

UNIT II GAMES WITH PERFECT INFORMATION 6


Games with Perfect Information — Strategic games — prisoner's dilemma, matching pennies -
Nash equilibria —mixed strategy equilibrium — zero-sum games

UNIT III GAMES WITH IMPERFECT INFORMATION 6


Games with Imperfect Information — Bayesian Games — Motivational Examples — General
Definitions
— Information aspects — Illustrations — Extensive Games with Imperfect — Information —
Strategies — Nash Equilibrium —Repeated Games — The Prisoner's Dilemma — Bargaining

UNIT IV NON-COOPERATIVE GAME THEORY 6


Non-cooperative Game Theory — Self-interested agents — Games in normal form — Analyzing
games: from optimality to equilibrium — Computing Solution Concepts of Normal — Form
Games — Computing Nash equilibria of two-player, zero-sum games —Computing Nash
equilibria of two-player, general- sum games — Identifying dominated strategies

UNIT V MECHANISM DESIGN 6


Aggregating Preferences — Social Choice — Formal Model — Voting — Existence of social
functions — Ranking systems — Protocols for Strategic Agents: Mechanism Design —
Mechanism design with unrestricted preferences
30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon Completion of the course, the students will be able to
CO1: Discuss the notion of a strategic game and equilibria and identify the characteristics of
main applications of these concepts.
CO2: Discuss the use of Nash Equilibrium for other problems.

141
CO3: Identify key strategic aspects and based on these be able to connect them to appropriate
game theoretic concepts given a real world situation.
CO4: Identify some applications that need aspects of Bayesian Games.
CO5: Implement a typical Virtual Business scenario using Game theory.

LABORATORY EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS

● Prisoner’s dilemma
● Pure Strategy Nash Equilibrium
● Extensive Form – Graphs and Trees, Game Trees
● Strategic Form – Elimination of dominant strategy
● Minimax theorem, minimax strategies
● Perfect information games: trees, players assigned to nodes, payoffs, backward Induction,
subgame perfect equilibrium,
● imperfect-information games - Mixed Strategy Nash Equilibrium - Finding mixed-strategy
Nash equilibria for zero sum games, mixed versus behavioral strategies.
● Repeated Games
● Bayesian Nash equilibrium

TEXT BOOKS:

1. M. J. Osborne, An Introduction to Game Theory. Oxford University Press, 2012.


2. M. Machler, E. Solan, S. Zamir, Game Theory, Cambridge University Press, 2013.
3. N. Nisan, T. Roughgarden, E. Tardos, and V. V. Vazirani, Algorithmic Game Theory.
Cambridge University Press, 2007.
4. A.Dixit and S. Skeath, Games of Strategy, Second Edition. W W Norton & Co Inc, 2004.
5. YoavShoham, Kevin Leyton-Brown, Multiagent Systems: Algorithmic, Game-Theoretic, and
Logical Foundations, Cambridge University Press 2008.
6. Zhu Han, DusitNiyato, WalidSaad, TamerBasar and Are Hjorungnes, “Game Theory in
Wireless and Communication Networks”, Cambridge University Press, 2012.
7. Y.Narahari, “Game Theory and Mechanism Design”, IISC Press, World Scientific.
8. William Spaniel, “Game Theory 101: The Complete Textbook”, CreateSpace Independent
Publishing, 2011.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

CO’s PO’s PSO’s


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 2 3 3 - - - - - - - 1 1 3
2 3 3 3 2 3 - - - - - - - 1 1 1
3 1 1 3 3 3 - - - - - - - 1 1 2
4 2 1 1 1 1 - - - - - - - 1 1 2
5 2 2 3 2 1 - - - - - - - 1 1 2
AVg. 2.2 2 2.4 2.2 2.2 - - - - - - - 1 1 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

142
CCS337 COGNITIVE SCIENCE LTPC
2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To know the theoretical background of cognition.
 To understand the link between cognition and computational intelligence.
 To explore probabilistic programming language.
 To study the computational inference models of cognition.
 To study the computational learning models of cognition.

UNIT I PHILOSOPHY, PSYCHOLOGY AND NEUROSCIENCE 6


Philosophy: Mental-physical Relation – From Materialism to Mental Science – Logic and the
Sciences of the Mind – Psychology: Place of Psychology within Cognitive Science – Science of
Information Processing –Cognitive Neuroscience – Perception – Decision – Learning and Memory
– Language Understanding and Processing.

UNIT II COMPUTATIONAL INTELLIGENCE 6


Machines and Cognition – Artificial Intelligence – Architectures of Cognition – Knowledge Based
Systems – Logical Representation and Reasoning – Logical Decision Making –Learning –
Language – Vision.

UNIT III PROBABILISTIC PROGRAMMING LANGUAGE 6


WebPPL Language – Syntax – Using Javascript Libraries – Manipulating probability types and
distributions – Finding Inference – Exploring random computation – Coroutines: Functions that
receive continuations –Enumeration

UNIT IV INFERENCE MODELS OF COGNITION 6


Generative Models – Conditioning – Causal and statistical dependence – Conditional
dependence – Data Analysis – Algorithms for Inference.

UNIT V LEARNING MODELS OF COGNITION 6

Learning as Conditional Inference – Learning with a Language of Thought – Hierarchical Models–


Learning (Deep) Continuous Functions – Mixture Models.

30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES 30 PERIODS
1.Demonstration of Mathematical functions using WebPPL.
2. Implementation of reasoning algorithms.
3. Developing an Application system using generative model.
4. Developing an Application using conditional inference learning model.
5. Application development using hierarchical model.
6. Application development using Mixture model.

TOTAL: 60 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Understand the underlying theory behind cognition.

143
CO2: Connect to the cognition elements computationally.
CO3: Implement mathematical functions through WebPPL.
CO4: Develop applications using cognitive inference model.
CO5: Develop applications using cognitive learning model.

TEXT BOOK:

1. Vijay V Raghavan,Venkat N.Gudivada, VenuGovindaraju, C.R. Rao, Cognitive Computing:


Theory and Applications: (Handbook of Statistics 35), Elsevier publications, 2016
2. Judith Hurwitz, Marcia Kaufman, Adrian Bowles, Cognitive Computing and Big Data
Analytics, Wiley Publications, 2015
3. Robert A. Wilson, Frank C. Keil, “The MIT Encyclopedia of the Cognitive Sciences”,The
MIT Press, 1999.
4. Jose Luis Bermúdez, Cognitive Science -An Introduction to the Science of the Mind,
Cambridge University Press 2020

REFERENCES:

1. Noah D. Goodman, Andreas Stuhlmuller, “The Design and Implementation of Probabilistic


Programming Languages”, Electronic version of book, https://dippl.org/.
2. Noah D. Goodman, Joshua B. Tenenbaum, The ProbMods Contributors, “Probabilistic
Models of Cognition”, Second Edition, 2016, https://probmods.org/.

CCS345 ETHICS AND AI L T P C


2 0 2 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Study the morality and ethics in AI
 Learn about the Ethical initiatives in the field of artificial intelligence
 Study about AI standards and Regulations
 Study about social and ethical issues of Robot Ethics
 Study about AI and Ethics- challenges and opportunities

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 6
Definition of morality and ethics in AI-Impact on society-Impact on human psychology-Impact on
the legal system-Impact on the environment and the planet-Impact on trust

UNIT II ETHICAL INITIATIVES IN AI 6


International ethical initiatives-Ethical harms and concerns-Case study: healthcare robots,
Autonomous Vehicles , Warfare and weaponization.

UNIT III AI STANDARDS AND REGULATION 6


Model Process for Addressing Ethical Concerns During System Design - Transparency of
Autonomous Systems-Data Privacy Process- Algorithmic Bias Considerations -
Ontological Standard for Ethically Driven Robotics and Automation Systems

144
UNIT IV ROBOETHICS: SOCIAL AND ETHICAL IMPLICATION OF ROBOTICS 6
Robot-Roboethics- Ethics and Morality- Moral Theories-Ethics in Science and Technology - Ethical
Issues in an ICT Society- Harmonization of Principles- Ethics and Professional Responsibility-
Roboethics Taxonomy.

UNIT V AI AND ETHICS- CHALLENGES AND OPPORTUNITIES 6


Challenges - Opportunities- ethical issues in artificial intelligence- Societal Issues Concerning the
Application of Artificial Intelligence in Medicine- decision-making role in industries-National and
International Strategies on AI.
30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the students will be able to
CO1: Learn about morality and ethics in AI
CO2: Acquire the knowledge of real time application ethics, issues and its challenges.
CO3: Understand the ethical harms and ethical initiatives in AI
CO4: Learn about AI standards and Regulations like AI Agent, Safe Design of Autonomous and
Semi-Autonomous Systems
CO5: Understand the concepts of Roboethics and Morality with professional responsibilities.
CO6: Learn about the societal issues in AI with National and International Strategies on AI

PRACTICAL EXERCISES 30 PERIODS


1. Recent case study of ethical initiatives in healthcare, autonomous vehicles and defense
2. Exploratory data analysis on a 2 variable linear regression model
3. Experiment the regression model without a bias and with bias
4. Classification of a dataset from UCI repository using a perceptron with and without bias
5. Case study on ontology where ethics is at stake
6. Identification on optimization in AI affecting ethics
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. y. Eleanor Bird, Jasmin Fox-Skelly, Nicola Jenner, Ruth Larbey, Emma Weitkamp and Alan
Winfield ,”The ethics of artificial intelligence: Issues and initiatives”, EPRS | European
Parliamentary Research Service Scientific Foresight Unit (STOA) PE 634.452 – March
2020
2. Patrick Lin, Keith Abney, George A Bekey,” Robot Ethics: The Ethical and Social
Implications of Robotics”, The MIT Press- January 2014.

REFERENCE BOOKS:
1. Towards a Code of Ethics for Artificial Intelligence (Artificial Intelligence: Foundations,
Theory, and Algorithms) by Paula Boddington, November 2017
2. Mark Coeckelbergh,” AI Ethics”, The MIT Press Essential Knowledge series, April 2020
3. Web link:
4. https://sci-hub.mksa.top/10.1007/978-3-540-30301-5_65
5. https://www.scu.edu/ethics/all-about-ethics/artificial-intelligence-and-ethics-sixteen-
challenges-and-opportunities/
6. https://www.weforum.org/agenda/2016/10/top-10-ethical-issues-in-artificial-intelligence/
7. https://sci-hub.mksa.top/10.1159/000492428

145
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 3 3 1 - - - 1 2 1 1 3 1 1
2 2 1 1 2 1 - - - 1 2 1 1 3 3 1
3 2 3 1 1 3 - - - 2 1 1 2 3 2 2
4 3 1 3 3 2 - - - 2 2 3 1 2 1 3
5 3 1 1 3 3 - - - 2 3 3 3 1 3 3
AVg. 2.6 1.6 1.8 2.4 2 - - - 1.6 2 1.8 1.6 2.4 2 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3003 CUSTOMER RELATION MANAGEMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
• To Learn the fundamentals of strategic and operational of CRM
• To understand operational methods of CRM
• To understand different analytical methods of CRM to enhance customer experience.
• To Learn the fundamentals of analytical CRM
• To Understand and apply the elements and tools of CRM to manage customer portfolios.

UNIT I UNDERSTANDING CUSTOMER RELATIONSHIPS 9


CRM definition and constituencies, understanding and misunderstanding CRM, the social CRM fit,
commercial contexts, the third sector- not-for-profit, CRM models. Relationship quality, customer
lifetime value, relationships with customers and suppliers. Managing the customer lifecycle –
customer acquisition, retention and development.

UNIT II STRATEGIC CRM 9


Customer portfolio management (CPM) - Customer portfolio, basic disciplines of CPM, CPM in
B2B context, CPM models, tools for CPM, strategically significant customers, seven core customer
management strategies.

UNIT III OPERATIONAL CRM 9


Sales force automation (SFA) – SFA and its ecosystem, SFA software functionality, SFA
adaptation. Marketing automation (MA) – definition of MA, benefits and software applications.
Service Automation (SA) –customer service definition, modelling service quality, software for SA,
benefits of SA, customer service excellence certification.

UNIT IV ANALYTICAL CRM 9


Customer database management –corporate customer data, structured and unstructured data,
developing a customer database, data – integration, warehousing and marts in the CRM context,
knowledge management, Analytics for – CRM strategy and tactics, customer lifecycle, structured
and unstructured data, Big data analytics in CRM, analytical insights.

UNIT V MANAGING CUSTOMER EXPERIENCE AND VALUE 9


Understanding Value and when do customers experience value, Modelling customer-perceived
value, Sources of customer value, Value through the marketing mix, Customisation for customer
146
value. Understanding customer experience and concepts, how to manage customer experience,
CRM vs CEM, Use of CRM software in CEM
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the elements of CRM
CO2: Apply the elements of CRM to manage customer portfolios.
CO3 : Understand the tools of CRM
CO4: Apply the tools of CRM to manage customer portfolios.
CO5: Understand different analytical methods of CRM to enhance customer experience

TEXT BOOKS:

1. Buttle Francis and Maklan Stan, Customer Relationship Management – Concepts and
Technologies, Special Indian edition, Fourth edition, Routledge, 2019.
2. Gerardus Blokdyk, Customer Relationship Management – A complete guide 2020 edition,
5starcooks, 2019.

REFERENCES :

1. Henry Assael, Consumer Behavior, Cengage Learning, 6th Edition, 2008


2. Kumar, Customer Relationship Management - A Database Approach, Wiley India, 2012.
3. Kumar and Werner Reinartz, Customer Relationship Management, Concept, Strategy and
Tools, Springer 2018.
4. Zikmund, Customer Relationship Management, Wiley 2012.
5. G. Shainesh, J. Jagdish N Seth. Customer Relationship Management : Emerging
Concepts, Tools and Application, McGraw Hill Education, 2017.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 2 2 - - 2 3 3 - - 3 3 1 1
2 3 2 3 2 2 - - 2 2 2 - - 3 2 1 2
3 3 2 2 2 3 - - 2 2 2 - - 3 2 1 2
4 3 2 3 2 2 - - 2 3 3 - - 3 3 1 1
5 3 2 2 3 2 - - 2 3 3 - - 3 3 1 2
AVg. 3 2 2.4 2.2 2.2 2 2.6 2.6 3 2.6 1 1.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CMG341 HUMAN RESOURCE MANAGEMENT FOR ENTREPRENEURS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the basic concepts, structure and functions of human resource management for
entrepreneurs.
 To create an awareness of the roles, functions and functioning of human resource
department.
 To understand the methods and techniques followed by Human Resource Management
practitioners.

147
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO HRM 9
Concept, Definition, Objectives- Nature and Scope of HRM - Evolution of HRM - HR Manager
Roles- Skills - Personnel Management Vs. HRM - Human Resource Policies - HR Accounting -
HR Audit - Challenges in HRM.

UNIT II HUMAN RESOURCE PLANNING 9


HR Planning - Definition - Factors- Tools - Methods and Techniques - Job analysis- Job rotation-
Job Description - Career Planning - Succession Planning - HRIS - Computer Applications in HR -
Recent Trends

UNIT III RECRUITMENT AND SELECTION 9


Sources of recruitment- Internal Vs. External - Domestic Vs. Global Sources -eRecruitment -
Selection Process- Selection techniques -eSelection- Interview Types- Employee Engagement.

UNIT IV TRAINING AND EMPLOYEE DEVELOPMENT 9


Types of Training - On-The-Job, Off-The-Job - Training Needs Analysis – Induction and
Socialisation Process - Employee Compensation - Wages and Salary Administration – Health and
Social Security Measures- Green HRM Practices

UNIT V CONTROLLING HUMAN RESOURCES 9


Performance Appraisal – Types - Methods - Collective Bargaining - Grievances Redressal
Methods – Employee Discipline – Promotion – Demotion - Transfer – Dismissal - Retrenchment -
Union Management Relationship - Recent Trends
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course the learners will be able:
CO 1 To understand the Evolution of HRM and Challenges faced by HR Managers
CO 2 To learn about the HR Planning Methods and practices.
CO 3 To acquaint about the Recruitment and Selection Techniques followed in Industries.
CO 4 To known about the methods of Training and Employee Development.
CO 5 To comprehend the techniques of controlling human resources in organisations.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Gary Dessler and Biju Varkkey, Human Resource Management, 14e , Pearson, 2015.
2. Mathis and Jackson, Human Resource Management, Cengage Learning 15e, 2017.
3. David A. Decenzo, Stephen.P.Robbins, and Susan L. Verhulst, Human Resource
Management, Wiley, International Student Edition, 11th Edition, 2014
4. R. Wayne Mondy, Human Resource Management, Pearson , 2015.
5. Luis R.Gomez-Mejia, David B.Balkin, Robert L Cardy. Managing Human Resource. PHI
Learning. 2012
6. John M. Ivancevich, Human Resource Management,12e, McGraw Hill Irwin,2013.
7. K. Aswathappa, Sadhna Dash , Human Resource Management - Text and Cases , 9th Edition,
McGraw Hill, 2021.
8. Uday Kumar Haldar, Juthika Sarkar. Human Resource management. Oxford. 2012

148
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 1 2 1 - - 2 2 - - 3 2 3 1
2 3 3 3 2 2 1 - - 2 2 - - 3 3 3 2
3 3 2 2 3 2 1 - - 1 2 - - 3 3 3 2
4 3 2 3 2 2 1 - - 2 2 - - 3 2 3 1
5 3 3 2 3 2 1 - - 2 2 - - 3 3 3 1
AVg. 3 2.4 2.4 2.2 2 1 1.8 2 3 2.6 3 1.4
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCD332 FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT LTPC


3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Understand the fundamental concepts of financial management
 Understand valuation of securities.
 Analyse operating and financial leverages.
 Comprehend and apply the concepts of capital budgeting.
 Understand cash management.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction: Introduction to Financial Management - Goals of the firm - Financial Environments.
Time Value of Money: Simple and Compound Interest Rates, Amortization, Computing more that
once a year, Annuity Factor.

UNIT II VALUATION OF SECURITIES 9


Valuation of Securities: Bond Valuation, Preferred Stock Valuation, Common Stock Valuation,
Concept of Yield and YTM. Risk & Return: Defining Risk and Return, Using Probability
Distributions to Measure Risk, Attitudes Toward Risk, Risk and Return in a Portfolio Context,
Diversification, The Capital Asset Pricing Model (CAPM).

UNIT III OPERATING & FINANCIAL LEVERAGE 9


Operating & Financial Leverage: Operating Leverage, Financial Leverage, Total Leverage,
Indifference Analysis in leverage study. Cost of Capital: Concept, Computation of Specific Cost of
Capital for Equity - Preference – Debt, Weighted Average Cost of Capital – Factors affecting Cost
of Capital 4L.

UNIT IV CAPITAL BUDGETING 9


Capital Budgeting: The Capital Budgeting Concept & Process - An Overview, Generating
Investment Project Proposals, Estimating Project, After Tax Incremental Operating Cash Flows,
Capital Budgeting Techniques, Project Evaluation and Selection - Alternative Methods. Working
Capital Management: Overview, Working Capital Issues, Financing Current Assets (Short Term
and Long Term- Mix), Combining Liability Structures and Current Asset Decisions, Estimation of
Working Capital.

149
UNIT V CASH MANAGEMENT 9
Cash Management: Motives for Holding cash, Speeding Up Cash Receipts, Slowing Down Cash
Payouts, Electronic Commerce, Outsourcing, Cash Balances to maintain, Factoring. Accounts
Receivable Management: Credit & Collection Policies, Analyzing the Credit Applicant, Credit
References, Selecting optimum Credit period.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the fundamental concepts of financial management
CO2: Apply valuation of securities and calculate the risk & return in portfolio management.
CO3: Analyse the cost structure of a company using operating and financial leverages.
CO4: Develop capital budgets and to estimate working capital. CO5: Apply cash management in
business.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
TEXTBOOKS
1. Chandra, Prasanna - Financial Management - Theory & Practice, Tata McGraw Hill, 2007.
2. Srivastava, Misra: Financial Management, OUP, 2011.
3. Van Horne and Wachowicz : Fundamentals of Financial Management, Prentice Hall/
Pearson Education.
4. Financial Management: Theory & Practice: by Brigham and Ernhardt, 14th edition,
Cengage, 2015.
5. M.Y. Khan and P.K.Jain Financial management, Text, Problems and cases Tata McGraw
Hill, 6th edition, 2011.
6. M. Pandey Financial Management, Vikas Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., 10th edition, 2012.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 2 1 1 - 2 - - 2 - 3 2 2 1
2 3 3 3 3 1 2 - 2 - - 2 - 2 2 2 2
3 3 3 3 3 1 1 - 2 - - 2 - 2 1 2 1
4 3 3 3 3 1 1 - 2 - - 2 - 3 2 1 2
5 3 3 3 3 1 2 - 2 - - 2 - 3 2 1 1
AVg. 3 3 3 2.8 1 2 2 2 2.6 1.8 1.6 1.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCD334 SUPPLY CHAIN MANAGEMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the importance of supply chain management
 To learn decisions in supply chain management for gaining competitive advantage
 To design supply chain networks to enhance supply chain performance
 To plan demand based on inventory and supply
 To understanding the role of logistics in supply chain performance

150
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Supply Chain – Fundamentals, Evolution, Role in Economy, Importance, Decision Phases,
Enablers & Drivers of Supply Chain Performance; Supply chain strategy; Supply Chain
Performance Measures.

UNIT II SUPPLY CHAIN NETWORK 9


Distribution Network Design – Role in supply chain, Influencing factors, design options, online
sales and distribution network, Distribution Strategies; Network Design in supply chain – Role,
influencing factors, framework for network design, Impact of uncertainty on Network Design.

UNIT III PLANNING DEMAND, INVENTORY AND SUPPLY 9


Managing supply chain cycle inventory and safety inventory - Uncertainty in the supply chain
,Analyzing impact of supply chain redesign on the inventory, Risk Pooling, Managing inventory for
short life-cycle products, multiple item -multiple location inventory management; Pricing and
Revenue Management.

UNIT IV LOGISTICS 9
Transportation – Role, Modes and their characteristics, infrastructure and policies, transport
documentation, design options, trade-offs in transportation design, intermodal transportation.
Logistics outsourcing – catalysts, benefits, value proposition. 3PL, 4PL, 5PL, 6PL; International
Logistics -objectives, importance in global economy, Characteristics of global supply chains,
Incoterms.

UNIT V SUPPLY CHAIN INNOVATIONS 9


Supply Chain Integration, SC process restructuring, IT in Supply Chain; Agile Supply Chains,
Legible supply chain, Green Supply Chain, Reverse Supply chain; Supply chain technology trends
– AI, Advanced analytics, Internet of Things, Intelligent things, conversational systems, robotic
process automation, immersive technologies, Block chain.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understanding of supply chain fundamentals
CO2: Ability to design supply chain networks to enhance supply chain performance
CO3 : Ability to plan demand based on inventory and supply
CO4: Understanding the role of logistics in supply chain performance
CO5: Awareness of innovations for sustainable supply chains

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Chopra, Sunil, Meindl, Peter and Kalra, D. V.; Supply Chain Management: Strategy,
Planning and Operation; Pearson Education, 2015.
2. Altekar, Rahul V.; Supply Chain Management: Concepts and Cases; PHI Learning, 2005.

REFERENCES
1. Sunil Chopra, Peter Meindl and DharamVirKalra, Supply Chain Management-Strategy
Planning and Operation, Pearson Education, Sixth Edition, 2016.
2. Janat Shah, Supply Chain Management – Text and Cases, Pearson Education, 2009
3. Ballou Ronald H, Business Logistics and Supply Chain Management, Pearson
Education, 5thEdition, 2007.

151
4. David Simchi-Levi, Philip Kaminsky, Edith Simchi-Levi, Designing and Managing
the SupplyChain: Concepts, Strategies, and Cases, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2005.
5. Pierre David, International Logistics, Biztantra, 2011.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 1 2 1 1 - - 2 2 2 - 3 2 2 3
2 3 2 3 3 2 1 - - 2 2 1 - 2 2 2 2
3 3 3 2 3 2 1 - - 2 1 2 - 3 1 2 3
4 3 2 2 2 2 2 - - 2 2 2 - 3 2 2 2
5 3 3 2 3 2 1 - - 2 1 1 - 2 2 2 2
AVg. 3 2.6 2 2.6 1.8 1.2 2 1.6 1.6 2.6 1.8 2 2.4
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3007 IT PROJECT MANAGEMENT LTPC


30 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn the concepts of managing IT projects.
 To learn more about planning
 To understand resource allocation, control, and completion
 To learn software quality management
 To understand budgeting and scheduling

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO PROJECT MANAGEMENT 9


Project Management – Definition –Goal - Lifecycles. Project Selection Methods. Project Portfolio
Process – Project Formulation. Project Manager – Roles- Responsibilities and Selection – Project
Teams, Project support activities, Types of project organizations.

UNIT II PLANNING AND BUDGETING 9


The Planning Process – Work Break down Structure – Role of Multidisciplinary teams, Critical path
analysis. Budget the Project – Methods. Cost Estimating and Improvement. Budget uncertainty
and risk management.

UNIT III SCHEDULING & RESOURCE ALLOCATION 9


PERT & CPM Networks - Crashing – Project Uncertainty and Risk Management – Simulation –
Gantt Charts – Expediting a project – Resource loading and leveling. Allocating scarce resources
– Goldratt‟s Critical Chain.

UNIT IV CONTROL AND COMPLETION 9


The Plan-Monitor-Control cycle – Data Collecting and reporting – Project Control – Designing the
control system. Project Evaluation, Earned Value Analysis, Auditing and Termination, Risk
Management, – Conflict – Origin & Consequences. Managing conflict – Team methods for
resolving conflict

152
UNIT V SOFTWARE QUALITY MANAGEMENT 9
Product quality and software quality, quality management systems, principles and features,
System quality specification and measurement, Process and product quality approaches, Quality
assurance and quality control, project audit and quality audit, Methods of enhancing quality: the
different types of testing, inspections, reviews, standards, Management and control of testing.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Apply project management principles in business situations
CO2: Learn more about planning, budgeting and scheduling
CO3: Optimize resource utilization and time optimization
CO4: Understand resource allocation, control, and completion
CO5: Learn software quality management

TEXT BOOK:
1. Clifford Gray and Erik Larson, Project Management, Tata McGraw Hill Edition, 2005.
2. John M. Nicholas, Project Management for Business and Technology - Principles and Practice,
Second Edition, Pearson Education, 2006.
3. Hughes B, Project Management for IT-related Projects. BCS Publications, 2012.

REFERENCES:
1.Gido and Clements, Successful Project Management, Second Edition, Thomson Learning,
2003.
2. Harvey Maylor, Project Management, Third Edition, Pearson Education, 2006.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 2 2 1 - - 2 2 1 - 3 1 2 2
2 3 2 1 3 3 2 - - 2 2 2 - 3 3 1 2
3 3 2 2 3 3 1 - - 1 2 1 - 3 3 2 2
4 3 3 1 3 3 2 - - 2 2 2 - 2 2 2 2
5 3 2 2 2 2 1 - - 1 2 2 - 2 2 2 2
AVg. 3 2.2 1.6 2.6 2.6 1.4 1.6 2 1.6 2.6 2.2 1.8 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3005 ENTREPRENEURSHIP DEVELOPMENT LTPC


202 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To equip and develop the learners entrepreneurial skills and qualities essential to undertake
business.
 To impart the learners entrepreneurial competencies needed for managing business efficiently
and effectively.

UNIT I ENTREPRENEURAL COMPETENCE 9


Entrepreneurship concept – Entrepreneurship as a Career – Entrepreneurial Personality -
Characteristics of Successful Entrepreneurs – Knowledge and Skills of an Entrepreneur.

153
UNIT II ENTREPRENEURAL ENVIRONMENT 9
Business Environment - Role of Family and Society - Entrepreneurship Development Training and
Other Support Organisational Services - Central and State Government Industrial Policies and
Regulations.

UNIT III BUSINESS PLAN PREPARATION 9


Sources of Product for Business - Prefeasibility Study - Criteria for Selection of Product -
Ownership - Capital Budgeting- Project Profile Preparation - Matching Entrepreneur with the
Project - Feasibility Report Preparation and Evaluation Criteria

UNIT IV LAUNCHING OF SMALL BUSINESS 9


Finance and Human Resource Mobilisation - Operations Planning - Market and Channel Selection
- Growth Strategies - Product Launching – Incubation, Venture capital, Start-ups.

UNIT V MANAGEMENT OF SMALL BUSINESS 9


Monitoring and Evaluation of Business - Business Sickness - Prevention and Rehabilitation of
Business Units - Effective Management of small Business - Case Studies.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Discuss a Business Plan on /Small scale industry/Food Processing Industry/Agriculture
units/Hospital .

2. Undertake SWOT analysis to arrive at your business idea of a product/service

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: The learners will gain entrepreneurial competence to run the business efficiently.
CO2: The learners are able to undertake businesses in the entrepreneurial environment
CO3: The learners are capable of preparing business plans and undertake feasible projects.
CO4 :The learners are efficient in launching and develop their business ventures successfully
CO5: The learners shall monitor the business effectively towards growth and development.

TOTAL :60 PERIODS


TEXTBOOKS
1. S.S.Khanka, Entrepreneurial Development, S.Chand and Company Limited, New Delhi,
2016.
2. R.D.Hisrich, Entrepreneurship, Tata McGraw Hill, New Delhi, 2018.
3. Rajeev Roy ,Entrepreneurship, Oxford University Press, 2nd Edition, 2011.
4. Donald F Kuratko,T.V Rao. Entrepreneurship: A South Asian perspective. Cengage Learning,
2012.
5. Dr. Vasant Desai, “Small Scale Industries and Entrepreneurship”, HPH,2006.
6. Arya Kumar. Entrepreneurship, Pearson,2012.
7. Prasanna Chandra, Projects – Planning, Analysis, Selection, Implementation and Reviews,
Tata McGraw-Hill, 8 th edition ,2017

154
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 3 2 2 2 - - 2 2 2 - 3 2 3 2
2 3 3 2 1 2 1 - - 2 2 2 - 3 3 3 1
3 3 3 3 2 2 2 - - 2 2 2 - 3 3 2 2
4 3 2 2 1 2 1 - - 2 2 2 - 3 3 2 2
5 3 3 2 2 1 2 - - 2 2 2 - 2 2 2 1
AVg. 3 2.6 2.4 1.6 1.8 1.6 2 2 2 2.8 2.6 2.4 1.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3006 INTRODUCTION TO INNOVATION, IP MANAGEMENT AND


ENTREPRENEURSHIP LTPC
30 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To develop and strengthen innovation.
 To understand IP management.
 To understand entrepreneurial quality.
 To motivate in and to impart basic skills.
 To understanding to run a business efficiently and effectively.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO INNOVATION 9


Adoption of Innovations, Exploring Innovations, Idea generation, Developing innovative culture,
Executing innovations, Innovation attributes and their adoption rate, Measuring and evaluation of
innovation, Exploiting and renewing innovations, Managing innovations in organizations,
Innovation and intellectual property rights, Innovation portfolio

UNIT II INTRODUCTION TO IPR 9


Basic concepts and need for Intellectual Property - Patents, Copyrights, Geographical Indications,
IPR in India and Abroad – Genesis and Development – the way from WTO to WIPO –TRIPS,
Nature of Intellectual Property, Industrial Property, technological Research, Inventions and
Innovations – Important examples of IPR.

UNIT III REGISTRATION OF IPRs 9


Meaning and practical aspects of registration of Copy Rights, Trademarks, Patents, Geographical
Indications, Trade Secrets and Industrial Design registration in India and Abroad, Agreements and
Legislations

UNIT IV ENTREPRENEURSHIP 9
Entrepreneur – Types of Entrepreneurs – Difference between Entrepreneur and Intrapreneur,
Major Motives Influencing an Entrepreneur –Achievement Motivation Training, Self Rating,
Business Games, Thematic Apperception Test – Stress Management

UNIT V BUSINESS AND FINANCING 9


Small Enterprises – Characteristics, Ownership Structures – Steps involved in setting up a
Business – identifying, selecting a Good Business opportunity, Market Survey and Research,
Techno Economic Feasibility Assessment – Preparation of Preliminary Project Reports – Project
155
Appraisal –Sources of Finance, Management of working Capital, Costing, Break Even Analysis,
Taxation – Income Tax, Excise Duty – Sales Tax.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the concept of innovation
CO2: Ability to manage Intellectual Property portfolio to enhance the value of the firm.
CO3: Gain knowledge and skills needed to run a business successfully
CO4: Understand entrepreneurial quality
CO5: Understand IP management.

TEXT BOOK:
1. 1.V. Scople Vinod, Managing Intellectual Property, Prentice Hall of India pvt Ltd, 2012
2. S.V. Satarkar, Intellectual Property Rights and Copy Rights, Ess Ess Publications, New
Delhi, 2002
3. Donald F Kuratko, “Entreprenuership – Theory, Process and Practice”, 9 th Edition,
Cengage Learning, 2014.
4. Khanka. S.S., “Entrepreneurial Development” S.Chand & Co. Ltd., Ram Nagar, New Delhi,
2013.

REFERENCES:
1. Deborah E. Bouchoux, “Intellectual Property: The Law of Trademarks, Copyrights, Patents
and Trade Secrets”, Cengage Learning, Third Edition, 2012.
2. Edited by Derek Bosworth and Elizabeth Webster, The Management of Intellectual
Property, Edward Elgar Publishing Ltd., 2013.
3. Prabuddha Ganguli,”Intellectual Property Rights: Unleashing the Knowledge Economy”,
McGraw Hill Education, 2011.
4. EDII “Faulty and External Experts – A Hand Book for New Entrepreneurs Publishers:
5. Entrepreneurship Development”, Institute of India, Ahmadabad, 1986.
6. Hisrich R D, Peters M P, “Entrepreneurship” 8 th Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2013.
7. Mathew J Manimala, "Enterprenuership theory at cross roads: paradigms and praxis” 2 nd
Edition Dream tech, 2005.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 1 1 2 - - - 2 1 2 - 3 2 3 2
2 3 3 2 2 1 - - - 2 2 2 - 3 3 3 1
3 3 3 2 2 2 - - - 2 2 1 - 3 3 2 2
4 3 3 2 2 1 - - - 2 2 2 - 2 2 2 2
5 2 2 1 1 2 - - - 2 1 2 - 2 2 2 1
AVg. 2.8 2.8 1.6 1.6 1.6 2 1.6 1.8 2.6 2.4 2.4 1.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

156
CW3001 BEHAVIORAL ECONOMICS LTPC
30 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
• To familiarize the students to the basic concepts of management in order to aid in
understanding how an organization function
• To understanding the complexity and wide variety of issues managers face in today's
business firms.
• To To acquaint the students with the fundamentals of managing business
• To understand individual and group behaviour at work place so as to improve the
effectiveness of an organization.

UNIT I NATURE AND THEORIES OF MANAGEMENT 9


Evolution of management Thought-Classical, Behavioral and Management Science Approaches
Management- meaning, levels, management as an art or science, Managerial functions and Roles,
Evolution of Management Theory- Classical era- Contribution of F.W.Taylor, Henri Fayol, Neo-
Classical-Mayo & Hawthorne Experiments. • Modern era – system & contingency approach
Managerial Skills.

UNIT II PLANNING AND ORGANISING 9


Planning - Steps in Planning Process - Scope and Limitations - Forecasting and types of Planning
- Characteristics of a sound Plan - Management by Objectives (MBO) - Policies and Strategies -
Scope and Formulation - Decision Making - Types, Techniques and Processes.

Organisation Structure and Design - Authority and Responsibility Relationships - Delegation of


Authority and Decentralisation - Interdepartmental Coordination - - Impact of Technology on
Organisational design - Mechanistic vs Adoptive Structures - Formal and Informal
Organisation.Control: meaning, function, Process and types of Control

UNIT III INDIVIDUAL BEHAVIOUR 9


Meaning of Organizational behavior, contributing disciplines, importance of organizational
behavior, Perception and Learning - Personality and Individual Differences - Motivation theories
and Job Performance - Values, Attitudes and Beliefs - Communication Types-Process - Barriers -
Making Communication Effective.

UNIT IV GROUP BEHAVIOUR 9


Groups and Teams: Definition, Difference between groups and teams, Stages of Group
Development, Group Cohesiveness, Types of teams, Group Dynamics - Leadership - Styles -
Approaches - Power and Politics - Organisational Structure - Organisational Climate and
Culture,Conflict: concept, sources, Types, Stages of conflict, Management of conflict
Organisational Change and Development.

UNIT V EMERGING ASPECTS OF ORGANIZATIONAL BEHAVIOUR 9


Comparative Management Styles and approaches - Japanese Management Practices
Organisational Creativity and Innovation - Organizational behavior across cultures - Conditions
affecting cross cultural organizational operations, Managing International Workforce, Productivity
and cultural contingencies, Cross cultural communication, Management of Diversity.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS

157
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understanding of various management concepts and skills required in the business world
CO2: In-depth knowledge of various functions of management in a real time management
context
CO3: Understanding of the complexities associated with management of individual behaviour in
the organizations
CO4: Develop the skill set to have manage group behaviour in Organizations
CO5: Insights about the current trends in managing organizational behaviour

TEXT BOOK:
1. Andrew J. Dubrin, Essentials of Management, Thomson Southwestern, 10th edition,2016.
2. Samuel C. Certo and S.Trevis Certo, Modern Management: Concepts and Skills, Pearson
education, 15th edition, 2018.

REFERENCES:

1. Harold Koontz and Heinz Weihrich, Essentials of Management: An


International, Innovation, And Leadership Perspective, 10th edition, Tata McGraw-Hill
Education, 2015.
2. Charles W.L Hill and Steven L McShane, „Principles of Management, McGraw
Hill Education, Special Indian Edition, 2017.
3. Stephen P. Robbins, Timothy A.Judge, Organisational Behavior, PHI Learning /
Pearson Education, 16th edition, 2014.
4. Fred Luthans, Organisational Behavior, McGraw Hill, 12th Edition, 2013.
5. Don Hellriegel, Susan E. Jackson and John W,Jr Slocum, Management: A competency-
Based Approach, Thompson South Western,11th edition, 2008.
6. Heinz Weihrich, Mark V Cannice and Harold Koontz, Management- A
global entrepreneurial perspective, Tata McGraw Hill, 12th edition, 2008.
7. Stephen P. Robbins, David De Cenzo and Mary Coulter, Fundamentals Of
Management, Prentice Hall of India,9 th edition 2016.
8. McShane, Mary V. Glinow, Organizational Behavior, 8th Edition, Tata Mc Graw Hill, 2017.
9. Nelson, Quick, Khandelwal. ORGB – An innovative approach to learning and
teaching. Cengage learning. 2nd edition. 2012.
10. Robert Konopaske, John M Ivancevich, Michael T Matteson, Oranizational Behavior
and Management, 11th edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2017.
11. Udai Pareek, Understanding Organisational Behavior, 3rd Edition, Oxford Higher Education,
2011.
12. Jerald Greenberg, Behavior in Organizations, PHI Learning. 10th edition. 2011.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 2 2 1 - - - 2 2 1 - 3 2 2 2
2 3 3 2 3 2 - - - 2 2 2 - 3 3 2 2
3 3 3 2 3 2 - - - 1 2 1 - 3 3 1 2
4 3 3 2 3 2 - - - 2 2 2 - 3 3 2 2
5 3 3 2 2 1 - - - 2 2 1 - 2 2 2 2
AVg. 3 3 2 2.6 1.6 1.8 2 1.4 2.8 2.6 1.8 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation
158
CMG354 FINANCIAL ANALYTICS LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand modern analytical tools that specifically target finance applications.
 To understand different management aspects
 To learn financial analysis for decision making
 To understand human resource management
 To learn different business strategy

UNIT I CORPORATE FINANCE ANALYSIS 9


Basic corporate financial predictive modelling- Project analysis- cash flow analysis- cost of
capital, Financial Break even modelling, Capital Budget model-Payback, NPV, IRR.

UNIT II FINANCIAL MARKET ANALYSIS 9


Estimation and prediction of risk and return ( bond investment and stock investment) –Time
series-examining nature of data, Value at risk, ARMA, ARCH and GARCH.

UNIT III PORTFOLIO ANALYSIS 9


Portfolio Analysis – capital asset pricing model, Sharpe ratio, Option pricing models- binomial
model for options, Black Scholes model and Option implied volatility.

UNIT IV TECHNICAL ANALYSIS 9


Prediction using charts and fundamentals – RSI, ROC, MACD, moving average and candle
charts, simulating trading strategies. Prediction of share prices.

UNIT V CONTROLLING 9
Credit Risk analysis- Data processing, Decision trees, logistic regression and evaluating credit
risk model.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand different management techniques
CO2: Applyanalytical tools that specificallytarget finance applications.
CO3: Describefinancial analysis for decision making
CO4:Understand human resource management
CO5:Adopt different business strategy

TEXT BOOK:
1. Financial analytics with R by Mark J. Bennett, Dirk L. Hugen, Cambridge universitypress.
2. Haskell Financial Data Modeling and Predictive Analytics Paperback – Import, 25 Oct 2013
by Pavel Ryzhov.

REFERENCES :
1. Quantitative Financial Analytics: The Path To Investment Profits Paperback –Import, 11 Sep
2017 by Edward E Williams (Author), John A Dobelman.
2. Python for Finance - Paperback – Import, 30 Jun 2017 by Yuxing Yan (Author).
3. Mastering Python for Finance Paperback – Import, 29 Apr 2015 by James Ma Weiming.

159
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 2 1 1 - 2 - - 2 - 3 2 2 1
2 3 3 2 3 3 1 - 2 - - 2 - 3 2 2 1
3 3 3 3 3 1 1 - 3 - - 2 - 3 3 2 1
4 3 2 2 2 2 1 - 3 - - 2 - 3 2 2 1
5 3 3 3 3 2 1 - 3 - - 2 - 3 3 2 1
AVg. 3 2.6 2.4 2.6 1.8 1 2.6 2 3 2.4 2 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3009 SOCIAL, TEXT AND MEDIA ANALYTICS LTPC


3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basic issues and types of social,text and media mining
 Familiarize the learners with the concept of social, text and media analytics and understand
its significance.
 Familiarize the learners with the tools of social, text and media analytics.
 Enable the learners to develop skills required for analyzing the effectiveness of social, text
and media for business purposes
 To know the applications in real time systems.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO SOCIAL MEDIA ANALYSIS 9


Social media landscape, Need for SMA; SMA in Small organizations; SMA in large organizations;
Application of SMA in different areas. Network fundamentals and models:

The social networks perspective - nodes, ties and influencers, Social network and web data and
methods. Graphs and Matrices- Basic measures for individuals and networks. Information
visualization.

UNIT II OVERVIEW OF TEXT MINING AND DATA MINING 9


Overview of text mining- Definition- General Architecture– Algorithms– Core Operations –
Preprocessing–Types of Problems- basics of document classification- information retrieval-
clustering and organizing documents- information extraction- prediction and evaluation-
Introduction to Data Mining Systems – Knowledge Discovery Process – Data Mining Techniques –
Issues – applications- Data Objects and attribute types, Statistical description of data, Data
Preprocessing – Cleaning, Integration, Reduction, Transformation and discretization, Data
Visualization, Data similarity and dissimilarity measures.

UNIT III TEXT MINING FOR INFORMATION RETRIEVAL AND


INFORMATION EXTRACTION 9
Information retrieval and text mining- keyword search- nearest-neighbor methods- similarity- web
based document search- matching- inverted lists- evaluation. Information extraction- Architecture -
Co-reference - Named Entity and Relation Extraction- Template filling and database construction –
Applications. Inductive -Unsupervised Algorithms for Information Extraction. Text Summarization
Techniques - Topic Representation - Influence of Context - Indicator Representations – Pattern
Extraction - Apriori Algorithm – FP Tree algorithm.

160
UNIT IV WEB ANALYTICS TOOLS 9
Click stream analysis, A/B testing, online surveys, Web crawling and Indexing. Natural Language
Processing Techniques for Micro-text Analysis. Do a case study on Google analytics.

UNIT V MARKETING RESEARCH & TRENDS IN MARKET 9


Introduction, parameters, demographics. Analyzing page audience. Reach and Engagement
analysis. Post- performance on FB. Social campaigns. Measuring and Analyzing social
campaigns, defining goals and evaluating outcomes, Network Analysis. Case study : Identify
Consumer Preferences and Market Positioning of a New Product.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand about social, text and media mining
CO2: Understand the significance of social text and media analytics
CO3: Learn tools of social, text and media analytics.
CO4: Develop skills required for analyzing the effectiveness of social text and media for business
purposes
CO5: Know the applications in real time systems.
TOTAL :45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOK :
1.Marshall Sponder, Social Media Analytics, McGraw Hill ,2011
2.Charu C. Aggarwal ,ChengXiang Zhai, Mining Text Data, Springer; 2012

REFERENCES :
1. 1.Matthew Ganis, Avinash Kohirkar , Social Media Analytics: Techniques and Insights for
Extracting Business Value Out of Social Media, Pearson, 2016.
2. Jim Sterne, Social Media Metrics: How to Measure and Optimize Your Marketing
Investment, Wiley, 2010.
3. Oliver Blanchard ,Social Media ROI: Managing and Measuring Social Media Efforts in Your
Organization (Que Biz-Tech), 2019
4. Sholom Weiss, Nitin Indurkhya, Tong Zhang, Fred Damerau “The Text Mining Handbook:
Advanced Approaches in Analyzing Unstructured Data”, Springer, paperback 2010
5. Ronen Feldman, James Sanger -“ The Text Mining Handbook: Advanced Approaches in
Analyzing Unstructured Data”, Springer, paperback 2010.
Tracy L. Tuten, Michael R. Solomon, Social Media Marketing , Sage, 2016.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 2 2 3 1 1 - - 1 - - 3 2 1 2
2 3 3 2 2 3 2 1 - - 1 - - 3 2 1 2
3 3 2 3 2 3 2 1 - - 1 - - 3 2 2 2
4 3 3 3 2 2 2 1 - - 1 - - 3 1 2 2
5 3 2 2 2 2 2 1 - - 1 - - 3 2 2 2
AVg. 3 2.6 2.4 2 2.6 1.8 1 1 3 1.8 1.6 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

161
CCW332 DIGITAL MARKETING LTPC
202 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 The primary objective of this module is to examine and explore the role and importance of
digital marketing in today’s rapidly changing business environment.
 It also focusses on how digital marketing can be utilised by organisations and how
its effectiveness can measured.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO ONLINE MARKET 6


Online Market space- Digital Marketing Strategy- Components -Opportunities for building
BrandWebsite - Planning and Creation- Content Marketing.

UNIT II SEARCH ENGINE OPTIMISATION 6


Search Engine optimisation - Keyword Strategy- SEO Strategy - SEO success factors -On-Page
Techniques - Off-Page Techniques. Search Engine Marketing- How Search Engine works- SEM
components- PPC advertising -Display Advertisement

UNIT III E- MAIL MARKETING 6


E- Mail Marketing - Types of E- Mail Marketing - Email Automation - Lead Generation - Integrating
Email with Social Media and Mobile- Measuring and maximising email campaign effectiveness.
Mobile Marketing- Mobile Inventory/channels- Location based; Context based; Coupons and
offers, Mobile Apps, Mobile Commerce, SMS Campaigns-Profiling and targeting

UNIT IV SOCIAL MEDIA MARKETING 6


Social Media Marketing - Social Media Channels- Leveraging Social media for brand
conversations and buzz. Successful /benchmark Social media campaigns. Engagement
Marketing- Building Customer relationships - Creating Loyalty drivers - Influencer Marketing.

UNIT V DIGITAL TRANSFORMATION 6


Digital Transformation & Channel Attribution- Analytics- Ad-words, Email, Mobile, Social Media,
Web Analytics - Changing your strategy based on analysis- Recent trends in Digital marketing.
30 PERIODS
PRACTICAL EXERCISES: 30 PERIODS
1. Subscribe to a weekly/quarterly newsletter and analyze how it’s content and structure aid with
the branding of the company and how it aids its potential customer segments.
2. Perform keyword search for a skincare hospital website based on search volume and
competition using Google keyword planner tool.
3. Demonstrate how to use the Google WebMasters Indexing API
4. Discuss an interesting case study regarding how an insurance company manages leads.
5. Discuss negative and positive impacts and ethical implications of using social media for
political advertising.
6. Discuss how Predictive analytics is impacting marketing automation

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: To examine and explore the role and importance of digital marketing in today’s rapidly
changing business environment..
CO2: To focusses on how digital marketing can be utilised by organisations and how
its effectiveness can measured.

162
CO3: To know the key elements of a digital marketing strategy.
CO4: To study how the effectiveness of a digital marketing campaign can be measured
CO5: To demonstrate advanced practical skills in common digital marketing tools such as SEO,
SEM, Social media and Blogs.
TOTAL:60 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Fundamentals of Digital Marketing by Puneet Singh Bhatia;Publisher: Pearson
Education; First edition ( July 2017);ISBN-10: 933258737X;ISBN-13: 978-9332587373.
2. Digital Marketing by Vandana Ahuja ;Publisher: Oxford University Press ( April 2015).
ISBN-10: 0199455449
3. Marketing 4.0: Moving from Traditional to Digital by Philip Kotler;Publisher: Wiley; 1st
edition ( April 2017); ISBN10: 9788126566938;ISBN13: 9788126566938;ASIN:
8126566930.
4. Ryan, D. (2014 ). Understanding Digital Marketing: Marketing Strategies for Engaging the
Digital Generation, Kogan Page Limited..
5. Barker, Barker, Bormann and Neher(2017), Social Media Marketing: A Strategic
Approach, 2E South-Western ,Cengage Learning.
6. Pulizzi,J Beginner's Guide to Digital Marketing , Mcgraw Hill Education

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 1 - 1 1 1 2 - - - - 3 2 1 1
2 3 3 1 - 2 1 1 2 - - - - 3 2 1 1
3 3 3 1 - 2 1 1 2 - - - - 3 2 1 1
4 3 3 1 - 1 1 1 2 - - - - 3 2 2 2
5 2 2 2 - 3 1 1 2 - - - - 3 3 2 2
AVg. 2.8 2.4 1.2 1.8 1 1 2 3 2.2 1.4 1.4
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3002 CONVERSATIONAL SYSTEMS LTPC


3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Enable attendees to acquire knowledge on chatbots and its terminologies
 Work with ML Concepts and different algorithms to build custom ML Model
 Better understand on Conversational experiences and provide better customer experiences

UNIT I FUNDAMENTALS OF CONVERSATIONAL SYSTEMS 9


Introduction: Overview, Case studies, Explanation about different modes of engagement for a
human being, History and impact of AI. Underlying technologies: Natural Language Processing,
Artificial Intelligence and Machine Learning, NLG, Speech-To-Text, Text-To-Speech, Computer
Vision etc. Introduction to Top players in Market – Google, MS, Amazon &Market trends.
Messaging Platforms (Facebook, WhatsApp) and Smart speakers – Alexa, Google Home and
other new channels. Ethical and Legal Considerations in AI Overview.

163
UNIT II FOUNDATIONAL BLOCKS FOR PROGRAMMING AND NATURAL LANGUAGE
PROCESSING 9
Introduction: Brief history, Basic Concepts, Phases of NLP, Application of chat bots etc. General
chatbot architecture, Basic concepts in chatbots: Intents, Entities, Utterances, Variables and Slots,
Fulfillment. Lexical Knowledge Networks (WordNet, Verbnet, PropBank, etc). Lexical Analysis,
Part-of-Speech Tagging, Parsing/Syntactic analysis, Semantic Analysis, Word Sense
Disambiguation. Information Extraction, Sentiment Analysis.

UNIT III BUILDING A CHAT BOT / CONVERSATIONAL AI SYSTEMS 9


Fundamentals of Conversational Systems (NLU, DM and NLG) - Chatbot framework &
Architecture, Conversational Flow & Design, Intent Classification (ML and DL based techniques),
Dialogue Management Strategies, Natural Language Generation. UX design, APIs and SDKs,
Usage of Conversational Design Tools. Introduction to popular chatbot frameworks – Google
Dialog flow, Microsoft Bot Framework, Amazon Lex, RASA Channels: Facebook Messenger,
Google Home, Alexa, WhatsApp, Custom Apps. Overview of CE Testing techniques, A/B Testing,
Introduction to Testing Frameworks - Botium /Mocha ,Chai. Security & Compliance – Data
Management, Storage, GDPR, PCI.

UNIT IV ROLE OF ML/AI IN CONVERSATIONAL TECHNOLOGIES AND CONTACT


CENTERS 9
Brief Understanding on how Conversational Systems uses ML technologies in ASR, NLP,
Advanced Dialog management, Language Translation, Emotion/Sentiment Analysis, Information
extraction ,etc. to effectively converse, Introduction to Contact centers – Impact & Terminologies.
Case studies & Trends, How does a Virtual Agent/Assistant fit in here?

UNIT V CONVERSATIONAL ANALYTICS AND FUTURE 9


Conversation Analytics : The need of it - Introduction to Conversational Metrics - Summary,
Robots and Sensory Applications overview - XR Technologies in Conversational Systems , XR-
Commerce - What to expect next? – Future technologies and market innovations overview.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Familiarize in the NLTK tool kit and the pre-processing techniques of natural language
processing.
CO2: Familiarize with the basic technologies required for building a conversational system.
CO3: Build a Chabot for any application and deploy it
CO4: Involve AI in building conversational system and build advanced systems that can be
cognitively inclined towards human behaviour.
CO5: Build a real time working conversational system for social domain that can intelligently
process inputs and generate relevant replies.
TOTAL :45 PERIODS
TEXTBOOKS:
1. Michael McTear, “Conversational AI: Dialogue Systems, Conversational Agents, and
Chatbots”, Second Edition, Moran and Claypool Publishers, 2020.
2. Cathy Pearl, “Designing Voice User Interfaces: Principles of Conversational Experiences”,
O’REILLY, 2016.

164
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 3 3 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 2 3 2
2 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 2 3 2
3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 2 3 2
4 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 2 3 2
5 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 - - 2 - 3 2 3 2
AVg. 3 3 3 3 2.2 2 1 2 2 3 2 3 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CCB331 MARKETING RESEARCH AND MARKETING MANAGEMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the changing business environment and the fundamental premise
underlying market driven strategies.
 To identify the indicators of management thoughts and practices.
 To analyze the nature of consumer buying behaviour
 To understanding the marketing research
 To new trends in the arena of marketing

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Defining Marketing − Core concepts in Marketing – Evolution of Marketing − Marketing Planning
Process − Scanning Business environment: Internal and External − Value chain − Core
Competencies – PESTEL − SWOT Analysis − Marketing interface with other functional areas –
Production, Finance, Human Relations Management, Information System − Marketing in global
environment – International Marketing − Rural Marketing − Prospects and Challenges

UNIT II MARKETING STRATEGY 9


Marketing strategy formulations – Key Drivers of Marketing Strategies - Strategies for Industrial
Marketing – Consumer Marketing − Services marketing – Competition Analysis − Analysis of
consumer and industrial markets − Influence of Economic and Behavioral Factors − Strategic
Marketing Mix components.

UNIT III MARKETING MIX DECISIONS 9


Product planning and development – Product life cycle – New product Development and
Management – Defining Market Segmentation – Targeting and Positioning − Brand Positioning
and Differentiation – Channel Management – Managing Integrated Marketing Channels −
Managing Retailing, Wholesaling and Logistics − Advertising and Sales Promotions – Pricing
Objectives, Policies and Methods.

UNIT IV BUYER BEHAVIOUR 9


Understanding Industrial and Consumer Buyer Behaviour − Influencing factors – Buyer Behaviour
Models – Online buyer behaviour − Building and measuring customer satisfaction – Customer
relationships management – Customer acquisition, Retaining, Defection − Creating Long Term
Loyalty Relationships. Do case studies on understanding consumer Decision-making Styles in
India - Domestic Vs Foreign brand clothing.

165
UNIT V MARKETING RESEARCH & TRENDS IN MARKET 9
Marketing Information System – Marketing Research Process – Concepts and applications:
Product – Advertising – Promotion – Consumer Behaviour – Retail research – Customer driven
organizations - Cause related marketing − Ethics in marketing – Online marketing trends - social
media and digital marketing. Do an analysis on Amazon in India.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Applied knowledge of contemporary marketing theories to the demands of business
and management practice
CO2: Enhanced knowledge of marketing strategies for consumer and industrial marketing
CO3 : Deep understanding of choice of marketing mix elements and managing integrated
marketing channels
CO4: Ability to analyze the nature of consumer buying behaviour
CO5: Understanding of the marketing research and new trends in the arena of marketing

TEXT BOOKS
1. Philip. T. Kotler and Kevin Lane Keller, Marketing Management, Prentice Hall India, 15th
Edition, 2017
2. KS Chandrasekar, “Marketing management-Text and Cases”, Tata McGraw Hill
Education, 2012
REFERENCES
1. Lamb, Hair, Sharma, Mc Daniel– Marketing – An Innovative approach to learning
and teaching- A south Asian perspective, Cengage Learning, 2012.
2. Paul Baines, Chris Fill, Kelly Page, Marketing, Asian edition, Oxford University Press,5
th edition, 2019.
3. Ramasamy, V.S, Namakumari, S, Marketing Management: Global Perspective
Indian Context, Macmillan Education, New Delhi, 6 th edition, 2018.
4. NAG, Marketing successfully- A Professional Perspective, Macmillan 2008.
5. Micheal R.Czinkota, Masaaki Kotabe, Marketing Management, Vikas Thomson
Learning, 2nd edition 2006.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 2 2 - 2 2 2 - 3 - - 3 1 2 -
2 3 3 1 1 - 2 2 2 - 3 - - 3 1 2 -
3 3 3 2 1 - 2 2 2 - 3 - - 3 1 2 -
4 3 3 2 2 - 2 2 2 - 3 - - 3 1 2 -
5 2 2 1 2 - 2 2 2 - 3 - - 3 1 2 -
AVg. 2.8 2.6 1.6 1.6 2 2 2 3 3 1 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

166
CW3008 RISK ANALYTICS LTPC
30 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
• To develop a basic understanding of risk assessment and its role within the risk
management process.
• To understand risk assessment and its role within the risk management process.
• To differentiate between risk assessment and risk management.
• To develop a basic understanding of how to conduct and evaluate an uncertainty analysis
for a risk assessment

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction, Fundamentals of Risk- Risk Planning, Assessment and Management Process and
the Systems Approach-Types of Risk Assessment- Risk, Hazard, Performance and Engineering
Risk Assessment.

UNIT II RISK IDENTIFICATION 9


Preliminary Hazard Analysis (PHA), Hazards and Operability Analysis (HAZOP) - Job Safety
Analysis (JSA) - Failure Modes and Effects Analysis (FMEA)- Fault Tree Analysis (FTA), Event
Tree Analysis (ETA), Decision Trees- Cause-Consequence Analysis (CCA)

UNIT III RISK PRIORITIZATION & TREATMENT 9


Preliminary Hazard Analysis (PHA), Hazards and Operability Analysis (HAZOP) - Job Safety
Analysis (JSA) - Failure Modes and Effects Analysis (FMEA)- Fault Tree Analysis (FTA), Event
Tree Analysis (ETA), Decision Trees- Cause-Consequence Analysis (CCA).

UNIT IV RISK PRIORITIZATION & TREATMENT 9


Risk Probability and Impact Assessment, Risk Index and Risk Ranking - − Risk Matrix, EV
Analysis, Sensitivity and Tradeoff Analysis, Modeling and Simulation- Risk Attitude and Risk
Tolerance, As Low As Reasonably Practicable (ALARP)- Avoidance, Separation, Reduction,
Transfer, Acceptance- Detection, Control, Response and Recovery- Performance Monitoring.

UNIT V SPECIAL TOPICS AND APPLICATION 9


ISO3100, Quality and Reliability- Supply Chain Risk Management- Project Risk Management-
Positive Risk/ Opportunities Management- Risk and TOC.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Identify the core types of project risks.
CO2: Use qualitative and quantitative risk assessment methods.
CO3: Competently use risk simulation techniques
CO4: Use risk analysis tools/methods and work in a group to create a risk management plan
based on the ISO 31000:2009.
CO5: Identify a range of risk management issues/challenges and the risks as complex systems
cascade and be competent to initiate potential actions in response

TEXT BOOK:
1. Marvin Rausand Stein Haugen , Risk Assessment: Theory, Methods, and Applications,
Wiley, 2020.

167
REFERENCES :
1. Mohammad Modarres , Risk Analysis in Engineering Techniques, Tools, and Trends, CRC
Press, 2006.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 2 1 1 1 1 2 - - - 2 1 3 - 2 3
2 3 2 2 2 2 1 2 - - - 2 1 3 - 2 3
3 3 3 2 2 1 1 2 - - - 2 1 3 - 2 3
4 3 2 1 1 3 1 2 - - - 2 2 3 - 2 3
5 3 3 2 2 2 1 2 - - - 2 2 3 - 2 3
AVg. 3 2.4 1.6 1.6 1.8 1 2 2 1.4 3 2 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

CW3004 ENTERPRISE SECURITY LTPC


30 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand enterprise security in today's world.
 To learn how to evaluate business processes related to risk management
 To learn business continuity
 To understand auditing and security issues in software development.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Developing a Secure Foundation-threat and vulnerabilities-Security Categorization Applied to
Information Types & Information Systems-Minimum Security Requirements-Infrastructure Security
Model Components-Systems Security Categorization-Business Impact Analysis-Risk
Management.

UNIT II PLANNING, MANAGEMENT AND MONITORING 9


Phases of Security-Focused Configuration Management-Security Configuration Management
Plan-Baseline Identification-Roles and Responsibilities-Measurements-Configuration Audits-Types
of Plans-Continuous Monitoring Strategy-Continuous Monitoring Program-Monitoring and
Assessment Frequencies.

UNIT III SECURITY ARCHITECTURE 9


The Meaning of Security - Measuring and Prioritizing Business Risk-Empowering the Customers-
Protecting Relationships and Leveraging Trust-The Meaning of Architecture-Information Systems
Architecture-Enterprise Security Architecture-Security Architecture Model-The SABSA Model-
Contextual and Conceptual Security Architecture

UNIT IV SECURITY POLICY , OPERATIONAL RISK AND ASSURANCE MANAGEMENT 9


Structuring the Content of a Security Policy-Policy Hierarchy and Architecture-Policy Principles-
Types of Security Policies-Complexity of Operational Risk Management-Approaches to Risk
Assessment-Risk Mitigation-Risk Financing-Assurance of Operational Continuity-Security Audits-
Functional & Penetration Testing.
168
UNIT V SECURITY ADMINISTRATION, OPERATIONS AND VALIDATION 9
Introduction-Managing the People-Managing Physical and Environmental Security-Managing ICT
Operations and Support-Access Control Management-Compliance Management-Security-Specific
Operations- Managed Security Services-Product Evaluation and Selection-Business Continuity
Management-Certification and Accreditation Process-General Process Phase I & II.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Design appropriate security architecture with an understanding of the technology
CO2: Create and deploy enterprise solutions in support of organizational goals
CO3: Plan and implement projects related to infrastructure, security, software development.
CO4: Interpret governance policies.
CO5: Manage IT governance policies.

TEXT BOOK:
1. James A. Scholz, Enterprise Architecture and Information Assurance Developing a Secure
Foundation, CRC Press, 2013.(UNIT –I &II) 107
2. John Sherwood, Andrew Clark, David Lynas, Enterprise Security Architecture A Business-
Driven Approach, CRC Press, 2005. (UNIT-III,IV and V)

REFERENCES :
1. John R.Vacca, Computer and Information Security Handbook, Second Edition, Elsevier 2013.
2. Michael E. Whitman, Herbert J. Mattord, Principal of Information Security, Fourth Edition,
Cengage Learning, 2012.

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 - - 2 - 3 3 2 2
2 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 - - 2 - 3 3 2 2
3 3 3 3 3 2 1 2 2 - - 2 - 3 3 2 2
4 3 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 - - 2 - 2 2 2 2
5 3 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 - - 2 - 2 2 2 2
AVg. 3 2.6 2.6 2.4 1.6 1.8 2 2 2 2.6 2.6 2 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-' - no correlation

169
SOFT CORE – MANAGEMENT

GE3751 PRINCIPLES OF MANAGEMENT


L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Sketch the Evolution of Management.
 Extract the functions and principles of management.
 Learn the application of the principles in an organization.
 Study the various HR related activities.
 Analyze the position of self and company goals towards business.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT AND ORGANIZATIONS 9


Definition of Management – Science or Art – Manager Vs Entrepreneur- types of managers-
managerial roles and skills – Evolution of Management –Scientific, human relations, system and
contingency approaches– Types of Business organization- Sole proprietorship, partnership,
company-public and private sector enterprises- Organization culture and Environment – Current
trends and issues in Management.

UNIT II PLANNING 9
Nature and purpose of planning – Planning process – Types of planning – Objectives – Setting
objectives – Policies – Planning premises – Strategic Management – Planning Tools and
Techniques – Decision making steps and process.

UNIT III ORGANISING 9


Nature and purpose – Formal and informal organization – Organization chart – Organization
structure – Types – Line and staff authority – Departmentalization – delegation of authority –
Centralization and decentralization – Job Design - Human Resource Management – HR Planning,
Recruitment, selection, Training and Development, Performance Management, Career planning
and management.

UNIT IV DIRECTING 9
Foundations of individual and group behaviour– Motivation – Motivation theories – Motivational
techniques – Job satisfaction – Job enrichment – Leadership – types and theories of leadership
– Communication – Process of communication – Barrier in communication – Effective
communication – Communication and IT.

UNIT V CONTROLLING 9
System and process of controlling – Budgetary and non - Budgetary control techniques – Use of
computers and IT in Management control – Productivity problems and management – Control
and performance – Direct and preventive control – Reporting.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Upon completion of the course, students will be able to have clear understanding of
managerial functions like planning, organizing, staffing, leading & controlling.
CO2: Have same basic knowledge on international aspect of management.
CO3: Ability to understand management concept of organizing.
CO4: Ability to understand management concept of directing.
170
CO5: Ability to understand management concept of controlling.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Harold Koontz and Heinz Weihrich “Essentials of management” Tata McGraw Hill,1998.
2. Stephen P. Robbins and Mary Coulter, “ Management”, Prentice Hall (India)Pvt. Ltd.,
10th Edition, 2009.

REFERENCES:
1. Robert Kreitner and MamataMohapatra, “ Management”, Biztantra, 2008.
2. Stephen A. Robbins and David A. Decenzo and Mary Coulter, “Fundamentals of
Management” Pearson Education, 7th Edition, 2011.
3. Tripathy PC and Reddy PN, “Principles of Management”, Tata Mcgraw Hill, 1999.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 - - - 1 - - - - - - 2 1 1
2 - 1 1 - - - - - - - - - 2 1 -
3 1 - 2 - - 1 - 2 - 1 1 - - 2
4 - 1 1 1 2 - - 1 2 - - - 1 1 1
5 1 - - 1 1 - - - 3 - 1 1 - 1
AVg. 1.66 1 1 1.5 1.5 1 1 1 2 3 1 1 1.5 1 1.25
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

GE3752 TOTAL QUALITY MANAGEMENT L T PC


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Teach the need for quality, its evolution, basic concepts, contribution of quality gurus,
TQMframework, Barriers and Benefits of TQM.
 Explain the TQM Principles for application.
 Define the basics of Six Sigma and apply Traditional tools, New tools, Benchmarking
andFMEA.
 Describe Taguchi's Quality Loss Function, Performance Measures and apply
Techniqueslike QFD, TPM, COQ and BPR.
 Illustrate and apply QMS and EMS in any organization.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction - Need for quality - Evolution of quality - Definition of quality - Dimensions of product
and service quality –Definition of TQM-- Basic concepts of TQM - Gurus of TQM (Brief
introduction) -- TQM Framework- Barriers to TQM –Benefits of TQM.

UNIT II TQM PRINCIPLES 9


Leadership - Deming Philosophy, Quality Council, Quality statements and Strategic planning-
Customer Satisfaction –Customer Perception of Quality, Feedback, Customer complaints, Service
Quality, Kano Model and Customer retention – Employee involvement – Motivation,
Empowerment, Team and Teamwork, Recognition & Reward and Performance Appraisal--

171
Continuous process improvement –Juran Trilogy, PDSA cycle, 5S and Kaizen - Supplier
partnership – Partnering, Supplier selection, Supplier Rating and Relationship development.

UNIT III TQM TOOLS & TECHNIQUES I 9


The seven traditional tools of quality - New management tools - Six-sigma Process Capability-
Bench marking - Reasons to benchmark, Benchmarking process, What to Bench Mark,
Understanding Current Performance, Planning, Studying Others, Learning from the data, Using
the findings, Pitfalls and Criticisms of Benchmarking - FMEA - Intent , Documentation, Stages:
Design FMEA and Process FMEA.

UNIT IV TQM TOOLS & TECHNIQUES II 9


Quality circles – Quality Function Deployment (QFD) - Taguchi quality loss function – TPM –
Concepts, improvement needs – Performance measures- Cost of Quality - BPR.

UNIT V QUALITY MANAGEMENT SYSTEM 9


Introduction-Benefits of ISO Registration-ISO 9000 Series of Standards-Sector-Specific Standards
- AS 9100, TS16949 and TL 9000-- ISO 9001 Requirements-Implementation-Documentation-
Internal Audits-Registration-ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT SYSTEM: Introduction—ISO
14000 Series Standards—Concepts of ISO 14001—Requirements of ISO 14001-Benefits of EMS.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Ability to apply TQM concepts in a selected enterprise.
CO2: Ability to apply TQM principles in a selected enterprise.
CO3: Ability to understand Six Sigma and apply Traditional tools, New tools,
Benchmarking andFMEA.
CO4: Ability to understand Taguchi's Quality Loss Function, Performance Measures
and
apply QFD, TPM, COQ and BPR.
CO5: Ability to apply QMS and EMS in any organization.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 2 3
2 3 3 2
3 3 3 2 3
4 2 3 2 3 2 3 3 2
5 3 3 3 2
AVg. 2.5 3 3 2.6 3 2 3 3 2.5 2 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

TEXT BOOK:
1. Dale H.Besterfiled, Carol B.Michna,Glen H. Bester field,MaryB.Sacre, HemantUrdhwareshe
and RashmiUrdhwareshe, “Total Quality Management”, Pearson Education Asia, Revised
Third Edition, Indian Reprint, Sixth Impression,2013.

REFERENCES:
1. Joel.E. Ross, “Total Quality Management – Text and Cases”,Routledge.,2017.
172
2. Kiran.D.R, “Total Quality Management: Key concepts and case studies, Butterworth –
Heinemann Ltd, 2016.
3. Oakland, J.S. “TQM – Text with Cases”, Butterworth – Heinemann Ltd., Oxford, Third
Edition,2003.
4. Suganthi,L and Anand Samuel, “Total Quality Management”, Prentice Hall (India) Pvt.
Ltd.,2006 .

GE3753 ENGINEERING ECONOMICS AND FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Understanding the concept of Engineering Economics.
 Implement various micro economics concept in real life.
 Gaining knowledge in the field of macro economics to enable the students to have better
 understanding of various components of macro economics.
 Understanding the different procedures of pricing.
 Learn the various cost related concepts in micro economics.

UNIT I DEMAND & SUPPLY ANALYSIS 9


Managerial Economics - Relationship with other disciplines - Firms: Types, objectives
and goals - Managerial decisions - Decision analysis.Demand - Types of demand - Determinants
of demand - Demand function – Demand elasticity - Demand forecasting - Supply - Determinants
of supply - Supply function -Supply elasticity.

UNIT II PRODUCTION AND COST ANALYSIS 9


Production function - Returns to scale - Production optimization - Least cost input -
Isoquants - Managerial uses of production function.
Cost Concepts - Cost function - Determinants of cost - Short run and Long run cost
curves - Cost Output Decision - Estimation of Cost.

UNIT III PRICING 9


Determinants of Price - Pricing under different objectives and different market structures
- Price discrimination - Pricing methods in practice.

UNIT IV FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING (ELEMENTARY TREATMENT) 9


Balance sheet and related concepts - Profit & Loss Statement and related concepts - -
Financial Ratio Analysis - Cash flow analysis - Funds flow analysis - Comparative
financial statements - Analysis & Interpretation of financial statements.

UNIT V CAPITAL BUDGETING (ELEMENTARY TREATMENT) 9


Investments - Risks and return evaluation of investment decision - Average rate of return
- Payback Period - Net Present Value - Internal rate of return.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students able to
CO1: Upon successful completion of this course, students will acquire the skills to apply the basics
of economics and cost analysis to engineering and take economically sound decisions
CO2: Evaluate the economic theories, cost concepts and pricing policies
173
CO3: Understand the market structures and integration concepts
CO4: Understand the measures of national income, the functions of banks and concepts of
globalization
CO5: Apply the concepts of financial management for project appraisal

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Panneer Selvam, R, “Engineering Economics”, Prentice Hall of India Ltd, New Delhi,2001.
2. Managerial Economics: Analysis, Problems and Cases - P. L. Mehta, Edition, 13. Publisher,
Sultan Chand, 2007.

REFERENCES:
1. Chan S.Park, “Contemporary Engineering Economics”, Prentice Hall of India, 2011.
2. Donald.G. Newman, Jerome.P.Lavelle, “Engineering Economics and analysis” Engg.
Press, Texas, 2010.
3. Degarmo, E.P., Sullivan, W.G and Canada, J.R, “Engineering Economy”, Macmillan, New
York, 2011.
4. Zahid A khan: Engineering Economy, "Engineering Economy", Dorling Kindersley, 2012
5. Dr. S. N. Maheswari and Dr. S.K. Maheshwari: Financial Accounting, Vikas, 2009

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 - 3 - - - - - - - 2 - - 1 3 -
2 - 3 - - - - - - - - - - - 2 2
3 - 2 - - - - - - - - - - - - -
4 2 3 3 - 2 - - - - - - - 2 3 -
5 3 3 3 - 2 - - - - - - - 2 - 2
AVg. 2.5 2.4 3 - 2 - - - - 2 - - 1.8 2.6 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

GE3754 HUMAN RESOURCE MANAGEMENT L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To provide knowledge about management issues related to staffing,
 To provide knowledge about management issues related to training,
 To provide knowledge about management issues related to performance
 To provide knowledge about management issues related to compensation
 To provide knowledge about management issues related to human factors consideration
and compliance with human resource requirements.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO HUMAN RESOURCE MANAGEMENT 9


The importance of human resources – Objective of Human Resource Management - Human
resource policies - Role of human resource manager.

UNIT II HUMAN RESOURCE PLANNING 9


Importance of Human Resource Planning – Internal and External sources of Human Resources -
Recruitment - Selection – Socialization.
174
UNIT III TRAINING AND EXECUTIVE DEVELOPMENT 9
Types of training and Executive development methods – purpose – benefits.

UNIT IV EMPLOYEE COMPENSATION 9


Compensation plan – Reward – Motivation – Career Development - Mentor – Protege
relationships.

UNIT V PERFORMANCE EVALUATION AND CONTROL 9


Performance evaluation – Feedback - The control process – Importance – Methods – grievances –
Causes – Redressal methods.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Students would have gained knowledge on the various aspects of HRM
CO2: Students will gain knowledge needed for success as a human resources professional.
CO3: Students will develop the skills needed for a successful HR manager.
CO4: Students would be prepared to implement the concepts learned in
the workplace.
CO5: Students would be aware of the emerging concepts in the field of HRM

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Decenzo and Robbins, "Human Resource Management", 8th Edition, Wiley, 2007.
2. John Bernardin. H., "Human Resource Management – An Experimental Approach", 5th Edition,
Tata McGraw Hill, 2013, New Delhi.

REFERENCES:
1. Luis R,. Gomez-Mejia, DavidB. Balkin and Robert L. Cardy, “Managing Human
Resources", 7th Edition, PHI, 2012.
2. Dessler, "Human Resource Management", Pearson Education Limited, 2007.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 2 1 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
2 3 3 2 3 2 2 2 2 3 1 2 1 1 2 1
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 3 1 2 1 1 2 1
4 3 3 2 3 3 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
5 3 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
AVg. 2.8 2.8 1.8 2.6 2.6 2.2 1.8 1.8 2.4 1 1.4 1 1 1.4 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

GE3755 KNOWLEDGE MANAGEMENT L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The student should be made to:
 Learn the Evolution of Knowledge management.
 Be familiar with tools.
 Be exposed to Applications.

175
 Be familiar with some case studies.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction: An Introduction to Knowledge Management -
The foundations of knowledge management- including cultural issues- technology applications
organizational concepts and processes- management aspects- and decision support systems. The
Evolution of Knowledge management: From Information Management to Knowledge Management -
Key Challenges Facing the Evolution of Knowledge Management - Ethics for Knowledge
Management.

UNIT II CREATING THE CULTURE OF LEARNING AND KNOWLEDGE SHARING 9


Organization and Knowledge Management - Building the Learning Organization. Knowledge
Markets: Cooperation among Distributed Technical Specialists – Tacit Knowledge and Quality
Assurance.

UNIT III KNOWLEDGE MANAGEMENT-THE TOOLS 9


Telecommunications and Networks in Knowledge Management - Internet Search Engines and
Knowledge Management - Information Technology in Support of Knowledge Management -
Knowledge Management and Vocabulary Control - Information Mapping in Information Retrieval -
Information Coding in the Internet Environment - Repackaging Information.

UNIT IV KNOWLEDGE MANAGEMENT APPLICATION 9


Components of a Knowledge Strategy - Case Studies (From Library to Knowledge Center,
Knowledge
Management in the Health Sciences, Knowledge Management in Developing Countries).

UNIT V FUTURE TRENDS AND CASE STUDIES 9


Advanced topics and case studies in knowledge management - Development of a knowledge
management map/plan that is integrated with an organization's strategic and business plan - A case
study on Corporate Memories for supporting various aspects in the process life -cycles of an
organization.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, the student should be able to:
CO1: Understand the process of acquiry knowledge from experts
CO2: Understand the learning organization.
CO3: Use the knowledge management tools.
CO4: Develop knowledge management Applications.
CO5: Design and develop enterprise applications.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1
2 2 1
3 2 2
4 1 1 1 1
5 1 1 1 1
AVg. 1 1.4 1 1 1.33
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

176
TEXT BOOK:
1. Srikantaiah, T.K., Koenig, M., “Knowledge Management for the Information Professional”
Information Today, Inc., 2000.

REFERENCE:
1. Nonaka, I., Takeuchi, H., “The Knowledge-Creating Company: How Japanese Companies
Create the Dynamics of Innovation”, Oxford University Press, 1995.

GE3792 INDUSTRIAL MANAGEMENT L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES

 To study the basic concepts of management; approaches to management; contributors


to management studies; various forms of business organization and trade unions function
in professional organizations.
 To study the planning; organizing and staffing functions of management in professional
organization.
 To study the leading; controlling and decision making functions of management in
professional organization.
 To learn the organizational theory in professional organization.
 To learn the principles of productivity and modern concepts in management in professional
organization.

UNIT – I INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT 9


Management: Introduction; Definition and Functions – Approaches to the study of Management –
Mintzberg’s Ten Managerial Roles – Principles of Taylor; Fayol; Weber; Parker – Forms of
Organization: Sole Proprietorship; Partnership; Company (Private and Public); Cooperative –
Public Sector Vs Private Sector Organization – Business Environment: Economic; Social; Political;
Legal – Trade Union: Definition; Functions; Merits & Demerits.

UNIT – II FUNCTIONS OF MANAGEMENT - I 9


Planning: Characteristics; Nature; Importance; Steps; Limitation; Planning Premises; Strategic
Planning; Vision & Mission statement in Planning– Organizing: Organizing Theory; Principles; Types;
Departmentalization; Centralization and Decentralization; Authority & Responsibility – Staffing: Systems
Approach; Recruiting and Selection Process; Human Resource Development (HRD) Concept and
Design.

UNIT – III FUNCTIONS OF MANAGEMENT - II 9


Directing (Leading): Leadership Traits; Style; Morale; Managerial Grids (Blake-Mounton, Reddin) –
Communication: Purpose; Model; Barriers – Controlling: Process; Types; Levels; Guidelines; Audit
(External, Internal, Merits); Preventive Control – Decision Making: Elements; Characteristics; Nature;
Process; Classifications.

UNIT – IV ORGANIZATION THEORY 9


Organizational Conflict: Positive Aspects; Individual; Role; Interpersonal; Intra Group; Inter
Group; Conflict Management – Maslow’s hierarchy of needs theory; Herzberg’s motivation-hygiene
theory; McClelland’s three needs motivation theory; Vroom’s valence-expectancy theory – Change
177
Management: Concept of Change; Lewin’s Process of Change Model; Sources of Resistance;
Overcoming Resistance; Guidelines to managing Conflict.

UNIT – V PRODUCTIVITY AND MODERN TOPICS 9


Productivity: Concept; Measurements; Affecting Factors; Methods to Improve – Modern Topics
(concept, feature/characteristics, procedure, merits and demerits): Business Process Reengineering
(BPR); Benchmarking; SWOT/SWOC Analysis; Total Productive Maintenance; Enterprise Resource
Planning (ERP); Management of Information Systems (MIS).
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course the students would be able to
CO1 Explain basic concepts of management; approaches to management; contributors to
management studies; various forms of business organization and trade unions function in
professional organizations.

CO2 Discuss the planning; organizing and staffing functions of management in professional
organization.
CO3 Apply the leading; controlling and decision making functions of management in professional
organization.
CO4 Discuss the organizational theory in professional organization.
CO5 Apply principles of productivity and modern concepts in management in professional
organization.
TEXTBOOKS:
1. M. Govindarajan and S. Natarajan, “Principles of Management”, Prentice Hall of India, New
Delhi, 2009.
2. Koontz. H. and Weihrich. H., “Essentials of Management: An International Perspective”, 8th
Edition, Tata McGrawhill, New Delhi, 2010.
REFERENCES:
1. Joseph J, Massie, “Essentials of Management”, 4th Edition, Pearson Education, 1987.
2. Saxena, P. K., “Principles of Management: A Modern Approach”, Global India
Publications, 2009.
3. S.Chandran, “Organizational Behaviours”, Vikas Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., 1994.
4. Richard L. Daft, “Organization Theory and Design”, South Western College Publishing, 11th
Edition, 2012.
5. S. TrevisCerto, “Modern Management Concepts and Skills”, Pearson Education, 2018.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3

1 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
2 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
4 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
5 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation
178
MANDATORY COURSES I

MX3081 INTRODUCTION TO WOMEN AND GENDER STUDIES LTPC


3 000

COURSE OBJECTIVE

UNIT I CONCEPTS
Sex vs. Gender, masculinity, femininity, socialization, patriarchy, public/ private, essentialism,
binaryism, power, hegemony, hierarchy, stereotype, gender roles, gender relation, deconstruction,
resistance, sexual division of labour.

UNIT II FEMINIST THEORY


Liberal, Marxist, Socialist, Radical, Psychoanalytic, postmodernist, ecofeminist.

UNIT III WOMEN’S MOVEMENTS: GLOBAL, NATIONAL AND LOCAL


Rise of Feminism in Europe and America.
Women’s Movement in India.

UNIT IV GENDER AND LANGUAGE


Linguistic Forms and Gender.
Gender and narratives.

UNIT V GENDER AND REPRESENTATION


Advertising and popular visual media.

Gender and Representation in Alternative Media.


Gender and social media.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS

MX3082 ELEMENTS OF LITERATURE LTPC


3 000

COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To make the students aware about the finer sensibilities of human existence through an art
form. The students will learn to appreciate different forms of literature as suitable modes of
expressing human experience.

1. COURSE CONTENTS

Introduction to Elements of Literature

1. Relevance of literature

a) Enhances Reading, thinking, discussing and writing skills.

b) Develops finer sensibility for better human relationship.


c) Increases understanding of the problem of humanity without bias.

179
d) Providing space to reconcile and get a cathartic effect.

2. Elements of fiction

a) Fiction, fact and literary truth.


b) Fictional modes and patterns.

c) Plot character and perspective.

3. Elements of poetry

a) Emotions and imaginations.

b) Figurative language.

c) (Simile, metaphor, conceit, symbol, pun and irony).

d) Personification and animation.


e) Rhetoric and trend.

4. Elements of drama

a) Drama as representational art.

b) Content mode and elements.

c) Theatrical performance.

d) Drama as narration, mediation and persuasion.

e) Features of tragedy, comedy and satire.

3. READINGS:

1. An Introduction to the Study of English Literature, W.H. Hudson, Atlantic, 2007.

2. An Introduction to Literary Studies, Mario Klarer, Routledge, 2013.

3. The Experience of Poetry, Graham Mode, Open college of Arts with Open Unv Press,
1991.

4. The Elements of Fiction: A Survey, Ulf Wolf (ed), Wolfstuff, 2114.


5. The Elements of Drama, J.L.Styan, Literary Licensing, 2011.
3.1 Textbook:

3.2 *Reference Books:: To be decided by the teacher and student, on the basis of individual
student so as to enable him or her to write the term paper.
4. OTHER SESSION:

4.1*Tutorials:

180
4.2*Laboratory:

4.3*Project: The students will write a term paper to show their understanding of a particular piece
of literature

5.*ASSESSMENT:

5.1HA:

5.2Quizzes-HA:

5.3Periodical Examination: one

5.4Project/Lab: one (under the guidance of the teachers the students will take a volume of poetry,
fiction or drama and write a term paper to show their understanding of it in a given context;
sociological, psychological, historical, autobiographical etc.

5.5Final Exam:
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
OUTCOME OF THE COURSE:
 Students will be able to understand the relevance of literature in human life and appreciate
its aspects in developing finer sensibilities.

MX3083 FILM APPRECIATION LT PC


3 0 00
In this course on film appreciation, the students will be introduced broadly to the development of
film as an art and entertainment form. It will also discuss the language of cinema as it evolved over
a century. The students will be taught as to how to read a film and appreciate the various nuances
of a film as a text. The students will be guided to study film joyfully.

Theme - A: The Component of Films

A-1: The material and equipment


A-2: The story, screenplay and script
A-3: The actors, crew members, and the director
A-4: The process of film making… structure of a film

Theme - B: Evolution of Film Language

B-1: Film language, form, movement etc.


B-2: Early cinema… silent film (Particularly French)
B-3: The emergence of feature films: Birth of a Nation
B-4: Talkies

Theme - C: Film Theories and Criticism/Appreciation

C-1: Realist theory; Auteurists


181
C-2: Psychoanalytic, Ideological, Feminists
C-3: How to read films?
C-4: Film Criticism / Appreciation
Theme – D: Development of Films

D-1: Representative Soviet films


D-2: Representative Japanese films
D-3: Representative Italian films
D-4: Representative Hollywood film and the studio system

Theme - E: Indian Films

E-1: The early era


E-2: The important films made by the directors
E-3: The regional films
E-4: The documentaries in India

READING:

A Reader containing important articles on films will be prepared and given to the students. The
students must read them and present in the class and have discussion on these.

MX3084 DISASTER RISK REDUCTION AND MANAGEMENT LTPC


300 0
COURSE OBJECTIVE
 To impart knowledge on concepts related to disaster, disaster risk reduction, disaster
management
 To acquaint with the skills for planning and organizing disaster response

UNIT I HAZRADS, VULNERABILITY AND DISASTER RISKS 9


Definition: Disaster, Hazard, Vulnerability, Resilience, Risks – Types of Disasters: Natural, Human
induced, Climate change induced –Earthquake, Landslide, Flood, Drought, Fire etc –
Technological disasters- Structural collapse, Industrial accidents, oil spills -Causes, Impacts
including social, Economic, political, environmental, health, psychosocial, etc.- Disaster
vulnerability profile of India and Tamil Nadu - Global trends in disasters: urban disasters,
pandemics, Complex emergencies, - -, Inter relations between Disasters and Sustainable
development Goals

UNIT II DISASTER RISK REDUCTION (DRR) 9


Sendai Framework for Disaster Risk Reduction, Disaster cycle - Phases, Culture of safety,
prevention, mitigation and preparedness community Based DRR, Structural- nonstructural
measures, Roles and responsibilities of- community, Panchayati Raj Institutions / Urban Local
Bodies (PRIs/ULBs), States, Centre, and other stakeholders- Early Warning System – Advisories
from Appropriate Agencies.- Relevance of indigenous Knowledge, appropriate technology and
Local resources.

182
UNIT III DISASTER MANAGEMENT 9
Components of Disaster Management – Preparedness of rescue and relief, mitigation,
rehabilitation and reconstruction- Disaster Risk Management and post disaster management –
Compensation and Insurance- Disaster Management Act (2005) and Policy - Other related
policies, plans, programmers and legislation - Institutional Processes and Framework at State and
Central Level- (NDMA –SDMA-DDMA-NRDF- Civic Volunteers)

UNIT IV TOOLS AND TECHNOLOGY FOR DISASTER MANAGEMENT 9


Early warning systems -Components of Disaster Relief: Water, Food, Sanitation, Shelter, Health,
Waste Management, Institutional arrangements (Mitigation, Response and Preparedness, – Role
of GIS and Information Technology Components in Preparedness, Risk Assessment, Response
and Recovery Phases of Disaster – Disaster Damage Assessment. - Elements of Climate Resilient
Development –Standard operation Procedure for disaster response – Financial planning for
disaster Management

UNIT V DISASTER MANAGEMENT: CASE STUDIES 9


Discussion on selected case studies to analyse the potential impacts and actions in the contest of
disasters-Landslide Hazard Zonation: Earthquake Vulnerability Assessment of Buildings and
Infrastructure: Case Studies, Drought Assessment: Case Studies, Coastal Flooding: Storm Surge
Assessment, Floods: Fluvial and Pluvial Flooding: Case Studies; Forest Fire: Case Studies, Man
Made disasters: Case Studies, Space Based Inputs for Disaster Mitigation and Management and
field works related to disaster management.- Field work-Mock drill -
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1 Taimpo (2016), Disaster Management and Preparedness, CRC Publications
2 Singh R (2017), Disaster Management Guidelines for earthquakes, Landslides, Avalanches and
tsunami, Horizon Press Publications
3 Singhal J.P. “Disaster Management”, Laxmi Publications, 2010. ISBN-10: 9380386427 ISBN-
13: 978-9380386423
4 Tushar Bhattacharya, “Disaster Science and Management”, McGraw Hill India
Education Pvt. Ltd., 2012. ISBN-10: 1259007367, ISBN-13: 978-1259007361]

REFERENCES
1. Govt. of India: Disaster Management Act, Government of India, New Delhi, 2005.
2. Government of India, National Disaster Management Policy, 2009.
3. Shaw R (2016), Community based Disaster risk reduction, Oxford University Press

COURSE OUTCOME:
CO1: To impart knowledge on the concepts of Disaster, Vulnerability and Disaster Risk reduction
(DRR)
CO2: To enhance understanding on Hazards, Vulnerability and Disaster Risk Assessment
prevention and risk reduction
CO3: To develop disaster response skills by adopting relevant tools and technology
CO4: Enhance awareness of institutional processes for Disaster response in the country and
CO5: Develop rudimentary ability to respond to their surroundings with potential
Disaster response in areas where they live, with due sensitivity

183
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 2 3 - - 2 2 - - 2 - 2 - 1
2 3 3 3 3 - - 2 1 - - 2 - 2 - 1
3 3 3 3 3 - - 2 2 - - - - 2 - 1
4 3 3 2 3 - - 2 1 - - 2 - 2 - 1
5 3 3 2 3 - - 2 2 - - 2 - 3 - 1
AVG 3 3 3 3 - - 2 2 - - 2 - 2 - 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

MANDATORY COURSES II

MX3085 WELL-BEING WITH TRADITIONAL PRACTICES-YOGA, AYURVEDA AND


SIDDHA L T PC
3 0 00
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To enjoy life happily with fun filled new style activities that help to maintain health also
 To adapt a few lifestyle changes that will prevent many health disorders
 To be cool and handbill every emotion very smoothly in every walk of life
 To learn to eat cost effective but healthy foods that are rich in essential nutrients
 To develop immunity naturally that will improve resistance against many health disorders

UNIT I HEALTH AND ITS IMPORTANCE 2+4

Health: Definition - Importance of maintaining health - More importance on prevention than


treatment
Ten types of health one has to maintain - Physical health - Mental health - Social health - Financial
health - Emotional health - Spiritual health - Intellectual health - Relationship health -
Environmental health - Occupational/Professional heath.

Present health status - The life expectancy-present status - mortality rate - dreadful diseases -
Non-communicable diseases (NCDs) the leading cause of death - 60% - heart disease – cancer –
diabetes - chronic pulmonary diseases - risk factors – tobacco – alcohol - unhealthy diet - lack of
physical activities.

Types of diseases and disorders - Lifestyle disorders – Obesity – Diabetes - Cardiovascular


diseases – Cancer – Strokes – COPD - Arthritis - Mental health issues.

Causes of the above diseases / disorders - Importance of prevention of illness - Takes care
of health - Improves quality of life - Reduces absenteeism - Increase satisfaction - Saves time

Simple lifestyle modifications to maintain health - Healthy Eating habits (Balanced diet
according to age) Physical Activities (Stretching exercise, aerobics, resisting exercise) -
Maintaining BMI-Importance and actions to be taken

184
UNIT II DIET 4+6
Role of diet in maintaining health - energy one needs to keep active throughout the day -
nutrients one needs for growth and repair - helps one to stay strong and healthy - helps to prevent
diet-related illness, such as some cancers - keeps active and - helps one to maintain a healthy
weight - helps to reduce risk of developing lifestyle disorders like diabetes – arthritis –
hypertension – PCOD – infertility – ADHD – sleeplessness -helps to reduce the risk of heart
diseases - keeps the teeth and bones strong.

Balanced Diet and its 7 Components - Carbohydrates – Proteins – Fats – Vitamins – Minerals -
Fibre and Water.

Food additives and their merits & demerits - Effects of food additives - Types of food additives -
Food additives and processed foods - Food additives and their reactions

Definition of BMI and maintaining it with diet


Importance - Consequences of not maintaining BMI - different steps to maintain optimal BM

Common cooking mistakes


Different cooking methods, merits and demerits of each method

UNIT III ROLE OF AYURVEDA & SIDDHA SYSTEMS IN MAINTAINING HEALTH 4+4
AYUSH systems and their role in maintaining health - preventive aspect of AYUSH - AYUSH
as a soft therapy.
Secrets of traditional healthy living - Traditional Diet and Nutrition - Regimen of Personal and
Social Hygiene - Daily routine (Dinacharya) - Seasonal regimens (Ritucharya) - basic sanitation
and healthy living environment - Sadvritta (good conduct) - for conducive social life.
Principles of Siddha & Ayurveda systems - Macrocosm and Microcosm theory -
Pancheekarana Theory / (Five Element Theory) 96 fundamental Principles - Uyir Thathukkal (Tri-
Dosha Theory) - Udal Thathukkal
Prevention of illness with our traditional system of medicine
Primary Prevention - To decrease the number of new cases of a disorder or illness - Health
promotion/education, and - Specific protective measures - Secondary Prevention - To lower the
rate of established cases of a disorder or illness in the population (prevalence) - Tertiary
Prevention - To decrease the amount of disability associated with an existing disorder.

UNIT IV MENTAL WELLNESS 3+4


Emotional health - Definition and types - Three key elements: the subjective experience - the
physiological response - the behavioral response - Importance of maintaining emotional health -
Role of emotions in daily life -Short term and long term effects of emotional disturbances - Leading
a healthy life with emotions - Practices for emotional health - Recognize how thoughts influence
emotions - Cultivate positive thoughts - Practice self-compassion - Expressing a full range of
emotions.

Stress management - Stress definition - Stress in daily life - How stress affects one’s life -
Identifying the cause of stress - Symptoms of stress - Managing stress (habits, tools, training,
professional help) - Complications of stress mismanagement.

Sleep - Sleep and its importance for mental wellness - Sleep and digestion.

185
Immunity - Types and importance - Ways to develop immunity

UNIT V YOGA 2+12


Definition and importance of yoga - Types of yoga - How to Choose the Right Kind for
individuals according to their age - The Eight Limbs of Yoga - Simple yogasanas for cure and
prevention of health disorders - What yoga can bring to our life.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Nutrition and Dietetics - Ashley Martin, Published by White Word Publications,
New York, NY 10001, USA
2. Yoga for Beginners_ 35 Simple Yoga Poses to Calm Your Mind and Strengthen Your Body,
by Cory Martin, Copyright © 2015 by Althea Press, Berkeley, California

REFERENCES:
1. WHAT WE KNOW ABOUT EMOTIONAL INTELLIGENCE How It Affects Learning, Work,
Relationships, and Our Mental Health, by Moshe Zeidner, Gerald Matthews, and Richard
D. Roberts
2. A Bradford Book, The MIT Press, Cambridge, Massachusetts, London, England The
Mindful Self-Compassion Workbook, Kristin Neff, Ph.D Christopher Germer, Ph.D,
Published by The Guilford Press A Division of Guilford Publications, Inc.370 Seventh
Avenue, Suite 1200, New York, NY 10001

1. https://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pmc/articles/PMC4799645/
2. Simple lifestyle modifications to maintain health
https://www.niddk.nih.gov/health-information/diet-nutrition/changing-habits-better-
health#:~:text=Make%20your%20new%20healthy%20habit,t%20have%20time%20to%20cook.
3. Read more: https://www.legit.ng/1163909-classes-food-examples-functions.html
4. https://www.yaclass.in/p/science-state-board/class-9/nutrition-and-health-5926
5. Benefits of healthy eating https://www.cdc.gov/nutrition/resources-publications/benefits-of-
healthy-eating.html
6. Food additives https://www.betterhealth.vic.gov.au/health/conditionsandtreatments/food-
additives
7. BMI https://www.hsph.harvard.edu/nutritionsource/healthy-weight/
https://www.who.int/europe/news-room/fact-sheets/item/a-healthy-lifestyle---who-
recommendations
8. Yoga https://www.healthifyme.com/blog/types-of-yoga/
https://yogamedicine.com/guide-types-yoga-styles/
Ayurveda : https://vikaspedia.in/health/ayush/ayurveda-1/concept-of-healthy-living-in-ayurveda
9. Siddha : http://www.tkdl.res.in/tkdl/langdefault/Siddha/Sid_Siddha_Concepts.asp
10. CAM : https://www.hindawi.com/journals/ecam/2013/376327/
11. Preventive herbs : https://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pmc/articles/PMC3847409/
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completing the course, the students will be able to:
CO1:Learn the importance of different components of health
CO2:Gain confidence to lead a healthy life
CO3:Learn new techniques to prevent lifestyle health disorders
CO4:Understand the importance of diet and workouts in maintaining health

186
MX3086 HISTORY OF SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY IN INDIA LT PC
3 0 00
UNIT I CONCEPTS AND PERSPECTIVES
Meaning of History
Objectivity, Determinism, Relativism, Causation, Generalization in History; Moral judgment in
history
Extent of subjectivity, contrast with physical sciences, interpretation and speculation, causation
verses evidence, concept of historical inevitability, Historical Positivism.
Science and Technology-Meaning, Scope and Importance, Interaction of science, technology &
society, Sources of history on science and technology in India.

UNIT II HISTORIOGRAPHY OF SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY IN INDIA


Introduction to the works of D.D. Kosambi, Dharmpal, Debiprasad Chattopadhyay, Rehman, S.
Irfan Habib, Deepak Kumar, Dhruv Raina, and others.

UNIT III SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY IN ANCIENT INDIA


Technology in pre-historic period
Beginning of agriculture and its impact on technology
Science and Technology during Vedic and Later Vedic times
Science and technology from 1st century AD to C-1200.

UNIT IV SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY IN MEDIEVAL INDIA


Legacy of technology in Medieval India, Interactions with Arabs
Development in medical knowledge, interaction between Unani and Ayurveda and alchemy
Astronomy and Mathematics: interaction with Arabic Sciences
Science and Technology on the eve of British conquest

UNIT V SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY IN COLONIAL INDIA


Science and the Empire
Indian response to Western Science
Growth of techno-scientific institutions

UNIT VI SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY IN A POST-INDEPENDENT INDIA


Science, Technology and Development discourse
Shaping of the Science and Technology Policy
Developments in the field of Science and Technology
Science and technology in globalizing India
Social implications of new technologies like the Information Technology and Biotechnology
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS

187
MX3087 POLITICAL AND ECONOMIC THOUGHT FOR A HUMANE SOCIETY LT PC
3 0 00
Pre-Requisite: None. (Desirable: Universal Human Values 1, Universal Human Values 2)

COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 This course will begin with a short overview of human needs and desires and how different
political-economic systems try to fullfill them. In the process, we will end with a critique of different
systems and their implementations in the past, with possible future directions.

COURSE TOPICS:
Considerations for humane society, holistic thought, human being’s desires, harmony in self,
harmony in relationships, society, and nature, societal systems. (9 lectures, 1 hour each)

(Refs: A Nagaraj, M K Gandhi, JC Kumarappa)

Capitalism – Free markets, demand-supply, perfect competition, laissez-faire, monopolies,


imperialism. Liberal democracy. (5 lectures)

(Refs: Adam smith, J S Mill)

Fascism and totalitarianism. World war I and II. Cold war. (2 lectures)

Communism – Mode of production, theory of labour, surplus value, class struggle, dialectical
materialism, historical materialism, Russian and Chinese models.

(Refs: Marx, Lenin, Mao, M N Roy) (5 lectures)

Welfare state. Relation with human desires. Empowered human beings, satisfaction. (3 lectures)

Gandhian thought. Swaraj, Decentralized economy & polity, Community. Control over one’s lives.
Relationship with nature. (6 lectures)

(Refs: M K Gandhi, Schumacher, Kumarappa)

Essential elements of Indian civilization. (3 lectures)

(Refs: Pt Sundarlal, R C Mazumdar, Dharampal)

Technology as driver of society, Role of education in shaping of society. Future directions. (4


lectures) (Refs: Nandkishore Acharya, David Dixon, Levis Mumford)

Conclusion (2 lectures)

Total lectures: 39

Preferred Textbooks: See Reference Books

188
Reference Books: Authors mentioned along with topics above. Detailed reading list will be
provided.

GRADING:
Mid sems 30
End sem 20
Home Assign 10
Term paper 40
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOME:
 The students will get an understanding of how societies are shaped by philosophy, political
and economic system, how they relate to fulfilling human goals & desires with some case studies
of how different attempts have been made in the past and how they have fared.

MX3088 STATE, NATION BUILDING AND POLITICS IN INDIA LT PC


3 0 00
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
The objective of the course is to provide an understanding of the state, how it works through its
main organs, primacy of politics and political process, the concept of sovereignty and its changing
contours in a globalized world. In the light of this, an attempt will be made to acquaint the students
with the main development and legacies of national movement and constitutional development in
India, reasons for adopting a Parliamentary-federal system, the broad philosophy of the
Constitution of India and the changing nature of Indian Political System. Challenges/ problems and
issues concerning national integration and nation-building will also be discussed in the
contemporary context with the aim of developing a future vision for a better India.

TOPICS:
Understanding the need and role of State and politics.
Development of Nation-State, sovereignty, sovereignty in a globalized world.

Organs of State – Executive, Legislature, Judiciary. Separation of powers, forms of government-


unitary-federal, Presidential-Parliamentary,
The idea of India.

1857 and the national awakening.

1885 Indian National Congress and development of national movement – its


legacies. Constitution making and the Constitution of India.
Goals, objective and philosophy.
Why a federal system?
National integration and nation-building.

Challenges of nation-building – State against democracy (Kothari)


New social movements.

189
The changing nature of Indian Political System, the future
scenario. What can we do?

OUTCOME OF THE COURSE:


It is expected that this course will make students aware of the theoretical aspect of the state, its
organs, its operationalization aspect, the background and philosophy behind the founding of the
present political system, broad streams and challenges of national integration and nation-building
in India. It will equip the students with the real understanding of our political system/ process in
correct perspective and make them sit up and think for devising ways for better participation in the
system with a view to making the governance and delivery system better for the common man who
is often left unheard and unattended in our democratic setup besides generating a lot of
dissatisfaction and difficulties for the system.

SUGGESTED READING:
i. Sunil Khilnani, The Idea of India. Penguin India Ltd., New Delhi.
ii. Madhav Khosla, The Indian Constitution, Oxford University Press. New Delhi, 2012.
iii. Brij Kishore Sharma, Introduction to the Indian Constitution, PHI, New Delhi, latest edition.
iv. Sumantra Bose, Transforming India: Challenges to the World’s Largest Democracy,
Picador India, 2013.
v. Atul Kohli, Democracy and Discontent: India’s Growing Crisis of Governability, Cambridge
University Press, Cambridge, U. K., 1991.
vi. M. P. Singh and Rekha Saxena, Indian Politics: Contemporary Issues and Concerns, PHI,
New Delhi, 2008, latest edition.
vii. Rajni Kothari, Rethinking Democracy, Orient Longman, New Delhi, 2005.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS

MX3089 INDUSTRIAL SAFETY L T PC


3 0 00
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To Understand the Introduction and basic Terminologies safety.
 To enable the students to learn about the Important Statutory Regulations and standards.
 To enable students to Conduct and participate the various Safety activities in the Industry.
 To have knowledge about Workplace Exposures and Hazards.
 To assess the various Hazards and consequences through various Risk Assessment
Techniques.

UNIT I SAFETY TERMINOLOGIES


Hazard-Types of Hazard- Risk-Hierarchy of Hazards Control Measures-Lead indicators- lag
Indicators-Flammability- Toxicity Time-weighted Average (TWA) - Threshold LimitValue (TLV) -
Short Term Exposure Limit (STEL)- Immediately dangerous to life or health (IDLH)- acute and
chronic Effects- Routes of Chemical Entry-Personnel Protective Equipment- Health and Safety
Policy-Material Safety Data Sheet MSDS

UNIT II STANDARDS AND REGULATIONS


Indian Factories Act-1948- Health- Safety- Hazardous materials and Welfare- ISO 45001:2018
occupational health and safety (OH&S) - Occupational Safety and Health Audit IS14489:1998-
Hazard Identification and Risk Analysis- code of practice IS 15656:2006
190
UNIT III SAFETY ACTIVITIES
Toolbox Talk- Role of safety Committee- Responsibilities of Safety Officers and Safety
Representatives- Safety Training and Safety Incentives- Mock Drills- On-site Emergency Action
Plan- Off-site Emergency Action Plan- Safety poster and Display- Human Error Assessment

UNIT IV WORKPLACE HEALTH AND SAFETY


Noise hazard- Particulate matter- musculoskeletal disorder improper sitting poster and lifting
Ergonomics RULE & REBA- Unsafe act & Unsafe Condition- Electrical Hazards- Crane Safety-
Toxic gas Release

UNIT V HAZARD IDENTIFICATION TECHNIQUES


Job Safety Analysis-Preliminary Hazard Analysis-Failure mode and Effects Analysis- Hazard and
Operability- Fault Tree Analysis- Event Tree Analysis Qualitative and Quantitative Risk
Assessment- Checklist Analysis- Root cause analysis- What-If Analysis- and Hazard Identification
and Risk Assessment
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Course outcomes on completion of this course the student will be able:
CO1:Understand the basic concept of safety.
CO2:Obtain knowledge of Statutory Regulations and standards.
CO3:Know about the safety Activities of the Working Place.
CO4:Analyze on the impact of Occupational Exposures and their Remedies
CO5:Obtain knowledge of Risk Assessment Techniques.

TEXTBOOKS
1. R.K. Jain and Prof. Sunil S. Rao Industrial Safety, Health and Environment Management
Systems KHANNA PUBLISHER
2. L. M. Deshmukh Industrial Safety Management: Hazard Identification and Risk Control
McGraw-Hill Education
REFERENCES
1. Frank Lees (2012) ‘Lees’ Loss Prevention in Process Industries.Butterworth-Heinemann
publications, UK, 4th Edition.
2. John Ridley & John Channing (2008)Safety at Work: Routledge, 7th Edition.
3. Dan Petersen (2003) Techniques of Safety Management: A System Approach.
4. Alan Waring.(1996).Safety management system: Chapman &Hall,England
5. Society of Safety Engineers, USA
ONLINE RESOURCES
ISO 45001:2018 occupational health and safety (OH&S) International Organization for
Standardization https://www.iso.org/standard/63787.html
Indian Standard code of practice on occupational safety and health audit
https://law.resource.org/pub/in/bis/S02/is.14489.1998.pdf
Indian Standard code of practice on Hazard Identification and Risk Analysis IS 15656:2006
https://law.resource.org/pub/in/bis/S02/is.15656.2006.pdf

191
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

Course Program Outcome


Outcome Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
Understand the basic
3 3 3 1 1 3 2 2 3 3 1 3 3 3 3
CO1 concept of safety.
Obtain knowledge of
CO2 Statutory Regulations 2 3 2 2 1 3 2 3 3 2 1 3 3 3 3
and standards.
Know about the safety
CO3 Activities of the 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 3 2 1 2 3 3 3
Working Place.
Analyze on the impact
CO4 of Occupational
3 3 3 2 2 3 2 2 3 2 1 3 3 3 3
Exposures and their
Remedies
Obtain knowledge of
CO5 Risk Assessment 3 2 3 2 2 3 2 2 3 2 2 3 3 3 3
Techniques.
Industrial safety 3 3 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 2 1 3 3 3 3

1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

192
OPEN ELECTIVE I

OAS351 SPACE SCIENCE L T PC


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To outline the space environment and their effects.
 To extend the origin of universe and development.
 To classify the galaxies and their evolution.
 To interpret the variable stars in the galaxies.
 To explain theory of formation of our solar system.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction to space science and applications – historical development – Space Environment-
Vacuum and its Effects, Plasma & Radiation Environments and their Effects, Debris Environment
and its Effects - Newton's Law of gravitation – Fundamental Physical Principles.

UNIT II ORIGIN OF UNIVERSE 9


Early history of the universe – Big-Bang and Hubble expansion model of the universe – cosmic
microwave background radiation – dark matter and dark energy.

UNIT III GALAXIES 7


Galaxies, their evolution and origin – active galaxies and quasars – Galactic rotation – Stellar
populations – galactic magnetic field and cosmic rays.

UNIT IV STARS 10
Stellar spectra and structure – stellar evolution – Nucleo-synthesis and formation of elements –
Classification of stars – Harvard classification system – Hertsprung-Russel diagram – Luminosity
of star – variable stars – composite stars (white dwarfs, Neutron stars, black hole, star clusters,
supernova and binary stars) – Chandrasekhar limit.

UNIT V SOLAR SYSTEM 10


Nebular theory of formation of our Solar System – Solar wind and nuclear reaction as the source
of energy – Sun and Planets: Brief description about shape size – period of rotation about axis and
period of revolution – distance of planets from sun – Bode's law – Kepler's Laws of planetary
motion – Newton's deductions from Kepler's Laws – correction of Kepler's third law –
determination of mass of earth – determination of mass of planets with respect to earth – Brief
description of Asteroids – Satellites and Comets.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion of this course, the student will be able to
CO1:Obtain a broad, basic knowledge of the space sciences.
CO2:Explain the scientific concepts such as evolution by means of natural selection, age of the
Earth and solar system and the Big-Bang.
CO3:Describe the main features and formation theories of the various types of observed galaxies,
in particular the Milky Way.
CO4:Explain stellar evolution, including red giants, supernovas, neutron stars, pulsars, white
dwarfs and black holes, using evidence and presently accepted theories;

193
CO5:Describe the presently accepted formation theories of the solar system based upon
observational and physical constraints;
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Hess W., “Introduction to Space Science”, Gordon & Breach Science Pub; Revised Ed.,
1968.
2. Krishnaswami K. S., “Astrophysics: A modern Perspective”, New Age International, 2006.

REFERENCES:
1. Arnab Rai Choudhuri, “Astrophysics for Physicists”, Cambridge University Press, New
York, 2010.
2. Krishnaswami K. S., “Understanding cosmic Panorama”, New Age International, 2008.

OIE351 INTRODUCTION TO INDUSTRIAL ENGINEERING LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The objective of this course is to provide foundation in Industrial Engineering in order to enable the
students to make significant contributions for improvements in diverse organizations.
 Explain the concepts productivity and productivity measurement approaches.
 Explain the basic principles in facilities planning and plant location.
 Apply work study and ergonomic principles to design workplaces for the improvement of
human performance
 Impart knowledge to design and implement Statistical Process control in any industry.
 Recognize the concept of Production and Operations Management in creating and
enhancing a firm’s competitive advantages

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Concepts of Industrial Engineering – History and development of Industrial Engineering – Roles of
Industrial Engineer – Applications of Industrial Engineering – Production Management Vs
Industrial Engineering – Production System – Input Output Model – Productivity – Factors affecting
Productivity – Increasing Productivity of resources – Kinds of Productivity measures.

UNIT II PLANT LOCATION AND LAYOUT 9


Factors affecting Plant location – COURSE OBJECTIVES of Plant Layout – Principles of Plant
Layout – Types of Plant Layout – Methods of Plant and Facility Layout – Storage Space
requirements – Plant Layout procedure – Line Balancing methods.

UNIT III WORK SYSTEM DESIGN& ERGONOMICS 9


Need – COURSE OBJECTIVES – Method Study procedure – Principles of Motion Economy –
Work
Measurement procedures – Time Study –Work sampling- Ergonomics and its areas of application
in the work system - Physical work load and energy expenditure, Anthropometry – measures –
design procedure, Work postures-sitting, standing.

UNIT IV STATISTICAL QUALITY CONTROL 9


Definition and Concepts – Fundamentals – Control Charts for variables – Control Charts for
attributes – Acceptance Sampling- O.C curve –Single sampling plan- Double sampling plan.

194
UNIT V PRODUCTION PLANNING AND CONTROL 9
Forecasting – Qualitative and Quantitative forecasting techniques – Types of production – Process
planning – Economic Batch Quantity– Loading – Scheduling and control of production –
Dispatching–Progress control.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, Students will be able to
CO1: Ability To define the concepts of productivity and productivity measurement approaches.
CO2: Ability to evaluate appropriate location models for various facility types and design various
facility layouts
CO3: Ability To conduct a method study and time study to improve the efficiency of the system.
CO4: Ability to Control the quality of processes using control charts in manufacturing/service
industries.
CO5: Ability to define the Planning strategies and Material Requirement Plan.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 1 1
2 2 2 3 2
3 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 2
4 2 2 3 1 1
5 1 2 2 1 3
AVg. 2.2 2 2.5 1.3 1 2 1 1 2 1 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

TEXT BOOK:
1. O.P.Khanna, 2010, Industrial Engineering and Management, Dhanpat Rai Publications.

REFERENCES:
1. Ravi Shankar, 2009, Industrial Engineering and Management, Galgotia Publications & Private
Limited.
2. Martand Telsang,2006, Industrial Engineering and Production Management, S. Chand and
Company

OBT351 FOOD, NUTRITION AND HEALTH LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:

 Build knowledge and an overview on general aspects of nutrition and health.


 Distinguish the nutritive value of various food items, BMI calculation differentiating super
junk, and functional foods in the market.
 To Solve the real-world problems based on nutrition and health

195
UNIT I FOOD AND MICROBIOLOGY OF HEALTH: 9

Food resources (plant, animal, microbes); Overview of current production systems; constraints and
necessity of novel strategies. Functional and “Super” Foods - role in optimal nutrition. Sugar,
protein and fat substitutes. Food and behaviour- physiological disturbances in alcoholism, drug
abuse and smoking. Food Related Laws: Inspection – Microbial Indicators of product quality –
Indicators of food safety – 229 Microbiological safety of foods - control strategies – Hazard
Analysis Critical Point System (HACCP concept)- Microbiological criteria.

UNIT II NUTRIENTS AND FOOD ADDITIVES: 9

Macro nutrients- carbohydrates, proteins and lipids. Micronutrients-Minerals: Calcium, Magnesium,


Iron, Zinc, Copper and Selenium; Vitamins. Nutritional Physiology: Digestion, absorption, and
utilization of major and minor nutrients. Biotechnology of food additives- Bioflavors and colors,
microbial polysaccharides, recombinant enzymes in food sector.

UNIT III NANO FOOD TECHNOLOGY: 9

Nano materials as food components, food packaging and nano materials, policies on usage of
nanomaterials in foods. Food product development: steps involved in food product development,
shelf-life assessment.

UNIT IV FOOD RELATED NUTRITIONAL DISORDERS AND ENERGY CALCULATION:


9

Type I Disorders-Causes of life style and stress related diseases. Cardio-vascular diseases,
hypertension, obesity. Type-II Disorders: Cancer, diabetics, ulcers, electrolyte and water
imbalance. Health indices. Preventive and remedial measures. Energy balance and methods to
calculate individual nutrient and energy needs. Planning a healthy diet.

UNIT V CONSUMERS ON GM FOODS AND CONTEMPORARY ISSUES: 9

Global perspective of consumers on GM foods; Major concerns of transgenic, foods GM


ingredients in food products. (labeling, bioavailability, safety aspects); regulatory agencies involved
in GM foods, Case studies- GM foods.

TOTAL:45 PERIODS

TEXT BOOK(S):

1. P.J. Fellows.2009. Food Processing Technology -Principles and Practice (Third Edition). A
volume in Woodhead Publishing Series in Food Science, Technology and Nutrition.
2. Kalidas Shetty, Gopinadhan Paliyath, Anthony Pometto, Robert E. Levin. 2015. Food
Biotechnology. CRC Press. Second edition.

REFERENCE BOOKS:

1. Understanding Nutrition. 2010. Ellie Whitney, Sharon Rady Rolfes, 11e. Thompson
Wadsworth. 2.
2. Nutritional Sciences- From Fundamentals to Food.2013. Michelle McGuire, Kathy A.
Beerman, 2 nd e. Thompson Wadsworth.
3. Yasmine Motarjemi, Huub Lelieveld, Food Safety Management - A Practical Guide for the
Food Industry (2014), 1st Edition, Academic Press, London, UK

196
EXPECTED COURSE OUTCOME:

1.To be able to understand the nutritional values of the various types of foods

2.To be able to Analyze the role of food in the metabolic activity of the healthy diet

3. To be able to Infer the BMI calculation and stress related diseases.

4. To be able to Elaborate the independent decision on the choice of food to prevent life style
disorders and diseases

5. To be able to Assess about the food laws governance

6. To be able to Compare junk, modified and super foods

OCE351 ENVIRONMENTAL AND SOCIAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT L T PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To impart the knowledge and skills to identify, assess and mitigate the environmental and
social impacts of developmental projects

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Impacts of Development on Environment – Rio Principles of Sustainable Development-
Environmental Impact Assessment (EIA) – Objectives – Historical development – EIA Types – EIA
in project cycle –EIA Notification and Legal Framework–Stakeholders and their Role in EIA–
Selection & Registration Criteria for EIA Consultants

UNIT II ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT 9


Screening and Scoping in EIA – Drafting of Terms of Reference,Baseline monitoring, Prediction
and Assessment of Impact on land, water, air, noise and energy, flora and fauna - Matrices –
Networks – Checklist Methods - Mathematical models for Impact prediction – Analysis of
alternatives

UNIT III ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT PLAN 9


Plan for mitigation of adverse impact on water, air and land, water, energy, flora and fauna –
Environmental Monitoring Plan – EIA Report Preparation – Review of EIA Reports – Public
Hearing-Environmental Clearance Post Project Monitoring

UNIT IV SOCIO ECONOMIC ASSESSMENT 9


Baseline monitoring of Socio economic environment – Identification of Project Affected Personal –
Rehabilitation and Resettlement Plan- Economic valuation of Environmental impacts – Cost
benefit Analysis-

UNIT V CASE STUDIES 9


EIA case studies pertaining to Infrastructure Projects – Real Estate Development - Roads and
Bridges – Mass Rapid Transport Systems - Ports and Harbor – Airports - Dams and Irrigation
projects - Power plants – CETPs- Waste Processing and Disposal facilities – Mining Projects.

TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

197
COURSE OUTCOMES:
The students completing the course will have ability to
CO1:carry out scoping and screening of developmental projects for environmental and social
assessments
CO2:explain different methodologies for environmental impact prediction and assessment
CO3:plan environmental impact assessments and environmental management plans
CO4:evaluate environmental impact assessment reports

TEXTBOOKS:
1. Canter, R.L, “Environmental impact Assessment “, 2nd Edition, McGraw Hill Inc, New
Delhi,1995.
2. Lohani, B., J.W. Evans, H. Ludwig, R.R. Everitt, Richard A. Carpenter, and S.L. Tu,
“Environmental Impact Assessment for Developing Countries in Asia”, Volume 1 –
Overview, Asian Development Bank,1997.
3. Peter Morris, Riki Therivel “Methods of Environmental Impact Assessment”, Routledge
Publishers,2009.

REFERENCES:
1. Becker H. A., Frank Vanclay,“The International handbook of social impact assessment”
conceptual and methodological advances, Edward Elgar Publishing, 2003.
2. Barry Sadler and Mary McCabe, “Environmental Impact Assessment Training Resource
Manual”, United Nations Environment Programme, 2002.
3. Judith Petts, “Handbook of Environmental Impact Assessment Vol. I and II”, Blackwell
Science New York, 1998.
4. Ministry of Environment and Forests EIA Notification and Sectoral Guides, Government of
India, New Delhi, 2010.

OEE351 RENEWABLE ENERGY SYSTEM LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To Provide knowledge about various renewable energy technologies
 To enable students to understand and design a PV system.
 To provide knowledge about wind energy system.
 To Provide knowledge about various possible hybrid energy systems
 To gain knowledge about application of various renewable energy technologies

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Primary energy sources, renewable vs. non-renewable primary energy sources, renewable energy
resources in India, Current usage of renewable energy sources in India, future potential of
renewable energy in power production and development of renewable energy technologies.

UNIT II SOLAR ENERGY 9


Solar Radiation and its measurements, Solar Thermal Energy Conversion from plate Solar
Collectors, Concentrating Collectors and its Types, Efficiency and performance of collectors,.
Direct Solar Electricity Conversion from Photovoltaic, types of solar cells and its application of

198
battery charger, domestic lighting, street lighting, and water pumping, power generation schemes.
Recent Advances in PV Applications: Building Integrated PV, Grid Connected PV Systems,

UNIT III WIND ENERGY 9


Wind energy principles, wind site and its resource assessment, wind assessment, Factors
influencing wind, wind turbine components, wind energy conversion systems (WECS),
Classification of WECS devices, wind electric generating and control systems, characteristics and
applications.

UNIT IV BIO-ENERGY 9
Energy from biomass, Principle of biomass conversion technologies/process and their
classification, Bio gas generation, types of biogas plants, selection of site for biogas plant,
classification of biogas plants, Advantage and disadvantages of biogas generation, thermal
gasification of biomass, biomass gasifies, Application of biomass and biogas plants and their
economics.

UNIT V OTHER TYPES OF ENERGY 9


Energy conversion from Hydrogen and Fuel cells, Geo thermal energy Resources, types of wells,
methods of harnessing the energy, potential in India. OTEC, Principles utilization, setting of OTEC
plants, thermodynamic cycles. Tidal and wave energy: Potential and conversion techniques, mini-
hydel power plants and their economics.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course students will be able to:
CO1: Attained knowledge about various renewable energy technologies
CO2: Ability to understand and design a PV system.
CO3: Understand the concept of various wind energy system.
CO4: Gained knowledge about various possible hybrid energy systems
CO5: Attained knowledge about various application of renewable energy technologies
REFERENCES
1. Twidell & Wier,‘Renewable Energy Resources’ CRC Press( Taylor & Francis).
2. Tiwari and Ghosal/ Narosa,‘Renewable energy resources’.
3. D.P.Kothari, K.C.Singhal,‘Renewable energy sources and emerging technologies’, P.H.I.
4. D.S.Chauhan, S.K. Srivastava, ‘Non – Conventional Energy Resources’, New Age
Publishers, 2006.
5. B.H.Khan, ‘Non – Conventional Energy Resources’, Tata Mc Graw Hill, 2006.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
CO1 3 - - - - - - - - - - 2 3 3 3
CO2 3 2 - - - - - - - - - 2 3 3 3
CO3 3 2 - - - - - - - - - 2 3 3 3
CO4 3 2 - - - - - - - - - 2 3 3 3
CO5 3 2 - - - - - - - - - 2 3 3 3
AVg. 3 2 - - - - - - - - - 2 3 3 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

199
OEI351 INTRODUCTION TO INDUSTRIAL INSTRUMENTATION AND CONTROL
LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce common unit operations carried out in process industries.
 To impact knowledge about the important unit operations taking place in process
industries.
 To prepare them to take up a case study on selected process industries like petrochemical
industry, power plant industry and paper & pulp industry to make the students understand
the different measurement and control techniques for important processes.
 Facilitate the students to apply knowledge to select appropriate measurement technique
and control strategy for a given process.

UNIT I COMMON UNIT OPERATIONS IN PROCESS INDUSTRIES -I 9


Unit Operation, Measurement and Control:-Transport of solid, liquid and gases - Evaporators –
Crystallizers-Dryers.

UNIT II COMMON UNIT OPERATIONS IN PROCESS INDUSTRIES -II 9


Unit Operation, Measurement and Control: - Distillation – Refrigeration processes – Chemical
reactors.

UNIT III PROCESS MEASUREMENT AND CONTROL IN PETROCHEMICAL


INDUSTRY 9
Process flow diagram of Petro Chemical Industry - Gas oil separation in production platform – wet
gas processing – Fractionation Column – Catalytic Cracking unit – Catalytic reforming unit

UNIT IV PROCESS MEASUREMENT AND CONTROL IN THERMAL POWER PLANT


INDUSTRY 9
Process flow diagram of Coal fired thermal Power Plant– Coal pulverizer - Deaerator – Boiler drum
- Superheater – Turbines.

UNIT V PROCESS MEASUREMENT AND CONTROL IN PAPER & PULP INDUSTRY


9
Process flow diagram of paper and pulp industry – Batch digestor – Continuous sulphatedigestor –
Control problems on the paper machine.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

SKILL DEVELOPMENT ACTIVITIES (Group Seminar/Mini Project/Assignment/Content


Preparation / Quiz/ Surprise Test / Solving GATE questions/ etc) 5
Study the characteristics of various processing units involved in chemical plant.
Develop the process model by using predefined unit operations (e.g. mixing, distillation, heating)
from the library of any process simulator.
Analyse the functioning of each processing units with help of virtual unit operations packages.
Perform a physical property analysis using simulation packages
Implement distillation column analysis using simulation software.
Create process flow models and diagrams

200
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students able to
CO1 understand common unit operations in process industries. L2
CO2 Identify the dynamics of important unit operations in petro chemical industry. L2
CO3 develop understanding of important processes taking place selected case studies namely
petrochemical industry, power plant industry and paper & pulp industry. L5
CO4 Select appropriate measurement techniques for selective processes. L5
CO5 Develop controller structure based on the process knowledge. L5
CO6 Analyze the operation and challenges in integrated industrial processes. L4

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Balchen ,J.G., and Mumme, K.J., “ Process Control structures and applications”, Van
Nostrand Reinhold Co., New York, 1988
2. Warren L. McCabe, Julian C. Smith and Peter Harriot, “Unit Operations of Chemical
Engineering”, McGraw-Hill International Edition, New York, Sixth Edition, 2001.
REFERENCES:
1. Liptak B.G., “Instrument and Automation Engineers' Handbook: Process Measurement and
Analysis”, Fifth Edition, CRC Press, 2016.
2. James R.couper, Roy Penny, W., James R.Fair and Stanley M.Walas, “Chemical
ProcessEquipment: Selection and Design”, Gulf Professional Publishing, 2010.
3. Austin G.T and Shreeves, A.G.T., “Chemical Process Industries”, McGraw–Hill
International student, Singapore, 1985.
4. Luyben W.C., “Process Modeling, Simulation and Control for Chemical Engineers”,
McGraw-Hill International edition, USA, 1989.
5. K. Krishnaswamy, Process Control, new age publishers , 2009.
List of Open Source Software/ Learning website:
1. https://www.aspentech.com/en
2. http://avtechscientific.com/
3. https://www.chemstations.com/CHEMCAD/
4. https://www.prosim.net/en/product/prosimplus-steady-state-simulation-and-optimization-
of-processes/
5. https://www.cocosimulator.org/
6. https://dwsim.fossee.in/

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

PO,PSO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PSO PSO PSO


CO 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 3 3 1 1 1

CO2 3 3 1 1 1 2 2

CO3 3 3 1 1 1

CO4 3 3 1 3 3 1 1 3 3

CO5 3 3 3 3 1 1 3 3 3

201
CO6 3 3 2 3 2 1 2 1 2 1 1 2
2.3
Avg 3 3 1.5 3 2.5 2 2 1 1.16 1.5 1 3 3
3

1- low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMA351 GRAPH THEORY LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To understand the graph models and basic concepts of graphs.
 To study the characterization and properties of trees and graph connectivity.
 To provide an exposure to the Eulerian and Hamiltonian graphs.
 To introduce Graph colouring and explain its significance.
 To provide an understanding of Optimization Graph Algorithms.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO GRAPHS 9


Graphs and Graph Models – Connected graphs – Common classes of graphs – Multi graphs and
Digraphs – Degree of a vertex – Degree Sequence – Graphs and Matrices – Isomorphism of
graphs.

UNIT II TREES AND CONNECTIVITY 9


Bridges – Trees – Characterization and properties of trees – Cut vertices – Connectivity.

UNIT III TRAVERSABILITY 9


Eulerian graphs – Characterization of Eulerian graphs – Hamiltonian graphs – Necessary condition
for Hamiltonian graphs – Sufficient condition for Hamiltonian graphs.

UNIT IV PLANARITY AND COLOURING 9


Planar Graphs – The Euler Identity – Non planar Graphs – Vertex Colouring – Lower and Upper
bounds of chromatic number.

UNIT V OPTIMIZATION GRAPH ALGORITHMS 9

Dijkstra’s shortest path algorithm – Kruskal’s and Prim’s minimum spanning tree algorithms –
Transport Network – The Max-Flow Min-Cut Theorem – The Labeling Procedure – Maximum flow
problem.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
At the end of this course, the student will be able to
CO1:Apply graph models for solving real world problem.
CO2:Understand the importance the natural applications of trees and graph connectivity.
CO3:Understand the characterization study of Eulerian graphs and Hamiltonian graphs.
202
CO4:Apply the graph colouring concepts in partitioning problems.
CO5:Apply the standard optimization graph algorithms in solving application problems.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Gary Chatrand and Ping Zhang, “Introduction to Graph Theory”, Tata McGraw – Hill
companies Inc., New York, 2006.
2. Ralph P. Grimaldi, “Discrete and Combinatorial Mathematics, An applied introduction" Fifth
edition, Pearson Education, Inc, Singapore, 2004.

REFERENCES
1. Balakrishnan R. and Ranganathan K., “A Text Book of Graph Theory”,
Springer – Verlag, New York, 2012.
2. Douglas B. West, “Introduction to Graph Theory”, Pearson, Second Edition, New York,
2018.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PO PO0 PO0 PO0 PO0 PO0 PO0 PO0 PO1 PO1 PO1 PS PS PS
01 02 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 3
CO2 2 2 2
CO3 2 2 2 2
CO4 2 2 2
CO5 3 2 2 3
CO6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OPEN ELECTIVE II

OIE352 RESOURCE MANAGEMENT TECHNIQUES LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Learn to formulate linear programming problems and solve LPP using simple algorithm
 Learn to solve networking problems
 Learn to formulate and solve integer programming problems
 Learn to solve Non Linear programming problems
 Learn to understand and solve project management problems

UNIT I LINEAR PROGRAMMING 9


Principal components of decision problem – Modeling phases – LP formulation and graphic
solution – Resource allocation problems – simplex method – sensitivity analysis.

UNIT II DUALITY AND NETWORKS 9


Definition of dual problems – primal – Dual relationships – Dual simplex method –post optimality
analysis – Transportation and assignment model – Shortest route problem.

203
UNIT III INTEGER PROGRAMMING 9
Cutting plan algorithm – Branch and bound methods, Multistage (Dynamic) programming.

UNIT IV CLASSICAL OPTIMISATION THEROY: 9


Unconstrained external problems, Newton – Ralphson method – Equality constraints –Jacobean
methods – Lagrangian method – Kuhn – Tucker conditions – Simple problems.

UNIT V OBJECT SCHEDULOING: 9


Network diagram representation – Critical path method – Time charts and resource leveling –
PERT.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon Completion of the course, the students should be able to:
CO1 : Understand to formulate linear programming problems and solve LPP using simple
algorithm
CO2 : Understand to solve networking problems
CO3 : Understand to formulate and solve integer programming problems
CO4 : Understand to solve Non Linear programming problems
CO5 : Understand to understand and solve project management problems

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 2 3 2 3
2 3 3 2 3 2 3
3 3 3 2 3 2 3
4 3 3 2 3 2 3
5 3 3 2 3 2 3
AVg. 3 3 2 3 2 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

TEXT BOOK:
1. H.A. Taha, “Operation Research”, Prentice Hall of India, 2002.

RFERENCES:
1. Paneer selvam, ‘Operations Research’ Prentice Hall of India, 2002.
2. Anderson ‘Quantitative Methods for Business’, 8th Edition, Thomson Learning, 2002.
3. Winston ‘Operations Research for Business’, Thomson Learning, 2003.
4. Vohra, ’Quantitative Techniques in Management’, Tata Mc Graw Hill, 2002.
5. Anand sarma, ‘Operation Research’ Himalaya Publishing House, 2003.

OMG351 FINTECH REGULATION LT PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn about Laws and Regulation

204
 To acquire the knowledge of Regulations of Fintech firm and their role in Market

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
The Role of the Regulators, Equal Treatment and Competition, Need for a regulatory assessment
of Fintech, India Regulations, The Risks to Consider, Regtech and SupTech, The rise of TechFins,
Regulatory sandboxes, compliance and whistleblowing.

UNIT II INNOVATION AND REGULATION 9


The technology, market and the law, Regulation and Innovation in Banking and Finance,
Regulations of Fintech Firms and their role in Market-Based Chains, Current Regulatory Approach,
Fintech Innovations in Banking, Asset Management, Insurance, Pensions and Healthcare
Schemes, Patentability of FinTech inventions.

UNIT III CROWDFUNDING AND DIGITAL ASSETS 9


Types of crowdfunding, The Jobs Act, Regulation crowdfunding, Regulation A+, Regulation D
crowdfunding, Intrastate offerings, Digital Assets – Three uses of Digital Assets, A world of
Altcoins, Stablecoins, Digital Asset Forks, Initial Coin Offerings, Regulatory Framework for Digital
and Crypto Assets, Central Bank Digital Currencies.

UNIT IV MARKETPLACE LENDING AND MOBILE PAYMENTS 9


Online Lending Business Models, Payday Loans, Consumer Protection Laws, Debt Collection,
Equal Credit Opportunity Act, Contract Formation and the E-Sign Act, Military Lending Act,
Securities Laws Considerations, Mobile Devices, Payment Cards and the Law, Truth in Lending
Act and Regulation Z, Card Act, Electronic Fund Transfer Act and Regulation E, Fair Credit
Reporting Act, Federal Bank Secrecy Act, State Money Transmitter Laws.

UNIT V ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND CYBERSECURITY 9


Reporting requirements under the Bank Secrecy Act, Patriot Act, Panalties for violating the BSA,
Virtual currencies and the Bank Secrecy Act, Cybersecurity Frameworks, Cybersecurity Act of
2015, Contractual and Self Regulatory obligations.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
REFERENCES
1. JelenaMadir, FinTech – Law and Regulation, Edward Elgar Publishing Limited, 2019
2. Valerio Lemma, Fintech Regulation : Exploring New Challenges of the Capital Markets
Union, Palgrave Macmillan, 2020
3. Chris Brummer, Fintech Law in a Nutshell, West Academic Publishing, 2020
4. Bernardo Nicoletti, The Future of Fintech, Integrating Finance and Technology in Financial
Services, Springer Nature, 2017
5. Kevin C. Taylor, FinTech Law : A Guide to Technology Law in the Financial Services
Industry, BNA Books, 2014
6. Lee Reiners, FinTech Law and Policy, 2018

205
OFD351 HOLISTIC NUTRITION L T PC
3 0 0 3
UNIT I NUTRITION AND HEALTH 9
Introduction to the principles of nutrition; Basics of nutrition including; micronutrients (vitamins and
minerals), the energy-yielding nutrients (Carbohydrates, Lipids and Proteins), metabolism,
digestion, absorption and energy balance. Lipids: their functions, classification, dietary
requirements, digestion & absorption, metabolism and links to the major fatal diseases, heart
disease and cancer.

UNIT II AYURVEDA – MIND/BODY HEALING 9


Philosophy of Holistic Nutrition with spiritual and psychological approaches towards attaining
optimal health; Principles and practical applications of Ayurveda, the oldest healing system in the
world. Three forces – Vata, Pitta and Kapha, that combine in each being into a distinct constitution.
Practical dietary and lifestyle recommendations for different constitutions will also be explored in
real case studies.

UNIT III NUTRITION AND ENVIRONMENT 9


Based on an underlying philosophy that environments maintain and promote health and that
individuals have a right to self-determination and self-knowledge, Nutrition principles which
promote health and prevent disease. Safety of our food supply, naturally occurring and
environmental toxins in foods, microbes and food poisoning.

UNIT IV COMPARATIVE DIETS 9


Evaluating principles of food dynamics, nutrient proportions, holistic individuality, the law of
opposites, food combining, and more. Therapeutic benefits and limitations of several alternative
diet approaches, including: modern diets (intermittent fasting, macrobiotics), food combining
(colour-therapy/rainbow diet), high protein diets (Ketogenic, Paleo), Vegetarian approaches (plant-
based/vegetarian/vegan variations, fruitarian, raw food), as well as cleansing and detoxification
diets (caffeine, alcohol, and nicotine detoxes, juice fasts).

UNIT V PREVENTIVE HEALTH CARE 9


Proper nutrition protection against, reverse and/or retard many ailments including: osteoporosis,
diabetes, atherosclerosis and high blood pressure, arthritis, cancer, anemia, kidney disease and
colon cancer. Current research developments on phytochemicals, antioxidants and nutraceuticals
will be explored.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1 Discuss the role of essential nutrients in physical, mental and emotional wellness
CO2 Discuss the role of deficiencies in essential nutrients in the disease process
CO3 Explain how the standard American diet relates to the disease process
CO4 Identify five contemporary eating “styles” and lists the pros and cons of each
CO5 Discuss the concept of whole foods nutrition and its relationship to wellness

TEXTBOOKS
1. Desai, B. B., Handbook of Nutrition and Diet. Marcel Dekker, New York. 2000
2. Macrae, R., Rolonson Roles and Sadlu, M.J. 1994. Encyclopedia of Food Science &
Technology & Nutrition. Vol. XI. Academic Press

206
REFERENCES
1. Modern Nutrition in Health & Disease by Young & Shils.
2. Food, Nutrition and Diet Therapy – by Krause and Mahan 1996, Publisher- W.B. Saunders,
ISBN: 0721658350
3. Nutritive Value of Indian Foods.- by C. Gopalan, B. V. Rama Sastri, S. C. Balasubramanian
Published by National Institute of Nutrition, Indian Council of Medical Research, 1989

AI3021 IT IN AGRICULTURAL SYSTEM L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the students to areas of agricultural systems in which IT and computers play a
major role.
 To also expose the students to IT applications in precision farming, environmental control
systems, agricultural systems management and weather prediction models.

UNIT I PRECISION FARMING 9


Precision agriculture and agricultural management – Ground based sensors, Remote sensing,
GPS, GIS and mapping software, Yield mapping systems, Crop production modeling.

UNIT II ENVIRONMENT CONTROL SYSTEMS 9


Artificial light systems, management of crop growth in greenhouses, simulation of CO 2
consumption in greenhouses, on-line measurement of plant growth in the greenhouse, models of
plant production and expert systems in horticulture.

UNIT III AGRICULTURAL SYSTEMS MANAGEMENT 9


Agricultural systems - managerial overview, Reliability of agricultural systems, Simulation of crop
growth and field operations, Optimizing the use of resources, Linear programming, Project
scheduling, Artificial intelligence and decision support systems.

UNIT IV WEATHER PREDICTION MODELS 9


Importance of climate variability and seasonal forecasting, Understanding and predicting world’s
climate system, Global climatic models and their potential for seasonal climate forecasting,
General systems approach to applying seasonal climate forecasts.

UNIT V E-GOVERNANCE IN AGRICULTURAL SYSTEMS 9


Expert systems, decision support systems, Agricultural and biological databases, e-commerce, e-
business systems & applications, Technology enhanced learning systems and solutions, e-
learning, Rural development and information society.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
TEXTBOOKS:
1. National Research Council, “Precision Agriculture in the 21st Century”, National Academies
Press, Canada, 1997.
2. H. Krug, Liebig, H.P. “International Symposium on Models for Plant Growth, Environmental
Control and Farm Management in Protected Cultivation”, 1989.

REFERENCES:
1. Peart, R.M., and Shoup, W. D., “Agricultural Systems Management”, Marcel Dekker, New
207
York, 2004.
2. Hammer, G.L., Nicholls, N., and Mitchell, C., “Applications of Seasonal Climate”, Springer,
Germany, 2000.

COURSE OUTCOME:
CO1:The students shall be able to understand the applications of IT in remote sensing
applications such as Drones etc.
CO2:The students will be able to get a clear understanding of how a greenhouse can be
automated and its advantages.
CO3:The students will be able to apply IT principles and concepts for management of field
operations.
CO4:The students will get an understanding about weather models, their inputs and applications.
CO5:The students will get an understanding of how IT can be used for e-governance in
agriculture.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

PO/PSO Course Outcome Overall


CO1 CO2 CO3 CO4 CO5 correlation of
CO s to POs
PO1 Knowledge of Engineering 2 3 2 3 2 2
Sciences
PO2 Problem Analysis 3 3 3 3 3 3
PO3 Design/ Development of 3 3 3 3 3 3
Solutions
PO4 Investigations 2 3 2 1 2 2
PO5 Modern Tool Usage 3 3 3 3 3 3
PO6 Individual and Team work 1 1 2 2 3 2
PO7 Communication 3 3 3 3 3 3
PO8 The Engineer and Society 3 3 2 3 3 3
PO9 Ethics 1 1 2 1 2 1
PO10 Environment and 3 3 3 3 3 3
Sustainability
PO11 Project Management and 3 3 3 3 3 3
Finance
PO12 Life Long Learning 3 3 3 3 3 3
PSO1 To make expertise in 1 1 2 2 3 2
design and engineering
problem solving approach
in agriculture with proper
knowledge and skill
PSO2 To enhance students 1 1 2 2 3 2
ability to formulate
solutions to real-world
problems pertaining to
sustained agricultural
productivity using modern

208
technologies.
PSO3 To inculcate 1 1 2 2 3 2
entrepreneurial skills
through strong Industry-
Institution linkage.
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OEI352 INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL ENGINEERING LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the control system components and transfer function model with their graphical
representation
 To understand the analysis of system in time domain along with steady state error.
 To introduce frequency response analysis of systems.
 To accord basic knowledge in design of compensators.
 To introduce the state space models.

UNIT I MATHEMATICAL MODELLING 9


Introduction – transfer function – simple electrical, mechanical, ,pneumatic , hydraulic and thermal
systems–analogies

UNIT II FEEDBACK CONTROL SYSTEMS 9


Control system components - Block diagram representation of control systems, Reduction of block
diagrams, Signal flow graphs, Output to input ratios

UNIT III TIME DOMAIN ANALYSIS 9


Response of systems to different inputs viz., Step impulse, pulse, parabolic and sinusoidal inputs,
Time response of first and second order systems, steady state errors and error constants of unity
feedback circuit.

UNIT IV STABILITY ANALYSIS 9


Necessary and sufficient conditions, Routh-Hurwitz criteria of stability,Rootlocus and
Bodetechniques,Concept and construction,frequency response.

UNIT V STATE SPACE TECHNIQUE 9


State vectors–state space models-Digital Controllers–design aspects.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
SKILL DEVELOPMENT ACTIVITIES (Group Seminar/Mini Project/Assignment/Content
Preparation / Quiz/ Surprise Test / Solving GATE questions/ etc) 5

1. Explore various controllers presently used in industries.


2. Develop control structures for industrial processes.
3. Implement the controllers for various transfer functions of industrial systems.
4. Using software tools for practical exposures to the controllers used in industries by undergoing
training.

209
5. Realisation of various stability criterion techniques for economical operation of process.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1 To represent and develop systems in different forms using the knowledge gained
(L5).
CO2 To analyses the system in time and frequency domain (L4).
CO3 Ability to Derive Transfer function Model of Electrical and Mechanical Systems. (L2)
CO4 Ability to Obtain the transfer Function by the Reduction of Block diagram & Signal flow
graph (L3)
CO5 To analyses the stability of physical systems(L4).
CO6 To acquire and analyse knowledge in State variable model for MIMO systems(L1)

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Nagarath, I.J. and Gopal, M., “Control Systems Engineering”, New Age International
Publishers,2017.
2. Benjamin C. Kuo, “Automatic Control Systems”, Wiley, 2014

REFERENCES:
1. Katsuhiko Ogata, “Modern Control Engineering”, Pearson, 2015.
2. Richard C. Dorf and Bishop, R.H., “Modern Control Systems”, Pearson Education,2009.
3. John J.D., Azzo Constantine, H. and HoupisSttuart, N Sheldon, “Linear Control System
Analysis and Design with MATLAB”, CRC Taylor& Francis Reprint 2009.
4. RamesC.Panda and T. Thyagarajan, “An Introduction to Process Modelling Identification and
Control of Engineers”, Narosa Publishing House, 2017.
5. M. Gopal, “Control System: Principle and design”, McGraw Hill Education, 2012.
6. NPTEL Video Lecture Notes on “Control Engineering “by Prof. S. D. Agashe, IIT Bombay.

List of Open Source Software/ Learning website:


1. https://nptel.ac.in/courses/112107240
2. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc20_me25/preview
3. https://onlinecourses.nptel.ac.in/noc20_ee90/preview
4. https://www.classcentral.com/course/swayam-automatic-control-9850

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO’s
1 L5 3 3 3 3 - - - 1 - 1 - 1
2 L4 3 3 3 2 - - - 1 - 1 - 1
3 L2 2 1 2 1 - - - 1 - 1 - 1
4 L5 3 3 3 3 - - - 1 - 1 - 1
5 L4 3 3 3 2 - - - 1 - 1 - 1
6 L4 3 3 3 2 - - - 1 - 1 - 1
AVg. 2.8 2.6 3 2.1 - - - 1 - 1 - 1
1-low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation
Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

210
OPY351 PHARMACEUTICAL NANOTECHNOLOGY LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 The goal of this course is to provide an insight into the fundamentals of nanotechnology in
biomedical and Pharmaceutical research. It will also guide the students to understand how
nanomaterials can be used for a diversity of analytical and medicinal rationales.

UNIT I NANOSTRUCTURES 9
Preparation, properties and characterization - Self-assembling nanostructure - vesicular and
micellar polymerization-nanofilms - Metal Nanoparticles- lipid nanoparticles- nanoemulsion -
Molecular nanomaterials: dendrimers, etc.,

UNIT II NANOTECHNOLOGY IN BIOMEDICAL INDUSTRY 9


Reconstructive Intervention and Surgery- Nanomaterials in bone substitutes and dentistry –
Implants and Prosthesis -in vivo imaging- genetic defects and other disease states ––
Nanorobotics in Surgery –Nanocarriers: sustained, controlled, targeted drug delivery systems.

UNIT III NANOTECHNOLOGY IN CANCER THERAPY 9


Cancer Cell Targeting and Detection- Polymeric Nanoparticles for cancer treatment – mechanism
of drug delivery to tumors -advantages and limitations - Multifunctional Agents - Cancer Imaging –
Magnetic Resonance Imaging- Cancer Immunotherapy.

UNIT IV NANOTECHNOLOGY IN COSMETICS 9


Polymers in cosmetics: Film Formers – Thickeners – Hair Colouring – Conditioning Polymers:
conditioning, Cleansing – Silicons – Emulsions – Stimuli Responsive Polymeric Systems -
Formulation of Nano Gels, Shampoos, Hair-conditioners -Micellar self-assembly Sun-screen
dispersions for UV protection – Color cosmetics.

UNIT V NANOTOXICITY 9
NanoToxicology- introduction, dose relationship- Hazard Classification-Risk assessment and
management - factors affecting nano toxicity- Dermal Effects of Nanomaterials, Pulmonary, Neuro
and Cardiovascular effects of Nanoparticles - Gene–Cellular and molecular Interactions of
Nanomaterials.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
The student will be able to
CO1:Identify the process for the preparation and characterization of the different nanostructured
materials.
CO2:Apply the nanotechnology in biomedical discipline with related to drug delivery and disease
diagnosis
CO3:Develop the process, experiments and apply in identifying in a societal and global context.
CO4:Design and develop the process with suitable equipment for the preparation of nanomaterials
in developing cosmetic products.
CO5:Understand the ethical principles to confirm the safety of the nano products with respect to
risk assessment and its management.
CO6:Have the knowledge about nanotechnology products and its different applications in a
societal and global context.

211
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Springer Handbook of Nanotechnology- Ed. by B. Bhushan, Springer-Verlag 2004
2. Nanobiotechnology: Concepts, Applications and Perspectives,. CM.Niemeyer C A. Mirkin,
(Eds) , Wiley, 2004
3. Nanotechnology: Health and Environmental Risks, Jo Anne Shatkin, Second Edition, CRC
Press, 2013
4. Sarah E. Morgan, Kathleen O. Havelka, Robert Y. Lochhead “Cosmetic Nanotechnology:
Polymers and Colloids in Cosmetics”, American Chemical Society, 2006.

REFERENCES:
1. Nanotechnology in Biology and Medicine: Methods, Devices and Applications, Tuan VoDinh,
CRC Press, 2007
2. The Chemistry of Nanomaterials: Synthesis, Properties and Applications, C.N.R. Rao, A.
Muller, A. K. Cheetham (Eds), Wiley-VCH Verlag 2004
3. Nanotechnology: Environmental Health and safety, Risks, Regulation and Management,
Matthew Hull and Diana Bowman, Elsevier, 2010.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


Course Outcome Programme Outcomes (PO) Programme
Statements Specific
Outcomes
(PSO)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
CO1 3 3 1 2 2 3 2
CO2 3 3 2 2 3 3
CO3 3 3 3 2 2 1 3 3
CO4 3 3 2 1 3
CO5 3 3 2 2 3 3
CO6 3 3 2 2 3 3 2
Overall CO 3 3 1 2 2 3 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation
(1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and
Substantial (High) respectively.)

OAE351 AVIATION MANAGEMENT L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To acquire solid background of managerial skills in aviation management
 To develop personality to face business difficulties.
 To control multicultural conditions.
 To identify the relevant analytical and logical skills to deal with problems in the airline
industry.
 To learn the concepts of performing well in teams, professionalism, an d the knowledge
acquired in the field of airport planning, airport security, passengers forecasting,
aerodromes work etc
212
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
History of aviation – organisation, global, social & ethical environment – history of Aviation in India
– major players in the airline industry - swot analysis of the different Airline companies in India –
market potential of airline industry in India – new airport Development plans – current challenges
in the airline industry - competition in the Airline industry – domestic and international from an
Indian perspective
UNIT II AIRPORT INFRASTRUCTURE AND MANAGEMENT 8
Airport planning – terminal planning design and operation – airport operations – Airport functions –
organisation structure in an airline - airport authority of India - Comparison of global and Indian
airport management – role of AAI -airline privatisation - full Privatisation - gradual privatisation –
partial privatization
UNIT III AIR TRANSPORT SERVICES 12
Various airport services - international air transport services – Indian scenario – an Overview of
airports in Delhi, Mumbai, Hyderabad and Bangalore – the role of private Operators – airport
development fees, rates, tariffs

UNIT IV INSTITUTIONAL FRAMEWORK 8


Role of DGCA - slot allocation – methodology followed by AFC and DGCA -management of
Bilaterals – economic regulations

UNIT V CONTROLLING 8
Role of air traffic control - airspace and navigational aids – control process – case
Studies in airline industry – Mumbai Delhi airport privatisation – Navi Mumbai airport
Tendering process – 6 cases in the airline industry
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Graham.A. Managing Airports: An International Perspective - Butterworth - Heinemann,
Oxford 2001.
2. Wells.A. Airport Planning and Management, 4th Edition McGraw- Hill, London 2000.

REFERENCES
1. Doganis. R. The Airport Business Routledge, London 1992
2. Alexender T. Wells, Seth Young, Principles of Airport Management, McGraw Hill 2003
3. P S Senguttavan Fundementals of Air Transport Management , Excel Books 2007
4. Richard de Neufille, Airport Systems: Planning, Design and Management, McGraw-Hill
London 2007.
5.. Manual of Aerodrome licensing of AAI airports – AAI website – freely downloadable – issue
may 2010

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:To interpret business difficulties.
CO2:To Dissect multicultural conditions.
CO3:To identify and apply the relevant analytical and logical skills to deal with problems in the
airline industry.
CO4:To Develop well in teams, professionalism etc.
CO5:To apply the knowledge acquired in the field of airport planning, airport security, passengers
forecasting, aerodromes work etc.

213
OPEN ELCTIVE III

OHS351 ENGLISH FOR COMPETITIVE EXAMINATIONS L T P C


3 0 0 3
Course Description:
Students aspiring to take up competitive exams of which the English language is a vital component
will find this course useful. Designed for students in the higher semesters, the course will help
students to familiarise themselves with those aspects of English that are tested in these
examinations.

COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To train the students in the language components essential to face competitive examinations
both at the national (UPSC, Banking, Railway, Defence) and the international level (GRE,
TOEFL, IELTS).
 To enhance an awareness of the specific patterns in language testing and the respective
skills to tackle verbal reasoning and verbal ability tests.
 To inculcate effective practices in language-learning in order to improve accuracy in usage of
grammar and coherence in writing.
 To improve students’ confidence to express their ideas and opinions in formal contexts
 To create awareness of accuracy and precision in communication

UNIT I 9
Orientation on different formats of competitive exams - Vocabulary – Verbal ability – Verbal
reasoning - Exploring the world of words – Essential words – Meaning and their usage –
Synonyms-antonyms – Word substitution – Word analogy – Idioms and phrases – Commonly
confused words – Spellings – Word expansion – New words in use.

UNIT II 9
Grammar – Sentence improvement –Sentence completion – Rearranging phrases into sentences
– Error identification –Tenses – Prepositions – Adjectives – Adverbs – Subject-verb agreement –
Voice – Reported speech – Articles – Clauses – Speech patterns.

UNIT III 9
Reading - Specific information and detail – Identifying main and supporting ideas – Speed reading
techniques – Improving global reading skills – Linking ideas – Summarising – Understanding
argument – Identifying opinion/attitude and making inferences - Critical reading.

UNIT IV 9
Writing – Pre-writing techniques – Mindmap - Describing pictures and facts - Paragraph structure –
organising points – Rhetoric writing – Improving an answer – Drafting, writing and developing an
argument – Focus on cohesion – Using cohesive devices –Analytic writing – Structure and types
of essay – Mind maps – Structure of drafts, letters, memos, emails – Statements of Purpose –
Structure, Content and Style.

UNIT V 9
Listening and Speaking – Contextual listening – Listening to instructions – Listening for specific
information – Identifying detail, main ideas – Following signpost words – Stress, rhythm and

214
intonation - Speaking to respond and elicit ideas – Guided speaking – Opening phrases –
Interactive communication – Dysfluency -Sentence stress – Speaking on a topic – Giving opinions
– Giving an oral presentation – Telling a story or a personal anecdote – Talking about oneself -
Utterance – Speech acts- Brainstorming ideas – Group discussion.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
LEARNING OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, learners will be able
 expand their vocabulary and gain practical techniques to read and comprehend a wide
range of texts with the emphasis required
 identify errors with precision and write with clarity and coherence
 understand the importance of task fulfilment and the usage of task-appropriate vocabulary
 communicate effectively in group discussions, presentations and interviews
 write topic based essays with precision and accuracy

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 1 3 1 3 - - -
2 2 3 3 2 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 - - -
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3 - - -
5 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 2 3 - - -
AVg. 2 2.6 2.6 2 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.6 2 3 2.4 3 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

Teaching Methods:
Instructional methods will involve discussions, taking mock tests on various question papers –
Objective, multiple-choice and descriptive. Peer evaluation, self-check on improvement and peer
feedback - Practice sessions on speaking assessments, interview and discussion – Using
multimedia.

Evaluative Pattern:
Internal Tests – 50%
End Semester Exam - 50%

TEXTBOOKS:
1. R.P.Bhatnagar - General English for Competitive Examinations. Macmillan India Limited,
2009.

REFERENCEBOOKS:
1. Educational Testing Service - The Official Guide to the GRE Revised General Test, Tata
McGraw Hill, 2010.
2. The Official Guide to the TOEFL Test, Tata McGraw Hill, 2010.
3. R Rajagopalan- General English for Competitive Examinations, McGraw Hill Education
(India) Private Limited, 2008.
215
Websites
http://www.examenglish.com/, http://www.ets.org/ , http://www.bankxams.com/
http://civilservicesmentor.com/, http://www.educationobserver.com
http://www.cambridgeenglish.org/in/

OMG352 NGOS AND SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 to understand the importance of sustainable development
 to acquire a reasonable knowledge on the legal frameworks pertaining to pollution control
and environmental management
 to comprehend the role of NGOs in attaining sustainable development

Unit I ENVIRONMENTAL CONCERNS 9


Introduction to sustainable development goals, Global responsibility of environmental concern,
Importance of environmental preservation, Environmental threats, Pollution and its types, Effects
of Pollution, Pollution control, Treatment of wastes

UNIT II ROLE OF NGOS 9


Role of NGO’s in national development, NGO’s and participatory management, Challenges and
limitations of NGO’s, Community Development programmes, Role of NGO’s in Community
Development programmes, Participation of NGO’s in environment management, Corporate Social
responsibility, NGO’s and corporate social responsibility

UNIT III SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT 9


Issues and Challenges of Sustainable Development, Bioenergy, Sustainable Livelihoods and Rural
Poor in Sustainable Development, Protecting ecosystem services for sustainable development,
Non-renewable sources of energy and its effect, Renewable sources of energy for sustainability,
Nuclear resources and Legal Regulation of Hazardous Substances, Sustainable Development:
Programme and Policies, Sustainability assessment and Indicators

UNIT IV NGO’S FOR SUSTAINABILITY 9


Civil Society Initiatives in Environment Management, Civil Society Initiatives for Sustainable
Development, Global Initiatives in Protecting Global Environment, World Summit on Sustainable
Development (Johannesburg Summit 2002), Ecological economics, Environmental sustainability,
Social inclusion, Health for all, education for all, Food security and Water security, NGOs and
Sustainable Development strategies

UNIT V LEGAL FRAMEWORKS 9


Need for a Legal framework and its enforcement, Legal measures to control pollution,
Environmental Legislations in India, Mechanism to implement Environmental Laws in India, Legal
Protection of Forests Act 1927, Legal Protection of Wild Life, Role of NGO’s in implementing
environmental laws, Challenges in the implementation of environmental legislation
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon completion of this course, the student will :
216
CO1 Have a thorough grounding on the issues and challenges being faced in attaining
sustainable development
CO2 have a knowledge on the role of NGOs towards sustainable developemnt
CO3 present strategies for NGOs in attaining sustainable development
CO4 recognize the importance of providing energy, food security and health equity to all members
of the society without damaging the environment
CO5 understand the environmental legislations

REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Kulsange, S and Kamble, R. (2019). Environmental NGO’s: Sustainability Stewardship, Lap
Lambert Academic Publishing, India, ISBN-13: 978-6200442444.
2. Dodds, F. (2007). NGO diplomacy: The influence of nongovernmental organizations in
international environmental negotiations. Mit Press, Cambridge, ISBN-13: 978-0262524766.
3. Ghosh, S. (Ed.). (2019). Indian environmental law: Key concepts and principles. Orient
BlackSwan, India, ISBN-13: 978-9352875795.
4. Alan Fowler and Chiku Malunga (2010) NGO Management: The Earthscan Companion,
Routledge, ISBN-13 : 978-1849711197.

OMG353 DEMOCRACY AND GOOD GOVERNANCE L T P C


3 0 0 3
UNIT I (9)
Structure and Process of Governance: Indian Model of Democracy, Parliament, Party Politics and
Electoral Behaviour, Federalism, the Supreme Court and Judicial Activism, Units of Local
Governance

UNIT II (9)
Regulatory Institutions – SEBI, TRAI, Competition Commission of India,

UNIT III (9)


Lobbying Institutions: Chambers of Commerce and Industries, Trade Unions, Farmers
Associations, etc.

UNIT IV (9)
Contemporary Political Economy of Development in India: Policy Debates over Models of
Development in India, Recent trends of Liberalisation of Indian Economy in different sectors, E‐
governance

UNIT V (9)
Dynamics of Civil Society: New Social Movements, Role of NGO’s, Understanding the political
significance of Media and Popular Culture.
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Atul Kohli (ed.): The Success of India’s Democracy, Cambridge University Press, 2001.
2. Corbridge, Stuart and John Harris: Reinventing India: Liberalisation, Hindu Nationalism and
Popular Democracy, Oxford University Press, 2000.
3. J.Dreze and A.Sen, India: Economic Development and Social Opportunity, Clarendon, 1995.
4. Saima Saeed: Screening the Public Sphere: Media and Democracy in India,2013
217
5. Himat Singh: Green Revolution Reconsidered: The Rural World of Punjab, OUP, 2001.
6. Jagdish Bhagwati: India in Transition: Freeing The Economy, 1993.
7. Smitu Kothari: Social Movements and the Redefinition of Democracy, Boulder, Westview, 1993.

CME365 RENEWABLE ENERGY TECHNOLOGIES L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To know the Indian and global energy scenario
 To learn the various solar energy technologies and its applications.
 To educate the various wind energy technologies.
 To explore the various bio-energy technologies.
 To study the ocean and geothermal technologies.

UNIT I ENERGY SCENARIO 9


Indian energy scenario in various sectors – domestic, industrial, commercial, agriculture,
transportation and others – Present conventional energy status – Present renewable energy
status-Potential of various renewable energy sources-Global energy status-Per capita energy
consumption - Future energy plans

UNIT II SOLAR ENERGY 9


Solar radiation – Measurements of solar radiation and sunshine – Solar spectrum - Solar thermal
collectors – Flat plate and concentrating collectors – Solar thermal applications – Solar thermal
energy storage – Fundamentals of solar photo voltaic conversion – Solar cells – Solar PV Systems
– Solar PV applications.

UNIT III WIND ENERGY 9


Wind data and energy estimation – Betz limit - Site selection for windfarms – characteristics - Wind
resource assessment - Horizontal axis wind turbine – components - Vertical axis wind turbine –
Wind turbine generators and its performance – Hybrid systems – Environmental issues -
Applications.

UNIT IV BIO-ENERGY 9
Bio resources – Biomass direct combustion – thermochemical conversion - biochemical
conversion-mechanical conversion - Biomass gasifier - Types of biomass gasifiers - Cogeneration
–- Carbonisation – Pyrolysis - Biogas plants – Digesters –Biodiesel production – Ethanol
production - Applications.

UNIT V OCEAN AND GEOTHERMAL ENERGY 9


Small hydro - Tidal energy – Wave energy – Open and closed OTEC Cycles – Limitations –
Geothermal energy – Geothermal energy sources - Types of geothermal power plants –
Applications - Environmental impact.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course the students would be able to
 Discuss the Indian and global energy scenario.
 Describe the various solar energy technologies and its applications.
 Explain the various wind energy technologies.
218
 Explore the various bio-energy technologies.
 Discuss the ocean and geothermal technologies.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Fundamentals and Applications of Renewable Energy | Indian Edition, by Mehmet
Kanoglu, Yunus A. Cengel, John M. Cimbala, cGraw Hill; First edition (10 December
2020), ISBN-10 : 9390385636
2. Renewable Energy Sources and Emerging Technologies, by Kothari, Prentice Hall India
Learning Private Limited; 2nd edition (1 January 2011), ISBN-10 : 8120344707

REFERENCES:
1. Godfrey Boyle, “Renewable Energy, Power for a Sustainable Future”, Oxford University
Press, U.K., 2012.
2. Rai.G.D., “Non-Conventional Energy Sources”, Khanna Publishers, New Delhi, 2014.
3. Sukhatme.S.P., “Solar Energy: Principles of Thermal Collection and Storage”, Tata
McGraw Hill Publishing Company Ltd., New Delhi, 2009.
4. Tiwari G.N., “Solar Energy – Fundamentals Design, Modelling and applications”, Alpha
Science Intl Ltd, 2015.
5. Twidell, J.W. & Weir A., “Renewable Energy Resources”, EFNSpon Ltd., UK, 2015.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 2 2 1 1 3 2 1 2
2 3 2 2 1 1 1 3 1 1 1 2 3 2 1 2
3 3 2 3 1 2 1 3 1 1 1 1 3 1 1 2
4 2 2 2 1 2 1 3 1 1 1 2 3 2 2 2
5 2 1 2 1 2 1 3 1 1 1 1 3 2 1 2
Low (1) ; Medium (2) ; High (3)
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OME354 APPLIED DESIGN THINKING LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The course aims to
 Introduce tools & techniques of design thinking for innovative product
 development Illustrate customer-centric product innovation using on simple
 use cases Demonstrate development of Minimum usable Prototypes
 Outline principles of solution concepts & their evaluation
 Describe system thinking principles as applied to complex systems

UNIT I DESIGN THINKING PRINCIPLES 9


Exploring Human-centered Design - Understanding the Innovation process, discovering areas of
opportunity, Interviewing & empathy-building techniques, Mitigate validation risk with FIR [Forge
Innovation rubric] - Case studies

219
UNIT II ENDUSER-CENTRIC INNOVATION 9
Importance of customer-centric innovation - Problem Validation and Customer Discovery -
Understanding problem significance and problem incidence - Customer Validation. Target user,
User persona & user stories. Activity: Customer development process - Customer interviews and
field visit

UNIT III APPLIED DESIGN THINKING TOOLS 9


Concept of Minimum Usable Prototype [MUP] - MUP challenge brief - Designing & Crafting
the value proposition - Designing and Testing Value Proposition; Design a compelling value
proposition; Process, tools and techniques of Value Proposition Design

UNIT IV CONCEPT GENERATION 9


Solution Exploration, Concepts Generation and MUP design- Conceptualize the solution
concept; explore, iterate and learn; build the right prototype; Assess capability, usability and
feasibility. Systematic concept generation; evaluation of technology alternatives and the solution
concepts

UNIT V SYSTEM THINKING 9


System Thinking, Understanding Systems, Examples and Understandings, Complex Systems
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
At the end of the course, learners will be able to:
CO1:Define & test various hypotheses to mitigate the inherent risks in product innovations.
CO2:Design the solution concept based on the proposed value by exploring alternate solutions to
achieve value-price fit.
CO3:Develop skills in empathizing, critical thinking, analyzing, storytelling & pitching
CO4:Apply system thinking in a real-world scenario

TEXT BOOKS
1. Steve Blank, (2013), The four steps to epiphany: Successful strategies for products that win,
Wiley.
2. Alexander Osterwalder, Yves Pigneur, Gregory Bernarda, Alan Smith, Trish Papadakos,
(2014), Value
3. Proposition Design: How to Create Products and Services Customers Want, Wiley
4. Donella H. Meadows, (2015), “Thinking in Systems -A Primer”, Sustainability Institute.
5. Tim Brown,(2012) “Change by Design: How Design Thinking Transforms Organizations and
Inspires Innovation”, Harper Business.

REFERENCES
1. https://www.ideou.com/pages/design-thinking#process
2. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/valuation-risk-versus-validation-risk-in-product-innovations-
49f253ca86 24
3. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/product-innovation-rubric-adf5ebdfd356
4. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/evaluating-product-innovations-e8178e58b86e
5. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/user-guide-for-product-innovation-rubric-857181b253dd
6. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/star tup-failure-is-like-true-lie-7812cdfe9b85

220
MF3003 REVERSE ENGINEERING LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 The main learning objective of this course is to prepare students for:
 Applying the fundamental concepts and principles of reverse engineering in product design and
development.
 Applying the concept and principles material characteristics, part durability and life limitation in
reverse engineering of product design and development.
 Applying the concept and principles of material identification and process verification in reverse
engineering of product design and development.
 Analysing the various legal aspect and applications of reverse engineering in product design
and development.
 Understand about 3D scanning hardware & software operations and procedure to generate 3D
model

UNIT I INTRODUCTION & GEOMETRIC FORM 9 Hours


Definition – Uses – The Generic Process – Phases – Computer Aided Reverse Engineering -
Surface and Solid Model Reconstruction – Dimensional Measurement – Prototyping.

UNIT II MATERIAL CHARACTERISTICS AND PROCESS IDENTIFICATION 9 Hours


.Alloy Structure Equivalency – Phase Formation and Identification – Mechanical Strength –
Hardness –Part Failure Analysis – Fatigue – Creep and Stress Rupture – Environmentally
Induced Failure Material Specification - Composition Determination - Microstructure Analysis -
Manufacturing Process Verification.

UNIT III DATA PROCESSING 9 Hours


Statistical Analysis – Data Analysis – Reliability and the Theory of Interference – Weibull Analysis
– Data Conformity and Acceptance – Data Report – Performance Criteria – Methodology of
Performance Evaluation – System Compatibility.

UNIT IV 3D SCANNING AND MODELLING 9 Hours


Introduction, working principle and operations of 3D scanners: Laser, White Light, Blue Light -
Applications- Software for scanning and modelling: Types- Applications- Preparation techniques
for Scanning objects- Scanning and Measuring strategies - Calibration of 3D Scanner- Step by
step procedure: 3D scanning - Geometric modelling – 3D inspection- Case studies.

UNIT V INDUSTRIAL APPLICATIONS 9 Hours


Reverse Engineering in the Automotive Industry; Aerospace Industry; Medical Device Industry.
Case studies and Solving Industrial projects in Reverse Engineering.Legality: Patent – Copyrights
–Trade Secret – Third-Party Materials.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1:Apply the fundamental concepts and principles of reverse engineering in product design and
development.
CO2:Apply the concept and principles material characteristics, part durability and life limitation in

221
reverse engineering of product design and development.
CO3:Apply the concept and principles of material identification and process verification in reverse
engineering of product design and development.
CO4:Apply the concept and principles of data processing, part performance and system
compatibility in reverse engineering of product design and development.
CO5:Analyze the various legal aspect
CO6:Applications of reverse engineering in product design and development.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Robert W. Messler, Reverse Engineering: Mechanisms, Structures, Systems & Materials, 1st
Edition, McGraw-Hill Education, 2014
2. Wego Wang, Reverse Engineering Technology of Reinvention, CRC Press, 2011

REFERENCES:
1. Scott J. Lawrence , Principles of Reverse Engineering, Kindle Edition, 2022
2. Kevin Otto and Kristin Wood, Product Design: Techniques in Reverse Engineering and New
Product Development, Prentice Hall, 2001
3. Kathryn, A. Ingle, “Reverse Engineering”, McGraw-Hill, 1994.
4. Linda Wills, “Reverse Engineering”, Kluver Academic Publishers, 1996
5. Vinesh Raj and Kiran Fernandes, “Reverse Engineering: An Industrial Perspective”, Springer-
Verlag London Limited 2008.

OPR351 SUSTAINABLE MANUFACTURING LT PC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To be acquainted with sustainability in manufacturing and its evaluation.
 To provide knowledge in environment and social sustainability.
 To provide the student with the knowledge of strategy to achieve sustainability.
 To familiarize with trends in sustainable operations.
 To create awareness in current sustainable practices in manufacturing industry.

UNIT I ECONOMIC SUSTAINABILITY 9


Industrial Revolution-Economic sustainability: globalization and international issues Sustainability
status - Emerging issues- Innovative products- Reconfiguration manufacturing enterprises -
Competitive manufacturing strategies - Performance evaluation- Management for sustainability -
Assessments of economic sustainability

UNIT II SOCIAL AND ENVIRONMENTAL SUSTAINABILITY 9


Social sustainability – Introduction-Work management -Human rights - Societal commitment -
Customers -Business practices -Modelling and assessing social sustainability. Environmental
issues pertaining to the manufacturing sector: Pollution - Use of resources -Pressure to reduce
costs - Environmental management: Processes that minimize negative environmental impacts -
environmental legislation and energy costs - need to reduce the carbon footprint of manufacturing
Operations-Modelling and assessing environmental sustainability

222
UNIT III SUSTAINABILITY PRACTICES 9
Sustainability awareness - Measuring Industry Awareness-Drivers and barriers -Availability of
sustainability indicators -Analysis of sustainability practicing -Modeling and assessment of
sustainable practicing -Sustainability awareness -Sustainability drivers and barriers - Availability of
sustainability indicators- Designing questionnaires- Optimizing Sustainability Indexes-Elements –
Cost and time model.

UNIT IV MANUFACTURING STRATEGY FOR SUSTAINABILITY 9


Concepts of competitive strategy and manufacturing strategies and development of a strategic
improvement programme - Manufacturing strategy in business success strategy formation and
formulation - Structured strategy formulation - Sustainable manufacturing system design options -
Approaches to strategy formulation - Realization of new strategies/system designs.

UNIT V TRENDS IN SUSTAINABLE OPERATIONS 9


Principles of sustainable operations - Life cycle assessment manufacturing and service activities -
influence of product design on operations - Process analysis – Capacity management - Quality
management -Inventory management - Just-In-Time systems - Resource efficient design -
Consumerism and sustainable well-being.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:
CO1: Discuss the importance of economic sustainability.
CO2: Describe the importance of sustainable practices.
CO3: Identify drivers and barriers for the given conditions.
CO4: Formulate strategy in sustainable manufacturing.
CO5: Plan for sustainable operation of industry with environmental, cost consciousness.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Ibrahim Garbie, “Sustainability in Manufacturing Enterprises Concepts, Analyses and
Assessments for Industry 4.0”, Springer International Publishing., United States, 2016, ISBN-
13: 978-3319293042.
2. Davim J.P., “Sustainable Manufacturing”, John Wiley & Sons., United States, 2010,ISBN:
978-1-848-21212-1.

REFERENCES:
1. Jovane F, Ęmper, W.E. and Williams, D.J., “The ManuFuture Road: Towards
Competitive and Sustainable High-Adding-Value Manufacturing”, Springer,2009, United
States, ISBN 978-3-540-77011-4.
2. Kutz M., “Environmentally Conscious Mechanical Design”, John Wiley & Sons., United
States, 2007, ISBN: 978-0-471-72636-4.
3. Seliger G., “Sustainable Manufacturing: Shaping Global Value Creation”, Springer,
United States, 2012, ISBN 978-3-642-27289-9.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
Mapping of COs with POs and PSOs
COs/Pos POs PSOs
&PSOs 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 3 - 2 - - - 2 2 - 1 1 2 2 2 1

223
CO2 3 - - - - - 2 - - 1 1 2 1 2 2
CO3 3 - - - - - 2 3 - 1 1 2 1 2 2
CO4 3 - 3 - - - 2 - 1 1 2 2 2 1
CO5 3 - 3 - - - 2 2 - 1 1 2 2 2 1
CO/PO &
3 - 3 - - - 2 2 - 1 1 2 2 2 1
PSO Average
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

AU3791 ELECTRIC AND HYBRID VEHICLES LT PC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 The objective of this course is to prepare the students to know about the general aspects of
Electric and Hybrid Vehicles (EHV), including architectures, modelling, sizing, and sub
system design and hybrid vehicle control.

UNIT I DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS FOR ELECTRIC VEHICLES 9


Need for Electric vehicle- Comparative study of diesel, petrol, hybrid and electric Vehicles.
Advantages and Limitations of hybrid and electric Vehicles. - Design requirement for electric
vehicles- Range, maximum velocity, acceleration, power requirement, mass of the vehicle. Various
Resistance- Transmission efficiency- Electric vehicle chassis and Body Design, Electric Vehicle
Recharging and Refuelling Systems.

UNIT II ENERGY SOURCES 9


Battery Parameters- - Different types of batteries – Lead Acid- Nickel Metal Hydride - Lithium ion-
Sodium based- Metal Air. Battery Modelling - Equivalent circuits, Battery charging- Quick Charging
devices. Fuel Cell- Fuel cell Characteristics- Fuel cell types-Half reactions of fuel cell. Ultra
capacitors. Battery Management System.

UNIT III MOTORS AND DRIVES 9


Types of Motors- DC motors- AC motors, PMSM motors, BLDC motors, Switched reluctance
motors working principle, construction and characteristics.

UNIT IV POWER CONVERTERS AND CONTROLLERS 9


Solid state Switching elements and characteristics – BJT, MOSFET, IGBT, SCR and TRIAC -
Power Converters – rectifiers, inverters and converters - Motor Drives - DC, AC motor, PMSM
motors, BLDC motors, Switched reluctance motors – four quadrant operations –operating modes

UNIT V HYBRID AND ELECTRIC VEHICLES 9


Main components and working principles of a hybrid and electric vehicles, Different configurations
of hybrid and electric vehicles. Power Split devices for Hybrid Vehicles - Operation modes -
Control Strategies for Hybrid Vehicle - Economy of hybrid Vehicles - Case study on specification of
electric and hybrid vehicles.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the student will be able to
CO1:Understand the operation and architecture of electric and hybrid vehicles
CO2:Identify various energy source options like battery and fuel cell
224
CO3:Select suitable electric motor for applications in hybrid and electric vehicles.
CO4:Explain the role of power electronics in hybrid and electric vehicles
CO5:Analyze the energy and design requirement for hybrid and electric vehicles.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Iqbal Husain, “ Electric and Hybrid Vehicles-Design Fundamentals”, CRC Press,2003
2. Mehrdad Ehsani, “ Modern Electric, Hybrid Electric and Fuel Cell Vehicles”, CRCPress,2005.

REFERENCES:
1. James Larminie and John Lowry, “Electric Vehicle Technology Explained “ John Wiley &
Sons,2003
2. Lino Guzzella, “ Vehicle Propulsion System” Springer Publications,2005
3. Ron HodKinson, “Light Weight Electric/ Hybrid Vehicle Design”, Butterworth Heinemann
Publication,2005.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
2 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
3 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
4 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
5 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
Avg. 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OAS352 SPACE ENGINEERING L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Use the standard atmosphere tables and equations.
 Find lift and drag coefficient data from NACA plots.
 Apply the concept of static stability to flight vehicles.
 Describe the concepts of stress, strain, Young’s modulus, Poisson’s ratio, yield strength.
 Demonstrate a basic knowledge of dynamics relevant to orbital mechanics.

UNIT I STANDARD ATMOSPHERE 6


History of aviation – standard atmosphere - pressure, temperature and density altitude.

UNIT II AERODYNAMICS 10
Aerodynamic forces – Lift generation Viscosity and its implications - Shear stress in a velocity
profile - Lagrangian and Eulerian flow field - Concept of a streamline – Aircraft terminology and
geometry - Aircraft types - Lift and drag coefficients using NACA data.

UNIT III PERFORMANCE AND PROPULSION 9


Viscous and pressure drag - flow separation - aerodynamic drag - thrust calculations -thrust/power
available and thrust/power required.

225
UNIT IV AIRCRAFT STABILITY AND STRUCTURAL THEORY 10
Degrees of freedom of aircraft motions - stable, unstable and neutral stability - concept of static
stability - Hooke’s Law- brittle and ductile materials - moment of inertia - section
modulus.
UNIT V SPACE APPLICATIONS 10
History of space research - spacecraft trajectories and basic orbital manoeuvres - six orbital
elements - Kepler’s laws of orbits - Newtons law of gravitation.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:Illustrate the history of aviation & developments over the years
CO2:Ability to identify the types & classifications of components and control systems
CO3:Explain the basic concepts of flight & Physical properties of Atmosphere
CO4:Identify the types of fuselage and constructions.
CO5:Distinguish the types of Engines and explain the principles of Rocket

TEXT BOOKS:
1. John D. Anderson, Introduction to Flight, 8 th Ed., McGraw-Hill Education, New York,2015.
2. E Rathakrishnan, “Introduction to Aerospace Engineering: Basic Principles of Flight”, John
Wiley, NJ, 2021.
3. Stephen. A. Brandt, " Introduction to Aeronautics: A design perspective "
American Institute of Aeronautics & Astronautics,1997.
REFERENCE:
1. Kermode, A.C., “Mechanics of Flight”, Himalayan Book, 1997.

OIM351 INDUSTRIAL MANAGEMENT LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce fundamental concepts of industrial management
 To understand the approaches to the study of Management
 To learn about Decision Making, Organizing and leadership
 To analyze the Managerial Role and functions
 To know about the Supply Chain Management’

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Technology Management - Definition - Functions - Evolution of Modern Management - Scientific
Management Development of Management Thought. Approaches to the study of Management,
Forms of Organization -Individual Ownership - Partnership - Joint Stock Companies - Co-operative
Enterprises - Public Sector Undertakings, Corporate Frame Work- Share Holders - Board of
Directors - Committees - Chief Executive Line and Functional Managers,-Financial-Legal-Trade
Union

UNIT II FUNCTIONS OF MANAGEMENT 9


Planning - Nature and Purpose - Objectives - Strategies – Policies and Planning Premises -
Decision Making - Organizing - Nature and Process - Premises - Departmentalization - Line and
staff - Decentralization -Organizational culture, Staffing - selection and training .Placement -
Performance appraisal - Career Strategy – Organizational Development. Leading - Managing

226
human factor - Leadership .Communication, Controlling - Process of Controlling - Controlling
techniques, productivity and operations management - Preventive control, Industrial Safety.

UNIT III ORGANIZATIONAL BEHAVIOUR 9


Definition - Organization - Managerial Role and functions -Organizational approaches, Individual
behaviour - causes - Environmental Effect - Behaviour and Performance, Perception -
Organizational Implications. Personality - Contributing factors - Dimension – Need Theories -
Process Theories - Job Satisfaction, Learning and Behaviour-Learning Curves, Work Design and
approaches.

UNIT IV GROUPDYNAMICS 9
Group Behaviour - Groups - Contributing factors - Group Norms, Communication - Process -
Barriers to communication - Effective communication, leadership - formal and informal
characteristics – Managerial Grid - Leadership styles - Group Decision Making - Leadership Role
in Group Decision, Group Conflicts - Types -Causes - Conflict Resolution -Inter group relations
and conflict, Organization centralization and decentralization - Formal and informal -
Organizational Structures Organizational Change and Development -Change Process –
Resistance to Change - Culture and Ethics.

UNIT V MODERN CONCEPTS 9


Management by Objectives (MBO) - Management by Exception (MBE),Strategic Management -
Planning for Future direction - SWOT Analysis -Evolving development strategies, information
technology in management Decisions support system-Management Games Business Process Re-
engineering(BPR) –Enterprises Resource Planning (ERP) - Supply Chain Management (SCM) -
Activity Based Management (AM) - Global Perspective - Principles and Steps Advantages and
disadvantage
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the basic concepts of industrial management
CO2: Identify the group conflicts and its causes.
CO3: Perform swot analysis
CO4 : Analyze the learning curves
CO5 : Understand the placement and performance appraisal

REFERENCES:
1. Maynard H.B, “Industrial Engineering Hand book”, McGraw-Hill, sixth 2008
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 1 2 1
2 3 2 3 2
3 2 3 2 3 1 2 3
4 2 2 3 3 3 3
5 2 2 2
AVg. 2 2.2 2.3 3 1.8 2 2.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

227
OIE354 QUALITY ENGINEERING L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 Developing a clear knowledge in the basics of various quality concepts.
 Facilitating the students in understanding the application of control charts and its techniques.
 Developing thespecialcontrolproceduresforserviceandprocessorientedindustries.
 Analyzing and understanding the process capability study.
 Developing the acceptance sampling procedures for incoming raw material.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Quality Dimensions–Quality definitions–Inspection-Quality control–Quality Assurance–Quality
planning-Quality costs–Economics of quality– Quality loss function

UNIT II CONTROLCHARTS 9
Chance and assignable causes of process variation, statistical basis of the control chart, control
charts for variables- X , R and S charts, attribute control charts - p, np, c and u- Construction and
application.

UNIT III SPECIAL CONTROL PROCEDURES 9


Warning and modified control limits, control chart for individual measurements, multi-vari chart,
Xchart with a linear trend, chart for moving averages and ranges, cumulative-sum and
exponentially weighted moving average control charts.

UNIT IV STATISTICALPROCESSCONTROL 9
Process stability, process capability analysis using a Histogram or probability plots and control
chart.Gauge capability studies,setting specification limits.

UNITV ACCEPTANCESAMPLING 9
The acceptance sampling fundamental, OC curve, sampling plans for attributes, simple, double,
multiple and sequential, sampling plans for variables,MIL-STD-105DandMIL-STD-414E&IS2500
standards.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students will be able to:
CO1: Control the quality of processes using control charts for variables in manufacturing industries.
CO2: Control the occurrence of defective product and the defects in manufacturing companies.
CO3: Control the occurrence of defects in services.
CO4: Analyzing and understanding the process capability study.
CO5: Developing the acceptance sampling procedures for incoming raw material.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 3 3 3 1 2 2 1
2 3 3 3 3 3 3 2
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 1
4 3 2 3 1 1
5 2 3 3 3 1
AVg. 2.6 2.7 2.7 3 3 1 2.7 1 2.7 1 2 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

228
OSF351 FIRE SAFETY ENGINEERING L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To enable the students to acquire knowledge of Fire and Safety Studies
 To learn about the effect of fire on materials used for construction, the method of test for
non-combustibility & fire resistance
 To learn about fire area, fire stopped areas and different types of fire-resistant doors
 To learn about the method of fire protection of structural members and their repair due to
fire damage.
 To develop safety professionals for both technical and management through systematic
and quality-based study programmes

UNIT I INHERENT SAFETY CONCEPTS 9


Compartment fire-factors controlling fire severity, ventilation controlled and fuel controlled fires;
Spread of fire in rooms, within building and between buildings. Effect of temperature on the
properties of structural materials- concrete, steel, masonry and wood; Behavior of non-structural
materials on fire- plastics, glass, textile fibres and other house hold materials.

UNIT II PLANT LOCATIONS 9


Compartment temperature-time response at pre-flashover and post flashover periods; Equivalence
of fire severity of compartment fire and furnace fire; Fire resistance test on structural elements-
standard heating condition, Indian standard test method, performance criteria.

UNIT III WORKING CONDITIONS 9


Fire separation between building- principle of calculation of safe distance. Design principles of fire
resistant walls and ceilings; Fire resistant screens- solid screens and water curtains; Local
barriers; Fire stopped areas-in roof, in fire areas and in connecting structures; Fire doors- Low
combustible, Non-combustible and Spark-proof doors; method of suspension of fire doors; Air-tight
sealing of doors;

UNIT IV FIRE SEVERITY AND REPAIR TECHNIQUES 9


Fabricated fire proof boards-calcium silicate, Gypsum, Vermiculite, and Perlite boards; Fire
protection of structural elements - Wooden, Steel and RCC.. Reparability of fire damaged
structures- Assessment of damage to concrete, steel, masonry and timber structures, Repair
techniques- repair methods to reinforced concrete Columns, beams and slabs, Repair to steel
structural members, Repair to masonry structures.

UNIT V WORKING AT HEIGHTS 9


Safe Access - Requirement for Safe Work Platforms- Stairways - Gangways and Ramps-Fall
Prevention & Fall Protection - Safety Belts - Safety nets - Fall Arrestors- Working on Fragile Roofs
- Work Permit Systems-Accident Case Studies.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
On completion of the course the student will be able to
CO1:Understand the effect of fire on materials used for construction
CO2:Understand the method of test for non-combustibility and fire resistance; and will be able to
select different structural elements and their dimensions for a particular fire resistance rating of a
229
building.
CO3:To understand the design concept of fire walls, fire screens, local barriers and fire doors and
able to select them appropriately to prevent fire spread.
CO4:To decide the method of fire protection to RCC, steel, and wooden structural elements and
their repair methods if damaged due to fire.
CO5:Describe the safety techniques and improve the analytical and intelligence to take the right
decision at right time.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Roytman, M. Y,”Principles of fire safety standards for building construction”. Amerind
Publishing Co. Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi,1975
2. John A. Purkiss,”Fire safety engineering design of structures” (2nd edn.), Butterworth
Heinemann, Oxford, UK,2009.

REFERENCES:
1. Smith, E.E. and Harmathy, T.Z. (Editors),”Design of buildings for fire safety”. ASTM Special
Publication 685, American Society for Testing and Materials, Boston, U.S.A,1979.
2. Butcher, E. G. and Parnell, A. C, ”Designing of fire safety”. JohnWiley and Sons Ltd., New
York, U.S.A.1983.
3. Jain, V.K,”Fire safety in buildings” (2nd edn.). New Age International(P) Ltd., New
Delhi,2010. 4. Hazop&Hazan,”Identifying and Assessing Process Industry Hazards”, Fourth
Edition ,1999
4. Frank R. Spellman, Nancy E. Whiting,”The Handbook of Safety Engineering: Principles and
Applications”, 2009

CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 - 1 - - 1 - - - - - - - - -
2 - - 3 - - - - - - - - - - - -
3 1 - 2 - - - 3 - - 1 - - - - -
4 - - - - - 1 1 - - - - - - - -
5 2 - 1 - - 1 1 1 - 1 - 1 - - -
AVg. 1.3 - 1.75 - - 1 1.3 1 1 - 1 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OML351 INTRODUCTION TO NON-DESTRUCTIVE TESTING L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The main learning objective of this course is to prepare the students for:
 Understanding the basic importance of NDT in quality assurance.
 Imbibing the basic principles of various NDT techniques, its applications, limitations, codes
and standards.
 Equipping themselves to locate a flaw in various materials, products.
 Applying apply the testing methods for inspecting materials in accordance with industry
specifications and standards.

230
 Acquiring the knowledge on the selection of the suitable NDT technique for a given
application

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO NDT & VISUAL TESTING 9


Concepts of Non-destructive testing-relative merits and limitations-NDT Versus mechanical
testing, Fundamentals of Visual Testing – vision, lighting, material attributes, environmental
factors, visual perception, direct and indirect methods – mirrors, magnifiers, boroscopes and
fibroscopes – light sources and special lighting.

UNIT II LIQUID PENETRANT & MAGNETIC PARTICLE TESTING 9


Liquid Penetrant Inspection: principle, applications, advantages and limitations, dyes, developers
and cleaners, Methods & Interpretation.
Magnetic Particle Inspection: Principles, applications, magnetization methods, magnetic particles,
Testing Procedure, demagnetization, advantages and limitations, – Interpretation and evaluation of
test indications.

UNIT III EDDY CURRENT TESTING & THERMOGRAPHY 9


Eddy Current Testing: Generation of eddy currents– properties– eddy current sensing elements,
probes, Instrumentation, Types of arrangement, applications, advantages, limitations – Factors
affecting sensing elements and coil impedance, calibration, Interpretation/Evaluation.
Thermography- Principle, Contact & Non-Contact inspection methods, Active & Passive methods,
Liquid Crystal – Concept, example, advantages & limitations. Electromagnetic spectrum, infrared
thermography- approaches, IR detectors, Instrumentation and methods, applications.

UNIT IV ULTRASONIC TESTING & AET 9


Ultrasonic Testing: Types of ultrasonic waves, characteristics, attenuation, couplants, probes,
EMAT. Inspection methods-pulse echo, transmission and phased array techniques, types of
scanning and displays, angle beam inspection of welds, time of flight diffraction (TOFD) technique,
Thickness determination by ultrasonic method, Study of A, B and C scan presentations,
calibration.
Acoustic Emission Technique – Introduction, Types of AE signal, AE wave propagation, Source
location, Kaiser effect, AE transducers, Principle, AE parameters, AE instrumentation, Advantages
& Limitations, Interpretation of Results, Applications.

UNIT V RADIOGRAPHY TESTING 9


Sources-X-rays and Gamma rays and their characteristics-absorption, scattering. Filters and
screens, Imaging modalities-film radiography and digital radiography (Computed, Direct, Real
Time, CT scan). Problems in shadow formation, exposure factors, inverse square law, exposure
charts, Penetrameters, safety in radiography.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1:Realize the importance of NDT in various engineering fields.
CO2:Have a basic knowledge of surface NDE techniques which enables to carry out various
inspection in accordance with the established procedures.
CO3:Calibrate the instrument and inspect for in-service damage in the components by means of
Eddy current testing as well as Thermography testing.

231
CO4:Differentiate various techniques of UT and AET and select appropriate NDT methods for
better evaluation.
CO5:Interpret the results of Radiography testing and also have the ability to analyse the influence
of various parameters on the testing.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Baldev Raj, T. Jayakumar and M. Thavasimuthu, Practical Non Destructive Testing, Alpha
Science International Limited, 3rd edition, 2002.
2. J. Prasad and C. G. K. Nair, Non-Destructive Test and Evaluation of Materials, Tata McGraw-
Hill Education, 2nd edition, 2011.
3. Ravi Prakash, “Non-Destructive Testing Techniques”, 1st revised edition, New Age
International Publishers, 2010.

REFERENCES:
1. ASM Metals Handbook, V-17, "Nondestructive Evaluation and Quality Control", American
Society of Metals, USA, 2001.
2. Barry Hull and Vernon John,"Nondestructive Testing", Macmillan, 1989.
3. Chuck Hellier, “Handbook of Nondestructive Evaluation”, Mc Graw Hill, 2012.
4. Louis Cartz, "Nondestructive Testing", ASM International, USA, 1995.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PSO PSO PSO
PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12
1 2 3
C01 2 2 2 3 2 2 2 1 2
C02 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1
C03 3 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2
CO4 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
CO5 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1
Avg 2.8 1.6 1.8 2.2 2 2 2 1.8 2 1.3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMR351 MECHATRONICS L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The main learning objective of this course is to prepare the students for:
 Selecting sensors to develop mechatronics systems.
 Explaining the architecture and timing diagram of microprocessor, and also interpret
and develop programs.
 Designing appropriate interfacing circuits to connect I/O devices with microprocessor.
 Applying PLC as a controller in mechatronics system.
 Designing and develop the apt mechatronics system for an application.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION AND SENSORS 9


Introduction to Mechatronics – Systems – Need for Mechatronics – Emerging areas of
Mechatronics – Classification of Mechatronics. Sensors and Transducers: Static and Dynamic

232
Characteristics of Sensor, Potentiometers – LVDT – Capacitance Sensors – Strain Gauges –
Eddy Current Sensor – Hall Effect Sensor –Temperature Sensors – Light Sensors.

UNIT II 8085 MICROPROCESSOR 9


Introduction – Pin Configuration - Architecture of 8085 – Addressing Modes – Instruction set,
Timing diagram of 8085.

UNIT III PROGRAMMABLE PERIPHERAL INTERFACE 9


Introduction – Architecture of 8255, Keyboard Interfacing, LED display – Interfacing, ADC and
DAC Interface, Temperature Control – Stepper Motor Control – Traffic Control Interface.

UNIT IV PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLER 9


Introduction – Architecture – Input / Output Processing – Programming with Timers, Counters
and Internal relays – Data Handling – Selection of PLC.

UNIT V ACTUATORS AND MECHATRONICS SYSTEM DESIGN 9


Types of Stepper and Servo motors – Construction – Working Principle – Characteristics,
Stages of Mechatronics Design Process – Comparison of Traditional and Mechatronics Design
Concepts with Examples – Case studies of Mechatronics Systems – Pick and Place Robot –
Engine Management system – Automatic Car Park Barrier.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:
CO1: Select sensors to develop mechatronics systems.
CO2: Explain the architecture and timing diagram of microprocessor, and also
interpret and develop programs.
CO3: Design appropriate interfacing circuits to connect I/O devices with microprocessor.
CO 4: Apply PLC as a controller in mechatronics system.
CO 5: Design and develop the apt mechatronics system for an application.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


COs/POs & POs PSOs
PSOs 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 2 3
CO2 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 2 3
CO3 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 2 3
CO4 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 2 3
CO5 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 2 3
CO/PO & PSO 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 2 3
Average
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

TEXT BOOKS
1. Bolton W., “Mechatronics”, Pearson Education, 6th Edition, 2015.
2. Ramesh S Gaonkar, “Microprocessor Architecture, Programming, and Applications with
the 8085”, Penram International Publishing Private Limited, 6th Edition, 2013.

233
REFERENCES
1. Bradley D.A., Dawson D., Buru N.C. and Loader A.J., “Mechatronics”, Chapman and Hall,
1993.
2. Davis G. Alciatore and Michael B. Histand, “Introduction to Mechatronics and
Measurement systems”, McGraw Hill Education, 2011.
3. Devadas Shetty and Richard A. Kolk, “Mechatronics Systems Design”, Cengage
Learning, 2010.
4. Nitaigour Premchand Mahalik, “Mechatronics Principles, Concepts and Applications”,
McGraw Hill Education, 2015.
5. Smaili. A and Mrad. F, “Mechatronics Integrated Technologies for Intelligent Machines”,
Oxford University Press, 2007.

ORA351 FOUNDATION OF ROBOTICS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To study the kinematics, drive systems and programming of robots.
 To study the basics of robot laws and transmission systems.
 To familiarize students with the concepts and techniques of robot manipulator, its
kinematics.
 To familiarize students with the various Programming and Machine Vision application in
robots.
 To build confidence among students to evaluate, choose and incorporate robots in
engineering systems.

UNIT I FUNDAMENTALS OF ROBOT 9


Robot – Definition – Robot Anatomy – Co-ordinate systems, Work Envelope, types and
classification – specifications – Pitch, yaw, Roll, Joint Notations, Speed of Motion, Pay Load –
Robot Parts and their functions – Need for Robots – Different Applications.

UNIT II ROBOT KINEMATICS 9


Forward kinematics, inverse kinematics and the difference: forward kinematics and inverse
Kinematics of Manipulators with two, three degrees of freedom (in 2 dimensional), four degrees
of freedom (in 3 dimensional) – derivations and problems. Homogeneous transformation
matrices, translation and rotation matrices.

UNIT III ROBOT DRIVE SYSTEMS AND END EFFECTORS 9


Pneumatic Drives – Hydraulic Drives – Mechanical Drives – Electrical Drives – D.C. Servo
Motors, Stepper Motor, A.C. Servo Motors – Salient Features, Applications and Comparison of
All These Drives. End Effectors – Grippers – Mechanical Grippers, Pneumatic and Hydraulic
Grippers, Magnetic grippers, vacuum grippers, internal grippers and external grippers, selection
and design considerations of a gripper

UNIT IV SENSORS IN ROBOTICS 9


Force sensors, touch and tactile sensors, proximity sensors, non-contact sensors, safety
considerations in robotic cell, proximity sensors, fail safe hazard sensor systems, and
compliance mechanism. Machine vision system - camera, frame grabber, sensing and

234
digitizing image data – signal conversion, image storage, lighting techniques, image processing
and analysis – data reduction, segmentation, feature extraction, object recognition, other
algorithms, applications – Inspection, identification, visual serving and navigation.

UNIT V PROGRAMMING AND APPLICATIONS OF ROBOT 9


Teach pendant programming, lead through programming, robot programming languages – VAL
programming – Motion Commands, Sensors commands, End-Effector Commands, and simple
programs - Role of robots in inspection, assembly, material handling, underwater, space and
medical fields.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOMES
At the end of the course, students will be able to:
CO1: Interpret the features of robots and technology involved in the control.
CO2: Apply the basic engineering knowledge and laws for the design of robotics.
CO3: Explain the basic concepts like various configurations, classification and parts of end
effectors compare various end effectors and grippers and tools and sensors used in robots.
CO4: Explain the concept of kinematics, degeneracy, dexterity and trajectory planning.
CO5: Demonstrate the image processing and image analysis techniques by machine vision
system.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


COs/POs& POs PSOs
PSOs 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 3 2 1 1 1 3
CO2 3 2 1 1 1 3
CO3 3 2 1 1 1 3
CO4 3 2 1 1 1 3
CO5 3 2 1 1 1 3
CO/PO &
PSO
Average
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Ganesh.S.Hedge,”A textbook of Industrial Robotics”, Lakshmi Publications, 2006.
2. Mikell.P.Groover , “Industrial Robotics – Technology, Programming and applications”
McGraw Hill 2ND edition 2012.

REFERENCES:
1. Fu K.S. Gonalz R.C. and ice C.S.G.”Robotics Control, Sensing, Vision and Intelligence”,
McGraw Hill book co. 2007.
2. YoramKoren, “Robotics for Engineers”, McGraw Hill Book, Co., 2002.
3. Janakiraman P.A., “Robotics and Image Processing”, Tata McGraw Hill 2005.
4. John. J.Craig, “Introduction to Robotics: Mechanics and Control” 2nd Edition, 2002.
5. 5. Jazar, “Theory of Applied Robotics: Kinematics, Dynamics and Control”, Springer
India reprint, 2010.

235
OAE352 FUNDAMENTALS OF AERONAUTICAL ENGINEERING LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To acquire the knowledge on the Historical evaluation of Airplanes
 To learn the different component systems and functions
 To know the concepts of basic properties and principles behind the flight
 To learn the basics of different structures & construction
 To learn the various types of power plants used in aircrafts

UNIT I HISTORY OF FLIGHT 8


Balloon flight-ornithopter-Early Airplanes by Wright Brothers, biplanes and monoplanes,
Developments in aerodynamics, materials, structures and propulsion over the years.

UNIT II AIRCRAFT CONFIGURATIONS AND ITS CONTROLS 10


Different types of flight vehicles, classifications-Components of an airplane and their functions-
Conventional control, powered control- Basic instruments for flying-Typical systems for control
actuation.

UNIT III BASICS OF AERODYNAMICS 9


Physical Properties and structures of the Atmosphere, Temperature, pressure and altitude
relationships, Newton’s Law of Motions applied to Aeronautics-Evolution of lift, drag and moment.
Aerofoils, Mach number, Maneuvers.

UNIT IV BASICS OF AIRCRAFT STRUCTURES 9


General types of construction, Monocoque, semi-monocoque and geodesic constructions, typical
wing and fuselage structure. Metallic and non-metallic materials. Use of Aluminium alloy, titanium,
stainless steel and composite materials. Stresses and strains-Hooke’s law- stress-strain diagrams-
elastic constants-Factor of Safety.

UNIT V BASICS OF PROPULSION 9


Basic ideas about piston, turboprop and jet engines – use of propeller and jets for thrust
production- Comparative merits, Principle of operation of rocket, types of rocket and typical
applications, Exploration into space.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:Illustrate the history of aircraft & developments over the years
CO2:Ability to identify the types & classifications of components and control systems
CO3:Explain the basic concepts of flight & Physical properties of Atmosphere
CO4:Identify the types of fuselage and constructions.
CO5:Distinguish the types of Engines and explain the principles of Rocket

TEXT BOOKS
1. Anderson, J.D., Introduction to Flight, McGraw-Hill; 8th edition , 2015
2. E Rathakrishnan, “Introduction to Aerospace Engineering: Basic Principles of Flight”, John
Wiley, NJ, 2021
3. Stephen.A. Brandt, Introduction to aeronautics: A design perspective, 2nd edition, AIAA
Education Series, 2004.

236
REFERENCE
1. SADHU SINGH, “INTERNAL COMBUSTION ENGINES AND GAS TURBINE”-, SS Kataraia
& sons, 2015
2. KERMODE , “FLIGHT WITHOUT FORMULAE”, -, Pitman; 4th Revised edition 1989

OGI351 REMOTE SENSING CONCEPTS LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the concepts of remote sensing processes and its components.
 To expose the various remote sensing platforms and sensors and to introduce the
elements of data interpretation

UNIT I REMOTE SENSING AND ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION 9


Definition – components of RS – History of Remote Sensing – Merits and demerits of data
collation between conventional and remote sensing methods - Electromagnetic Spectrum –
Radiation principles - Wave theory, Planck‘s law, Wien’s Displacement Law, Stefan’s
Boltzmann law, Kirchoff‘s law – Radiation sources: active & passive - Radiation Quantities

UNIT II EMR INTERACTION WITH ATMOSPHERE AND EARTH MATERIAL 9


Standard atmospheric profile – main atmospheric regions and its characteristics – interaction of
radiation with atmosphere – Scattering, absorption and refraction – Atmospheric windows - Energy
balance equation – Specular and diffuse reflectors – Spectral reflectance & emittance –
Spectroradiometer – Spectral Signature concepts – Typical spectral reflectance curves for
vegetation, soil and water – solid surface scattering in microwave region.

UNIT III ORBITS AND PLATFORMS 9


Motions of planets and satellites – Newton‘s law of gravitation - Gravitational field and potential -
Escape velocity - Kepler‘s law of planetary motion - Orbit elements and types – Orbital
perturbations and maneuvers – Types of remote sensing platforms - Ground based, Airborne
platforms and Space borne platforms – Classification of satellites – Sun synchronous and
Geosynchronous satellites – Lagrange Orbit.

UNIT IV SENSING TECHNIQUES 9


Classification of remote sensors – Resolution concept : spatial, spectral, radiometric and temporal
resolutions - Scanners - Along and across track scanners – Optical-infrared sensors – Thermal
sensors – microwave sensors – Calibration of sensors - High Resolution Sensors - LIDAR , UAV –
Orbital and sensor characteristics of live Indian earth observation satellites

UNIT V DATA PRODUCTS AND INTERPRETATION 9


Photographic and digital products – Types, levels and open source satellite data products –-
selection and procurement of data– Visual interpretation: basic elements and interpretation keys -
Digital interpretation – Concepts of Image rectification, Image enhancement and Image
classification
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the student is expected to
237
CO 1 Understand the concepts and laws related to remote sensing
CO 2 Understand the interaction of electromagnetic radiation with atmosphere and earth material
CO 3 Acquire knowledge about satellite orbits and different types of satellites
CO 4 Understand the different types of remote sensors
CO 5 Gain knowledge about the concepts of interpretation of satellite imagery

TEXTBOOKS:
1. Thomas M.Lillesand, Ralph W. Kiefer and Jonathan W. Chipman, Remote Sensing and
Image interpretation, John Wiley and Sons, Inc, New York,2015.
2. George Joseph and C Jeganathan, Fundamentals of Remote Sensing,Third Edition
Universities Press (India) Private limited, Hyderabad, 2018

REFERENCES:
1. Janza, F.Z., Blue H.M. and Johnson,J.E. Manual of Remote Sensing. Vol.1, American Society
of Photogrametry, Virginia, USA, 2002.
2. Verbyla, David, Satellite Remote Sensing of Natural Resources. CRC Press, 1995
3. Paul Curran P.J. Principles of Remote Sensing. Longman, RLBS, 1988.
4. Introduction to Physics and Techniques of Remote Sensing , Charles Elachi and Jacob Van
Zyl, 2006 Edition II, Wiley Publication.
5. Basudeb Bhatta, Remote Sensing and GIS, Oxford University Press, 2011
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
Course Outcome
PO Graduate Attribute CO1 CO2 CO3 CO4 CO5 Average
PO1 Engineering Knowledge 3 3 3 3 3 3
PO2 Problem Analysis 3 3 3
PO3 Design/Development of Solutions 3 3 3
PO4 Conduct Investigations of Complex 3
3 3
Problems
PO5 Modern Tool Usage 3 3 3
PO6 The Engineer and Society
PO 7 Environment and Sustainability
PO 8 Ethics
PO 9 Individual and Team Work
PO 10 Communication
PO 11 Project Management and Finance
PO 12 Life-long Learning 3 3 3 3 3
PSO 1 Knowledge of Geoinformatics discipline 3 3 3 3 3 3
PSO 2 Critical analysis of Geoinformatics 3
3 3 3 3 3
Engineering problems and innovations
PSO 3 Conceptualization and evaluation of 3
3 3 3 3 3
Design solutions
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

238
OAI351 URBAN AGRICULTURE LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the students the principles of agricultural crop production and the production
practices of crops in modern ways.
 To delineate the role of agricultural engineers in relation to various crop production practices.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Benefits of urban agriculture- economic benefits, environmental benefits, social and cultural
benefits, educational, skill-building and job training benefits, health, nutrition and food accessibility
benefits.

UNIT II VERTICAL FARMING 9


Vertical farming- types, green facade, living/green wall-modular green wall , vegetated mat wall-
Structures and components for green wall system: plant selection, growing media, irrigation and
plant nutrition: Design, light, benefits of vertical gardening. Roof garden and its types. Kitchen
garden, hanging baskets: The house plants/ indoor plants

UNIT III SOIL LESS CULTIVATION 9


Hydroponics, aeroponics, aquaponics: merits and limitations, costs and Challenges, backyard
gardens- tactical gardens- street landscaping- forest gardening, greenhouses, urban beekeeping

UNIT IV MODERN CONCEPTS 9


Growth of plants in vertical pipes in terraces and inside buildings, micro irrigation concepts suitable
for roof top gardening, rain hose system, Green house, polyhouse and shade net system of crop
production on roof tops

UNIT V WASTE MANAGEMENT 9


Concept, scope and maintenance of waste management- recycle of organic waste, garden
wastes- solid waste management-scope, microbiology of waste, other ingredients like insecticide,
pesticides and fungicides residues, waste utilization.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1:Demonstrate the principles behind crop production and various parameters that influences
the crop growth on roof tops
CO2:Explain different methods of crop production on roof tops
CO3:Explain nutrient and pest management for crop production on roof tops
CO4:Illustrate crop water requirement and irrigation water management on roof tops
CO5:Explain the concept of waste management on roof tops

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Martellozzo F and J S Landry. 2020. Urban Agriculture. Scitus Academics Llc.
2. Rob Roggema. 2016. Sustainable Urban Agriculture and Food Planning. Routledge Taylor
and Francis Group.
3. Akrong M O. 2012. Urban Agriculture. LAP Lambert Academic Publishing.

239
REFERENCES:
1. Agha Rokh A. 2008. Evaluation of ornamental flowers and fishes breeding in Bushehr urban
wastewater using a pilot-scale aquaponic system. Water and Wastewater, 19 (65): 47–53.
2. Agrawal M, Singh B, Rajput M, Marshall F and Bell J. N. B. 2003. Effect of air pollution on peri-
urban agriculture: A case study. Environmental Pollution, 126 (3): 323–329.
https://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S0269749103002458#aep-section-id24.
3. Jac Smit and Joe Nasr. 1992. Urban agriculture for sustainable cities: using wastes and idle
land and water bodies as resources. Environment and Urbanization, 4 (2):141-152.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO/PSO CO1 CO2 CO3 CO4 CO5 Overall
correlation of
COs with POs
PO1 Engineering Knowledge 1 2 1 1 2 1
PO2 Problem Analysis 1 1 1 1 1 2
PO3 Design/ Development of Solutions 1 2 1 1 3 2
PO4 Conduct Investigations of
1 1 2 2 1 1
Complex Problems
PO5 Modern Tool Usage 1 2 1 1 1 2
PO6 The Engineer and Society 1 2 1 2 1 1
PO7 Environment and sustainability 1 2 1 1 2 1
PO8 Ethics 2 1 1 1 2 1
PO9 Individual and team work: 1 1 2 1 1 1
PO10 Communication 1 2 1 1 2 1
PO11 Project management and finance 1 1 1 1 1 2
PO12 Life-long learning: 1 2 1 1 3 2
PSO1 To make expertise in design and
engineering problem solving
1 2 1 1 2 1
approach in agriculture with
proper knowledge and skill
PSO2 To enhance students ability to
formulate solutions to real-world
problems pertaining to 2 1 2 1 1 1
sustained agricultural productivity
using modern technologies.
PSO3 To inculcate entrepreneurial skills
through strong Industry-Institution 1 2 1 2 1 2
linkage.
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OEN351 DRINKING WATER SUPPLY AND TREATMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To equip the students with the principles and design of water treatment units and
distribution system.
240
UNIT I SOURCES OF WATER 9
Public water supply system – Planning, Objectives, Design period, Population forecasting; Water
demand – Sources of water and their characteristics, Surface and Groundwater – Impounding
Reservoir – Development and selection of source – Source Water quality – Characterization –
Significance – Drinking Water quality standards.

UNIT II CONVEYANCE FROM THE SOURCE 9


Water supply – intake structures – Functions; Pipes and conduits for water – Pipe materials –
Hydraulics of flow in pipes – Transmission main design – Laying, jointing and testing of pipes –
appurtenances – Types and capacity of pumps – Selection of pumps and pipe materials.

UNIT III WATER TREATMENT 9


Objectives – Unit operations and processes – Principles, functions, and design of water treatment
plant units, aerators of flash mixers, Coagulation and flocculation –- sand filters - Disinfection -
–Construction, Operation and Maintenance aspects.

UNIT IV ADVANCED WATER TREATMENT 9


Water softening – Desalination- R.O. Plant – demineralization – Adsorption - Ion exchange–
Membrane Systems - Iron and Manganese removal - Defluoridation - Construction and Operation
and Maintenance aspects

UNIT V WATER DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLY 9


Requirements of water distribution – Components – Selection of pipe material – Service reservoirs -
Functions – Network design – Economics - Computer applications – Appurtenances – Leak
detection - Principles of design of water supply in buildings – House service connection – Fixtures
and fittings, systems of plumbing and types of plumbing.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1: an understanding of water quality criteria and standards, and their relation to public
health
CO2: the ability to design the water conveyance system
CO3: the knowledge in various unit operations and processes in water treatment
CO4: an ability to understand the various systems for advanced water treatment
CO5: an insight into the structure of drinking water distribution system

TEXTBOOKS :
1. Garg. S.K., "Water Supply Engineering", Khanna Publishers, Delhi, September 2008.
2. Punmia B.C, Arun K.Jain, Ashok K.Jain, “ Water supply Engineering” Lakshmi publication
private limited, New Delhi, 2016.
3. Rangwala "Water Supply and Sanitary Engineering", February 2022
4. Birdie.G.S., "Water Supply and Sanitary Engineering", Dhanpat Rai and sons, 2018.

REFERENCES :
1. Fair. G.M., Geyer.J.C., "Water Supply and Wastewater Disposal", John Wiley and Sons,
241
1954.
2. Babbit.H.E, and Donald.J.J, "Water Supply Engineering" , McGraw Hill book Co, 1984.
3. Steel. E.W.et al., "Water Supply Engineering" , Mc Graw Hill International book Co, 1984.
4. Duggal. K.N., “Elememts of public Health Engineering”, S.Chand and Company Ltd,
New Delhi, 1998.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 3 3
2 3 2 2 3 3
3 2 2 3 3
4 3 2 3 2 3 3
5 3 2 1 2 3 1
Avg. 3 3 2 2 1 3 2 3 1 3

1.low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation


Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

OEE352 ELECTRIC VEHICLE TECHNOLOGY LT PC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To provide knowledge about electric machines and special machine
 To understand the basics of power converters
 To know the concepts of controlling DC and AC drive systems
 To understand the architecture and power train components.
 To impart knowledge on vehicle control for standard drive cycles of hybrid electrical vehicles
(HEVs)

UNIT I ROTATING POWER CONVERTERS 9


Magnetic circuits- DC machine and AC machine –Working principle of Generator and Motor-DC
and AC - Voltage and torque equations – Characteristics and applications. Working principle of
special machines like: Brushless DC motor, Switched reluctance motor and PMSM.

UNIT II STATIC POWER CONVERTERS 9


Working and Characteristics of Power Diodes, MOSFET and IGBT. Working of uncontrolled
rectifiers, controlled rectifiers (Single phase and Three phase), DC choppers, single and three
phase inverters, Multilevel inverters and Matrix Converters.

UNIT III CONTROL OF DC AND AC MOTOR DRIVES 9


Speed control for constant torque, constant HP operation of all electric motors - DC/DC chopper
based four quadrant operation of DC motor drives, inverter based V/f Operation (motoring and
braking) of induction motor drives, Transformation theory, vector control operation of Induction
motor and PMSM, Brushless DC motor drives, Switched reluctance motor (SRM) drives

242
UNIT IV HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE ARCHITECTURE AND POWER TRAIN
COMPONENTS 9
History of evolution of Electric Vehicles - Comparison of Electric Vehicles with Internal
Combustion Engines - Architecture of Electric Vehicles (EV) and Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV) –
Plug-in Hybrid Electric Vehicles (PHEV)- Power train components and sizing, Gears, Clutches,
Transmission and Brakes.

UNIT V MECHANICS OF HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES AND CONTROL OF


VEHICLES 9
Fundamentals of vehicle mechanics - tractive force, power and energy requirements for standard
drive cycles of HEV's - motor torque and power rating and battery capacity. HEV supervisory
control - Selection of modes - power spilt mode - parallel mode - engine brake mode -
regeneration mode - series parallel mode
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Able to understand the principles of conventional and special electrical machines.
CO2: Acquired the concepts of power devices and power converters
CO3: Able to understand the control for DC and AC drive systems.
CO4: Learned the electric vehicle architecture and power train components.
CO5: Acquired the knowledge of mechanics of electric vehicles and control of electric
vehicles.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 2 3 3 3 3
CO2 3 2 2 3 3 3 3 3
CO3 3 3 2 2 3 3 3
CO4 3 2 2 3 3 3 3
CO5 3 2 2 3 3 3
Avg 3 2 2 3 3 1 2 3 2 3 3 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

REFERENCES:
1 Stephen D. Umans, “Fitzgerald & Kingsley’s Electric Machinery”, Tata McGraw Hill, 7 th
Edition, 2020.
2 Bogdan M. Wilamowski, J. David Irwin, The Industrial Electronics Handbook, Second Edition,
Power Electronics and Motor Drives, CRC Press, 2011
3 Paul C. Krause, Oleg Wasynczuk, Scott D. Sudhoff, Steven D. Pekarek “Analysis of Electric
Machinery and Drive Systems”, 3rd Edition, Wiley-IEEE Press, 2013.
4 Rashid M.H., “Power Electronics Circuits, Devices and Applications ", Pearson, fourth Edition,
10th Impression 2021.
5 Iqbal Husain, ‘Electric and Hybrid Electric Vehicles’, CRC Press, 2021.
6 Wei Liu, ‘Hybrid Electric Vehicle System Modeling and Control’, Second Edition, WILEY,
2017

243
7 James Larminie and John Lowry, ‘Electric Vehicle Technology Explained’, Second Edition,
Wiley, 2012

OEI353 INTRODUCTION TO PLC PROGRAMMING LT P C


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Understand basic PLC terminologies digital principles, PLC architecture and operation.
 Familiarize different programming language of PLC.
 Develop PLC logic for simple applications using ladder logic.
 Understand the hardware and software behind PLC and SCADA.
 Exposures about communication architecture of PLC/SCADA.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO PLC 9


Introduction to PLC: Microprocessor, I/O Ports, Isolation, Filters, Drivers, Microcontrollers/DSP,
PLC/DDC- PLC Construction: What is a PLC, PLC Memories, PLC I/O, , PLC Special I/O, PLC
Types.

UNIT II PLC INSTRUCTIONS 9


PLC Basic Instructions: PLC Ladder Language- Function block Programming- Ladder/Function
Block functions- PLC Basic Instructions, Basic Examples (Start Stop Rung, Entry/Reset Rung)-
Configuration of Sensors, Switches, Solid State Relays-Interlock examples- Timers, Counters,
Examples.

UNIT III PLC PROGRAMMING 9


Different types of PLC program, Basic Ladder logic, logic functions, PLC module addressing,
registers basics, basic relay instructions, Latching Relays, arithmetic functions, comparison
functions, data handling, data move functions, timer-counter instructions, input-output instructions,
sequencer instructions

UNIT IV COMMUNICATION OF PLC AND SCADA 9


Communication Protocol – Modbus, HART, Profibus- Communication facilities SCADA: -
Hardware and software, Remote terminal units, Master Station and Communication architectures

UNIT V CASE STUDIES 9


Stepper Motor Control- Elevator Control-CNC Machine Control- conveyor control-Interlocking
Problems
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
SKILL DEVELOPMENT ACTIVITIES (Group Seminar/Mini Project/Assignment/Content
Preparation / Quiz/ Surprise Test / Solving GATE questions/ etc) 5
1. Market survey of the recent PLCs and comparison of their features.
2. Summarize the PLC standards
3. Familiarization of any one programming language (Ladder diagram/ Sequential Function
Chart/ Function Block Diagram/ Equivalent open source software)
4. Market survey of Communication Network Used for PLC/SCADA.

244
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1 Know the basic requirement of a PLC input/output devices and architecture. (L1)
CO2 Ability to apply Basics Instruction Sets used for ladder Logic and Function Block
Programming.(L2)
CO3 Ability to design PLC Programmes by Applying Timer/Counter and Arithmetic and Logic
Instructions Studied for Ladder Logic and Function BIock.(L3)
CO4 Able to develop a PLC logic for a specific application on real world problem. (L5)
CO5 Ability to Understand the Concepts of Communication used for PLC/SCADA.(L1)

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Frank Petruzzula, Programmable Logic Controllers, Tata Mc-Graw Hill Edition
2. John W. Webb, Ronald A. Reis, Programmable Logic Controllers Principles and
Applications, PHI publication

REFERENCES:
1. MadhuchanndMitra and SamerjitSengupta, Programmable Logic Controllers Industrial
Automation an Introduction, Penram International Publishing Pvt. Ltd.
2. J. R. Hackworth and F. D. Hackworth, Programmable Logic Controllers Principles
andApplications, Pearson publication

List of Open Source Software/ Learning website:


1. https://nptel.ac.in/courses/108105063
2. https://www.electrical4u.com/industrial-automation/
3. https://www.etf.ues.rs.ba/~slubura/Procesni%20racunari/Programmable%20Logic%2
0Controllers%20Programming%20Methods.pdf
4. https://www.electrical4u.com/industrial-automation/

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

PO,
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PSO PSO PSO
PSO
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO
CO1 3 2 1 1 1
CO2 3 3 2 1 1 2 2
CO3 3 3 3 3 1 1 1
CO4 3 3 3 3 1 1 3 3
CO5 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 3 3 3
Avg 3 2.9 2.25 2.6 1.6 1 1 3 3 2.9

1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

245
OCH351 NANO TECHNOLOGY L T PC
3 0 03
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 8
General definition and size effects–important nano structured materials and nano particles-
importance of nano materials- Size effect on thermal, electrical, electronic, mechanical, optical and
magnetic properties of nanomaterials- surface area - band gap energy and applications.
Photochemistry and Electrochemistry of nanomaterials –Ionic properties of nanomaterials- Nano
catalysis.

UNIT II SYNTHESIS OF NANOMATERIALS 8


Bottom up and Top-down approach for obtaining nano materials - Precipitation methods – sol gel
technique – high energy ball milling, CVD and PVD methods, gas phase condensation, magnetron
sputtering and laser deposition methods – laser ablation, sputtering.

UNIT III NANO COMPOSITES 10


Definition- importance of nanocomposites- nano composite materials-classification of composites-
metal/metal oxides, metal-polymer- thermoplastic based, thermoset based and elastomer based-
influence of size, shape and role of interface in composites applications.

UNIT IV NANO STRUCTURES AND CHARACTERIZATION TECHNIQUES 10


Classifications of nanomaterials - Zero dimensional, one-dimensional and two-dimensional
nanostructures- Kinetics in nanostructured materials- multilayer thin films and superlattice-
clusters of metals, semiconductors and nanocomposites. Spectroscopic techniques, Diffraction
methods, thermal analysis method, BET analysis method.

UNIT V APPLICATIONS OF NANO MATERIALS 9


Overview of nanomaterials properties and their applications, nano painting, nano coating,
nanomaterials for renewable energy, Molecular Electronics and Nanoelectronics – Nanobots-
Biological Applications. Emerging technologies for environmental applications- Practice of
nanoparticles for environmental remediation and water treatment.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1 understand the basic properties such as structural, physical, chemical properties of
nanomaterials and their applications.
CO2 able to acquire knowledge about the different types of nano material synthesis
CO3 describes about the shape, size,structure of composite nano materials and their
interference
CO4 understand the different characterization techniques for nanomaterials
CO5 develop a deeper knowledge in the application of nanomaterials in different fields.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Mick Wilson, Kamali Kannangara,Geoff Smith, Michelle Simmom, Burkhard Raguse, “ Nano
Technology: Basic Science & Engineering Technology”, 2005, Overseas Press
2. G. Cao, “Nanostructures & Nanomaterials: Synthesis, Properties &Applications” Imperial
College Press, 2004
3.William A Goddard “Handbook of Nanoscience, Engineering and Technology”, 3rd Edition,
CRC Taylor and Francis group 2012.

246
REFERENCES
1. R.H.J.Hannink & A.J.Hill, Nanostructure Control, Wood Head Publishing Ltd.,Cambridge,
2006.
2. C.N.R.Rao, A.Muller, A.K.Cheetham, The Chemistry of Nanomaterials: Synthesis, Properties
and Applications Vol. I & II, 2nd edition, 2005, Wiley VCH Verlag Gibtl & Co
3. Ivor Brodie and Julius J.Muray,’The physics of Micro/Nano – Fabrication’,Springer
International Edition,2010

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
Outcomes
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 understand the basic
properties such as
structural, physical,
2 3 2 3 3 - - - 1 1 - 3 1 1 3
chemical properties of
nanomaterials and
their applications
CO2 acquire knowledge
about the different
2 3 1 3 3 - - - 1 1 - 3 2 1 3
types of nano material
synthesis
CO3 describes about the
shape, size,structure
of composite nano 2 2 2 3 3 1 1 - 1 1 - 3 2 1 3
materials and their
interference
CO4 understand the
different
characterization 2 2 1 3 3 1 1 1 1 - 1 3 1 1 3
techniques for
nanomaterials
CO5 develop a deeper
knowledge in the
3
application of 2 2 1 3 3 1 1 1 1 - 1 3 2 1
nanomaterials in
different fields
Overall CO 3 2 2 1 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

247
OCH352 FUNCTIONAL MATERIALS LT P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 The course emphasis on the molecular safe assembly and materials for polymer
electronics

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Historical Perspectives, Lessons from the Nature, Engineering the Functions, Tuning the functions,
Multiscale Modeling and Computation, Classification of Functional Materials, Functional Diversity
of Materials, Hybrid Materials, Technological Relevance, Societal Impact.

UNIT II MOLECULAR SELF ASSEMBLY 9


Molecular Organization, Self-Assembly in Biology, Energetics of Self-Organization, A Few Case
Studies, Synthetic Protocols and Challenges, Solvent-assisted Self-Assembly, Directed Assembly-
Langmuir-Blodgett and Langmuir-Schaefer techniques, Technological Applications of SAMs.

UNIT III BIO-INSPIRED MATERIALS 9


Bio-inspired materials, Classification, Biomimicry, Spider Silk, Lotus Leaf, Gecko feet, Synovial
fluid, ‘Bionics’-Bio-inspired Information Technologies, Artificial Sensory Organs, Biomineralization-
En route to Nanotechnology.

UNIT IV SMART OR INTELLIGENT MATERIALS 9


Criteria for Smartness, Significance of Smart Materials, Representative Examples like Smart Gels
and Polymers, Electro/Magneto Rheological Fluids, Smart Electroceramics, Technical Limitations
and Challenges, Functional Nanocomposites, Polymer-carbon nanotube composities.

UNIT V MATERIALS FOR POLYMER ELECTRONICS 9


Polymers for Electronics, Organic Light Emitting Diodes, Working Principle of OLEDs, Illustrated
Examples, Organic Field-Effect Transistors Operating Principle, Design Considerations, Polymer
FETs vs Inorganic FETs, Liquid Crystal Displays, Engineering Aspects of Flat Panel Displays,
Intelligent Polymers for Data Storage, Polymer-based Data Storage-Principle, Magnetic Vs.
Polymer-based Data Storage.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOME:
 Students will be able to differentiate among various functional properties and select
appropriate material for certain functional applications, analyze the nature and potential of
functional material.

TEXT BOOK:
1. Vijayamohanan K. Pillai and MeeraParthasarathy, “Functional Materials: A chemist’s
perpective”, Universities Press Hyderabad (2012).

REFERENCE:
1. Stephen Manne “Biomimetic Materials Chemistry” Wiley-VCH Newyork, 1966.

248
OFD352 TRADITIONAL INDIAN FOODS LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To help students acquire a sound knowledge on diversities of foods, food habits and patterns in
India with focus on traditional foods.

UNIT I HISTORICAL AND CULTURAL PERSPECTIVES 9


Food production and accessibility - subsistence foraging, horticulture, agriculture and
pastoralization, origin of agriculture, earliest crops grown. Food as source of physical sustenance,
food as religious and cultural symbols; importance of food in understanding human culture -
variability, diversity, from basic ingredients to food preparation; impact of customs and traditions
on food habits, heterogeneity within cultures (social groups) and specific social contexts - festive
occasions, specific religious festivals, mourning etc. Kosher, Halal foods; foods for religious and
other fasts.

UNIT II TRADITIONAL METHODS OF FOOD PROCESSING 9


Traditional methods of milling grains – rice, wheat and corn – equipments and processes as
compared to modern methods. Equipments and processes for edible oil extraction, paneer, butter
and ghee manufacture – comparison of traditional and modern methods. Energy costs, efficiency,
yield, shelf life and nutrient content comparisons. Traditional methods of food preservation –
sundrying, osmotic drying, brining, pickling and smoking.

UNIT III TRADITIONAL FOOD PATTERNS 9


Typical breakfast, meal and snack foods of different regions of India.Regional foods that have
gone Pan Indian / Global. Popular regional foods; Traditional fermented foods,pickles and
preserves, beverages, snacks, desserts and sweets, street foods; IPR issues in traditional foods

UNIT IV COMMERCIAL PRODUCTION OF TRADITIONAL FOODS 9


Commercial production of traditional breads, snacks, ready-to-eat foods and instant mixes, frozen
foods – types marketed, turnover; role of SHGs, SMES industries, national and multinational
companies; commercial production and packaging of traditional beverages such as tender coconut
water, neera, lassi, buttermilk, dahi. Commercial production of intermediate foods – ginger and
garlic pastes, tamarind pastes, masalas (spice mixes), idli and dosa batters.

UNIT V HEALTH ASPECTS OF TRADIONAL FOODS 9


Comparison of traditional foods with typical fast foods / junk foods – cost, food safety, nutrient
composition, bioactive components; energy and environmental costs of traditional foods; traditional
foods used for specific ailments /illnesses.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1To understand the historical and traditional perspective of foods and food habits
CO2 To understand the wide diversity and common features of traditional Indian foods and meal
patterns.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Sen, Colleen Taylor “Food Culture in India” Greenwood Press, 2005.
2. Davidar, Ruth N. “Indian Food Science: A Health and Nutrition Guide to Traditional Recipes:
East West Books, 2001.
249
OFD353 INTRODUCTION TO FOOD PROCESSING LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 The course aims to introduce the students to the area of Food Processing. This is necessary for
effective understanding of a detailed study of food processing and technology subjects. This
course will enable students to appreciate the importance of food processing with respect to the
producer, manufacturer and consumer.

UNIT I PROCESSING OF FOOD AND ITS IMPORTANCE 9


Source of food - plant, animal and microbial origin; different foods and groups of foods as raw
materials for processing – cereals, pulses, grains, vegetables and fruits, milk and animal foods,
sea weeds, algae, oil seeds & fats, sugars, tea, coffee, cocoa, spices and condiments, additives;
need and significance of processing these foods.
UNIT II METHODS OF FOOD HANDLING AND STORAGE 9
Nature of harvested crop, plant and animal; storage of raw materials and products using low
temperature, refrigerated gas storage of foods, gas packed refrigerated foods, sub atmospheric
storage, Gas atmospheric storage of meat, grains, seeds and flour, roots and tubers; freezing of
raw and processed foods.

UNIT III LARGE-SCALE FOOD PROCESSING 12


Milling of grains and pulses; edible oil extraction; Pasteurisation of milk and yoghurt; canning and
bottling of foods; drying – Traditional and modern methods of drying, Dehydration of fruits,
vegetables, milk, animal products etc; preservation by use of acid, sugar and salt; Pickling and
curing with microorganisms, use of salt, and microbial fermentation; frying, baking, extrusion
cooking, snack foods.

UNIT IV FOOD WASTES IN VARIOUS PROCESSES 6


Waste disposal-solid and liquid waste; rodent and insect control; use of pesticides; ETP; selecting
and installing necessary equipment.

UNIT V FOOD HYGIENE 9


Food related hazards – Biological hazards – physical hazards – microbiological considerations in
foods. Food adulteration – definition, common food adulterants, contamination with toxic metals,
pesticides and insecticides; Safety in food procurement, storage handling and preparation;
Relationship of microbes to sanitation, Public health hazards due to contaminated water and food;
Personnel hygiene; Training& Education for safe methods of handling and processing food;
sterilization and disinfection of manufacturing plant; use of sanitizers, detergents, heat, chemicals,
Cleaning of equipment and premises.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course the students are expected to
CO1 Be aware of the different methods applied to processing foods.
CO2 Be able to understand the significance of food processing and the role of foodand beverage
industries in the supply of foods.

TEXT BOOKS/REFERENCES:
1. Karnal, Marcus and D.B. Lund “Physical Principles of Food Preservation”. Rutledge, 2003.

250
2. VanGarde, S.J. and Woodburn. M “Food Preservation and Safety Principles and
Practice”.Surbhi Publications, 2001.
3. Sivasankar, B. “Food Processing & Preservation”, Prentice Hall of India, 2002.
4. Khetarpaul, Neelam, “Food Processing and Preservation”, Daya Publications, 2005.

OPY352 IPR FOR PHARMA INDUSTRY LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To provide the basic fundamental knowledge of different forms of Intellectual Property
Rights in national and international level.
 To provide the significance of the Intellectual Property Rights about the patents, copyrights,
industrial design, plant and geographical indications.
 This paper is to study significance of the amended patent act on pharma industry.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION- INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS 9


Introduction, Types of Intellectual Property Rights -patents, plant varieties protection, geographical
indicators, copyright, trademark, trade secrets.

UNIT II PATENTS 9
Patents-Objective, Introduction, Requirement for patenting- Novelty, Inventive step (Non-
obviousness) and industrial application (utility), Non-patentable inventions, rights of patent owner,
assignment of patent rights, patent specification (provisional and complete), parts of complete
specification, claims, procedure for obtaining patents, compulsory license.

UNIT III PLANT VARIETY-TRADITIONAL KNOWLEDGE –GEOGRAPHICAL


INDICATIONS 9
Plant variety- Justification, criteria for protection of plant variety and protection in India. Traditional
knowledge- Concept of traditional knowledge, protection of traditional knowledge under Intellectual
Property frame works in national level and Traditional knowledge digital library (TKDL).
Geographical Indications – Justification for protection, National and International position.

UNIT IV ENFORCEMENT AND PRACTICAL ASPECTS OF IPR 9


Introduction – civil remedies – injunction, damage, account of profit – criminal remedies – patent,
trademark. Practical aspects – Introduction, benefits of licensing, licensing of basic types of IPR,
licensing clauses of IPR. Case studies of patent infringement, compulsory licensing, simple patent
license agreements.

UNIT V INTERNATIONAL BACKGROUND OF INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY 9


International Background of Intellectual Property- Paris Convention, Berne convention, World
Trade Organization (WTO), World Intellectual Property Organization (WIPO), Trade Related
Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights (TRIPS) and Patent Co-operation Treaty (PCT).
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. N. Nagpal, M. Arora, M.R.D. Usman, S. Rahar, “Intellectual Property Rights” Edu creation
Publishing, New Delhi, 2017.
2. The Patents Act, 1970 (Bare Act with Short Notes) (New Delhi: Universal Law Publishing
Company Pvt. Ltd. 2012.
251
3. B.S. Rao, P.V. Appaji, “Intellectual Property Rights in Pharmaceutical Industry: Theory and
Practice”, 2015.

REFERENCES:
1. Patents for Chemicals, Pharmaceuticals, & Biotechnology-Fundamentals of Global Law,
Practice and Strategy. Philip W. Grubb, Oxford University Press, 2004.
2. Basic Principles of patent law – Basics principles and acquisition of IPR. Ramakrishna T.
CIPRA, NLSIU, Bangalore, 2005
3. S. Lakshmana Prabu, TNK. Suriyaprakash, “Intellectual Property Rights”, 1st ed., In Tech
open access, Croatia, 2017.

COURSE OUTCOME
The student will be able to
C1 Understand and differentiate the categories of intellectual property rights.
C2 Describe about patents and procedure for obtaining patents.
C3 Distinguish plant variety, traditional knowledge and geographical indications under IPR.
C4 Provide the information about the different enforcements and practical aspects involved in
protection of IPR.
C5 Provide different organizations role and responsibilities in the protection of IPR in the
international level.
C6 Understand the interrelationships between different Intellectual Property Rights on
International Society

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


IPR FOR PHARMA INDUSTRY
PO1 PO2 PO PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO1 PO11 PO
3 0 12
C1 3 3 2 2 2
C2 3 3 2 2
C3 3 3 2 2 1
C4 2 3 3 2 2
C5 3 3 2 1
C6 3 2 2 2 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OTT351 BASICS OF TEXTILE FINISHING LT PC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To enable the students to understand the basics and different types of finishes required for
textile materials and machines used for finishing.

UNIT I RESIN FINISHING 9


Importance of finishing and its classification. Resin finishing: Mechanism of creasing, Types of
Resins .Anti crease, wash and wear, durable press resin finishing. Study about eco friendly
method of anti crease finishing.

252
UNIT II FLAME PROOF & WATERPROOF 9
Concept of Flame proof & flame retardancy. Flame retardant finishes for cotton, Concept of
waterproof and water repellent Finishes, Durable & Semi durable and Temporary finishes,
Concept of Antimicrobial finish.

UNIT III SOIL RELEASE AND ANTISTATIC FINISHES 9


Soil Release Finishing: Mechanism of soil retention & soil release. Anti pilling Finishing: chemical
and mechanical methods to produce anti pilling. Concept of UV Protection finishes- Concept of
antistatic finishes.

UNIT IV MECHANICAL FINISHES 9


Mechanical finishing of textile materials - calendaring, compacting, Sanforising, Peach finishing.
Object of Heat setting. Various methods of heat setting and mechanism of heat setting.

UNIT V STIFFENING AND SOFTENING 9


Concept of stiffening and softening of textile materials. Mechanism in the weight reduction of PET
.Concept of Micro encapsulation techniques in finishing process, Nano finish, Plasma Treatment
and Bio finishing.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, the students will be able to Understand the
CO: 1 Basics of Resin Finishing Process.
CO: 2 Concept of Flame proof & flame retardancy, waterproof and water repellent, Antimicrobial
finishes.
CO: 3 Concept of Soil Release, Anti Pilling, UV Protection and Antistatic finishes.
CO: 4 Concept of Mechanical finishing.
CO: 5 Basics of Micro encapsulation techniques, Nano finish, Plasma Treatment.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. V.A.Shennai, "Technology of Finishing", Vol X, Sevak Publications, Mumbai
2. Perkins, W.S., “Textile colouration and finishing”, Carolina Academic Press., U.K, ISBN:
0890898855.2004.
REFERENCES:
1. Microencapsulation in finishing, Review of progress of Colouration, SDC, 2001 62
2. Chakraborty, J.N, Fundamentals and Practices in colouration of Textiles, Woodhead
Publishing India, 2009, ISBN-13:978-81-908001-4-3
3. W. D. Schindler and P. J. Hauser "Chemical finishing of textiles", Woodhead Publishing
Cambridge England,2004.

OTT352 INDUSTRIAL ENGINEERING FOR GARMENT INDUSTRY LTPC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To enable the students to learn about basics of industrial engineering and different tools of
industrial engineering and its application in apparel industry

253
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Scope of industrial engineering in apparel Industry, role of industrial engineers.
Productivity: Definition - Productivity, Productivity measures .Reduction of work content due to
the product and process, Reduction of ineffective time due to the management, due to the
worker. Causes for low productivity in apparel industry and measures for improvement.

UNIT II WORK STUDY 9


Definition, Purpose, Basic procedure and techniques of work-study.
Work environment – Lighting, Ventilation, Climatic condition on productivity.
Temperature control, humidity control, noise control measures. Safety and ergonomics on
work station and work environment
Material Handling – Objectives, Classification and characteristics of material handling
equipments, Specialized material handling equipments.

UNIT III METHOD STUDY 9


Definition, Objectives, Procedure, Process charts and symbols. Various charts – Charts
indicating process sequence: Outline process chart, flow process chart (man type, material type
and equipment type); Charts using time scale – multiple activity chart. Diagrams indicating
movement – flow diagram, string diagram, cycle graph, chrono cycle graph, travel chart
MOTION STUDY: Principle of motion economy, Two handed process chart, micro motion
analysis – therbligs, SIMO chart.

UNIT IV WORK MEASUREMENT 9


Definition, purpose, procedure, equipments, techniques. Time study - Definition, basics of
time study- equipments. Time study forms, Stop watch procedure. Predetermined motion time
standards (PMTS). Time Study rating, calculation of standard time, Performance rating –
relaxation and other allowances. Calculation of SAM for different garments, GSD.

UNIT V WORK STUDY APPLICATION 9


Application of work study techniques in cutting, stitching and packing in garment industry.
Workaids in sewing, Pitch diagram, Line balancing, Capacity planning, scientific method
of training.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon the completion of the course the student shall be able to understand
CO1: Fundamental concepts of industrial Engineering and productivity
CO2: Method study
CO3: Motion analysis
CO4: Work measurement and SAM
CO5: Ergonomics and its application to garment industry

TEXTBOOKS:
1. George Kanwaty, “Introduction to Work Study “, ILO, Geneva, 1996, ISBN: 9221071081
|ISBN-13: 9789221071082
2. Enrick N. L., “Time study manual for Textile industry”, Wiley Eastern (P) Ltd., 1989, ISBN:
0898740444 | ISBN-13: 9780898740448
3. Khanna O. P., and Sarup A., “Industrial Engineering and Management”, Dhanpat Rai
Publications, New Delhi, 2010, ISBN: 818992835X / ISBN: 978-8189928353
254
REFERENCES
1. Norberd Lloyd Enrick., “Industrial Engineering Manual for Textile Industry”, Wiley Eastern
(P) Ltd., New Delhi, 1988, ISBN: 0882756311 | ISBN-13: 9780882756318
2. Chuter A. J., “Introduction to Clothing Production Management”, Wiley-Black well Science,
U.S. A., 1995, ISBN: 0632039396 | ISBN-13: 9780632039395
3. GordanaColovic., “Ergonomics in the garment industry”, Wood publishing India Pvt. Ltd.,
India, 2014, ISBN: 0857098225 | ISBN-13: 9780857098221
4. Rajesh Bheda, “Managing Productivity in Apparel Industry “CBS Publishers & Distributors,
2008

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


Course Program Outcome
Outcome Statement PO1 PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
s 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O 2 O3
CO1 Fundamental concepts of
industrialEngineering and 2 2 3 3 2 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 1 -
productivity
CO2 Method study 1 2 3 3 2 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 1 -
CO3 Motion analysis 1 2 3 3 2 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 1 -
CO4 Work measurement and SAM 1 2 3 3 2 1 1 2 2 1 3 2 1 1 -
CO5 Ergonomics and itsapplication
to 1 2 3 3 2 1 2 2 2 1 3 2 1 1 -
garment industry
Overall CO 1.2 2 3 3 2 1 1.2 2 2 1 2.4 2 1 1 -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and
Substantial (High) respectively

OTT353 BASICS OF TEXTILE MANUFACTURE LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To enable the students to learn about the basics of fibre forming, yarn production, fabric
formation, coloration of fabrics and garment manufacturing

UNIT I NATURAL FIBRES 9


Introduction: Definition of staple fibre, filament; Classification of natural and man-made fibres,
essential and desirable properties of fibres. Production and cultivation of Natural Fibers:
Cultivation of cotton, production of silk (sericulture), wool and jute – physical and chemical
structure of these fibres..

UNIT II REGENERATED AND SYNTHETIC FIBRES 9


Production sequence of regenerated and modified cellulosic fibres: viscose rayon, Acetate Rayon,
high wet modulus and high tenacity fibres; synthetic fibres – chemical structure, fibre forming
polymers, production principles.

255
UNIT III BASICS OF SPINNING 9
Spinning – principle of yarn formation, sequence of machines for yarn production with short staple
fibres and blends, principles of opening and cleaning machines; yarn numbering – calculations

UNIT IV BASICS OF WEAVING 9


Woven fabric – warp, weft, weaving, path of warp; looms – classification, handloom and its parts,
powerloom, automatic looms, shuttleless looms, special type of looms; preparatory machines for
weaving process and their objectives; basic weaving mechanism - primary, secondary and
auxiliary mechanisms,

UNIT V BASICS OF KNITTING AND NONWOVEN 9


Knitting – classification, principle, types of fabrics; nonwoven process –classification, principle,
types of fabrics.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of this course, the students shall have the basic knowledge on
CO1: Classification of fibres and production of natural fibres
CO2: Regenerated and synthetic fibres
CO3: Yarn spinning
CO4: Weaving
CO5: Knitting and nonwoven
TEXTBOOKS
1. Mishra S. P. , “A Text Book of Fibre Science and Technology”, New Age Publishers, 2000,
ISBN: 8122412505
2. Marks R., and Robinson. T.C., “Principles of Weaving”, The Textile Institute, Manchester,
1989, ISBN: 0 900739 258.
3. Spencer D.J., “Knitting Technology”, III Ed., Textile Institute, Manchester, 2001, ISBN:
185573 333 1.
REFERENCES:
1. Hornberer M., Eberle H., Kilgus R., Ring W. and Hermeling H., “Clothing Technology: From
Fibre to Fabric”, Europa LehrmittelVerlag, 2008, ISBN: 3808562250 / ISBN: 978-
3808562253.
2. Wynne A., “Motivate Series-Textiles”, Maxmillan Publications, London, 1997.

3. Carr H. and Latham B., “The Technology of Clothing Manufacture” Backwell Science, U.K.,
1994, ISBN: 0632037482 / ISBN:13: 9780632037483.Klein W., “The Rieter Manual of
Spinning, Vol.1”, Rieter Machine Works Ltd., Winterthur, 2014, ISBN 10 3-9523173-1-4 /
ISBN 13 978-3-9523173-1-0.
4. Klein W., “The Rieter Manual of Spinning, Vol.2”, Rieter Machine Works Ltd., Winterthur,
2014, ISBN 10 3-9523173-2-2 / ISBN 13 978-3-9523173-2-7.
5. Klein W., “The Rieter Manual of Spinning, Vol.1-3”, Rieter Machine Works Ltd., Winterthur,
2014, ISBN 10 3-9523173-3-0 / ISBN 13 978-3-9523173-3-4.
6. Talukdar. M.K., Sriramulu. P.K., and Ajgaonkar. D.B., “Weaving: Machines, Mechanisms,
Management”, Mahajan Publishers, Ahmedabad, 1998, ISBN: 81-85401-16-0.
7. Morton W. E., and Hearle J. W. S., “Physical Properties of Textile Fibres”, The Textile
Institute, Washington D.C., 2008, ISBN 978-1-84569-220-95
8. Gohl E. P. G., “Textile Science”, CBS Publishers and distributors, 1987, ISBN 0582685958

256
Course Articulation Matrix:

Course Statement Program Outcome


Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1. Classification of fibres - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
and production of
natural fibres
CO2. Regenerated and - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
synthetic fibres
CO3. Yarn spinning - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
CO4. Weaving - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
CO5. Knitting and - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
nonwoven
Overall CO - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OPE351 INTRODUCTION TO PETROLEUM REFINING AND


PETROCHEMICALS LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 The course is aimed to
Gain knowledge about petroleum refining process and production of petrochemical products.

UNIT I ORIGIN, FORMATION AND REFINING OF CRUDE OIL 9


Origin, Formation and Evaluation of Crude Oil. Testing of Petroleum Products. Refining of
Petroleum - Atmospheric and Vacuum Distillation.

UNIT II CRACKING 9
Cracking, Thermal Cracking, Vis-breaking, Catalytic Cracking (FCC), Hydro Cracking, Coking and
Air Blowing of Bitumen

UNIT III REFORMING AND HYDROTREATING 9


Catalytic Reforming of Petroleum Feed Stocks. Lube oil processing- Solvent Treatment
Processes, Dewaxing, Clay Treatment and Hydrofining. Treatment Techniques: Removal of
Sulphur Compounds in all Petroleum Fractions to improve performance.

UNIT IV INTRODUCTION TO PETROCHEMICALS 9


Petrochemicals - Cracking of Naphtha and Feed stock gas for the production of Ethylene,
Propylene, Isobutylene and Butadiene. Production of Acetylene from Methane, and Extraction of
Aromatics.

257
UNIT V PRODUCTION OF PETROCHEMICALS 9
Production of Petrochemicals like Dimethyl Terephathalate(DMT), Ethylene Glycol, Synthetic
glycerine, Linear Alkyl Benzene (LAB), Acrylonitrile, Methyl Methacrylate (MMA), Vinyl Acetate
Monomer, Phthalic Anhydride, Maleic Anhydride, Phenol, Acetone, Methanol, Formaldehyde,
Acetaldehyde, Pentaerythritol and production of Carbon Black.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On the completion of the course students are expected to
CO1: Understand the classification, composition and testing methods of crude petroleum and its
products. Learn the mechanism of refining process.
CO2: Understand the insights of primary treatment processes to produce the precursors.
CO3: Study the secondary treatment processes cracking, vis-breaking and coking to produce
more petroleum products.
CO4: Appreciate the need of treatment techniques for the removal of sulphur and other impurities
from petroleum products.
CO5: Understand the societal impact of petrochemicals and learn their manufacturing processes.
CO6: Learn the importance of optimization of process parameters for the high yield of petroleum
products.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Nelson, W. L., “Petroleum Refinery Engineering”, 4th Edition., McGraw Hill, New York,1985.
2. Wiseman. P., "Petrochemicals", UMIST Series in Science and Technology, John Wiley &
Sons,1986.

REFERENCES
1. Bhaskara Rao, B. K., “Modern Petroleum Refining Processes”, 2nd Edition, Oxford and
IBH Publishing Company, New Delhi, 1990.
2. Bhaskara Rao, B. K. “A Text on Petrochemicals”, 1st Edition, Khanna Publishers

CPE334 ENERGY CONSERVATION AND MANAGEMENT L T P C


3 0 0 3
OBJECTIVES:
At the end of the course, the student is expected to
 understand and analyse the energy data of industries
 carryout energy accounting and balancing
 conduct energy audit and suggest methodologies for energy savings and
 utilise the available resources in optimal ways

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Energy - Power – Past & Present scenario of World; National Energy consumption Data –
Environmental aspects associated with energy utilization – Energy Auditing: Need, Types,
Methodology and Barriers. Role of Energy Managers. Instruments for energy auditing.

258
UNIT II ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS 9
Components of EB billing – HT and LT supply, Transformers, Cable Sizing, Concept of Capacitors,
Power Factor Improvement, Harmonics, Electric Motors - Motor Efficiency Computation, Energy
Efficient Motors, Illumination – Lux, Lumens, Types of lighting, Efficacy, LED Lighting and scope of
Encon in Illumination.

UNIT III THERMAL SYSTEMS 9


Stoichiometry, Boilers, Furnaces and Thermic Fluid Heaters – Efficiency computation and encon
measures. Steam: Distribution &U sage: Steam Traps, Condensate Recovery, Flash Steam
Utilization, Insulators & Refractories

UNIT IV ENERGY CONSERVATION IN MAJOR UTILITIES 9


Pumps, Fans, Blowers, Compressed Air Systems, Refrigeration and Air Conditioning Systems –
Cooling Towers – D.G. sets

UNIT V ECONOMICS 9
Energy Economics – Discount Rate, Payback Period, Internal Rate of Return, Net Present Value,
Life Cycle Costing –ESCO concept
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students can able to analyze the energy data of industries.
CO1: Remember the knowledge for Basic combustion and furnace design and
selection of thermal and mechanical energy equipment.
CO2: Study the Importance of Stoichiometry relations, Theoretical air required for
complete combustion.
CO3: Skills on combustion thermodynamics and kinetics.
CO4: Apply calculation and design tube still heaters.
CO5: Studied different heat treatment furnace.
CO6: Practical and theoretical knowledge burner design.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Energy Manager Training Manual (4 Volumes) available at
www.energymanagertraining.com. a website administered by Bureau of Energy Efficiency (BEE),
a statutory body under Ministry of Power, Government of India, 2004.

REFERENCES:
1. Witte. L.C., P.S. Schmidt, D.R. Brown, “Industrial Energy Management and
Utilisation” Hemisphere Publ, Washington, 1988.
2. Callaghn, P.W. “Design and Management for Energy Conservation”, Pergamon
Press, Oxford, 1981.
3. Dryden. I.G.C., “The Efficient Use of Energy” Butterworths, London, 1982
4. Turner. W.C., “Energy Management Hand book”, Wiley, New York, 1982.
5. Murphy. W.R. and G. Mc KAY, “Energy Management”, Butterworths, London 1987

OPT351 BASICS OF PLASTICS PROCESSING LTPC


3 003
259
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 Understand the fundamentals of plastics processing, such as the relationships between
material structural properties and required processing parameters, and so on
 To gain practical knowledge on the polymer selection and its processing
 Understanding the major plastic material processing techniques (Extrusion, Injection
molding, Compression and Transfer molding, Blow molding, Thermoforming and casting)
 To understand suitable additives for plastics compounding
 To Propose troubleshooting mechanisms for defects found in plastics products
manufactured by various processing techniques

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO PLASTICS PROCESSING 9


Introduction to plastic processing – Principles of plastic processing: processing of plastics vs.
metals and ceramics. Factors influencing the efficiency of plastics processing: molecular weight,
viscosity and rheology. Difference in approach for thermoplastic and thermoset processing.
Additives for plastics compounding and processing: antioxidants, light stabilizers, UV stabilizers,
lubricants, impact modifiers, flame retardants, antistatic agents, stabilizers and plasticizers.
Compounding: plastic compounding techniques, plasticization, pelletization.

UNIT II EXTRUSION 9
Extrusion – Principles of extrusion. Features of extruder: barrel, screw, types of screws, drive
mechanism, specifications, heating & cooling systems, types of extruders. Flow mechanism:
process variables, die entry effects and exit instabilities. Die swell, Defects: melt fracture, shark
skin, bambooing. Factors determining efficiency of an extruder. Extrusion of films: blown and cast
films. Tube/pipe extrusion. Extrusion coating: wire & cable. Twin screw extruder and its
applications. Applications of extrusion and new developments.

UNIT III INJECTION MOLDING 9


Injection molding – Principles and processing outline, machinery, accessories and functions,
specifications, process variables, mould cycle. Types of clamping: hydraulic and toggle
mechanisms. Start-up and shut down procedures-Cylinder nozzles- Press capacity projected area
-Shot weight Basic theoretical concepts and their relationship to processing - Interaction of
moulding process aspect effects in quoted variables. Basic mould types. Reciprocating vs. plunger
type injection moulding. Thermoplastic vs. thermosetting injection moulding. Injection moulding vs.
other plastic processing techniques. State-of-the art injection moulding techniques - Introduction to
trouble shooting

UNIT IV COMPRESSION AND TRANSFER MOLDING 9


Compression moulding – Basic principles of compression and transfer moulding-Meaning of terms-
Bulk factor and flow properties, moulding materials, process variables and process cycle, Inter
relation between flow properties-Curing time-Mould temperature and Pressure requirements.
Preforms and preheating- Techniques of preheating. Machines used-Types of compression mould-
positive, semi-positive and flash. Common moulding faults and their correction- Finishing of
mouldings. Transfer moulding: working principle, equipment, Press capacity-Integral moulds and
auxiliary ram moulds, moulding cycle, moulding tolerances, pot transfer, plunger transfer and
screw transfer moulding techniques, advantages over compression moulding

UNIT V BLOW MOLDING, THERMOFORMING AND CASTING 9

260
Blow moulding: principles and terminologies. Injection blow moulding. Extrusion blow moulding.
Design guidelines for optimum product performance and appearance. Thermoforming: principle,
vacuum forming, pressure forming mechanical forming. Casting: working principle, types and
applications.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1:Ability to find out the correlation between various processing techniques with product
properties.
CO2:Understand the major plastics processing techniques used in moulding (injection, blow,
compression, and transfer), extrusion, thermoforming, and casting.
CO3:Acquire knowledge on additives for plastic compounding and methods employed for the same
CO4:Familiarize with the machinery and ancillary equipment associated with various plastic
processing techniques.
CO5:Select an appropriate processing technique for the production of a plastic product

REFERENCES
1. S. S. Schwart, S. H. Goodman, Plastics Materials and Processes, Van Nostrad Reinhold
Company Inc. (1982).
2. F. Hensen (Ed.), Plastic Extrusion Technology, Hanser Gardner (1997).
3. W. S. Allen and P. N. Baker, Hand Book of Plastic Technology, Volume-1, Plastic
Processing Operations [Injection, Compression, Transfer, Blow Molding], CBS Publishers and
Distributors (2004).
4. M. Chanda, S. K. Roy, Plastic Technology handbook, 4th Edn., CRC Press (2007).
5. I. I. Rubin, Injection Molding Theory & Practice, Society of Plastic Engineers, Wiley (1973).
6. D.V. Rosato, M. G. Rosato, Injection Molding Hand Book, Springer (2012).
7. M. L. Berins (Ed.), SPI Plastic Engineering Hand Book of Society of Plastic Industry Inc.,
Springer (2012).
8. B. Strong, Plastics: Material & Processing, A, Pearson Prentice hall (2005).
9. D.V Rosato, Blow Molding Hand Book, Carl HanserVerlag GmbH & Co (2003).

261
OEC351 SIGNALS AND SYSTEMS L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES :
● To understand the basic properties of signal & systems
● To know the methods of characterization of LTI systems in time domain
● To analyze continuous time signals and system in the Fourier and Laplace domain
● To analyze discrete time signals and system in the Fourier and Z transform domain
UNIT I CLASSIFICATION OF SIGNALS AND SYSTEMS 9
Standard signals- Step, Ramp, Pulse, Impulse, Real and complex exponentials and
Sinusoids_Classification of signals – Continuous time (CT) and Discrete Time (DT) signals,
Periodic & Aperiodic signals, Deterministic & Random signals, Energy & Power signals -
Classification of systems- CT systems and DT systems- – Linear & Nonlinear, Time-variant&
Time-invariant,Causal & Non-causal, Stable & Unstable.

UNIT II ANALYSIS OF CONTINUOUS TIME SIGNALS 9


Fourier series for periodic signals - Fourier Transform – properties- Laplace Transforms and
Properties

UNIT III LINEAR TIME INVARIANT CONTINUOUS TIME SYSTEMS 9


Impulse response - convolution integrals- Differential Equation- Fourier and Laplace transforms in
Analysis of CT systems - Systems connected in series / parallel.

UNIT IV ANALYSIS OF DISCRETE TIME SIGNALS 9


Baseband signal Sampling–Fourier Transform of discrete time signals (DTFT)– Properties of
DTFT - Z Transform & Properties

UNIT V LINEAR TIME INVARIANT-DISCRETE TIME SYSTEMS 9


Impulse response–Difference equations-Convolution sum- Discrete Fourier Transform and Z
Transform Analysis of Recursive & Non-Recursive systems-DT systems connected in series and
parallel.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, the student will be able to:
CO1:determine if a given system is linear/causal/stable
CO2: determine the frequency components present in a deterministic signal
CO3:characterize continuous LTI systems in the time domain and frequency domain
CO4:characterize discrete LTI systems in the time domain and frequency domain
CO5:compute the output of an LTI system in the time and frequency domains

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Oppenheim, Willsky and Hamid, “Signals and Systems”, 2nd Edition, Pearson Education,
New Delhi, 2015.(Units I - V)
2. Simon Haykin, Barry Van Veen, “Signals and Systems”, 2nd Edition, Wiley, 2002

REFERENCES :
1. B. P. Lathi, “Principles of Linear Systems and Signals”, 2nd Edition, Oxford, 2009.
2. M. J. Roberts, “Signals and Systems Analysis using Transform methods and MATLAB”,
McGraw- Hill Education, 2018.
3. John Alan Stuller, “An Introduction to Signals and Systems”, Thomson, 2007.
262
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
C PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO PSO
O 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 3
1 3 - 3 - 3 2 - - - - 3 - - 1
2 3 - 3 - - 2 - - - - 3 - 3 -
3 3 3 - - 3 2 - - - - 3 2 - -
4 3 3 - - 3 2 - - - - 3 - 3 1
5 3 3 - 3 3 2 - - - - 3 - 3 1
C 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 3 2 3 1
O

OEC352 FUNDAMENTALS Of ELECTRONIC DEVICES AND CIRCUITS L T PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES :
● To give a comprehensive exposure to all types of devices and circuits constructed with
discrete components. This helps to develop a strong basis for building linear and digital
integrated circuits
● To analyze the frequency response of small signal amplifiers
● To design and analyze single stage and multistage amplifier circuits
 To study about feedback amplifiers and oscillators principles
 To understand the analysis and design of multi vibrators

UNIT I SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES 9


PN junction diode, Zener diode, BJT, MOSFET, UJT –structure, operation and V-I characteristics,
Rectifiers – Half Wave and Full Wave Rectifier, Zener as regulator

UNIT II AMPLIFIERS 9
Load line, operating point, biasing methods for BJT and MOSFET, BJT small signal model –
Analysis of CE, CB, CC amplifiers- Gain and frequency response –Analysis of CS and Source
follower – Gain and frequency response- High frequency analysis.

UNIT III MULTISTAGE AMPLIFIERS AND DIFFERENTIAL AMPLIFIER 9


Cascode amplifier, Differential amplifier – Common mode and Difference mode analysis – Tuned
amplifiers – Gain and frequency response – Neutralization methods.

UNIT IV FEEDBACK AMPLIFIERS AND OSCILLATORS 9


Advantages of negative feedback – Analysis of Voltage / Current, Series , Shunt feedback
Amplifiers – positive feedback–Condition for oscillations, phase shift – Wien bridge, Hartley,
Colpitts and Crystal oscillators.

UNIT V POWER AMPLIFIERS AND DC/DC CONVERTERS 9


Power amplifiers- class A-Class B-Class AB-Class C-Temperature Effect- Class AB Power
amplifier using MOSFET –DC/DC convertors – Buck, Boost, Buck-Boost analysis and
design.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

263
COURSE OUTCOMES :
At the end of the course the students will be able to
CO1: Explain the structure and working operation of basic electronic devices.
CO2: Design and analyze amplifiers.
CO3: Analyze frequency response of BJT and MOSFET amplifiers
CO4: Design and analyze feedback amplifiers and oscillator principles.
CO5: Design and analyze power amplifiers and supply circuits

TEXT BOOKS :
1. David A. Bell, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", Oxford Higher Education press, 5 th Edition,
2010.
2. Robert L. Boylestad and Louis Nasheresky, “Electronic Devices and Circuit Theory”, 10th
Edition, Pearson Education / PHI, 2008.
3. Adel .S. Sedra, Kenneth C. Smith, "Micro Electronic Circuits", Oxford University Press, 7 th
Edition, 2014.

REFERENCES :
1. Donald.A. Neamen, "Electronic Circuit Analysis and Design", Tata McGraw Hill, 3 rd Edition,
2010.
2. D.Schilling and C.Belove, "Electronic Circuits", McGraw Hill, 3 rd Edition, 1989
3. Muhammad H.Rashid, "Power Electronics", Pearson Education / PHI , 2004.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
1 3 3 3 3 2 1 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
2 3 2 2 3 2 2 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
3 3 3 3 2 1 2 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
4 3 3 2 3 2 2 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
5 3 2 3 2 2 1 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
CO 3 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

CBM348 FOUNDATION SKILLS IN INTEGRATED PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the global trends and development methodologies of various types of
products and services
 To conceptualize, prototype and develop product management plan for a new product
based on the type of the new product and development methodology integrating the
hardware, software, controls, electronics and mechanical systems
 To understand requirement engineering and know how to collect, analyze and arrive at
requirements for new product development and convert them in to design specification
 To understand system modeling for system, sub-system and their interfaces and arrive at
the optimum system specification and characteristics
 To develop documentation, test specifications and coordinate with various teams to validate
and sustain up to the EoL (End of Life) support activities for engineering customer

264
UNIT I BASICS OF PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT 9
Global Trends Analysis and Product decision - Social Trends - Technical Trends- Economical
Trends - Environmental Trends - Political/Policy Trends - Introduction to Product Development
Methodologies and Management - Overview of Products and Services - Types of Product
Development - Overview of Product Development methodologies - Product Life Cycle – Product
Development Planning and Management.

UNIT II REQUIREMENTS AND SYSTEM DESIGN 9


Requirement Engineering - Types of Requirements - Requirement Engineering - traceability Matrix
and Analysis - Requirement Management - System Design & Modeling - Introduction to System
Modeling - System Optimization - System Specification - Sub-System Design - Interface Design.

UNIT III DESIGN AND TESTING 9


Conceptualization - Industrial Design and User Interface Design - Introduction to Concept
generation Techniques – Challenges in Integration of Engineering Disciplines - Concept Screening
& Evaluation - Detailed Design - Component Design and Verification – Mechanical, Electronics and
Software Subsystems - High Level Design/Low Level Design of S/W Program - Types of
Prototypes, S/W Testing- Hardware Schematic, Component design, Layout and Hardware Testing
– Prototyping - Introduction to Rapid Prototyping and Rapid Manufacturing - System Integration,
Testing, Certification and Documentation

UNIT IV SUSTENANCE ENGINEERING AND END-OF-LIFE (EOL) SUPPORT 9


Introduction to Product verification processes and stages - Introduction to Product Validation
processes and stages - Product Testing Standards and Certification - Product Documentation -
Sustenance -Maintenance and Repair – Enhancements - Product EoL - Obsolescence
Management – Configuration Management - EoL Disposal

UNIT V BUSINESS DYNAMICS – ENGINEERING SERVICES INDUSTRY 9


The Industry - Engineering Services Industry - Product Development in Industry versus Academia
–The IPD Essentials - Introduction to Vertical Specific Product Development processes -
Manufacturing/Purchase and Assembly of Systems - Integration of Mechanical, Embedded and
Software Systems – Product Development Trade-offs - Intellectual Property Rights and
Confidentiality – Security and Configuration Management.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, the students will be able to:
CO1:Define, formulate, and analyze a problem
CO2:Solve specific problems independently or as part of a team
CO3:Gain knowledge of the Innovation & Product Development process in the Business Context
CO4:Work independently as well as in teams
CO5:Manage a project from start to finish

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Book specially prepared by NASSCOM as per the MoU.
2. Karl T Ulrich and Stephen D Eppinger, "Product Design and Development", Tata McGraw Hill,
Fifth Edition, 2011.
3. John W Newstorm and Keith Davis, "Organizational Behavior", Tata McGraw Hill, Eleventh
Edition, 2005.
265
REFERENCES:
1. Hiriyappa B, “Corporate Strategy – Managing the Business”, Author House, 2013.
2. Peter F Drucker, “People and Performance”, Butterworth – Heinemann [Elsevier], Oxford,
2004.
3. Vinod Kumar Garg and Venkita Krishnan N K, “Enterprise Resource Planning – Concepts”,
Second Edition, Prentice Hall, 2003.
4. Mark S Sanders and Ernest J McCormick, "Human Factors in Engineering and Design",
McGraw Hill Education, Seventh Edition, 2013
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2 3 1 1 1
2 3 2 3 1 1 1
3 3 2 3 1 1 1 1 1 1
4 3 2 3 1 1 1 1 1 1
5 3 2 3 1 1 1 1 1 1
AVg.
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

CBM333 ASSISTIVE TECHNOLOGY LTPC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The student should be made to:
 To know the hardware requirement various assistive devices
 To understand the prosthetic and orthotic devices
 To know the developments in assistive technology

UNIT I CARDIAC ASSIST DEVICES 9


Cardiac functions and parameters, principle of External counter pulsation techniques, intra aortic
balloon pump, Auxillary ventricle and schematic for temporary bypass of left ventricle, prosthetic
heart valves, cardiac pacemaker.

UNIT II HEMODIALYSERS 9
Physiology of kidney, Artificial kidney, Dialysis action, hemodialyser unit, membrane dialysis,
portable dialyser monitoring and functional parameters.

UNIT III HEARING AIDS 9


Anatomy of ear, Common tests – audiograms, air conduction, bone conduction, masking
techniques, SISI, Hearing aids – principles, drawbacks in the conventional unit, DSP based
hearing aids.

UNIT IV PROSTHETIC AND ORTHODIC DEVICES 9


Hand and arm replacement – different types of models, externally powered limb prosthesis,
feedback in orthotic system, functional electrical stimulation, sensory assist devices.

266
UNIT V RECENT TRENDS 9
Transcutaneous electrical nerve stimulator, bio-feedback, assistive devices in drug delivery
TOTAL :45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion of this course, the student will be able to
CO1: Interpret the various mechanical techniques that will help in assisting the heart functions.
CO2: Describe the underlying principles of hemodialyzer machine.
CO3: Indicate the methodologies to assess the hearing loss.
CO4: Evaluate the types of assistive devices for mobilization.
CO5: Explain about TENS and biofeedback system.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Joseph D. Bronzino, The Biomedical Engineering Handbook, Third Edition: Three Volume Set,
CRC Press,2006
2. Marion. A. Hersh, Michael A. Johnson,Assistive Technology for visually impaired and
blind,Springer Science & Business Media, 1st edition, 12-May-2010
3. Yadin David, Wolf W. von Maltzahn, Michael R. Neuman, Joseph.D, Bronzino, Clinical
Engineering, CRC Press, 1st edition,2010.

REFERENCES
1. Kenneth J. Turner Advances in Home Care Technologies: Results of the match Project,
Springer, 1stedition, 2011.
2. Gerr M. Craddock Assistive Technology-Shaping the future, IOS Press, 1st edition, 2003.
3. 3D Printing in Orthopaedic Surgery, Matthew Dipaola , Elsevier 2019 ISBN 978 -0-323-662116
4. Cardiac Assist Devices, Daniel Goldstein (Editor), Mehmet Oz (Editor), Wiley-Blackwell April
2000 ISBN: 978-0-879-93449-1
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 1 1 1 1
2 3 1 1 1 1
3 3 1 1 1 1
4 3 1 1 1 1
5 3 1 1 1 1
AVg. 3 1 1 1 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMA352 OPERATIONS RESEARCH L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
This course will help the students to
 determine the optimum solution for Linear programming problems.
 study the Transportation and assignment models and various techniques to solve them.
 acquire the knowledge of optimality, formulation and computation of integer programming
problems.
 acquire the knowledge of optimality, formulation and computation of dynamic programming
267
problems.
 determine the optimum solution for non-linear programming problems.

UNIT I LINEAR PROGRAMMING 9


Formulation of linear programming models – Graphical solution – Simplex method - Big M Method
– Two phase simplex method - Duality - Dual simplex method.

UNIT II TRANSPORTATION AND ASSIGNMENT PROBLEMS 9


Matrix form of Transportation problems – Loops in T.P – Initial basic feasible solution –
Transportation algorithm – Assignment problem – Unbalanced assignment problems .

UNIT III INTEGER PROGRAMMING 9


Introduction – All and mixed I.P.P – Gomory’s method – Cutting plane algorithm – Branch and
bound algorithm – Zero – one programming.

UNIT IV DYNAMIC PROGRAMMING PROBLEMS 9


Recursive nature of computation – Forward and backward recursion – Resource Allocation
model – Cargo – loading model – Work – force size model - Investment model – Solution of
L.P.P by dynamic programming .

UNIT VNON - LINEAR PROGRAMMING PROBLEMS 9


Lagrange multipliers – Equality constraints – Inequality constraints – Kuhn – Tucker Conditions –
Quadratic programming.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES :
At the end of the course, students will be able to
CO1:Could develop a fundamental understanding of linear programming models, able to develop a
linear programming model from problem description, apply the simplex method for solving linear
programming problems.
CO2:analyze the concept of developing, formulating, modeling and solving transportation and
assignment problems.
CO3:solve the integer programming problems using various methods.
CO4:conceptualize the principle of optimality and sub-optimization, formulation and computational
procedure of dynamic programming.
CO5:determine the optimum solution for non linear programming problems.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Kanti Swarup, P.K.Gupta and Man Mohan, " Operations Research " , Sultan Chand &
Sons, New Delhi, Fifth Edition , 1990.
2. Taha. H.A, " Operations Research – An Introduction , Pearson Education, Ninth Edition ,
New Delhi, 2012.

REFERENCES :
1. J.K.Sharma , " Operations Research - Theory and Applications " Mac Millan India Ltd ,
Second Edition , New Delhi , 2003.
2. Richard Bronson & Govindasami Naadimuthu , " Operations Research " ( Schaum’s Outlines
– TMH Edition) Tata McGraw Hill, Second Edition, New Delhi, 2004.

268
3. Pradeep Prabhakar Pai , " Operations Research and Practice", Oxford University Press,
New Delhi , 2012.
4. J.P.Singh and N.P.Singh , " Operations Research , Ane Books Pvt.L.td, New Delhi , 2014.
5. F.S.Hillier and G.J. Lieberman, " Introduction to Operations Research " , Tata McGraw Hill,
Eighth Edition , New Delhi, 2005.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO2 3 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO3 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO4 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO5 3 3 2 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
Avg 3 3 1 0.8 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMA353 ALGEBRA AND NUMBER THEORY L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES :
 To introduce the basic notions of groups, rings, fields which will then be used to solve
related problems.
 To examine the key questions in the Theory of Numbers.
 To give an integrated approach to number theory and abstract algebra, and provide a firm
basis for further reading and study in the subject.

UNIT I GROUPS AND RINGS 9


Groups: Definition - Properties - Homomorphism - Isomorphism - Cyclic groups - Cosets -
Lagrange's theorem.
Rings: Definition - Sub rings - Integral domain - Field - Integer modulo n - Ring homomorphism.

UNIT II FINITE FIELDS AND POLYNOMIALS 9


Rings - Polynomial rings - Irreducible polynomials over finite fields - Factorization of polynomials
over finite fields.

UNIT III DIVISIBILITY THEORY AND CANONICAL DECOMPOSITIONS 9


Division algorithm- Base-b representations – Number patterns – Prime and composite numbers –
GCD – Euclidean algorithm – Fundamental theorem of arithmetic – LCM.

UNIT IV DIOPHANTINE EQUATIONS AND CONGRUENCES 9


Linear Diophantine equations – Congruence’s – Linear Congruence’s - Applications : Divisibility
tests - Modular exponentiation - Chinese remainder theorem – 2x2 linear systems.

UNIT V CLASSICAL THEOREMS AND MULTIPLICATIVE FUNCTIONS 9


Wilson’s theorem – Fermat’s Little theorem – Euler’s theorem – Euler’s Phi functions – Tau and
Sigma functions.

269
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES :
CO1:Explain the fundamental concepts of advanced algebra and their role in modern
mathematics and applied contexts.
CO2:Demonstrate accurate and efficient use of advanced algebraic techniques.
CO3:The students should be able to demonstrate their mastery by solving non-trivial problems
related to the concepts, and by proving simple theorems about the, statements proven by the text

TEXT BOOKS :
1. Grimaldi, R.P and Ramana, B.V., "Discrete and Combinatorial Mathematics", Pearson
Education, 5th Edition, New Delhi, 2007.
2. Thomas Koshy, “Elementary Number Theory with Applications”, Elsevier
Publications , New Delhi , 2002.

REFERENCES:
1. San Ling and Chaoping Xing, “Coding Theory – A first Course”, Cambridge Publications,
Cambridge, 2004.
2. Niven.I, Zuckerman.H.S., and Montgomery, H.L., “An Introduction to Theory of Numbers” ,
John Wiley and Sons , Singapore, 2004.
3. Lidl.R., and Pitz. G, "Applied Abstract Algebra", Springer Verlag, New Delhi, 2nd Edition , 2006.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 1 2 - - - 2 1 - 1 2 2 - - -
CO2 3 3 1 1 3 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 - - -
CO3 3 3 2 1 3 1 3 1 1 1 2 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 2 2 3 2 2 1 1 1 2 3 - - -
CO5 2 2 1 - 3 1 2 1 1 1 3 3 - - -
Avg 2.8 2.4 1.6 0.8 2.4 1 2.2 1 0.8 1 2.2 2.6 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMA354 LINEAR ALGEBRA LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To test the consistency and solve system of linear equations.
 To find the basis and dimension of vector space.
 To obtain the matrix of linear transformation and its eigenvalues and eigenvectors.
 To find orthonormal basis of inner product space and find least square approximation.
 To find eigenvalues of a matrix using numerical techniques and perform matrix
decomposition.

UNIT I MATRICES AND SYSTEM OF LINEAR EQUATIONS 9


Matrices - Row echelon form - Rank - System of linear equations - Consistency - Gauss elimination
method - Gauss Jordan method.

270
UNIT II VECTOR SPACES 9
Vector spaces over Real and Complex fields - Subspace – Linear space - Linear independence
and dependence - Basis and dimension.

UNIT III LINEAR TRANSFORMATION 9


Linear transformation - Rank space and null space - Rank and nullity - Dimension theorem– Matrix
representation of linear transformation - Eigenvalues and eigenvectors of linear transformation –
Diagonalization.

UNIT IV INNER PRODUCT SPACES 9


Inner product and norms - Properties - Orthogonal, Orthonormal vectors - Gram Schmidt
orthonormalization process - Least square approximation.

UNIT V EIGEN VALUE PROBLEMS AND MATRIX DECOMPOSITION 9


Eigen value Problems : Power method, Jacobi rotation method - Singular value decomposition –
QR decomposition.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After the completion of the course the student will be able to
CO1:Test the consistency and solve system of linear equations.
CO2:Find the basis and dimension of vector space.
CO3:Obtain the matrix of linear transformation and its eigenvalues and eigenvectors.
CO4:Find orthonormal basis of inner product space and find least square approximation.
CO5:Find eigenvalues of a matrix using numerical techniques and perform matrix decomposition.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Faires J.D. and Burden R., Numerical Methods, Brooks/Cole (Thomson Publications), New
Delhi, 2002.
2. Friedberg A.H, Insel A.J. and Spence L, Linear Algebra, Pearson Education, 5th Edition,2019.

REFERENCES
1. Bernard Kolman, David R. Hill, Introductory Linear Algebra, Pearson Educations, New Delhi,
8th Edition, 2009.
2. Gerald C.F. and Wheatley P.O, Applied Numerical Analysis, Pearson Educations, New Delhi,
7th Edition, 2007.
3. Kumaresan S, Linear Algebra - A geometric approach, Prentice Hall of India, New Delhi,
Reprint, 2010.
4. Richard Branson, Matrix Operations, Schaum's outline series, 1989.
5. Strang G, Linear Algebra and its applications, Thomson (Brooks / Cole) New Delhi, 4th
Edition, 2005.
6. Sundarapandian V, Numerical Linear Algebra, Prentice Hall of India, New Delhi, 2014.

271
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO2 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO5 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
Avg 3 3 3 3 2.8 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OCE353 LEAN CONCEPTS, TOOLS AND PRACTICES LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To impart knowledge about the basics of lean principles, tools and techniques, and
implementation in the construction industry.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction and overview of the construction project management - Review of Project
Management & Productivity Measurement Systems - Productivity in Construction - Daily Progress
Report-The state of the industry with respect to its management practices -construction project
phases - The problems with current construction management techniques.

UNIT II LEAN MANAGEMENT 9


Introduction to lean management - Toyota’s management principle-Evolution of lean in
construction industry - Production theories in construction –Lean construction value - Value in
construction - Target value design - Lean project delivery system- Forms of waste in construction
industry - Waste Elimination.

UNIT III CORE CONCEPTS IN LEAN 9


Concepts in lean thinking – Principles of lean construction – Variability and its impact – Traditional
construction and lean construction – Traditional project delivery - Lean construction and workflow
reliability – Work structuring – Production control.

UNIT IV LEAN TOOLS AND TECHNIQUES 9


Value Stream Mapping – Work sampling – Last planner system – Flow and pull based production –
Last Planner System – Look ahead schedule – constraint analysis – weekly planning meeting-
Daily Huddles – Root cause analysis – Continuous improvement – Just in time.

UNIT V LEAN IMPLEMENTATION IN CONSTRUCTION INDUSTRY 9


Lean construction implementation- Enabling lean through information technology - Lean in design -
Design Structure - BIM (Building Information Modelling) - IPD (Integrated Project Delivery) –
Sustainability through lean construction approach.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOME:
On completion of this course, the student is expected to be able t o

272
CO1 Explains the contemporary management techniques and the issues in present scenario.
CO2 Apply the basics of lean management principles and their evolution from manufacturing
industry to construction industry.
CO3 Develops a better understanding of core concepts of lean construction tools and techniques
and their importance in achieving better productivity.
CO4 Apply lean techniques to achieve sustainability in construction projects.
CO5 Apply lean construction techniques in design and modeling.

REFERENCES:
1. Corfe, C. and Clip, B., Implementing lean in construction: Lean and the sustainability agenda,
CIRIA, 2013.
2. Shang Gao and Sui Pheng Low, Lean Construction Management: The Toyota Way, Springer,
2014.
3. Dave, B., Koskela, L., Kiviniemi, A., Owen, R., andTzortzopoulos, P.,Implementing lean in
construction: Lean construction and BIM, CIRIA, 2013.
4. Ballard, G., Tommelein, I., Koskela, L. and Howell, G., Lean construction tools and
techniques, 2002.
5. Salem, O., Solomon, J., Genaidy, A. and Luegring, M., Site implementation and Assessment
of Lean Construction Techniques, Lean Construction Journal, 2005.

OBT352 BASICS OF MICROBIAL TECHNOLOGY LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 Enable the Non-biological student’s to understand about the basics of life science and their
pro and cons for living organisms.

UNIT I BASICS OF MICROBES AND ITS TYPES 9


Introduction to microbes, existence of microbes, inventions of great scientist and history, types of
microorganisms – Bacteria, Virus, Fungi.

UNIT II MICROBIAL TECHNIQUES 9


Sterilization – types – physical and chemical sterilization, Decontamination, Preservation methods,
fermentation, Cultivation and growth of microbes, Diagnostic methods.

UNIT III PATHOGENIC MICROBES 9


Infectious Disease – Awareness, Causative agent, Prevention and control - Cholera, Dengu,
Malaria, Diarrhea, Tuberculosis, Typhoid, Covid, HIV.

UNIT IV BENEFICIAL MICROBES 9


Applications of microbes – Clinical microbiology, agricultural microbiology, Food Microbiology,
Environmental Microbiology, Animal Microbiology, Marine Microbiology.

UNIT V PRODUCTS FROM MICROBES 9


Fermentedproducts – Fermented Beverages, Curd, Cheese, Mushroom, Agricultural products –
Biopesticide, Biofertilizers, Vermi compost, Pharmaceutical products - Antibiotics, Vaccines
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

273
COURSE OUTCOME:
At the end of the course the students will be able to
CO1:Microbes and their types
CO2:Cultivation of microbes
CO3:Pathogens and control measures for safety
CO4:Microbes in different industry for economy.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Talaron K, Talaron A, Casita, Pelczar and Reid. Foundations in Microbiology, W.C. Brown
Publishers, 1993.
2. Pelczar MJ, Chan ECS and Krein NR, Microbiology, Tata McGraw Hill Edition, New Delhi, India.
3. Prescott L.M., Harley J.P., Klein DA, Microbiology, 3rd Edition, Wm. C. Brown Publishers, 1996.

OBT353 BASICS OF BIOMOLECULES LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 The objective is to offer basic concepts of biochemistry to students with diverse background
in life sciences including but not limited to the structure and function of various biomolecules and
their metabolism.

UNIT I CARBOHYDRATES 9
Introduction to carbohydrate, classification, properties of monosaccharide, structural aspects of
monosaccharides. Introduction to disaccharide (lactose, maltose, sucrose) and polysaccharide
(Heparin, starch, and glycogen) biological function of carbohydrate.

UNIT II LIPID AND FATTY ACIDS 9


Introduction to lipid, occurrence, properties, classification of lipid. Importance of phospholipids,
sphingolipid and glycerolipid. Biological function of lipid. Fatty acid, Introduction, Nomenclature and
classification of fatty acid Essential and non essential fatty acids.

UNIT III AMINO ACIDS AND PROTEIN. 9


Introduction to amino acid, structure, classification of protein based on polarity. Introduction to
protein, classification of protein based on solubility, shape, composition and Function. Peptide
bond– Structure of peptide bond. Denauration – renaturation of protein, properties of protein.
Introduction to lipoprotein, glycoprotein and nucleoprotein.Biological function of protein.

UNIT IV NUCLEIC ACIDS 9


Introduction to nucleic acid, Difference between nucleotide and nucleoside, composition of DNA &
amp; RNA Structure of Nitrogen bases in DNA and RNA along with the nomenclature· DNA double
helix (Watson and crick) model, types of DNA, RNA.

274
UNIT V VITAMINS AND HORMONES 9
Different types of vitamins, their diverse biochemical functions and deficiency related diseases.
Overview of hormones. Hormone mediated signaling. Mechanism of action of steroid hormones,
epinephrine, glucagons and insulin.Role of vitamins and hormones in metabolism; Hormonal
disorders; Therapeutic uses ofvitamins and hormones.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:Students will learn about various kinds of biomolecules and their physiological role.
CO2:Students will gain knowledge about various metabolic disorders and will help them to know
the importance of various biomolecules in terms of disease correlation.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Lehninger Principles of Biochemistry 6th Edition by David L. Nelson, Michael M. Cox
W.H.Freeman and Company 2017
2. Satyanarayana, U. and U. Chakerapani, “Biochemistry” 3rd Rev. Edition, Books &
Allied (P) Ltd., 2006. 3. Rastogi, S.C. “Biochemistry” 2nd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2003.
3. Conn, E.E., etal., “Outlines of Biochemistry” 5th Edition, John Wiley & Sons, 1987.
4. Outlines of Biochemistry, 5th Edition: By E E Conn, P K Stumpf, G Bruening and R Y
Doi.pp 693. John Wiley and Sons, New York. 1987.
REFERENCES
1. Berg, Jeremy M. et al. “Biochemsitry”, 6th Edition, W.H. Freeman & Co., 2006.
2. Murray, R.K., etal “Harper’s Illustrated Biochemistry”, 31st Edition, McGraw-Hill, 2018.
3. Voet, D. and Voet, J.G., “Biochemistry”, 4th Edition, John Wiley & Sons Inc., 2010.

OBT354 FUNDAMENTALS OF CELL AND MOLECULAR BIOLOGY LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To provide knowledge on the fundamentals of cell biology.
 To understand the signalling mechanisms.
 Understand basic principles of molecular biology at intracellular level to regulate growth,
division and development.

UNIT-I INTRODUCTION TO CELL 9


Cell, cell wall and Extracellular Matrix (ECM), composition, cellular dimensions, Evolution,
Organisation, differentiation of prokaryotic and Eukaryotic cells, Virus, bacteria,cyanobacteria,
mycoplasma and prions.

UNIT II CELL ORGANELLES 9


Molecular organisation, biogenesis and functin Mitochondria, endoplasmic reticulam, golgi
apparatus, plastids, chloroplast, leucoplast, centrosome, lysosome, ribosome, peroxisome,
Nucleus and nucleolus. Endo membrane system, concept of compartmentalisation.

UNIT III BIO-MEMBRANE TRANSPORT 9


Physiochemical properties of cell membranes. Molecular constitute of membranes, asymmetrical
organisation of lipids and proteins. Solute transport across membrane’s-fick’s law, simple diffusion,
passive-facilitated diffusion, active transport- primary and secondary, group translocation, transport
275
ATPases, membrane transport in bacteria and animals. Transportmechanism- mobile carriers and
pores mechanisms. Transport by vesicle formation, endocytosis, exocytosis, cell respiration.

UNIT IV CELL CYCLE 9


Cell cycle- Cell division by mitosis and meosis, Comparision of meosis and mitosis, regulation of
cell cycle, cell lysis, Cytokinesis, Cell signaling, Cell communication, Cell adhesion and Cell
junction, cell cycle checkpoints.

UNIT V CENTRAL DOGMA 9


Overview of Central dogma DNA replication: Meselson & Stahl experiment, bi–directional
DNA replication, Okazaki fragments. Structure and function of mRNA, rRNA and tRNA. RNA
synthesis: Initiation, elongation and termination of RNA synthesis Introduction to Genetic code-
Steps in translation: Initiation, Elongation and termination of protein synthesis.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:Understanding of cell at structural and functional level.
CO2:Understand the central dogma of life and its significance.
CO3:Comprehend the basic mechanisms of cell division.

TEXTBOOKS:
1. Cooper, G.M. and R.E. Hansman “The Cell: A Molecular Approach”, 8th Edition, Oxford
University Press, 2018
2. Friefelder, David. “Molecular Biology.” Narosa Publications, 1999
3. Weaver, Robert F. “Molecular Biology” IInd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2003.
REFERENCES:
1. Lodish H, Berk A, MatsudairaP,Kaiser CA, Krieger M, Schot MP, Zipursky L, Darnell J.
Molecular Cell Biology, 6th Edition, 2007.
2. Becker, W.M. etal., “The World of the Cell”, 9th Edition, Pearson Education, 2003.
3. Campbell, N.A., J.B. Recee and E.J. Simon “Essential Biology”, VIIrd Edition, Pearson
International, 2007.
4. Alberts, Bruce etal., “Essential Cell Biology”, 4th Edition, W.W. Norton, 2013.

OPEN ELECTIVE IV

OHS352 PROJECT REPORT WRITING L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE
The Course will enable Learners to,
 Understand the essentials of project writing.
 Perceive the difference between general writing and technical writing
 Assimilate the fundamental features of report writing.
 Understand the essential differences that exist between general and technical writing.
 Learn the structure of a technical and project report.

276
UNIT I 9
Writing Skills – Essential Grammar and Vocabulary – Passive Voice, Reported Speech, Concord,
Signpost words, Cohesive Devices – Paragraph writing - Technical Writing vs. General Writing.

UNIT II 9
Project Report – Definition, Structure, Types of Reports, Purpose – Intended Audience –
Plagiarism – Report Writing in STEM fields – Experiment – Statistical Analysis.

UNIT III 9
Structure of the Project Report: (Part 1) Framing a Title – Content – Acknowledgement – Funding
Details -Abstract – Introduction – Aim of the Study – Background - Writing the research question -
Need of the Study/Project Significance, Relevance – Determining the feasibility – Theoretical
Framework.

UNIT IV 9
Structure of the Project Report: (Part 2) – Literature Review, Research Design, Methods of Data
Collection - Tools and Procedures - Data Analysis - Interpretation - Findings –Limitations -
Recommendations – Conclusion – Bibliography.

UNIT V 9
Proof reading a report – Avoiding Typographical Errors – Bibliography in required Format – Font –
Spacing – Checking Tables and Illustrations – Presenting a Report Orally – Techniques.

TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
By the end of the course, learners will be able to
CO1:Write effective project reports.
CO2:Use statistical tools with confidence.
CO3:Explain the purpose and intension of the proposed project coherently and with clarity.
CO4:Create writing texts to suit achieve the intended purpose.
CO5:Master the art of writing winning proposals and projects.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO PO PSO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 1 1 1 1 3 2 2 3 3 3 3 - - -
2 2 2 2 1 1 1 2 1 2 3 2 3 - - -
3 2 2 3 3 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 3 - - -
4 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
5 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
AVg. 2.4 2.2 2.4 2.2 2 2.6 2.4 2.2 2.6 3 2.6 3 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

REFERENCES
1. Gerson and Gerson - Technical Communication: Process and Product, 7th Edition, Prentice
Hall(2012)

277
2. Virendra K. Pamecha - Guide to Project Reports, Project Appraisals and Project Finance
(2012)
3. Daniel Riordan - Technical Report Writing Today (1998)
4. Darla-Jean Weatherford - Technical Writing for Engineering Professionals (2016) Penwell
Publishers.

OMA355 ADVANCED NUMERICAL METHODS LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To impart knowledge on numerical methods that will come in handy to solve numerically the
problems that arise in engineering and technology. This will also serve as a precursor for future
research.

UNIT I ALGEBRAIC EQUATIONS AND EIGENVALUE PROBLEM 9


System of nonlinear equations : Fixed point iteration method - Newton's method; System of linear
equations: Thomas algorithm for tri diagonal system - SOR iteration methods ; Eigen value
problems: Given's method - Householder's method.

UNIT II INTERPOLATION 9
Central difference: Stirling and Bessel's interpolation formulae ; Piecewise spline interpolation:
Piecewise linear, piecewise quadratic and cubic spline ; Least square approximation for continuous
data (upto 3rd degree).

UNIT III NUMERICAL METHODS FOR ORDINARY DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS 9


Explicit Adams - Bashforth Techniques - Implicit Adams - Moulton Techniques, Predictor -
Corrector Techniques - Finite difference methods for solving two - point linear boundary value
problems - Orthogonal Collocation method.

UNIT IV FINITE DIFFERENCE METHODS FOR ELLIPTIC EQUATIONS 9


Laplace and Poisson’s equations in a rectangular region : Five point finite difference schemes -
Leibmann’s iterative methods - Dirichlet's and Neumann conditions – Laplace equation in polar
coordinates : Finite difference schemes .

UNIT V FINITE DIFFERENCE METHOD FOR TIME DEPENDENT PARTIAL


DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS 9
Parabolic equations : Explicit and implicit finite difference methods – Weighted average
approximation - Dirichlet's and Neumann conditions – First order hyperbolic equations - Method of
characteristics - Different explicit and implicit methods; Wave equation : Explicit scheme –
Stability of above schemes.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: demonstrate the understandings of common numerical methods for nonlinear equations,
system of linear equations and eigenvalue problems;
CO2: understand the interpolation theory;
CO3: understand the concepts of numerical methods for ordinary differential equations;
CO4: demonstrate the understandings of common numerical methods for elliptic equations;
CO5: understand the concepts of numerical methods for time dependent partial differential
equations

278
TEXT BOOKS :
1. Grewal, B.S., "Numerical Methods in Engineering & Science ", Khanna Publications,
Delhi, 2013.
2. Gupta, S.K., "Numerical Methods for Engineers", (Third Edition), New Age Publishers, 2015.
3. Jain, M.K., Iyengar, S.R.K. and Jain, R.K., "Computational Methods for Partial Differential
Equations", New Age Publishers, 1994.

REFERENCES:
1. Saumyen Guha and Rajesh Srivastava, "Numerical methods for Engineering and Science",
Oxford Higher Education, New Delhi, 2010.
2. Burden, R.L., and Faires, J.D., “Numerical Analysis – Theory and Applications”, 9 th Edition,
Cengage Learning, New Delhi, 2016.
3. Gupta S.K., “Numerical Methods for Engineers”,4th Edition, New Age Publishers, 2019.
4. Sastry, S.S., “Introductory Methods of Numerical Analysis”, 5th Edition, PHI Learning, 2015.
5. Morton, K.W. and Mayers D.F., "Numerical solution of Partial Differential equations",
Cambridge University press, Cambridge, 2002.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO2 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO5 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
Avg 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMA356 RANDOM PROCESSES L T P C


3 0 0 3

COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the basic concepts of probability, one and two dimensional random variables with
applications to engineering which can describe real life phenomenon.
 To understand the basic concepts of random processes which are widely used in
communication networks.
 To acquaint with specialized random processes which are apt for modelling the real time
scenario.
 To understand the concept of correlation and spectral densities.
 To understand the significance of linear systems with random inputs.

UNIT I RANDOM VARIABLES 9


Discrete and continuous random variables – Moments – Moment generating functions – Joint
Distribution- Covariance and Correlation – Transformation of a random variable.

279
UNIT II RANDOM PROCESSES 9
Classification – Characterization – Cross correlation and Cross covariance functions - Stationary
Random Processes – Markov process - Markov chain.

UNIT III SPECIAL RANDOM PROCESSES 9


Bernoulli Process – Gaussian Process - Poisson process – Random telegraph process.

UNIT IV CORRELATION AND SPECTRAL DENSITIES 9


Auto correlation functions – Cross correlation functions – Properties – Power spectral density –
Cross spectral density – Properties.

UNIT V LINEAR SYSTEMS WITH RANDOM INPUTS 9


Linear time invariant system – System transfer function – Linear systems with random inputs –
Auto correlation and cross correlation functions of input and output.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:

CO1:Understand the basic concepts of one and two dimensional random variables and apply in
engineering applications.
CO2:Apply the concept random processes in engineering disciplines.
CO3:Understand and apply the concept of correlation and spectral densities.
CO4:Get an exposure of various distribution functions and help in acquiring skills in handling
situations involving more than one variable.
CO5:Analyze the response of random inputs to linear time invariant systems.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Ibe, O.C.," Fundamentals of Applied Probability and Random Processes ", 1st Indian
Reprint, Elsevier, 2007.
2. Peebles, P.Z., "Probability, Random Variables and Random Signal Principles ", Tata
McGraw Hill, 4th Edition, New Delhi, 2002.

REFERENCES
1. Cooper. G.R., McGillem. C.D., "Probabilistic Methods of Signal and System Analysis",
Oxford University Press, New Delhi, 3rd Indian Edition, 2012.
2. Hwei Hsu, "Schaum’s Outline of Theory and Problems of Probability, Random
Variables and Random Processes ", Tata McGraw Hill Edition, New Delhi, 2004.
3. Miller. S.L. and Childers. D.G., “Probability and Random Processes with Applications to
Signal Processing and Communications ", Academic Press, 2004.
4. Stark. H. and Woods. J.W., “Probability and Random Processes with Applications to Signal
Processing ", Pearson Education, Asia, 3rd Edition, 2002.
5. Yates. R.D. and Goodman. D.J., “Probability and Stochastic Processes", Wiley India Pvt.
Ltd., Bangalore, 2nd Edition, 2012.

280
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
CO2 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
CO3 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
CO4 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
CO5 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
Avg 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -

1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMA357 QUEUEING AND RELIABILITY MODELLING LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To provide necessary basic concepts in probability and random processes for applications
such as random signals, linear systems in communication engineering.
 To understand the concept of queueing models and apply in engineering.
 To provide the required mathematical support in real life problems and develop probabilistic
models which can be used in several areas of science and engineering.
 To study the system reliability and hazard function for series and parallel systems.
 To implement Markovian Techniques for availability and maintainability which opens up new
avenues for research.
UNIT I RANDOM PROCESSES 9
Classification – Stationary process – Markov process - Poisson process – Discrete parameter
Markov chain – Chapman Kolmogorov equations – Limiting distributions.

UNIT II MARKOVIAN QUEUEING MODELS 9


Markovian queues – Birth and death processes – Single and multiple server queueing models –
Little’s formula - Queues with finite waiting rooms.

UNIT III ADVANCED QUEUEING MODELS 9


M/G/1 queue – Pollaczek Khinchin formula - M/D/1 and M/EK/1 as special cases – Series
queues – Open Jackson networks.

UNIT IV SYSTEM RELIABILITY 9


Reliability and hazard functions- Exponential, Normal, Weibull and Gamma failure distribution –
Time - dependent hazard models – Reliability of Series and Parallel Systems.

UNIT V MAINTAINABILITY AND AVAILABILITY 9


Maintainability and Availability functions – Frequency of failures – Two Unit parallel system with
repair – k out of m systems.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:

281
CO1:Enable the students to apply the concept of random processes in engineering disciplines.
CO2:Students acquire skills in analyzing various queueing models.
CO3:Students can understand and characterize phenomenon which evolve with respect to time in
a probabilistic manner.
CO4:Students can analyze reliability of the systems for various probability distributions.
CO5:Students can be able to formulate problems using the maintainability and availability analyses
by using theoretical approach.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Shortle J.F, Gross D, Thompson J.M,Harris C.M., “Fundamentals of Queueing Theory”, John
Wiley and Sons, New York,2018.
2. Balagurusamy E., “Reliability Engineering”, Tata McGraw Hill Publishing Company Ltd., New
Delhi,2010.

REFERENCES
1. Medhi J, ”Stochastic models of Queueing Theory”, Academic Press, Elsevier, Amsterdam,
2003.
2. Taha, H.A., "Operations Research", 9th Edition, Pearson India Education Services, Delhi, 2016.
3. Trivedi, K.S., "Probability and Statistics with Reliability, Queueing and Computer Science
Applications", 2nd Edition, John Wiley and Sons, 2002.
4. Govil A.K., “Reliability Engineering”, Tata-McGraw Hill Publishing Company Ltd., New
Delhi,1983.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO2 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO3 3 3 0 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO4 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO5 3 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
Avg 3 3 1.4 0.8 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMG354 PRODUCTION AND OPERATIONS MANAGEMENT FOR ENTREPRENEURS


L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To know the basic concept and function of Production and Operation Management for
entrepreneurship.
 To understand the Production process and planning.
 To understand the Production and Operations Management Control for business owners.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO PRODUCTION AND OPERATIONS MANGEMENT 9


Functions of Production Management - Relationship between production and other functions –
Production management and operations management, Characteristics of modern production and

282
operation management, organisation of production function, recent trends in production /operations
management - production as an organisational function, decision making in production Operations
research

UNIT II PRODUCTION & OPERATION SYSTEMS 9


Production Systems- principles – Models - CAD and CAM- Automation in Production - Functions
and significance- Capacity and Facility Planning: Importance of capacity planning- Capacity
measurement – Capacity Requirement Planning (CRP) process for manufacturing and service
industry

UNIT III PRODUCTION & OPERATIONS PLANNING 9


Facility Planning – Location of facilities – Location flexibility – Facility design process and
techniques – Location break even analysis-Production Process Planning: Characteristic of
production process systems – Steps for production process- Production Planning Control
Functions – Planning phase- Action phase- Control phase - Aggregate production planning

UNIT IV PRODUCTION & OPERATIONS MANAGEMENT PROCESS 9


Process selection with PLC phases- Process simulation tools- Work Study – Significance –
Methods, evolution of normal/ standard time – Job design and rating - Value Analysis - Plant
Layout: meaning – characters –- Plant location techniques - Types- MRP and Layout Design -
Optimisation and Theory of Constraints (TOC)– Critical Chain Project Management (CCPM)- REL
(Relationship) Chart – Assembly line balancing- – Plant design optimisation -Forecasting methods.

UNIT V CONTROLING PRODUCTION & OPERATIONS MANAGEMENT 9


Material requirement planning (MRP)- Concept- Process and control - Inventory control systems
and techniques – JIT and Lean manufacturing - Network techniques - Quality Management:
Preventive Vs Breakdown maintenance for Quality – Techniques for measuring quality - Control
Chart (X , R , p , np and C chart ) - Cost of Quality, Continuous improvement (Kaizen) - Quality
awards - Supply Chain Management - Total Quality Management - 6 Sigma approach and Zero
Defect Manufacturing.
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon completion of this course the learners will be able :
CO 1 To understand the basics and functions of Production and Operation Management for
business owners.
CO 2 To learn about the Production & Operation Systems.
CO 3 To acquaint on the Production & Operations Planning Techniques followed by entrepreneurs
in Industries.
CO 4 To known about the Production & Operations Management Processes in organisations.
CO 5 To comprehend the techniques of controlling , Production and Operations in industries.

REFERENCES
1. Mikell P. Groover, Automation, Production Systems, and Computer-Integrated Manufacturing,
Pearson, 2007.
2. Amitabh Raturi, Production and Inventory Management, , 2008.
3. Adam Jr. Ebert, Production and Operations Management, PHI Publication, 1992.
4. Muhlemann, Okland and Lockyer, Production and Operation Management, Macmillan
India,1992.
283
6. Chary S.N, Production and Operations Management, TMH Publications, 2010.
7. Terry Hill ,Operation Management. Pal Grave McMillan (Case Study).2005.

OMG355 MULTIVARIATE DATA ANALYSIS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To know various multivariate data analysis techniques for business research.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Uni-variate, Bi-variate and Multi-variate techniques – Classification of multivariate techniques –
Guidelines for multivariate analysis and interpretation.

UNIT II PREPARING FOR MULTIVARIATE ANALYSIS 9


Conceptualization of research model with variables, collection of data –-Approaches for dealing
with missing data – Testing the assumptions of multivariate analysis.

UNIT III MULTIPLE LINEAR REGRESSION ANALYSIS, FACTOR ANALYSIS 9


Multiple Linear Regression Analysis – Inferences from the estimated regression function –
Validation of the model. -Approaches to factor analysis – interpretation of results.

UNIT IV LATENT VARIABLE TECHNIQUES 9


Confirmatory Factor Analysis, Structural equation modelling, Mediation models, Moderation
models, Longitudinal studies.

UNIT V ADVANCED MULTIVARIATE TECHNIQUES 9


Multiple Discriminant Analysis, Logistic Regression, Cluster Analysis, Conjoint Analysis,
multidimensional scaling.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOMES :
CO1: Demonstrate a sophisticated understanding of the concepts and methods; know the exact
scopes and possible limitations of each method; and show capability of using multivariate
techniques to provide constructive guidance in decision making.
CO2:Use advanced techniques to conduct thorough and insightful analysis, and interpret the
results correctly with detailed and useful information.
CO3:Show substantial understanding of the real problems; conduct deep analysis using correct
methods; and draw reasonable conclusions with sufficient explanation and elaboration.
CO4:Write an insightful and well-organized report for a real-world case study, including thoughtful
and convincing details.
CO5:Make better business decisions by using advanced techniques in data analytics. ‘

REFERENCES :
1. Joseph F Hair, Rolph E Anderson, Ronald L. Tatham & William C. Black, Multivariate Data
Analysis, Pearson Education, New Delhi, 2005.
2. Barbara G. Tabachnick, Linda S.Fidell, Using Multivariate Statistics, 6th Edition, Pearson,
2012.

284
3. Richard A Johnson and Dean W.Wichern, Applied Multivariate Statistical Analysis, Prentice
Hall, New Delhi, 2005.
4. David R Anderson, Dennis J Seveency, and Thomas A Williams, Statistics for Business and
Economics, Thompson, Singapore, 2002

OME352 ADDITIVE MANUFACTURING L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the development, capabilities, applications, of Additive Manufacturing (AM),
and its business opportunities.
 To be acquainted with vat polymerization and material extrusion processes
 To be familiar with powder bed fusion and binder jetting processes.
 To gain knowledge on applications of direct energy deposition, and material jetting
processes.
 To impart knowledge on sheet lamination and direct write technologies.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Overview - Need - Development of Additive Manufacturing (AM) Technology: Rapid Prototyping-
Rapid Tooling - Rapid Manufacturing - Additive Manufacturing. AM Process Chain - ASTM/ISO
52900 Classification - Benefits - AM Unique Capabilities - AM File formats: STL, AMF Applications:
Building Printing, Bio Printing, Food Printing, Electronics Printing, Automobile, Aerospace,
Healthcare. Business Opportunities in AM.

UNIT II VAT POLYMERIZATION AND MATERIAL EXTRUSION 9


Photo polymerization: Stereolithography Apparatus (SLA)- Materials -Process - top down and
bottom up approach - Advantages - Limitations - Applications. Digital Light Processing (DLP) -
Process - Advantages - Applications.
Material Extrusion: Fused Deposition Modeling (FDM) - Process-Materials -Applications and
Limitations.

UNIT III POWDER BED FUSION AND BINDER JETTING 9


Powder Bed Fusion: Selective Laser Sintering (SLS): Process - Powder Fusion Mechanism -
Materials and Application. Selective Laser Melting (SLM), Electron Beam Melting (EBM): Materials
- Process - Advantages and Applications.
Binder Jetting: Three-Dimensional Printing - Materials - Process - Benefits - Limitations -
Applications.

UNIT IV MATERIAL JETTING AND DIRECTED ENERGY DEPOSITION 9


Material Jetting: Multijet Modeling- Materials - Process - Benefits - Applications.
Directed Energy Deposition: Laser Engineered Net Shaping (LENS) - Process - Material Delivery -
Materials -Benefits -Applications.

UNIT V SHEET LAMINATION AND DIRECT WRITE TECHNOLOGY 9


Sheet Lamination: Laminated Object Manufacturing (LOM)- Basic Principle- Mechanism: Gluing or
Adhesive Bonding - Thermal Bonding - Materials - Application and Limitation.
Ink-Based Direct Writing (DW): Nozzle Dispensing Processes, Inkjet Printing Processes, Aerosol
DW - Applications of DW.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
285
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course students shall be able to:
CO1: Recognize the development of AM technology and how AM technology propagated into
various businesses and developing opportunities.
CO2: Acquire knowledge on process vat polymerization and material extrusion processes and its
applications.
CO3: Elaborate the process and applications of powder bed fusion and binder jetting.
CO4: Evaluate the advantages, limitations, applications of material jetting and directed energy
deposition processes.
CO5: Acquire knowledge on sheet lamination and direct write technology.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Ian Gibson, David Rosen, Brent Stucker, Mahyar Khorasani “Additive manufacturing
technologies”. 3rd edition Springer Cham, Switzerland. (2021). ISBN: 978-3-030-56126-0
2. Andreas Gebhardt and Jan-Steffen Hötter “Additive Manufacturing: 3D Printing for Prototyping
and Manufacturing”, Hanser publications, United States, 2015, ISBN: 978-1-56990-582-

REFERENCES:
1. Andreas Gebhardt, “Understanding Additive Manufacturing: Rapid Prototyping, Rapid
Manufacturing”, Hanser Gardner Publication, Cincinnati., Ohio, 2011, ISBN :9783446425521.
2. Milan Brandt, “Laser Additive Manufacturing: Materials, Design, Technologies, and
Applications”, Woodhead Publishing., United Kingdom, 2016, ISBN: 9780081004333.
3. Amit Bandyopadhyay and Susmita Bose, “Additive Manufacturing”, 1st Edition, CRC Press.,
United States, 2015, ISBN-13: 978-1482223590.
4. Kamrani A.K. and Nasr E.A., “Rapid Prototyping: Theory and practice”, Springer., United States
,2006, ISBN: 978-1-4614-9842-1.
5. Liou, L.W. and Liou, F.W., “Rapid Prototyping and Engineering applications: A tool box for
prototype development”, CRC Press., United States, 2011, ISBN: 9780849334092.

CME343 NEW PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To introduce the fundamental concepts of the new product development
 To develop material specifications, analysis and process.
 To Learn the Feasibility Studies & reporting of new product development.
 To study the New product qualification and Market Survey on similar products of new product
development
 To learn Reverse Engineering. Cloud points generation, converting cloud data to 3D model

UNIT I FUNDAMENTALS OF NPD 9


Introduction – Reading of Drawing – Grid reading, Revisions, ECN (Engg. Change Note), Component
material grade, Specifications, customer specific requirements – Basics of monitoring of NPD applying
Gantt chart, Critical path analysis – Fundamentals of BOM (Bill of Materials), Engg. BOM & Manufacturing
BOM. Basics of MIS software and their application in industries like SAP, MS Dynamics, Oracle ERP
Cloud – QFD.

286
UNIT II MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS, ANALYSIS & PROCESS 9
Material specification standards – ISO, DIN, JIS, ASTM, EN, etc. – Awareness on various manufacturing
process like Metal castings & Forming, Machining (Conventional, 3 Axis, 4 Axis, 5 Axis, ), Fabrications,
Welding process. Qualifications of parts mechanical, physical & Chemical properties and their test report
preparation and submission. Fundamentals of DFMEA & PFMEA, Fundamentals of FEA, Bend Analysis,
Hot Distortion, Metal and Material Flow, Fill and Solidification analysis.

UNIT III ESSENTIALS OF NPD 9


RFQ (Request of Quotation) Processing – Feasibility Studies & reporting – CFT (Cross Function Team)
discussion on new product and reporting – Concept design, Machine selection for tool making, Machining
– Manufacturing Process selection, Machining Planning, cutting tool selection – Various Inspection
methods – Manual measuring, CMM – GOM (Geometric Optical Measuring), Lay out marking and Cut
section analysis. Tool Design and Detail drawings preparation, release of details to machine shop and
CAM programing. Tool assembly and shop floor trials. Initial sample submission with PPAP documents.

UNIT IV CRITERIONS OF NPD 9


New product qualification for Dimensions, Mechanical & Physical Properties, Internal Soundness proving
through X-Ray, Radiography, Ultrasonic Testing, MPT, etc. Agreement with customer for testing
frequencies. Market Survey on similar products, Risk analysis, validating samples with simulation
results, Lesson Learned & Horizontal deployment in NPD.

UNIT V REPORTING & FORWARD-THINKING OF NPD 9


Detailed study on PPAP with 18 elements reporting, APQP and its 5 Sections, APQP vs PPAP,
Importance of SOP (Standard Operating Procedure) – Purpose & documents, deployment in shop floor.
Prototyping & RPT - Concepts, Application and its advantages, 3D Printing – resin models, Sand cores for
foundries; Reverse Engineering. Cloud points generation, converting cloud data to 3D model –
Advantages & Limitation of RE, CE (Concurrent Engineering) – Basics, Application and its advantages in
NPD (to reduce development lead time, time to Market, Improve productivity and product cost.)
TOTAL :45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course the students would be able to
CO1:Discuss fundamental concepts and customer specific requirements of the New Product
development
CO2:Discuss the Material specification standards, analysis and fabrication, manufacturing process.
CO3:Develop Feasibility Studies & reporting of New Product development
CO4:Analyzing the New product qualification and Market Survey on similar products of new product
development
CO5:Develop Reverse Engineering. Cloud points generation, converting cloud data to 3D model
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Product Development – Sten Jonsson
2. Product Design & Development – Karl T. Ulrich, Maria C. Young, Steven D. Eppinger

REFERENCES:
1. Revolutionizing Product Development – Steven C Wheelwright & Kim B. Clark
2. Change by Design
3. Toyota Product Development System – James Morgan & Jeffrey K. Liker
287
4. Winning at New Products – Robert Brands 3rd Edition
5. Product Design & Value Engineering – Dr. M.A. Bulsara &Dr. H.R. Thakkar
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
2 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
3 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
4 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
5 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
Low (1) ; Medium (2) ; High (3)
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OME355 INDUSTRIAL DESIGN & RAPID PROTOTYPING TECHNIQUES LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The course aims to
 Outline Fundamental concepts in UI & UX
 Introduce the principles of Design and Building an mobile app
 Illustrate the use of CAD in product design
 Outline the choice and use of prototyping tools
 Understanding design of electronic circuits and fabrication of electronic devices

UNIT I UI/UX 9
Fundamental concepts in UI & UX - Tools - Fundamentals of design principles - Psychology and
Human Factors for User Interface Design - Layout and composition for Web, Mobile and
Devices - Typography - Information architecture - Color theory - Design process flow, wireframes,
best practices in the industry -User engagement ethics - Design alternatives

UNIT II APP DEVELOPMENT 9


SDLC - Introduction to App Development - Types of Apps - web Development -
understanding Stack - Frontend - backend - Working with Databases - Introduction to API -
Introduction to Cloud services - Cloud environment Setup- Reading and writing data to cloud
- Embedding ML models to Apps - Deploying application.

UNIT III INDUSTRIAL DESIGN 9


Introduction to Industrial Design - Points, lines, and planes - Sketching and concept
generation - Sketch to CAD - Introduction to CAD tools - Types of 3D modeling - Basic 3D
Modeling Tools - Part creation – Assembly - Product design and rendering basics - Dimensioning
& Tolerancing

UNIT IV MECHANICAL RAPID PROTOTYPING 9


Need for prototyping - Domains in prototyping - Difference between actual manufacturing and
prototyping - Rapid prototyping methods - Tools used in different domains - Mechanical
Prototyping; 3D Printing and classification - Laser Cutting and engraving - RD Works - Additive
manufacturing
288
UNIT V ELECTRONIC RAPID PROTOTYPING 9
Basics of electronic circuit design - lumped circuits - Electronic Prototyping - Working with
simulation tool - simple PCB design with EDA
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
At the end of the course, learners will be able to:
CO1:Create quick UI/UX prototypes for customer needs
CO2:Develop web application to test product traction / product feature
CO3:Develop 3D models for prototyping various product ideas
CO4:Built prototypes using Tools and Techniques in a quick iterative methodology

TEXT BOOKS
1. Peter Fiell, Charlotte Fiell, Industrial Design A-Z, TASCHEN America Llc(2003)
2. Samar Malik, Autodesk Fusion 360 - The Master Guide.
3. Steve Krug, Don't Make Me Think, Revisited: A Common Sense Approach to Web Usability,
Pearson,3rd edition(2014)

REFERENCES
1. https://www.adobe.com/products/xd/learn/get-star ted.html
2. https://developer.android.com/guide
3. https://help.autodesk.com/view/fusion360/ENU/courses/
4. https://help.prusa3d.com/en/categor y/prusaslicer_204

MF3010 MICRO AND PRECISION ENGINEERING LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
At the end of this course the student should be able to
 Learn about the precision machine tools
 Learn about the macro and micro components.
 Understand handling and operating of the precision machine tools.
 Learn to work with miniature models of existing machine tools/robots and other instruments.
 Learn metrology for micro system

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MICROSYSTEMS 9


Design, and material selection, micro-actuators: hydraulic, pneumatic, electrostatic/ magnetic etc.
for medical to general purpose applications. Micro-sensors based on Thermal, mechanical,
electrical properties; micro-sensors for measurement of pressure, flow, temperature, inertia, force,
acceleration, torque, vibration, and monitoring of manufacturing systems.

UNIT II FABRICATION PROCESSES FOR MICRO-SYSTEMS: 9


Additive, subtractive, forming process, microsystems-Micro-pumps, micro- turbines, micro
engines, micro-robot, and miniature biomedical devices

289
UNIT III INTRODUCTION TO PRECISION ENGINEERING 9
Machine tools, holding and handling devices, positioning fixtures for fabrication/ assembly of
microsystems. Precision drives: inch worm motors, ultrasonic motors, stick- slip mechanism and
other piezo-based devices.

UNIT IV PRECISION MACHINING PROCESSES 9


Precision machining processes for macro components - Diamond turning, fixed and free abrasive
processes, finishing processes.

UNIT V METROLOGY FOR MICRO SYSTEMS 9


Metrology for micro systems - Surface integrity and its characterization.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon the completion of this course the students will be able to
CO1:Select suitable precision machine tools and operate
CO2:Apply the macro and micro components for fabrication of micro systems.
CO3:Apply suitable machining process
CO4:Able to work with miniature models of existing machine tools/robots and other instruments.
CO5:Apply metrology for micro system

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Davim, J. Paulo, ed. Microfabrication and Precision Engineering: Research and
Development. Woodhead Publishing, 2017
2. Gupta K, editor. Micro and Precision Manufacturing. Springer; 2017
REFERENCES:
1. Dornfeld, D., and Lee, D. E., Precision Manufacturing, 2008, Springer.
2. H. Nakazawa, Principles of Precision Engineering, 1994, Oxford University Press.
3. Whitehouse, D. J., Handbook of Surface Metrology, Institute of Physics Publishing,
Philadelphia PA, 1994.
4. Murthy.R.L, ―Precision Engineering in Manufacturing‖, New Age International, New Delhi,
2005

OMF354 COST MANAGEMENT OF ENGINEERING PROJECTS LT PC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Summarize the costing concepts and their role in decision making
 Infer the project management concepts and their various aspects in selection
 Interpret costing concepts with project execution
 Develop knowledge of costing techniques in service sector and various budgetary control
techniques
 Illustrate with quantitative techniques in cost management

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO COSTING CONCEPTS 9


Objectives of a Costing System; Cost concepts in decision-making; Relevant cost, Differential cost,
Incremental cost and Opportunity cost; Creation of a Database for operational control.’

290
UNIT II INTRODUCTION TO PROJECT MANAGEMENT 9
Project: meaning, Different types, why to manage, cost overruns centres, various stages of project
execution: conception to commissioning. Project execution as conglomeration of technical and
nontechnical activities, Detailed Engineering activities, Pre project execution main clearances and
documents, Project team: Role of each member, Importance Project site: Data required with
significance, Project contracts

UNIT III PROJECT EXECUTION AND COSTING CONCEPTS 9


Project execution Project cost control, Bar charts and Network diagram, Project commissioning:
mechanical and process, Cost Behavior and Profit Planning Marginal Costing; Distinction between
Marginal Costing and Absorption Costing; Break-even Analysis, Cost-Volume-Profit Analysis,
Various decision-making problems, Pricing strategies: Pareto Analysis, Target costing, Life Cycle
Costing

UNIT IV COSTING OF SERVICE SECTOR AND BUDGETERY CONTROL 9


Just-in-time approach, Material Requirement Planning, Enterprise Resource Planning, Activity
Based Cost Management, Bench Marking; Balanced Score Card and Value-Chain Analysis,
Budgetary Control: Flexible Budgets; Performance budgets; Zero-based budgets.

UNIT V QUANTITATIVE TECHNIQUES FOR COST MANAGEMENT 9


Linear Programming, PERT/CPM, Transportation problems, Assignment problems, Learning Curve
Theory.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:
CO1: Understand the costing concepts and their role in decision making.
CO2: Understand the project management concepts and their various aspects in selection.
CO3: Interpret costing concepts with project execution.
CO4: Gain knowledge of costing techniques in service sector and various budgetary control
techniques.
CO5: Become familiar with quantitative techniques in cost management.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. John M. Nicholas, Herman Steyn Project Management for Engineering, Business and
Technology, Taylor & Francis, 2 August 2020, ISBN: 9781000092561.
2. Albert Lester ,Project Management, Planning and Control, Elsevier/Butterworth-Heinemann,
2007, ISBN: 9780750669566, 075066956X.

REFERENCES:
1. Ashish K. Bhattacharya, Principles & Practices of Cost Accounting A. H. Wheeler publisher,
1991.
2. Charles T. Horngren and George Foster, Advanced Management Accounting, 1988.
3. Charles T. Horngren et al Cost Accounting a Managerial Emphasis, Prentice Hall of India, New
Delhi, 2011.
4. Robert S Kaplan Anthony A. Alkinson, Management & Cost Accounting, 2003.
5. Vohra N.D., Quantitative Techniques in Management, Tata McGraw Hill Book Co. Ltd, 2007.

291
AU3002 BATTERIES AND MANAGEMENT SYSTEM L T PC
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The objective of this course is to make the students
 to understand the working and characteristics of different types of batteries and
their management .

UNIT I ADVANCED BATTERIES 9


Li-ion Batteries-different formats, chemistry, safe operating area, efficiency, aging. Characteristics-
SOC,DOD, SOH. Balancing-Passive Balancing Vs Active Balancing. Other Batteries-NCM and
NCA Batteries. NCR18650B specifications.

UNIT II BATTERY PACK 9


Battery Pack- design, sizing, calculations, flow chart, real and simulation Model.Peak power –
definition, testing methods-relationships with Power, Temperature and ohmic Internal Resistance.
Cloud based and Local Smart charging.

UNIT III BATTERY MODELLING 9


Battery Modelling Methods-Equivalent Circuit Models, Electrochemical Model, Neural Network
Model. ECM Comparisons- Rint model, Thevenin model, PNGV model. State space Models-
Introduction. Battery Modelling software/simulation frameworks

UNIT IV BATTERY STATE ESTIMATION 9


SOC Estimation- Definition, importance, single cell Vs series batteries SOC. Estimation Methods-
Load voltage, Electromotive force, AC impedance, Ah counting, Neural networks, Neuro-fuzzy
forecast method, Kalman filter. Estimation Algorithms.

UNIT V BMS ARCHITECTURE AND REAL TIME COMPONENTS 9


Battery Management System- need, operation, classification. BMS ASIC-bq76PL536A-Q1 Battery
Monitor IC- CC2662R-Q1 Wireless BMS MCU. Communication Modules- CAN Open-Flex Ray-
CANedge1 package.ARBIN Battery Tester. BMS Development with Modeling software and Model-
Based Design.
TOTAL :45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, students will be able to
CO1:Acquire knowledge of different Li-ion Batteries performance.
CO2:Design a Battery Pack and make related calculations.
CO3:Demonstrate a BatteryModel or Simulation.
CO4:Estimate State-of-Charges in a Battery Pack.
CO5:Approach different BMS architectures during real world usage.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Jiuchun Jiang and Caiping Zhang, “Fundamentals and applications of Lithium-Ion batteriesin
Electric Drive Vehicles’’, Wiley, 2015.
2. Davide Andrea ,“Battery Management Systems for Large Lithium-Ion Battery Packs” ARTECH
House, 2010.

292
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Developing Battery Management Systems with Simulink and Model-Based Design-whitepaper
2. Panasonic NCR18650B- DataSheet
3. bq76PL536A-Q1- IC DataSheet
4. CC2662R-Q1- IC DataSheet

AU3008 SENSORS AND ACTUATORS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 The objective of this course is to make the students to list common types of sensor and
actuators used in automotive vehicles.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MEASUREMENTS AND SENSORS 9


Sensors: Functions- Classifications- Main technical requirement and trends Units and standards-
Calibration methods- Classification of errors- Error analysis- Limiting error- Probable error-
Propagation of error- Odds and uncertainty- principle of transduction-Classification. Static
characteristics- mathematical model of transducers- Zero, First and Second order transducers-
Dynamic characteristics of first and second order transducers for standard test inputs.

UNIT II VARIABLE RESISTANCE AND INDUTANCE SENSORS 9


Principle of operation- Construction details- Characteristics and applications of resistive
potentiometer- Strain gauges- Resistive thermometers- Thermistors- Piezoresistive sensors
Inductive potentiometer- Variable reluctance transducers:- EI pick up and LVDT

UNIT III VARIABLE AND OTHER SPECIAL SENSORS 9


Variable air gap type, variable area type and variable permittivity type- capacitor microphone
Piezoelectric, Magnetostrictive, Hall Effect, semiconductor sensor- digital transducers-Humidity
Sensor. Rain sensor, climatic condition sensor, solar, light sensor, antiglare sensor.

UNIT IV AUTOMOTIVE ACTUATORS 9


Electromechanical actuators‐ Fluid‐mechanical actuators‐ Electrical machines‐ Direct‐current
machines‐ Three‐phase machines‐ Single‐phase alternating‐current Machines ‐ Duty‐type ratings
for electrical machines. Working principles, construction and location of actuators viz. Solenoid,
relay, stepper motor etc.

UNIT V AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL ACTUATORS 9


Different types of actuators used in automatic temperature control‐ Fixed and variable
displacement temperature control‐ Semi Automatic‐ Controller design for Fixed and variable
displacement type air conditioning system.
TOTAL =45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, the student will be able to
CO1:List common types of sensor and actuators used in vehicles.
CO2:Design measuring equipment’s for the measurement of pressure force, temperature and flow.
CO3:Generate new ideas in designing the sensors and actuators for automotive application
CO4:Understand the operation of thesensors, actuators and electronic control.

293
CO5:Design temperature control actuators for vehicles.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Doebelin's Measurement Systems: 7th Edition (SIE),Ernest O. Doebelin DhaneshN.Manik
McGraw Hill Publishers, 2019.
2. Robert Brandy, “ Automotive Electronics and Computer System”, Prentice Hall,2001
3. William Kimberley,” Bosch Automotive Handbook”, 6th Edition, Robert Bosch GmbH, 2004.
4. Bosch Automotive Electrics and Automotive Electronics Systems and Components,
Networking and Hybrid Drive, 5th Edition, 2007, ISBN No: 978‐3‐658‐01783‐5.

REFERENCES:
1. James D Halderman, “ Automotive Electrical and Electronics” , Prentice Hall, USA, 2013
2. Tom Denton, “Automotive Electrical and Electronics Systems,” Third Edition, 2004, SAE
International.
3. Patranabis.D, “ Sensors and Transducers”, 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall India Ltd,2003
4. William Ribbens, "Understanding Automotive Electronics ‐An Engineering Perspective," 7th
Edition, Elsevier Butterworth‐Heinemann Publishers, 2012.

OAS353 SPACE VEHICLES L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To interpret the missile space stations, space vs earth environment.
 To explain the life support systems, mission logistics and planning.
 To deploy the skills effectively in the understanding of space vehicle configuration design.
 To explain Engine system and support of space vehicle
 To interpret nose cone configuration of space vehicle

UNIT I FUNDAMENTAL ASPECTS 9


Energy and Efficiencies of power plants for space vehicles – Typical Performance Values –
Mission design – Structural design aspects during launch - role of launch environment on launch
vehicle integrity.

UNIT II SELECTION OF ROCKET PROPULSION SYSTEMS 9


Ascent flight mechanics – Launch vehicle selection process – Criteria for Selection for different
missions – selection of subsystems – types of staging – Interfaces – selection and criteria for
stages and their role in launch vehicle configuration design.

UNIT III ENGINE SYSTEMS, CONTROLS, AND INTEGRATION 9


Propellant Budget – Performance of Complete or Multiple Rocket Propulsion Systems – Engine
Design – Engine Controls – Engine System Calibration – System Integration and Engine
Optimization.

UNIT IV THRUST VECTOR CONTROL 9


TVC Mechanisms with a Single Nozzle – TVC with Multiple Thrust Chambers or Nozzles – Testing
– Integration with Vehicle – SITVC method – other jet control methods - exhaust plume problems in
space environment

294
UNIT V NOSE CONE CONFIGURATION 9
Aerodynamic aspects on the selection of nose shape of a launch vehicle - design factors in the
finalization of nose configuration with respect to payload - nose cone thermal protection system -
separation of fairings - payload injection mechanism
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion of this course, the student will be able to
CO1:Explain exotic space propulsion concepts, such as nuclear, solar sail, and antimatter.
CO2:Apply knowledge in selecting the appropriate rocket propulsion systems.
CO3:interpret the air-breathing propulsion suitable for initial stages and fly-back boosters.
CO4:Analyze aerodynamics aspect, including boost-phase lift and drag, hypersonic, and re-entry.
CO5:Adapt from aircraft engineers moving into launch vehicle, spacecraft, and hypersonic vehicle
design.

OIM352 MANAGEMENT SCIENCE LT PC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
Of this course are
 To introduce fundamental concepts of management and organization to students.
 Toi mpart knowledge to students on various aspects of marketing, quality control and
marketing strategies.
 To make students familiarize with the concepts of human resources management.
 To acquaint students with the concepts of project management and cost analysis.
 To make students familiarize with the concepts of planning process and business
strategies.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MANAGEMENT AND ORGANISATION 9


Concepts of Management and organization- nature, importance and Functions of Management,
Systems Approach to Management - Taylor's Scientific Management Theory- Fayal's Principles of
Management- Maslow's theory of Hierarchy of Human Needs- Douglas McGregor's
TheoryXandTheoryY-HertzbergTwoFactorTheoryofMotivation-
LeadershipStyles,Socialresponsibilities of Management, Designing Organisational Structures:
Basic concepts related to Organisation -Departmentation and Decentralisation.
UNIT II OPERATIONS AND MARKETING MANAGEMENT 9
Principles and Types of Plant Layout-Methods of Production(Job, batch and Mass
Production),Work Study - Basic procedure involved in Method Study and Work Measurement -
BusinessProcessReengineering(BPR)-
StatisticalQualityControl:controlchartsforVariablesandAttributes (simple Problems) and Acceptance
Sampling, Objectives of Inventory control, EOQ,ABC Analysis, Purchase Procedure, Stores
Management and Store Records - JIT System,Supply Chain Management, Functions of Marketing,
Marketing Mix, and Marketing Strategies based on ProductLifeCycle.

UNIT III HUMAN RESOURCES MANAGEMENT 9


Concepts of HRM, HRD and Personnel Management and Industrial Relations (PMIR), HRM vs
PMIR, Basic functions of HR Manager:Manpower planning, Recruitment, Selection,

295
TrainingandDevelopment,WageandSalaryAdministration,Promotion,Transfer,PerformanceAppraisa
l, Grievance Handling and Welfare Administration, Job Evaluation and Merit Rating –Capability
Maturity Model (CMM)Levels.

UNIT IV PROJECT MANAGEMENT 9


Network Analysis, Programme Evaluation and Review Technique (PERT), Critical Path
Method(CPM), identifying critical path, Probability of Completing the project within given time,
Project Cost Analysis,Project Crashing (simple problems).

UNIT V STRATEGIC MANAGEMENT AND CONTEMPORARY STRATEGIC ISSUES 9


Mission, Goals, Objectives, Policy, Strategy, Programmes, Elements of Corporate Planning
Process, Environmental Scanning, Value Chain Analysis, SWOT Analysis, Steps in Strategy
Formulation and Implementation, Generic Strategy alternatives. Bench Marking and Balanced
Score Cardas Contemporary Business Strategies.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, Students will be able to
CO1:Plananorganizationalstructureforagivencontextintheorganisationtocarryoutproductionoperatio
nsthroughWork-study.
CO2:Surveythemarkets,customersandcompetitionbetterandpricethegivenproductsappropriatey
CO3:Ensurequalityforagivenproduct or service.
CO4:Plan, schedule and control projects through PERTandCPM.
CO5:Evaluate strategyforabusiness orserviceorganisation.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 3
2 3 2 3 3 2 3 2 2
3 3 3 2 2 3 2 2 2
4 3 3 3 2 3 2 3 3
5 3 2 3 3 2 3 3 2 1
AVg. 3 2.6 2.8 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.4 2 2 2.5
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation
TEXTBOOKS:
1. KanishkaBedi, Production and Operations Management,Oxford University Press, 2007.
2. Stoner,Freeman,Gilbert, Management,6th Ed, PearsonEducation,NewDelhi,2004.
3. ThomasN.Duening & John M.Ivancevich Management Principles and Guidelines,
Biztantra,2007.
4. P.VijayKumar,N.Appa Rao and Ashnab, Chnalill, CengageLearning India,2012.

REFERECES:
1. KotlerPhilip and KellerKevinLane: Marketing Management, Pearson, 2012.
2. KoontzandWeihrich: Essentials of Management, McGrawHill, 2012.
3. Lawrence RJauch,R.Guptaand William F. Glueck: Business Policy and Strategic
Management Science,McGrawHill,2012.
4. SamuelC.Certo:Modern Management,2012.
296
OIM353 PRODUCTION PLANNING AND CONTROL L T PC
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the concept of production planning and control act work study,
 To apply the concept of product planning,
 To analyze the production scheduling,
 To apply the Inventory Control concepts.
 To prepare the manufacturing requirement Planning (MRP II) and Enterprise Resource
Planning (ERP).

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Objectives and benefits of planning and control-Functions of production control-Types of
production- job- batch and continuous-Product development and design-Marketing aspect -
Functional aspects- Operational aspect-Durability and dependability aspect aesthetic aspect. Profit
consideration- Standardization, Simplification & specialization- Break even analysis-Economics of
a new design.

UNIT II WORK STUDY 9


Method study, basic procedure-Selection-Recording of process - Critical analysis, Development -
Implementation - Micro motion and memo motion study – work measurement - Techniques of work
measurement - Time study - Production study - Work sampling - Synthesis from standard data -
Predetermined motion time standards.

UNIT III PRODUCT PLANNING AND PROCESS PLANNING 9


Product planning-Extending the original product information-Value analysis-Problems in lack of
product planning-Process planning and routing-Pre requisite information needed for process
planning- Steps in process planning-Quantity determination in batch production-Machine capacity,
balancing- Analysis of process capabilities in a multi product system.

UNIT IV PRODUCTION SCHEDULING 9


Production Control Systems-Loading and scheduling-Master Scheduling-Scheduling rules-Gantt
charts-Perpetual loading-Basic scheduling problems - Line of balance – Flow production
scheduling- Batch production scheduling-Product sequencing – Production Control systems-
Periodic batch control-Material requirement planning kanban – Dispatching-Progress reporting and
expediting- Manufacturing lead time-Techniques for aligning completion times and due dates.

UNIT V INVENTORY CONTROL AND RECENT TRENDS IN PPC 9


Inventory control-Purpose of holding stock-Effect of demand on inventories-Ordering procedures.
Two bin system - Ordering cycle system-Determination of Economic order quantity and economic
lot size- ABC analysis - Recorder procedure-Introduction to computer integrated production
planning systems- elements of JUST IN TIME SYSTEMS-Fundamentals of MRP II and ERP.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course,
CO1:The students can able to prepare production planning and control act work study,
CO2:The students can able to prepare product planning,
CO3:The students can able to prepare production scheduling,

297
CO4:The students can able to prepare Inventory Control.
CO5:They can plan manufacturing requirements manufacturing requirement Planning (MRP II) and
Enterprise Resource Planning (ERP).

TEXT BOOKS:
1. James. B. Dilworth, ”Operations management – Design, Planning and Control for manufacturing
and services” Mcgraw Hill International edition 1992.
2. Martand Telsang, “Industrial Engineering and Production Management”, First edition, S. Chand
and Company, 2000.

REFERENCES
1. Chary. S.N., “Theory and Problems in Production & Operations Management”, Tata McGraw
Hill, 1995.
2. Elwood S.Buffa, and Rakesh K.Sarin, “Modern Production / Operations Management”, 8th
Edition John Wiley and Sons, 2000
3. Jain. K.C. & Aggarwal. L.N., “Production Planning Control and Industrial Management”,
Khanna Publishers, 1990
4. Kanishka Bedi, “Production and Operations management”, 2nd Edition, Oxford university
press, 2007.
5. Melynk, Denzler, “ Operations management – A value driven approach” Irwin Mcgraw hill.
6. Norman Gaither, G. Frazier, “Operations Management” 9th Edition, Thomson learning IE,
2007
7. Samson Eilon, “Elements of Production Planning and Control”, Universal Book Corpn.1984
8. Upendra Kachru, “ Production and Operations Management – Text and cases” 1st Edition,
Excel books 2007
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 3 1 1 3
2 3 2 3 2
3 2 3 2
4 2 2
5 3 3 2 1
AVg. 3 2.6 2 3 1 1 3 1.8
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OIE353 OPERATIONS MANAGEMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 Recognize and appreciate the concept of Production and Operations Management in creating
and enhancing a firm’s competitive advantages.
 Describe the concept and contribution of various constituents of Production and Operations
Management (both manufacturing and service).
 Relate the interdependence of the operations function with the other key functional areas of a
firm.
 Teach analytical skills and problem-solving tools to the analysis of the operations problems.
 Apply scheduling and Lean Concepts for improving System Performance.
298
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO OPERATIONS MANAGEMENT 9
Operations Management – Nature, Importance, historical development, transformation processes,
differences between services and goods, a system perspective, functions, challenges, current
priorities, recent trends; Operations Strategy - Strategic fit , framework; Supply Chain
Management

UNIT II FORECASTING, CAPACITY AND FACILITY DESIGN 9


Demand Forecasting - Need, Types, COURSE OBJECTIVES and Steps. Overview of
Qualitative and Quantitative methods. Capacity Planning - Long range, Types, Developing
capacity alternatives. Overview of sales and operations planning. Overview of MRP, MRP II and
ERP. Facility Location – Theories, Steps in Selection, Location Models. Facility Layout –
Principles, Types, Planning tools and techniques.

UNIT III DESIGN OF PRODUCT, PROCESS AND WORK SYSTEMS 9


Product Design – Influencing factors, Approaches, Legal, Ethical and Environmental issues.
Process – Planning, Selection, Strategy, Major Decisions. Work Study – COURSE
OBJECTIVES, Procedure. Method Study and Motion Study. Work Measurement and
Productivity – Measuring Productivityand Methods to improve productivity.

UNIT IV MATERIALS MANAGEMENT 9


Materials Management – COURSE OBJECTIVES, Planning, Budgeting and Control.
Purchasing – COURSE OBJECTIVES, Functions, Policies, Vendor rating and Value Analysis.
Stores Management – Nature, Layout, Classification and Coding. Inventory – COURSE
OBJECTIVES, Costs and control techniques. Overview of JIT.

UNIT V SCHEDULING AND PROJECT MANAGEMENT 9


Project Management – Scheduling Techniques, PERT, CPM; Scheduling - work centers –
nature, importance; Priority rules and techniques, shopfloor control; Flow shop scheduling –
Johnson‟sAlgorithm – Gantt charts; personnel scheduling in services.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: The students will appreciate the role of Production and Operations management in enabling
and enhancing a firm’s competitive advantages in the dynamic business
environment.
CO2: The students will obtain sufficient knowledge and skills to forecast demand for
Production and Service Systems.
CO3: The students will able to Formulate and Assess Aggregate Planning strategies and
Material Requirement Plan.
CO4: The students will be able to develop analytical skills to calculate capacity requirements and
developing capacity alternatives.
CO5: The students will be able to apply scheduling and Lean Concepts for improving System
Performance.

299
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2
2 3 3 3 3
3 2 3 3 2 3
4 3 3 3 2 3
5 3 2
AVg. 3 2.6 3 2.6 2 2 3 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation
TEXT BOOKS
1. Richard B. Chase, Ravi Shankar, F. Robert Jacobs, Nicholas J. Aquilano, Operations
and Supply Management, Tata McGraw Hill, 12th Edition, 2010.
2. Norman Gaither and Gregory Frazier, Operations Management, South Western Cengage
Learning, 2002.

REFERENCES
1. William J Stevenson, Operations Management, Tata McGraw Hill, 9th Edition, 2009.
2. Russel and Taylor, Operations Management, Wiley, Fifth Edition, 2006.
3. Kanishka Bedi, Production and Operations Management, Oxford University Press, 2004.
4. Chary S. N, Production and Operations Management, Tata McGraw Hill, Third Edition, 2008.
5. Aswathappa K and Shridhara Bhat K, Production and Operations Management,
Himalaya Publishing House, Revised Second Edition, 2008.
6. Mahadevan B, Operations Management Theory and practice, Pearson Education, 2007.
7. Pannerselvam R, Production and Operations Management, Prentice Hall India, Second
Edition, 2008.

OSF352 INDUSTRIAL HYGIENE L T PC


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 Demonstrate an understanding of how occupational hygiene standards are set and used in
work health and safety.
 Compare and contrast the roles of environmental and biological monitoring in work health
and safety
 Outline strategies for identifying, assessing and controlling risks associated with airborne
gases, vapours and particulates
 Discuss how personal protective equipment can be used to reduce risks associated with
workplace exposures
 Provide high-level advice on managing and controlling noise and noise-related hazards

UNIT I INTRODUCTION AND SCOPE 9


Occupational Health and Environmental Safety Management - Principles practices. Common
Occupational diseases: Occupational Health Management Services at the work place. Pre-
employment, periodic medical examination of workers, medical surveillance for control of
occupational diseases and health records.

300
UNIT II MONITORING FOR SAFETY, HEALTH & ENVIRONMENT 9
Occupational Health and Environment Safety Management System, ILO and EPA Standards
Industrial Hygiene: Definition of Industrial Hygiene, Industrial Hygiene: Control Methods,
Substitution, Changing the process, Local Exhaust Ventilation, Isolation, Wet method, Personal
hygiene, housekeeping and maintenance, waste disposal, special control measures.

UNIT III OCCUPATIONAL HEALTH AND ENVIRONMENTAL SAFETY EDUCATION 9


Element of training cycle, Assessment of needs.Techniques of training, design and development
of training programs.Training methods and strategies types of training.Evaluation and review of
training programs. Occupational Health Hazards, Promoting Safety, Safety and Health training,
Stress and Safety, Exposure Limit .

UNIT IV OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY, HEALTH AND ENVIRONMENT MANAGEMENT 9


Bureau of Indian standards on safety and health 14489 - 1998 and 15001 – 2000, OSHA, Process
Safety Management (PSM) as per OSHA, PSM principles, OHSAS – 18001, EPA Standards,
Performance measurements to determine effectiveness of PSM. Importance of Industrial safety,
role of safety department,

UNIT V INDUSTRIAL HAZARDS 9


i. Radiation: Types and effects of radiation on human body, Measurement and detection of
radiation intensity. Effects of radiation on human body, Measurement – disposal of radioactive
waste, Control of radiation ii. Noise and Vibration: Sources, and its control, Effects of noise on the
auditory system and health, Measurement of noise , Different air pollutants in industries, Effect of
different gases and particulate matter ,acid fumes ,smoke, fog on human health, Vibration: effects.
TOTAL PERIODS: 45
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students able to
CO1: Explain and apply human factors engineering concepts in both evaluation of existing systems
and design of new systems
CO2: Specify designs that avoid occupation related injuries
CO3: Define and apply the principles of work design, motion economy, and work environment
design.
CO4: Identify the basic human sensory, cognitive, and physical capabilities and limitations with
respect to human-machine system performance.
CO5: Acknowledge the impact of workplace design and environment on productivity

TEXT BOOKS:
1. R. K. Jain and Sunil S. Rao , Industrial Safety , Health and Environment Management Systems,
Khanna publishers, New Delhi (2006)
2. Slote. L, Handbook of Occupational Safety and Health, John Willey and Sons, New York .

REFERENCES:
1. Jeanne MagerStellman, Encyclopedia of Occupational Health and Safety (ILO) Ms. Irma
Jourdan publication
2. Frank P Lees - Loss of prevention in Process Industries, Vol. 1 and 2,
3. ButterworthHeinemann Ltd., London (1991). 2. Industrial Safety - National Safety Council of
India

301
4. Frank P Lees – Loss of prevention in Process Industries , Vol. 1 and 2, Butterworth- Heinemann
Ltd., London
5. R. K. Jain and Sunil S. Rao, Industrial Safety , Health and Environment Management Systems,
Khanna publishers, New Delhi (2006).

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 2 2 - - - - - 2 - - - -
2 - 2 - - 1 - - - 1 - - - -
3 - - 2 - - - - - 2 - - - -
4 - - - - - - 2 - 3 - - - -
5 - - - - - 1 - - - - - - -
AVg. 2 - 2 - - - 1 1 2 - 2 - - -
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OSF353 CHEMICAL PROCESS SAFETY L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 Teach the principles of safety applicable to the design, and operation of chemical process
plants.
 Ensure that potential hazards are identified and mitigation measures are in place to prevent
unwanted release of energy.
 Learn about the hazardous chemicals into locations that could expose employees and others to
serious harm.
 Focuses on preventing incidents and accidents during large scale manufacturing of chemicals
and pharmaceuticals.
 Ensure that the general design of the plant is capable of complying with the dose limits in force
and with the radioactive releases.

UNIT I SAFETY IN THE STORAGE AND HANDLING OF CHEMICALS AND GASES 9


Types of storage-general considerations for storage layouts- atmospheric venting, pressure and
temperature relief - relief valve sizing calculations - storage and handling of hazardous chemicals
and industrial gases, safe disposal methods, reaction with other chemicals, hazards during
transportation - pipe line transport - safety in chemical laboratories.

UNIT II CHEMICAL REACTION HAZARDS 9


Hazardous inorganic and organic reactions and processes, Reactivity as a process hazard,
Detonations, Deflagrations, and Runaways, Assessment and Testing strategies, Self - heating
hazards of solids, Explosive potential of chemicals, Structural groups and instability of chemicals,
Thermochemical screening,

UNIT III SAFETY IN THE DESIGN OF CHEMICAL PROCESS PLANTS 9


Design principles -Process design development -types of designs, feasibility survey, preliminary
design, Flow diagrams, piping and instrumentation diagram, batch versus continuous operation,
factors in equipment scale up and design, equipment specifications - reliability and safety in

302
designing - inherent safety - engineered safety - safety during startup and shutdown - non
destructive testing methods - pressure and leak testing - emergency safety devices - scrubbers
and flares- new concepts in safety design and operation- Pressure vessel testing standards-
Inspection techniques for boilers and reaction vessels.

UNIT IV SAFETY IN THE OPERATION OF CHEMICAL PROCESS PLANTS 9


Properties of chemicals - Material Safety Data Sheets - the various properties and formats used -
methods available for property determination. Operational activities and hazards -standards
operating procedures - safe operation of pumps, compressors, heaters, column, reactors, pressure
vessels, storage vessels, piping systems - effects of pressure, temperature, Flow rate and humidity
on operations - corrosion and control measures- condition monitoring - control valves - safety
valves - pressure reducing valves, drains, bypass valves, inert gases. Chemical splashes, eye
irrigation and automatic showers.

UNIT V SAFETY AND ANALYSIS 9


Safety vs reliability- quantification of basic events, system safety quantification, Human error
analysis, Accident investigation and analysis, OSHAS 18001 and OSHMS.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students able to
CO1 Differentiate between inherent safety and engineered safety and recognize the
importance of safety in the design of chemical process plants.
CO2 Develop thorough knowledge about safety in the operation of chemical plants.
CO3Apply the principles of safety in the storage and handling of gases.
CO4Identify the conditions that lead to reaction hazards and adopt measures to prevent them.
CO5Develop thorough knowledge about

TEXT BOOK
1 David A Crowl& Joseph F Louvar,”Chemical Process safety”, Pearson publication, 3rd
Edition,2014
2 Maurice Jones .A,”Fire Protection Systems,2nd edition, Jones & Bartlett Publishers,2015
REFERENCES:
1. Ralph King and Ron Hirst,”King´s safety in the process industries”, Arnold, London, 1998.
2. Industrial Environment and its Evolution and Control, NIOSH Publication, 1973.
3. National Safety Council,” Accident prevention manual for industrial operations”. Chicago, 1982.
4. Lewis, Richard. J., Sr,“Sax´s dangerous properties of materials”. (Ninth edition). Van Nostrand
Reinhold, New York, 1996.
5. Roy E Sanders, ”Chemical Process Safety”,3rd Edition, Gulf professional publishing, 2006
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 3 - - - 1 - - 1 - - - 2 - -
2 - 2 - - - - 1 - - - 2 -
3 - 3 1 - - - 2 - - 1 - - - -
4 - 2 - - 1 - - 1 - - - - 2
5 - 2 3 - - - 1 - - 1 - - - -
AVg. 2 2.5 3 1.5 - 1 - 1.5 1 - 1 2 2 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation
303
OML352 ELECTRICAL, ELECTRONIC AND MAGNETIC MATERIALS LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The main learning objective of this course is to prepare the students for:
 Understanding the importance of various materials used in electrical, electronics and
 magnetic applications
 Acquiring knowledge on the properties of electrical, electronics and magnetic materials.
 Gaining knowledge on the selection of suitable materials for the given application
 Knowing the fundamental concepts in Semiconducting materials
 Getting equipped with the materials used in optical and optoelectronic applications.

UNIT I DIELECTRIC MATERIALS 9


Dielectric as Electric Field Medium, leakage currents, dielectric loss, dielectric strength, breakdown
voltage, breakdown in solid dielectrics, flashover, liquid dielectrics, electric conductivity in solid,
liquid and gaseous dielectrics, Ferromagnetic materials, properties of ferromagnetic materials in
static fields, spontaneous, polarization, curie point, anti-ferromagnetic materials, piezoelectric
materials, pyroelectric materials.

UNIT II MAGNETIC MATERIALS 9


Classification of magnetic materials, spontaneous magnetization in ferromagnetic materials,
magnetic Anisotropy, Magnetostriction, diamagnetism, magnetically soft and hard materials,
special purpose materials, feebly magnetic materials, Ferrites, cast and cermet permanent
magnets, ageing of magnets. Factors effecting permeability and Hysteresis

UNIT III SEMICONDUCTOR MATERIALS 9


Properties of semiconductors, Silicon wafers, integration techniques, Large and very large scale
Integration techniques. Concept of superconductivity; theories and examples for high temperature
superconductivity; discussion on specific superconducting materials; comments on fabrication and
engineering applications.

UNIT IV MATERIALS FOR ELECTRICAL APPLICATIONS 9


Materials used for Resistors, rheostats, heaters, transmission line structures, stranded conductors,
bimetals fuses, soft and hard solders, electric contact materials, electric carbon materials,
thermocouple materials. Solid, Liquid and Gaseous insulating materials, Effect of moisture on
insulation.

UNIT V OPTICAL AND OPTOELECTRONIC MATERIALS 9


Principles of photoconductivity - effect of impurities - principles of luminescence-laser principles -
He-Ne, injection lasers, LED materials - binary, ternary photoelectronic materials - LCD materials -
photo detectors - applications of optoelectronic materials - optical fibres and materials - electro
optic modulators - Kerr effect - Pockels effect.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1:Understand various types of dielectric materials, their properties in various conditions.
CO2:Evaluate magnetic materials and their behavior.

304
CO3:Evaluate semiconductor materials and technologies.
CO4:Select suitable materials for electrical engineering applications.
CO5:Identify right material for optical and optoelectronic applications

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Pradeep Fulay, “Electronic, Magnetic and Optical materials”, CRC Press, taylor and Francis, 2
nd illustrated edition, 2017.
2. “R K Rajput”, “A course in Electrical Engineering Materials”, Laxmi Publications, 2009.

REFERENCE BOOKS:
1. T K Basak, “A course in Electrical Engineering Materials”, New Age Science Publications, 2009
2. TTTI Madras, “Electrical Engineering Materials”, McGraw Hill Education, 2004.
3. Adrianus J. Dekker, “Electrical Engineering Materials”, PHI Publication, 2006.
4. S. P. Seth, P. V. Gupta “A course in Electrical Engineering Materials”, Dhanpat Rai & amp;
Sons, 2011.
5. C. Kittel, “Introduction to Solid State Physics”, 7th Edition, John Wiley & Sons,Singapore,
(2006).
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO1 PSO PSO PSO
PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO11 PO12
0 1 2 3
C01 3 2 2 3 2 2 2 1
C02 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 1
C03 3 2 1 2 2 2 2 1
CO4 3 2 1 2 2 2 2 2
CO5 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1
Avg 3 1.8 1.6 2.2 2 2 2 1.2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OML353 NANOMATERIALS AND APPLICATIONS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The main learning objective of this course is to prepare the students for:

 Understanding the evolution of nanomaterials in the scientific era and make them to
understand different types of nanomaterials for the future engineering applications
 Gaining knowledge on dimensionality effects on different properties of nanomaterials
 Getting acquainted with the different processing techniques employed for fabricating
nanomaterials
 Having knowledge on the different characterisation techniques employed to characterise the
nanomaterials
 Acquiring knowledge on different applications of nanomaterials in different disciplines of
305
engineering.

UNIT I NANOMATERIALS 9
Introduction, Classification: 0D, 1D, 2D, 3D nanomaterials and nano-composites, their mechanical,
electrical, optical, magnetic properties; Nanomaterials versus bulk materials.

UNIT II THERMODYNAMICS & KINETICS OF NANOSTRUCTURED MATERIALS 9


Size and interface/interphase effects, interfacial thermodynamics, phase diagrams, diffusivity, grain
growth, and thermal stability of nanomaterials.

UNIT III PROCESSING 9


Bottom-up and top-down approaches for the synthesis of nanomaterials, mechanical alloying,
chemical routes, severe plastic deformation, and electrical wire explosion technique.

UNIT IV STRUCTURAL CHARACTERISTICS 9


Principles of emerging nanoscale X-ray techniques such as small angle X-ray scattering and X-ray
absorption fine structure (XAFS), electron and neutron diffraction techniques and their application
to nanomaterials; SPM, Nanoindentation, Grain size, phase formation, texture, stress analysis

UNIT V APPLICATIONS 9
Applications of nanoparticles, quantum dots, nanotubes, nanowires, nanocoatings; applications in
electronic, electrical and medical industries
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1:Evaluate nanomaterials and understand the different types of nanomaterials
CO2:Recognise the effects of dimensionality of materials on the properties
CO3:Process different nanomaterials and use them in engineering applications
CO4:Use appropriate techniques for characterising nanomaterials
CO5:Identify and use different nanomaterials for applications in different engineering fields.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Bhusan, Bharat (Ed), “Springer Handbook of Nanotechnology”, 2nd edition, 2007.
2. Carl C. Koch (ed.), NANOSTRUCTURED MATERIALS, Processing, Properties and Potential
Applications, NOYES PUBLICATIONS, Norwich, New York, U.S.A.

REFERENCES:
1. Poole C.P, and Owens F.J., Introduction to Nanotechnology, John Wiley 2003
2. Nalwa H.S., Encyclopedia of Nanoscience and Nanotechnology, American Scientific
Publishers 2004
3. Zehetbauer M.J. and Zhu Y.T., Bulk Nanostructured Materials, Wiley 2008
4. Wang Z.L., Characterization of Nanophase Materials, Wiley 2000
5. Gutkin Y., Ovid’ko I.A. and Gutkin M., Plastic Deformation in Nanocrystalline Materials,
Springer 2004

306
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PO PO PSO PSO PSO
PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9
10 11 12 1 2 3
C01 2 2 2 3 2 1 2
C02 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 1
C03 3 2 1 2 2 2 2
CO4 3 1 2 2 2 2 2
CO5 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1
Avg 2.8 1.6 1.7 2.2 2 1.8 2 1.3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMR352 HYDRAULICS AND PNEUMATICS L T PC


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To knowledge on fluid power principles and working of hydraulic pumps
 To obtain the knowledge in hydraulic actuators and control components
 To understand the basics in hydraulic circuits and systems
 To obtain the knowledge in pneumatic and electro pneumatic systems
 To apply the concepts to solve the trouble shooting

UNIT I FLUID POWER PRINICIPLES AND HYDRAULIC PUMPS 9


Introduction to Fluid power – Advantages and Applications – Fluid power systems – Types of fluids
- Properties of fluids and selection – Basics of Hydraulics – Pascal’s Law – Principles of flow -
Friction loss – Work, Power and Torque Problems, Sources of Hydraulic power : Pumping Theory
– Pump Classification – Construction, Working, Design, Advantages, Disadvantages, Performance,
Selection criteria of Linear and Rotary – Fixed and Variable displacement pumps – Problems.

UNIT II HYDRAULIC ACTUATORS AND CONTROL COMPONENTS 9


Hydraulic Actuators: Cylinders – Types and construction, Application, Hydraulic cushioning –
Hydraulic motors - Control Components : Direction Control, Flow control and pressure control
valves – Types, Construction and Operation – Servo and Proportional valves – Applications –
Accessories : Reservoirs, Pressure Switches – Applications – Fluid Power ANSI Symbols –
Problems.

UNIT III HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS AND SYSTEMS 9


Accumulators, Intensifiers, Industrial hydraulic circuits – Regenerative, Pump Unloading, Double
Pump, Pressure Intensifier, Air-over oil, Sequence, Reciprocation, Synchronization, Fail-Safe,
Speed Control, Hydrostatic transmission, Electro hydraulic circuits, Mechanical hydraulic servo
systems.

UNIT IV PNEUMATIC AND ELECTRO PNEUMATIC SYSTEMS 9


Properties of air – Perfect Gas Laws – Compressor – Filters, Regulator, Lubricator, Muffler, Air
control Valves, Quick Exhaust Valves, Pneumatic actuators, Design of Pneumatic circuit –
Cascade method – Electro Pneumatic System – Elements – Ladder diagram – Problems,
Introduction to fluidics and pneumatic logic circuits
307
UNIT V TROUBLE SHOOTING AND APPLICATIONS 9
Installation, Selection, Maintenance, Trouble Shooting and Remedies in Hydraulic and Pneumatic
systems, Design of hydraulic circuits for Drilling, Planning, Shaping, Surface grinding, Press and
Forklift applications. Design of Pneumatic circuits for Pick and Place applications and tool handling
in CNC Machine tools – Low cost Automation – Hydraulic and Pneumatic power packs.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:
CO 1: Analyze the methods in fluid power principles and working of hydraulic pumps
CO 2: Recognize the concepts in hydraulic actuators and control components
CO 3: Obtain the knowledge in basics of hydraulic circuits and systems
CO 4: Know about the basics concept in pneumatic and electro pneumatic systems
CO 5: Apply the concepts to solve the trouble shooting hydraulic and pneumatics

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


Mapping of COs with POs and PSOs
COs/POs & PSOs POs PSOs
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 3 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1
CO2 3 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1
CO3 3 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1
CO4 3 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1
CO5 3 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1
CO/PO & PSO 3 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1
Average
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

TEXT BOOKS
1. Anthony Esposito, “Fluid Power with Applications”, Prentice Hall, 2009.
2. James A. Sullivan, “Fluid Power Theory and Applications”, Fourth Edition, Prentice Hall,
1997.
REFERENCES
1. Shanmugasundaram.K, “Hydraulic and Pneumatic Controls”. Chand & Co, 2006.
2. Majumdar, S.R., “Oil Hydraulics Systems – Principles and Maintenance”, Tata McG Raw
Hill, 2001.
3. Majumdar, S.R., “Pneumatic Systems – Principles and Maintenance”, Tata McGRaw Hill,
2007.
4. Dudley, A. Pease and John J Pippenger, “Basic Fluid Power”, Prentice Hall, 1987
5. Srinivasan. R, “Hydraulic and Pneumatic Controls”, Vijay Nicole Imprints, 2008
6. Joshi.P, Pneumatic Control”, Wiley India, 2008.
7. Jagadeesha T, “Pneumatics Concepts, Design and Applications “, Universities Press, 2015.

308
OMR353 SENSORS L T PC
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn the various types of sensors, transducers, sensor output signal types, calibration
techniques, formulation of system equation and its characteristics.
 To understand basic working principle, construction, Application and characteristics of
displacement, speed and ranging sensors.
 To understand and analyze the working principle, construction, application and
characteristics of force, magnetic and heading sensors.
 To learn and analyze the working principle, construction, application and characteristics of
optical, pressure, temperature and other sensors.
 To familiarize students with different signal conditioning circuits design and data acquisition
system.

UNIT I SENSOR CLASSIFICATION, CHARACTERISTICS AND SIGNAL TYPES 9


Basics of Measurement – Classification of Errors – Error Analysis – Static and Dynamic
Characteristics of Transducers – Performance Measures of Sensors – Classification of Sensors –
Sensor Calibration Techniques – Sensor Outputs - Signal Types - Analog and Digital Signals,
PWM and PPM.

UNIT II DISPLACEMENT, PROXIMITY AND RANGING SENSORS 9


Displacement Sensors – Brush Encoders - Potentiometers, Resolver, Encoders – Optical,
Magnetic, Inductive, Capacitive, LVDT – RVDT – Synchro – Microsyn, Accelerometer – Range
Sensors - Ultrasonic Ranging - Reflective Beacons - Laser Range Sensor (LIDAR) – GPS - RF
Beacons.

UNIT III FORCE, MAGNETIC AND HEADING SENSORS 9


Strain Gage – Types, Working, Advantage, Limitation, and Applications: Load Measurement –
Force and Torque Measurement - Magnetic Sensors – Types, Principle, Advantage, Limitation,
and Applications - Magneto Resistive – Hall Effect, Eddy Current Sensor - Heading Sensors –
Compass, Gyroscope and Inclinometers.

UNIT IV OPTICAL, PRESSURE, TEMPERATURE AND OTHER SENSORS 9


Photo Conductive Cell, Photo Voltaic, Photo Resistive, LDR – Fiber Optic Sensors – Pressure –
Diaphragm – Bellows - Piezoelectric - Piezo-resistive - Acoustic, Temperature – IC, Thermistor,
RTD, Thermocouple – Non Contact Sensor - Chemical Sensors - MEMS Sensors - Smart Sensors.

UNIT V SIGNAL CONDITIONING 9


Need for Signal Conditioning – Resistive, Inductive and Capacitive Bridges for Measurement - DC
and AC Signal Conditioning - Voltage, Current, Power and Instrumentation Amplifiers – Filter and
Isolation Circuits – Fundamentals of Data Acquisition System
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:
CO1: Understand various sensor effects, sensor characteristics, signal types, calibration
methods and obtain transfer function and empirical relation of sensors. They can also
analyze the densor response.

309
CO2: Analyze and select suitable sensor for displacement, proximity and range measurement.
CO3: Analyze and select suitable sensor for force, magnetic field, speed, position and direction
measurement.
CO4: Analyze and Select suitable sensor for light detection, pressure and temperature
measurement and also familiar with other miniaturized smart sensors.
CO5: Select and design suitable signal conditioning circuit with proper compensation and
linearizing element based on sensor output signal.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
Mapping of COs with POs and PSOs
COs/POs & POs PSOs
PSOs 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 3 3 2 1 2 3 2 1
CO2 3 3 2 1 1 1 1 2 3 2 1
CO3 3 3 2 1 1 1 1 2 3 2 1
CO4 3 3 2 1 1 1 1 2 3 2 1
CO5 3 3 2 1 1 1 1 2 3 2 1
CO/PO & PSO 3 3 2 0. 0. 0.8 0.8 2 3 2 1
Average 8 8
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

TEXT BOOKS
1. Bolton W., “Mechatronics”, Pearson Education, 6th Edition, 2015.
2. Ramesh S Gaonkar, “Microprocessor Architecture, Programming, and Applications with the
8085”, Penram International Publishing Private Limited, 6th Edition, 2013.

REFERENCES
1. Bradley D.A., Dawson D., Buru N.C. and Loader A.J., “Mechatronics”, Chapman and Hall,
1993.
2. Davis G. Alciatore and Michael B. Histand, “Introduction to Mechatronics and Measurement
systems”, McGraw Hill Education, 2011.
3. Devadas Shetty and Richard A. Kolk, “Mechatronics Systems Design”, Cengage Learning,
2010.
4. Nitaigour Premchand Mahalik, “Mechatronics Principles, Concepts and Applications”,
McGraw Hill Education, 2015.
5. Smaili. A and Mrad. F, “Mechatronics Integrated Technologies for Intelligent Machines”,
Oxford University Press, 2007.

310
ORA352 CONCEPTS IN MOBILE ROBOTS L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To introduce mobile robotic technology and its types in detail.
 To learn the kinematics of wheeled and legged robot.
 To familiarize the intelligence into the mobile robots using various sensors.
 To acquaint the localization strategies and mapping technique for mobile robot.
 To aware the collaborative mobile robotics in task planning, navigation and intelligence.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MOBILE ROBOTICS 9


Introduction – Locomotion of the Robots – Key Issues on Locomotion – Legged Mobile Roots –
Configurations and Stability – Wheeled Mobile Robots – Design Space and Mobility Issues –
Unmanned Aerial and Underwater Vehicles

UNIT II KINEMATICS 9
Kinematic Models – Representation of Robot – Forward Kinematics – Wheel and Robot
Constraints – Degree of Mobility and Steerability – Manoeuvrability – Workspace – Degrees of
Freedom – Path and Trajectory Considerations – Motion Controls - Holonomic Robots

UNIT III PERCEPTION 9


Sensor for Mobile Robots – Classification and Performance Characterization – Wheel/Motor
Sensors – Heading Sensors - Ground-Based Beacons - Active Ranging - Motion/Speed
Sensors – Camera - Visual Appearance based Feature Extraction.

UNIT IV LOCALIZATION 9
Localization Based Navigation Versus Programmed Solutions - Map Representation -
Continuous Representations - Decomposition Strategies - Probabilistic Map-Based Localization
- Landmark-Based Navigation - Globally Unique Localization - Positioning Beacon Systems -
Route-Based Localization - Autonomous Map Building - Simultaneous Localization and
Mapping (SLAM).

UNIT V PLANNING, NAVIGATION AND COLLABORATIVE ROBOTS 9


Introduction - Competences for Navigation: Planning and Reacting - Path Planning - Obstacle
Avoidance - Navigation Architectures - Control Localization - Techniques for Decomposition -
Case Studies – Collaborative Robots – Swarm Robots.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Evaluate the appropriate mobile robots for the desired application.
CO2: Create the kinematics for given wheeled and legged robot.
CO3:Analyse the sensors for the intelligence of mobile robotics.
CO4: Create the localization strategies and mapping technique for mobile robot.
CO5: Create the collaborative mobile robotics for planning, navigation and intelligence for
desired applications.

TEXTBOOK
1. Roland Siegwart and IllahR.Nourbakish, “Introduction to Autonomous Mobile Robots” MIT
Press, Cambridge, 2004.

311
REFERENCES:
1. Dragomir N. Nenchev, Atsushi Konno, TeppeiTsujita, “Humanoid Robots: Modelling and
Control”, Butterworth-Heinemann, 2018
2. MohantaJagadish Chandra, “Introduction to Mobile Robots Navigation”, LAP Lambert
Academic Publishing, 2015.
3. Peter Corke, “Robotics, Vision and Control”, Springer, 2017.
4. Ulrich Nehmzow, “Mobile Robotics: A Practical Introduction”, Springer, 2003.
5. Xiao Qi Chen, Y.Q. Chen and J.G. Chase, “Mobile Robots - State of the Art in Land, Sea,
Air, and Collaborative Missions”, Intec Press, 2009.
6. Alonzo Kelly, Mobile Robotics: Mathematics, Models, and Methods, Cambridge
University Press, 2013, ISBN: 978-1107031159.

MV3501 MARINE PROPULSION LT PC


3 0 03
COOURSE OBJECTIVES:

 To impart knowledge on basics of propulsion system and ship dynamic movements


 To educate them on basic layout and propulsion equipment’s
 To impart basic knowledge on performance of the ship
 To impart basic knowledge on Ship propeller and its types
 To impart knowledge on ship rudder and its types

UNIT I BASICS SHIP PROPULSION SYSTEM AND EQUIPMENTS 9


law of floatation - Basics principle of propulsion- Earlier methods of propulsion- ship propulsion
machinery- boiler, Marine steam engine, diesel engine, ship power transmission system, ship
dynamic structure, Marine propulsion equipment - shaft tunnel, Intermediate shaft and bearing,
stern tube, stern tube sealing etc. degree of freedom, Modern propelling methods- water jet
propulsion , screw propulsion.

UNIT II SHIPS MOVEMENTS AND SHIP STABILIZATION 9


Thrust augmented devices, Ship hull, modern ship propulsion design, bow thruster – Advantages,
various methods to stabilize the ship- passive and active stabilizer, fin stabilizer, bilge keel -
stabilizing and securing ship in port- effect of tides on ship – effect of river water and sea water
sailing vessel, Load line and load line of marking- draught markings.

UNIT III SHIPS SPEED AND ITS PERFORMANCE 9


Ship propulsion factors, factors affecting ships speed, various velocities of ship, hull drag, effects of
fouling on ships hull, ship wake, relation between powers, Fuel consumption of ship, cavitations -
effects of cavitation’s, ship turning radius.

UNIT IV BASICS OF PROPELLER 9


Propeller dimension, Propeller and its types – fixed propeller, control pitch propeller, kort nozzle,
ducted propeller, voith schneider, Parts of propeller, 3 blade - 5 blade - 6 blade propellers and its
advantages, propeller boss hub, crown nut, propeller skew, pitch of propeller - Thrust creation by
propeller. Propeller Material – Propeller balancing- static and dynamic.

312
UNIT V BASICS OF RUDDER 9
Rudder dimension, Area of rudder and its design, Rudder arrangements, Rudder fittings- Rudder
pintle - Rudder types- Balanced rudder, semi balanced rudder, Spade rudder, merits and demerits
of various types of rudders, Propeller and rudder interaction, Rudder stopper, movement of
rudders, Basic construction of Rudder
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:
CO1: Explain the basics of propulsion system and ship dynamic movements
CO2: Familiarize with various components assisting ship stabilization.
CO3: Demonstrate the performance of the ship.
CO4: Classify the Propeller and its types, Materials etc.
CO5: Categories the Rudder and its types, design criteria of rudder.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. GP. Ghose, “Basic Ship propulsion”,2015
2. E.A. Stokoe “Reeds Ship construction for marine engineers”, Vol. 5,2010
3. E.A. Stokoe, “Reeds Naval architecture for the marine engineers”,4th Edition,2009

REFERENCES BOOKS:
1. DJ Eyers and GJ Bruse, “Ship Construction”, 7th Edition, 2006.
2. KJ Rawson and EC Tupper, “Basic Ship theory I” Vol. 1,5th Edition,2001.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
C PO PSO
O PO P P P P P P P P PO PO PO PS PS PS PS
1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 O8 O9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3 O4
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
2 1 1 1 1 1
3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
4 1 1 1 1 1
5 1 1 1 1 1
Av 5/5 2/2 4/4 4/4 2/2 1/1 1/1 2/2 1/1 1/1 5/5 5/5
g =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OMV351 MARINE MERCHANT VESSELS LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
At the end of the course, students are expected to acquire
 Knowledge on basics of Hydrostatics
 Familiarization on types of merchant ships
 Knowledge on Shipbuilding Materials
 Knowledge on marine propeller and rudder
 Awareness on governing bodies in shipping industry
313
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO HYDROSTATICS 9
Archimedes Principle- Laws of floatation– Meta centre – stability of floating and submerged bodies-
Density, relative density - Displacement –Pressure –centre of pressure.

UNIT II TYPES OF SHIP 10


General cargo ship - Refrigerated cargo ships - Container ships - Roll-on Roll-off ships – Oil
tankers- Bulk carriers - Liquefied Natural Gas carriers - Liquefied Petroleum Gas carriers - Chemical
tankers - Passenger ships

UNIT III SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS 9


Types of Steels used in Shipbuilding - High tensile steels, Corrosion resistant steels, Steel
sandwich panels, Steel castings, Steel forgings - Other shipbuilding materials, Aluminium alloys,
Aluminium alloy sandwich panels, Fire protection especially for Aluminium Alloys, Fiber Reinforced
Composites

UNIT IV MARINE PROPELLER AND RUDDER 8


Types of rudder, construction of Rudder-Types of Propeller, Propeller material-Cavitations and its
effects on propeller

UNIT V GOVERNING BODIES FOR SHIPPING INDUSTRY 9


Role of IMO (International Maritime Organization), SOLAS (International Convention for the
Safety of Life at Sea), MARPOL (International Convention for the Prevention of Pollution from
Ships ) , MLC (Maritime Labour Convention), STCW 2010 (International Convention on Standards
of Training, Certification and Watch keeping for Seafarers), Classification societies Administration
authorities
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, students would
CO1:Acquire Knowledge on floatation of ships
CO2:Acquire Knowledge on features of various ships
CO3:Acquire Knowledge of Shipbuilding Materials
CO4:Acquire Knowledge to identify the different types of marine propeller and
rudder
CO5:Understand the Roles and responsibilities of governing bodies

TEXT BOOKS:
1. D.J.Eyres, “Ship Constructions”, Seventh Edition, Butter Worth Heinemann Publishing,
USA,2015
2. Dr.DA Taylor, “Merchant Ship Naval Architecture” I. Mar EST publications, 2006
3. EA Stokoe, E.A, “Naval Architecture for Marine Engineers”, Vol.4, Reeds Publications,2000

REFERENCES:
1. Kemp & Young “Ship Construction Sketches & Notes”, Butter Worth Heinemann
Publishing,USA, 2011
2. MARPOL Consolidated Edition , Bhandakar Publications, 2018
3. SOLAS Consolidated Edition , Bhandakar Publications, 2016

314
OMV352 ELEMENTS OF MARINE ENGINEERING LT PC
3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
At the end of the course, students are expected to
 Understand the role of Marine machinery systems
 Be familiar with Marine propulsion machinery system
 Acquaint with Marine Auxiliary machinery system
 Have acquired basics of Marine Auxiliary boiler system
 Be aware of ship propellers and steering system

UNIT I ELEMENTARY KNOWLEDGE ON MARINE MACHINERY SYSTEMS 9


Marine Engineering Terminologies, Parts of Ship, Introduction to Machinery systems on board
ships – Propulsion Machinery system, Electricity Generator system, Steering gear system, Air
compressors & Air reservoirs, Fuel oil and Lubricating Oil Purifiers, Marine Boiler systems

UNIT II MARINE PROPULSION MACHINERY SYSTEM 9


Two stroke Large Marine slow speed Diesel Engine – General Construction, Basic knowledge of
Air starting and reversing mechanism, Cylinder lubrication oil system, Main lubricating oil system
and cooling water system

UNIT III MARINE AUXILIARY MACHINERY SYSTEM 9


Four stroke medium speed Diesel engine – General Construction, Inline, V-type arrangement of
engine, Difference between slow speed and medium speed engines – advantages, limitations and
applications

UNIT IV MARINE BOILER SYSTEM 9


Types of Boiler – Difference between Water tube boiler and Fire tube boiler, Need for boiler on
board ships, Uses of steam, Advantages of using steam as working medium, Boiler mountings and
accessories – importance of mountings, need for accessories

UNIT V SHIP PROPELLERS AND STEERING MECHANISM 9


Importance of Propellor and Steering gear, Types of propellers - Fixed pitch propellers,
Controllable pitch propellers, Water jet propellers, Steering gear systems - 2-Ram and 4 Ram
steering gear, Electric steering gear
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, students should able to,
CO1:Distinguish the role of various marine machinery systems
CO2:Relate the components of marine propulsion machinery system
CO3:Explain the importance of marine auxiliary machinery system
CO4:Acquire knowledge of marine boiler system
CO5:Understand the importance of ship propellors and steering system

315
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Taylor, “Introduction to Marine engineering”, Revised Second Edition, Butterworth
Heinemann, London, 2011
2. J.K.Dhar, “Basic Marine Engineering”, Tenth Edition, G-Maritime Publications, Mumbai, 2011
3. K.Ramaraj, “ Text book on Marine Engineering”, Eswar Press, Chennai, 2018

REFERENCES:
1. Alan L.Rowen, “Introduction to Practical Marine Engineering, Volume 1&2, The Institute of
Marine Engineers (India), Mumbai, 2006
2. A.S.Tambwekar, “Naval Architecture and Ship Construction”, The Institute of Marine
Engineers (India), Mumbai, 2015

CRA332 DRONE TECHNOLOGIES L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basics of drone concepts
 To learn and understand the fundaments of design, fabrication and programming of
drone
 To impart the knowledge of an flying and operation of drone
 To know about the various applications of drone
 To understand the safety risks and guidelines of fly safely

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO DRONE TECHNOLOGY 9


Drone Concept - Vocabulary Terminology- History of drone - Types of current generation of
drones based on their method of propulsion- Drone technology impact on the businesses-
Drone business through entrepreneurship- Opportunities/applications for entrepreneurship and
employability

UNIT II DRONE DESIGN, FABRICATION AND PROGRAMMING 9


Classifications of the UAV -Overview of the main drone parts- Technical characteristics of the
parts -Function of the component parts -Assembling a drone- The energy sources- Level of
autonomy- Drones configurations -The methods of programming drone- Download program -
Install program on computer- Running Programs- Multi rotor stabilization- Flight modes -Wi-Fi
connection.

UNIT III DRONE FLYING AND OPERATION 9


Concept of operation for drone -Flight modes- Operate a small drone in a controlled
environment- Drone controls Flight operations –management tool –Sensors-Onboard storage
capacity -Removable storage devices- Linked mobile devices and applications

UNIT IV DRONE COMMERCIAL APPLICATIONS 9


Choosing a drone based on the application -Drones in the insurance sector- Drones in
delivering mail, parcels and other cargo- Drones in agriculture- Drones in inspection of
transmission lines and power distribution -Drones in filming and panoramic picturing

316
UNIT V FUTURE DRONES AND SAFETY 9
The safety risks- Guidelines to fly safely -Specific aviation regulation and standardization-
Drone license- Miniaturization of drones- Increasing autonomy of drones -The use of drones in
swarms
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:
CO1: Know about a various type of drone technology, drone fabrication and programming.
CO2: Execute the suitable operating procedures for functioning a drone
CO3: Select appropriate sensors and actuators for Drones
CO4: Develop a drone mechanism for specific applications
CO5: Createthe programs for various drones

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


COs/Pos&P POs PSOs
SOs 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO2 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO3 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO4 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO5 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO/PO & 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
PSO
Average
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

TEXT BOOKS
1. Daniel Tal and John Altschuld, “Drone Technology in Architecture, Engineering and
Construction: A Strategic Guide to Unmanned Aerial Vehicle Operation and
Implementation”, 2021 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
2. Terry Kilby and Belinda Kilby, “Make:Getting Started with Drones “,Maker Media, Inc,
2016

REFERENCES
1. John Baichtal, “Building Your Own Drones: A Beginners' Guide to Drones, UAVs, and
ROVs”, Que Publishing, 2016
2. Zavrsnik, “Drones and Unmanned Aerial Systems: Legal and Social Implications for
Security and Surveillance”, Springer, 2018.

OGI352 GEOGRAPHICAL INFORMATION SYSTEM LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To impart the knowledge on basic components, data preparation and implementation of
Geographical Information System.

317
UNIT I FUNDAMENTALS OF GIS 9
Introduction to GIS - Basic spatial concepts - Coordinate Systems - GIS and Information
Systems – Definitions – History of GIS - Components of a GIS – Hardware, Software, Data,
People, Methods – Proprietary and open source Software - Types of data – Spatial, Attribute
data- types of attributes – scales/ levels of measurements.

UNIT II SPATIAL DATA MODELS 9


Database Structures – Relational, Object Oriented – Entities – ER diagram - data models -
conceptual, logical and physical models - spatial data models – Raster Data Structures – Raster
Data Compression - Vector Data Structures - Raster vs Vector Models- TIN and GRID data
models.

UNIT III DATA INPUT AND TOPOLOGY 9


Scanner - Raster Data Input – Raster Data File Formats – Georeferencing – Vector Data Input –
Digitizer – Datum Projection and reprojection -Coordinate Transformation – Topology - Adjacency,
connectivity and containment – Topological Consistency – Non topological file formats - Attribute
Data linking – Linking External Databases – GPS Data Integration

UNIT IV DATA QUALITY AND STANDARDS 9


Data quality - Basic aspects - completeness, logical consistency, positional accuracy, temporal
accuracy, thematic accuracy and lineage – Metadata – GIS Standards –Interoperability - OGC -
Spatial Data Infrastructure

UNIT V DATA MANAGEMENT AND OUTPUT 9


Import/Export – Data Management functions- Raster to Vector and Vector to Raster Conversion -
Data Output - Map Compilation – Chart/Graphs – Multimedia – Enterprise Vs. Desktop GIS-
distributed GIS.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the student is expected to
CO1 Have basic idea about the fundamentals of GIS.
CO2 Understand the types of data models.
CO3 Get knowledge about data input and topology
CO4 Gain knowledge on data quality and standards
CO5 Understand data management functions and data output

TEXTBOOKS:
1. Kang - Tsung Chang, Introduction to Geographic Information Systems, McGraw Hill
Publishing, 2nd Edition, 2011.
2. Ian Heywood, Sarah Cornelius, Steve Carver, Srinivasa Raju, “An Introduction Geographical
Information Systems, Pearson Education, 2nd Edition,2007.

REFERENCES:
1. Lo. C. P., Albert K.W. Yeung, Concepts and Techniques of Geographic Information
Systems, Prentice-Hall India Publishers, 2006

318
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING: GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION SYSTEM
Course Outcome
PO Graduate Attribute CO1 CO2 CO3 CO4 CO5 Average
PO1 Engineering Knowledge 3 3 3 3 3 3
PO2 Problem Analysis 3 3 3
PO3 Design/Development of Solutions 3 3 3 3
PO4 Conduct Investigations of Complex 3
3 3 3
Problems
PO5 Modern Tool Usage 3 3 3 3
PO6 The Engineer and Society
PO 7 Environment and Sustainability
PO 8 Ethics
PO 9 Individual and Team Work
PO 10 Communication
PO 11 Project Management and Finance
PO 12 Life-long Learning
PSO 1 Knowledge of Geoinformatics 3
3 3 3 3 3
discipline
PSO 2 Critical analysis of Geoinformatics 3
Engineering problems and 3 3 3 3 3
innovations
PSO 3 Conceptualization and evaluation of 3
Design solutions 3 3 3 3 3

1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OAI352 AGRICULTURE ENTREPRENEURSHIP DEVELOPMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To introduce the importance of Agri-business management, its characteristics and
principles
 To impart knowledge on the functional areas of Agri-business like Marketing management,
Product pricing methods and Market potential assessment.

UNIT I ENTREPRENEURIAL ENVIRONMENT IN INDIAN CONTEXT 9


Entrepreneur Development(ED): Concept of entrepreneur and entrepreneurship assessing overall
business environment in Indian economy- Entrepreneurial and managerial characteristics-
Entrepreneurship development programmers (EDP)-Generation incubation and commercialization
of ideas and innovations- Motivation and entrepreneurship development- Globalization and the
emerging business entrepreneurial environment.

UNIT II AGRIPRNEURSHIP IN GLOBAL ARENA: LEGAL PERSPECTIVE 9


Importance of agribusiness in Indian economy - International trade-WTO agreements- Provisions
related to agreements in agricultural and food commodities - Agreements on Agriculture (AOA)-
Domestic supply, market access, export subsidies agreements on sanitary and phyto-sanitary
(SPS) measures, Trade related intellectual property rights (TRIPS).

319
UNIT III ENTREPRENEURSHIP MANAGEMENT: FINANCIAL PERSPECTIVE 9
Entrepreneurship - Essence of managerial Knowledge -Management functions- Planning-
organizing-Directing-Motivation-ordering-leading-supervision- communication and control-
Understanding Financial Aspects of Business - Importance of financial statements-liquidity ratios-
leverage ratios, coverage ratios-turnover ratios-Profitability ratios. Agro-based industries-Project-
Project cycle-Project appraisal and evaluation techniques-undiscounted measures-Payback
period-proceeds per rupee of outlay, Discounted measures-Net Present Value (NPV)-Benefit-Cost
Ratio(BCR)-Internal Rate of Return(IRR)-Net benefit investment ratio(N/K ratio)-sensitivity analysis.

UNIT IV ENTREPRENEURIAL OPPORTUNITIES: ECONOMIC GROWTH


PERSPECTIVE 9
Managing an enterprise: Importance of planning, budgeting, monitoring evaluation and follow-up
managing competition. Role of ED in economic development of a country- Overview of Indian
social, political system and their implications for decision making by individual entrepreneurs-
Economic system and its implication for decision making by individual entrepreneurs.

UNITV ENTREPRENEURIAL PROMOTION MEASURES AND GOVERNMENT


SUPPORT 9
Social responsibility of business. Morals and ethics in enterprise management- SWOT analysis-
Government schemes and incentives for promotions of entrepreneurship. Government policy on
small and medium enterprises (SMEs)/SSIs/MSME sectors- Venture capital (VC), contract
framing (CF) and Joint Venture (JV), public-private
partnerships (PPP) - overview of agricultural engineering industry, characteristics of Indian farm
machinery industry.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1:Judge about agricultural finance, banking and cooperation
CO2:Evaluate basic concepts, principles and functions of financial management
CO3:Improve the skills on basic banking and insurance schemes available to customers
CO4:Analyze various financial data for efficient farm management
CO5:Identify the financial institutions

TEXT BOOKS
1. Joseph L. Massie, 1995, “Essentials of Management”, prentice Hall of India Pvt limited, New
Delhi
2. Khanka S, 1999, Entrepreneurial Development, S, Chand and Co, New Delhi
3. Mohanty S K, 2007, Fundamentals of Entrepreneurship, Prentice Hall India, New Delhi.

REFERENCES
1. Harih S B, Conner U J and Schwab G D, 1981, Management of the Farm Business, Prentice
Hall Inc, New Jersey
2. Omri Ralins, N.1980, Introduction to Agricultural: Prentice Hall Inc, New Jersey
3. Gittenger Price, 1989, Economic Analysis of Agricultural project, John Hopkins University,
Press, London.
4. Thomas W Zimmer and Norman M Scarborough, 1996, Entrepreneurship, Prentice Hall, New
Jersey.
5. Mar J Dollinger, 1999, Entrepreneurship strategies and resources, Prentice –Hall, Upper
Saddal Rover, New Jersey.

320
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO/PSO CO1 CO2 CO3 CO4 CO5 Overall
correlation of
COs with POs
PO1 Engineering Knowledge 1 2 1 1 1 2
PO2 Problem Analysis 2 1 1 1 2 1
PO3 Design/ Development of Solutions 1 1 1 2 1 2
PO4 Conduct Investigations of Complex
1 1 2 1 1 1
Problems
PO5 Modern Tool Usage 2 1 1 1 1 2
PO6 The Engineer and Society 1 2 1 2 1 1
PO7 Environment and sustainability 1 1 2 1 1 1
PO8 Ethics 1 2 1 1 1 1
PO9 Individual and team work: 1 1 1 2 1 1
PO10 Communication 1 1 1 1 2 1
PO11 Project management and finance 1 1 2 1 1 1
PO12 Life-long learning: 1 2 1 1 1 2
PSO1 To make expertise in design and
engineering problem solving approach
1 2 1 1 1 1
in agriculture with proper knowledge
and skill
PSO2 To enhance students ability to
formulate solutions to real-world
problems pertaining to 1 1 2 1 1 1
sustained agricultural productivity using
modern technologies.
PSO3 To inculcate entrepreneurial skills
through strong Industry-Institution 1 2 1 1 2 1
linkage.
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OEN352 BIODIVERSITY CONSERVATION LT PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 The identification of different aspects of biological diversity and conservation
techniques.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Concept of Species, Variation; Introduction to Major Plant Groups; Evolutionary relationships
between Plant Groups; Nomenclature and History of plant taxonomy; Systems of Classification
and their Application; Study of Plant Groups; Study of Identification Characters; Study of important
families of Angiosperms; Plant Diversity Application.

321
UNIT II INTRODUCTION TO ANIMAL DIVERSITY AND TAXONOMY 9
Principles and Rules of Taxonomy; ICZN Rules, Animal Study Techniques; Concepts of Taxon,
Categories, Holotype, Paratype, Topotype etc; Classification of Animal kingdom, Invertebrates,
Vertebrates, Evolutionary relationships between Animal Groups.

UNIT III MICROBIAL DIVERSITY 9


Microbes and Earth History, Magnitude, Occurrence and Distribution. Concept of Species, Criteria
for Classification, Outline Classification of Microorganisms (Bacteria, Viruses and Protozoa);
Criteria for Classification and Identification of Fungi; Chemical and Biochemical Methods of
Microbial Diversity Analysis

UNIT IV MEGA DIVERSITY 9


Biodiversity Hot-spots, Floristic and Faunal Regions in India and World; IUCN Red List; Factors
affecting Diversity, Impact of Exotic Species and Human Disturbance on Diversity, Dispersal,
Diversity-Stability Relationship; Socio- economic Issues of Biodiversity; Sustainable Utilization of
Bioresources; National Movements and International Convention/Treaties on Biodiversity.

UNIT V CONSERVATIONS OF BIODIVERSITY 9


In-Situ Conservation- National parks, Wildlife sanctuaries, Biosphere reserves; Ex-situ
conservation- Gene bank, Cryopreservation, Tissue culture bank; Long term captive breeding,
Botanical gardens, Animal Translocation, Zoological Gardens; Concept of Keystone Species,
Endangered Species, Threatened Species, Rare Species, Extinct Species
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

TEXT BOOKS:
1. A textbook of Botany: Angiosperms- Taxonomy, Anatomy, Economic Botany & Embryology. S.
Chand, Limited, Pandey, B. P. January 2001
2. Principles of Systematic Zoology, Mcgraw-Hill College, Ashlock, P.D., Latest Edition.
3. Microbiology, MacGraw Hill Companies Inc, Prescott, L.M., Harley, J.P., and Klein D.A. (2022).
th
4. Microbiology, Pearson Publisher, Gerard J. Tortora, Berdell R. Funke, Christine L.Case, 13
Edition 2019

REFERENCES:
1. Ecological Census Technique: A Handbook, Cambridge University Press, Sutherland, W.
2. Encyclopedia of Biodiversity, Academic Press, Simonson Asher Levin.

COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of this course, students will:
CO1: An insight into the structure and function of diversity for ecosystem stability.
CO2: Understand the concept of animal diversity and taxonomy
CO3: Understand socio-economic issues pertaining to biodiversity
CO4: An understanding of biodiversity in community resource management.
CO5: Student can apply fundamental knowledge of biodiversity conservation to solve problems
associated with infrastructure development.

322
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 2 2 2 2
2 2 2 2 2 3 2
3 2 2 3 2 3
4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 2 3
5 2 3 2 1 1 2
Avg. 3 2 3 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
1.low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation
Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.

OEE353 INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL SYSTEMS LTPC


30 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To impart knowledge on various representations of systems.
 To familiarize time response analysis of LTI systems and steady state error.
 To analyze the frequency responses and stability of the systems
 To analyze the stability of linear systems in frequency domain and time domain
 To develop linear models mainly state variable model and transfer function model

UNIT I MATHEMATICAL MODELS OF PHYSICALSYSTEMS 9


Definition & classification of system – terminology & structure of feedback control theory –
Analogous systems - Physical system representation by Differential equations – Block diagram
reduction–Signal flow graphs.

UNIT II TIME RESPONSE ANALYSIS & ROOTLOCUSTECHNIQUE 9


Standard test signals – Steady state error & error constants – Time Response of I and II order
system–Root locus–Rules for sketching root loci.

UNIT III FREQUENCY RESPONSE ANALYSIS 9


Correlation between Time & Frequency response – Polar plots – Bode Plots – Determination
of Transfer Function from Bode plot.

UNIT IV STABILITY CONCEPTS & ANALYSIS 9


Concept of stability – Necessary condition – RH criterion – Relative stability – Nyquist stability
criterion – Stability from Bode plot – Relative stability from Nyquist & Bode – Closed
loop frequency response.

UNITV STATE VARIABLE ANALYSIS 9


Concept of state – State Variable & State Model – State models for linear & continuous time
systems–Solution of state & output equation–controllability & observability.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
323
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Ability to
CO1: Design the basic mathematical model of physical System.
CO2: Analyze the time response analysis and techniques.
CO3: Analyze the transfer function from different plots.
CO4: Apply the stability concept in various criterion.
CO5: Assess the state models for linear and continuous Systems.

TEXTBOOKS
1. Farid Golnarghi , Benjamin C. Kuo, Automatic Control Systems Paper back McGraw Hill
Education, 2018.
2. Katsuhiko Ogata, ‘Modern Control Engineering’, Pearson, 5th Edition2015.
3. J. Nagrath and M. Gopal, Control Systems Engineering (Multi Colour Edition), New Age
International, 2018.
REFERENCES
1. Richard C. Dorf and Robert H. Bishop, Modern Control Systems, Pearson Education, 2010.
2. Control System Dynamics" by Robert Clark, Cambridge University Press, 1996 USA.
3. John J. D’Azzo, Constantine H. Houpis and Stuart N. Sheldon, Linear Control System
AnalysisandDesign, 5th Edition, CRC PRESS, 2003.
4. S. Palani, Control System Engineering, McGraw-Hill Education Private Limited, 2009.
5. Yaduvir Singh and S.Janardhanan, Modern Control, Cengage Learning, First
Impression2010.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
CO1 3 3 3 2 2 2 3 3 3
CO2 3 3 2 3 1 3 3 3
CO3 3 3 3 2 2 3 3 3
CO4 3 3 3 2 2 2 3 3 3
CO5 3 3 3 1 1 1 3 3 3
3 3 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OEI354 INTRODUCTION TO INDUSTRIAL AUTOMATION SYSTEMS LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To educate on design of signal conditioning circuits for various applications.
 To Introduce signal transmission techniques and their design.
 Study of components used in data acquisition systems interface techniques
 To educate on the components used in distributed control systems
 To introduce the communication buses used in automation industries.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Automation overview, Requirement of automation systems, Architecture of Industrial Automation
system, Introduction of PLC and supervisory control and data acquisition (SCADA). Industrial bus
systems : Modbus & Profibus
324
UNIT II AUTOMATION COMPONENTS 9
Sensors for temperature, pressure, force, displacement, speed, flow, level, humidity and pH
measurement. Actuators, process control valves, power electronics devices DIAC, TRIAC, power
MOSFET and IGBT. Introduction of DC and AC servo drives for motion control.

UNIT III COMPUTER AIDED MEASUREMENT AND CONTROL SYSTEMS 9


Role of computers in measurement and control, Elements of computer aided measurement and
control, man-machine interface, computer aided process control hardware, process related
interfaces, Communication and networking, Industrial communication systems, Data transfer
techniques, Computer aided process control software, Computer based data acquisition system,
Internet of things (IoT) for plant automation.

UNIT IV PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLERS 9


Programmable controllers, Programmable logic controllers, Analog digital input and output
modules, PLC programming, Ladder diagram, Sequential flow chart, PLC Communication and
networking, PLC selection, PLC Installation, Advantage of using PLC for Industrial automation,
Application of PLC to process control industries.

UNIT V DISTRIBUTED CONTROL SYSTEM 9


Overview of DCS, DCS software configuration, DCS communication, DCS Supervisory Computer
Tasks, DCS integration with PLC and Computers, Features of DCS, Advantages of DCS.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
SKILL DEVELOPMENT ACTIVITIES (Group Seminar/Mini Project/Assignment/Content
Preparation / Quiz/ Surprise Test / Solving GATE questions/ etc) 5
1. Market survey of the recent PLCs and comparison of their features.
2. Summarize the PLC standards
3. Familiarization of any one programming language (Ladder diagram/ Sequential Function
Chart/ Function Block Diagram/ Equivalent open source software)
4. Market survey of Industrial Data Networks.

COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students able to
CO1 Design a signal conditioning circuits for various application (L3).
CO2 Acquire a detail knowledge on data acquisition system interface and DCS system (L2).
CO3 Understand the basics and Importance of communication buses in applied automation
Engineering (L2).
CO4 Ability to design PLC Programmes by Applying Timer/Counter and Arithmetic and Logic
Instructions Studied for Ladder Logic and Function BIock.(L3)
CO5 Able to develop a PLC logic for a specific application on real world problem. (L5)

TEXT BOOKS:
1. S.K.Singh, “Industrial Instrumentation”, Tata Mcgraw Hill, 2nd edition companies,2003.
2. C D Johnson, “Process Control Instrumentation Technology”, Prentice Hall India,8th
Edition, 2006.
3. E.A.Parr, Newnes ,NewDelhi,“Industrial Control Handbook”,3rd Edition, 2000.

325
REFERENCES:
1. John W. Webb and Ronald A. Reis, “Programmable Logic Controllers: Principles and
Applications”, 5th Edition, Prentice Hall Inc., New Jersey, 2003.
2. Frank D. Petruzella, “Programmable Logic Controllers”, 5th Edition, McGraw- Hill, New York,
2016.
3. Krishna Kant, “Computer - Based Industrial Control”, 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall, New Delhi, 2011.
4. Gary Dunning, Thomson Delmar,“Programmable Logic Controller”, CeneageLearning, 3 rd
Edition,2005.

List of Open Source Software/ Learning website:


1. https://archive.nptel.ac.in/courses/108/105/108105062/
2. https://nptel.ac.in/courses/108105063
3. https://www.electrical4u.com/industrial-automation/
4. https://realpars.com/what-is-industrial-automation/
5. https://automationforum.co/what-is-industrial-automation-2/

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 3 2 2 2 1 1 - 1 - 1 - 1 1 - 1
CO2 3 `1 1 - 1 - - 1 - 1 - - 1 - 1
CO3 3 - 1 - 1 - - 1 - 1 - - 1 - 1
CO4 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 1 1
CO5 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1
AVg. 3 2.25 2 2.6 1 1 - 1 - 1 - - 1 - 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OCH353 ENERGY TECHNOLOGY L T PC


3 0 0 3

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 8
Units of energy, conversion factors, general classification of energy, world energy resources and
energy consumption, Indian energy resources and energy consumption, energy crisis, energy
alternatives, Renewable and non-renewable energy sources and their availability. Prospects of
Renewable energy sources

UNIT II CONVENTIONAL ENERGY 8


Conventional energy resources, Thermal, hydel and nuclear reactors, thermal, hydel and nuclear
power plants, efficiency, merits and demerits of the above power plants, combustion processes,
fluidized bed combustion.

UNIT III NON-CONVENTIONAL ENERGY 10


Solar energy, solar thermal systems, flat plate collectors, focusing collectors, solar water heating,
solar cooling, solar distillation, solar refrigeration, solar dryers, solar pond, solar thermal power
generation, solar energy application in India, energy plantations. Wind energy, types of windmills,
326
types of wind rotors, Darrieus rotor and Gravian rotor, wind electric power generation, wind power
in India, economics of wind farm, ocean wave energy conversion, ocean thermal energy
conversion, tidal energy conversion, geothermal energy.

UNIT IV BIOMASS ENERGY 10


Biomass energy resources, thermo-chemical and biochemical methods of biomass conversion,
combustion, gasification, pyrolysis, biogas production, ethanol, fuel cells, alkaline fuel cell,
phosphoric acid fuel cell, molten carbonate fuel cell, solid oxide fuel cell, solid polymer electrolyte
fuel cell, magneto hydrodynamic power generation, energy storage routes like thermal energy
storage, chemical, mechanical storage and electrical storage.

UNIT V ENERGY CONSERVATION 9


Energy conservation in chemical process plants, energy audit, energy saving in heat exchangers,
distillation columns, dryers, ovens and furnaces and boilers, steam economy in chemical plants,
energy conservation.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the students will be able to
CO1: Students will be able to describe the fundamentals and main characteristics of
renewable energy sources and their differences compared to fossil fuels.
CO2: Students will excel as professionals in the various fields of energy engineering
CO3: Compare different renewable energy technologies and choose the most appropriate based
on local conditions.
CO4: Explain the technological basis for harnessing renewable energy sources.
CO5: Identify and critically evaluate current developments and emerging trends within the
field of renewable energy technologies and to develop in-depth technical
understanding of energy problems at an advanced level.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Rao, S. and Parulekar, B.B., Energy Technology, Khanna Publishers, 2005.
2. Rai, G.D., Non-conventional Energy Sources, Khanna Publishers, New Delhi, 1984.
3. Bansal, N.K., Kleeman, M. and Meliss, M., Renewable Energy Sources and Conversion
Technology, Tata McGraw Hill, 1990.
4. Nagpal, G.R., Power Plant Engineering, Khanna Publishers, 2008.

REFERENCES
1. Nejat Vezirog, Alternate Energy Sources, IT, McGraw Hill, New York.
2. El. Wakil, Power Plant Technology, Tata McGraw Hill, New York, 2002.
3. Sukhatme. S.P., Solar Enery - Thermal Collection and Storage, Tata McGraw hill, New
Delhi, 1981.

327
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
Cour Program Outcomes
se Statements P P P P P P P P P P P P P PS PS
Outc O O O O O O O O O O O O S O2 O3
ome 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 1 1 O
s 0 1 2 1
CO1 Students will be able to 2 3 2 3 3 - - - 1 1 - 3 1 1 3
describe the
fundamentals and main
characteristics of
renewable energy
sources and their
differences compared to
fossil fuels.
CO2 Students will excel as 2 3 1 3 3 - - - 1 1 - 3 2 1 3
professionals in the
various fields of energy
engineering
CO3 Compare different 2 2 2 3 3 1 1 - 1 1 - 3 2 1 3
renewable energy
technologies and choose
the most appropriate
based on local
conditions.
CO4 Explain the technological 2 2 1 3 3 1 1 1 1 - 1 3 1 1 3
basis for harnessing
renewable energy
sources.
CO5 Identify and critically 2 2 1 3 3 1 1 1 1 - 1 3 2 1 3
evaluate current
developments and
emerging trends within
the field of renewable
energy technologies and
to develop in-depth
technical understanding
of energy problems at an
advanced level
OVERALL CO 2 2 1 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 2 1 3
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and
Substantial (High) respectively

328
OCH354 SURFACE SCIENCE LT P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To enable the students to analyze properties of a surfaces and correlate them to structure,
chemistry, and physics and surface modification technique.

UNIT I SURFACE STRUCTURE AND EXPERIMENTAL PROBES 9


Relevance of surface science to Chemical and Electrochemical Engineering, Heterogeneous
Catalysis and Nanoscience; Surface structure and reconstructions, absorbate structure, Band and
Vibrational structure, Importance of UHV techniques, Electronic probes and molecular beams,
Scanning probes and diffraction, Qualitative introduction to electronic and vibrational spectroscopy

UNIT II ADSORPTION, DYNAMICS, THERMODYNAMICS AND KINETICS AT


SURFACES 9
Interactions at the surface, Physisorption, Chemisorption, Diffusion, dynamics and reactions of
atoms/molecules on surfaces, Generic reaction mechanism on surfaces, Adsorption isotherms,
Kinetics of adsorption, Use of temperature desorption methods

UNIT III LIQUID INTERFACES 9


Structure and Thermodynamics of liquid-solid interface, Self-assembled monolayers, Electrified
interfaces, Charge transfer at the liquid-solid interfaces, Photoelectrochemical processes, Gratzel
cells

UNIT IV HETEROGENEOUS CATALYSIS 9


Characterization of heterogeneous catalytic processes, Microscopic kinetics to catalysis, Overview
of important heterogeneous catalytic processes: Haber-Bosch, Fishcher-Tropsch and Automotive
catalysis, Role of promoters and poisons, Bimetallic surfaces, surface functionalization and
clusters in catalysis, Role of Sabatier principle in catalyst design, Rate oscillations and
spatiotemporal pattern formation

UNIT V EPITAXIAL GROWTH AND NANO SURFACE-STRUCTURES 9


Origin of surface forces, Role of stress and strain in epitaxial growth, Energetic and growth modes,
Nucleation theory, Nonequilibrium growth modes, MBE, CVD and ablation techniques, Catalytic
growth of nanotubes, Etching of surfaces, Formation of nanopillars and nanorods and its
application in photoelectrochemical processes, Polymer surfaces and biointerfaces.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOME:
 Upon completion of this course, the students can understand, predict and design surface
properties based on surface structure. Students would understand the physics and chemistry
behind surface phenomena

TEXT BOOK:
1. K. W. Kolasinski, “Surface Science: Foundations of catalysis and nanoscience” II Edition, John
Wiley & Sons, New York, 2008.

REFERENCE:
1. Gabor A. Somorjai and Yimin Li “Introduction to Surface Chemistry and catalysis”, II Edition
John Wiley & Sons, New York, 2010.
329
OFD354 FUNDAMENTALS OF FOOD ENGINEERING LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
The course aims to
 acquaint and equip the students with different techniques of measurement of engineering
properties.
 make the students understand the nature of food constituents in the design of processing
equipment
UNIT I 9
Engineering properties of food materials: physical, thermal, aerodynamic, mechanical, optical and
electromagnetic properties.

UNIT II 9
Drying and dehydration: Basic drying theory, heat and mass transfer in drying, drying rate curves,
calculation of drying times, dryer efficiencies; classification and selection of dryers; tray, vacuum,
osmotic, fluidized bed, pneumatic, rotary, tunnel, trough, bin, belt, microwave, IR, heat pump and
freeze dryers; dryers for liquid: Drum or roller dryer, spray dryer and foammat dryers

UNIT III 9
Size reduction: Benefits, classification, determination and designation of the fineness of ground
material, sieve/screen analysis, principle and mechanisms of comminution of food, Rittinger’s,
Kick’s and Bond’s equations, work index, energy utilization; Size reduction equipment: Principal
types, crushers (jaw crushers, gyratory, smooth roll), hammer mills and impactors, attrition mills,
buhr mill, tumbling mills, tumbling mills, ultra fine grinders, fluid jet pulverizer, colloid mill, cutting
machines (slicing, dicing, shredding, pulping)

UNIT IV 9
Mixing: theory of solids mixing, criteria of mixer effectiveness and mixing indices, rate of mixing,
theory of liquid mixing, power requirement for liquids mixing; Mixing equipment: Mixers for lo.w- or
medium-viscosity liquids (paddle agitators, impeller agitators, powder-liquid contacting devices,
other mixers), mixers for high viscosity liquids and pastes, mixers for dry powders and particulate
solids.

UNIT V 9
Mechanical Separations: Theory, centrifugation, liquid-liquid centrifugation, liquid-solid
centrifugation, clarifiers, desludging and decanting machine, Filtration: Theory of filtration, rate of
filtration, pressure drop during filtration, applications, constant-rate filtration and constant-pressure
filtration, derivation of equation; Filtration equipment; plate and frame filter press, rotary filters,
centrifugal filters and air filters, filter aids, Membrane separation: General considerations, materials
for membrane construction, ultra-filtration, microfiltration, concentration, polarization, processing
variables, membrane fouling, applications of ultra-filtration in food processing, reverse osmosis,
mode of operation, and applications; Membrane separation methods, demineralization by electro-
dialysis, gel filtration, ion exchange, per-evaporation and osmotic dehydration.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course the students will be able to
CO1 understand the importance of food polymers
330
CO2 understand the effect of various methods of processing on the structure and texture of food
materials
CO3 understand the interaction of food constituents with respect to thermal, electrical properties to
develop new technologies for processing and preservation.

TEXTBOOKS:
1. R.L. Earle. 2004. Unit Operations in Food Processing. The New Zealand Intitute of Food
Science & Technology, Nz. Warren L. McCabe, Julian Smith, Peter Harriott. 2004.
2. Unit Operations of Chemical Engineering, 7th Ed. McGraw-Hill, Inc., NY, USA. Christie John
Geankoplis. 2003.
3. Transport Processes and Separation Process Principles (Includes Unit Operations), 4th Ed.
Prentice-Hall, NY, USA.
4. George D. Saravacos and Athanasios E. Kostaropoulos. 2002. Handbook of Food Processing
Equipment. Springer Science+Business Media, New York, USA.
5. J. F. Richardson, J. H. Harker and J. R. Backhurst. 2002. Coulson & Richardson's Chemical
Engineering, Vol. 2, Particle Technology and Separation Processes, 5th Ed.

OFD355 FOOD SAFETY AND QUALITY REGULATIONS LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To characterize different type of food hazards, physical, chemical and biological in the
industry and food service establishments
 To help become skilled in systems for food safety surveillance
 To be aware of the regulatory and statutory bodies in India and the world
 To ensure processed food meets global standards

UNIT I 10
Introduction to food safety and security: Hygienic design of food plants and equipments, Food
Contaminants (Microbial, Chemical, Physical), Food Adulteration (Common adulterants), Food
Additives (functional role, safety issues), Food Packaging & labeling. Sanitation in warehousing,
storage, shipping, receiving, containers and packaging materials. Control of rats, rodents, mice,
birds, insects and microbes. Cleaning and Disinfection, ISO 22000 – Importance and
Implementation

UNIT II 8
Food quality: Various Quality attributes of food, Instrumental, chemical and microbial Quality
control. Sensory evaluation of food and statistical analysis. Water quality and other utilities.

UNIT III 9
Critical Quality control point in different stages of production including raw materials and
processing materials. Food Quality and Quality control including the HACCP system. Food
inspection and Food Law, Risk assessment – microbial risk assessment, dose response and

331
exposure response modelling, risk management, implementation of food surveillance system to
monitor food safety, risk communication

UNIT IV 9
Indian and global regulations: FAO in India, Technical Cooperation programmes, Bio-security in
Food and Agriculture, World Health Organization (WHO), World Animal Health Organization (OIE),
International Plant Protection Convention (IPPC)

UNIT V 9
Codex Alimentarius Commission - Codex India – Role of Codex Contact point, National Codex
contact point (NCCP), National Codex Committee of India – ToR, Functions, Shadow Committees
etc.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1 Thorough Knowledge of food hazards, physical, chemical and biological in the industry and
food service establishments
CO2 Awareness on regulatory and statutory bodies in India and the world

REFERENCES:
1. Handbook of food toxicology by S. S. Deshpande, 2002
2. The food safety information handbook by Cynthia A. Robert, 2009
3. Nutritional and safety aspects of food processing by Tannenbaum SR, Marcel Dekker Inc., New
York 1979
4. Microbiological safety of Food by Hobbs BC, 1973
5. Food Safety Handbook by Ronald H. Schmidt, Gary E. Rodrick, A John Wiley & Sons
Publication, 2003

OPY353 NUTRACEUTICALS LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the basic concepts of Nutraceuticals and functional food, their chemical
nature and methods of extraction.
 To understand the role of Nutraceuticals and functional food in health and disease.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION AND SIGNIFICANCE 6


Introduction to Nutraceuticals and functional foods; importance, history, definition, classification, list
of functional foods and their benefits, Phytochemicals, zoochemicals and microbes in food, plants,
animals and microbes.

UNIT II PHYTOCHEMICALS AS NUTRACEUTICALS 11


Phytoestrogens in plants; isoflavones; flavonols, polyphenols, tannins, saponins, lignans, lycopene,
chitin, caratenoids. Manufacturing practice of selected nutraceuticals such as lycopene,
isoflavonoids, glucosamine, phytosterols. Formulation of functional foods containing nutraceuticals
- stability, analytical and labelling issues.

332
UNIT III ASSESSMENT OF ANTIOXIDANT ACTIVITY 11
In vitro and in vivo methods for the assessment of antioxidant activity, Comparison of different in
vitro methods to evaluate the antioxidant, antioxidant mechanism, Prediction of the antioxidant
activity of natural phenolics from electrotopological state indices, Optimising phytochemical release
by process technology; Variation of Antioxidant Activity during technological treatments, new food
grade peptidases from plant sources.

UNIT IV ROLE IN HEALTH AND DISEASE 11


The health benefit of - Soy protein, Spirulina, Tea, Olive oil, plant sterols, Broccoli, omega3 fatty
acid and eicosanoids. Nutraceuticals and Functional foods in Gastrointestinal disorder, Cancer,
CVD, Diabetic Mellitus, HIV and Dental disease; Importance and function of probiotic, prebiotic and
synbiotic and their applications, Functional foods and immune competence; role and use in obesity
and nervous system disorders.

UNIT V SAFETY ISSUES 6


Health Claims, Adverse effects and toxicity of nutraceuticals, regulations and safety issues
International and national.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Bisset, Normal Grainger and Max Wich H “Herbal Drugs and Phytopharmaceuticals”, 2nd
Edition, CRC, 2001.
2. Handbook of Nutraceuticals and Functional Foods: Robert Wildman, CRC, Publications. 2006
3. WEBB, PP, Dietary Supplements and Functional Foods Blackwell Publishing Ltd (United
Kingdom), 2006
4. Ikan, Raphael “Natural Products: A Laboratory Guide”, 2nd Edition, Academic Press /
Elsevier, 2005.

REFERENCES:
1. Asian Functional Foods (Nutraceutical Science and Technology) by John Shi (Editor),
Fereidoon Shahidi (Editor), Chi-Tang Ho (Editor), CRC Publications, Taylor & Francis,
2007
2. Functional Foods and Nutraceuticals in Cancer Prevention by Ronald Ross Watson
(Author), Blackwell Publishing, 2007
3. Marketing Nutrition: Soy, Functional Foods, Biotechnology, and Obesity by Brian
Wansink.
4. Functional foods: Concept to Product: Edited by G R Gibson and C M Williams, Wood
head Publ., 2000
5. Hanson, James R. “Natural Products: The Secondary Metabolites”, Royal Society of
Chemistry, 2003.

COURSE OUTCOME - NUTRACEUTICALS

CO 1 acquire knowledge about the Nutraceuticals and functional foods, their classification and
benefits.
CO 2 acquire knowledge of phytochemicals, zoochemicals and microbes in food, plants,
animals and microbes
CO 3 attain the knowledge of the manufacturing practices of selected nutraceutical

333
components and formulation considerations of functional foods.
CO 4 distinguish the various In vitro and In vivo assessment of Antioxidant activity of
compounds from plant sources.
CO 5 gain information about the health benefits of various functional foods and nutraceuticals
in the prevention and treatment of various lifestyle diseases.
CO 6 Attain the knowledge of the regulatory and safety issues of nutraceuticals at national
and international level.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


NUTRACEUTICALS
Course PO1 PO2 PO PO PO PO6 PO PO8 PO PO10 PO11 PO12
outcome 3 4 5 7 9
CO 1 3 1
CO 2 3 1
CO 3 3 2
CO 4 3
CO 5 3 2 1
CO 6 3 2 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OTT354 BASICS OF DYEING AND PRINTING LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To enable the students to learn about the basics of Pretreatment, dyeing, printing and
machinery in textile processing.

UNIT I INTRODUCTIO 9
Impurities present in different fibres, Inspection of grey goods and lot preparation. Shearing,

UNIT II PRE TREATMENT 9


Desizing-Objective of Desizing- types of Desizing- Objective of Scouring- Mechanism of Scouring–
Degumming of Silk, Scouring of wool - Bio Scouring. Bleaching -Objective of Bleaching: Bleaching
mechanism of Hydrogen Peroxide, Hypo chlorites. Objective of Mercerizing - Physical and
Chemical changes of Mercerizing.

UNIT III DYEING 9


Dye - Affinity, Substantively, Reactivity, Exhaustion and Fixation. Classification of dyes. Direct
dyes: General properties, principles and method of application on cellulosic materials. Reactive
dyes – principles and method of application on cellulosic materials hot brand, cold brand.

UNIT IV PRINTING 9
Definition of printing – Difference between printing and dying- Classification thickeners –
Requirements to be good thickener, printing paste Preparation - different styles of printing.
334
UNIT V MACHINERIES 9
Fabric Processing - winch, jigger and soft flow machines. Beam dyeing machines: Printing -flat
bed screen - Rotary screen. Thermo transfer printing machinery. Garment dyeing machines.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, the students will be able to Understand the
CO1: Basics of grey fabric
CO2: Basics of pre treatment
CO3: Concept of Dyeing
CO4: Concept of Printing
CO5: Machinery in processing industry

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Trotman, E.R., Textile Scouring and Bleaching, Charless Griffins, Com. Ltd., London 1990.
2. Shenai V.A. “Technology of Textile Processing Vol. IV” 1998, Sevak Publications, Mumbai.

REFERENCES:
1. Trotman E. R., “Dyeing and Chemical Technology of Textile Fibres”, Charles Griffin & Co. Ltd.,
U.K., 1984, ISBN : 0 85264 165 6.
2. Dr. N N Mahapatra., “Textile dyeing”, Wood head publishing India, 2018
3. Mathews Kolanjikombil., ”Dyeing of Textile substrates III –Fibres, Yarns and Knitted fabrics”,
Wood head publishing India , 2021
4. Bleaching & Mercerizing – BTRA Silver Jubilee Monograph series
5. Chakraborty, J.N, "Fundamentals and Practices in colouration of Textiles", Wood head
Publishing India, 2009, ISBN-13:978-81-908001-4-3.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING:


1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and
Substantial (High) respectively

Course Program Outcome


Outco Statemen PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
mes t 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
Classifica - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
tion of
fibres and
CO1 productio
n of
natural
fibres
Regenera - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
ted and
CO2
synthetic
fibres
Yarn - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
CO3
spinning

335
CO4 Weaving - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
Knitting - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
and
CO5
nonwove
n
Overa - - - - - - - 2 1 - 1 1 - 1 -
ll CO
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

FT3201 FIBRE SCIENCE L T PC


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To enable the students to learn about the types of fibre and its properties

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO TEXTILE FIBRES 9


Definition of various forms of textile fibres - staple fibre, filament, bicomponent fibres. Classification
of Natural and Man-made fibres, essential and desirable properties of Fibres. Production and
cultivation of Natural Fibers: Cotton, Silk, Wool -Physical and chemical structure of the above
fibres.

UNIT II REGENERATED FIBRES 9


Production Sequence of Regenerated Cellulosic fibres: Viscose Rayon, Acetate rayon – High wet
modulus fibres: Modal and Lyocel ,Tencel

UNIT III SYNTHEITC FIBRES 9


Production Sequence of Synthetic Fibers: polymer-Polyester, Nylon, Acrylic and polypropylene.
Mineral fibres: fibre glass ,carbon .Introduction to spin finishes and texturization

UNIT IV SPECIALITY FIBRES 9


Properties and end uses of high tenacity and high modulus fibres, high temperature and flame
retardant fibres, Chemical resistant fibres

UNIT V FUNCTIONAL SPECIALITY FIBRES 9


Properties and end uses : Fibres for medical application – Biodegradable fibres based on PLA
,Super absorbent fibres elastomeric fibres, ultra-fine fibres, electrospun nano fibres, metallic fibres
– Gold and Silver coated.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon completion of this course, the student would be able to
CO1:Understand the process sequence of various fibres
CO2:Understand the properties of various fibres

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Morton W. E., and Hearle J. W. S., “Physical Properties of Textile Fibres”, The Textile
Institute, Washington D.C., 2008, ISBN 978-1-84569-220-95
2. Meredith R., and Hearle J. W. S., “Physical Methods of Investigation of Textiles”, Wiley
Publication, New York, 1989, ISBN: B00JCV6ZWU | ISBN-13:

336
3. Mukhopadhyay S. K., “Advances in Fibre Science”, The Textile Institute,1992, ISBN:
1870812379

REFERENCES:
1. Meredith R., “Mechanical Properties of Textile Fibres”, North Holland, Amsterdam, 1986, ISBN:
1114790699, ISBN-13: 9781114790698
2. Hearle J. W. S., Lomas B., and Cooke W. D., “Atlas of Fibre Fracture and Damage to Textiles”,
The Textile Institute, 2nd Edition, 1998, ISBN: 1855733196.
3. Raheel M. (ed.)., “Modern Textile Characterization Methods”, Marcel Dekker, 1995,
ISBN:0824794737
4. Mukhopadhyay. S. K., “The Structure and Properties of Typical Melt Spun Fibres”, Textile
Progress, Vol. 18, No. 4, Textile Institute, 1989, ISBN: 1870812115
5. Hearle J.W.S., “Polymers and Their Properties: Fundamentals of Structures and Mechanics Vol
1”, Ellis Horwood, England, 1982, ISBN: 047027302X | ISBN-13: 9780470273029 36

OTT355 GARMENT MANUFACTURING TECHNOLOGY LT PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To enable the students to understand the basics of pattern making, cutting and sewing.
 To expose the students to various problems & remedies during garment manufacturing

UNIT I PATTERN MAKING, MARKER PLANNING, CUTTING 9


Anthropometry, specification sheet, pattern making – principles, basic pattern set drafting, grading,
marker planning, spreading & cutting

UNIT II TYPES OF SEAMS, STITCHES AND FUNCTIONS OF NEEDLES 9


Different types of seams and stitches; single needle lock stitch machine – mechanism and
accessories; needle – functions, special needles, needlepoint

UNIT III COMPONENTS AND TRIMS USED IN GARMENT 9


Sewing thread-construction, material, thread size, packages, accessories – labels, linings,
interlinings, wadding, lace, braid, elastic, hook and loop fastening, shoulder pads, eyelets and
laces, zip fasteners, buttons

UNIT IV GARMENT INSPECTION AND DIMENSIONAL CHANGES 9


Raw material, in process and final inspection; needle cutting; sewability of fabrics; strength
properties of apparel; dimensional changes in apparel due to laundering, dry-cleaning, steaming
and pressing.

UNIT V GARMENT PRESSING, PACKING AND CARE LABELING 9


Garment pressing – categories and equipment, packing; care 337abelling of apparels
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, the students will be able to Understand
CO1: Pattern making, marker planning, cutting
CO2: Types of seams, stitches and functions of needles
337
CO3: Components and trims used in garment
CO4: Garment inspection and dimensional changes
CO5: Garment pressing, packing and careabelling

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Carr H., and Latham B., “The Technology of Clothing Manufacture”, Blackwell Science Ltd.,
Oxford, 1994.
2. Gerry Cooklin, “Introduction to Clothing Manufacture” Blackwell Science Ltd., 1995. 64
3. Harrison.P.W Garment Dyeing, The Textile Institute Publication, Textile Progress, Vol .19
No.2,1988.

REFERENCES:
1. Winifred Aldrich., “Metric Pattern Cutting”, Blackwell Science Ltd., Oxford, 1994
2. Peggal H., “The Complete Dress Maker”, Marshall Caverdish, London, 1985
3. Jai Prakash and Gaur R.K., “Sewing Thread”, NITRA, 1994
4. Ruth Glock, Grace I. Kunz, “Apparel Manufacturing”, Dorling Kindersley Publishing Inc., New
Jersey, 1995.
5. Pradip V.Mehta, “An Introduction to Quality Control for the Apparel Industry”, J.S.N.
Internationals, 1992.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
1 1 1 1 - 2 - 1 1 - 2 3 1 2 3 1 3
2 2 2 1 1 1 - 1 1 - 2 2 1 2 2 1 2
3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 - 1 2 1 1 3 1 3
4 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 1 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 3
5 2 2 1 1 1 1 2 1 - 2 2 1 2 2 1 2
Avg 1.6 1.2 1 0.8 1.4 0.8 1.4 1 0.2 1.8 2.4 1 1.8 2.6 1 2.6
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

OPE353 INDUSTRIAL SAFETY L T P C


3 0 0 3

COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To educate about the health hazards and the safety measures to be followed in the industrial
environment.
 Describe industrial legislations (Factories Acts, Workmen's Compensation and other laws)
enacted for the protection of employees health at work settings
 Describe methods of prevention and control of Occupational Health diseases, accidents /
emergencies and other hazards

338
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Need for developing Environment, Health and Safety systems in work places - Accident Case
Studies - Status and relationship of Acts - Regulations and Codes of Practice - Role of trade union
safety representatives. International initiatives - Ergonomics and work place.

UNIT II OCCUPATIONAL HEALTH AND HYGIENE 9


Definition of the term occupational health and hygiene - Categories of health hazards - Exposure
pathways and human responses to hazardous and toxic substances - Advantages and limitations
of environmental monitoring and occupational exposure limits - Hierarchy of control measures for
occupational health risks - Role of personal protective equipment and the selection criteria - Effects
on humans - control methods and reduction strategies for noise, radiation and excessive stress.

UNIT III WORKPLACE SAFETY AND SAFETY SYSTEMS 9


Features of Satisfactory and Safe design of work premises – good housekeeping - lighting and
colour, Ventilation and Heat Control – Electrical Safety – Fire Safety – Safe Systems of work for
manual handling operations – Machine guarding – Working at different levels – Process and
System Safety.

UNIT IV HAZARDS AND RISK MANAGEMENT 9


Safety appraisal - analysis and control techniques – plant safety inspection – Accident investigation
- Analysis and Reporting – Hazard and Risk Management Techniques – major accident hazard
control – Onsite and Offsite emergency Plans.

UNIT V ENVIRONMENTAL HEALTH AND SAFETY MANAGEMENT 9


Concept of Environmental Health and Safety Management – Elements of Environmental Health
and Safety Management Policy and methods of its effective implementation and review – Elements
of Management Principles – Education and Training – Employee Participation.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completion of this course, the student is expected to be able to:
CO1:Describe, with example, the common work-related diseases and accidents in occupational
setting
CO2:Name essential members of the Occupational Health team
CO3:What roles can a community health practitioners play in an Occupational setting to ensure the
protection, promotion and maintenance of the health of the employee

OPE354 UNIT OPERATIONS IN PETRO CHEMICAL INDUSTRIES LT PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To impart to the student basic knowledge on fluid mechanics, mechanical operations, heat
transfer operations and mass transfer operations.

UNIT I FLUID MECHANICS CONCEPTS


Fluid definition and classification of fluids, types of fluids, Rheological behaviour of fluids &
Newton’s Law of viscosity. Fluid statics-Pascal's law, Hydrostatic equilibrium, Barometric equation
and pressure measurement(problems),Basic equations of fluid flow - Continuity equation, Euler’s
equation and Bernoulli equation; Types of flow - laminar and turbulent; Reynolds experiment; Flow

339
through circular and non-circular conduits - Hagen Poiseuille equation (no derivation). Flow
through stagnant fluids – theory of Settling and Sedimentation – Equipment (cyclones, thickeners)
Conceptual numericals.

UNIT II FLOW MEASUREMENTS & MECHANICAL OPERATIONS


Different types of flow measuring devices (Orifice meter, Venturimeter, Rotameter) with
derivations, flow measurements –. Pumps – types of pumps (Centrifugal & Reciprocating pumps),
Energy calculations and characteristics of pumps. Size reduction–characteristics of comminute
products, sieve analysis, Properties and handling of particulate solids – characterization of solid
particles, average particle size, screen analysis- Conceptual numerical of differential and
cumulative analysis. Size reduction, crushing laws, working principle of ball mill. Filtration & types,
filtration equipments (plate and frame, rotary drum). Conceptual numericals.

UNIT III CONDUCTIVE & CONVECTIVE HEAT TRANSFER


Modes of heat transfer; Conduction – steady state heat conduction through unilayer and multilayer
walls, cylinders; Insulation, critical thickness of insulation. Convection- Forced and Natural
convection, principles of heat transfer co-efficient, log mean temperature difference, individual and
overall heat transfer co-efficient, fouling factor; Condensation – film wise and drop wise (no
derivation). Heat transfer equipments – double pipe heat exchanger, shell and tube heat
exchanger (with working principle and construction with applications).

UNIT IV BASICS OF MASS TRANSFER


Diffusion-Fick’s law of diffusion. Types of diffusion. Steady state molecular diffusion in fluids at rest
and laminar flow (stagnant / unidirection and bi direction). Measurement of diffusivity, Mass
transfer coefficients and their correlations. Conceptual numerical.

UNIT V MASS TRANSFER OPERATIONS


Basic concepts of Liquid-liquid extraction – equilibrium, stage type extractors (belt extraction and
basket extraction).Distillation – Methods of distillation, distillation of binary mixtures using McCabe
Thiele method.Drying- drying operations, batch and continuous drying. Conceptual numerical.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course the student will be able to:
CO1:State and describe the nature and properties of the fluids.
CO2:Study the different flow measuring instruments, the principles of various size reductions,
conveying equipment’s, sedimentation and mixing tanks.
CO3:Comprehend the laws governing the heat and mass transfer operations to solve the
problems.
CO4:Design the heat transfer equipment suitable for specific requirement.

TEXTBOOK(S)
1. Unit operations in Chemical Engineering Warren L. McCabe, Julian C. Smith & Peter
Harriot McGraw-Hill Education (India) Edition 2014
2. Fluid Mechanics K L Kumar S Chand & Company Ltd 2008
3. Introduction to Chemical Engineering Badger W.I. and Banchero, J.T., Tata McGraw Hill
New York 1997

340
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Principles of Unit Operations Alan S Foust, L.A. Wenzel, C.W. Clump, L. Maus, and
L.B. Anderson John Wiley & Sons 2nd edition 2008
2. Unit Operations of Chemical Engineering, Vol I &II Chattopadhyaya Khanna Publishers,
Delhi-6 1996
3. Heat Transfer J P Holman McGraw Hill International Ed

OPT352 PLASTIC MATERIALS FOR ENGINEERS L T PC


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 Understand the advantages, disadvantages and general classification of plastic materials
 To know the manufacturing, sources, and applications of engineering thermoplastics
 Understand the basics as well as the advanced applications of various plastic materials in
the industry
 To understand the preparation methods of thermosetting materials
 Select suitable specialty plastics for different end applications

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO PLASTIC MATERIALS 9


Introduction to Plastics – Brief history of plastics, advantages and disadvantages, thermoplastic
and thermosetting behavior, amorphous polymers, crystalline polymers and cross-linked
structures. General purpose thermoplastics/ Commodity plastics: manufacture, structure,
properties and applications of polyethylene (PE), cross-linked PE, chlorinated PE, polypropylene,
polyvinyl chloride-compounding, formulation, polypropylene (PP)

UNIT II ENGINEERING THERMOPLASTICS AND APPLICATIONS 9


Engineering thermoplastics – Aliphatic polyamides: structure, properties, manufacture and
applications of Nylon 6, Nylon 66. Polyesters: manufacture, structure, properties and uses of PET,
PBT. Manufacture, structure, properties and uses of Polycarbonates, acetal resins, polyimides,
PMMA, polyphenylene oxide, thermoplastic polyurethane (PU)

UNIT III THERMOSETTING PLASTICS 9


Thermosetting Plastics – Manufacture, curing, moulding powder, laminates, properties and uses of
phenol formaldehyde resins, urea formaldehyde, melamine formaldehyde, unsaturated polyester
resin, epoxy resin, silicone resins, polyurethane resins.

UNIT IV MISCELLANEOUS PLASTICS FOR END APPLICATIONS 9


Miscellaneous plastics- Manufacture, properties and uses of polystyrene, HIPS, ABS, SAN,
poly(tetrafluoroethylene) (PTFE), TFE and copolymers, PVDF, PVA, poly (vinyl acetate), poly (vinyl
carbazole), cellulose acetate, PEEK, High energy absorbing polymers, super absorbent polymers-
their synthesis, properties and applications

UNIT V PLASTICS MATERIALS FOR BIOMEDICAL APPLICATIONS 9


Sources, raw materials, methods of manufacturing, properties and applications of bio-based
polymers- poly lactic acid (PLA), poly hydroxy alkanoates (PHA), PBAT, bioplastics- bio-PE, bio-
PP, bio-PET, polymers for biomedical applications
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

341
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1:To study the importance, advantages and classification of plastic materials
CO2:Summarize the raw materials, sources, production, properties and applications of various
engineering thermoplastics
CO3:To understand the application of polyamides, polyesters and other engineering
thermoplastics, thermosetting resins
CO4:Know the manufacture, properties and uses of thermosetting resins based on polyester,
epoxy, silicone and PU
CO5:To understand the engineering applications of various polymers in miscellaneous areas and
applications of different biopolymers

REFERENCES
1. Marianne Gilbert (Ed.), Brydson’s Plastics Materials, 8th Edn., Elsevier (2017).
2. J.A.Brydson, Plastics Materials, 7th Edn., Butterworth Heinemann (1999).
3. Manas Chanda, Salil K. Roy, Plastics Technology Handbook, 4th Edn., CRC press (2006).
4. A. Brent Strong, Plastics: Materials and Processing, 3rd Edn., Pearson Prentice Hall (2006).
5. Olagoke Olabisi, Kolapo Adewale (Eds.), Handbook of Thermoplastics 2nd Edn.,
CRC press (2016).
6. Charles A. Harper, Modern Plastics Handbook, McGraw-Hill, New York, 1999.
7. H. Dominighaus, Plastics for Engineers, Hanser Publishers, Munich, 1988.

OPT353 PROPERTIES AND TESTING OF PLASTICS LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To understand the relevance of standards and specifications as well as the specimen
preparation for polymer testing.
 To study the mechanical properties and testing of polymer materials and their structural
property relationships.
 To understand the thermal properties of polymers and their testing methods.
 To gain knowledge on the electrical and optical properties of polymers and their testing
methods.
 To study about the environmental effects and prevent polymer degradation.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO CHARACTERIZATION AND TESTING OF POLYMERS 9


Introduction- Standard organizations: BIS, ASTM, ISO, BS, DIN etc. Standards and specifications.
Importance of standards in the quality control of polymers and polymer products. Preparation of
test pieces, conditioning and test atmospheres. Tests on elastomers: processability parameters of
rubbers – plasticity, Mooney viscosity, scorch time, cure time, cure rate index, Processability tests
carried out on thermoplastics and thermosets: MFI, cup flow index, gel time, bulk density, bulk
factor.

UNIT II MECHANICAL PROPERTIES 9


Mechanical properties: Tensile, compression, flexural, shear, tear strength, hardness, impact
strength, resilience, abrasion resistance, creep and stress relaxation, compression set, dynamic
fatigue, ageing properties, Basic concepts of stress and strain, short term tests: Viscoelastic
behavior (simple models: Kelvin model for creep and stress relaxation, Maxwell-Voigt model,

342
strain recovery and dynamic response), Effect of structure and composition on mechanical
properties, Behavior of reinforced polymers

UNIT III THERMAL RHEOLOGICAL PROPERTIES 9


Thermal properties: Transition temperatures, specific heat, thermal conductivity, co-efficient of
thermal expansion, heat deflection temperature, Vicat softening point, shrinkage, brittleness
temperature, thermal stability and flammability. Product testing: Plastic films, sheeting, pipes,
laminates, foams, containers, cables and tubes.

UNIT IV ELECTRICAL AND OPTICAL PROPERTIES 9


Electrical properties: volume and surface resistivity, dielectric strength, dielectric constant and
power factor, arc resistance, tracking resistance, dielectric behavior of polymers (dielectric co-
efficient, dielectric polarization), dissipation factor and its importance. Optical properties:
transparency, refractive index, haze, gloss, clarity, birefringence.

UNIT V ENVIRONMENTAL AND CHEMICAL RESISTANCE 9


Environmental stress crack resistance (ESCR), water absorption, weathering, aging, ozone
resistance, permeability and adhesion. Tests for chemical resistance. Acids, alkalies, Flammability
tests- oxygen index test.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1:Understand the relevance of standards and specifications.
CO2:Summarize the various test methods for evaluating the mechanical properties of the
polymers.
CO3:To know the thermal, electrical & optical properties of polymers.
CO4:Identify various techniques used for characterizing polymers.
CO5:Distinguish the processability tests used for thermoplastics, thermosets and
elastomers.

REFERENCES
1. F.Majewska, H.Zowall, Handbook of analysis of synthetic polymers and plastics, Ellis Horwood
Limited Publisher 1977.
2. J.F.Rabek, Experimental Methods in Polymer Chemistry, John Wiley and Sons 1980.
3. R.P.Brown, Plastic test methods, 2nd Edn., Harlond, Longman Scientific, 1981.
4. A. B. Mathur, I. S. Bharadwaj, Testing and Evaluation of Plastcis, Allied Publishers Pvt. Ltd.,
New Delhi, 2003.
5. Vishu Shah, Handbook of Plastic Testing Technology, 3rd Edn., John Wiley & Sons 2007.
6. S. K. Nayak, S. N. Yadav, S. Mohanty, Fundamentals of Plastic Testing, Springer, 2010.

OEC353 VLSI DESIGN LT PC


30 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
● Understand the fundamentals of IC technology components and their characteristics.
● Understand combinational logic circuits and design principles.
● Understand sequential logic circuits and clocking strategies.
● Understand Interconnects and Memory Architecture.
● Understand the design of arithmetic building blocks
343
UNIT I MOS TRANSISTOR PRINCIPLES 9
MOS logic families (NMOS and CMOS), Ideal and Non Ideal IV Characteristics, CMOS devices.
MOS(FET) Transistor DC transfer Characteristics ,small signal analysis of MOSFET.

UNIT II COMBINATIONAL LOGIC CIRCUITS 9


Propagation Delays, stick diagram, Layout diagrams, Examples of combinational logic design,
Elmore’s constant, Static Logic Gates, Dynamic Logic Gates, Pass Transistor Logic, Power
Dissipation.

UNIT III SEQUENTIAL LOGIC CIRCUITS AND CLOCKING STRATEGIES 9


Static Latches and Registers, Dynamic Latches and Registers, Pipelines, Timing classification of
Digital Systems, Synchronous Design, Self-Timed Circuit Design .

UNIT IV INTERCONNECT, MEMORY ARCHITECTURE 9


Interconnect Parameters – Capacitance, Resistance, and Inductance, Logic Implementation using
Programmable Devices (ROM, PLA, FPGA), Memory Architecture and Building Blocks.

UNIT V DESIGN OF ARITHMETIC BUILDING BLOCKS 9


Arithmetic Building Blocks: Data Paths, Adders-Ripple Carry Adder, Carry-Bypass Adder, Carry
Select Adder, Carry-Look Ahead Adder, Multipliers, Barrel Shifter, power and speed tradeoffs.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon successful completion of the course the student will be able to
CO1: Understand the working principle and characteristics of MOSFET
CO2: Design Combinational Logic Circuits
CO3: Design Sequential Logic Circuits and Clocking systems
CO4: Understand Memory architecture and interconnects
CO5: Design of arithmetic building blocks.

TEXTBOOKS
1. Jan D Rabaey, Anantha Chandrakasan, “Digital Integrated Circuits: A Design Perspective”,
PHI, 2016.(Units II, III IV and V).
2. Neil H E Weste, Kamran Eshranghian, “Principles of CMOS VLSI Design: A System
Perspective,” Addison Wesley, 2009.( Units - I).

REFERENCES
1. D.A. Hodges and H.G. Jackson, Analysis and Design of Digital Integrated Circuits,
International Student Edition, McGraw Hill 1983
2. P. Rashinkar, Paterson and L. Singh, "System-on-a-Chip Verification-Methodology and
Techniques", Kluwer Academic Publishers,2001
3. Samiha Mourad and Yervant Zorian, “Principles of Testing Electronic Systems”, Wiley 2000
4. M. Bushnell and V. D. Agarwal, "Essentials of Electronic Testing for Digital, Memory and
Mixed-Signal VLSI Circuits", Kluwer Academic Publishers,2000

344
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
C PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO PSO
O
1 1
3 2
3 3
2 4
2 5
1 6
3 7- 8- 9- 0- 1
2 2
3 1
3 2
3 3
2 3 3 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 3 3 3
3 3 - 3 2 1 2 - - - - 3 2 3 2 3
4 3 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 3 2
5 2 - 3 2 2 1 - - - - 1 1 3 2 2
C 3 3 2 2 1 2 - - - - 2 2 3 3 3
1O- low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

CBM370 WEARABLE DEVICES LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The student should be made to:
 To know the hardware requirement of wearable systems
 To understand the communication and security aspects in the wearable devices
 To know the applications of wearable devices in the field of medicine

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO WEARABLE SYSTEMS AND SENSORS 9


Wearable Systems- Introduction, Need for Wearable Systems, Drawbacks of Conventional
Systems for Wearable Monitoring, Applications of Wearable Systems, Types of Wearable
Systems, Components of wearable Systems. Sensors for wearable systems-Inertia movement
sensors, Respiration activity sensor, Impedance plethysmography, Wearable ground reaction force
sensor.

UNIT II SIGNAL PROCESSING AND ENERGY HARVESTING FOR WEARABLE


DEVICES 9
Wearability issues -physical shape and placement of sensor, Technical challenges - sensor design,
signal acquisition, sampling frequency for reduced energy consumption, Rejection of irrelevant
information. Power Requirements- Solar cell, Vibration based, Thermal based, Human body as a
heat source for power generation, Hybrid thermoelectric photovoltaic energy harvests,
Thermopiles.

UNIT III WIRELESS HEALTH SYSTEMS 9


Need for wireless monitoring, Definition of Body area network, BAN and Healthcare, Technical
Challenges- System security and reliability, BAN Architecture – Introduction, Wireless
communication Techniques.

UNIT IV SMART TEXTILE 9


Introduction to smart textile- Passive smart textile, active smart textile. Fabrication Techniques-
Conductive Fibres, Treated Conductive Fibres, Conductive Fabrics, Conductive Inks.Case study-
smart fabric for monitoring biological parameters - ECG, respiration.

UNIT V APPLICATIONS OF WEARABLE SYSTEMS 9


Medical Diagnostics, Medical Monitoring-Patients with chronic disease, Hospital patients, Elderly
patients, neural recording, Gait analysis, Sports Medicine.

345
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On successful completion of this course, the student will be able to
CO1: Describe the concepts of wearable system.
CO2: Explain the energy harvestings in wearable device.
CO3: Use the concepts of BAN in health care.
CO4: Illustrate the concept of smart textile
CO5: Compare the various wearable devices in healthcare system
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Annalisa Bonfiglo and Danilo De Rossi, Wearable Monitoring Systems, Springer, 2011
2. Zhang and Yuan-Ting, Wearable Medical Sensors and Systems,Springer, 2013
3. Edward Sazonov and Micheal R Neuman, Wearable Sensors: Fundamentals,
Implementation and Applications, Elsevier, 2014
4. Mehmet R. Yuce and JamilY.Khan, Wireless Body Area Networks Technology,
Implementation applications,Pan Stanford Publishing Pte.Ltd, Singapore, 2012

REFERENCES
1. Sandeep K.S, Gupta, Tridib Mukherjee and Krishna Kumar Venkatasubramanian, Body
Area Networks Safety, Security, and Sustainability, Cambridge University Press, 2013.
2. Guang-Zhong Yang, Body Sensor Networks, Springer, 2006.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1
2 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1
3 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1
4 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1
5 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1
AVg. 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

CBM356 MEDICAL INFORMATICS LTPC


3 0 03
Preamble:
1. To study the applications of information technology in health care management.
2. This course provides knowledge on resources, devices, and methods required to optimize
the acquisition, storage, retrieval, and use of information in health and biomedicine.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MEDICAL INFORMATICS 9


Introduction - Structure of Medical Informatics –Internet and Medicine -Security issues ,
Computer based medical information retrieval, Hospital management and information
system, Functional capabilities of a computerized HIS, Health Informatics – Medical
Informatics, Bioinformatics

346
UNIT II COMPUTERS IN CLINICAL LABORATORY AND MEDICAL IMAGING 9
Automated clinical laboratories-Automated methods in hematology, cytology and histology,
Intelligent Laboratory Information System - Computer assisted medical imaging- nuclear
medicine, ultrasound imaging, computed X-ray tomography, Radiation therapy and
planning, Nuclear Magnetic Resonance.

UNIT III COMPUTERISED PATIENT RECORD 9


Introduction - conventional patient record, Components and functionality of CPR, Development
tools, Intranet, CPR in Radiology- Application server provider, Clinical information system,
Computerized prescriptions for patients.

UNIT IV COMPUTER ASSISTED MEDICAL DECISION-MAKING 9


Neuro computers and Artificial Neural Networks application, Expert system-General model of
CMD, Computer–assisted decision support system-production rule system cognitive model,
semantic networks, decisions analysis inclinical medicine-computers in the care of critically ill
patients, Computer aids for the handicapped.

UNIT V RECENT TRENDS IN MEDICAL INFORMATICS 9


Virtual reality applications in medicine, Virtual endoscopy, Computer assisted surgery, Surgical
simulation, Telemedicine - Tele surgery, Computer assisted patient education and health- Medical
education and healthcare information, computer assisted instruction in medicine.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, students will be able to:
CO1:Explain the structure and functional capabilities of Hospital Information System.
CO2:Describe the need of computers in medical imaging and automated clinical laboratory.
CO3:Articulate the functioning of information storage and retrieval in computerized patient record
system.
CO4:Apply the suitable decision support system for automated clinical diagnosis.
CO5:Discuss the application of virtual reality and telehealth technology in medical industry.

TEXT BOOKS:
1. Mohan Bansal, “Medical informatics”, Tata McGraw Hill Publishing Ltd, 2003.
2. R.D.Lele, “Computers in medicine progress in medical informatics”, Tata Mcgraw Hill,2005
REFERENCES:
1. Kathryn J. Hannah, Marion J Ball, “Health Informatics”, 3rd Edition, Springer, 2006.
CO’s- PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1
2 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1
3 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1
4 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1
5 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1
AVg. 3 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

347
OCE354 BASICS OF INTEGRATED WATER RESOURCES MANAGEMENT LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To introduce the interdisciplinary approach of water management.
 To develop knowledge base and capacity building on IWRM.

UNIT I OVERVIEW OF IWRM 9


Facts about water - Definition – Key challenges - Paradigm shift - Water management Principles -
Social equity - Ecological sustainability – Economic efficiency - SDGs - World Water Forums.

UNIT II WATER USE SECTORS: IMPACTS AND SOLUTION 9


Water users: People, Agriculture, ecosystem and others - Impacts of the water use sectors on
water resources - Securing water for people, food production, ecosystems and other uses - IWRM
relevance in water resources management.

UNIT III WATER ECONOMICS 9


Economic characteristics of water good and services – Economic instruments – Private sector
involvement in water resources management - PPP experiences through case studies.

UNIT IV RECENT TREANDS IN WATER MANAGEMENT 9


River basin management - Ecosystem Regeneration – 5 Rs - WASH - Sustainable livelihood -
Water management in the context of climate change.

UNIT V IMPLEMENTATION OF IWRM 9


Barriers to implementing IWRM - Policy and legal framework - Bureaucratic reforms and inclusive
development - Institutional Transformation - Capacity building - Case studies on conceptual
framework of IWRM.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSEOUTCOMES
On completion of the course, the student will be able to apply appropriate management techniques
towards managing the water resources.
CO1 Describe the context and principles of IWRM; Compare the conventional and integrated
ways of water management.
CO2 Discuss on the different water uses; how it is impacted and ways to tackle these impacts.
CO3 Explain the economic aspects of water and choose the best economic option among the
alternatives; illustrate the pros and cons of PPP through case studies.
CO4 Illustrate the recent trends in water management.
CO5 Understand the implementation hitches and the institutional frameworks.

TEXT BOOKS
1. Cech Thomas V., Principles of water resources: history, development, management and
policy. John Wiley and Sons Inc., New York. 2003.
2. Mollinga P. et al. “ Integrated Water Resources Management”, Water in South Asia Volume
I, Sage Publications, 2006.

REFERENCES
1. Technical Advisory Committee, Background Papers No: 1, 4 and 7, Stockholm, Sweden.
2002.
348
2. IWRM Guidelines at River Basin Level (UNESCO, 2008).
3. Tutorial on Basic Principles of Integrated Water Resources Management ,CAP-NET.
http://www.pacificwater.org/userfiles/file/IWRM/Toolboxes/introduction%20to%20iwrm/Tutorial_text
.pdf
4. Pramod R. Bhave, 2011, Water Resources Systems, Narosa Publishers.
5. The 17 Goals, United Nations, https://sdgs.un.org/goals.

OBT355 BIOTECHNOLOGY FOR WASTE MANAGEMENT LTPC


3 003

UNIT I BIOLOGICAL TREATMENT PROCESS 9


Fundamentals of biological process - Anaerobic process – Pretreatment methods in anaerobic
process – Aerobic process, Anoxic process, Aerobic and anaerobic digestion of organic wastes -
Factors affecting process efficiency - Solid state fermentation – Submerged fermentation – Batch
and continous fermentation

UNIT II WASTE BIOMASS AND ITS VALUE ADDITION 9


Types of waste biomass – Solid waste management - Nature of biomass feedstock – Biobased
economy/process – Value addition of waste biomass – Biotransformation of biomass –
Biotransformation of marine processing wastes – Direct extraction of biochemicals from biomass –
Plant biomass for industrial application

UNIT III BIOCONVERSION OF WASTES TO ENERGY 9


Perspective of biofuels from wastes - Bioethanol production – Biohydrogen Production – dark and
photofermentative process - Biobutanol production – Biogas and Biomethane production - Single
stage anaerobic digestion, Two stage anaerobic digestion - Biodiesel production - Enzymatic
hydrolysis technologies

UNIT IV CHEMICALS AND ENZYME PRODUCTION FROM WASTES 9


Production of lactic acid, succinic acid, citric acid – Biopolymer synthesis – Production of Amylases
- Lignocellulolytic enzymes - Pectinolytic enzymes - Proteases – Lipases

UNIT V BIOCOMPOSTING OF ORGANIC WASTES 9


Overview of composting process - Benefitis of composting, Role of microorganisms in composting -
Factors affecting the composting process - Waste Materials for Composting, Fundamentals of
composting process - Composting technologies, Composting systems – Nonreactor Composting,
Reactor composting - Compost Quality
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
After completion of this course, the students should be able
 To learn the various methods biological treatment
 To know the details of waste biomass and its value addition
 To develop the bioconversion processes to convert wastes to energy
 To synthesize the chemicals and enzyme from wastes
 To produce the biocompost from wastes
 To apply the theoretical knowledge for the development of value added products

349
TEXT BOOKS
1. Antoine P. T., (2017) “Biofuels from Food Waste Applications of Saccharification Using Fungal
Solid State Fermentation”, CRC press
2. Joseph C A., (2019)“Anaerobic Waste-Wastewater Treatment and Biogas Plants-A Practical
Handbook”, CRC Press,

REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Palmiro P. and Oscar F.D’Urso, (2016) ‘Biotransformation of Agricultural
Waste and By-Products’,The Food, Feed, Fibre, Fuel (4F) Economy, Elsevier
2. Kaur Brar S., Gurpreet Singh D. and Carlos R.S., (Eds), (2014)‘Biotransformation of Waste
Biomass into High Value Biochemicals’, Springer.
3. Keikhosro K, Editor, (2015) ‘Lignocellulose-Based Bioproducts’, Springer.
4. John P, (2014) ‘Waste Management Practices-Municipal, Hazardous, and Industrial’, Second
Edition, CRC Press, 2014

OBT356 LIFESTYLE DISEASES LT PC


3 0 03
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Lifestyle diseases – Definition ; Risk factors – Eating, smoking, drinking, stress, physical activity,
illicit drug use ; Obesity, diabetes, cardiovascular diseases, respiratory diseases, cancer;
Prevention – Diet and exercise.

UNIT II CANCER 9
Types - Lung cancer, Mouth cancer, Skin cancer, Cervical cancer, Carcinoma oesophagus;
Causes Tobacco usage, Diagnosis – Biomarkers, Treatment

UNIT III CARDIOVASCULAR DISEASES 9


Coronoary atherosclerosis – Coronary artery disease; Causes -Fat and lipids, Alcohol abuse -–
Diagnosis - Electrocardiograph, echocardiograph, Treatment, Exercise and Cardiac rehabilitation

UNIT IV DIABETES AND OBESITY 9


Types of Diabetes mellitus; Blood glucose regulation; Complications of diabetes – Paediatric and
adolescent obesity – Weight control and BMI

UNIT V RESPIRATORY DISEASES 9


Chronic lung disease, Asthma, COPD; Causes - Breathing pattern (Nasal vs mouth), Smoking –
Diagnosis - Pulmonary function testing
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. R.Kumar&Meenal Kumar, “Guide to Prevention of Lifestyle Diseases”, Deep & Deep
Publications, 2003
2. Gary Eggar et al, “Lifestyle Medicine”, 3rd Edition, Academic Press, 2017

REFERENCES:
1. James M.R, “Lifestyle Medicine”, 2nd Edition, CRC Press, 2013
2. Akira Miyazaki et al, “New Frontiers in Lifestyle-Related Disease”, Springer, 2008

350
OBT357 BIOTECHNOLOGY IN HEALTH CARE LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
The aim of this course is to
 Create higher standard of knowledge on healthcare system and services
 Prioritize advanced technologies for the diagnosis and treatment of various diseases

UNIT I PUBLIC HEALTH 9


Definition and Concept of Public Health, Historical aspects of Public Health, Changing Concepts of
Public Health, Public Health versus Medical Care, Unique Features of Public Health, Determinants
of Health (Social, Economic, Cultural, Environmental, Education, Genetics, Food and Nutrition).
Indicators of health, Burden of disease, Role of different disciplines in Public Health.

UNIT II CLINICAL DISEASES 9


Communicable diseases: Chickenpox / Shingles, COVID-19, Tuberculosis, Hepatitis B, Hepatitis
C, HIV / AIDS, Influenza, Swine flu. Non Communicable diseases: Diabetes mellitus,
atherosclerosis, fatty liver, Obesity, Cancer

UNIT III VACCINOLOGY 9


History of Vaccinology, conventional approaches to vaccine development, live attenuated and
killed vaccines, adjuvants, quality control, preservation and monitoring of microorganisms in seed
lot systems. Instruments related to monitoring of temperature, sterilization, environment.

UNIT IV OUTPATIENT & IN PATIENT SERVICES 9


Radiotherapy, Nuclear medicine, surgical units, OT Medical units, G & Obs. units Pediatric,
neonatal units, Critical care units, Physical medicine & Rehabilitation, Neurology,
Gastroenterology, Endoscopy, Pulmonology, Cardiology.

UNIT V BASICS OF IMAGING MODALITIES 9


Diagnostic X-rays - Computer tomography – MRI – Ultrasonography – Endoscopy – Thermography
– Different types of biotelemetry systems.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. Joseph J.carr and John M. Brown, Introduction to Biomedical Equipment Technology, John
Wiley and sons, New York, 4th Edition, 2012.
2. Thomas M. Devlin.Textbook of Biochemistry with clinical correlations. Wiley Liss
Publishers
3. The Vaccine Book (2nd Ed.), Rafi Ahmed, Roy M. Anderson et. al.Editor(s): Barry R.
Bloom, PaulHenri Lambert, Academic Press, 2016, Pages xxi-xxiv.

REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Suh, Sang, Gurupur, Varadraj P., Tanik, Murat M., Health Care Systems, Technology and
Techniques, Springer, 1st Edition, 2011
2. Burtis & Ashwood W.B. Tietz Textbook of Clinical chemistry. Saunders Company
3. Levine, M. M. (2004). New Generation Vaccines. New York: M. Dekker

351
VERTICAL 1: FINTECH AND BLOCK CHAIN

CMG331 FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT LT P C


3003
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
1.To acquire the knowledge of the decision areas in finance.
2. To learn the various sources of Finance
3. To describe about capital budgeting and cost of capital.
4. To discuss on how to construct a robust capital structure and dividend policy
5. To develop an understanding of tools on Working Capital Management.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO FINANCIAL MANGEMENT 9


Definition and Scope of Finance Functions - Objectives of Financial Management - Profit
Maximization and Wealth Maximization- Time Value of money- Risk and return concepts.

UNIT II SOURCES OF FINANCE 9


Long term sources of Finance -Equity Shares – Debentures - Preferred Stock – Features – Merits
and Demerits. Short term sources - Bank Sources, Trade Credit, Overdrafts, Commercial Papers,
Certificate of Deposits, Money market mutual funds etc

UNIT III INVESTMENT DECISIONS: 9


Investment Decisions: capital budgeting – Need and Importance – Techniques of Capital
Budgeting -– Payback -ARR – NPV – IRR –Profitability Index.
Cost of Capital - Cost of Specific Sources of Capital - Equity -Preferred Stock- Debt - Reserves -
Concept and measurement of cost of capital - Weighted Average Cost of Capital.

UNIT IV FINANCING AND DIVIDEND DECISION 9


Operating Leverage and Financial Leverage- EBIT-EPS analysis. Capital Structure – determinants
of Capital structure- Designing an Optimum capital structure .
Dividend policy - Aspects of dividend policy - practical consideration - forms of dividend policy - -
Determinants of Dividend Policy

UNIT V WORKING CAPITAL DECISION 9


Working Capital Management: Working Capital Management - concepts - importance -
Determinants of Working capital. Cash Management: Motives for holding cash – Objectives and
Strategies of Cash Management. Receivables Management: Objectives - Credit policies.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS
1. M.Y. Khan and P.K.Jain Financial management, Text, Tata McGraw Hill
2. M. Pandey Financial Management, Vikas Publishing House Pvt. Ltd

REFERENCES .
1. James C. Vanhorne –Fundamentals of Financial Management– PHI Learning,.
2. Prasanna Chandra, Financial Management,
3. Srivatsava, Mishra, Financial Management, Oxford University Press, 2011

352
CMG332 FUNDAMENTALS OF INVESTMENT L T PC
3 0 03

COURSEOBJECTIVES:
 Describe the investment environment in which investment decisions are taken.
 Explain how to Value bonds and equities
 Explain the various approaches to value securities
 Describe how to create efficient portfolios through diversification
 Discuss the mechanism of investor protection in India.

UNIT I THE INVESTMENT ENVIRONMENT 9


The investment decision process, Types of Investments – Commodities, Real Estate and
FinancialAssets, the Indian securities market, the market participants and trading of securities,
securitymarket indices, sources of financial information, Concept of return and risk, Impact of
Taxes andInflationonreturn.

UNIT II FIXED INCOME SECURITIES 9


Bond features, types of bonds, estimating bond yields, Bond Valuation types of bond risks,
defaultrisk andcreditrating.

UNIT III APPROACHES TOEQUITYANALYSIS 9


Introduction to Fundamental Analysis, Technical Analysis and Efficient Market Hypothesis,
dividend capitalisation models, and price-earnings multiple approach to equity valuation.

UNIT IV PORTFOLIO ANALYSIS AND FINANCIAL DERIVATIVES 9


Portfolio and Diversification, Portfolio Risk and Return; Mutual Funds; Introduction to Financial
Derivatives; Financial Derivatives Markets in India

UNIT V INVESTOR PROTECTIONRole of SEBI and stock exchanges in investor protection;


Investor grievances and their redressal system, insider trading, investors’ awareness andactivism
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES
1. Charles P. Jones, Gerald R. Jensen. Investments: analysis and management. Wiley, 14TH
Edition, 2019.
2. Chandra, Prasanna. Investment analysis and portfolio management. McGraw-hill
education, 5th, Edition, 2017.
3. Rustagi, R. P. Investment Management Theory and Practice. Sultan Chand & Sons, 2021.
4. ZviBodie, Alex Kane, Alan J Marcus, PitabusMohanty, Investments, McGraw Hill Education
(India), 11 Edition(SIE), 2019

CMG333 BANKING, FINANCIAL SERVICES AND INSURANCE LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 Understand the Banking system in India
 Grasp how banks raise their sources and how they deploy it
 Understand the development in banking technology

353
 Understand the financial services in India
 Understand the insurance Industry in India

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO INDIAN BANKING SYSTEM 9


Overview of Banking system – Structure – Functions –Banking system in India - Key Regulations
in Indian Banking sector –RBI. Relationship between Banker and Customer - Retail & Wholesale
Banking – types of Accounts - Opening and operation of Accounts.

UNIT II MANAGING BANK FUNDS/ PRODUCTS 9


Liquid Assets - Investment in securities - Advances - Loans.Negotiable Instruments – Cheques,
Bills of Exchange & Promissory Notes.Designing deposit schemes– Asset and Liability
Management – NPA’s – Current issues on NPA’s – M&A’s of banks into securities market

UNIT III DEVELOPMENT IN BANKING TECHNOLOGY 9


Payment system in India – paper based – e payment –electronic banking –plastic money – e-
money –forecasting of cash demand at ATM’s –The Information Technology Act, 2000 in India –
RBI’s Financial Sector Technology vision document – security threats in e-banking & RBI’s
Initiative.

UNIT IV FINANCIAL SERVICES 9


Introduction – Need for Financial Services – Financial Services Market in India – NBFC –– Leasing
and Hire Purchase –– mutual funds. Venture Capital Financing –Bill discounting –factoring –
Merchant Banking

UNIT V INSURANCE 9
Insurance –Concept - Need - History of Insurance industry in India. Insurance Act, 1938 –IRDA –
Regulations – Life Insurance - Annuities and Unit Linked Policies - Lapse of the Policy – revival –
settlement of claim
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES :
1. Padmalatha Suresh and Justin Paul, “Management of Banking and Financial Services, Pearson,
Delhi, 2017.
2. Meera Sharma, “Management of Financial Institutions – with emphasis on Bank and Risk
Management”, PHI Learning Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi 2010
3. Peter S. Rose and Sylvia C. and Hudgins, “Bank Management and Financial Services”, Tata
McGraw Hill, New Delhi, 2017

CMG334 INTRODUCTION TO BLOCKCHAIN AND ITS APPLICATIONS LTPC


3 003
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO BLOCKCHAIN 9
Blockchain: The growth of blockchain technology - Distributed systems - The history of blockchain
and Bitcoin - Features of a blockchain - Types of blockchain, Consensus: Consensus mechanism -
Types of consensus mechanisms - Consensus in blockchain. Decentralization: Decentralization
using blockchain - Methods of decentralization - Routes to decentralization- Blockchain and full
ecosystem decentralization - Smart contracts - Decentralized Organizations- Platforms for
decentralization.
354
UNIT II INTRODUCTION TO CRYPTOCURRENCY 9
Bitcoin – Digital Keys and Addresses – Transactions – Mining – Bitcoin Networks and Payments –
Wallets – Alternative Coins – Theoretical Limitations – Bitcoin limitations – Name coin – Prime coin
– Zcash – Smart Contracts – Ricardian Contracts- Deploying smart contracts on a blockchain

UNIT III ETHEREUM 9


Introduction - The Ethereum network - Components of the Ethereum ecosystem - Transactions and
messages - Ether cryptocurrency / tokens (ETC and ETH) - The Ethereum Virtual Machine (EVM),
Ethereum Development Environment: Test networks - Setting up a private net - Starting up the
private network

UNIT IV WEB3 AND HYPERLEDGE ` 9


Introduction to Web3 – Contract Deployment – POST Requests – Development Frameworks –
Hyperledger as a Protocol – The Reference Architecture – Hyperledger Fabric – Distributed Ledger
– Corda.

UNIT V EMERGING TRENDS 9


Kadena – Ripple – Rootstock – Quorum – Tendermint – Scalability – Privacy – Other Challenges –
Blockchain Research – Notable Projects – Miscellaneous Tools.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
REFERENCE
1. Imran. Bashir. Mastering block chain: Distributed Ledger Technology, Decentralization, and
Smart Contracts Explained. Packt Publishing, 2nd Edition, 2018
2. Peter Borovykh , Blockchain Application in Finance, Blockchain Driven, 2nd Edition, 2018
3. ArshdeepBahga, Vijay Madisetti, “Blockchain Applications: A Hands On Approach”, VPT,
2017.

CMG335 FINTECH PERSONAL FINANCE AND PAYMENTS LT PC


3 0 03
UNIT I CURRENCY EXCHANGE AND PAYMENT 9
Understand the concept of Crypto currency- Bitcoin and Applications -Cryptocurrencies and Digital
Crypto Wallets -Types of Cryptocurrencies - Cryptocurrencies and Applications, block chain,
Artificial Intelligence, machine learning. Fintech users, Individual Payments, RTGS Systems,
Immediate Page 54 of 90 Payment Service (IMPS), Unified Payments Interface (UPI).Legal and
Regulatory Implications of Crypto currencies, Payment systems and their regulations.Digital
Payments Smart Cards, Stored-Value Cards, EC Micropayments, Payment Gateways, Mobile
Payments, Digital and Virtual Currencies, Security, Ethical, Legal, Privacy, and Technology Issues

UNIT II DIGITAL FINANCE AND ALTERNATIVE FINANCE 9


A Brief History of Financial Innovation, Digitization of Financial Services, Crowd funding, Charity
and Equity,. Introduction to the concept of Initial Coin Offering

UNIT III INSURETECH 9


InsurTech Introduction , Business model disruption AI/ML in InsurTech ● IoT and InsurTech ,Risk
Modeling ,Fraud Detection Processing claims and Underwriting Innovations in Insurance Services
355
UNIT IV PEER TO PEER LENDING 9
P2P and Marketplace Lending, New Models and New Products in market place lending P2P
Infrastructure and technologies , Concept of Crowdfunding Crowdfunding Architecture and
Technology ,P2P and Crowdfunding unicorns and business models , SME/MSME Lending: Unique
opportunities and Challenges, Solutions and Innovations

UNIT V REGULATORY ISSUES 9


FinTech Regulations: Global Regulations and Domestic Regulations, Evolution of RegTech,
RegTech Ecosystem: Financial Institutions, RegTech Ecosystem: StartupsRegTech, Startups:
Challenges, RegTech Ecosystem: Regulators, Use of AI in regulation and Fraud detection
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
REFERENCE
1. Swanson Seth, Fintech for Beginners: Understanding and Utilizing the power of technology,
Createspace Independent Publishing Platform,2016.
2. Models AuTanda, Fintech Bigtech And Banks Digitalization and Its Impact On Banking
Business, Springer, 2019
3. Henning Diedrich, Ethereum: Blockchains, Digital Assets, Smart Contracts, Decentralized
Autonomous Organizations, Wildfire Publishing, 2016
4. Jacob William, FinTech:TheBeginner’s Guide to Financial Technology, Createspace
Independent Publishing Platform, 2016
5. IIBF, Digital Banking, Taxmann Publication, 2016
6. Jacob William, Financial Technology, Create space Independent Pub, 2016
7. Luke Sutton, Financial Technology: Bitcoin & Blockchain, Createspace Independent Pub,
2016

CMG336 INTRODUCTION TO FINTECH LT P C


3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To learn about history, importance and evolution of Fintech
 To acquire the knowledge of Fintech in payment industry
 To acquire the knowledge of Fintech in insurance industry
 To learn the Fintech developments around the world
 To know about the future of Fintech

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Fintech - Definition, History, concept, meaning, architecture, significance, Goals, key areas in
Fintech, Importance of Fintech, role of Fintech in economic development, opportunities and
challenges in Fintech, Evolution of Fintech in different sectors of the industry - Infrastructure,
Banking Industry, Startups and Emerging Markets, recent developments in FinTech, future
prospects and potential issues with Fintech.

UNIT II PAYMENT INDUSTRY 9


FinTech in Payment Industry-Multichannel digital wallets, applications supporting wallets,
onboarding and KYC application, FinTech in Lending Industry- Formal lending, Informal lending,
P2P lending, POS lending, Online lending, Payday lending, Microfinance, Crowdfunding.

356
UNIT III INSURANCE INDUSTRY 9
FinTech in Wealth Management Industry-Financial Advice, Automated investing, Socially
responsible investing, Fractional Investing, Social Investing. FinTech in Insurance Industry- P2P
insurance, On-Demand Insurance, On-Demand Consultation, Customer engagement through
Quote to sell, policy servicing, Claims Management, Investment linked health insurance.

UNIT IV FINTECH AROUND THE GLOBE 9


FinTech developments - US, Europe and UK, Germany, Sweden, France, China, India, Africa,
Australia, New Zealand, Brazil and Middle East, Regulatory and Policy Assessment for Growth of
FinTech. FinTech as disruptors, Financial institutions collaborating with FinTech companies, The
new financial world.

UNIT V FUTURE OF FINTECH 9


How emerging technologies will change financial services, the future of financial services, banking
on innovation through data, why FinTech banks will rule the world, The FinTech Supermarket,
Banks partnering with FinTech start-ups, The rise of BankTech, Fintech impact on Retail Banking,
A future without money, Ethics in Fintech.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES
1. Arner D., Barbers J., Buckley R, The evolution of FinTech: a new post crisis paradigm,
University of New South Wales Research Series, 2015
2. Susanne Chishti, Janos Barberis, The FINTECH Book: The Financial Technology
Handbook for Investors, Entrepreneurs and Visionaries, Wiley Publications, 2016
3. Richard Hayen, FinTech: The Impact and Influence of Financial Technology on Banking
and the Finance Industry, 2016
4. Parag Y Arjunwadkar, FinTech: The Technology Driving Disruption in the financial service
industry CRC Press, 2018
5. Sanjay Phadke, Fintech Future : The Digital DNA of Finance Paperback .Sage
Publications, 2020
6. Pranay Gupta, T. Mandy Tham, Fintech: The New DNA of Financial Services Paperback,
2018

VERTICAL 2: ENTREPRENEURSHIP

CMG337 FOUNDATIONS OF ENTREPRENERUSHIP L TP C


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To develop and strengthen the entrepreneurial quality and motivation of learners.
 To impart the entrepreneurial skills and traits essential to become successful
entrepreneurs.
 To apply the principles and theories of entrepreneurship and management in Technology
oriented businessess.
 To empower the learners to run a Technology driven business efficiently and effectively

357
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO ENTREPRENEURSHIP 9
Entrepreneurship- Definition, Need, Scope - Entrepreneurial Skill & Traits - Entrepreneur vs.
Intrapreneur; Classification of entrepreneurs, Types of entrepreneurs -Factors affecting
entrepreneurial development – Achievement Motivation – Contributions of Entreprenrship to
Economic Development.

UNIT II BUSINESS OWNERSHIP & ENVRIONMENT 9


Types of Business Ownership – Buiness Envrionemental Factors – Political-Economic-
Sociological-Technological-Environmental-Legal aspects – Human Reosurces Mobilisation-Basics
of Managing Finance- Esentials of Marketing Management - Production and Operations Planning –
Systems Management and Administration

UNIT III FUNDAMENTALS OF TECHNOPRENEURSHIP 9


Introduction to Technopreneurship - Definition, Need, Scope- Emerging Concepts- Principles -
Characterisitcis of a technopreneur - Impacts of Technopreneurship on Society – Economy- Job
Opportuinites in Technopreneurship - Recent trends

UNIT IV APPLICATIONS OF TECHNOPRENEURSHIP 9


Technology Entrepreneurship - Local, National and Global practices - Intrapreneurship and
Technology interactions, Networking of entrepreneurial activities – Launching - Managing
Technology based Product / Service entrepreneurship -– Success Stories of Technopreneurs -
Case Studies

UNIT V EMERGING TRENDS IN ENTREPRENERUSHIP 9


Effective Business Management Strategies For Franchising - Sub-Contracting- Leasing-
Technopreneurs – Agripreneurs - Netpreneurs- Portfolio entrepreneruship - NGO Entrepreneurship
– Recent Entrperneruial Develoments - Local – National – Global perspectives.
TOTAL45 : PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the student should be able to:
CO 1 Learn the basics of Entrepreneurship
CO 2 Understand the business ownership patterns and evnironment
CO 3 Understand the Job opportunites in Industries relating to Technopreneurship
CO 4 Learn about applications of tehnopreneurship and successful technopreneurs
CO 5 Acquaint with the recent and emerging trends in entrepreneruship

TEXT BOOKS:
1 S.S.Khanka, “Entrepreneurial Development” S.Chand & Co. Ltd. Ram Nagar New Delhi, 2021.
2 Donal F Kuratko Entrepreneurship (11th Edition) Theory, Process, Practice by Published 2019
by Cengage Learning,

REFERENCES :
1 Daniel Mankani. 2003. Technopreneurship: The successful Entrepreneur in the new
Economy. Prentice Hall
2 Edward Elgar. 2007. Entrepreneurship, Cooperation and the Firm: The Emergence and
Survival of High-Technology Ventures in Europe. Edi: Jan Ulijn, Dominique Drillon, and Frank
Lasch. Wiley Pub.
3 Lang, J. 2002, The High Tech Entrepreneur's Handbook, Ft.com.
358
4 David Sheff 2002, China Dawn: The Story of a Technology and Business Revolution,
5 HarperBusiness,https://fanny.staff.uns.ac.id/files/2013/12/Technopreneur-BASED-
EDUCATION-REVOLUTION.pdf
6 JumpStart: A Technoprenuership Fable, Dennis Posadas, (Singapore: Pearson Prentice Hall,
2009
7 Basics of Technoprenuership: Module 1.1-1.2, Frederico Gonzales, President-PESO Inc; M.
Barcelon, UP
8 Journal articles pertaining to Entrepreneurship

CMG338 TEAM BUILDING & LEADERSHIP MANAGEMENT FOR BUSINESS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To develop and strengthen the Leadership qualities and motivation of learners.
 To impart the Leadership skills and traits essential to become successful entrepreneurs.
 To apply the principles and theories of Team Building in managing Technology oriented
businessess.
 To empower the learners to build robust teams for running and leading a business
efficiently and effectively

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MANAGING TEAMS 9


Introduction to Team - Team Dynamics - Team Formation – Stages of Team Devlopment -
Enhancing teamwork within a group - Team Coaching - Team Decision Making - Virtual Teams -
Self Directed Work Teams (SDWTs) -Multicultural Teams.

UNIT II MANAGING AND DEVELOPING EFFECTIVE TEAMS 9


Team-based Organisations- Leadershp roles in team-based organisations - Offsite training and
team development - Experiential Learning - Coaching and Mentoring in team building - Building
High-Performance Teams - Building Credibility and Trust - Skills for Developing Others - Team
Building at the Top - Leadership in Teamwork Effectiveness.

UNIT III INTRODUCTION TO LEADERSHIP 9


Introduction to Leadership - Leadership Myths – Characteristics of Leader, Follower and Situation -
Leadership Attributes - Personality Traits and Leadership- Intelligence Types and Leadership -
Power and Leadership - Delegation and Empowerment .

UNIT IV LEADERSHIP IN ORGANISATIONS 9


Leadership Styles – LMX Theory- Leadership Theory and Normative Decision Model - Situational
Leadership Model - Contingency Model and Path Goal Theory – Transactional and
Transformational Leadership - Charismatic Leadership - Role of Ethics and Values in
Organisational Leadership.

UNIT V LEADERSHIP EFFECTIVENESS 9


Leadership Behaviour - Assessment of Leadership Behaviors - Destructive Leadership -
Motivation and Leadership - Managerial Incompetence and Derailment Conflict Management -
Negotiation and Leadership - Culture and Leadership - Global Leadership – Recent Trends in
Leadership.
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
359
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon completion of this course, the student should be able to:
CO 1 Learn the basics of managing teams for business.
CO 2 Understand developing effective teams for business management.
CO 3 Understand the fundamentals of leadership for running a business.
CO 4 Learn about the importance of leadership for business development.
CO 5 Acquaint with emerging trends in leadership effectiveness for entreprenerus.’’

REFERENCES :
1. Hughes, R.L., Ginnett, R.C., & Curphy, G.J., Leadership: Enhancing the lessons of
experience ,9th Ed, McGraw Hill Education, Chennai, India. (2019).
2. Katzenback, J.R., Smith, D.K., The Wisdom of Teams: Creating the High Performance
Organisations, Harvard Business Review Press, (2015).
3. Haldar, U.K., Leadership and Team Building, Oxford University Press, (2010).
4. Daft, R.L., The Leadership Experience, Cengage, (2015).
5. Daniel Levi, Group Dynamics for Teams ,4th Ed, (2014), Sage Publications.
6. Dyer, W. G., Dyer, W. G., Jr., & Dyer, J. H..Team building: Proven strategies for improving
team performance, 5thed, Jossey-Bass, (2013).

CMG339 CREATIVITY & INNOVATION IN ENTREPRENEURSHIP L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To develop the creativity skills among the learners
 To impart the knowledge of creative intelligence essential for entrepreneurs
 To know the applications of innovation in entprerenship.
 To develeop innovative business models for business.

UNIT I CREATIVITY 9
Creativity: Definition- Forms of Creativity-Essence, Elaborative and Expressive Creativities- Quality
of Creativity-Existential, Entrepreneurial and Empowerment Creativities – Creative Environment-
Creative Technology- - Creative Personality and Motivation.

UNIT II CREATIVE INTELLIGENCE 9


Creative Intelligence: Convergent thinking ability – Traits Congenial to creativity – Creativity
Training--Criteria for evaluating Creativity-Credible Evaluation- Improving the quality of our
creativity – Creative Tools and Techniques - Blocks to creativity- fears and Disabilities- Strategies
for Unblocking- Designing Creativity Enabling Environment.

UNIT III INNOVATION 9


Innovation: Definition- Levels of Innovation- Incremental Vs Radical Innovation-Product Innovation
and Process- Technological, Organizational Innovation – Indicators- Characteristics of Innovation
in Different Sectors. Theories in Innovation and Creativity- Design Thinking and Innovation-
Innovation as Collective Change-Innovation as a system

360
UNIT IV INNOVATION AND ENTREPRENEURSHIP 9
Innovation and Entrepreneurship: Entrepreneurial Mindset , Motivations and Behaviours-
Opportunity Analysis and Decision Making- Industry Understanding - Entrepreneurial
Opportunities- Entrepreneurial Strategies – Technology Pull/Market Push – Product -Market fit

UNIT V INNOVATIVE BUSINESS MODELS 9


Innovative Business Models: Customer Discovery-Customer Segments-Prospect Theory and
Developing Value Propositions- Developing Business Models: Elements of Business Models –
Innovative Business Models: Elements, Designing Innovative Business Models- Responsible
Innovation and Creativity.
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon completion of this course, the student should be able to:
CO 1 Learn the basics of creativity for developing Entrepreneurship
CO 2 Understand the importance of creative inteligence for business growth
CO 3 Understand the advances through Innovation in Industries
CO 4 Learn about applications of innovation in building successful ventures
CO 5 Acquaint with developing innovative business models to run the business effecientlty and
effectively

Suggested Readings:
Creativity and Inovation in Entrepreneurship, Kankha, Sultan Chand
Pradip N Khandwalla, Lifelong Creativity, An Unending Quest, Tata Mc Graw Hill, 2004.
Paul Trott, Innovation Management and New Product Development, 4e, Pearson, 2018.
Vinnie Jauhari, Sudanshu Bhushan, Innovation Management, Oxford Higher Education, 2014.
Innovation Management, C.S.G. Krishnamacharyulu, R. Lalitha, Himalaya Publishing House, 2010.
A. Dale Timpe, Creativity, Jaico Publishing House, 2003.
Brian Clegg, Paul Birch, Creativity, Kogan Page, 2009.
Strategic Innovation: Building and Sustaining Innovative Organizations- Course Era, Raj
Echambadi.

CMG340 PRINCIPLES OF MARKETING MANAGEMENT FOR BUSINESS L T P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To provide basic knowledge of concepts, principles, tools and techniques of marketing for
entrepreneurs
 To provide an exposure to the students pertaining to the nature and Scope of marketing,
which they are expected to possess when they enter the industry as practitioners.
 To give them an understanding of fundamental premise underlying market driven strategies
and the basic philosophies and tools of marketing management for business owners.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO MARKETING MANAGEMENT 9


Introduction - Market and Marketing – Concepts- Functions of Marketing - Importance of Marketing
- Marketing Orientations - Marketing Mix-The Traditional 4Ps - The Modern Components of the Mix
- The Additional 3Ps - Developing an Effective Marketing Mix.

361
UNIT II MARKETING ENVIRONMENT 9
Introduction - Environmental Scanning - Analysing the Organisation’s Micro Environment and
Macro Environment - Differences between Micro and Macro Environment – Techniques of
Environment Scanning - Marketing organization - Marketing Research and the Marketing
Information System, Types and Components.

UNIT III PRODUCT AND PRICING MANAGEMENT 9


Product- Meaning, Classification, Levels of Products – Product Life Cycle (PLC) - Product
Strategies - Product Mix - Packaging and Labelling - New Product Development - Brand and
Branding - Advantages and disadvantages of branding Pricing - Factors Affecting Price Decisions -
Cost Based Pricing - Value Based and Competition Based Pricing - Pricing Strategies - National
and Global Pricing.

UNIT IV PROMOTION AND DISTRIBTUION MANAGEMENT 9


Introduction to Promotion – Marketing Channels- Integrated Marketing Communications (IMC) -
Introduction to Advertising and Sales Promotion – Basics of Public Relations and Publicity -
Personal Selling - Process - Direct Marketing - Segmentation, Targeting and Positioning (STP)-
Logistics Management- Introduction to Retailing and Wholesaling.

UNIT V CONTEMPORARY ISSUES IN MARKETING MANAGEMENT 9


Introduction - Relationship Marketing Vs. Relationship Management - Customer Relationship
Management (CRM) - Forms of Relationship Management - CRM practices - Managing Customer
Loyalty and Development – Buyer-Seller Relationships- Buying Situations in Industrial / Business
Market - Buying Roles in Industrial Marketing - Factors that Influence Business - Services
Marketing - E-Marketing or Online Marketing.
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completion of this course, the students will be able to :
CO1 Have the awareness of marketing management process
CO 2 Understand the marketing environment
CO 3 Acquaint about product and pricing strategies
CO 4 Knowledge of promotion and distribution in marketing management.
CO 5 Comprehend the contemporary marketing scenairos and offer solutions to marketing
issues.

REFERENCES:
1. Marketing Management, Sherlekar S.A, Himalaya Publishing House, 2016.
2. Marketing Management , Philip Kortler and Kevin Lane Keller, PHI 15th Ed, 2015.
3 Marketing Management- An Indian perspective, Vijay Prakash Anand, Biztantra, Second edition,
2016.
4. Marketing Management Global Perspective, Indian Context, V.S.Ramaswamy &
S.Namakumari, Macmillan Publishers India,5th edition, 2015.
5. Marketing Management, S.H.H. Kazmi, 2013, Excel Books India.
6. Marketing Management- text and Cases, Dr. C.B.Gupta & Dr. N.Rajan Nair, 17th edition, 2016.

362
CMG341 HUMAN RESOURCE MANAGEMENT FOR ENTREPRENEURS L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To introduce the basic concepts, structure and functions of human resource management
for entrepreneurs.
 To create an awareness of the roles, functions and functioning of human resource
department.
 To understand the methods and techniques followed by Human Resource Management
practitioners.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO HRM 9
Concept, Definition, Objectives- Nature and Scope of HRM - Evolution of HRM - HR Manager
Roles- Skills - Personnel Management Vs. HRM - Human Resource Policies - HR Accounting -
HR Audit - Challenges in HRM.

UNIT II HUMAN RESOURCE PLANNING 9


HR Planning - Definition - Factors- Tools - Methods and Techniques - Job analysis- Job rotation-
Job Description - Career Planning - Succession Planning - HRIS - Computer Applications in HR -
Recent Trends

UNIT III RECRUITMENT AND SELECTION 9


Sources of recruitment- Internal Vs. External - Domestic Vs. Global Sources -eRecruitment -
Selection Process- Selection techniques -eSelection- Interview Types- Employee Engagement.

UNIT IV TRAINING AND EMPLOYEE DEVELOPMENT 9


Types of Training - On-The-Job, Off-The-Job - Training Needs Analysis – Induction and
Socialisation Process - Employee Compensation - Wages and Salary Administration – Health and
Social Security Measures- Green HRM Practices

UNIT V CONTROLLING HUMAN RESOURCES 9


Performance Appraisal – Types - Methods - Collective Bargaining - Grievances Redressal
Methods – Employee Discipline – Promotion – Demotion - Transfer – Dismissal - Retrenchment -
Union Management Relationship - Recent Trends
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon completion of this course the learners will be able:
CO 1 To understand the Evolution of HRM and Challenges faced by HR Managers
CO 2 To learn about the HR Planning Methods and practices.
CO 3 To acquaint about the Recruitment and Selection Techniques followed in Industries.
CO 4 To known about the methods of Training and Employee Development.
CO 5 To comprehend the techniques of controlling human resources in organisations.

REFERENCES
1) Gary Dessler and Biju Varkkey, Human Resource Management, 14e , Pearson, 2015.
2) Mathis and Jackson, Human Resource Management, Cengage Learning 15e, 2017.
3) David A. Decenzo, Stephen.P.Robbins, and Susan L. Verhulst, Human Resource
Management, Wiley, International Student Edition, 11th Edition, 2014
4) R. Wayne Mondy, Human Resource Management, Pearson , 2015.

363
5) Luis R.Gomez-Mejia, David B.Balkin, Robert L Cardy. Managing Human Resource. PHI
Learning. 2012
6) John M. Ivancevich, Human Resource Management,12e, McGraw Hill Irwin,2013.
7) K. Aswathappa, Sadhna Dash , Human Resource Management - Text and Cases , 9th
Edition, McGraw Hill, 2021.
8) Uday Kumar Haldar, Juthika Sarkar. Human Resource management. Oxford. 2012

CMG342 FINANCING NEW BUSINESS VENTURES LT P C


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To develop the basics of business venture financing.
 To impart the knowledge essential for entrepreneurs for financing new ventures.
 To acquaint the learners with the sources of debt and quity financing.
 To empower the learners towards fund rasiing for new ventures effectively.

UNIT I ESSENTIALS OF NEW BUSINES VENTURE 9


Setting up new Business Ventures – Need - Scope - Franchising - Location Strategy, Registration
Process - State Directorate of Industries- Financing for New Ventures - Central and State
Government Agencies - Types of loans – Financial Institutions - SFC, IDBI, NSIC and SIDCO.

UNIT II INTRODUCTION TO VENTURE FINANCING 9


Venture Finance – Definition – Historic Background - Funding New Ventures- Need – Scope –
Types - Cost of Project - Means of Financing - Estimation of Working Capital - Requirement of
funds – Mix of Dent and Equity - Challenges and Opportunities.

UNIT III SOURCES OF DEBT FINANCING 9


Fund for Capital Assets - Term Loans - Leasing and Hire-Purchase - Money Market instruments –
Bonds, Corporate Papers – Preference Capital- Working Capital Management- Fund based Credit
Facilities - Cash Credit - Over Draft.

UNIT IV SOURCES OF EQUITY FINANCING 9


Own Capital, Unsecured Loan - Government Subsidies , Margin Money- Equity Funding - Private
Equity Fund- Schemes of Commercial banks - Angel Funding – Crowdfunding- Venture Capital.

UNIT V METHODS OF FUND RAISING FOR NEW VENTURES 9


Investor Decision Process - Identifying the appropriate investors- Targeting investors- Developing
Relationships with investors - Investor Selection Criteria- Company Creation- Raising Funds -
Seed Funding- VC Selection Criteria – Process- Methods- Recent Trends
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students should be able to:
CO 1 Learn the basics of starting a new business venture.
CO 2 Understand the basics of venture financing.

364
CO 3 Understand the sources of debt financing.
CO 4 Understanf the sources of equity financing.
CO 5 Acquaint with the methods of fund raising for new business ventures.

REFERENCES :
1) Principles of Corporate Finance by Brealey and Myers et al.,12TH ed, McGraw Hill
Education (India) Private Limited, 2018
2) Prasanna Chandra, Projects : Planning ,Analysis,Selection ,Financing,Implementation and
Review, McGraw Hilld Education India Pvt Ltd ,New Delhi , 2019.
3) Introduction to Project Finance. Andrew Fight,Butterworth-Heinemann, 2006.
4) Metrick, Andrew; Yasuda, Ayako. Venture Capital And The Finance Of Innovation. Venture
Capital And The Finance Of Innovation, 2nd Edition, Andrew Metrick And Ayako Yasuda, Eds.,
John Wiley And Sons, Inc, 2010.
5) ‪Feld, Brad; Mendelson, Jason. Venture Deals. Wiley, 2011.‪
6) ‪May, John; Simons, Cal. Every Business Needs An Angel: Getting The Money You Need
To Make Your Business Grow. Crown Business, 2001.‪
7) ‪Gompers, Paul Alan; Lerner, Joshua. The Money Of Invention: How Venture Capital
Creates New Wealth. Harvard Business Press, 2001.‪
8) ‪Camp, Justin J. Venture Capital Due Diligence: A Guide To Making Smart Investment
Choices And Increasing Your Portfolio Returns. John Wiley & Sons, 2002.‪
9) ‪Byers, Thomas. Technology Ventures: From Idea To Enterprise. Mcgraw-Hill Higher
Education, 2014.‪
10) ‪Lerner, Josh; Leamon, Ann; Hardymon, Felda. Venture Capital, Private Equity, And The
Financing Of Entrepreneurship. 2012.‪

VERTICAL 3: PUBLIC ADMINISTRATION

CMG343 PRINCIPLES OF PUBLIC ADMINISTRATION L TPC


3 003
UNIT I (9)
1. Meaning, Nature and Scope of Public Administration
2. Importance of Public Administration
3. Evolution of Public Administration

UNIT II (9)
1. New Public Administration
2. New Public Management
3. Public and Private Administration

UNIT III (9)


1. Relationships with Political Science, History and Sociology
2. Classical Approach
3. Scientific Management Approach

365
UNIT IV (9)
1. Bureaucratic Approach: Max Weber
2. Human Relations Approach : Elton Mayo
3. Ecological Approach : Riggs

UNIT V (9)
1. Leadership: Leadership - Styles - Approaches
2. Communication: Communication Types - Process - Barriers
3. Decision Making: Decision Making - Types, Techniques and Processes.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCEs:
1. Avasthi and Maheswari: Public Administration in India, Agra:Lakshmi Narain Agarwal,2013.
2. Ramesh K Arora: Indian Public Administration, New Delhi: Wishwa Prakashan, 2012.
3. R.B. Jain: Public Administration in India,21st Century Challenges for Good Governance, New
Delhi: Deep and Deep, 2002.
4. Rumki Basu: Public Administration:Concept and Theories, New Delhi:Sterling, 2013.
5. R. Tyagi, Public Administration, Atma Ram & Sons, New Delhi, 1983.

CMG344 CONSTITUTION OF INDIA LTPC


3 003
UNIT I (9)
1. Constitutional Development Since 1909 to 1947
2. Making of the Constitution.
3. Constituent Assembly

UNIT II (9)
1. Fundamental Rights
2. Fundamental Duties
3. Directive Principles of State Policy

UNIT III (9)


1. President
2. Parliament
3. Supreme Court
UNIT IV (9)
1. Governor
2. State Legislature
3. High Court

UNIT V (9)
1. Secularism
2. Social Justice
3. Minority Safeguards
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

366
REFERENCES:
1. Basu. D.D.: Introduction to Indian Constitution ; Prentice Hall; New Delhi.
2. Kapur. A.C: Indian Government and Political System; S.Chand and Company Ltd., New Delhi.
3. Johari J.C.: Indian Politics, Vishal Publications Ltd, New Delhi
4. Agarwal R.C: Indian Political System; S.Chand & Co., New Delhi

CMG345 PUBLIC PERSONNEL ADMINISTRATION L T PC


3 0 03
UNIT I (9)
1. Meaning, Scope and Importance of Personnel Administration
2. Types of Personnel Systems: Bureaucratic, Democratic and Representative systems

UNIT II (9)
1. Generalist Vs Specialist
2. Civil Servants’ Relationship with Political Executive
3. Integrity in Administration.

UNIT III (9)


1. Recruitment: Direct Recruitment and Recruitment from Within
2. Training: Kinds of Training
3. Promotion

UNIT IV (9)
1. All India Services
2. Service Conditions
3. State Public Service Commission

UNIT V (9)
1. Employer Employee Relations
2. Wage and Salary Administration
3. Allowances and Benefits
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Stahl Glean O: Public Personnel Administration
2. Parnandikar Pai V.A: Personnel System for Development Administration.
3. Bhambhiru . P: Bureaucracy and Policy in India.
4. Dwivedi O.P and Jain R.B: India’s Administrative state.
5. Muttalis M.A: Union Public Service Commission.
6. Bhakara Rao .V: Employer Employee Relations in India.
7. Davar R.S. Personnel Management & Industrial Relations

367
CMG346 ADMINISTRATIVE THEORIES L T PC
3 0 0 3
UNIT I (9)
Meaning, Scope and significance of Public Administration, Evolution of Public Administration as a
discipline and Identity of Public Administration

UNIT II (9)
Theories of Organization: Scientific Management Theory, Classical Model,
Human Relations Theory

UNIT III (9)


Organization goals and Behaviour, Groups in organization and group dynamics, Organizational
Design.

UNIT IV (9)
Motivation Theories, content, process and contemporary; Theories of Leadership: Traditional and
Modern: Process and techniques of decision-making

UNIT V (9)
Administrative thinkers: Kautilya, Woodrow Willson, C.I. Barnard . Peter Drucker
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Crozior M : The Bureaucratic phenomenon (Chand)
2. Blau. P.M and Scott. W : Formal Organizations (RKP)
3. Presthus. R : The Organizational Society (MAC)
4. Alvi, Shum Sun Nisa : Eminent Administrative Thinkers.
5. Keith Davis : Organization Theory (MAC)

CMG347 INDIAN ADMINISTRATIVE SYSTEM LTPC


3 003
UNIT I (9)
Evolution and Constitutional Context of Indian Administration, Constitutional Authorities: Finance
Commission, Union Public Services Commission, Election Commission, Comptroller and Auditor
General of India, Attorney General of India

UNIT II (9)
Role & Functions of the District Collector, Relationship between the District
Collector and Superintendent of Police, Role of Block Development Officer in development
programmes, Local Government

UNIT III (9)


Main Features of 73rd Constitutional Amendment Act 1992, Salient Features of 74th Constitutional
Amendment Act 1992

UNIT IV (9)
Coalition politics in India, Integrity and Vigilance in Indian Administration

368
UNIT V (9)
Corruption – Ombudsman, Lok Pal & Lok Ayuktha
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. S.R. Maheswari : Indian Administration
2. Khera. S.S : Administration in India
3. Ramesh K. Arora : Indian Public Administration
4. T.N. Chaturvedi : State administration in India
5. Basu, D.D : Introduction to the Constitution of India

CMG348 PUBLIC POLICY ADMINISTRATION LTPC


3 003
UNIT I (9)
Meaning and Definition of Public Policy - Nature, Scope and Importance of public policy – Public
policy relationship with social sciences especially with political science and Public Administration.

UNIT II (9)
Approaches in Policy Analysis - Institutional Approach – Incremental Approach and System’s
Approach – Dror’s Optimal Model

UNIT III (9)


Major stages involved in Policy making Process – Policy Formulation – Policy Implementation –
Policy Evaluation.

UNIT IV (9)
Institutional Framework of Policy making – Role of Bureaucracy – Role of Interest Groups and Role
of Political Parties.

UNIT V (9)
Introduction to the following Public Policies – New Economic Policy – Population Policy –
Agriculture policy - Information Technology Policy.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Rajesh Chakrabarti & Kaushik Sanyal : Public Policy in India, Oxford University Press, 2016.
2. Kuldeep Mathur : Public Policy and Politics in India, Oxford University Press, 2016.
3. Bidyutv Chakrabarty: Public Policy: Concept, Theory and Practice, 2015.
4. Pradeep Saxena : Public Policy Administration and Development
5. Sapru R.K. : Public Policy: Formulation, Implementation and Evaluation, Sterling Publishers,
2016.

369
VERTICAL 4: BUSINESS DATA ANALYTICS

CMG349 STATISTICS FOR MANAGEMENT LT PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To learn the applications of statistics in business decision making.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Basic definitions and rules for probability, Baye‘s theorem and random variables, Probability
distributions: Binomial, Poisson, Uniform and Normal distributions.

UNIT II SAMPLING DISTRIBUTION AND ESTIMATION 9


Introduction to sampling distributions, Central limit theorem and applications, sampling techniques,
Point and Interval estimates of population parameters.

UNIT III TESTING OF HYPOTHESIS - PARAMETIRC TESTS 9


Hypothesis testing: one sample and two sample tests for means of large samples (z-test), one
sample and two sample tests for means of small samples (t-test), ANOVA one way.

UNIT IV NON-PARAMETRIC TESTS 9


Chi-square tests for independence of attributes and goodness of fit, Kolmogorov-Smirnov – test for
goodness of fit, Mann – Whitney U test and Kruskal Wallis test.

UNIT V CORRELATION AND REGRESSION 9


Correlation –Rank Correlation – Regression – Estimation of Regression line – Method of Least
Squares – Standard Error of estimate.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:To facilitate objective solutions in business decision making.
CO2:To understand and solve business problems
CO3:To apply statistical techniques to data sets, and correctly interpret the results.
CO4:To develop skill-set that is in demand in both the research and business environments
CO5:To enable the students to apply the statistical techniques in a work setting.

REFERENCES:
1. Richard I. Levin, David S. Rubin, Masood H.Siddiqui, Sanjay Rastogi, Statistics for
Management, Pearson Education, 8th Edition, 2017.
2. Prem. S. Mann, Introductory Statistics, Wiley Publications, 9th Edition, 2015.
3. T N Srivastava and Shailaja Rego, Statistics for Management, Tata McGraw Hill, 3rd Edition
2017.
4. Ken Black, Applied Business Statistics, 7th Edition, Wiley India Edition, 2012.
5. David R. Anderson, Dennis J. Sweeney, Thomas A.Williams, Jeffrey D.Camm, James
J.Cochran, Statistics for business and economics, 13th edition, Thomson (South – Western) Asia,
Singapore, 2016.
6. N. D. Vohra, Business Statistics, Tata McGraw Hill, 2017.

370
CMG350 DATAMINING FOR BUSINESS INTELLIGENCE LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES :
 To know how to derive meaning form huge volume of data and information.
 To understand how knowledge discovering process is used in business decision making.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Data mining, Text mining, Web mining, Data ware house.
UNIT II DATA MINING PROCESS 9
Datamining process – KDD, CRISP-DM, SEMMA
Prediction performance measures

UNIT III PREDICTION TECHNIQUES 9


Data visualization, Time series – ARIMA, Winter Holts,

UNIT IV CLASSIFICATION AND CLUSTERING TECHNIQUES 9


Classification, Association, Clustering.

UNIT V MACHINE LEARNING AND AI 9


Genetic algorithms, Neural network, Fuzzy logic, Ant Colony optimization, Particle Swarm
optimization
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1:Learn to apply various data mining techniques into various areas of different domains.
CO2:Be able to interact competently on the topic of data mining for business intelligence.
CO3:Apply various prediction techniques.
CO4:Learn about supervised and unsupervised learning technique.
CO5:Develop and implement machine learning algorithms

REFERENCES :
1. Jaiwei Ham and Micheline Kamber, Data Mining concepts and techniques, Kauffmann
Publishers 2006
2. Efraim Turban, Ramesh Sharda, Jay E. Aronson and David King, Business Intelligence, Prentice
Hall, 2008.
3. W.H.Inmon, Building the Data Warehouse, fourth edition Wiley India pvt. Ltd. 2005.
4. Ralph Kimball and Richard Merz, The data warehouse toolkit, John Wiley, 3rd edition,2013.
5. Michel Berry and Gordon Linoff, Mastering Data mining, John Wiley and Sons Inc, 2nd Edition,
2011
6. Michel Berry and Gordon Linoff, Data mining techniques for Marketing, Sales and Customer
support, John Wiley, 2011
7. G. K. Gupta, Ïntroduction to Data mining with Case Studies, Prentice hall of India, 2011
8. Giudici, Applied Data mining – Statistical Methods for Business and Industry, John Wiley. 2009
9. Elizabeth Vitt, Michael Luckevich Stacia Misner, Business Intelligence, Microsoft, 2011
10. Michalewicz Z., Schmidt M. Michalewicz M and Chiriac C, Adaptive Business Intelligence,
Springer – Verlag, 2007
11. GalitShmueli, Nitin R. Patel and Peter C. Bruce, Data Mining for Business Intelligence –
Concepts, Techniques and Applications Wiley, India, 2010.

371
CMG351 HUMAN RESOURCE ANALYTICS LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To develop the ability of the learners to define and implement HR metrics that are aligned
with the overall business strategy.
 To know the different types of HR metrics and understand their respective impact and
application.
 To understand the impact and use of HR metrics and their connection with HR analytics.
 To understand common workforce issues and resolving them using people analytics.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO HR ANALYTICS 9


People Analytics - stages of maturity - Human Capital in the Value Chain : impact on business –
HR metrics and KPIs.

UNIT II HR ANLYTICS I: RECRUITMENT 9


Recruitment Metrics : Fill-up ratio - Time to hire - Cost per hire - Early turnover - Employee referral
hires - Agency hires - Lateral hires - Fulfillment ratio- Quality of hire.

UNIT III HR ANALYTICS - TRAINING AND DEVELOPMENT 9


Training & Development Metrics : Percentage of employees trained- Internally and externally
trained -Training hours and cost per employee - ROI.

UNIT IV HR ANALYTICS EMPLOYEE ENGAGEMENT AND CAREER


PROGRESSION 9
Employee Engagement Metrics :Talent Retention index - Voluntary and involuntary turnover-
grades, performance, and service tenure - Internal hired index Career Progression Metrics:
Promotion index - Rotation index - Career path index.

UNIT V HR ANALYTICS IV: WORKFORCE DIVERSITY AND DEVELOPMENT 9


Workforce Diversity and Development Metrics : Employees per manager – Workforce age profiling
- Workforce service profiling - Churnover index - Workforce diversity
index - Gender mix
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOME:
CO1:The learners will be conversant about HR metrics and ready to apply at work settings.
CO2:The learners will be able to resolve HR issues using people analytics.

REFERENCES:
1. JacFitzenz , The New HR Analytics, AMACOM , 2010.
2. Edwards M. R., & Edwards K, Predictive HR Analytics: Mastering the HR Metric.London: Kogan
Page.2016.
3. Human Resources kit for Dummies – 3 rd edition – Max Messmer, 2003
4. Dipak Kumar Bhattacharyya, HR Analytics ,Understanding Theories and
Applications, SAGE Publications India ,2017.
5. Sesil, J. C. , Applying advanced analytics to HR management decisions: Methods fo selection,
developing incentives, and improving collaboration. Upper Saddle River,New Jersey: Pearson
Education,2014.
372
6. Pease, G., & Beresford, B, Developing Human Capital: Using Analytics to Plan and Optimize
Your Learning and Development Investments. Wiley ,2014.
7. Phillips, J., & Phillips, P.P, Making Human Capital Analytics Work: Measuring the ROI of Human
Capital Processes and OUTCOME. McGraw-Hill,2014.
8. HR Scorecard and Metrices, HBR, 2001.

CMG352 MARKETING AND SOCIAL MEDIA WEB ANALYTICS LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To showcase the opportunities that exist today to leverage the power of the web and social
media

UNIT I MARKETING ANALYTICS 9


Marketing Budget and Marketing Performance Measure, Marketing - Geographical Mapping, Data
Exploration, Market Basket Analysis

UNIT II COMMUNITY BUILDING AND MANAGEMENT 9


History and Evolution of Social Media-Understanding Science of Social Media –Goals for using
Social Media- Social Media Audience and Influencers - Digital PR- Promoting Social Media Pages-
Linking Social Media Accounts-The Viral Impact of Social Media.

UNIT III SOCIAL MEDIA POLICIES AND MEASUREMENTS 9


Social Media Policies-Etiquette, Privacy- ethical problems posed by emerging social media
technologies - The Basics of Tracking Social Media.

UNIT IV WEB ANALYTICS 9


Data Collection, Overview of Qualitative Analysis, Business Analysis, KPI and Planning, Critical
Components of a Successful Web Analytics Strategy, Proposals & Reports, Web Data Analysis.

UNIT V SEARCH ANALYTICS 9


Search engine optimization (SEO), user engagement, user-generated content, web traffic analysis,
online security, online ethics, data visualization.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOME:
 The Learners will understand social media, web and social media analytics and their
potential impact.

REFERENCES:
1. K. M. Shrivastava, Social Media in Business and Governance, Sterling Publishers Private
Limited, 2013
2. Christian Fuchs, Social Media a critical introduction, SAGE Publications Ltd, 2014
3. Bittu Kumar, Social Networking, V & S Publishers, 2013
4. Avinash Kaushik, Web Analytics - An Hour a Day, Wiley Publishing, 2007
5. Ric T. Peterson, Web Analytics Demystified, Celilo Group Media and CafePress 2004
6. Takeshi Moriguchi, Web Analytics Consultant Official Textbook, 7th Edition, 2016

373
CMG353 OPERATION AND SUPPLY CHAIN ANALYTICS LTPC
3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To treat the subject in depth by emphasizing on the advanced quantitative models and
methods in operations and supply chain management and its practical aspects and the
latest developments in the field.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Descriptive, predictive and prescriptive analytics, Data Driven Supply Chains – Basics, transforming
supply chains.

UNIT II WAREHOUSING DECISIONS 9


P-Median Methods - Guided LP Approach, Greedy Drop Heuristics, Dynamic Location Models,
Space Determination and Layout Methods.

UNIT III INVENTORY MANAGEMENT 9


Dynamic Lot sizing Methods, Multi-Echelon Inventory models, Aggregate Inventory system and
LIMIT, Risk Analysis in Supply Chain, Risk pooling strategies.

UNIT IV TRANSPORTATION NETWORK MODELS 9


Minimal Spanning Tree, Shortest Path Algorithms, Maximal Flow Problems, Transportation
Problems, Set covering and Set Partitioning Problems, Travelling Salesman Problem, Scheduling
Algorithms.

UNIT V MCDM MODELS 9


Analytic Hierarchy Process(AHP), Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA), Fuzzy Logic an Techniques,
the analytical network process (ANP), TOPSIS.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOME:
 To enable quantitative solutions in business decision making under conditions of certainty,
risk and uncertainty.

REFERENCES:
1. Nada R. Sanders, Big data driven supply chain management: A framework for implementing
analytics and turning information into intelligence, Pearson Education, 2014.
2. Michael Watson, Sara Lewis, Peter Cacioppi, Jay Jayaraman, Supply Chain Network Design:
Applying Optimization and Analytics to the Global Supply Chain, Pearson Education, 2013.
3. Anna Nagurney, Min Yu, Amir H. Masoumi, Ladimer S. Nagurney, Networks Against Time:
Supply Chain Analytics for Perishable Products, Springer, 2013.
4. Muthu Mathirajan, Chandrasekharan Rajendran, Sowmyanarayanan Sadagopan, Arunachalam
Ravindran, Parasuram Balasubramanian, Analytics in
Operations/Supply Chain Management , I.K. International Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., 2016.
5. Gerhard J. Plenert, Supply Chain Optimization through Segmentation and Analytics, CRC Press,
Taylor & Francis Group, 2014.

374
CMG354 FINANCIAL ANALYTICS L T PC
3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 This course introduces a core set of modern analytical tools that specifically target finance
applications.

UNIT I CORPORATE FINANCE ANALYSIS 9


Basic corporate financial predictive modelling- Project analysis- cash flow analysis- cost of capital,
Financial Break even modelling, Capital Budget model-Payback, NPV, IRR.

UNIT II FINANCIAL MARKET ANALYSIS 9


Estimation and prediction of risk and return ( bond investment and stock investment) –Time series-
examining nature of data, Value at risk, ARMA, ARCH and GARCH.

UNIT III PORTFOLIO ANALYSIS 9


Portfolio Analysis – capital asset pricing model, Sharpe ratio, Option pricing models- binomial
model for options, Black Scholes model and Option implied volatility.

UNIT IV TECHNICAL ANALYSIS 9


Prediction using charts and fundamentals – RSI, ROC, MACD, moving average and candle charts,
simulating trading strategies. Prediction of share prices.

UNIT V CREDIT RISK ANALYSIS 9


Credit Risk analysis- Data processing, Decision trees, logistic regression and evaluating credit risk
model.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOME
 The learners should be able to perform financial analysis for decision making using excel,
Python and R.

REFERENCES:
1. Financial analytics with R by Mark J. Bennett, Dirk L. Hugen, Cambridge university press.
2. Haskell Financial Data Modeling and Predictive Analytics Paperback – Import, 25 Oct 2013 by
Pavel Ryzhov.
3. Quantitative Financial Analytics: The Path To Investment Profits Paperback – Import, 11 Sep
2017 by Edward E Williams (Author), John A Dobelman.
4. Python for Finance - Paperback – Import, 30 Jun 2017 by Yuxing Yan (Author).
5. Mastering Python for Finance Paperback – Import, 29 Apr 2015 by James Ma Weiming.

375
VERTICAL 5: ENVIRONMENT AND SUSTAINABILITY

CES331 SUSTAINABLE INFRASTRUCTURE DEVELOPMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To impart knowledge about sustainable Infrastructure development goals, practices and to
understand the concepts of sustainable planning, design, construction, maintenance and
decommissioning of infrastructure projects.

UNIT I SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT GOALS 9


Definitions, principles and history of Sustainable Development - Sustainable development goals
(SDG): global and Indian – Infrastructure Demand and Supply - Environment and Development
linkages - societal and cultural demands – Sustainability indicators - Performance indicators of
sustainability and Assessment mechanism - Policy frameworks and practices: global and Indian –
Infrastructure Project finance – Infrastructure project life cycle - Constraints and barriers for
sustainable development - future directions.

UNIT II SUSTAINABLE INFRASTRUCTURE PLANNING 9


Overview of Infrastructure projects: Housing sector, Power sector, Water supply, road, rail and port
transportation sector, rural and urban infrastructure. Environmental Impact Assessment (EIA),
Land acquisition -Legal aspects, Resettlement &Rehabilitation and Development - Cost
effectiveness Analysis - Risk Management Framework for Infrastructure Projects, Economic,
demand, political, socio-environmental and cultural risks. Shaping the Planning Phase of
Infrastructure Projects to mitigate risks, Designing Sustainable Contracts, Negotiating with multiple
Stakeholders on Infrastructure Projects. Use of ICT tools in planning – Integrated planning - Clash
detection in construction - BIM (Building Information Modelling).

UNIT III SUSTAINABLE CONSTRUCTION PRACTICES AND TECHNIQUES 9


Sustainability through lean construction approach - Enabling lean through information technology –
Lean in planning and design - IPD (Integrated Project Delivery) - Location Based Management
System - Geospatial Technologies for machine control, site management, precision control and
real time progress monitoring - Role of logistics in achieving sustainable construction – Data
management for integrated supply chains in construction - Resource efficiency benefits of effective
logistics - Sustainability in geotechnical practice – Design considerations, Design Parameters and
Procedures – Quality control and Assurance - Use of sustainable construction techniques: Precast
concrete technology, Pre-engineered buildings.

UNIT IV SUSTAINABLE CONSTRUCTION MATERIALS 9


Construction materials: Concrete, steel, glass, aluminium, timber and FRP - No/Low cement
concrete - Recycled and manufactured aggregate - Role of QC and durability - Sustainable
consumption – Eco-efficiency - green consumerism - product stewardship and green engineering -
Extended producer responsibility – Design for Environment Strategies, Practices, Guidelines,
Methods, And Tools. Eco-design strategies –Design for Disassembly - Dematerialization,
rematerialization, transmaterialization – Green procurement and green distribution - Analysis
framework for reuse and recycling – Typical constraints on reuse and recycling - Communication of
Life Cycle Information - Indian Eco mark scheme - Environmental product declarations –
Environmental marketing- Life cycle Analysis (LCA), Advances in LCA: Hybrid LCA,

376
Thermodynamic LCA - Extending LCA - economic dimension, social dimension - Life cycle costing
(LCC) - Combining LCA and LCC – Case studies

UNIT V SUSTAINABLE MAINTENANCE OF INFRASTRUCTURE PROJECTS 9


Case Studies - Sustainable projects in developed countries and developing nations - An Integrated
Framework for Successful Infrastructure Planning and Management - Information Technology and
Systems for Successful Infrastructure Management, - Structural Health Monitoring for
Infrastructure projects - Innovative Design and Maintenance of Infrastructure Facilities - Capacity
Building and Improving the Governments Role in Infrastructure Implementation, Infrastructure
Management Systems and Future Directions. – Use of Emerging Technologies – IoT, Big Data
Analytics and Cloud Computing, Artificial Intelligences, Machine and Deep Learning, Fifth
Generation (5G) Network services for maintenance .
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS

COURSE OUTCOME:
On completion of the course, the student is expected to be able to
CO1 Understand the environment sustainability goals at global and Indian scenario.
CO2 Understand risks in development of projects and suggest mitigation measures.
CO3 Apply lean techniques, LBMS and new construction techniques to achieve sustainability in
infrastructure construction projects.
CO4 Explain Life Cycle Analysis and life cycle cost of construction materials.
CO5 Explain the new technologies for maintenance of infrastructure projects.
REFERENCES:
1. Charles J Kibert, Sustainable Construction : Green Building Design & Delivery, 4th Edition ,
Wiley Publishers 2016.
2. Steve Goodhew, Sustainable Construction Process, Wiley Blackwell,UK, 2016.
3. Craig A. Langston & Grace K.C. Ding, Sustainable Practices in the Built Environment,
4. Butterworth Heinemann Publishers, 2011.
5. William P Spence, Construction Materials, Methods & Techniques (3e), Yesdee Publication
Pvt. Ltd, 2016.
6. New Building Materials and Construction World magazine
7. Kerry Turner. R, "Sustainable Environmental Management", Principles and Practice
Publisher:Belhaven Press,ISBN:1852930039.
8. Munier N, "Introduction to Sustainability”, Springer2005
9. Sharma, “Sustainable Smart Cities In India: Challenges And Future Perspectives”,
SPRINGER, 2022.
10. Ralph Horne, Tim Grant, KarliVerghese, Life Cycle Assessment: Principles, Practice and
Prospects, Csiro Publishing,2009
11. European Commission - Joint Research Centre - Institute for Environment and
Sustainability: International Reference Life Cycle Data System (ILCD) Handbook - General
guide for Life Cycle Assessment - Detailed guidance. Luxembourg. European Union;2010
12. Hudson, Haas, Uddin, Infrastructure management: integrating design, construction,
maintenance, rehabilitation, and renovation, McGraw Hill, (1997).
13. GregerLundesjö, Supply Chain Management and Logistics in Construction: Delivering
Tomorrow's Built Environment, Kogan Page Publishers, 2015.

377
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING

PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 1 1 2 3 1 1 2 1 1 2 1
2 3 1 3 2 1 2 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 2
3 2 2 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 1
4 3 1 3 2 2 1 3 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2
5 3 1 2 2 2 2 3 1 1 1 2 2 3 2
Avg. 3 1 3 2 2 2 3 1 1 1 1 2 2 3 2
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

CES332 SUSTAINABLE AGRICULTURE AND ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
• To educate the students about the issues of sustainability in agroecosystems, introduce the
concepts and principles of agroecology as applied to the design and management of sustainable
agricultural systems for a changing world.

UNIT I AGROECOLOGY, AGROECOSYSTEM AND SUSTAINABLE AGRICULTURE


CONCEPTS 9
Ecosystem definition - Biotic Vs. abiotic factors in an ecosystem - Ecosystem processes -
Ecological services and agriculture - Problems associated with industrial agriculture/food systems -
Defining sustainability - Characteristics of sustainable agriculture - Difference between
regenerative and sustainable agriculture systems

UNIT II SOIL HEALTH, NUTRIENT AND PEST MANAGEMENT 9


Soil health definition - Factors to consider (physical, chemical and biological) - Composition of
healthy soils - Soil erosion and possible control measures - Techniques to build healthy soil -
Management practices for improving soil nutrient - Ecologically sustainable strategies for pest and
disease control

UNIT III WATER MANAGEMENT 9


Soil water storage and availability - Plant yield response to water - Reducing evaporation in
agriculture - Earthworks and tanks for rainwater harvesting - Options for improving the productivity
of water - Localized irrigation - Irrigation scheduling - Fertigation - Advanced irrigation systems and
agricultural practices for sustainable water use

UNIT IV ENERGY AND WASTE MANAGEMENT 9


Types and sources of agricultural wastes - Composition of agricultural wastes - Sustainable
technologies for the management of agricultural wastes - Useful and high value materials
produced using different processes from agricultural wastes - Renewable energy for sustainable
agriculture

378
UNIT V EVALUATING SUSTAINABILITY IN AGROECOSYSTEMS 9
Indicators of sustainability in agriculture - On-farm evaluation of agroecosystem sustainability -
Alternative agriculture approaches/ farming techniques for sustainable food production - Goals and
components of a community food system - Case studies
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOME
On completion of the course, the student is expected to be able to
CO1 Have an in-depth knowledge about the concepts, principles and advantages of sustainable
agriculture
CO2 Discuss the sustainable ways in managing soil health, nutrients, pests and diseases
CO3 Suggest the ways to optimize the use of water in agriculture to promote an ecological use of
resources
CO4 Develop energy and waste management plans for promoting sustainable agriculture in non-
sustainable farming areas
CO5 Assess an ecosystem for its level of sustainability and prescribe ways of converting to a
sustainable system through the redesign of a conventional agroecosystem

REFERENCES:
1. Approaches to Sustainable Agriculture – Exploring the Pathways Towards the Future of
Farming, Oberc, B.P. & Arroyo Schnell, A., IUCN, Belgium, 2020
2. Natural bioactive products in sustainable agriculture, Singh, J. & Yadav, A.N., Springer,
2020
3. Organic Farming for Sustainable Agriculture, Nandwani, D., Springer, 2016
4. Principles of Agronomy for Sustainable Agriculture, Villalobos, F.J. & Fereres, E., Springer,
2016
5. Sustainable Agriculture for Food Security: A Global Perspective, Balkrishna, A., CRC
Press, 2021
6. Sustainable Energy Solutions in Agriculture, Bundschuh, J. & Chen, G., CRC Press, 2014

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING - SUSTAINABLE AGRICULTURE PRACTICES


PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 2 2 2 2
2 2 2 2 2 3 2
3 2 2 3 2 3
4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 2 3
5 2 3 2 1 1 2
Avg. 3 2 3 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
1 – Low; 2 – Medium; 3 – High; ‘- “– No correlation

CES333 SUSTAINABLE BIOMATERIALS LT PC


3 00 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To Impart knowledge of biomaterials and their properties
 To learn about Fundamentals aspects of Biopolymers and their applications
 To learn about bioceramics and biopolymers
379
 To introduce the students about metals as biomaterials and their usage as implants
 To make the students understand the significance of bionanomaterials and its applications.

UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO BIOMATERIALS 9


Introduction: Definition of biomaterials, requirements & classification of biomaterials- Types of
Biomaterials- Degradable and resorbable biomaterials- engineered natural materials-
Biocompatibility-Hydrogels-pyrolitic carbon for long term medical implants-textured and porous
materials-Bonding types- crystal structure-imperfection in crystalline structure-surface properties
and adhesion of materials –strength of biological tissues-performance of implants-tissue response
to implants- Impact and Future of Biomaterials

UNIT II BIO POLYMERS 9


Molecular structure of polymers -Molecular weight - Types of polymerization techniques–Types of
polymerization reactions- Physical states of polymers- Common polymeric biomaterials -
Polyethylene -Polymethylmethacrylate (PMMA-Polylactic acid (PLA) and polyglycolic acid (PGA) -
Polycaprolactone (PCL) - Other biodegradable polymers –Polyurethan- reactions polymers for
medical purposes - Collagens- Elastin- Cellulose and derivatives-Synthetic polymeric membranes
and their biological applications

UNIT III BIO CERAMICS AND BIOCOMPOSITES 9


General properties- Bio ceramics -Silicate glass - Alumina (Al2O3) -Zirconia (ZrO2)-Carbon-
Calcium phosphates (CaP)- Resorbable Ceramics- surface reactive ceramics- Biomedical
Composites-Polymer Matrix Compsite(PMC)-Ceramic Matrix Composite(CMC)-Metal Matrix
Composite (MMC)–glass ceramics - Orthopedic implants-Tissue engineering scaffolds

UNIT IV METALS AS BIOMATERIALS 9


Biomedical metals-types and properties-stainless steel-Cobalt chromium alloys-Titanium alloys-
Tantalum-Nickel titanium alloy (Nitinol)- magnesium-based biodegradable alloys-surface properties
of metal implants for osteointegration-medical application-corrosion of metallic implants – biological
tolerance of implant metals

UNIT V NANOBIOMATERIALS 9
Meatllicnanobiomaterials–Nanopolymers-Nanoceramics- Nanocomposites -Carbon based
nanobiomaterials - transport of nanoparticles- release rate-positive and negative effect of
nanosize-nanofibres-Nano and micro features and their importance in implant performance-
Nanosurface and coats-Applications nanoantibiotics-Nanomedicines- Biochips – Biomimetics-
BioNEMs -Biosensor-Bioimaging/Molecular Imaging- challenges and future perspective.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1:Students will gain familiarity with Biomaterials and they will understand their importance.
CO2:Students will get an overview of different biopolymers and their properties
CO3:Students gain knowledge on some of the important Bioceramics and Biocomposite materials
CO4:Students gain knowledge on metals as biomaterials
CO5:Student gains knowledge on the importance of nanobiomaterials in biomedical applications.

380
REFERENCES
1. C. Mauli Agrawal, Joo L. Ong, Mark R. Appleford, Gopinath Mani “Introduction to
Biomaterials Basic Theory with Engineering Applications” Cambridge University Press,
2014.
2. Donglu shi “Introduction to Biomaterials” Tsinghua University press, 2006.
3. Joon Park, R.S.Lakes “Biomaterials An Introduction” third edition, Springer 2007.
4. M.Jaffe,W.Hammond, P.Tolias and T.Arinzeh “Characterization of Biomaterials” Wood
head publishing, 2013.
5. Buddy D.Ratner and Allan S.Hoffman Biomaterials Science “An Introduction to Material in
Medicine” Third Edition, 2013.
6. VasifHasirci, NesrinHasirci “Fundamentals of Biomaterials” Springer, 2018
7. Leopoido Javier Rios Gonzalez. “Handbook of Research on Bioenergy and Biomaterials:
Consolidated and green process” Apple academic press, 2021.
8. Devarajan Thangadurai, Jeyabalan Sangeetha, Ram Prasad “Functional Bionanomaterials”
springer, 2020.
9. Sujata.V.Bhat Biomaterials; Narosa Publishing house, 2002.

CES334 MATERIALS FOR ENERGY SUSTAINABILITY LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
 To familiarize the students about the challenges and demands of energy sustainability
 To provide fundamental knowledge about electrochemical devices and the materials used.
 To introduce the students to various types of fuel cell
 To enable students to appreciate novel materials and their usage in photovoltaic application
 To introduce students to the basic principles of various types Supercapacitors and the
materials used.

UNIT I SUSTAINABLE ENERGY SOURCES 9


Introduction to energy demand and challenges ahead – sustainable source of energy (wind, solar
etc.) – electrochemical energy systems for energy harvesting and storage – materials for
sustainable electrochemical systems building – India centric solutions based on locally available
materials – Economics of wind and solar power generators vs. conventional coal plants – Nuclear
energy

UNIT II ELECTROCHEMICAL DEVICES 9


Electrochemical Energy – Difference between primary and secondary batteries – Secondary
battery (Li-ion battery, Sodium-ion battery, Li-S battery, Li-O2 battery, Nickel Cadmium, Nickel
Metal Hydride) – Primary battery (Alkaline battery, Zinc-Carbon battery) – Materials for battery
(Anode materials – Lithiated graphite, Sodiated hard carbon, Silicon doped graphene, Lithium
Titanate) (Cathode Materials – S, LiCoO2, LiFePO4, LiMn2O4) – Electrolytes for Lithium-ion battery
(ethylene carbonate and propylene carbonate based)

381
UNIT III FUEL CELLS 9
Principle of operation of fuel cells – types of fuel cells (Proton exchange membrane fuel cells,
alkaline fuel cell, direct methanol fuel cells, direct borohydride fuel cells, phosphoric acid fuel cells,
solid oxide fuel cells, and molten carbonate fuel cells) – Thermodynamics of fuel cell – Fuel
utilization – electrolyte membrane ( proton conducting and anion conducting) – Catalysts (
Platinum, Platinum alloys, carbon supported platinum systems and metal oxide supported platinum
catalysts) – Anatomy of fuel cells (gas diffusion layer, catalyst layer, flow field plate, current
conductors, bipolar plates and monopolar plates).

UNIT IV PHOTOVOLTAICS 9
Physics of the solar cell – Theoretical limits of photovoltaic conversion – bulk crystal growth of Si
and wafering for photovoltaic application - Crystalline silicon solar cells – thin film silicon solar cells
– multijunction solar cells – amorphous silicon based solar cells – photovoltaic concentrators –
Cu(InGa)Se2 solar cells – Cadium Telluride solar cells – dye sensitized solar cells – Perovskite
solar cells – Measurement and characterization of solar cells - Materials used in solar cells (
metallic oxides, CNT films, graphene, OD fullerenes, single-multi walled carbon nanotubes, two-
dimensional Graphene, organic or Small molecule-based solar cells materials - copper-
phthalocyanine and perylenetetracarboxylicbis - benzine – fullerenes - boron subphthalocyanine-
tin (II) phthalocyanine)

UNIT V SUPERCAPACITORS 9
Supercapacitor –types of supercapacitors (electrostatic double-layer capacitors, pseudo capacitors
and hybrid capacitors) - design of supercapacitor-three and two electrode cell-parameters of
supercapacitor- Faradaic and non - Faradaic capacitance – electrode materials (transition metal
oxides (MO), mixed metal oxides, conducting polymers (CP), Mxenes, nanocarbons, non-noble
metal, chalcogenides, hydroxides and 1D-3D metal-organic frame work (MOF), activated carbon
fibres (ACF)- Hydroxides-Based Materials - Polyaniline (PANI), a ternary hybrid composite-
conductive polypyrrole hydrogels – Different types of nanocomposites for the SC electrodes
(carbon–carbon composites, carbon-MOs composites, carbon-CPs composites and MOs-CPs
composites) - Two-Dimensional (2D) Electrode Materials - 2D transition metal carbides,
carbonitrides, and nitrides.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1:Students will acquire knowledge about energy sustainability.
CO2:Students understand the principles of different electrochemical devices.
CO3:Students learn about the working of fuel cells and their application.
CO4:Students will learn about various Photovoltaic applications and the materials used.
CO5:The students gain knowledge on different types of supercapacitors and the performance of
various materials

REFERENCES
1. Functional materials for sustainable energy applications; John A. Kilner, Stephen J. Skinner,
Stuart J. C. Irvine and Peter P. Edwards.
2. Hand Book of Fuel Cells: Fuel Cell Technology and Applications, Wolf Vielstich, Arnold
Lamm, Hubert Andreas Gasteiger, Harumi Yokokawa, Wiley, London 2003.
3. B.E. Conway, Electrochemical supercapacitors: scientific fundamentals and technological
applications, Kluwer Academic / Plenum publishers, New York, 1999.
4. T.R. Crompton, Batteries reference book, Newners, 3rd Edition, 2002.
382
5. Materials for Supercapacitor applications; B.Viswanathan. M.Aulice Scibioh
6. Electrode Materials for Supercapacitors: A Review of Recent Advances, Parnia
Forouzandeh, Vignesh Kumaravel and Suresh C. Pillai, catalysts 2020.
7. Recent advances, practical challenges, and perspectives of intermediate temperature solid
oxide fuel cell cathodes Amanda Ndubuisi, Sara Abouali, Kalpana Singh and
VenkataramanThangadurai, J. Mater. Chem. A, 2022.
8. Review of next generation photovoltaic solar cell technology and comparative materialistic
development Neeraj Kant, Pushpendra Singh, Materials Today: Proceedings, 2022.

CES335 GREEN TECHNOLOGY L T PC


3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
 To acquire knowledge on green systems and the environment, energy technology and
efficiency, and sustainability.
 To provide green engineering solutions to energy demand, reduced energy footprint.

UNIT I PRINCIPLES OF GREEN CHEMISTRY 9


Historical Perspectives and Basic Concepts. The twelve Principles of Green Chemistry and green
engineering. Green chemistry metrics- atom economy, E factor, reaction mass efficiency, and other
green chemistry metrics, application of green metrics analysis to synthetic plans.

UNIT II POLLUTION TYPES 9


Pollution – types, causes, effects, and abatement. Waste – sources of waste, different types of
waste, chemical, physical and biochemical methods of waste minimization and recycling.

UNIT III GREEN REAGENTS AND GREEN SYNTHESIS 9


Environmentally benign processes- alternate solvents- supercritical solvents, ionic liquids, water as
a reaction medium, energy-efficient design of processes- photo, electro and sono chemical
methods, microwave-assisted reactions

UNIT IV DESIGNING GREEN PROCESSES 9


Safe design, process intensification, in process monitoring. Safe product and process design –
Design for degradation, Real-time Analysis for pollution prevention, inherently safer chemistry for
accident prevention

UNIT V GREEN NANOTECHNOLOGY 9


Nanomaterials for water treatment, nanotechnology for renewable energy, nanotechnology for
environmental remediation and waste management, nanotechnology products as potential
substitutes for harmful chemicals, environmental concerns with nanotechnology
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
CO1: To understand the principles of green engineering and technology
CO2: To learn about pollution using hazardous chemicals and solvents
CO3: To modify processes and products to make them green and safe.
CO4: To design processes and products using green technology
CO5: To understand advanced technology in green synthesis

383
TEXT BOOKS
1. Green technology and design for the environment, Samir B. Billatos, Nadia A. Basaly, Taylor &
Francis, Washington, DC, ©1997
2. Green Chemistry – An introductory text - M. Lancaster, RSC,2016.
3. Green chemistry metrics - Alexi Lapkin and david Constable (Eds) , Wiley publications,2008

REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Environmental chemistry, Stanley E Manahan, Taylor and Francis, 2017

CES336 ENVIRONMENTAL QUALITY MONITORING AND ANALYSIS LT PC


3 0 03
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 to understand and study the complexity of the environment in relation to pollutants
generated due to industrial activity.
 To analyze the quality of the environmental parameters and monitor the same for the
purpose of environmental risk assessment.

UNIT I ENVIRONMENTAL MONITORING AND STANDARDS 9


Introduction- Environmental Standards- Classification of Environmental Standards- Global
Environmental Standards- Environmental Standards in India- Ambient air quality standards- water
quality standard- Environmental Monitoring-Need for environmental monitoring- Concepts of
environmental monitoring- Techniques of Environmental Monitoring.

UNIT II MONITORING OF ENVIRONMENTAL ARAMETERS 9


Current Environmental Issues- Global Environmental monitoring programme-International
conventions- Application of Environmental Monitoring- Atmospheric Monitoring - screening
parameters – Significance of environmental sampling- sampling methods – water sampling -
sampling of ambient air-sampling of flue gas.

UNIT III ANALYTICAL METHODS FOR ENVIRONMENTAL MONITORING 9


Classification of Instrumental Method- Analysis of Organic Pollutants by Spectrophotometric
methods -Determination of nitrogen, phosphorus and, chemical oxygen demand (COD) in sewage;
Biochemical oxygen demand (BOD)- Sampling techniques for air pollution measurements; analysis
of particulates and air pollutants like oxides of nitrogen, oxides of sulfur, carbon monoxide,
hydrocarbon; Introduction to advanced instruments for environmental analysis

UNIT IV ENVIRONMENTAL MONITORING PROGRAMME (EMP) & RISKASSESSMENT 9


Water quality monitoring programme- national water quality monitoring- Parameters for National
Water Quality Monitoring- monitoring protocol; Process of risk assessment- hazard identification-
exposure assessment- dose-response assessment; risk characterization.

UNIT V AUTOMATED DATA ACQUISITION AND PROCESSING 9


Data Acquisition for Process Monitoring and Control - The Data Acquisition System - Online Data
Acquisition, Monitoring, and Control - Implementation of a Data Management System - Review of
Observational Networks -Sensors and transducers- classification of transducers- data acquisition

384
system- types of data acquisition systems- data management and quality control; regulatory
overview.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
After completion of this course, the students will know

CO1 Basic concepts of environmental standards and monitoring.


CO2 the ambient air quality and water quality standards;
CO3 the various instrumental methods and their principles for environmental monitoring
CO4 The significance of environmental standards in monitoring quality and sustainability
of the environment.
CO5 the various ways of raising environmental awareness among the people.
CO6 Know the standard research methods that are used worldwide for monitoring the
environment.

TEXTBOOKS
1. Environmental monitoring Handbook, Frank R. Burden, © 2002 by The McGraw-Hill
Companies, Inc.
2. Handbook of environmental analysis: chemical pollutants in the air, water, soil, and soild
wastes / Pradyot Patnaik, © 1997 by CRC Press, Inc
REFERENCES
1. Environmental monitoring / edited by G. Bruce Wiersma, © 2004 by CRC Press LLC.
2. H. H. Willard, L. L. Merit, J. A. Dean and F. A. Settle, Instrumental Methods of Analysis,
CBP Publishers and Distributors, New Delhi, 1988.
3. Heaslip, G. (1975) Environmental Data Handling. John Wiley & Sons. New York.

CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING


Course Program Outcomes
Outcom PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
es 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 1 1 1 - - - - - - - - - 3 - -
CO2 1 1 1 1 1 - - - 1 - 2 2 2 1 1
CO3 1 1 2 1 1 - - - 2 - 1 1 1 - -
CO4 1 2 3 3 1 - - - 2 - 3 3 1 - -
CO5 1 1 3 2 1 - - - 3 - 3 1 2 - -
CO6 3 2 3 3 2 - - - 3 - 3 3 3 1 1
Over all 3 2 3 3 2 - - - 3 - 3 3 3 1 1
1 - low, 2 - medium, 3 - high, ‘-“- no correlation

CES337 INTEGRATED ENERGY PLANNING FOR SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT L T P C


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To create awareness on the energy scenario of India with respect to world
 To understand the fundamentals of energy sources, energy efficiency and resulting
environmental implications of energy utilisation
 Familiarisation on the concept of sustainable development and its benefits
385
 Recognize the potential of renewable energy sources and its conversion technologies for
attaining sustainable development
 Acquainting with energy policies and energy planning for sustainable development

UNIT I ENERGY SCENARIO 9


Comparison of energy scenario – India and World (energy sources, generation mix, consumption
pattern, T&D losses, energy demand, per capita energy consumption) – energy pricing – Energy
security

UNIT II ENERGY AND ENVIRONMENT 9


Conventional Energy Sources - Emissions from fuels – Air, Water and Land pollution –
Environmental standards - measurement and controls

UNIT III SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT 9


Sustainable Development: Concepts and Stakeholders, Sustainable Development Goal (SDG) -
Social development: Poverty, conceptual issues and measures, impact of poverty. Globalization
and Economic growth - Economic development: Economic inequalities, Income and growth.

UNIT IV RENEWABLE ENERGY TECHNOLOGY 9


Renewable Energy – Sources and Potential – Technologies for harnessing from Solar, Wind,
Hydro, Biomass and Oceans – Principle of operation, relative merits and demerits

UNIT V ENERGY PLANNING FOR SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT 9


National & State Energy Policy - National solar mission - Framework of Central Electricity Authority
- National Hydrogen Mission - Energy and climate policy - State Energy Action Plan, RE
integration, Road map for ethanol blending, Energy Efficiency and Energy Mix

COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1:Understand the world and Indian energy scenario
CO2:Analyse energy projects, its impact on environment and suggest control strategies
CO3:Recognise the need of Sustainable development and its impact on human resource
development
CO4:Apply renewable energy technologies for sustainable development
CO5:Fathom Energy policies and planning for sustainable development.

REFERENCES:
1. Energy Manager Training Manual (4Volumes) available at http://www.em-
ea.org/gbook1.asp, a website administered by Bureau of Energy Efficiency (BEE), a
statutory body under Ministry of Power, Government of India.2004
2. Robert Ristirer and Jack P. Kraushaar, “Energy and the environment”, Willey, 2005.
3. Godfrey Boyle, “Renewable Energy, Power for a Sustainable Future”, Oxford University
Press, U.K., 2012
4. Twidell, J.W. & Weir A., “Renewable Energy Resources”, EFNSpon Ltd., UK, 2015.
5. Dhandapani Alagiri, Energy Security in India Current Scenario, The ICFAI University Press,
2006.
6. M.H. Fulekar,Bhawana Pathak, R K Kale,“Environment and Sustainable Development”
Springer,2016
386
7. https://www.niti.gov.in/verticals/energy

CES338 ENERGY EFFICIENCY FOR SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT LTPC


3 003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
 To understand the types of energy sources, energy efficiency and environmental
implications of energy utilisation
 To create awareness on energy audit and its impacts
 To acquaint the techniques adopted for performance evaluation of thermal utilities
 To familiarise on the procedures adopted for performance evaluation of electrical
utilities
 To learn the concept of sustainable development and the implication of energy usage

UNIT I ENERGY AND ENVIRONMENT 9


Primary energy sources - Coal, Oil, Gas – India Vs World with respect to energy production and
consumption, Climate Change, Global Warming, Ozone Depletion, UNFCCC, COP

UNIT II ENERGY AUDITING 9


Need and types of energy audit. Energy management (audit) approach-understanding energy
costs, bench marking, energy performance, matching energy use to requirement, maximizing
system efficiencies, optimizing the input energy requirements, fuel & energy substitution, energy
audit instruments

UNIT III ENERGY EFFICIENCY IN THERMAL UTILITIES 9


Energy conservation avenues in steam generation and utilisation, furnaces, Thermic Fluid Heaters.
Insulation and Refractories - Commercial waste heat recovery devices: recuperator, regenerator,
heat pipe, heat exchangers (Plate, Shell & Tube), heat pumps, and thermocompression

UNIT IV ENERGY CONSERVTION IN ELECTRICAL UTILITIES 9


Demand side management - Power factor improvement – Energy efficient transformers - Energy
conservation avenues in Motors, HVAC, fans, blowers, pumps, air compressors, illumination
systems and cooling towers

UNIT V SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT 9


Sustainable Development: Concepts and Stakeholders, Sustainable Development Goal (SDG).
Globalization and Economic growth. Economic development: Economic inequalities, Income and
growth. Social development: Poverty, conceptual issues and measures, impact of poverty,

COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1:Understand the prevailing energy scenario
CO2:Familiarise on energy audits and its relevance
CO3:Apply the concept of energy audit on thermal utilities
CO4:Employ relevant techniques for energy improvement in electrical utilities
CO5:Understand Sustainable development and its impact on human resource development

387
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Energy Manager Training Manual (4Volumes) available at http://www.em-
ea.org/gbook1.asp, a website administered by Bureau of Energy Efficiency (BEE), a
statutory body under Ministry of Power, Government of India.2004
2. Eastop.T.D& Croft D.R, “Energy Efficiency for Engineers and Technologists”, Logman
Scientific & Technical, ISBN-0-582-03184, 1990
3. W.R. Murphy and G. McKay “Energy Management” Butterworths, London 1987
4. Pratap Bhattacharyya, “Climate Change and Greenhouse Gas Emission”, New India
Publishing Agency- Nipa,2020
5. Matthew John Franchetti , Defne Apul “Carbon Footprint Analysis: Concepts, Methods,
Implementation, and Case Studies” CRC Press,2012
6. Robert A. Ristinen, Jack J. Kraushaar, Jeffrey T. Brack, “Energy and the Environment”, 4th
Edition,Wiley,2022
7. M.H. Fulekar,Bhawana Pathak, R K Kale,“Environment and Sustainable Development”
Springer,2016
8. Sustainable development in India: Stocktaking in the run up to Rio+20: Report prepared by
TERI for MoEF, 2011.

388

You might also like